Quarterlytics / Kerry Group

Kerry Group

kyga · LSE
Claim this profile
Ticker kyga
Exchange LSE
Sector
Industry
Employees 10,000+
← All annual reports
FY2024 Annual Report · Kerry Group
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
		
INSPIRING FOOD 
NOURISHING LIFE
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
DIRECTORS’ REPORT

CONTENTS
CONTENTS
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
Our Performance in 2024 	
2 
At a Glance	
4
Our Business in 2024	
5
Chairman's Statement	
6 
Chief Executive Officer’s Review	
8 
Our Strategy 	
12
Our People	
14
Our Business Model 	
18
Science & Technology	
20
Our Markets	
22
Strategy & Targets	
24
Key Performance Indicators	
26
Financial Review	
28
Business Review: Taste & Nutrition	
34
Business Review: Dairy Ireland	
37
Sustainability Review	
38 
TCFD Compliance Statement	
45
Risk Management Report	
46 
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Board of Directors	
58 
Report of the Directors	
62
Governance Report  
Corporate Governance Report	
69 
Audit Committee Report	
85
Governance and Nomination Committee Report 	
91
Sustainability Committee Report  	
96
Remuneration Committee Report  	
98
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
Independent Practitioners’ Limited Assurance Report	
	 128
Sustainability Statement	
131
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Independent Auditors’ Report	
235
Financial Statements 	
244
Notes to the Financial Statements 	
252 
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
Financial Definitions  	
322 

Scope 1 & 2  
Carbon Reduction2
50%
2023: 48%
2 See Sustainability Review pages 38-45 for further information on Sustainability Measures
Consumers reached  
with Positive and Balanced 
Nutritional Solutions2
1.36bn
2023: 1.25bn
Reduction in  
Food Waste2
38%
2023: 39%
Sustainability Measures
Strategic Report Our Performance in 2024
OUR PERFORMANCE IN 2024
Financial Performance Measures 
Performance based on total operations unless otherwise stated
1 See Key Performance Indicators section pages 26-27 and the Supplementary Information section pages 322-326 for definitions,  
calculations and reconciliations of Alternative Performance Measures
€8.0bn
2023: €8.0bn 
2024 Continuing Revenue: €6.9bn
Group Revenue
Volume Growth1
+3.3%
2023: -0.9%
15.7%+120bps
2023: 14.5% +60bps 
2024 Continuing EBITDA Margin: 17.1%
424.5c
+3.4%
2023: 410.4c +20%
€766m
+95%
2023: €701m 92%
10.6%
2023: 10.0%
€989m
2023: €1,038m
127.1c
+10.1%
2023: 115.4c +10.1%
Group EBITDA Margin1
Basic EPS
Net Cash from Operating Activities
Total Dividend Per Share
Group EBITDA1
Constant Currency Adjusted EPS1
Free Cash Flow¹ (cash conversion %)
Return on Average Capital Employed1
€1.25bn
2023: €1.17bn
2024 Continuing EBITDA: €1.19bn
467.5c
+9.7%
2023: 430.1c +1.2%
3
2
Strategic Report Our Performance in 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

5
Strategic Report At a Glance
Strategic Report Business Overview
OUR BUSINESSES IN 2024
Taste & Nutrition 
The leader in integrated solutions
We use our broad range of ingredient solutions to innovate 
with our customers to create great tasting products, with 
improved nutrition and functionality, while ensuring a better 
impact for the planet.
Our consumer insights experts, R&D team of over 1,200 
food scientists and extensive global footprint enable us  
to solve our customers’ most complex challenges with 
differentiated solutions.
Our Taste & Nutrition business has three  
key market differentiators:
•	 Sustainable Nutrition - we are a leader in solutions  
that combine nutritional profile enhancements, 
improved taste, value for money and a minimised 
environmental impact
•	 Emerging Markets - we have a winning local model 
supported by a leading presence across emerging 
markets and a portfolio that drives positive impact
•	 Foodservice - we have deeply embedded innovation 
partnerships with customers, a longstanding and 
dedicated business model, and a broad and deep 
technology portfolio
Dairy Ireland
The Kerry Dairy Ireland business consists of Dairy Consumer Products, with its leading range of brands 
across cheese, cheese snacks, dairy snacks and dairy spreads. It also comprises the Dairy Ingredients 
business, which is a leading provider of Irish dairy ingredients including functional dairy proteins, 
nutritional dairy bases and cheese systems, along with the provision of related agribusiness products 
and services.
Following the 70% sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland (which forms the Dairy Ireland segment) as described in 
Note 8 to the Group's Financial Statements, effective 2025 the Dairy Ireland business will no longer be a 
reportable segment of the Group.
Geography
End Use Market
Channel
A Diversified Global Business
21,000+
Employees
124
Manufacturing  
Facilities
+9%
Revenue  
CAGR
+11%
EBITDA  
CAGR
+11%
Adjusted EPS  
CAGR
+16%
Dividend  
per share  
CAGR
70+
Technology and 
Innovation Centres
1,200+
R&D scientists
AT A GLANCE
1 Based on total operations
2 Based on continuing operations
CAGR = Compound Average Growth Rate (1986 - 2024)
OUR
PEOPLE
OUR  
GLOBAL  
FOOTPRINT
OUR  
TRACK  
RECORD
Kerry is a world leader in sustainable 
taste and nutrition solutions. Using 
our unique capabilities, we partner 
with customers to create healthier, 
tastier, and more sustainable 
products enjoyed by over one billion 
people around the world.
€1.25bn
Group EBITDA
Continuing EBITDA €1.19bn
€8.0bn
Group Revenue
Continuing Revenue €6.9bn
Our vision: 
To be our customers’  
most valued partner, 
creating a world of 
sustainable nutrition
4
7%
21%
24%
33%
67%
55%
66%
27%
68%
32%
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

Strategic Report Chairman's Statement
6
Strategic Report Chairman's Statement
Overview
2024 was a transformative year for Kerry with the 
sale of the Dairy Ireland business. It was also a year 
of strong financial performance, particularly given 
the market environment.
This exemplifies our track record of evolution and our 
collective drive to deliver long-term sustainable results 
through the execution of our strategy.
Strategic Update
Through targeted capital investments and strategic 
portfolio development, the Group continues to evolve 
its footprint and technology portfolio to strengthen 
Kerry’s standing as a world-leading sustainable taste 
and nutrition company. This portfolio evolution, 
including the buildout of the Group’s Biotechnology 
Solutions business and the recent sale of the Dairy 
Ireland business, has better positioned Kerry to  
deliver impact and value for our customers and  
other stakeholders. 
Our management team held an investor day in 
October, where they provided a strategic update 
on how Kerry continues to outperform its markets. 
Materials relating to the investor day are available in 
the investor section of the Group's website.
The Group will remain agile and flexible in terms 
of assessing the various capital allocation options 
available and will prioritise those that will generate 
sustained value over the longer-term, taking account 
of prevailing market conditions.
Sustainability
The Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy 
underpins Kerry’s future growth as we continue 
to partner with our customers across the globe to 
deliver impact through sustainable nutrition.
The Group is committed to achieving net zero carbon 
emissions before 2050. The Climate Transition Plan, 
which was published during the year, sets out how 
Kerry is working to better understand the ways in 
which carbon emissions can be reduced while we 
help our customers create healthier, more nutritious 
products that taste great in a way that protects people 
and the environment around us.
Details regarding the Group’s sustainability strategy, 
targets, performance, policies and programmes are 
outlined in the Sustainability Committee Report on 
pages 96-97, the Sustainability Review on pages 38-45 
and the Sustainability Statement on pages 127-233. 
The Sustainability Statement is new this year and 
is included in the 2024 Annual Report in line with 
the requirements of the Corporate Sustainability 
Reporting Directive.
Corporate Governance
The Board is committed to maintaining the highest 
standards of corporate governance. During 2024, the 
Board reviewed the Company’s corporate governance 
policies and procedures to monitor compliance with 
the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code and the Irish 
Corporate Governance Annex (together the Code) 
alongside the latest developments in legal/regulatory 
requirements and best practice.
We also engaged with our stakeholders during the 
year as we believe that listening to their views and 
needs is fundamental to building a sustainable 
business. Further details of our stakeholder 
engagement activities are outlined on pages 75-78.
Each year, the Board undertakes a formal evaluation 
of its own effectiveness and that of its Committees. In 
2024, the evaluation was an internal self-assessment 
and the outcome of this review is that both the Board 
and its Committees are operating effectively.
Board Changes
We are delighted to have further strengthened our 
Board in 2024 with the addition of Ms. Liz Hewitt who 
joined the Board with effect from 1 March 2024. She 
brings a wealth of experience and expertise which 
will make her a valuable asset to the Board and I look 
forward to working with her in the years ahead.
Dr. Hugh Brady and Dr. Karin Dorrepaal retired from 
the Board at the conclusion of the 2024 AGM. On 
behalf of the Board, I would like to thank Hugh 
and Karin for their commitment and dedication 
throughout their years of service.
As part of the ongoing Board refreshment process, 
the Governance and Nomination Committee will 
continue its search for candidates with the required 
skills, experiences and backgrounds to join the Board 
as vacancies arise.
Purpose and Values
Our purpose, Inspiring Food, Nourishing Life, and our 
Values of Courage, Enterprising Spirit, Inclusiveness, 
Open-mindedness and Ownership guide our actions 
and behaviours, keeping us on the right path toward 
achieving our goals and vision.
During 2024, the Board continued to oversee how 
management promotes our purpose and values 
to unite the organisation across different cultures 
and geographies. Staying true to Kerry’s purpose, 
the organisation has responded to the changing 
economic and geopolitical landscape, demonstrating 
the significant agility, passion and resilience of 
our people by doing the right thing for customers, 
shareholders, communities and the environment. 
People and Engagement
The hard work and commitment of all our employees 
is central to Kerry’s success. During the year, the 
Board ensured that employee interests were taken 
into account in Board decision-making including 
recognising the impact of the inflationary environment 
that prevailed in recent years.
The Board also recognises the importance of 
employee engagement and continues to enhance 
our employee engagement activities. During 2024, 
Ms. Emer Gilvarry, the newly designated Workforce 
Engagement Director, participated in a programme 
of activities where she had the opportunity to assess 
the engagement levels of our people, both in-person 
within our offices and manufacturing sites as well as 
remotely. Details of these activities are outlined in 
the Corporate Governance Report on pages 69-84.
Operational Visits
In 2024, the Board held its June Board meeting in the 
Netherlands. The visit afforded Board members the 
opportunity to meet and engage with key leaders 
and emerging talent from the European region.  
The Board also participated in customer immersion 
experiences that showcased the Group’s capabilities 
in helping customers to solve industry challenges 
with differentiated solutions.
I also visited Group facilities in Ireland, the US and 
most recently, Dubai and Saudi Arabia. During those 
visits, I had the opportunity to meet and engage  
with the local management teams and see  
first-hand how the significant capital expenditure 
which was approved by the Board has bolstered 
Kerry's presence in these countries.
Dividend and Share  
Buyback Programme
The Board recommends a final dividend of 89.0 cent 
per share, (an increase of 10.1% on the 2023 final 
dividend) payable on 9 May 2025 to shareholders 
registered on the record date of 11 April 2025.
Together with the interim dividend of 38.1 cent per 
share paid in November 2024, this brings the total 
dividend for the year to 127.1 cent, an increase of 
10.1% on 2023.
During the year, the Board approved two additional 
share buyback programmes which combined will 
return up to €600m of capital to shareholders.  
This is in addition to the €300m that was returned 
to shareholders in the buyback programme 
launched in November 2023. These programmes are 
underpinned by the Group’s strong balance sheet 
and cash flow and are aligned to the Company’s 
Capital Allocation Framework.
Prospects
The Board remains confident that the Group’s 
business model, strategic priorities and capital 
allocation decision-making will continue to deliver 
growth, enhance shareholder value and benefit our 
stakeholders in the years to come. In this regard the 
Group’s balance sheet is well placed to support our 
objectives. The view of management regarding the 
business outlook for 2025 is presented in the Chief 
Executive Officer’s Review.
On behalf of the Board, I would like to sincerely 
thank Edmond and the Executive Leadership Team 
for their exceptional leadership and thank everyone 
throughout the organisation for their contribution to 
the ongoing success of the Group.
Tom Moran 
Chairman 
17 February 2025
Kerry delivered a strong  
financial performance in a  
year of transformative change.
CHAIRMAN’S  
STATEMENT
7
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

Strategic Report Chief Executive Officer’s Review
Dear shareholders and all stakeholders,
We were pleased to report a strong performance 
and progress through 2024, with revenue of €8.0bn, 
EBITDA of €1.25bn and free cash flow of €766m, 
while expanding our nutritional reach to 1.36 billion 
consumers globally. This growth was enabled by 
our key growth differentiators of Foodservice, 
Emerging Markets and Sustainable Nutrition.
Key to Kerry’s success over the years has been 
the ability to continually evolve and develop 
our business, while maintaining an unwavering 
commitment to growth and market outperformance. 
It’s hard to believe that since 2017, almost 60% 
of Kerry’s portfolio has been rotated, including 
the development of our Biotechnology Solutions 
business and the sale of our Consumer Foods and 
Dairy Ireland businesses. This systematic strategic 
development has much better positioned Kerry 
to deliver impact and value for our customers.
At our US Investor Day in October, we highlighted 
our unique strategic positioning, key strengths and 
showcased our talented market-winning teams. 
A key takeaway from the day was the significant 
market penetration opportunity that exists with 
our customers, through areas like reduced sodium 
and sugar, sustainability improvements and 
technology solutions that help reduce cost and 
complexity. These have been a key underpin of 
our recent market outperformance, and we feel 
confident these will continue into the future.
We maintain a proactive, flexible approach as 
regards capital allocation, balancing reinvestment 
in our business and capital returns. Underpinning 
our framework is the ongoing evaluation of market 
conditions and strategic alternatives to determine how 
best to generate value and deliver on our targets.
As we continue to grow and strategically evolve 
as a business, it is our people who continue 
to embody our purpose of Inspiring Food, 
Nourishing Life, as we aim to achieve our vision 
of being our customers’ most valued partner, 
creating a world of sustainable nutrition.
CHIEF  
EXECUTIVE  
OFFICER’S  
REVIEW
Strategic Report Chief Executive Officer’s Review
8
2024 represented a milestone year for Kerry,  
with the sale of our Dairy Ireland business,  
a strategic update at our Investor Day and  
a strong financial performance.
€8.0bn €1.25bn €766m
Group Revenue 
EBITDA
Free Cash Flow
consumers reached 
with our positive and 
balanced nutritional 
solutions globally
1.36bn
Strong Business Performance and Strategic Development
9
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

Our Markets and Performance
While a number of markets remained subdued, 
2024 represented a more normalised year relative 
to recent history. Customer innovation activity was 
more weighted towards renovation of existing 
products, with an increased focus on nutritional 
profile enhancement, cost optimisation and improving 
sustainability characteristics of products. A significant 
level of new product innovation concentrated on 
addressing increased consumer demand for new taste 
experiences and providing relative value options.
Revenue for the year was €8.0bn with Taste & Nutrition 
volume growth of 3.4%, reflecting good progression 
through the year and 4.1% in the last quarter. EBITDA 
increased to €1.25bn with margins increasing by 
120bps. Adjusted earnings per share increased by 
9.7% on a constant currency basis and strong free 
cash flow of €766m was achieved in the year.
We made good progress against our Beyond the 
Horizon sustainability strategy and commitments. 
Under Better for People, we increased our 
nutritional reach of positive and balanced 
nutrition solutions to 1.36 billion people, as we 
continue to support our customers in improving 
the nutritional profile of their products.
Under Better for Society, we extended our award-
winning employee share ownership plan 'OurShare' 
to a further 16 countries, and increased our level 
of women in senior leadership positions to 35%.
Under Better for the Planet, we delivered an 
overall 50% reduction in Scope 1 & 2 carbon, while 
we reduced food waste across our operational 
footprint by 38% versus our base year. We continue 
our efforts across our range of sustainability 
commitments, while supporting our customers 
in producing more nutritious, sustainable food 
and beverage products that deliver a better 
impact for people, society and the planet.
Regional Performance
Taste & Nutrition delivered a good performance, 
particularly in the Americas, which had reported 
revenue of €3.8bn, reflecting good volume growth 
of 4.1%. This was driven by excellent growth 
in foodservice with established and emerging 
chains. Within our end markets, growth was led by 
Snacks, Beverage and Bakery with innovation and 
renovation utilising Kerry's range of savoury taste 
profiles and Tastesense™ salt and sugar reduction 
technologies. Within LATAM, growth was led by 
Mexico, particularly in Snacks and Beverage.
In Europe, reported revenue was €1.5bn, with 
volumes similar to the prior year given muted 
market conditions across the region. Good growth 
was achieved in the foodservice channel through 
seasonal and limited time offer extensions, 
with volumes in the retail channel turning 
positive in the last quarter. Performance was 
led by Meals, Bakery and Beverage markets.
In APMEA, reported revenue was €1.7bn, with 
volume growth of 4.8% primarily driven by strong 
performances in the Middle East and Africa, while 
volumes in China remained challenged through 
the year. Growth in the region was led by Beverage, 
Snacks and Meat markets, with good launch 
activity across global and regional leaders.
Dairy Ireland delivered a good overall performance, 
with EBITDA increasing to €63m, led by growth 
in Dairy Consumer Products. The sale of Kerry 
Dairy Ireland completed on 31 December.
Forward Looking Statement
We remain well-positioned for continued market 
outperformance given our unique positioning with 
customers as an innovation and renovation partner, 
and we will continue to strategically evolve and 
develop our taste and nutrition portfolio in areas 
where we can create the most value.
Edmond Scanlon 
Chief Executive Officer  
17 February 2025
11
Strategic Report Chief Executive Officer’s Review
A Pure Play Taste and Nutrition Company 
The sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland represents a significant step and a natural progression in Kerry’s 50 year 
journey. The result of the sale is a global leader in taste and nutrition solutions and an end-to-end industry 
leader in dairy. Kerry is now a pure play global business-to-business taste and nutrition company, with 
sustainable nutrition at our core, with this transaction supporting our financial objectives of continued market 
outperformance, strong margin progression and delivering returns for our shareholders. Both businesses are 
well positioned for success, thanks to the dedication and extraordinary contribution of our people over the 
years, and we wish our Dairy Ireland colleagues all the best in the future.
Strategic Report Chief Executive Officer’s Review
10
Positioned for Success
At our investor day we outlined five key strategic takeaways  
that make Kerry unique.
1.	
We demonstrated how our winning model is driving success in the Americas.
2.	
We showcased why we believe foodservice represents a structural tailwind for Kerry.
3.	
Emerging markets have been a key driver of growth over many years, and we gave  
examples of how regulatory changes in front-of-pack labelling are leading to renovation  
and innovation opportunities.
4.	
We have significantly enhanced our technology portfolio in recent years, in particular our 
Biotechnology Solutions platform, which has better positioned Kerry to drive impact for  
our customers. 
5.	
Finally, we highlighted the market penetration opportunity, which is all about renovation 
of products through reformulation, nutritional enhancements, cleaner labels, sustainability 
enhancements or cost reduction solutions.
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

13
Strategic Report Our Strategy
Strategic Report Our Strategy
OUR STRATEGY
Kerry's focus is on food and beverage markets, with its strategic priorities 
of Taste, Nutrition and Emerging Markets, ensuring capital allocation 
decisions are aligned to strategy.
Taste for Kerry is built on our 
from-food-for-food heritage 
and philosophy, with a 
broad range of foundational 
technology capabilities 
including Taste Modulation, 
Botanicals and Natural 
Extracts, and Savoury, 
Sweet and Dairy Flavours, 
supported by our expertise 
in sensory science.
Our Nutrition, Wellness 
& Functionality portfolio 
delivers benefits such as 
immunity support, digestive 
health, cleaner labels, and 
preservation. These benefits 
are achieved by leveraging 
our broad foundational 
technology platform which 
includes Proteins, Probiotics 
and Bioactives, Lipids, 
Enzymes, Bio-preservation 
and Pharma.
We have a winning model 
in emerging markets. Our 
local focus, combined with 
our global expertise and 
capabilities, supported by 
our leading presence across 
emerging markets, have 
been key to our excellent 
track record of growth.
Strategy in Action
Going beyond the targets
Up to 60% salt reduction, enabled  
by Kerry Tastesense™ technologies.
We partner with customers to reduce salt in their products, 
helping them meet WHO’s 30% global target for salt reduction, 
adapt to a growing number of local nutritional guidelines 
and regulations, and achieve their own ambitious sustainable 
nutrition goals. With Kerry’s Tastesense™ Salt portfolio, we have 
industry-leading solutions to solve sodium reduction challenges 
across snacks, meals, soups, sauces and dressings, meats and 
bakery. Linking taste receptor mechanisms with capabilities 
across our technology portfolio, our scientists develop 
modulation tools that mimic the sought-after mouthfeel, body, 
and taste of salt – with no compromise on taste experiences.
Slow cooked, fast tracked
Layering Kerry technologies to deliver 
authentic savoury taste experiences  
for consumers.     
There is a growing demand among consumers for the authentic, 
slow-cooked, rich flavours of traditional, carefully crafted meals. 
Through our unique business model, Kerry is leading the way 
in creating true-to-tradition, natural taste solutions inspired 
by local cooking methods, with our chefs, food scientists and 
application experts layering Kerry technologies to create a 
differentiated integrated solution that can be deployed at scale. 
Technologies such as fermentation, where our Umamex™ taste 
solutions portfolio of extracts provides rich and robust savoury 
character to a variety of finished applications through naturally 
occurring amino acids and peptides.
TASTE
NUTRITION
EMERGING 
MARKETS
Cut the waste
Kerry multi-technology preservation 
solutions delivering extended shelf life  
for our bakery customers.
Tackling food waste is a key challenge for our industry, with 
bread and bakery products being the largest category of waste 
by volume. We are a leader in food protection and preservation, 
with a broad range of capabilities across conventional and 
clean label preservation solutions, including solutions powered 
by fermentation and biotechnology. Through combining and 
layering these technologies, we deliver differentiated integrated 
solutions where others cannot. Recently, we partnered with a 
bakery customer to more than double the textural shelf life of 
their fresh baked product, virtually eliminating waste in store, 
using a multi-technology, enzyme-based preservation solution.
This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 SBM-1 40 a i as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 133 - subject to limited assurance.
12
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

People
Locations
Countries
21,000+
200+
50+
Strategic Report Our People
14
OUR 
PEOPLE
15
Strategic Report Our People
We value the unique contributions of employees with 
different backgrounds, experiences, and viewpoints, 
and foster an inclusive culture where everyone can 
feel welcome. We are committed to preserving and 
further cultivating an environment where everyone 
feels respected, valued, included and encouraged 
to contribute, and confident that they belong. 
Employees’ terms and conditions of employment, 
including hiring, training, working conditions, 
compensation, benefits, and promotions are based 
on the individual’s qualifications, performance, 
contribution, motivation, skills, and experience. 
Kerry is committed to providing equality of 
opportunity to people in all aspects of employment. 
In 2024, under the guidance of our Global Diversity, 
Inclusion & Belonging (DI&B) Council, a DI&B Global 
Taskforce was set-up to coordinate the roll-out of 
our refreshed DI&B framework which builds on what 
has already been achieved and gives enhanced focus 
to Inclusive Leadership, Education and Awareness, 
and Equitable Experience. We continue to raise 
awareness at a local level, with events designed to 
celebrate gender, cultural and intellectual diversity. 
To monitor the effectiveness and implementation 
of these initiatives, we track employee experience 
on a recurring basis through a formal process. 
We are committed to increasing awareness and 
understanding, and to developing skills so that 
our leaders, managers, and all employees can play 
their part in building an inclusive organisation.
In 2024, 35% of our senior leadership roles were 
held by female leaders (2023: 34%), meeting our 
2025 target for share of leadership roles held by 
women one year ahead of schedule. At the end of 
2024, women held 39% (2023: 37%) of our senior 
management roles and we remain committed 
to achieving equal gender representation in 
senior management by the end of 2030.
People with Purpose
In 2024, the Kerry team included 
more than 21,000 dedicated 
individuals, working across 54 
countries worldwide. These people 
form our global organisation, working 
to make our purpose – Inspiring food, 
nourishing life – an everyday reality. 
Our teams are active around the world, 
bringing together leading expertise in a range 
of disciplines and engaging with stakeholders 
across the value chain to create value for our 
customers, while contributing positively to 
the communities in which we operate.
Our values of Courage, Enterprising Spirit, 
Inclusiveness, Open-Mindedness and Ownership 
guide how we approach our work. We expect all of our 
people, from our established leaders to colleagues 
at the early stage of their careers, to demonstrate 
these values in their work, and in their interactions 
with co-workers, customers and other stakeholders; 
creating the dynamic, and the environment necessary 
to achieve progress, and to realise our purpose. 
Safe & Inclusive
Providing a safe workplace is 
a fundamental requirement 
for our organisation.
We nurture and maintain a culture of safety at work, 
for the protection of co-workers, communities, 
customers and other stakeholders. ‘Safety First, 
Quality Always’ is a guiding principle by which 
we operate; never compromising on the safety 
of our people and providing a safe and healthy 
workplace. This principle is embedded across 
the organisation, underpinned by the Group’s 
Health and Safety policy. A series of dynamic 
initiatives, including a ‘Global Safety Guardians’ 
programme - to motivate employees to take the 
right decisions when it comes to safety, have been 
deployed to reinforce the behaviours needed to 
maintain the highest standards of health and 
safety at work. All of our people have a role to 
play in achieving our health and safety ambition, 
and everyone is expected to challenge potentially 
unsafe conditions and behaviours if they arise.
representation of 
women in senior 
leadership roles
35%
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

17
Strategic Report Our People
Strategic Report Our People
Learning & Leading
Enabling colleagues to continue 
to grow professionally, from early 
career to leadership positions, is an 
essential consideration to ensure 
we have the skills and capability to 
deliver on our ambitions.
Our Kerry Leadership Academy offers a range 
of learning experiences designed to grow our 
leaders’ competencies. During 2024, we focused 
on accelerating growth in the number of female 
candidates available for leadership positions, 
embedding our Women in Leadership programme 
in two regions. This programme provides skills and 
the networks necessary to ensure female leaders can 
successfully navigate potential challenges to  
their progression.
We continue to evaluate and further strengthen 
the quality of our senior leadership talent pipelines 
through ongoing strategic talent reviews. This 
includes initiatives to build upon the quality of our 
leadership teams and develop candidates for key 
strategic appointments. We also continue to invest 
in activities to accelerate succession readiness of 
identified talent for senior leadership roles through 
our Investing in Leadership for Growth programme.
Across the organisation, our Learning Academies 
support growth by enabling the development and 
application of skills and knowledge necessary to 
enhance commercial and operational effectiveness, 
and to support opportunities for personal growth. 
We continue to develop enterprise learning initiatives 
across the Group, to build core capabilities aligned 
to our strategic objectives. One such example 
is our proprietary ‘This Is Sustainable Nutrition’ 
programme, designed to enhance our leaders’, and 
ultimately all of our employees understanding of 
Kerry’s market offering in sustainable nutrition.
Kerry’s early careers programme is a core component 
of our strategy to strengthen our future talent 
pipeline. We expanded our graduate programme 
during 2024 and will further extend the programme 
into 2025 across all regions, fully aligned to Kerry’s 
strategic priorities and future skillset requirements.
Rewarding and  
Recognising our People
Total Reward at Kerry is about more 
than just pay and financial rewards.
Informed by our principles of fairness and 
equitability, Total Reward encompasses career 
development, personal growth and access to 
opportunities where all our people can excel, both 
personally and professionally. Our approach to 
reward supports us in striving to be the first choice 
for the best talent by providing fair, competitive 
offerings which our people value and which drive an 
ownership mindset to achieve Kerry’s goals.
Our aim is to ensure that our reward programmes 
are positioned as one of the key levers of business 
performance, are appropriately aligned with the 
external market, and are delivered in a way that 
makes them more easily understood and appreciated 
by our people.
During 2024, we implemented the next phase of 
our Total Rewards roadmap. Some examples of 
enhancements made during 2024 include: 
•	 Building on the success of our employee share 
plan OurShare in 2023, we expanded the plan to 
a further 16 countries. It is now available in 24 
countries across all regions, covering more than 
94% of our workforce. 
One in six colleagues have chosen to join OurShare 
becoming shareholders and owning part of Kerry.
We are delighted that OurShare was recognised as 
‘Best International Share Plan’ by Proshare, a UK 
body working to promote wider share ownership. 
•	 Throughout 2024, we partnered with the Global 
Fair Wage Network to enhance our Living Wage 
strategy and roadmap, building on our current 
certification and experience in the UK where we 
have been an accredited Living Wage Employer 
since April 2023.
•	 Continuing our focus on fostering a healthy, 
positive work environment, in 2024, together 
with a leading psychology-based organisation, 
we developed, piloted, and commenced a phased 
rollout of a structured Emotional Wellbeing 
Training Programme for people leaders at Kerry. 
We will continue our rollout across all regions  
in 2025. 
•	 We continue to promote and embed our 
global recognition programme, Inspiring 
People, recognising our people for their active 
engagement and commitment to living our 
Kerry values. This year we presented a special 
recognition award of an additional day of paid 
annual leave to 12,000 frontline operators across 
our manufacturing sites worldwide.
Working Together
Our people define our organisation. 
They are a critical stakeholder group, and their 
perspectives and interests play a vital role in realising 
the business opportunities that Kerry pursues. 
Ensuring our employees have the capability, skills, 
resources, and working environment necessary to do 
their roles is a key consideration. 
We utilise multiple employee engagement 
mechanisms to ensure the voices of our employees 
and others who undertake work for our organisation 
are heard and considered in our decision-making. 
These include the OurVoice employee experience 
survey, ongoing two-way engagement through 
our employee representative groups and regular 
townhall meetings. 
Our Workforce Engagement Director plays a key role 
at Board level, ensuring employee perspectives are 
considered and integrated into high-level  
decision-making. 
It is in these ways we ensure that the entire Kerry team 
can work together, to be our customers’ most-valued 
partner, creating a world of sustainable nutrition. 
16
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

19
Strategic Report Our Business Model
18
Strategic Report Our Business Model
OUR BUSINESS MODEL
Financial
Investment grade credit rating 
S&P BBB+, Moody’s Baa1 
€6.5bn Equity
Social And  
Relationships
Relationships with global 
brands, local communities, 
regulators and industry bodies
60+ university and external 
research partnerships
Manufacturing
Target CAPEX of 4-5% of 
revenue per annum
124 manufacturing locations 
across 34 countries
Natural
A global network of raw 
material suppliers across 
almost 80 countries
Human
21,000+ talented employees 
across 200+ locations and 
50+ countries, bringing broad 
industry knowledge and  
local expertise
Intellectual
70+ technology and  
innovation centres
1,200+ food scientists
€310m R&D spend across  
total operations
Kerry is a leading B2B specialty ingredients provider. We source our natural raw materials from 
a vast global network of producers and suppliers. Using our unique capabilities, we partner with 
customers to create healthier, tastier and more sustainable products. Our value-add ingredient 
solutions deliver impact across our large and diverse customer base which includes food, 
beverage and pharma companies operating across both the retail and foodservice channels.
Our unique business model comprises our broad range of taste and nutrition foundational 
technologies, product process technologies, insights and culinary expertise, and development 
and application teams. These capabilities are underpinned by our strong culture of innovation, 
quality and safety, as we aim to solve our customers challenges with differentiated solutions.
WHAT WE DO2
HOW WE DO IT
INPUTS: WHAT WE DEPEND ON1
	 Elevated Nutrition
	 Clinical Health Benefits
	 Speed to Market
	 Extended Shelf Life
	 Operational Efficiencies
	 Channel Diversification
	 Cleaner Labels
SOLVING OUR  
CUSTOMERS’ CHALLENGES
	 Improved Taste
	 Process Improvement
	 Enhanced Sustainability
	 New Innovation Platforms
	 Novel Taste Experiences
	 Local Cooking Taste
	 Regulatory Support
WITH DIFFERENTIATED  
SOLUTIONS
Financial
€8.0bn Revenue and €1.25bn 
EBITDA from total operations
€766m Free Cash Flow
Social And  
Relationships
Concern Worldwide, the UN 
World Food Programme and 
Women’s Empowerment 
Principles (WEPs)
Manufacturing
Global manufacturing footprint 
and supply chain infrastructure 
enabling Kerry solutions to reach 
over one billion people around  
the world
Natural
Responsible consumption and 
production with sustainable 
sourcing, emissions reduction 
and waste recovery
Human
An inclusive workplace that 
enables people to excel both 
personally and professionally
Intellectual
Customer-specific innovation 
combined with differentiated 
new technologies and solutions
~1,200 Patents and patent 
applications
Supporting our customers in creating great tasting products, with improved 
nutrition and functionality, while ensuring a better impact for the planet.
THE IMPACT WE DELIVER2
WHO WE BENEFIT
HOW WE CONTRIBUTE
OUTPUTS: THE VALUE WE CREATE3
Customers and Consumers
Global reach, local supply and 
a positive impact portfolio
Community
External partnerships 
supporting the communities 
in which we operate 
Suppliers
Supporting producers and 
local economies through 
responsible sourcing
Employees
Safe and inclusive workplace, 
an equitable reward philosophy 
and development supports
Shareholders
Long-term value creation and 
consistent dividend growth
Government
A source of tax revenues  
and employment,  
supporting economies
Securing and developing the inputs that we depend on is critical to the long-term sustainable success of the 
Group. It is a key factor in our strategic decision-making and is supported by our capital allocation, stakeholder 
engagement and risk management strategies.
1 This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 SBM-1 42 a as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 133 - subject to limited assurance.
2 This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 SBM-1 42 c as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 133 - subject to limited assurance.
2 This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 SBM-1 42 c as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 133 - subject to limited assurance.
3 This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 SBM-1 42 b as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 133 - subject to limited assurance.
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

21
Strategic Report Science & Technology
Strategic Report Science & Technology
20
22
Core Technologies
33
End Use Markets
Development and
Applications Centres
70+
Technology
& Innovation
Centres Globally
OUR GLOBAL SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY ECO-SYSTEM
1,200+
~ 200
~ 1,200
60+
Scientists
PhDs & Masters
Patents & Patent
Applications
University & External
Partnerships
1 Cumulative 10 year operating and capital investment
Leading Research, Development & Applications Capabilities
Blending science and technology 
expertise to pioneer sustainable 
solutions that will nourish 
generations to come.
Innovating for Today
Leveraging our broad and deep technology 
portfolio, our application teams bring to life 
new innovations for our customers that deliver 
on sustainable nutrition.
Evolving Today
Deploying our process technology capabilities, 
we create better products for customers, with 
improved costs and sustainability features. 
Innovating for Tomorrow
With a focus on Taste and Biotechnology 
platforms, we uncover the deeper science 
of food and nutrition, to advance new and 
innovative technologies that can deliver on 
future customer needs. 
Application  
Innovation
Proactive & Reactive
Technology  
Innovation
Science 
Innovation
Open  
Innovation
Innovating Together
SCIENCE &  
TECHNOLOGY
investment in science and 
technology eco-system1
€3bn+
Innovating for Today
Innovating for Tomorrow
Evolving Today
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 SBM-1 40 a ii as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 133 - subject to limited assurance.
Strategic Report Our Markets
Strategic Report Our Markets
The growing
€85 
BILLION
speciality ingredients 
and flavours markets
Market 
Penetration   
Opportunity1
2
Consumer Dynamics
	 Health and wellbeing
	 Natural trusted ingredients
	 Authentic local taste
	 Sustainability credentials
	 Convenience
3
Macro Dynamics
	 Growing world population
	 Urbanisation
	 Rising Global Incomes
1
A significant market 
penetration opportunity
2
Consumer dynamics 
within our markets
3
Macro, global demographic 
and economic dynamics
OUR MARKETS
Kerry provides ingredient solutions to the food, beverage and pharma 
markets. These are highly dynamic markets, with many opportunities 
for growth into the future. 
The key drivers of market growth that we see are:
1
Market Penetration Opportunity
There are significant opportunities across our markets. Kerry’s technology portfolio 
and business model is well-positioned to take advantage of these opportunities by 
partnering with our customers to renovate their product portfolios, helping them 
make progress towards their sustainable nutrition goals.
Nutritional 
Enhancement
Significant opportunity to improve the nutritional profile of our customers’ 
products, particularly across sodium and sugar reduction where we help them 
meet WHO guidelines and their own, often more ambitious, targets.
Cleaner Labels
Partnering with customers to enhance the ingredient profile of their products, 
delivering natural clean label alternative ingredient solutions, and maintaining 
or improving taste and consumer perception.
Sustainability 
Enhancement
Helping our customers achieve their sustainability goals through portfolio 
renovation and reformulation. Targeting food waste with natural preservation 
solutions and delivering solutions to reduce carbon footprint.
Cost Reduction 
Solutions
Bringing our customers solutions to reduce cost. For example, solutions 
to simplify back-of-house operations for foodservice customers and food 
protection and preservation solutions to reduce food waste across the 
supply chain.
€75bn
2019
€85bn
2024
Future Market
€15bn+
1 Source: Kerry estimates based on market data from various sources, including Euromonitor, Nielson,  
Foodtrending and Innova Market Insights.
23
22
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

Strategic Report Strategy & Targets
1 Taste & Nutrition business volume growth target assumes end market growth of 1%+
2 Assumes neutral currency and raw materials
3 Average adjusted earnings per share growth in constant currency terms (2025-2028)
4 Sustainability targets to be achieved by 2030. Carbon and food waste reduction versus 2017 base year. The food waste reduction 
target relates to own operations only. For more detail on Kerry’s targets, see the Sustainability Review on pages 38-45 and the 
Sustainability Statement on pages 127-233.
Full financial definitions can be found on pages 322-326.
Volume Growth1
4-6%
EBITDA Margin by 20262
18-19%
Cash Conversion
80%+
ROACE
10-12%
OUR FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE MEASURES
SUSTAINABILITY4
RETURN
GROWTH
Nutritional Reach
Reach over two billion 
people with sustainable 
nutrition solutions
Carbon
55% reduction in  
Scope 1 & 2 carbon 
emissions
Food Waste
50% reduction  
in Food Waste
STRATEGY  
& TARGETS
Strategic Report Strategy & Targets
25
Medium-Term Financial Targets Post Divestment of Kerry Dairy Ireland
Following the divestment of Kerry Dairy Ireland on 31 December 2024, the Group is refreshing 
its current medium-term financial targets for 2022-26 to reflect Kerry’s new business profile as a  
pure-play Taste & Nutrition company. It is also introducing an expanded 2028 Group EBITDA 
margin target of 19-20% and a target for adjusted earnings per share growth.
EBITDA Margin by 20282
19-20%
Adjusted EPS Growth3
HSD+
Current Medium-Term Financial Targets (2022-26)  
On average across the plan
Additional Financial Targets
24
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

27
26
Strategic Report Key Performance Indicators
Strategic Report Key Performance Indicators
¹ Cumulative 10 year operating and capital investment
¹ Cumulative 10 year operating and capital investment
SUSTAINABILITY
Metric
Nutritional Reach 
1.36 billion
Carbon Reduction 
50%
Reduction in Food Waste 
38%
Performance
Commentary
Nutritional Reach is a measure of the number 
of consumers we impact with positive and 
balanced nutritional solutions as we strive to 
be Better for People.
Scope 1 & 2 Carbon Reduction is a measure of 
progress towards Kerry’s environmental targets, 
as part of its Better for Planet ambition.
Food waste reduction measures food loss and waste 
across our operations, and aligns with UN SDG 12 
and our Better for Planet ambition.
Strategic  
Importance / 
Link to  
Remuneration
As consumers seek healthier, more sustainable 
diets, Kerry is ideally placed to support 
customers in the development of products 
that deliver sustainable nutrition. This is a 
sustainability performance metric within the 
long-term incentive plan.
At Kerry, we are addressing our operational 
emissions as part of our total carbon footprint 
and are committed to achieving Net Zero before 
2050. This is a sustainability performance metric 
within the long-term incentive plan.
We are committed to halving food waste across our 
operations and supporting our customers in reducing 
their food waste with sustainable solutions. This is 
a sustainability performance metric within the long- 
term incentive plan.
Further definitions, calculations and detail for these are set out above and within the Sustainability Review on pages 38-45.
GROWTH
Metric
Volume Growth1  
+3.3%
EBITDA Margin1 
+120bps
Performance
Commentary
Group volumes increased in the year due to good 
growth in our Taste & Nutrition business, which 
represented a significant outperformance relative 
to food and beverage end markets.
Group EBITDA margin increased due to benefits from the Accelerate 
Operational Excellence Programme, portfolio developments, 
operating leverage, product mix and the net effect from pricing.
Strategic  
Importance / 
Link to  
Remuneration
Volume growth is an important metric as it
is a key driver of organic top line business
improvement. It is a metric in the short-term
incentive plan and is a key driver of adjusted
EPS growth, which is a metric for the long-term
incentive plan.
EBITDA margin expansion is a key measure of
profitability. It is a metric in the short-term incentive
plan and is a key driver of adjusted EPS growth on
a constant currency basis, which is a metric for the
long-term incentive plan.
Comparable  
IFRS measure
Continuing revenue growth:
-0.7%
Continuing operating profit:
€832.8m -1.1%
1 Volume growth and EBITDA margin performance based on total operations
For more information see the Supplementary Information section – Financial Definitions on page 322-326.
RETURN
Return on Average Capital Employed 
10.6%
Free Cash Flow Conversion 
95%
Group return on average capital employed increased 
in the year due to good organic profit growth.
Free cash flow conversion increased in the year, with 
good EBITDA growth and an improvement in average 
working capital more than offsetting increased capital 
expenditure.
ROACE is a key measure of the return the Group 
achieves on its investment in capital expenditure 
projects, acquisitions and other strategic 
investments. It is a performance metric for 
the long-term incentive plan.
Cash conversion is an important metric as it measures 
how much of the Group’s adjusted earnings is converted 
into cash. It is a performance metric for the short-term 
incentive plan.
There is no IFRS measure  
comparable to ROACE.
Net cash from operating activities:
€988.7m (2023: €1,037.8m).
Kerry’s key performance measures include a combination of 
growth, return and sustainability metrics, which have helped  
the Group achieve its track record of long-term value creation.
-0.9%
+3.3%
2023
2024
2022
+6.1%
2023
2024
2022
10.3%
10.0%
10.6%
€701m
€640m
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2023
2024
2022
92%
95%
82%
€766m
LONG-TERM VALUE CREATION
Total shareholder return (TSR) for the year 
was 20.1%. This represented a top quartile 
performance amongst Kerry's specialty food 
& beverage ingredients peers and a strong 
outperformance relative to the MSCI Europe 
Food Producers and E300 Food & Beverage 
indices in the year. Kerry's TSR has grown at  
a compound annual rate of 11% since 2010.
TSR is an important indicator of how successful 
the Group has been in terms of shareholder 
value creation. Relative TSR is a performance 
metric for the long-term incentive plan.
KEY PERFORMANCE  
INDICATORS
We use a number of financial and non-financial 
key performance indicators (KPIs) to measure 
performance across our business. 
These KPIs help inform decision-making, assist 
effective goal setting and track progress in 
achieving our strategic objectives.
€1,165m
€1,216m
2023
2024
2022
 
 
 
14.5%
15.7%
13.9%
€1,251m
2024
2023
 
1.25 billion 
 
1.36 billion 
48.0%
50.0%
2023
2024
39.0%
38.0%
 
2023
2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

29
Strategic Report Financial Review
28
Strategic Report Financial Review
FINANCIAL  
REVIEW
GROWTH
RETURN
SUSTAINABILITY
Revenue 
Volume  
Growth
Group  
EBITDA  
Margin
Constant 
Currency
Adjusted EPS
Return on 
Average
Capital 
Employed
Free  
Cash Flow 
Conversion
Scope 1 & 2  
Carbon  
Reduction
+3.3%
15.7% 467.5c
10.6% 95%
50%
+120bps
+9.7%
2023: (0.9)%
2023: 14.5%
2023: 430.1c +1.2%
2023: 10.0%
2023: 92%
2023: 48%
Continuing Business
+3.4%
17.1% 448.2c
+120bps
+9.1%
2023: 1.1%
2023: 15.9%
2023: 414.9c
Key Financial Indicators
2024
2023
Continuing 
Operations 
€m
Discontinued 
Operations* 
€m
Total 
€m
Continuing 
Operations 
€m
Discontinued 
Operations* 
€m
Total 
€m
Revenue                                                                                                  
6,929
1,052
7,981
6,975
1,045
8,020
EBITDA                                                                                                   
1,188
63
1,251
1,112
53
1,165
EBITDA margin
17.1%
15.7%
15.9%
14.5%
Depreciation (net)
(212)
(23)
(235)
(198)
(22)
(220)
Computer software amortisation
(29)
(0)
(29)
(27)
(0)
(27)
Finance costs (net)
(53)
(1)
(54)
(50)
(0)
(50)
Share of joint ventures’ results  
after taxation
(1)
-
(1)
(2)
-
(2)
Adjusted earnings before taxation
893
39
932
835
31
866
Income taxes (excluding  
non-trading items)
(117)
(6)
(123)
(98)
(5)
(103)
Adjusted earnings after taxation
776
33
809
737
26
763
Brand-related intangible asset 
amortisation
(59)
(0)
(59)
(52)
0
(52)
Non-trading items (net of  
related tax)
(44)
28
(16)
16
1
17
Profit after taxation
673
61
734
701
27
728
2024
2023
Continuing 
Operations 
cent
Discontinued 
Operations 
cent
Total 
cent
Continuing 
Operations 
cent
Discontinued 
Operations 
cent
Total 
cent
Basic EPS                                                                              
389.2
35.3
424.5
395.0
15.4
410.4
Brand related intangible  
asset amortisation
33.8
0.1
33.9
29.5
0.0
29.5
Non-trading items  
(net of related tax)
25.2
(16.1)
9.1
(9.6)
(0.2)
(9.8)
Adjusted EPS                                                               
448.2
19.3
467.5
414.9
15.2
430.1
Adjusted EPS Growth (%)
8.0%
27.0%
8.7%
Impact of exchange rate translation 
1.1%
(1.3)%
1.0%
Adjusted EPS growth  
in constant currency                                  
9.1%
25.7%
9.7%
Revenue
Group revenue for the year was €7,981m (2023: €8,020), comprising volume growth of 3.3%, an overall 
pricing reduction of 1.9%, favourable transaction currency of 0.2%, unfavourable translation currency of 0.9%, 
contribution from acquisitions of 0.7% and the effect from disposals of 1.9%, resulting in an overall decrease of 
0.5%. Revenue from continuing operations for the year was €6,929m (2023: €6,975m).
EBITDA & Margin %
Group EBITDA increased by 7.4% to €1,251m (2023: €1,165m), with Group EBITDA margin increasing by 120bps 
to 15.7%, driven by benefits from the Accelerate Operational Excellence Programme, portfolio developments, 
operating leverage, product mix and the net effect from pricing. EBITDA from continuing operations for the year 
was €1,188m (2023: €1,112m).
The Financial Review provides an overview of the 
Group’s financial performance for the year ended 31 
December 2024 and the Group’s financial position at 
that date.
I am pleased to report a strong financial performance 
in 2024, with good volume growth and strong EBITDA 
margin progression contributing to our earnings per 
share growth. We made good progress on returns  
and delivered strong free cash flow during the year.
From a capital allocation perspective, we continued 
to reinvest in the growth and strategic development 
of our business, while also returning significant 
capital to shareholders through a combination of  
our share repurchase activity and dividends. We 
maintain a proactive, balanced approach to strategic 
capital allocation.
The Key Financial Performance Indicators outlined 
below are used to track business and operational 
performance and help to drive value creation.  
The Group has a long-term track record of delivery 
with a disciplined financial approach of targeting 
continued growth while meeting return on 
investment objectives. 
Growth
Further detail is set out within the Key Performance Indicators section on pages 26-27 and within supplementary information section – 
Financial Definitions on pages 322-326.
*Inter-segment revenue eliminations form part of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information. 
Strong business performance  
and strategic execution.
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

Strategic Report Financial Review
Strategic Report Financial Review
Computer Software Amortisation
Computer software amortisation increased to €29m (2023: €27m) reflecting continued investment in our digital 
enablement initiatives.
Brand Related Intangible Asset Amortisation
Brand related intangible asset amortisation increased to €59m (2023: €52m), which is reflective of recent 
acquisition activity.
Finance Costs 
Net finance costs for the year of €54m (2023: €50m) reflected the interest due on €1bn senior notes issued in 
September 2024 offset by increased deposit interest earned on cash. The Group’s average cost of finance for the 
year was 2.8% (2023: 2.4%).
Taxation
The tax charge for the year before non-trading items was €123m (2023: €103m) representing an effective tax 
rate of 14.1% (2023: 12.7%), an increase year on year reflecting the timing of in-year recognition of deferred 
assets in 2023.
Non-Trading Items
During the year, the Group incurred a non-trading charge of €16m (2023: €17m credit) net of tax. This was 
made up of a charge from continuing operations of €44m net of tax, and offset by a credit from discontinued 
operations of €28m net of tax. The charge primarily relates to investments in the Accelerate Operational 
Excellence transformation programme, which predominantly reflects costs of streamlining operations, project 
management costs, and consultancy fees, incurred to deliver manufacturing and supply chain excellence. The 
offsetting credit relates to the profit on the 70% shareholding divestment of Dairy Ireland. 
The credit in the prior year is primarily related to the profit on the divestment of the Sweet Ingredients 
Portfolio offset in part by the Accelerate Operational Excellence transformation programme.
Foreign Exchange
Group results are impacted by year-on-year fluctuations in exchange rates versus the Euro. The primary rates 
driving the currency impact in the figures above were Brazilian Real and Malaysian Ringgit which had average 
rates of 5.78 (2023: 5.40) and 4.96 (2023: 4.93) respectively.
Cash & Returns
Free Cash Flow
In 2024, the Group achieved a strong free cash flow of €765.6m (2023: €701.3m) reflecting 95% cash conversion 
in the year.
Free Cash Flow
2024
2023
€’m
€’m
EBITDA
1,250.8
1,165.1
Movement in average working capital
28.9
38.4
Pension contributions paid less pension expense
(12.1)
(13.5)
Finance costs paid (net)
(43.9)
(65.8)
Income taxes paid
(108.2)
(119.5)
Purchase of non-current assets
(344.3)
(315.0)
Sales proceeds on disposal of non-current assets
(5.6)
11.6
Free cash flow
765.6
701.3
Cash conversion1
95%
92%
1 Cash conversion is free cash flow expressed as a percentage of adjusted earnings after tax.
Strong cash conversion primarily driven by increased EBITDA, continued management of working capital 
partially offset by an increase in non-current asset additions supporting our growth strategies. 
Returns
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Adjusted profit
862.7
813.5
Average capital employed
8,172.3
8,172.8
Return on average capital employed (ROACE)
10.6%
10.0%
Further detail is set out within the Supplementary Information section - Financial Definitions on pages 322-326.
The increase in ROACE is primarily due to increased profits year on year.
Share Buyback Programmes
During the year, the Board approved two share buyback programmes totalling €600m, in addition to the €300m 
programme that was launched in November 2023. These programmes are underpinned by the Group’s strong 
balance sheet and cash flow and are aligned to the Company’s Capital Allocation Framework.
During 2024, the total number of shares acquired was 6,757,726 at a cost of €556.5m. Since the year end, and 
up to 31 January 2025, the Company has purchased an additional 458,271 shares equating to an additional 
capital return of €43.3m. Further detail on share buyback programmes is included in note 28 to the Consolidated 
Financial Statements.
Net Debt
Net debt at the end of the year was €1,925.8m (2023: €1,604.1 m). The increase during the year reflects strong 
business cash generation partially offset by acquisition spend and the share buyback programme.
Movement in Total Net Debt
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Free cash flow
765.6
701.3
Acquisitions (including payments relating to previous acquisitions) net of disposal proceeds
(195.7)
175.6
Purchase of financial asset investments
(1.8) 
(3.0)
Difference between average working capital and year end working capital
(72.3) 
147.1
Non-trading items
(50.7)
(99.8)
Dividends paid
(205.2)
(191.3)
Purchase of own shares
(556.5)
(101.7)
Exchange translation adjustment
(3.8)
(14.2)
(Increase)/Decrease in net debt resulting from cash flows
(320.4) 
614.0
Fair value movement on interest rate swaps
3.4
1.0
Exchange translation adjustment on net debt
13.3
(2.3)
(Increase)/Decrease in net debt in the year
(303.7) 
612.7
Net debt at beginning of year
(1,535.5)
(2,148.2)
Net debt at the end of the year – pre-lease liabilities
(1,839.2)
(1,535.5)
Lease liabilities 
(86.6)
(68.6)
Net debt at end of year
(1,925.8)
(1,604.1)
31
30
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

Strategic Report Financial Review
Strategic Report Financial Review
Net Debt = €1,926m
Maturity Profile of 2024 Net Debt
The weighted average maturity of debt in years is 5.6 (7.5 years excluding the €950m 2025 bond). 
€995m 
Within 
1 year
On 
Demand
Between  
1 and 2 years
Between  
2 and 5 years
Over  
5 years
€23m
(€1,608m)
€770m
€1,746m
Key Financial Ratios
Our credit metrics remain strong and we have a well spread debt maturity profile. Our strong balance sheet,  
combined with the establishment of our new €3bn EMTN programme positions Kerry very well for the continued 
strategic development of our business.
2024
2023
Net debt:EBITDA
1.6
1.5
EBITDA:Net interest
21.7
21.8
Financing
Undrawn committed facilities at the end of the year were €1,500m (2023: €1,500m) while undrawn standby 
facilities were €344m (2023: €335m). During 2024, the Group exercised the first of the two 1-year extension 
options on the €1,500m revolving credit facilities. The facility contains two one-year extension options, 
exercisable on the 1st and 2nd anniversaries of the facility and which, if exercised, would extend the maturity 
date of the facility to June 2030. In August 2024, the Group established a €3bn EMTN programme for future 
Euro public bond issuances. In September 2024, the Group issued €1bn of new public bonds under this 
programme and the Group has €950m of senior notes repayable in September 2025. 
Full details of the Group’s financial liabilities, cash at bank and in hand and credit facilities are disclosed in 
notes 24 and 25 to the Consolidated Financial Statements. Of the cash at bank and in hand at year end, 
€227.0m (2023: €50.8m) was on short term deposit under a Sustainable Deposits programme.
Sustainability-Linked Bond Progress Report
In 2021, Kerry issued a €750 million, ten-year Sustainability-Linked Bond (SLB) aligned with the Sustainability-
Linked Bond Principles (SLBPs) administered by the International Capital Markets Association. The bond has a 
sustainability-linked feature that could result in an interest coupon step-up if certain KPI targets are not met, as 
outlined below, by December 2030.
The KPIs that have been included in the SLB have been selected as they reflect material environmental 
sustainability challenges for our industry and key focus areas under our Beyond the Horizon sustainability 
strategy. These KPIs and targets are as follows:
KPI 1: 55% Absolute reduction in Scope 1 & 2 greenhouse gas emissions;
KPI 2: 50% Food waste reduction across our operations.
2024 Performance
In 2024, our performance has continued to trend positively, delivering a 50% (20232: 48%) reduction in our 
absolute Scope 1 & 2 emissions and a 38% (20232: 39%) reduction in our food waste volumes, versus a 2017 
baseline for both KPIs.
Emissions (CO₂e)
2024
20171
Food Waste
2024
20171
Scope 1 & 2 (Tonnes)
462,351
926,424
Tonnes
9,204
14,919
% reduction
50% 
% reduction
38%
1 The 2017 KPI baseline has been adjusted in accordance with our November 2021 Sustainability-Linked Bond Framework Recalculation 
Policy, to take into account structural changes including acquisitions and divestitures.
2 The prior year movements have also been restated in line with the November 2021 Sustainability-Linked Bond Framework,  
to take into account structural changes including acquisitions and divestitures. 
For more details on our progress in reducing emissions and food waste, see our Sustainability Review on pages 
38-45 and Sustainability Statement on pages 127-233.
Financial Risk Management
Within the Group risk management framework as described in the Risk Management Report on page 47, the 
Group has a Financial Risk Management Programme, which is approved by the Board of Directors and is subject 
to regular monitoring by the Finance Committee and Group Internal Audit. The Group does not engage in 
speculative trading.
Further details relating to the Group’s financial and compliance risks and their associated mitigation  
processes are discussed in the Risk Management Report on pages 46-56 and in note 25 to the Consolidated 
Financial Statements.
Dividend and Annual General Meeting
During the year, the Group paid an interim dividend of 38.1 cent per A ordinary share, which was an increase 
of 10.1% versus the 2023 interim dividend. The Board has proposed a final dividend of 89.0 cent per A ordinary 
share, payable on 9 May 2025 to shareholders registered on the record date of 11 April 2025. When combined 
with the interim dividend, the total dividend for the year amounts to 127.1 cent per share (2023: 115.4 cent per 
share), which is an increase of 10.1% over last year’s dividend. The Group’s aim is to have double-digit dividend 
growth each year. Over 38 years as a listed company, the Group has grown its dividend at a compound rate  
of 16%.
Kerry’s Annual General Meeting is scheduled to take place on 1 May 2025.
33
32
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

BUSINESS  
REVIEW
 	 Volume growth of 3.4% – well ahead of 
food and beverage end markets
 	 Growth led by Snacks, Beverage  
and Bakery
 	 Pricing reflected easing input cost deflation 
in the year
 	 EBITDA margins +110bps driven by cost 
efficiencies, portfolio developments, 
operating leverage, product mix and the 
net effect of pricing
Reported revenue of €6,929m reflected volume 
growth of 3.4%, an overall pricing reduction of 
2.1%, favourable transaction currency of 0.2%, 
unfavourable translation currency of 1.2% and the 
effect of disposals net of acquisitions of 1.0%.
Taste & Nutrition delivered good volume growth 
and continued progression through the year. This 
represented a significant outperformance of food 
and beverage end markets, supported by continued 
product renovation activity with many customers to 
enhance nutritional profiles. 
Foodservice performed strongly with volume growth 
of 6.8%, supported by new menu innovations, 
seasonal products and solutions designed to reduce 
operational costs and simplify processes, while 
growth in the retail channel of 1.8% reflected good 
performances in the Americas and APMEA. 
The year’s growth was led by innovations 
incorporating Kerry’s broad range of taste and 
proactive health technologies. This was supported by 
strong performance across savoury taste, botanicals 
and natural extracts, along with Tastesense™ salt  
and sugar reduction technologies. Proactive health  
also delivered excellent growth, most notably in 
technologies for digestive, cognitive and  
women’s health. 
Business volumes in emerging markets increased 
by 6.5%, with good growth across the Middle East, 
Africa, LATAM and Southeast Asia.
Within the Pharma & Other EUM, growth in 
supplements was partially offset by softer volumes  
in cell nutrition.
Taste & Nutrition
Continue Volume Progression  
with Strong Margin Expansion
Strategic Report Business Review
Strategic Report Business Review
34
35
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

Reported revenue in the Americas region was 
€3,764m reflecting volume growth of 4.1%, an overall 
pricing reduction of 1.6%, unfavourable translation 
currency of 1.2% and the effect from disposals net 
of acquisitions of 1.5%. Volume growth in the year 
included a strong finish to the year with good broad-
based growth across end markets and channels. 
Within North America, Snacks achieved excellent 
growth, with innovations utilising Kerry’s range of 
savoury taste profiles and Tastesense™ salt reduction 
technologies, given an increased level of customer 
focus on improving the nutritional profiles  
of products.
The Beverage category remained highly dynamic 
through the year, with a significant level of innovation 
driving strong growth in Kerry’s coffee extracts, 
proactive health and Tastesense™ sugar reduction 
technologies. Growth in Bakery was supported by 
performance in preservation and taste systems.
Foodservice delivered strong volume growth 
through new and improved signature taste profiles, 
integrated solutions to reduce cost and complexity, 
and continued strong growth with new and emerging 
chains. Good growth was achieved in the retail 
channel, given continued renovation activity with 
many customer and retailer brands through the year.
LATAM delivered strong growth, led by performance 
in Mexico in Snacks and Beverage, while Brazil 
performed well, particularly in the second half of  
the year. 
36
37
Strategic Report Business Review
Strategic Report Business Review
The business achieved a good EBITDA performance 
of €63m with margin expansion of 60bps in the 
year, reflective of Dairy Consumer Products’ growth 
and mix development, combined with recovery in 
Dairy Ingredients. Revenue increased in the year to 
€1,315m, with volume growth of 1.6% and pricing  
of 2.2%. 
Dairy Consumer Products achieved strong growth, 
led by performances in snacking and branded cheese 
ranges. Dairy Ingredients volumes reflected soft 
overall supply conditions, which improved through 
the year.
As previously announced, the transaction for the 
initial disposal of 70% of Kerry Dairy Ireland by Kerry 
Group plc to Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited 
completed on 31 December. 
Good EBITDA  
performance led by Dairy 
Consumer Products 
Reported revenue in the APMEA region was €1,661m 
reflecting volume growth of 4.8%, an overall pricing 
reduction of 2.3%, favourable transaction currency of 
0.6%, unfavourable translation currency of 2.8% and 
the effect from acquisitions net of disposals of 0.5%.
Volume growth within the region reflected strong 
growth in the Middle East, Africa and Southeast 
Asia, with challenging market conditions in China 
deteriorating through the year.
Beverage achieved good growth most notably 
through refreshing beverage innovations with Kerry’s 
botanicals, natural extracts and Tastesense™ sugar 
reduction technologies. Snacks delivered strong 
growth with leading global and regional brands, given 
continued innovation and increased demand for 
Kerry’s range of authentic local savoury taste profiles. 
Growth in Meat was driven by strong performance 
across savoury taste and preservation systems. 
Foodservice achieved strong volume growth with 
leading regional coffee chains and quick service 
restaurants in particular, while growth in the retail 
channel was supported by good performance across 
Kerry’s range of local authentic taste solutions with 
regional leaders.
APMEA Region
Dairy Ireland
 	 Volumes +4.8% with good overall growth 
given market conditions in China   
 	 Beverage, Snacks and Meat EUMs 
performed well
 	 Foodservice achieved strong growth with 
good growth in retail
 	 Volume reduction of 0.1% in the year, with  
a return to growth in H2
 	 Meals, Bakery and Beverage performed well
 	 Foodservice delivered good growth, with 
retail volumes turning positive in Q4
Reported revenue in the Europe region was €1,455m 
reflecting volume and pricing reductions of 0.1% and 
3.5% respectively, favourable translation currency of 
0.9% and the effect from disposals net of acquisitions 
of 1.4%. Volume performance improved through 
the year with a return to growth in the second half, 
supported by recovery in the retail channel. 
Within the Food EUM, Meals and Bakery delivered 
good growth through solutions incorporating Kerry’s 
food protection, preservation and authentic taste 
technologies, while performance in Dairy reflected 
strong prior year comparatives. Beverage performed 
well with new innovations in functional and 
refreshing beverages supported by a number of new 
innovations with Kerry’s proactive health portfolio. 
Foodservice continued to deliver good growth with 
launches in meat applications across a number of 
customers, combined with increased seasonal and 
limited time offering activity within the region.
Americas Region
Europe Region
 	 Volumes +4.1% reflected continued strong 
performance
 	 Growth led by Snacks, Beverage and 
Bakery EUMs
 	 Retail achieved good growth with 
continued strong growth in Foodservice
 	 LATAM achieved good growth led by Mexico
Continued strong 
performance, with broad-
based growth across end 
markets and channels
Improved performance 
through the year with a 
return to volume growth 
in the second half
Volume growth within the 
region reflected strong 
growth in the Middle East, 
Africa and Southeast Asia
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

39
Strategic Report Sustainability Review
As a committed stakeholder in the global food and 
beverage industry, Kerry recognises the critical role 
we play in bringing about change in the way that 
food is produced and consumed. We look towards a 
future of sustainable nutrition: where food systems 
can provide sufficient energy and essential nutrients 
to maintain good health for the population, without 
compromising the environment, or the ability of 
future generations to meet their nutritional needs.
Our people work with customers, suppliers and the 
wider industry, to drive collective actions which help 
to address some of society’s biggest challenges, 
including diet-related health issues, climate 
change, and environmental and social impacts.
We need to maintain and build upon efforts to 
provide healthier food and beverages, reduce 
emissions, protect biodiversity and create fair 
working conditions in our own operations, while 
engaging with key stakeholders to uphold human 
rights across our supply chain. All of this is required, 
to deliver on the promise of sustainable nutrition. 
Kerry’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy sets 
out how we take that work forward. In our activity and 
across our operations, we seek to address key dietary, 
social and environmental considerations, to ensure 
that food is better for people, and is produced in ways 
that are better for society, and better for the planet. 
GOAL 2: 
Zero Hunger
GOAL 12:  
Responsible Consumption  
and Production
GOAL 3: 
Good Health  
& Well-being
Contribution to the UN Sustainable Development Goals
Kerry is committed to using its global reach and influence to drive positive change in support of the 
United Nations’ (UN) Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs). Good nutrition is fundamental to realising 
many of the SDGs1. Through our Beyond the Horizon strategy, we anticipate that Kerry can have most 
impact on areas covered by the following SDGs: 
1	Global Alliance for Improved Nutrition, Sustainable Development Goals, https://www.gainhealth.org/about/sustainable-development-goals
38
Strategic Report Sustainability Review
Sustainability at Kerry: Our Strategy and Approach
SUSTAINABILITY  
REVIEW
SUSTAINABLE NUTRITION SPECTRUM
Climate 
Action
Customer
Sustainable 
Nutrition
Environmental 
& Social
Nutrition
Food Safety 
& Security
Clean 
Label
Social 
Impact
Protecting 
Nature
Circular
Solutions
Positive & Balanced 
Nutrition
Proactive
Nutrition
Personalised 
Nutrition
Taste
Affordability
Accessibility
Kerry's Beyond the Horizon strategy is focused on enabling our customers overcome key challenges as they 
move across the sustainable nutrition spectrum.
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

41
40
Strategic Report Sustainability Review
Strategic Report Sustainability Review
2	New WHO tools to support action on noncommunicable diseases and climate change, https://www.who.int/europe/news/item/ 
11-12-2023-new-who-tools-to-support-action-on-noncommunicable-diseases-and-climate-change
Better for People
Our Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy is 
anchored around our ambition to reach over two 
billion people with sustainable nutrition solutions by 
the end of 2030. 
Globally, 11 million deaths a year are associated with 
unhealthy diets2. With our capabilities in nutritional 
optimisation and our position to influence within the 
food and beverage industry, we are ideally placed to 
respond to growing demand for healthier foods and 
to support positive changes in the food that we eat.
Kerry’s capabilities can be applied to address key 
needs of customers and consumers in sustainable 
nutrition, spanning requirements for food protection, 
clean label solutions, and nutrition that is positive, 
balanced, and personalised. We define this range of 
requirements as the Sustainable Nutrition Spectrum.
Expanding our  
Nutritional Reach
We increased access to sustainable nutrition in 2024, 
reaching 1.36 billion people (2023: 1.25 billion) with 
Kerry Taste & Nutrition products with positive or 
balanced nutrition, highlighting progress towards 
our 2030 nutritional reach target. Expanding our 
nutritional reach requires us to co-create nutritionally 
optimised products with our customers around the 
world. Kerry’s expertise in nutritional profiling and 
regulatory matters can be leveraged through our 
suite of digital tools such as Kerry Nutri Map and 
Kerry Nutri Guide. 
These tools guide formulation and reformulation 
options for our customers’ products across a range of 
nutrition labelling systems and nutritional legislation 
requirements in selected countries globally.
Ensuring Food Safety & Quality
The quality of the food we produce is a key priority. 
We maintain robust monitoring programmes 
and preventative controls in line with our guiding 
principle of Safety First, Quality Always. We regularly 
audit compliance with our standards, and we 
facilitated in excess of 800 external food safety and 
quality audits, in addition to those from our internal 
Group Food Safety Quality (FSQ) audit team.
We had one product recall notification in 2024 (2023: 
zero) related to a recall of raw materials by a Kerry 
supplier. Due to our well-established processes 
there were no reported illnesses associated with the 
recalled Kerry product.
For further information on Nutritional Reach and 
Food Safety and Quality see pages 213-219 of our 
Sustainability Statement.
Communicating About Nutrition
We recognise the impact our communications can 
have on informing stakeholder choice and we are 
dedicated to maintaining accurate and transparent 
communications to develop and retain trust. Reliable 
product information is essential to help customers 
and consumers make informed choices and adopt 
more sustainable products. Our Responsible 
Communications Policy outlines our expectations 
and approach to ensuring we consistently apply 
the principles of accuracy, transparency and 
substantiation across our communications. 
Kerry contributes to a broader understanding 
of nutritional science via the Kerry Health and 
Nutrition Institute (KHNI), which was established 
to advance ‘science for healthier food’. The KHNI 
brings a scientific perspective to some of the most 
challenging questions facing the food and beverage 
industry, connecting a network of over 1,200 Kerry 
food scientists with external collaborators. The 
institute’s work is supported by its Scientific Advisory 
Council. In 2024, the KHNI’s output focused on key 
trends in sustainable nutrition, including work on the 
gut microbiome and the role of postbiotics. 
KHNI also had a presence at events such as the 
European Congress on Immunology, and Climate 
Week NYC, sharing its commitment to science-
forward leadership in the industry.
For further information, see pages 220-222 of our 
Sustainability Statement.
Better for Society
The second pillar of our Beyond the Horizon strategy, 
Better for Society, encompasses our work to create a 
positive environment where people are treated with 
fairness and dignity and provided with appropriate 
opportunity and reward. Connecting our 21,000+ 
people across 200+ locations and over 50 countries 
creates a powerful force for change. It brings 
together a variety of approaches, experience  
and perspectives to find new ways to deliver 
sustainable nutrition.
Employee Health and Wellbeing
Our employees are our most important resource, 
and we put their safety, security and wellbeing first. 
Guided by our Safety First, Quality Always mindset, 
we continued to enhance our safety programmes, 
launching the Global Safety Guardians programme 
and toolkits. This programme is designed to motivate 
employees to make the right decisions when it 
comes to safety. The reinforcing of safety standards 
and monitoring of leading indicators are proactive 
strategies to manage safety and reduce risk. 
Sadly, we lost a Kerry colleague to a workplace 
fatality at one of our manufacturing facilities in 2024. 
We extend our deepest sympathy to their family, 
friends and co-workers. 
A thorough investigation of the accident was 
undertaken, involving relevant authorities and 
external experts, with key findings gathered to 
inform safety protections and improvements.
Kerry remains committed to improving workplace 
safety. In 2024, our total incident rate has reduced  
to 4.5 (2023: 4.8), when calculated based on 1 million 
hours, representing continued progress in the 
reduction of injuries.
For further information on health, safety and 
wellbeing at Kerry, see pages 187-205 of our  
Sustainability Statement.
Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging
Kerry strives to create a diverse and inclusive 
workplace where employees are empowered to make 
their unique contribution.
Kerry recognises the value of a supportive 
environment in creating a dynamic business and 
promoting the wellbeing of our people. In 2024, 35% 
(2023: 34%) of our senior leadership positions were 
held by women, reaching our 2025 target level one 
year ahead of schedule. At the end of 2024, women 
held 39% (2023: 37%) of our senior management 
roles and we remain committed to achieving equal 
gender representation in senior management by the 
end of 2030. 
For further information on these topics see pages  
187-205 of our Sustainability Statement.
Career Development,  
Reward and Recognition
We are dedicated to recruiting 
talented people and providing them 
with fair and competitive reward and 
recognition, and ongoing support to 
develop the skills they need to thrive 
at work.
Developing a sense of shared ownership, alongside 
shared purpose, is an important consideration for 
Kerry. In 2024, our award-winning employee share 
ownership plan 'OurShare' was extended to a further 
16 countries. The plan is now available to 94% of 
employees across 24 countries.
Our global recognition programme, Inspiring People, 
celebrates achievements of individuals and teams 
throughout the year. In 2024, we recognised 12,000 
frontline operators worldwide for their pivotal role 
in achieving our vision to be our customers’ most 
valued partner. Ensuring all team members are 
appropriately rewarded for their contributions, Kerry 
is proud to have established a Living Wage roadmap 
to achieve living wage coverage across all regions 
following engagement with the Global Fair Wage 
Network during 2024.
As part of our commitment to empower employees 
to take ownership of their development and enhance 
their skills, we are rolling out a new learning platform, 
starting with our Digital and Global Business Service 
teams. This platform will enable employees to deepen 
their expertise and align their skill development with 
their career objectives.
For further information on reward and recognition 
and learning and development, see pages 187-205  
of our Sustainability Statement.
Our Sustainability  
Reporting Approach
The EU’s Corporate Sustainability Reporting 
Directive (CSRD), and accompanying European 
Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS), 
seek to ensure greater transparency and 
consistency in sustainability disclosures 
across businesses. This is the first year Kerry 
will report under these new standards in our 
Sustainability Statement on pages 131-233 
within this Annual Report. This Sustainability 
Statement replaces the separate Sustainability 
Report, which was published on our website 
in previous years, with references to the 
Global Reporting Initiative's Standards.
This Sustainability Review provides an 
overview of our 2024 progress against our 
Beyond the Horizon strategy, complementing 
our Sustainability Statement which provides 
greater detail on each of our material topics. 
References throughout the Review point to 
further information available in the Statement. 
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

42
43
Strategic Report Sustainability Review
Strategic Report Sustainability Review
1	Nature Food, Food systems are responsible for a third of global anthropogenic GHG emissions,  
https://www.nature.com/articles/s43016-021-00225-9
Protecting Human Rights
From our employees to the people 
working across our value chain, 
everyone has the right to fair working 
conditions with inclusive, equal and 
respectful treatment.
As a global company, we can leverage our position 
to have a positive influence by ensuring that the 
standards and values we live by are adopted more 
widely to make a real difference to people across our 
value chain. In 2024, we updated our Human Rights 
Policy, reinforcing our position that we will not tolerate 
or condone any abuse of human rights within our 
business or value chain. The policy outlines Kerry’s 
commitment to human rights due diligence processes, 
prioritising our own operations and upstream value 
chain activities where our risk assessments highlight 
greater potential of adverse human rights impacts. 
For further information on our policies and our 
approach to human rights, see page 186 of our 
Sustainability Statement.
Supporting our Community
We encourage our people to support their 
local community through our MyCommunity 
programme and by offering an annual 
volunteer day to all employees. More detail 
of our charitable activities are available under 
Kerry Community Initiatives on our website 
kerry.com.
We continue to work in partnership with the 
World Food Programme, Concern Worldwide 
and other NGOs to improve livelihoods and 
increase food security. For more on our work to 
improve food security and support vulnerable 
communities, see the ALIVE programme and 
Project Amata updates on our website.
Better for Planet
The Better for Planet pillar of our Beyond the Horizon 
strategy covers how we reduce our footprint on the 
climate and the environment.
The food industry generates as much as one-third 
of global greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions1. At 
the same time, extreme weather events have the 
potential to affect the ecosystems we rely on for our 
food security. At Kerry, we understand that these 
dynamics are interconnected. 
Climate Action
At Kerry, we take a holistic view of 
mitigating climate change, working 
with stakeholders to reduce emissions 
across our value chain and to reach 
net zero emissions before 2050.
With climate change increasingly testing the 
resilience of our food system, we acknowledge the 
need to reduce carbon emissions in our business and 
across the industry. In 2024, we developed a detailed 
Climate Transition Plan (available on kerry.com), 
setting out the pathway by which we aim to reach 
net zero before 2050. We also evolved our Scope 3 
emissions targets, putting in place separate targets 
for Forest, Land and Agriculture (FLAG) and non-FLAG 
emissions in line with the guidance from the Science 
Based Targets initiative (SBTi). Our new 2030 Scope 
3 targets, aligned to 1.5 degree pathway, have been 
submitted to SBTi for approval.
For Scope 1 and 2 carbon emissions, we have achieved 
a reduction of 50% compared with our 2017 base year. 
One example of our carbon reduction activities is our 
investment in a heat recovery, at our site in Penang, 
thereby improving energy efficiency and lowering 
Scope 1 carbon emissions by 80t CO2 per year. 
Working in partnership with our suppliers, we have 
reduced Scope 3 carbon emissions by 5% in 2024, off 
of a 2022 base year.
For more information on our how we are working to 
reduce carbon emissions, see pages 146-164 of our 
Sustainability Statement.
Water Stewardship
We recognise the importance of 
good water stewardship to safeguard 
access for our business and the 
communities where we operate. 
We achieved an 11% reduction in water withdrawal 
intensity across our business. Kerry remains 
committed to ongoing tracking and monitoring of the 
water we use and discharge from our sites to minimise 
our impact on local water quality and ecosystems for 
the benefit of the communities where we operate.
For further information on our approach to 
responsible water stewardship, see pages 165-168  
of our Sustainability Statement.
Raw Material Sourcing
Kerry’s ongoing success relies on 
healthy ecosystems for production of 
the raw materials we use and we are 
committed to addressing key impact 
areas to ensure the future security  
of supply.
At Kerry, we are focused on minimising material 
impacts on the environment by reducing our upstream 
carbon emissions, protecting biodiversity by reducing 
deforestation and ensuring safe, fair and equitable 
working conditions for farmers and primary producers. 
In 2024, we initiated sustainable sourcing 
programmes with dairy, wheat and corn suppliers in 
North America, incentivising farmers to implement 
regenerative agriculture practices with outcome-based 
compensation for the carbon reduction achieved. 
We continued to promote regenerative agriculture 
practices as we broadened our Evolve Dairy 
Sustainability programme, by expanding the actions 
eligible for incentivisation with the primary goal to 
reward suppliers for sustainable farming practices 
in Southwest Ireland and to incentivise further 
adoption of additional sustainability measures. The 
programme contributed to Kerry Dairy Ireland’s 
success in becoming the first Sustainable Dairy 
Partnership (SDP) member to achieve stage five 
verification, the highest level attainable within the 
SDP platform. 
Soy, paper and palm oil are three commodity 
products which are often associated with a risk of 
forest loss and land-use change. In line with our 
Deforestation and Conversion-Free (DCF) Policy, we 
remain committed to sourcing 100% of these inputs 
from deforestation-free sources by the end of 2025. 
For further information on our approach to responsible 
sourcing and reducing deforestation and land-use, see 
pages 169-174 of our Sustainability Statement.
Food Waste
We continue to work with partners across 
the food industry to understand the drivers 
of food waste and ways to reduce it using 
food protection and preservation ingredients. 
Leveraging our 2023 consumer research with 
the support of our global insights team, we 
identified key personas and their attitudes 
to waste, helping to develop better food 
preservation strategies. We worked with the 
University of Georgia, USA, to validate our 
publicly-available Kerry Food Waste Estimator, 
which provides information on initiatives for 
food waste prevention in our downstream value 
chain. The results were published in a peer-
reviewed article in the journal Sustainability.
For further information on how we support 
reduction in food waste, see pages 175-177 of 
our Sustainability Statement.
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

45
44
Strategic Report TCFD Compliance Statement
Strategic Report Sustainability Review
Our Ongoing Commitment
In an era defined by growing environmental awareness and increasing demand for healthier food, the food 
industry has a pivotal role to play in building a more sustainable future. At Kerry, we are proud of our progress 
to date towards delivering better nutrition for consumers with no compromise on taste and doing it in a way 
that enhances the lives of those with whom we engage and minimises our environmental footprint.
As we approach the midway point of implementing our Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy we realise 
more work will be required to achieve the ambitious targets we have set, and we remain fully committed to 
achieving them.
External Recognition
Kerry acknowledges the importance of independent validation of our sustainability efforts to ensure that we are 
on the right path and maintain the pace of progress. We are pleased to have received the following recognition:
MSCI: Kerry has retained its AAA rating from MSCI in 2024. To achieve an 
AAA rating companies are required to reach a high level of performance 
on a range of Environmental, Social and Governance issues.
World Benchmarking Alliance: Kerry has been recognised by the World 
Benchmarking Alliance (WBA) for our sustainability leadership and our 
contribution towards the UN SDGs since WBA first introduced its Food and 
Agriculture Benchmark in 2021. We are proud that Kerry is among the top 10 
food companies according to the WBA 2023 Food and Agriculture Benchmark. 
ISS: Kerry has maintained its Prime ESG rating from ISS. This places us  
in the top 10% of companies within our industry.
CDP: We have been recognised at leadership level (A-) by CDP across the 
themes of Climate Change and Water Security and we also received a B for  
our actions and disclosures on Forests. 
FTSE4GOOD: Kerry is a constituent of the FTSE4GOOD, which measures  
the performance of companies demonstrating strong Environmental, 
Social and Governance practices.
Sustainalytics: Kerry has been included in Sustainalytics 2025 top-rated  
ESG companies for our industry.
Origin Green: Kerry is a gold member of this world-leading programme 
to reward companies for excellence in their sustainability performance.
TCFD COMPLIANCE STATEMENT 
As required by the UK Financial Conduct Authority Listing rule 9.8.6R9(8), Kerry has complied with the climate-
related financial disclosures and is consistent with all four recommendations and 11 disclosures in the Task Force 
on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD). The required disclosures are included within our Sustainability 
Statement. The table below sets out the specific location of each disclosure within the Annual Report.
THEME
RECOMMENDED DISCLOSURES
LOCATION IN KERRY 
ANNUAL REPORT
SECTION
PAGE
Governance
The board's oversight of climate related risks and 
opportunities
Sustainability 
Statement 
Climate Change (E1) - 
Governance
150
Describe management's role in assessing and 
monitoring climate related risks and opportunities
Sustainability 
Statement 
Climate Change (E1) - 
Governance
150
Strategy
Describe the climate related risks and opportunities 
the organisation has identified over the short, 
medium, and long term
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Identifying Climate-Related 
Risks and Opportunities
146, 153-
155
Describe the impact of climate-related risks and 
opportunities on the organisation’s business, 
strategy, and financial planning
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Climate Resilience Analysis
153-156
Describe the resilience of the organisation's 
strategy, taking into consideration different climate-
related scenarios, include a 2°C or lower scenario
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Climate Resilience Analysis
156-157
Risk  
Management
Describe the organisation’s process for identifying 
and assessing climate-related risks
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Assessing Climate-Related 
Risks and Opportunities
151-156
Describe the organisation’s process for managing 
climate-related risks
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Actions, Policy, Targets
147-149, 
157-159
Describe how processes for identifying, assessing, 
and managing climate-related risks are integrated 
into the organisations overall risk management
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Prioritisation of 
Sustainability-Related Risks
157
Metrics  
and Targets
Describe the metrics used by the organisation to 
assess climate-related risks and opportunities in 
line with strategy and risk management process
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Metrics
159-164
Disclose Scope 1, Scope 2, and, if appropriate, 
Scope 3 greenhouse gas emissions (GHG) and the 
related risks
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) - 
Gross Scope 1, 2, 3 and 
Total GHG Emissions
163
Describe the targets used by the organisation to 
manage climate-related risks and opportunities and 
performance against targets
Sustainability 
Statement
Climate Change (E1) -  
Targets
158-159
NON-FINANCIAL REPORTING STATEMENT 
We comply with regulations on non-financial reporting and provide information on required topics within this 
report, including within our Sustainability Statement. For environmental metrics, base years are restated where 
necessary to provide a like-for-like comparison. Information on each topic can be found below. In addition, non-
financial risks are evaluated as part of the broader enterprise risk management framework and more detail can 
be found in our Risk Management Report on page 46.
REPORTING REQUIREMENTS 
OUR POLICIES / REFERENCE 
PAGE NUMBER 
Environmental Matters 
Sustainability Statement policy disclosures as follows: E1, E3, E4, E5
157, 165, 170, 176
Social and  
Employee Matters
Sustainability Statement policy disclosures as follows: S1, S2, S4
189, 208, 214, 220
Respect for 
Human Rights 
Human Rights Policy 
186
Anti-Bribery and Corruption 
Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy; Group Code of Conduct
179, 189
Our Business Model
18-19
Sustainability KPIs
Sustainability Statement targets and metrics disclosures as follows:  
E1, E3, E4, E5, S1, S2, S4
158, 168, 173, 177, 196, 
212, 219
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

47
46
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
RISK MANAGEMENT REPORT 
Our Approach 
Our comprehensive risk management framework 
provides a structure to ensure that we identify and 
assess the material risks which may impact the 
Group's viability and delivers a consistent approach 
to the oversight and management of these risks. 
Our integrated approach, which brings together 
risk management, internal controls and business 
integrity, ensures that we focus on those risks which 
could have the greatest impact. 
The Board is responsible for determining the nature 
and extent of the risks the Group is willing to take 
in pursuit of its strategic objectives, maintaining 
a culture which embeds risk awareness into 
management activities and overseeing the risk 
management governance framework which enables 
the Group to effectively prioritise and manage risk 
within approved appetite levels. 
Board of Directors 
Ultimately responsible for setting the risk 
appetite and overseeing and monitoring risk 
management and internal control systems. 
Ensure the appropriate tone and culture are 
established and cascaded throughout the Group. 
Oversight is achieved with the support of the 
Audit Committee, along with regular updates  
and insights from management.
Audit Committee
Support the Board in the assessment of risk 
and monitoring, evaluating and reviewing 
the principal risks and effectiveness of risk 
management systems. The Audit Committee 
agenda ensures appropriate updates are received 
from management on relevant areas of risk and 
internal control. The Chairman updates the Board 
after each Committee meeting.
A review of the effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management and internal control systems is 
conducted annually. A comprehensive overview of 
how the review is conducted is outlined in the Audit 
Committee report on page 88. 
The Group’s risk management framework has 
been implemented to ensure there is clear 
ownership and delegation of responsibility for risk 
management. The three lines model defines roles 
and responsibilities for all colleagues and ensures 
there is action, accountability and assurance within 
the risk management approach and embedding risk 
management into all decision-making processes. This 
framework enables the Group to effectively prioritise 
and manage principal and emerging risks.
Risk Oversight Committee (ROC)
Chaired by the CFO and comprising senior 
members of Group leadership. Support the 
Audit Committee in the risk management 
process through ongoing monitoring of the risk 
environment and the effectiveness of internal 
controls, in addition to the consideration of 
emerging risks. The ROC provides the Audit 
Committee with updates on changes to the  
risk landscape.
Executive Management
Ensure that internal controls are implemented 
and operating effectively to manage the Group’s 
risks within the approved risk appetite. The 
three lines model embeds risk management 
accountability into operational activities.
1st Line: 
Operational Management 
is responsible for risk 
identification, managing the 
internal control environment 
and monitoring changes in 
the risk profile of the Group.
2nd Line: 
Group functional teams 
ensure the 1st line is operating 
as designed, manage 
performance reviews, internal 
control verifications and 
facilitate risk assessments.
3rd Line: 
The Group Internal Audit 
function along with other 
external assurance providers 
perform reviews which provide 
independent assurance of the 
risk management and internal 
control systems.
Effective risk management is essential to achieving our strategy, 
supporting our ambition to grow a sustainable and resilient business 
in a dynamic market environment.
Risk Management Framework 
Top down
Bottom up
1. Identify: An enterprise-wide 
top-down and bottom-up 
approach identifies risks 
through input from 
management, consideration of 
external information sources 
and horizon scanning. Emerging 
risks are also identified and 
added to the risk register when 
they become material.
2. Assess: The risk assessment 
process evaluates the impact 
and likelihood of risks using 
standard criteria. Input 
from management through 
workshops, interviews and 
surveys is consolidated to 
produce the risk register. 
Executive input and calibration 
ensure a comprehensive view 
of the risk landscape and the 
principal and emerging risks 
are approved by the Board.
4. Monitor and Review:  
The Board and Audit Committee 
receive regular deep-dive 
updates outlining the status of 
principal risks and mitigating 
actions to manage them. If 
material control weaknesses are 
identified, management report 
these to the Audit Committee or 
Board, outlining remediations.
3. Mitigate: Each principal risk 
is assigned an executive owner 
with responsibility for ensuring 
that appropriate controls and 
management actions are in 
place. Regular reviews ensure 
the residual risk remains within 
approved risk appetite and if 
required, additional controls or 
actions are implemented.
Risk 
Management
Framework
1
3
2
4
O
ve
rs
i
g
h
t
C
ul
t
u
re
G
o
v
er
n
a
n
c
e
M
it
ig
a
t
e
I
d
e
n
ti
fy
A
s
s
e
s
s
M
o
n
it
o
r 
a
n
d
 
R
e
v
ie
w 
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

49
48
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Risk Appetite
In order to deliver on the Group’s strategic objectives, 
the Board recognises the need for balance and 
flexibility in our risk management approach. Kerry 
uses a five-point scale from Risk Averse to Risk 
Seeking which provides guidance on how much 
or little risk the Group is willing to accept in each 
circumstance. During 2024, the risk appetite for 
each principal risk was reviewed and approved by 
the Board, ensuring management have scope to 
operate while also providing guardrails to protect the 
Group, acknowledging a risk and reward trade-off. 
We have a zero tolerance for risks that could harm 
our people, impact food safety, or result in non-
compliance with laws and regulations. However, 
in a competitive marketplace, we recognise that 
strategic, commercial, and investment risks are 
necessary to seize opportunities and drive business 
results. Our acceptance of risk is contingent on fully 
understanding potential benefits and risks and 
implementing appropriate mitigation measures.
Principal Risks
The Board is satisfied that the Group has conducted a 
robust assessment of its principal and emerging 
risks, including those risks that could threaten the 
Group’s business model, future performance, 
solvency or liquidity. The table on pages 49-54 
describes the principal risks and uncertainties, which 
have been identified through the risk assessment 
process along with the mitigating actions established 
to manage these. Additionally, each risk is linked to 
our Value Creation Framework as outlined in the 
Strategic Report on pages 12-13. These risks form the 
basis of Board and Audit Committee communications 
and discussions.
While there have been no significant change in the 
principal risks in the last year, the Group operates 
in a dynamic environment where risks continue to 
evolve and the Group continues to develop mitigation 
measures to address them. The table presents 
the Board’s view of the Group’s principal risks and 
uncertainties and is not an exhaustive list of all the 
risks which may impact the Group. There may be 
additional risks that have not yet been considered 
material or are not yet known to the Board, but which 
could become significant in the future. Likewise, some 
of the current risks may reduce in significance as 
management actions are implemented or changes 
in the operating or external environment occur.
Emerging Risks
Emerging risks are considered during the risk 
assessment process as well as being identified 
through horizon scanning, continual dialogue with 
the business and keeping abreast of market and 
industry changes. Due to the uncertain nature of such 
risks, they can be difficult to quantify. A summary 
of emerging risks identified is presented to the 
Audit Committee and the Board for consideration 
and these risks continue to be monitored as part 
of our ongoing risk management processes. 
Emerging risks being monitored include climate-
related transition risks, such as challenges in 
sustainability reporting and the adoption of lower 
carbon technologies. The emergence of generative 
AI tools presents opportunity to enhance ways 
of working across many areas of the Group but 
vigilance is required to ensure the associated risks 
such as data privacy, accuracy and reliability are 
also managed. The Group is also focused on the 
risk associated with AI-related malicious attacks and 
continues to monitor the threat environment in this 
area. We also continue to monitor the impact of the 
current media attention surrounding ultra-processed 
foods and the rising popularity of anti-obesity 
drugs, and how these might influence consumer 
behaviours in the markets in which we operate and 
any risks and opportunities that this may present.
Climate Risk
The Board recognises the risks and opportunities 
posed by climate change and the influence they 
may have on the delivery of the Group’s business 
strategy. The Sustainability Committee plays a lead 
role in overseeing the Group’s actions on climate 
change and is supported by the Audit Committee 
in assessing how climate-related risks have been 
reviewed and integrated within the risk management 
and financial and sustainability reporting process.
In 2024, we have updated our assessment of 
climate-related impacts over a number of time 
horizons and different temperature pathways. The 
assessment approach is aligned with the overall 
Group enterprise risk management (ERM) process; 
however, by its nature the physical impacts of climate 
risk require a longer-term view and therefore when 
assessing climate as a discrete risk we have applied 
an extended time horizon using 2030 (medium-
term) and 2050 (long-term) as our reference 
timeframes. Further information in accordance 
with European Sustainability Reporting Standards 
and guidance from the Task Force on Climate-
related Financial Disclosures (TCFD), is available in 
the Sustainability Statement on pages 127-233.
Risk Trend
Risk is unchanged
Risk has increased
Risk has decreased
Growth
Return
Sustainability
Link to value creation Framework 
as per the Strategic Report
Principal Risks and Uncertainties – Strategic
PORTFOLIO MANAGEMENT
Description and Impact
The Group’s future growth and profitability is determined 
by how its portfolio of science backed technologies, end use 
markets, geographies, channels and customers evolve  
over time.
The Group’s ability to anticipate key market trends  
and evolving consumer demands and ensure the  
ongoing relevance of its portfolio is critical to its  
long-term performance.
A failure to respond to changing market dynamics and 
make optimal portfolio management decisions may impact 
on the Group’s profitability and long-term growth.
Mitigations
•	 The Group’s strategic planning process is designed to 
ensure that investment decisions consider both our 
financial and sustainability targets. A robust portfolio 
management toolkit is in place to support this process 
which uses multiple perspectives and data.
•	 The sale of Dairy Ireland marked a significant strategic 
step in the Group’s continued business development and 
portfolio evolution to becoming a fully dedicated taste 
and nutrition company. 
•	 Post-completion reviews are undertaken for all major 
investment projects to measure returns and inform 
future investment decisions.
•	 Our integrated business model is differentiated in the 
marketplace through our science and technology strategy 
which leverages an extensive ecosystem and expertise 
to deliver a leading product technology portfolio, with 
targeted deployment to meet market needs.
GEOPOLITICAL, EMERGING MARKETS AND MACROECONOMIC ENVIRONMENT 
Description and Impact
The Group’s global footprint and acquisitive growth strategy 
exposes it to global market forces, fluctuations in national 
economies, societal unrest, geopolitical uncertainty and an 
increasingly complex legal and regulatory environment.
Ongoing conflicts around the world continue to highlight 
the potential impact of geopolitical instability on areas such 
as supply chains, raw material costs and energy pricing  
and security. 
Failure to monitor and respond to change and volatility 
across the Group’s markets may lead to operational 
disruption or have an impact on the future growth and 
profitability of the Group.
Mitigations
•	 The Board and Group Executive Leadership Team closely 
monitor political and economic developments to inform 
decision-making and implement appropriate responses 
if required.
•	 Rigorous due diligence is undertaken when entering or 
commencing business activities in new markets.
•	 Group and local legal, regulatory and compliance teams 
ensure adherence to applicable laws and regulations 
– see Legal, Regulatory and Ethical Compliance risk for 
further detail.
•	 The breadth of the Group’s portfolio and well-diversified 
geographic reach help to mitigate exposure to localised 
risk. The Group has appropriate crisis management and 
business continuity plans in place to deal with issues as  
they arise.
Principal Risks
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

50
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Principal Risks and Uncertainties – Strategic (continued)	
BUSINESS ACQUISITION AND DIVESTITURE
Description and Impact
Acquisitions and divestitures continue to be a core element 
of the Group’s growth and portfolio management strategy 
which presents risks around due diligence, execution and 
integration or separation of businesses.
A failure to successfully execute divestments or identify, 
execute and efficiently integrate acquisitions and capitalise 
on potential synergies in a timely and effective manner could 
impact profitability and impede the strategic development of 
the Group.
Mitigations
•	 An experienced and dedicated Mergers and Acquisitions 
team is in place who follow a strong governance process 
throughout all stages of a transaction.
•	 All potential transactions are rigorously assessed and 
evaluated to ensure the Group’s strategic, financial and 
sustainability criteria are met. All transactions are fully 
reviewed and approved by the Board.
•	 Robust integration and divestment processes are in 
place and post-transaction performance is closely 
monitored by both divisional and Group management.
•	 Significant focus is placed on the retention of key acquired 
talent and support is provided to facilitate an efficient 
integration process.
CLIMATE CHANGE AND ENVIRONMENTAL
Description and Impact
Climate related risks may have a significant impact on the 
Group’s operations. 
Physical climate and other environmental risks including 
extreme weather events, temperature rises, biodiversity 
loss and water scarcity may result in operational disruption 
and increased volatility in the supply of raw materials, which 
may increase costs and have a negative impact on the 
Group’s assets, revenue and profitability.
Transition risks such as changes in consumer demand, 
carbon taxes or a failure to remain compliant with the 
continuously evolving regulatory landscape may have a 
negative impact on the Group’s revenue and profitability, 
and may damage the reputation of the Group.
The failure of the business to meet our climate and 
environmental objectives could result in reputational damage 
amongst customers, investors and other stakeholders.
Mitigations
•	 The Group’s cross-functional Sustainability Executive 
Committee oversees progress in delivering against 
the Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy. 
Regular updates are provided to the Sustainability 
Committee, the Audit Committee and the Board. For 
further detail in relation to sustainability risk governance 
please see page 133-134 of our Sustainability Statement.
•	 Performance versus targets is monitored through a suite 
of global KPIs. In addition, sustainability and climate-
related metrics are included as part of the Long-Term 
Incentive Plan (LTIP) for Executive Directors and  
senior management. 
•	 Consideration of climate-related matters is embedded 
in key investment decisions including capital, innovation 
and mergers & acquisitions. In 2024, an internal carbon 
price was introduced to aid assessment of large  
capital projects.
•	 In 2024, the Group has updated and expanded its 
assessment of climate-related risks and opportunities. 
Further details are outlined in the Sustainability 
Statement on pages 127-233.
•	 During 2024, significant work was completed to publish 
details of our climate transition plan and to ensure that 
the Group was prepared to meet the requirements of the 
European Sustainability Reporting Standards.
Principal Risks and Uncertainties – Operational 
PEOPLE
Description and Impact
The ability to attract, develop, engage and retain a diverse, 
talented and skilled workforce in a competitive labour 
market is critical if the Group is to continue to compete and 
grow effectively.
Ongoing geopolitical and economic uncertainty as well 
as competition for key leadership and specialist talent 
continues to impact both the supply and cost of labour in a 
number of markets in which the Group operates.
A failure to effectively manage talent, plan for leadership 
succession, invest in critical skills development and adapt to 
evolving employee needs may impact on the Group’s ability 
to deliver on its strategic objectives.
Mitigations
•	 Robust talent management and succession planning 
processes are in place, regularly reviewed by the 
Group Executive and overseen by the Governance and 
Nomination Committee.
•	 Our global Talent Acquisition team, embedded across all 
regions, ensures the Group is positioned to attract and 
select talent with the requisite skills and experience for 
execution of its strategy.
•	 Through its global Learning Academy the Group invests 
in and deploys learning and development programmes 
to build core capabilities and leadership expertise 
aligned to its strategic objectives. 
•	 The Group nurtures and monitors employee engagement 
through a combination of pulse surveys and a regular 
group-wide employee experience survey.
•	 The Group’s Diversity, Inclusion and Belonging Council 
continues to guide and oversee progress in embedding 
an inclusive culture across the Group and relevant KPIs 
and measures are in place.
•	 Reward and recognition programmes are regularly 
reviewed to ensure they remain competitive, incentivise 
and encourage the right behaviour and provide fair and 
equitable pay across all markets. 
FOOD SAFETY AND QUALITY
Description and Impact
Adherence to stringent food safety and quality controls is 
critical to ensure the safety and integrity of raw materials 
and products throughout the Group’s supply chain. 
The Group must also ensure compliance with continuously 
evolving legal and regulatory obligations in the areas of 
food safety, quality and labelling.
A significant food safety or regulatory compliance issue 
could result in a product recall, financial penalties and 
costs, impact business performance and/or damage the 
reputation of the Group.
Mitigations
•	 Industry-leading food safety and traceability systems 
are in place, and all manufacturing sites comply with 
international food safety and quality management 
standards. This is supported by a strong quality culture 
embedded through the Group’s Safety First, Quality 
Always approach.
•	 Comprehensive food safety training programmes are in 
place for all relevant employees.
•	 Regular audits of manufacturing sites against recognised 
global food safety standards are conducted by Internal 
Group Food Safety Quality (FSQ) audit team and Internal 
Audit, customers and other independent agencies.
•	 Stringent controls operate across our supply chain 
including due diligence and audits of suppliers 
supported by rigorous quality checking of all  
high-risk ingredients.
•	 A dedicated regulatory function closely monitors 
the external environment and engages industry 
organisations to identify and understand emerging 
issues and address increasing compliance requirements.
51
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

52
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Principal Risks and Uncertainties – Operational (continued)
HEALTH AND SAFETY
Description and Impact
The nature of the Group’s operations can expose 
employees, sub-contractors, customers and other 
individuals to potential health and safety risks.
The Group is also subject to local safety regulations in 
multiple jurisdictions, compliance with which is paramount.
A significant safety incident or failure to comply with laws 
and regulations could expose the Group to legal liability, 
significant costs and damage the Group’s reputation.
Mitigations
•	 A global health and safety management system is in 
place, which defines the global mandatory requirements 
for all sites. 
•	 An independent internal health and safety audit 
programme, to which all Group sites are subject,  
verifies the implementation of our global health and 
safety standards and fosters a culture of  
continuous improvement.
•	 A strong health and safety culture has been driven by 
management and employees at all levels supported by 
our Safety First, Quality Always mindset. All employees 
are empowered to challenge unsafe work conditions  
or practices.
•	 Standard suite of KPI’s in place, aligned to industry 
benchmarks, to monitor performance across all sites.
•	 An ongoing programme of initiatives is in place to 
continue to enhance the Group’s health and safety 
culture and processes. 
MARGIN MANAGEMENT
Description and Impact
The Group’s cost base and margin may be impacted by 
fluctuations in commodities, freight, energy, labour and 
other input costs.
While the unprecedented inflationary environment of  
recent years has eased, there is ongoing volatility in input 
costs which the Group must manage through its  
pricing mechanisms.
Failure to pass on cost increases to customers may have 
a material impact on the Group’s margins and ability to 
deliver target returns. 
Mitigations
•	 A strong commercial focus on procurement, pricing and 
cost improvement initiatives is maintained along with 
continuous monitoring of the commercial implications of 
commodity price and other input cost movements.
•	 Risk management processes such as taking purchasing 
cover on a back-to-back basis and exchange rate hedging 
have been implemented where necessary.
•	 Contractual mechanisms to pass through fluctuations in 
commodity prices are in place with many customers.
OPERATIONAL AND SUPPLY CHAIN RESILIENCE
Description and Impact
The Group’s manufacturing operations and global supply 
chain network is potentially exposed to adverse events 
such as physical disruptions, environmental and industrial 
accidents, cybersecurity incidents, widespread health 
events, trade restrictions or disruptions at a key supplier 
which could impact on our ability to service customers.
An uncertain geopolitical environment combined with an 
increase in the number of extreme weather events has 
highlighted the need to continue to focus on building a 
resilient supply chain which is responsive to changing 
internal and external pressures.
Failure to effectively respond to a significant operational or 
supply chain disruption could adversely affect the Group’s 
operations and financial performance.
Mitigations
•	 Crisis management and business continuity plans are in 
place to enable effective recovery from a major disruption. 
The diversified nature of the Group’s manufacturing 
footprint facilitates the transfer of production if required.
•	 Robust inventory management processes are in place 
including the maintenance of appropriate safety stock 
levels and our sourcing model includes dual supply for 
critical raw materials.
•	 All facilities have insurance cover to mitigate the impact of 
significant disruption.
•	 The Group continues to work with third-party experts to 
better understand climate-related risks and opportunities. 
For details on climate resilience, including our scenario 
analysis and transition plans refer to the Sustainability 
Statement on pages 127-233.
Principal Risks and Uncertainties – Operational (continued)
CYBERSECURITY AND ICT RESILIENCE
Description and Impact
The Group depends on a reliable and secure ICT 
infrastructure (both within our network and in partnership 
with third-party service providers) for its daily business 
operations, internal communications, controls, reporting 
and communications with customers and suppliers.
Ongoing geopolitical tensions and technological 
advancements, such as digital enablement and AI, mean 
that the Group, similar to other large global companies, is 
increasingly susceptible to sophisticated cyber-attacks or 
other information security breaches. 
A successful cyber-attack, internal breach or other systems 
failure, either within the Group or at a third-party service 
provider, could result in theft, misappropriation of critical 
assets and/or personal data and disruption to core business 
operations including manufacturing and supply chain. This 
could result in a significant customer, financial, reputational 
and/or regulatory impact for the Group.
Mitigations
•	 Formally documented policies in relation to cyber 
security are in place, supported by a robust governance 
structure, including an Executive Information Security 
Management Committee and the ROC. Cybersecurity 
strategy and actions are a major focus area for the Board 
and Audit Committee who this year received two formal 
updates from the Chief Information Security Officer.
•	 A dedicated ICT Security team is in place who, in 
conjunction with selected external technical specialists, 
use industry-leading tools, technology and processes 
aligned to global best practice cybersecurity frameworks. 
We have robust cybersecurity defences, including a 
continuous monitoring programme to detect threats 
and vulnerabilities. Additionally, we conduct secure 
assurance and compliance checks on our cloud-hosted 
ICT service providers.
•	 The Group continues to invest significantly to strengthen 
its ICT security posture and ensure it is compliant with all 
regulatory obligations such as the EU NIS2 Directive.
•	 Business continuity and disaster recovery plans are in 
place for critical applications which are routinely tested 
to ensure that data backup and restore procedures  
work reliably.
•	 All employees are required to complete mandatory 
cybersecurity training. In addition, the Group has 
intensified its information security awareness initiatives 
to further enhance the information security culture 
across the Group.
•	 Cybersecurity reviews are conducted by a team of 
internal ICT auditors in addition to the engagement of 
external experts on a biennial basis to conduct a cyber 
resilience assessment against the National Institute of 
Standards and Technology (NIST) 2.0 framework.
•	 The Group maintains a cyber insurance policy and no 
material information or cybersecurity breaches have 
been noted over the last three years.
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
Description and Impact
The Group’s unique mix of Intellectual Property (IP) is created 
by combining fundamental scientific knowledge, carefully 
managed material sourcing, recipe formulation and process 
technology expertise. The protection of IP is critical given it 
is a key component of the Group’s value creation model and 
supports its unique and differentiated position in  
the marketplace.
If IP owned by the Group is not adequately protected it may 
result in the loss of commercially sensitive and/or Kerry 
proprietary information which may have an adverse impact 
on revenue and profitability.
Mitigations
•	 A global centre of expertise exists to provide legal and 
technical support in the area of IP protection.
•	 Policies, procedures and training programmes are in place 
to provide guidance in relation to the capture, exploitation 
and protection of IP.
•	 Strong physical and system access controls are in  
place to prevent unauthorised access or download of 
sensitive data.
•	 Third-party misuse of intellectual property is monitored in 
both traditional and digital environments and appropriate 
action is taken when issues are identified.
53
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

55
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Principal Risks and Uncertainties – Financial and Compliance
LEGAL, REGULATORY AND ETHICAL COMPLIANCE
Description and Impact
The Group must comply with a complex and constantly 
evolving framework of local and international laws and 
regulations in such diverse areas as product safety and 
labeling, the environment, health & safety, employment 
law, human rights, data privacy, sustainability, international 
sanctions, anti-bribery and corruption, anti-money 
laundering, competition law, company law, taxation, 
corporate governance and stock exchange listing rules. 
Acting in a legal, ethical and socially responsible manner, 
consistent with our purpose, the expectations of customers, 
consumers and other stakeholders, is essential for the 
protection of the reputation of the Group.
A material failure to comply with applicable legal, 
regulatory and ethical standards or best practices could 
result in litigation or investigations, the imposition of 
significant fines, sanctions, adverse operational impact and 
reputational damage. 
Changes to laws and regulations could also have a material 
impact on the cost of doing business.
Mitigations
•	 Dedicated legal and regulatory teams supported by 
specialised functions and external advisors ensure 
compliance with applicable laws and regulations and 
provide support and advice on upcoming changes. 
•	 A Group Code of Conduct is in place underpinned by 
policies, processes and controls in relevant areas. 
•	 A Supplier Code of Conduct outlines the standards 
expected from those we do business with and our 
responsible sourcing programme focuses on key impact 
areas such as deforestation and human rights.
•	 The Legal function manages the Group’s business 
integrity programme incorporating a global Speak Up 
channel with robust mechanisms in place to ensure issues 
are properly investigated and remedial actions taken. 
The Business Integrity Committee oversee this work with 
regular updates provided to the Audit Committee.
•	 A group-wide mandatory compliance training programme 
is in place supplemented with regular, targeted training 
and awareness sessions. 
•	 Disputes and litigation are managed by the Litigation 
team within the Legal department, with General Counsel 
oversight of significant matters.
TAXATION
Description and Impact
Given the Group’s global network, it is exposed to a complex 
and evolving international tax environment.
The Group’s tax liability or reporting requirements may be 
negatively impacted by local or international legislative 
changes, evolving legal interpretations, tax audits or transfer 
pricing judgements.
Mitigations
•	 A team of dedicated tax experts responsible for ensuring 
compliance with all taxation matters globally are 
employed. A programme of continuous professional 
development ensures that the team is up to date on tax 
law changes e.g., OECD Pillar Two – Global Minimum Tax.
•	 In-house expertise is supplemented by external taxation 
advisors where required.
TREASURY
Description and Impact
The international nature of the Group’s operations 
means that it has transactions and activities across many 
jurisdictions which expose it to liquidity, foreign exchange, 
interest rate and counterparty risks.
Failure to manage these risks could negatively impact on the 
financial performance of the Group.
Mitigations
•	 The Group Finance Committee monitors treasury risk on 
an ongoing basis.
•	 The Group has a strong investment grade credit rating 
and maintains access to global debt markets. Significant 
cash balances and long-dated debt facilities are in place to 
ensure the Group’s liquidity requirements are met.
•	 The Treasury function actively manages treasury 
risks through cashflow forecasts, monitoring funding 
requirements, foreign currency exposure netting and 
hedging, interest rate hedging and management of 
counterparty risk.
Going Concern  
and Viability Assessment
The Board, taking into consideration the Group’s 
principal risks and uncertainties, including emerging 
risks, assessed the going concern and longer-term 
viability of the Group in line with the requirements 
of the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code and the 
Irish Annex. Its conclusions on these assessments are 
outlined below.
Going Concern
The Consolidated Financial Statements have been 
prepared on the going concern basis of accounting.
The Directors considered the Group’s business 
activities and how it generates value, together with 
the main trends and factors likely to affect future 
development, business performance and position of 
the Group, including the potential impact of climate-
related risks on profitability and liquidity, as described 
in the Business Reviews on pages 34-37.
The Group’s 2025 budget was reviewed and approved 
at the December Board meeting. The Directors have 
also examined the financial position of the Group, 
including cash flows, liquidity position, borrowing 
facilities, financial instruments and financial risk 
management, as described on pages 28-33 and 
additionally as described in note 25 to the  
financial statements.
As a result of this review, the Directors report that they 
have satisfied themselves and consider it appropriate 
that the Group and the Company is a going concern, 
having adequate resources to continue in operational 
existence for the foreseeable future and have not 
identified any material uncertainties that cast a 
significant doubt on the Group’s and the Company’s 
ability to continue as a going concern over a period of 
at least 12 months. 
Viability Assessment
Assessment of Prospects
In line with Provision 31 of the 2018 UK Corporate 
Governance Code, the Directors have carried out a 
rigorous review of the prospects of the Group over the 
medium term. In assessing the prospects of the Group 
and its ability to meet its liabilities as they fall due, the 
Board has taken account of the Group’s medium-term 
strategic planning cycle, capital investment plans, 
sources of funding, the business model, its broad 
portfolio and the innovation pipeline. The Directors 
have also considered the Group’s strong cash 
generation and debt maturity profile in addition to 
the principal risks and uncertainties detailed on pages 
49-54. This included a consideration of the potential 
impact of climate-related risks on profitability and 
liquidity. The financial position of the Group, its cash 
flows, liquidity position and borrowing facilities are 
outlined in the Financial Review on pages 28-33.
Scenario 1:  
External and Macroeconomic Risks
Depressed economic performance, 
increased pricing pressure, fluctuating 
inflation rates and interest rates, supply 
chain disruption, political unrest
Scenario 3:  
Additional Income Statement Expense
Impact of a catastrophic event such as 
a large-scale cyber-attack, significant 
product contamination, disruption to 
operations or demand shock 
Scenario 2:  
Climate Change and Environmental Risk*
Impacts of extreme weather events, water stress or 
other climate-related physical or transition risks
•	 Climate Change and Environmental  
•	 Business Acquisition and Divestiture 
•	 Geopolitical, Emerging Markets & Macroeconomic Environment
•	 Operational and Supply Chain Resilience 
•	 Legal , Regulatory and Ethical Compliance 
•	 Margin Management 
•	 Portfolio Management 
•	 People
•	 Intellectual Property
•	 Taxation and Treasury
•	 Climate Change and Environmental 
•	 Portfolio Management
•	 Operational and Supply Chain Resilience
•	 Margin Management
•	 Climate Change and Environmental 
•	 Cybersecurity and ICT Resilience
•	 Operational and Supply Chain Resilience
•	 Food Safety and Quality
•	 Legal, Regulatory and Ethical Compliance
•	 Portfolio Management 
•	 Intellectual Property
•	 Taxation and Treasury
RELEVANT PRINCIPAL RISKS
SCENARIO MODELLED
Viability Assessment Scenarios
*This scenario was modelled based on a three-year time horizon. For a longer-term assessment of climate risk please see the Climate 
Resilience Analysis on page 151-157 of the Sustainability Statement.
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

DIRECTORS’  
REPORT
56
57
Strategic Report Risk Management Report
Directors’ Report
Period of Viability Assessment
The Board has considered the length of time to be 
reviewed in the context of the viability assessment. 
Although the Group’s strategic planning cycle covers 
a period of five years, the Board considers that three 
years is the most appropriate period to assess the 
longer-term viability of the Group as current capital 
expenditure plans, commercial arrangements and 
financial projections are considered to be more 
reliable and robust over this period.
Assessment of Viability
The viability of the Group has been assessed, 
considering the Group’s current financial position, 
including external funding in place over the 
assessment period, and after modelling the impact of 
certain scenarios arising from the Group’s principal 
risks and uncertainties as outlined on pages 49-54.
While each of the principal risks and uncertainties 
could have an impact on the Group’s performance, 
three severe but plausible scenarios were modelled 
that the Board assessed would have the most 
direct and material impact on the Group. The three 
scenarios as outlined on the previous page were 
stress tested both individually and in combination to 
assess their potential impact on the Group’s solvency, 
liquidity and cash flow.
This analysis indicated that significant liquidity 
headroom existed in all scenarios tested. In addition, 
the Board consider that the diverse nature of the 
Group’s geographies, markets, customer base, and 
product portfolio provide significant mitigation 
against the impact of a serious business interruption.
Viability Statement
Based on their assessment of prospects and viability, 
the Directors have concluded that they have a 
reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to 
continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they 
fall due over the three-year period of the assessment.
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
59
58
Directors’ Report Board Of Directors
Directors’ Report Board Of Directors
Experience:
Christopher is an experienced 
non-Executive Director with 
a broad business leadership 
background who also brings 
extensive knowledge of the 
foodservice industry together 
with financial and risk 
management expertise.
He was formerly an Executive 
Director of Whitbread plc for 
11 years, serving as Finance 
Director for 7 years and then 
as Global Managing Director 
of Costa Coffee.
Christopher is currently 
Chairman of Wickes plc 
and previously was a 
non-Executive Director at 
Sanderson Design Group plc. 
Christopher is a Fellow of 
Chartered Accountants 
England and Wales.
Christopher joined the Board 
and was appointed Chairman 
of the Audit Committee in 
May 2018. He joined the 
Remuneration Committee 
in April 2020. He was 
appointed to the Governance 
& Nomination Committee 
in May 2024 and stepped 
down from the Sustainability 
Committee on the same date.
Appointed:
8 May 2018
Committee Membership
A
G
R
Experience:
Genevieve is a global 
science leader having 
served as Director General 
of the Centre National de 
la Recherche Scientifique, 
one of the world’s largest 
research organisations, and 
who during her executive 
career held roles as the 
Chief Science Officer at 
Firmenich International SA 
as well as the Chief Research 
& Development Officer and 
Chief Science Officer at 
Unilever plc. In addition to 
being a medical doctor, she 
holds two other doctorates, 
a PhD in Physics and one in 
Human Biology.
Genevieve brings to the 
Board expertise in the areas 
of human health, nutrition 
and food ingredients.
Genevieve is currently a non-
Executive Director of Dassault 
Systèmes SE and previously 
served on the boards of Air 
Liquide SA, AstraZeneca plc 
and Smith & Nephew plc. 
Genevieve joined the Board 
on 1 November 2023 and 
was appointed to the 
Sustainability Committee in 
May 2024.
Appointed:
1 November 2023
Committee Membership
S
Experience:
Fiona has over 30 years of 
experience in the consumer 
food and beverage sector 
having retired after a long 
and successful career with 
Mars Inc. culminating in her 
final role as Global President 
Food, Customers and 
Multisales Markets. 
She brings to the Board 
a deep knowledge of the 
consumer food and beverage 
sector, an understanding of 
global markets, customers 
and general management 
experience on a global scale. 
Fiona also has a strong track 
record in sustainability, health 
and wellbeing, particularly 
in the areas of women’s 
entrepreneurship and human 
rights. In May 2021, Fiona was 
awarded a CBE for services to 
women and the UK economy. 
Fiona is currently a non-
Executive director of Lego 
Group A/S, Marks and 
Spencer Group plc and Reckitt 
Benckiser Group plc. She is a 
board member of The Social 
Mobility Foundation and 
the Chartered Management 
Institute.
Fiona joined the Board 
in January 2022 and 
was appointed to the 
Remuneration Committee 
in February 2022. She was 
appointed as Chairperson of 
the Sustainability Committee 
in August 2023 and joined the 
Audit Committee in May 2024 
Appointed:
4 January 2022
Committee Membership
A
R
S
Experience:
Emer is a highly experienced 
professional who brings legal, 
business, governance and 
climate expertise to the Board.
Emer is a former senior 
partner of law firm Mason 
Hayes and Curran where 
she served as Head of the 
Litigation group from 2001 to 
2008, Managing Partner from 
2008 to 2014 and Chair from 
2014 to 2017.
Emer is currently the Senior 
Independent Director at 
Greencoat Renewables 
plc and is Chair of its 
Remuneration Committee. 
She is also a director of a 
number of private companies.
She previously served as a 
non-Executive Director of Aer 
Lingus plc from 2014 to 2015 
and as a Council Member 
of The Economic and Social 
Research Institute from 2014 
to 2020.
Emer brings experience on 
climate impact through her 
patronage of Chapter Zero 
Ireland, the Irish Chapter 
of the Climate Governance 
Initiative, developed in 
collaboration with the World 
Economic Forum.
Emer joined the Board in 
2020 and was appointed 
Chairperson of the 
Remuneration Committee 
in April 2022. She was 
appointed to the Governance 
& Nomination Committee and 
as Workforce Engagement 
Director in May 2024. She 
stepped down from the Audit 
Committee on the same date.
Appointed:
1 November 2020
Committee Membership
R
G
Experience:
Tom is an experienced 
leader who brings extensive 
knowledge of the food 
and agriculture industries, 
combined with a broad range 
of international diplomacy 
skills. He has been a member 
of numerous Irish Government 
food strategy committees 
including the most recent Agri-
Food 2030 Strategy Group. 
Tom had a long and 
distinguished career within 
the Irish Public Sector where 
he served for 10 years as 
Secretary General of the Irish 
Department of Agriculture, 
Food and the Marine and also 
held a number of international 
policy and trade negotiation 
leadership roles. 
Tom is currently Vice Chair 
of the Origin Green Global 
Sustainability Council. He 
is also Chairman of the 
Irish Government Public 
Appointments Service. Tom is a 
registered Chartered Director. 
Tom was a Board member of 
Bord Bia, the Irish Food Board, 
for 8 years and chaired its 
Dairy Subsidiary Board.
Tom joined the Board in 
September 2015 and was 
appointed Chairman in April 
2022. He is Chairman of  
the Governance and 
Nomination Committee.
Appointed:
29 September 2015 and as 
Chairman 28 April 2022
Committee Membership 
Experience:
Edmond is a highly 
experienced leader in the 
global food and beverage 
industry having spent over 20 
years in senior roles across 
the Group. Edmond brings 
a strategic mindset to drive 
Group performance and 
growth as well as significant 
financial and operational 
expertise.
Edmond joined Kerry’s 
graduate programme in 
Ireland in 1996. Over his 
career he has held leadership 
roles in the Group’s Flavours 
and Applied Health and 
Nutrition businesses as well 
as heading up the Group’s 
activities in China and the 
Asia Pacific region.
Edmond was appointed 
Executive Director and Group 
Chief Executive Officer in 
October 2017.
Appointed:
1 October 2017
Experience:
Marguerite brings extensive 
financial knowledge and 
risk management expertise 
as well as being a highly 
experienced business leader.
Marguerite has almost 
30 years' international 
experience having served as 
lead client partner at Deloitte 
Ireland for a number of 
multinationals operating in 
a broad range of industries 
including food and beverage, 
pharma and technology.
During her career with 
Deloitte, Marguerite served 
as a senior partner and held 
a number of leadership roles 
within Deloitte Ireland.
Marguerite is a Fellow of 
Chartered Accountants 
Ireland and holds a Bachelor 
of Commerce degree 
and a Masters degree in 
Accountancy.
Marguerite was appointed 
Executive Director and Group 
Chief Financial Officer in 
September 2018.
Appointed:
30 September 2018	
Experience:
Gerry has over 35 years’ 
experience in the Group and 
has extensive knowledge of 
the global food and beverage 
industry.
He has a wealth of business 
leadership experience, 
financial and operational 
expertise and brings a 
strategic mindset to the 
advancement of Kerry’s 
leading taste and nutrition 
capabilities and unique 
positioning.
Gerry joined Kerry’s graduate 
programme in 1986 and 
has held a number of senior 
financial and business 
management roles,  
primarily in the Americas 
region, including regional 
Chief Operating Officer  
and regional Chief  
Executive Officer.
He was appointed President 
and Chief Executive Officer 
of Kerry’s Global Taste & 
Nutrition business in 2011.
Gerry has served as an 
Executive Director on the 
Board since 2008.
Appointed:
13 May 2008
G
Chairman & Executive Directors
Independent Non-Executive Directors
MR. TOM MORAN
(69)(M)
Chairman of the Board
MR. CHRISTOPHER ROGERS
(64)(M)
Senior Independent  
Non-Executive Director
MR. EDMOND SCANLON
(51)(M) 
Executive Director
Chief Executive Officer
DR. GENEVIEVE BERGER
(70)(F) 
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
MS. MARGUERITE LARKIN
(53)(F) 
Executive Director
Chief Financial Officer
MS. FIONA DAWSON
(58)(F)
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
MR. GERRY BEHAN
(60)(M)
Executive Director
President and CEO  
Kerry Taste & Nutrition
MS. EMER GILVARRY
(67)(F)
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
Committee Membership Key 
Audit Committee 
A
Governance and Nomination Committee
G
Remuneration Committee
R
Sustainability Committee
Indicates Committee Chair
S
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
61
60
Directors’ Report Board Of Directors
Directors’ Report Board Of Directors
Independent Non-Executive Directors
Independent Non-Executive Directors
Experience:
Catherine has an 
international reputation in 
scientific research gained 
through a long and successful 
academic career in the US, 
Switzerland and at University 
College Dublin (UCD).
She brings to the Board 
knowledge across human 
health and is a global expert 
on diabetes as well as 
inflammation, cardiovascular 
and kidney diseases. 
Catherine is the Associate 
Dean, Research and 
Innovation at UCD’s School 
of Medicine as well as being 
Director of the Diabetes 
Complications Research 
Centre at the UCD Conway 
Institute and the UCD School 
of Medicine. During her time 
with UCD she held a variety 
of senior management roles 
including Vice President, 
Innovation. She currently 
serves as a Trustee of Barts 
Charity, London.
Catherine was appointed to 
the Board on 1 November 
2023 and joined the 
Sustainability Committee in 
May 2024.
Appointed: 
1 November 2023
Committee Membership
S
Experience:
Liz has over 30 years’ 
experience in executive and 
non-executive positions.
She brings to the Board 
significant and wide ranging 
business leadership as well 
as non-executive director and 
audit committee experience 
gained in complex multi-
national listed companies.
Liz holds a BSc in Economics 
from University College 
London and is a Fellow of 
Chartered Accountants in 
England and Wales.
Liz is currently a non-Executive 
Director of Glencore plc.
She was formerly Director 
of Corporate Affairs at 3i 
Group and Group Director of 
Corporate Affairs at Smith & 
Nephew plc.
She previously served as non-
Executive Director of Novo-
Nordisk A/S, National Grid plc, 
Melrose Industries plc, Savills 
plc and Synergy Health plc. 
Liz was appointed to 
the Board and the Audit 
Committee on 1 March 2024.
Appointed: 
1 March 2024
Committee Membership
A
Experience:
Michael has over 36 years 
of investment management 
experience having retired 
after a long and successful 
career with Capital Group, 
one of the world’s oldest 
and largest investment 
management organisations. 
He brings to the Board a 
detailed knowledge of global 
equity capital markets, 
finance knowledge, extensive 
business leadership skills 
and insights into the North 
American market. 
Michael is currently a non-
Executive director with  
EOG Resources Inc, which is 
listed on the New York  
Stock Exchange. 
Michael joined the Board in 
May 2021 and was appointed 
to the Audit Committee 
in November 2021. He 
joined the Governance and 
Nomination Committee 
in August 2022 and the 
Remuneration Committee in 
May 2024.
Appointed: 
3 May 2021
Committee Membership
A
G
R
Experience:
Jinlong is an experienced 
leader with more than 30 
years’ experience in global 
business development, 
consumer branding and 
general management. His 
in-depth understanding of 
Asian markets, coupled with 
his extensive knowledge 
of the food and beverage 
industry, brings a key set of 
skills to the Board.
Jinlong holds a Bachelor’s 
degree in international 
economics and trade from 
the University of International 
Economics and Trade in 
Beijing and a Juris Doctor 
degree from Columbia 
University School of Law.
He was formerly President of 
Starbucks Coffee Asia Pacific 
having served as Chairman 
and President of Starbucks 
Greater China Region. He also 
served as Operating Partner 
of Hony Capital Limited 
and as Group Chairman 
and Chief Executive Officer 
of PizzaExpress. He was 
previously a non-Executive 
Director on the Boards of 
Sonova Holdings AG and 
Swire Properties Limited.
Jinlong joined the Board 
in January 2021 and was 
appointed to the Audit 
Committee in May 2021.
Appointed: 
5 January 2021
Committee Membership
A
Experience:
Patrick has considerable 
experience in the food 
industry, in particular the 
dairy and agribusiness 
sectors. He has held a 
number of local and national 
roles in a leading Irish dairy 
representation body through 
which he has knowledge in 
dealing with environmental 
sustainability matters relevant 
to the dairy sector. He brings 
insights to the Board that 
are reflective of the Group’s 
heritage.
Patrick joined the Board 
in January 2023 and 
was appointed to the 
Sustainability Committee in 
August 2023.
Appointed: 
16 January 2023
Committee Membership
S
Diverse Leadership1
Executive/Non Executive Split
Board Age Profile (years)
Board Tenure (Years)
Board Gender Profile
Executive
23%
Non-Executive
77%
56-65, 
38%
66-70, 
38%
40-55, 
24%
0-2, 
31%
11-20, 
7%
3-5, 
31%
6-10, 
31%
Female 
46%
Male 
54%
PROF. CATHERINE GODSON
(63)(F)
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
MS. LIZ HEWITT
(68)(F) 
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
MR. MICHAEL KERR
(65)(M) 
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
MR. PATRICK ROHAN
(50)(M)
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
MR. JINLONG WANG
(67)(M) 
Independent  
Non-Executive Director
1	This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 GOV-1 21 a as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 132 - subject to limited assurance
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
63
Directors’ Report Report of the Directors
Directors’ Report Report of the Directors
Report of the Directors
Directors and Other Information
Directors
Tom Moran, Chairman 
Edmond Scanlon, Chief Executive Officer* 
Marguerite Larkin, Chief Financial Officer* 
Gerry Behan, President & CEO Kerry Taste & Nutrition* 
Christopher Rogers 
Genevieve Berger 
Fiona Dawson 
Emer Gilvarry 
Catherine Godson 
Liz Hewitt 
Michael Kerr 
Patrick Rohan 
Jinlong Wang
*Executive Director
Secretary and Registered Office
Ronan Deasy 
Kerry Group plc 
Prince’s Street Tralee 
Co. Kerry 
V92 EH11 
Ireland
Registrar and Share Transfer Office
Ronan Deasy 
Registrar’s Department 
Kerry Group plc 
Prince’s Street 
Tralee 
Co. Kerry 
V92 EH11 
Ireland
Website
kerry.com
The Directors submit their Annual Report together 
with the audited Consolidated Financial Statements 
and the Sustainability Statement with limited 
assurance for the year ended 31 December 2024.
Principal Activities
Kerry is a world leading provider of taste and 
nutrition solutions across food and beverage 
markets. It innovates with its customers to create 
great tasting products, with improved nutrition 
and functionality, while ensuring a better impact 
for the planet. In 2024, Kerry was also a leading 
Irish provider of value-add dairy ingredients 
and consumer products. Kerry is driven to be its 
customers most valued partner, creating a world of 
sustainable nutrition.
Listed on the Euronext Dublin and London Stock 
Exchanges, Kerry has an international presence with 
124 manufacturing facilities across the world.
Results and Review of the Business 
The Directors are pleased to report a strong 
performance across our financial metrics and 
sustainability measures for 2024.
Group reported revenue was €8.0bn (2023: €8.0bn) 
and EBITDA was €1.25bn (2023: €1.17bn) reflecting 
an EBITDA margin of 15.7% (2023: 14.5%). This 
resulted in growth in adjusted EPS on a constant 
currency basis of 9.7% (2023: 1.2%). The Basic EPS 
increased to 424.5c (2023: 410.4c). Revenue from 
continuing operations was €6.9bn (2023: €7.0bn) 
and EBITDA from continuing operations was €1.19bn 
(2023: €1.11bn). This resulted in growth in adjusted 
EPS from continuing operations of 9.1%. The Basic 
EPS from continuing operations was 389.2c (2023: 
395.0c). The free cash flow generated was €766m 
(2023: €701m) and from a balance sheet perspective 
Shareholders equity was €6.5bn (2023: €6.5bn) 
and Return on Average Capital Employed (ROACE) 
was 10.6% (2023: 10.0%). Our main sustainability 
measures showed our nutritional reach increased to 
1.36bn (2023: 1.25bn). The absolute carbon reduction 
was 50% (2023: 48%) and the food waste reduction 
was 38% (2023: 39%). 
Further details of the financial results for the year are 
set out in the Consolidated Financial Statements and 
further details of the sustainability results are set out 
in the Sustainability Statement on pages 127-233. The 
Group’s financial and sustainability key performance 
indicators are discussed on pages 26-27.
The Chairman’s Statement, the Chief Executive 
Officer’s Review, the Business Reviews and the 
Financial Review, which are included in the Strategic 
Report on pages 6-37, report on the assets and 
liabilities and financial position as well as the 
performance of the Group’s business, including M&A 
activity during the year, and on future developments.
Dividends
On 17 February 2025, the Directors recommended 
a final dividend totalling 89.0 cent per share in 
respect of the year ended 31 December 2024 (see 
note 11 to the financial statements). This final 
dividend per share is an increase of 10.1% over the 
final 2023 dividend per share paid on 10 May 2024. 
This dividend is in addition to the interim dividend 
of 38.1 cent per share paid to shareholders on 8 
November 2024.
The payment date for the final dividend is 9 May 2025 
to shareholders registered on the record date of 11 
April 2025.
Principal Risks and Uncertainties
In accordance with Section 327(1)(b) of the 
Companies Act 2014 and the Central Bank 
(Investment Market Conduct) Rules, a description of 
the principal risks and uncertainties facing the Group 
are outlined in the Risk Management Report on 
pages 49-54.
Research and Development
The Group is fully committed to ongoing 
technological innovation in all sectors of its business, 
leveraging our broad and unique technology 
portfolio to provide our customers with integrated 
solutions that meet their need to deliver great 
tasting, sustainable and nutritious products for 
their markets. To facilitate this, the Group has 
invested in leading research, development and 
application centres of excellence with a strategically 
located Global Innovation Centre, based in Naas, 
Ireland, which is supported by Regional Technology 
& Innovation Centres and a global knowledge 
management infrastructure. Expenditure on research 
and development applications and technical support 
amounted to €309.8m in 2024 (2023: €301.3m).
62
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
64
65
Directors’ Report Report of the Directors
Directors’ Report Report of the Directors
Sustainability
The Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy 
underpins Kerry’s future growth as we continue 
to partner with our customers across the globe 
to create a world of sustainable nutrition. As part 
of our Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy, 
Kerry works with customers to promote healthier 
and more sustainable diets through positive and 
balanced nutrition, aiming to reach over two billion 
people by 2030. The strategy also includes ambitions 
to deliver for people, society and the planet with 
associated targets across material topics including 
climate change, responsible employer and consumer 
health. The Board, through the Sustainability 
Committee, is responsible for governance and 
oversight of the Group’s sustainability strategy and 
its implementation. Details regarding the Group’s 
sustainability strategy, targets, performance, policies 
and programmes are outlined in the Sustainability 
Review on pages 38-45 and in the Sustainability 
Statement on pages 127-233.
Details of our climate-related risks, opportunities 
and other climate-related disclosures including those 
relating to the Task Force on Climate-related Financial 
Disclosures (TCFD) are outlined on page 45.
The Sustainability Statement is prepared in 
accordance and compliance with the European 
Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS) issued by 
the EU Commission and transposed and adopted into 
the Companies Act 2014 and details Kerry’s strategic 
management of the impacts, risks and opportunities 
identified for our material topics based on our 
double materiality assessment. 
Share Capital
Details of the share capital are shown in note 28 
of the financial statements. The authorised share 
capital of the Company is €35,000,000 divided into 
280,000,000 A ordinary shares of 12.5 cent each, 
of which 166,440,652 shares were in issue as at 31 
December 2024.
The A ordinary shares rank equally in all respects. 
There are no limitations on the holding of securities 
in the Company.
There are no restrictions on the transfer of fully 
paid shares in the Company, but the Directors have 
the power to refuse the transfer of shares that are 
not fully paid. There are no deadlines for exercising 
voting rights other than proxy votes, which must be 
received by the Company at least 48 hours before the 
time of the meeting at which a vote will take place. 
There are no restrictions on voting rights except:
•	 where the holder or holders of shares have failed 
to pay any call or instalment in the manner and at 
the time appointed for payment; or
•	 the failure of any shareholder to comply with the 
terms of Article 14 of the Company’s Articles of 
Association (disclosure of beneficial interest).
The Company is not aware of any agreements 
between shareholders which may result in 
restrictions on the transfer of securities or on voting 
rights.
The Directors have the authority to issue new shares 
in the Company up to a maximum aggregate nominal 
value of €7,181,767 (representing approximately 
33% of the A Ordinary Shares in issue as at the date 
of the 2024 Annual General Meeting). This authority 
will expire on the earlier of the conclusion of the 
2025 Annual General Meeting (AGM) and close of 
business on 1 August 2025 and it is intended to seek 
shareholder approval to renew the authority at the 
AGM to be held on 1 May 2025.
Shareholders approved the authority for the 
Directors to allot shares for cash on a non-pro 
rata basis up to an aggregate nominal amount of 
€2,176,293 (representing approximately 10% of the A 
Ordinary Shares in issue) at the AGM held on 2 May 
2024. Shareholders also approved an authority to 
allot additional shares up to an aggregate nominal 
amount of €2,176,293 (representing approximately 
10% of the A Ordinary Shares in issue) for cash on a 
non-pro rata basis provided the additional authority 
will only be used for the purpose of an acquisition 
or specified capital investment announced 
contemporaneously with the issue or which has 
taken place in the preceding six-month period and 
is disclosed with the announcement of the issue. 
Neither authority has been exercised to date and 
both authorities will expire on the earlier of the 
conclusion of the 2025 AGM and close of business 
on 1 August 2025. It is intended to seek shareholder 
approval for their renewal, but at a lower amount, at 
the 2025 AGM.
In December 2024, the Company redeemed and 
cancelled 19,045,396 shares held by Kerry Co-
operative Creameries Limited (“KCC”) and allotted 
16,187,024 shares to the members of KCC and to 
satisfy fractional share entitlements pursuant to the 
share exchange steps executed as part of the process 
to dispose of the Dairy Ireland business.
During 2024, 264,089 shares were allotted pursuant 
to the Company’s Short and Long-Term Incentive 
Plans as a result of shares which vested and options 
which were exercised. Further details are shown in 
note 29 to the financial statements.
The Company may purchase its own shares in 
accordance with the Companies Act 2014 and the 
Company’s Articles of Association. At the 2023 AGM, 
shareholders passed a resolution authorising the 
Company to purchase up to 10% of its own issued 
share capital as at the date of the AGM. The Company 
exercised this authority, and a share buyback 
programme was launched on 1 November 2023. In 
the period from 1 November 2023 to 1 May 2024 
the Company purchased 3,854,452 shares returning 
a total of €300m to shareholders. The authority 
was renewed at the 2024 AGM and the Company 
launched two additional share buyback programmes. 
In the period 7 May 2024 to 31 December 2024 the 
Company purchased a further 4,276,535 shares 
returning an additional €358m to shareholders. 
During 2024 the total number of shares acquired was 
6,757,726 at a cost of €557m.
All shares purchased under the share buyback 
programmes are cancelled immediately. The current 
authority is due to expire on the earlier of the 
conclusion of the 2025 AGM and close of business on 
1 August 2025 and it is intended to seek shareholder 
approval for its renewal at the 2025 AGM.
Substantial Interests
The Directors have been notified of the following 
shareholdings of 3% or more in the issued share 
capital of the Company:
Shareholder
Number Held
%
Blackrock 
Investment 
Management
9,742,721
5.9%
Percentage held is based on the number of shares in issue as at  
31 December 2024.
Apart from the aforementioned, the Company has 
not been notified of any interest of 3% or more in the 
issued share capital of the Company.
Directors
The Board, at the date of this report, consists of a 
Chairman, three Executive and nine independent 
non-Executive Directors. The names and biographical 
details of the Directors are set out on pages 58-61. 
In accordance with the Company’s Articles of 
Association and Provision 18 of the Code, each of 
the Directors individually retire at the AGM of the 
Company and, where appropriate, submit themselves 
for re-election.
No reappointment is automatic and all Directors 
who intend to submit themselves for re-election are 
subject to a full and rigorous evaluation. One of the 
main purposes of the evaluation is to assess each 
Director’s suitability for re-election. If a Director is 
not deemed to be effective in carrying out his or 
her required duties, the Board will not recommend 
that Director for re-election. Following the individual 
performance evaluation of all Directors, as outlined 
in the Corporate Governance Report on page 82, the 
Board recommends the re-election of all Directors 
seeking re-election.
The Directors’ and Company Secretary’s interests 
in shares and debentures are included in the 
Remuneration Report on pages 121-122.
Board and Committee Changes
Ms. Liz Hewitt joined the Board and the Audit 
Committee with effect from 1 March 2024.
Dr. Hugh Brady and Dr. Karin Dorrepaal, each having 
served in excess of nine years, did not seek re-
election and retired from the Board at the conclusion 
of the AGM on 2 May 2024.
The Articles of Association empower the Board to 
appoint Directors, but also require such Directors 
to retire and submit themselves for re-election at 
the next AGM following their appointment. For the 
purposes of the European Communities (Takeover 
Bids (Directive 2004/25/EC)) Regulations 2006 specific 
rules regarding the appointment and re-election 
of Directors are referred to in the Governance and 
Nomination Committee Report.
Corporate Governance
The Corporate Governance Report on pages 69-84 
sets out the Company’s application of the Principles, 
and compliance with the Provisions of the 2018 UK 
Corporate Governance Code and the Irish Corporate 
Governance Annex (the Code).
Non-Financial Information
Pursuant to the European Union (Disclosure of Non- 
Financial and Diversity Information by certain large 
undertakings and groups) Regulations 2017, the 
Group is required to report on certain non-financial 
information to provide an understanding of its 
development, performance, position and the impact of 
its activities, relating to, at least, environmental matters, 
social matters, employee matters, respect for human 
rights and anti-bribery & corruption. Information on 
these matters can be found in the following sections 
of the Annual Report, which are deemed to form part 
of the Directors’ Report: the Sustainability Review on 
pages 38-45, the Sustainability Statement on pages 
127-233 (which is prepared in accordance with Part 28 
of the Companies Act 2014 and in compliance with the 
European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS) 
issued by the EU Commission and transposed and 
adopted into the Companies Act 2014), Our Business 
Model on pages 18-19, the Risk Management Report 
on pages 46-56. Information on diversity can be 
found in the Governance and Nomination Committee 
Report on pages 91-95, Our People on pages 14-17, 
the Sustainability Review on pages 38-45 and the 
Sustainability Statement on pages 127-233.
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
66
Going Concern and Long-Term Viability 
Statements
The going concern and longer-term viability 
statements in the Risk Management Report on pages 
55-56 set out the Company’s basis for the adoption of 
the going concern basis of accounting in preparing 
the Consolidated Financial Statements and the 
basis for the Directors’ conclusion that they have a 
reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to 
continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they 
fall due over the next three years.
Directors’ Responsibility Statement
Annual Report and Financial Statements
The Directors are responsible for preparing the 
Annual Report and the financial statements in 
accordance with applicable laws and regulations.
Irish Company Law requires the Directors to prepare 
financial statements for each financial year, which 
give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities 
and financial position of the Company and the 
Group, and of the profit or loss of the Group for that 
period. Under that law the Directors have elected to 
prepare Group financial statements in accordance 
with International Financial Reporting Standards as 
issued by the IASB (‘IFRS Accounting Standards’) and 
International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) 
as adopted by the European Union and Article 4 of 
the IAS Regulation and have also chosen to prepare 
the parent company financial statements under 
IFRS Accounting Standards and IFRS as adopted 
by the European Union. In preparing the financial 
statements, the Directors are required to:
•	 select suitable accounting policies and then apply 
them consistently;
•	 make judgements and estimates that are 
reasonable and prudent;
•	 state that the financial statements comply with 
IFRS Accounting Standards and IFRS as adopted by 
the European Union; and
•	 prepare the financial statements on the going 
concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume 
that the Group will continue in business. 
The Directors are responsible for ensuring that the 
Company keeps adequate accounting records which 
correctly explain and record the transactions of the 
Company, enabling at any time the assets, liabilities, 
financial position and profit or loss of the Company 
to be determined with reasonable accuracy and 
ensuring that the financial statements are prepared 
in accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards and 
IFRS as adopted by the European Union, comply with 
the Companies Act 2014 and as regards to the Group 
financial statements, Article 4 of the IAS Regulation 
and enable the financial statements to be audited.
The Directors are also responsible for safeguarding 
the assets of the Company and hence for taking 
reasonable steps for the prevention and detection 
of fraud and other irregularities. The Directors are 
responsible for the maintenance and integrity of 
the corporate and financial information included 
on the Group’s website kerry.com. Irish legislation 
governing the preparation and dissemination of 
financial statements may differ from legislation in 
other jurisdictions.
In accordance with the Central Bank (Investment 
Market Conduct) Rules, the Directors are required 
to include a management report containing a fair 
review of the business and a description of the 
principal risks and uncertainties facing the Group.
The Directors are also required by applicable law and 
the Listing Rules issued by Euronext Dublin and the 
UK Listing Authority to prepare a Directors’ Report 
and reports relating to Directors’ remuneration and 
corporate governance.
Each of the Directors, whose names and functions 
are listed on page 62, confirms that, to the best of 
their knowledge and belief:
•	 the Consolidated Financial Statements for the year 
ended 31 December 2024 have been prepared in 
accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards and 
IFRS as adopted by the European Union and as 
applied in accordance with the Companies Act 
2014. They give a true and fair view of the assets, 
liabilities, and financial position of the Group and 
the undertakings included in the consolidation, 
taken as a whole, as at that date and its profit for 
the year then ended;
•	 the Company financial statements, prepared 
in accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards 
and IFRS as adopted by the European Union and 
as applied in accordance with the Companies 
Act 2014, give a true and fair view of the assets, 
liabilities and financial position of the Company as 
at 31 December 2024;
•	 the Financial and Business Reviews on pages 28-
37 include a fair review of the development and 
performance of the business for the year ended 31 
December 2024 and the position of the Company 
and the Group at the year end;
•	 the Risk Management Report provides a 
description of the principal risks and uncertainties 
which may impact the future performance of the 
Company and the Group at the year end; and
•	 the Annual Report and Consolidated Financial 
Statements, taken as a whole, provides the 
information necessary for shareholders to 
assess the Company’s and Group’s position and 
performance, business model and strategy and is 
fair, balanced and understandable.
Sustainability Statement 
The Directors are responsible for the preparation 
of the Sustainability Statement in accordance with 
Part 28 of the Companies Act 2014, including the 
Sustainability Statement in a clearly identifiable 
dedicated section of the Directors’ Report. 
The Directors are also responsible for designing, 
implementing and maintaining such internal 
controls that they determine are relevant to enable 
the preparation of the Sustainability Statement in 
accordance with Part 28 of the Companies Act 2014, 
that is free from material misstatement, whether due 
to fraud or error. 
In preparing the Sustainability Statement, the 
directors are required to: 
•	 prepare the statement in accordance with the 
European Sustainability Reporting Standards 
(ESRS) including the selection and application of 
appropriate sustainability reporting methods; 
•	 disclose the double materiality assessment 
process performed to identify the information 
required to be reported in the Sustainability 
Statement; 
•	 prepare the disclosures within the environmental 
section of the Sustainability Statement, in 
compliance with Article 8 of EU Regulation 
2020/852 (the “Taxonomy Regulations”); 
•	 ensure that the Group maintains adequate records 
for the preparation of the Sustainability Statement; 
•	 make judgements and estimates that are 
reasonable in the circumstances including the 
identification and description of any inherent 
limitations in the measurement or evaluation of 
information in the Sustainability Statement; and 
•	 prepare forward-looking information, where 
applicable, on the basis of disclosed assumptions 
about events that may occur in the future and 
possible future actions by the Group.
Directors’ Compliance Policy Statement
It is the policy of the Company to comply with its 
relevant obligations (as defined in the Companies 
Act 2014). The Directors have drawn up a compliance 
policy statement (as defined in section 225(3)(a) of 
the Companies Act 2014) and arrangements and 
structures are in place that are, in the Directors’ 
opinion, designed to secure material compliance with 
the Company’s relevant obligations. The Directors 
confirm that these arrangements and structures 
were reviewed during the financial year. As required 
by Section 225(2) of the Companies Act 2014, the 
Directors acknowledge that they are responsible 
for the Company’s compliance with the relevant 
obligations. In discharging their responsibilities 
under Section 225, the Directors relied on the advice 
both of persons employed by the Company and 
of third parties who the Directors believe have the 
requisite knowledge and experience to advise the 
Company on compliance with its relevant obligations.
Accounting Records
To ensure that proper accounting records are kept 
for the Company in accordance with sections 281 
to 285 of the Companies Act 2014, the Directors 
employ appropriately qualified accounting personnel 
and maintain appropriate accounting policies and 
systems. The accounting records of the Company are 
maintained at the Company’s registered office.
Accountability and External Audit
A statement relating to the Directors’ responsibilities 
in respect of the preparation of the financial 
statements is set out on pages 66-67 with the 
responsibilities of the Company’s external Auditors 
outlined on pages 235-243. 
The Financial Statements on pages 244-321 have 
been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers (PwC), 
Chartered Accountants. 
The external Auditors PwC, who were appointed in 
March 2016, will continue in office in accordance 
with Section 383(2) of the Companies Act 2014. A 
resolution authorising the Directors to determine 
their remuneration will be proposed at the Annual 
General Meeting.
Disclosure of Information to the External 
Auditors
Each of the Directors, who were members of the 
Board at the date of approval of this Report of the 
Directors, confirms that:
•	 so far as they are aware there is no relevant audit 
information of which the Company’s external 
auditors are unaware; and
•	 they have taken all the steps that they ought 
to have taken as a Director in order to make 
themselves aware of any relevant audit 
information and to establish that the Company’s 
external auditors are aware of that information.
Memorandum and Articles of Association 
The Company’s Memorandum and Articles of 
Association set out the objects and powers of the 
Company. The Articles of Association of the Company 
may only be amended by way of special resolution 
approved by shareholders in a general meeting.
A copy of the Memorandum and Articles of 
Association can be obtained from the Company’s 
website kerry.com.
Directors’ Report Report of the Directors
Directors’ Report Report of the Directors
67
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
STRATEGIC REPORT
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
GOVERNANCE REPORT
Corporate Governance Report
Dear Shareholder, 
I am pleased to present the Kerry 
Group Corporate Governance Report 
for the year ended 31 December 2024.
The Corporate Governance Report describes how 
we apply the main Principles of good governance 
as set out in the 2018 UK Corporate Governance 
Code and the Irish Corporate Governance Annex 
(together the Code). On behalf of the Board, I can 
confirm that for the year under review, the Group has 
complied with all Provisions of the Code other than 
Provision 19 (Chair tenure). For further information 
refer to the Compliance Statement on page 74.
The Board sets the tone and shared values for the 
way in which the Group operates and recognises the 
importance of culture to the success of the business 
model. During 2024, the Board continued to assess 
and monitor the Group’s culture to ensure that 
it is aligned with the Group’s strategy and values 
and is adequately embedded across the Group.
As a Board, we recognise the benefits of 
understanding the views of all our stakeholders and 
we ensure that their interests are taken into account 
in Board discussions and decision making. Details of 
stakeholder engagement activities during the year, 
including the work of the designated Workforce 
Engagement Director, are outlined on pages 75-78.
The Board, in conjunction with the Governance 
and Nomination Committee, ensures that there 
are robust plans in place to facilitate Board, 
Executive and senior management succession.
During 2024, the Board appointed Ms. Liz Hewitt 
as a non-Executive Director and her experience 
and skills will be an invaluable asset to the 
Board. Details of the non-Executive Director 
and Committee changes that occurred during 
the year, are set out in the Governance and 
Nomination Committee Report on page 94.
The Board recognises its role in providing 
guidance and strategic oversight in relation to 
the implementation of the Group’s Beyond the 
Horizon sustainability strategy. The Sustainability 
Committee monitored how the implementation 
of the Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy is 
progressing, and reviewed performance achieved 
versus sustainability commitments and targets. 
Together with the Audit Committee, it also approved 
the sustainability related reporting in the 2024 
Annual Report, including the new Sustainability 
Statement arising from the implementation of the 
Corporate Sustainability Reporting Directive. 
Diversity at Board level has been a focus for the 
Governance and Nomination Committee for a number 
of years and also continues to be a key factor when 
considering Board and Committee refreshment. 
During 2024, the Committee also monitored the 
progress made against the diversity targets at senior 
management level to ensure the appropriate level 
of skills and diversity exist, to support the delivery of 
the Group’s strategy and financial targets. Diversity 
at Board level, in terms of gender, nationality and 
ethnic background have all improved in recent years. 
I am pleased to say that the Board now has 46% 
female representation and plans to maintain female 
representation at a minimum level of 40% going 
forward, in alignment with listing requirements.
The Group has committed to achieving equal gender 
representation across all senior management roles 
by the end of 2030. Improving and monitoring 
diversity beyond gender, and below Board level will 
continue to be a key area of focus for the Board 
and the Executive Leadership Team in 2025.
Each year, the Board undertakes a formal evaluation 
of its effectiveness and that of its Committees. In 
2024, the evaluation was an internal self-assessment 
and the outcome of this review is that the Board and 
its Committees consider that they are performing 
effectively. Details of the process and the resulting 
actions from this review are outlined on page 82.
Details of the Group’s activities and the operations of 
the Board, contained in the following report, outline the 
manner in which the Group has achieved compliance 
with the Code through the activities and operations 
of the Board and its Committees during the year.
Tom Moran
Chairman of the Board
69
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
Change of Control Provisions
The Group’s revolving credit facility includes a 
‘Change of Control’ provision which requires the 
Group to notify the lending institutions of a change 
of control event occurring. Each lender has the 
option to withdraw their facilities in the event of a 
change of control occurring.
Public senior bond notes issued by the Group contain 
a provision that may require the Group to repurchase 
the notes in the event that a change of control occurs 
which leads to a downgrading of the credit rating 
assigned to the notes to below investment grade.
Other than the ‘Change of Control’ provisions in those 
arrangements, the Group is not a party to any other 
significant agreements which contain such a provision.
Events After the Balance Sheet Date
Since the financial year end, the Group has:
•	 repurchased 458,271 shares at a cost of €43.3m up 
to 31 January 2025; and
•	 proposed a final dividend of 89.0 cent per A 
Ordinary Share.
Political Donations
During the year, the Company made no political 
contributions which require disclosure under the 
Electoral Act, 1997.
Group Entities
The principal subsidiaries and associated 
undertakings as at 31 December 2024 are listed in 
note 37 to the financial statements.
Financial Instruments
The financial risk management objectives and 
policies, along with a description of the use of 
financial instruments are set out in note 25 to the 
financial statements.
Information Required to be Disclosed by 
Listing Rule 6.1.77, Republic of Ireland 
Listing Authority
For the purposes of Listing Rule 6.1.77, the 
information required to be disclosed can be found in 
the following locations:
Section
Topic
Location
(1)
Interest capitalised
Not applicable
(2)
Publication 
of unaudited 
financial 
information
Supplementary 
information
(3)
Details of small 
related party 
transactions
Note 34 to the financial 
statements
(4)
Details of long-
term incentive 
schemes
Remuneration 
Committee Report
(5) – (14)
Section 5 - 14 of 
Listing Rule 6.1.77
Not applicable
Cross References
All information cross-referenced in this report  
forms part of the Report of the Directors.
Signed on behalf of the Board:
Tom Moran	
Edmond Scanlon 
Chairman	
Chief Executive Officer 
17 February 2025	
17 February 2025
68
Directors’ Report Report of the Directors
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Board Role and Operations
The Board currently comprises 13 members: a non-
Executive Chairman, Chief Executive Officer, Chief 
Financial Officer, one other Executive Director and 
nine non-Executive Directors. 
The Directors are of the opinion that the 
composition of the Board provides the extensive, 
relevant business experience needed to oversee 
the effective operation of the Group’s activities 
and that the individual Directors bring a range of 
skills, knowledge and experience including financial 
as well as industry, scientific and international 
experience necessary to provide effective 
governance and oversight of the Group.
Information Flow
The Chairman ensures that all Directors have full 
and timely access to the information they require to 
discharge their responsibilities fully and effectively. 
Board papers are issued to each Director at least 
one week in advance of Board meetings and include 
the meeting agenda, minutes of the previous Board 
meeting and all papers relevant to the agenda.
The Chairman, in conjunction with the Company 
Secretary, has primary responsibility for setting the 
agenda for each meeting. All Directors continually 
receive comprehensive reports and documentation 
on all matters for which they have responsibility to 
enable them to fulfil their duties as a Director. All 
Directors participate in and contribute to discussions 
relating to strategy, trading updates, financial 
performance, significant risks and operational 
activities, in addition to discussions on the Group’s 
purpose, vision, values and culture.
Board meetings are of sufficient duration to ensure 
that all agenda items and any other material 
non-agenda items that may arise are adequately 
addressed. In addition to formal meetings, the 
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer maintain 
regular contact with all Directors. The Chairman also 
holds informal meetings and calls with non-Executive 
Directors without the Executive Directors present to 
discuss issues affecting the Group.
All Directors have access to the advice and services 
of the Company Secretary, who is responsible 
for advising the Board on governance matters. 
In accordance with an agreed procedure, in the 
furtherance of their duties, each Director has the 
authority to engage independent professional advice 
at the Company’s expense.
Board Leadership and Company Purpose
Kerry Group Governance Framework
Kerry Group has a clear Governance Framework with defined responsibilities and accountabilities as outlined 
in the diagram below. This Governance Framework is designed to safeguard long-term shareholder value and 
ensure that the Group contributes to wider society.
BOARD COMMITTEES
The Board has four Committees, the Audit 
Committee, the Governance and Nomination 
Committee, the Sustainability Committee and 
the Remuneration Committee, which support 
the operation of the Board through their 
focus on specific areas of governance.
Each Committee is governed by its Terms of 
Reference, available from the Group’s website 
kerry.com or upon request, which sets out 
how it should operate including its role, 
membership, authority and duties.
EXECUTIVE MANAGEMENT
The Executive Directors, led by the CEO, 
are responsible for executing strategy 
and for the day-to-day management of 
the business. The Executive Directors 
and other senior executives provide 
updates at Board meetings, and maintain 
a regular dialogue with the Board to 
facilitate support and challenge.
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
The Board’s role is to promote the 
long-term sustainable success of the 
Company, generating value for all its 
stakeholders, including shareholders, 
employees, customers, suppliers and the 
communities in which it operates, while 
developing and monitoring strategy, 
and ensuring that the risks that face the 
organisation are appropriately managed. 
It is also responsible for embedding 
the Company’s purpose, instilling the 
appropriate values and behaviours and 
monitoring and assessing culture across 
the organisation.
EXECUTIVE MANAGEMENT FORUMS
The Executive Management Forums 
support the governance framework on 
specific projects as and when required. 
Risk Oversight 
Committee
Read more on 
page 47
Business 
Integrity 
Committee
Read more on 
pages 80 & 92
Sustainability 
Executive 
Committee
Read more on 
pages 133-134
Remuneration 
Committee
Read more on 
page 98
Audit Committee
Read more on 
page 85
Sustainability 
Committee
Read more on 
page 96
Governance & 
Nomination 
Committee
Read more on 
page 91
Finance 
Committee
Read more on 
page 33
Schedule of Matters Reserved 
for the Board
•	 Appointments to the Board;
•	 Ensuring compliance with corporate 
governance, legal, statutory and regulatory 
requirements;
•	 Approval of the overall Group strategic and 
operating plans;
•	 Monitoring and reviewing risk management 
and internal control systems;
•	 Monitoring and assessing culture;
•	 Reviewing and assessing the adequacy of the 
Group’s whistleblowing arrangements;
•	 Monitoring implementation of the Group’s 
Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy;
•	 Approval of acquisitions and divestitures;
•	 Approval of significant capital expenditure;
•	 Approval of Treasury policy including 
changes to the Group’s capital structure;
•	 Approval of dividend policy and dividends;
•	 Approval of annual budgets;
•	 Approval of preliminary results, interim 
management statements and interim 
financial statements;
•	 Assessment of the long-term viability of the 
Group and the going concern assumption; 
and
•	 The preparation of, and confirmation that 
the annual report, financial statements 
and sustainability statement present a fair, 
balanced and understandable assessment 
of the Company’s position, performance 
and prospects.
71
70
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
The Board monitors and assesses the culture of the 
Group through a number of mechanisms including 
compliance with Group policies, internal audit, formal 
and informal channels for employees wishing to 
raise concerns, including leader pulse checks, town 
halls, the OurVoice employee experience survey, the 
Group’s Speak Up arrangements and feedback from 
the designated Workforce Engagement Director. 
Following the assessments completed during the year, 
in recognition of the critical role our frontline workers 
play in helping Kerry to reach 1.36bn people with 
positive and balanced nutrition, the Board approved 
a special recognition award of an additional day of 
paid annual leave to our 12,000 frontline operators 
across our 124 manufacturing sites worldwide. In 
approving the award, the Board was mindful of how 
the behaviours of the frontline operators exemplified 
the Group values which underpin our culture. The 
Board also determined that the enhanced Speak Up 
procedures and channel, introduced in 2021 continue 
to operate effectively.
Board Activities
The Board’s activities during the year included the 
items set out below:
Strategy
•	 monitored progress against the Group’s strategic 
plan and approved the inclusion of additional 
medium-term financial targets post the sale of the 
Dairy Ireland business;
•	 provided input to and approved the content for the 
investor day held in October;
•	 reviewed and approved the Group’s digital strategy 
as well as receiving updates on cybersecurity risks 
and on the risks and opportunities associated with 
AI initiatives;
•	 monitored the buildout of the Group’s 
Biotechnology Solutions business as well as the 
enhancement of its Science, Technology and 
Innovation capability and approved the associated 
investment required; 
•	 considered the growth opportunities in 
emerging markets. Approved the associated 
investment required;
•	 reviewed and approved the Group’s strategy relating 
to mergers, acquisitions and divestitures; and
•	 monitored the implementation of the Group’s 
Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy and 
approved the Climate Transition Plan.
Operational/Commercial
•	 following updates from the Executive Directors 
considered the mitigating actions taken to 
counter the impact of subdued consumer demand 
following a number of years of cost inflation;
•	 assessed the appropriateness of the structures, 
processes and controls in place to ensure that 
Kerry operates to the highest standards from a 
food safety as well as an employee health and 
safety perspective following briefings from the 
Chief Operations Officer, the Food Safety and 
Quality and the Employee Health and Safety 
teams;
•	 approved M&A transactions (including the sale of 
the Dairy Ireland business) and considered the 
learnings from completed acquisitions; and
•	 approved significant capital expenditure projects, 
considering impacts on financial and sustainability 
performance criteria.
Financial/Sustainability
•	 at each meeting discussed how the Group was 
navigating through the current challenging 
economic environment following updates from the 
Chief Financial Officer;
•	 monitored the progress against the targets 
included in the Beyond the Horizon sustainability 
strategy and approved the new Scope 3 targets to 
2030;
•	 considered the progress being made under 
the Group’s Accelerate Operational Excellence 
programme;
•	 reviewed Investor Relations activities and share 
price performance;
•	 approved the Group’s Preliminary Results, Annual 
Report and Accounts, Interim Financial Statements 
and Interim Management Statements;
•	 approved the payment of an interim dividend and 
recommended the payment of a final dividend;
•	 approved additional share buyback programmes 
ensuring consistency with the Group’s Capital 
Allocation Framework;
•	 approved the going concern basis of accounting 
and the long-term viability statement; and
•	 approved the Group Budget for the 2025 
financial year including both financial and 
sustainability targets.
Internal Controls and Risk Management
•	 confirmed that a robust assessment of the 
Group’s principal risks and uncertainties, including 
emerging risks, was completed and approved the 
risk appetite for each of the principal risks;
•	 discussed the Group’s internal controls, risks and 
risk management framework following updates 
from the Chairman of the Audit Committee;
•	 received regular reports from business and 
functional leaders on the Group’s key risks; and
•	 considered and confirmed the effectiveness of the 
internal control and risk management framework.
Strategy
The Board collaborated with Executive Management 
in the development of the Group’s updated strategy 
and associated medium-term financial targets. 
During 2024, the Board monitored progress 
implementing the strategies for volume growth, 
margin expansion and return on investment as well 
as the sustainability related goals and targets that 
underpin the strategic plan. The Board also discussed 
and approved the content for the investor day held 
in October as well as the Group’s Climate Transition 
Plan which was published in December.
The Board oversaw and approved the strategic M&A 
transactions completed during the year including the 
sale of the Dairy Ireland business. M&A transactions 
have been a significant factor in recent years as the 
Group evolves its technology portfolio, investing 
in businesses more aligned with the Group’s 
strategic growth priorities and exiting non-strategic 
businesses. As a result of this M&A activity, the Group 
has further strengthened its sustainable nutrition 
capabilities and has better positioned itself for long-
term organic growth.
Presentations were received from internal and external 
experts throughout the year on matters such as 
digital risks and opportunities, evolving geopolitical 
landscape, macroeconomic and emerging markets 
updates, corporate governance developments, the 
general M&A landscape as well as corporate defence 
and shareholder activism. Through these reviews and 
ongoing discussions on strategy, the Board is confident 
that Kerry’s strategic priorities will continue to be the 
key drivers of growth and investment in the future.
The Board ensures that the decisions it makes 
are aligned with the achievement of the Group’s 
strategy, are made in the long-term interest of 
the Group and its stakeholders and are aligned 
with the Group’s sustainability strategy. This is 
particularly the case when deciding how to prioritise 
the allocation of resources (human and financial 
capital) across competing research and development 
activities, acquisition opportunities and major capital 
expenditure projects.
During the year, the Board also reviewed the business 
model and how it is executed. The Board is satisfied 
that the business model is both sustainable in 
the long-term and optimally structured to enable 
delivery of the Group’s strategy. Details of the Group’s 
strategy are outlined in Strategy and Financial 
Targets on pages 12-25.
Purpose, Values and Culture
Our purpose, Inspiring Food, Nourishing Life 
underpins our culture and is reflected in our values.
The Group’s purpose is guided by the Group’s Vision 
to be our customers’ most valued partner, creating a 
world of sustainable nutrition. The Board is satisfied 
that the current strategy is aligned to the Group’s 
purpose which is also guided by our values of 
Courage, Enterprising Spirit, Inclusiveness, Open-
mindedness and Ownership. The Board is led by the 
Group’s purpose during its discussions and when 
making decisions on the matters that are reserved 
for its consideration. Our purpose of Inspiring Food, 
Nourishing Life guided our actions as we approved the 
sale of the Dairy Ireland Business further focusing 
our portfolio and capabilities behind our taste and 
sustainable nutrition ambitions. The Group’s values, 
and in particular the values of Courage, Ownership 
and Open-mindedness guided our capital allocation 
decisions including the execution of a number of 
share buyback programmes during the year. Further 
details of the Group’s purpose and values are 
outlined on pages 14-17.
The Group’s culture is based on a common 
understanding of our values, underpinned by our 
practices of Safety First, Quality Always and a robust 
risk management framework consisting of policies 
and procedures, including a Code of Conduct which 
defines business conduct standards for anyone 
working for, or on behalf of the Group. The Board 
is satisfied that the Group’s purpose, values and 
strategy are aligned to the Group’s culture.
The Board recognises the importance of its role in 
setting the tone for Kerry’s culture and embedding 
it across the Group. In addition to the Board, the 
Executive Team has responsibility to ensure that 
the policies and behaviours set at Board level 
are effectively communicated and implemented 
throughout the Group. The Group’s Code of Conduct 
aligns with the Group’s purpose and values and the 
MyKerry internal website provides a platform for 
employees to access the Group’s policies.
73
72
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
SHAREHOLDERS
Why We Engage
•	 Active engagement with shareholders ensures 
continuous awareness of the Group’s business 
environment, strategy, business model, 
performance and sustainability commitments.
•	 Shareholder input informs the strategic 
decision making of the Board.
How We Engage
The Investor Relations team and Executive 
Directors maintain ongoing engagement with 
the investment community, through a variety	
of different mediums including:
•	 Ongoing engagement with shareholders 
through physical meetings, virtual meetings 
and calls on a daily basis outside of closed 
periods;
•	 Hosting investor events with members of the 
broader Kerry team to give investors a deeper 
understanding of Kerry’s business;
•	 Direct engagement with the Chief Executive 
Officer and Chief Financial Officer through 
presentation of the Group’s full year, half year 
and interim management statements;
•	 Publication of results releases, presentations, 
share price information and news releases 
which are accessible to all shareholders on the 
Group’s website kerry.com; and
•	 The Company’s Annual General Meeting (AGM) 
provides an opportunity for the Directors to 
deliver presentations and to answer questions 
from shareholders, both institutional and private.
What we believe matters 
most to Shareholders
•	 Strategic updates and progress on the 
execution of the Group’s strategic plan.
•	 Group performance and outlook including 
share price performance, marketplace 
dynamics and industry developments.
•	 Capital allocation framework, particularly in 
light of higher interest rates.
•	 Progress against the sustainability strategy and 
ESG matters.
Our Actions and Their Impact
•	 The Group has continued to execute its strategic 
plan. Actions included the move to be a pure-play 
taste and nutrition company with Board approval 
of the sale of the Dairy Ireland business.
•	 Members of the Board attended a number of 
investor engagements, including the AGM, the 
EGM relating to the Kerry Dairy Ireland sale and 
an investor day held in Beloit in October. This 
event included an update on performance and 
strategic priorities of the Group. More details of 
this event are available on our website.
•	 The Chairman engaged with various institutional 
shareholders across the year to discuss 
governance related matters. When necessary 
the Committee Chairs engage with shareholders 
on specific topics. Arising from the matters 
discussed feedback is provided to the Directors 
to inform decision making.
•	 In line with the Group’s capital allocation 
framework, the Board has continued to invest 
funds in the best interest of the shareholders 
which included the continuation of the share 
buyback programme that commenced in 
late 2023, ran through 2024 and continues 
into 2025. Investors noted they appreciated 
the clarity provided around Kerry’s capital 
allocation framework and its decision making 
on share buybacks based on prevailing 
market conditions.
Governance and Stakeholders
•	 considered updates received from the Chairman of 
the Governance and Nomination Committee on its 
activities;
•	 approved the appointment of a new Senior 
Independent Director and a new Designated 
Workforce Engagement Director;
•	 approved the appointment of Ms. Liz Hewitt as a 
non-Executive Director;
•	 approved changes to the composition of Board 
Committees;
•	 conducted an internal self-assessment Board 
evaluation and considered its outcome;
•	 considered compliance with the 2018 UK 
Corporate Governance Code and the Irish 
Corporate Governance Annex, as well as 
the implications of the 2024 UK Corporate 
Governance Code and the new Irish Corporate 
Governance Code both of which are effective 
from 1 January 2025; 
•	 confirmed that appropriate arrangements 
and structures are in place to ensure material 
compliance with the relevant obligations under 
Section 225 of the Companies Act 2014;
•	 confirmed that appropriate structures are in 
place for the proportionate and independent 
investigation and follow-up of matters 
raised through the Group’s whistleblowing 
arrangements; and
•	 participated in training on a range of corporate 
governance and regulatory matters from  
external advisors.
People and Culture
•	 considered updates received from the Chairperson 
of the Remuneration Committee on its activities;
•	 approved the changes to the new Remuneration 
Policy which was put to an advisory vote at the 
2024 AGM; 
•	 approved the rollout of the All Employee Share 
Plan (which was adopted by shareholders at the 
2023 AGM) to a further 16 countries;
•	 received and considered reports from the 
designated Workforce Engagement Director on 
her activities during the year. Details are outlined 
in Governance in Action on page 79;
•	 assessed talent and succession planning activities 
following presentations from the Chief Executive 
Officer and the Chief Human Resources Officer;
•	 reviewed the actions taken to support lower-paid 
employees following a number of years of cost 
inflation; and
•	 monitored and assessed the culture of the Group 
to ensure it promotes integrity and openness, 
is aligned with strategy and is responsive to the 
views of shareholders and wider stakeholders.
Stakeholder Engagement
The Board acknowledges the importance of considering the interests of all stakeholders in their 
discussions and decision making. Enhanced engagement with stakeholders enables better, 
informed decision making, thereby increasing the likelihood of long-term sustainable success for 
the Group. The Board also recognises the need to maintain high standards of business conduct in 
its actions and decisions. Details of our stakeholder engagement are set out below.
2018 UK Corporate Governance Code 
and the Irish Corporate Governance 
Annex – Compliance Statement
Kerry applied the main Principles of the 2018 
UK Corporate Governance Code and the Irish 
Corporate Governance Annex (together the 
“Code”) and complied with all the Provisions 
throughout FY24, with the exception of:
– Provision 19 (Chair tenure). Mr. Tom Moran was 
appointed as Chairman in 2022 after having 
served just over six years as a non-Executive 
Director. Mr. Moran will, subject to shareholder 
approval, continue as Chairman until the AGM 
in 2026 and will have served over ten years by 
this time. Provision 19 requires the Chair to 
serve no longer than nine years and therefore 
for the period from September 2024 to May 
2026, Kerry will not be compliant with this 
provision. However, the Provision also notes 
that to facilitate effective succession planning 
this period can be extended, particularly 
where the Chair was an existing non-Executive 
Director on appointment. In 2023, having 
conducted a rigorous review, the Governance 
& Nomination Committee and the Board 
agreed, subject to shareholder approval, that 
Mr. Moran should continue as Chairman until 
the AGM in 2026 to allow appropriate time 
for the new SID to identify a successor and to 
enable an orderly transition to the role. The 
Committee also noted the need for stability 
given the high level of Board refreshment 
that occurred in 2023 and the additional 
appointments/ retirements that would occur 
in 2024. Mr. Moran’s re-election to the Board 
was strongly supported by shareholders at the 
2024 AGM. A Chair succession committee is 
undertaking a formal succession process which 
is being led by Mr. Christopher Rogers in his 
role as Senior Independent Director.
The Board recognises the importance of good 
corporate governance in providing confidence 
in our ability to deliver our strategic goals and 
also, in building trust with our key stakeholders, 
both of which are essential for the long-term 
sustainable success of the Group. The table 
below outlines the main Principles of the Code 
and where in the Annual Report there is further 
information on the application of the Principles. 
Main Principles	
Pages
Board leadership	
	
70-73 
and company purpose	
Division of 	
 58-61 & 80 
responsibilities	
 
Composition, succession	
82-83 & 
and evaluation	
 91-95
Audit, risk and internal control	
83-90
Remuneration	
98-125
75
74
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
CUSTOMERS AND CONSUMERS
Why We Engage
•	 Our commitment to strong engagement with 
customers and consumers is at the heart of 
our business. This engagement is driven by 
a customer-centric business model, which is 
crucial in achieving our vision of becoming our 
customers’ most valued partner, creating a 
world of sustainable nutrition.
How We Engage
•	 Kerry has a community of experts to engage 
with customers directly through dedicated 
engagement sessions to enhance their 
experience and build strong partnerships.
•	 Digital plays a key role to enhance the 
customer experience and how we engage 
and communicate through multiple different 
channels. A digital platform has been developed 
to enhance our customer experience and 
support speed to market for example offering 
direct access to product documentation, sample 
requests and order visibility.
•	 Kerry actively participates in industry 
conferences to engage with customers, share 
insights and showcase how Kerry is leading the 
future of sustainable nutrition.
•	 Kerry conducts an annual Voice of Customer 
survey to listen and gather feedback so that 
we identify areas of improvements for our 
customers.
•	 Market Research teams analyse consumer 
behaviours, attitudes, emerging trends and 
combine cutting-edge technology with our 
expertise in taste and nutrition to deliver holistic 
insights to empower our customers to seize 
opportunities, and lead in sustainable nutrition.
•	 The Kerry Health and Nutrition Institute® 
established 10 years ago offers scientific 
expertise to address challenges in the food, 
beverage and pharma sector.
What we believe matters most to 
Customers and Consumers
•	 Evolving consumer dynamics and market 
changes drive ongoing customer engagement 
and demand for innovative, sustainable 
nutrition solutions.
•	 Customers seek products that enhance health 
and wellbeing while addressing sustainability, 
environmental criteria and nutrition.
•	 Challenges include managing inflation, 
global supply chain issues, shifting consumer 
preferences, and regulatory changes related to 
sustainable nutrition.
•	 Insights from the double materiality 
assessment highlight customer priorities 
around reducing environmental impact, 
particularly concerning climate change and 
food waste.
Our Actions and Their Impact
•	 Customer feedback from engagement activities 
is reviewed and discussed at Board meetings, 
influencing decision-making.
•	 The Board approved €310m for research and 
development to focus on projects meeting 
customer needs, supporting revenue growth 
and sustainability. 
•	 Investments in the digital strategy and 
supply chain initiatives aim to enhance 
customer experience through improved 
information sharing and service levels. The 
Board approved continued investment into a 
global customer care portal which empowers 
customer care to be more proactive and 
responsive to deliver customer service 
excellence. This has enabled faster response 
times to customers. These investments have 
led to improved fulfilment reliability and 
increased Net Promoter Scores (NPS).
•	 In 2024, the Board approved acquisitions totalling 
€167m and gross capital expenditure of €330m, 
aligned with the Group’s strategic priorities.
•	 The Board received regular updates on the 
sale of the Dairy Ireland business and was 
satisfied that the transfer of the customer base 
would be completed smoothly and successfully 
without any adverse impact on the rest of the 
Group’s customers.
•	 The Group’s sustainability strategy, the 
execution of which is overseen by the Board 
through the Sustainability Committee, 
is funded and integrated into its value 
proposition, with further details available in the 
Sustainability Review, Sustainability Statement 
and other documents on the Group’s website. 
EMPLOYEES
Why We Engage
•	 Consistently connecting with employees is 
crucial for attracting, nurturing, and retaining 
a skilled, committed, inspired and diverse 
workforce.
How We Engage
•	 Ms. Emer Gilvarry, the designated Workforce 
Engagement Director, directly interacted with 
employees through a variety of channels, 
including participation in Kerry employee 
events and site visits. Details of these activities 
are outlined on page 79.
•	 Routine two-way dialogue with our 21,000+ 
employees through regular CEO townhalls and 
career discussions.
•	 Regular employee experience survey, OurVoice, 
assesses employee engagement along with 
feedback on other employee experience 
measures including Safety, Reward, Talent 
Development and Manager Effectiveness.
•	 Direct engagement through visits to offices, 
production and supply chain sites during  
the year. 
•	 Kerry’s Speak Up channel enables employees 
and other stakeholders to report concerns 
confidentially and safely.
•	 Our Health and Wellbeing framework is 
underpinned by a balanced set of programmes 
accessible to our employees across our 
four wellbeing pillars: emotional, physical, 
nutritional and financial.
What we believe matters 
most to Employees
•	 Diversity, Inclusion and Belonging (DI&B) and 
understanding how employees’ roles contribute 
to the Group’s success, helping to make Kerry a 
better place to work for employees at all levels.
Our Actions and Their Impact
•	 Ms. Emer Gilvarry, as Workforce Engagement 
Director, visited a number of sites to gather 
employee feedback on onboarding and share 
insights with the Board on engagement 
initiatives.
•	 In approving the sale of the Dairy Ireland 
business, the Board considered the 
consequences for the 1,599 employees who 
work in that business and ensured that 
appropriate actions were taken to mitigate the 
impact on the employees involved.
•	 The Board received updates on employee 
health, safety, and wellbeing, reinforcing and 
fostering a proactive safety culture through our 
Health and Safety committees at a plant level.
•	 In line with our Safety First, Quality Always 
ethos, the Board ensured that the existing 
structures. processes and controls were 
appropriate to reinforce a culture of safety at 
work particularly given the loss of a colleague to 
a workplace fatality during the year. The Board 
monitored the level of workplace incidents 
that occurred in 2024 and noted that the Total 
Incident Rate at 4.5 (based on 1 million hours, as 
required for CSRD reporting) has improved year 
on year. 
•	 Diversity, Inclusion and Belonging (DI&B) remain 
priorities with the Board monitoring gender 
representation and pay equity and taking 
corrective actions if required.
•	 The Board allocated resources for training, 
internal communications, and initiatives to 
streamline operations and improve the health 
and wellbeing of employees. 
•	 Further details on employee engagement 
activities can be found in the Sustainability 
Review, the Sustainability Statement and on the 
Group’s website.
77
76
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
COMMUNITY
Why We Engage
•	 By fostering strong relationships with the 
communities in which we operate, we can help 
support livelihoods and create a better society 
whilst protecting the environment.
How We Engage
•	 Kerry partners with community groups, charities, 
and NGOs across all its operating regions.
•	 Engage selected organisations to participate in 
Kerry’s double materiality assessment, sharing 
insights on social and environmental issues.
•	 The MyCommunity programme enables Kerry 
to support a range of community projects.
•	 Kerry encourages employees to engage in local 
initiatives by providing paid volunteer hours.
What we believe matters most to 
Community
•	 Outputs include employment and local 
economic development, social inclusion, access 
to nutrition, food security and sustainable 
food production, as well as the opportunity 
for organisations like Kerry to play a lead role 
in environmental protection and community 
support.
Our Actions and Their Impact
•	 The Board ensures that local community 
engagement is integrated into Kerry’s overall 
sustainability strategy.
•	 As a sustainable nutrition leader, the Board 
commits to a sustainable supply chain that 
supports balanced nutrition for over a billion 
consumers while protecting people and the 
environment.
•	 Priority is given to capital expenditure projects 
that benefit the environment.
•	 During 2024, the Board approved the 2024 
MyCommunity programme. More detail on all 
of our charitable activities are available under 
Kerry Community Initiatives on our website 
kerry.com.
SUPPLIERS
Why We Engage
•	 By engaging with suppliers, we can ensure 
they continue to meet Kerry’s high standards 
in product safety, quality, and business 
ethics, while respecting human rights and the 
environment.
How We Engage
•	 Kerry engages with suppliers daily through 
the procurement and supply chain functions, 
two-way communication, meetings, multi- 
stakeholder collaborations and industry events.
•	 Suppliers can report concerns via the Group’s 
Speak Up whistleblowing channel.
•	 Engage selected suppliers to contribute 
insights on sustainability for the Group’s double 
materiality assessment.
•	 A risk-based approach is used for supplier 
assessments to maintain safety, quality, and 
responsible sourcing.
•	 The Board receives updates on supply chain 
quality and supplier interests from key 
executives.
What we believe matters 
most to Suppliers
•	 Key topics for suppliers included human rights, 
quality and food safety, service levels, business 
continuity, capacity, cost, innovation and 
responsible sourcing requirements.
Our Actions and Their Impact
•	 The Board ensures that long-term, sustainable 
relationships are established with key suppliers 
under mutually agreed terms.
•	 Through the Beyond the Horizon sustainability 
strategy, the Board ensures suppliers meet 
safety, quality, and fair treatment standards.
•	 The Board reviewed and approved the Climate 
Transition Plan including the Group’s new Scope 3 
targets which has been submitted to the Science 
Based Target initiative (SBTI) for approval. 
•	 In 2024, training was provided to suppliers 
in China and India to enhance awareness of 
human rights standards and build compliance 
capacity.
•	 The Board reviewed the progress on ongoing 
supplier compliance with the Group’s Supplier 
Code of Conduct.
•	 More details on the responsible sourcing 
strategy are available in the Sustainability 
Review on page 43.
Governance in Action
Designated Workforce Engagement Director – 
Activities in 2024
The role of Workforce Engagement Director 
transitioned to Ms. Emer Gilvarry in May 2024. 
Since commencing her appointment, Ms. Gilvarry 
regularly met with the Chief Human Resources 
Officer and the Group Human Resources Team. 
She provided updates to the Board about her 
activities and the feedback from employees. She 
contributed an employee perspective during all 
Board discussions and when the Board made 
decisions, including the decision to dispose of the 
Dairy Ireland business. 
Ms. Gilvarry has engaged with a number of 
groups across Kerry as part of a defined 2024 
engagement plan. The engagement plan was 
focused around three objectives:
1.	 Obtain a broad understanding of workforce 
engagement across Kerry;
2.	 Leverage established forums/events to better 
understand employee sentiment; and
3.	 Represent the Board at various employee 
events.
To achieve these objectives, Ms. Gilvarry attended 
several Kerry employee events and toured various 
manufacturing plants as outlined below:
•	 Meetings with each of the regional leadership 
teams to receive an overview of the regions’ 
approach to workforce engagement and 
priorities for 2024/2025;
•	 Attending a variety of events, including:
	» The Global Commercial Conference, 
where  senior commercial leaders were 
in attendance from all regions and 
technologies;
	» The Women in Leadership Europe 
graduation, celebrating the 2024 
cohort’s completion of the Women in 
Leadership development programme and 
understanding learnings they have taken 
away from the experience; and
	» Team Townhalls, e.g. the APMEA region 
Townhalls and team conferences including 
Internal Audit and Global HR team 
conferences. 
•	 Site visits to meet our front line workers 
and understanding associated workforce 
engagement priorities; and
•	 Meeting with Kerry’s HR team responsible for 
employee experience surveys to gain insight 
into Kerry’s progress in this area and to 
pinpoint key focus areas following the OurVoice 
experience survey completed in 2024.
In 2025, Ms. Gilvarry will continue to engage with 
different groups across the organisation so that 
she can accurately share employee sentiment and 
represent their interests at Board meetings.
Global Priorities for Employee Engagement in 
2024
This year, we made tangible progress in our three 
engagement pillars: Making it Better, Making it 
Clearer, and Making it Easier at Kerry. In April 
2024, we conducted a company-wide OurVoice 
employee experience survey, achieving a 93% 
response rate with over 18,000 participants, 
leading to a significant improvement in 
employee engagement.
Following the survey, we have created company-
wide engagement action plans to build on our 
key strengths (which include our commitment to 
a Safety First, Quality Always culture; a workplace 
where everyone can feel valued and included 
and where our managers create an inclusive and 
collaborative environment) and also to focus 
on areas where we can unlock our full potential 
(including simplifying our processes to enable 
sharper decision making, continuing to develop 
our people to thrive at Kerry and to continue to 
share a compelling vision for the future).
Annual General Meeting
All Directors attend the AGM and are available to 
meet with shareholders and answer questions as 
required. Notice of the AGM, Form of Proxy and the 
Annual Report and financial statements are sent to 
shareholders at least 20 working days before the 
meeting. A separate resolution is proposed at the 
AGM on each substantially separate matter including 
a particular resolution relating to the adoption of 
the Directors and Auditors reports and the financial 
statements. Details of the proxy votes received for 
and against each resolution, together with details 
of votes withheld are announced after the result of 
the votes by hand. These details are published on 
the Group’s website following the conclusion of the 
AGM. At the AGM held on 2 May 2024, there were no 
material votes cast against any resolutions.
In addition to the AGM, an Extraordinary General 
Meeting was held in December 2024 at which 
shareholders overwhelmingly supported the sale of 
the Dairy Ireland business.
79
78
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Whistleblowing Arrangement
The Group’s whistleblowing arrangement includes 
an externally facilitated multi-lingual reporting 
service Speak Up through which all employees and 
third parties can raise concerns in confidence about 
possible wrong doings in financial reporting and 
other matters. These facilities are available 24 hours 
a day by phone or online.
All whistleblowing incidents are reviewed by the 
Business Integrity Committee as well as by the 
Legal and Ethical Compliance team and formally 
investigated by the relevant functional heads 
depending on the nature of the concern raised.
In 2024, the Audit Committee reviewed the 
whistleblowing incidents and outcomes and provided 
updates to the Board which enabled it to assess the 
adequacy of the whistleblowing arrangements and 
to review the reports arising from its operation. The 
Board is satisfied that the Group’s whistleblowing 
arrangements are operating effectively.
Division of Responsibilities
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
The roles of the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer 
are separate and the division of duties between 
them is formally established, set out in writing and 
agreed by the Board. The Chairman is responsible 
for leadership of the Board and ensuring its 
effectiveness in all respects. The Executive Directors, 
led by the Chief Executive Officer, are responsible for 
the management of the Group’s business and the 
implementation of Group strategy and policy.
Senior Independent Director
The principal role of the Senior Independent Director 
(SID) is to provide a sounding board for the Chairman 
and to act as an intermediary for other Directors as 
required. The SID is responsible for the appraisal of 
the Chairman’s performance throughout the year.
The SID is also responsible for leading a formal 
succession process for the role of Chairman. The SID 
is available to meet shareholders upon request, in 
particular if they have concerns that cannot be resolved 
through the Chairman or the Chief Executive Officer.
Non-Executive Directors
The non-Executive Directors’ main responsibilities 
are to review the performance of management and 
the Group’s financial information, assist in strategy 
development, provide constructive challenge in 
Board discussions and ensure that appropriate 
and effective systems of internal control and risk 
management are in place. The non-Executive 
Directors review the relationship with external 
auditors through the Audit Committee and monitor 
the remuneration structures and policy through the 
Remuneration Committee.
Company Secretary
Each Director has access to the advice and services 
of the Company Secretary, whose responsibilities 
include ensuring that Board procedures are followed, 
assisting the Chairman in relation to corporate 
governance matters, ensuring the Company 
complies with its legal and regulatory obligations and 
facilitating appropriate information flows between 
the business and the Board.
Commitments
Under the terms of their appointment all Directors 
agreed to the time commitment schedule which 
requires them to allocate sufficient time to discharge 
their responsibilities effectively. This matter is 
considered by the Governance and Nomination 
Committee on an ongoing basis in accordance with 
its Terms of Reference. 
All Directors must seek prior approval of the Board 
in advance of undertaking any additional external 
appointments. Before approving any additional 
external appointment, the Board considers the time 
commitment required for the role. Each proposed 
external appointment is reviewed independently.
Independence
The Board, as a whole, has assessed the non- 
Executive Directors independence and confirmed 
that, in its opinion, all non-Executive Directors are 
independent in judgement and character.
Dr. Hugh Brady and Dr. Karin Dorrepaal had served in 
excess of nine years as Directors before they retired 
from the Board at the conclusion of the AGM held in 
May 2024. Having conducted a rigorous review, the 
Board was satisfied that Dr. Brady and Dr. Dorrepaal, 
given their personal attributes and the challenges they 
bring to Board discussions, continued to apply objective 
and independent judgement to act in the best interest 
of the Company up to the date of their retirement.
As disclosed in note 34 to the Financial Statements, 
Mr. Patrick Rohan, in the ordinary course of business 
as a farmer, traded on standard commercial terms 
with the Group’s Dairy Ireland business. Given the 
small quantum involved, the fact that all trading is on 
standard commercial terms and Mr. Rohan’s personal 
attributes, the Board, having conducted a rigorous 
review, is satisfied that Mr. Rohan applies objective 
and independent judgement to act in the best 
interest of the Company.
Conflicts of Interest
Under the terms of their appointment all Directors 
have continuing obligations to update the Chairman 
as soon as they become aware of a situation that 
could give rise to a conflict or a potential conflict of 
interest.
A total of 11 Board meetings were held in 2024. Individual attendance at the Board and Committee meetings is 
set out in the following table:
Directors
Board
Audit 
Committee
Governance and 
Nomination 
Committee
Sustainability 
Committee
Remuneration 
Committee
Tom Moran
11/11
4/4
Edmond Scanlon1
11/11
Marguerite Larkin1
11/11
Gerry Behan1
11/11
Genevieve Berger
11/11
3/3
Hugh Brady2
3/3
3/3
2/2
Fiona Dawson
11/11
4/4
5/5
5/5
Karin Dorrepaal2
3/3
2/2
2/2
3/3
Emer Gilvarry3
10/11
3/3
2/2
5/5
Catherine Godson
11/11
3/3
Liz Hewitt4,5
10/10
3/4
Michael Kerr
11/11
7/7
4/4
2/2
Christopher Rogers5
11/11
7/7
2/2
1/2
5/5
Patrick Rohan
11/11
5/5
Jinlong Wang
11/11
7/7
1  Executive Directors
2  Hugh Brady and Karin Dorrepaal retired on 2 May 2024
3  Emer Gilvarry was unable to attend one Board meeting due to a diary conflict
4  Liz Hewitt was appointed on 1 March 2024
5  Liz Hewitt and Christopher Rogers missed one Committee meeting each due to diary conflicts
Attendance statistics represent: Total number of meetings attended by the Director/Total number of meetings 
held during the year which they were eligible to attend.
Meetings and Attendance
The Board meets regularly to ensure that all its duties are discharged effectively. All Directors are expected to 
prepare for and attend meetings of the Board, the Committees of which they are members and the AGM.
In the event that a Board member cannot attend or participate in the meeting, the Director may discuss and 
share opinions on agenda items with the Chairman, Chief Executive Officer, Senior Independent Director or 
Company Secretary in advance of the meeting.
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
81
80
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Composition, Succession and 
Evaluation
Board Induction and Development
On appointment to the Board, each new non-
Executive Director undergoes a full formal induction 
programme organised by the Chairman and 
supported by the Company Secretary. The purpose 
of the induction programme is to enable new 
Directors to gain a full understanding of the Group, 
governance-related matters and Directors’ duties 
and responsibilities. The induction programme 
includes presentations on the Group’s operations and 
results, meetings with Executive Management and an 
outline of the principal risks and uncertainties facing 
the Group. Details of the induction programme 
undertaken by Prof. Catherine Godson and  
Dr. Genevieve Berger are included below:
Governance in Action (Example):
New Director Induction
Prof. Catherine Godson and Dr. Genevieve 
Berger were appointed to the Board on 1 
November 2023. Following their appointment, 
Prof. Godson and Dr. Berger underwent a 
formal induction programme which was 
tailored to their individual requirements and 
included the following induction activities.
Induction Activities
•	 provision of a detailed information pack 
including key corporate governance 
policies, Board papers, financial and 
strategic documents and information on 
directors’ duties and responsibilities;
•	 meetings with the Executive Directors;
•	 meetings with the Chairman, the Senior 
Independent Director, Remuneration 
Committee Chairperson, Sustainability 
Committee Chairperson and the Audit 
Committee Chairman;
•	 meetings with functional leaders on matters 
such as Board and corporate governance, 
internal audit, strategy, investor relations, 
human resources and sustainability; 
•	 meetings with business leaders of the Taste 
& Nutrition and the Dairy Ireland businesses 
to obtain an overview of each business; 
•	 completed sustainability related training; 
and 
•	 site visits to see first-hand the Group’s 
operations while engaging with employees 
and senior management.
Ms. Liz Hewitt, who was appointed to the Board 
during 2024, also completed a full, formal, induction 
programme tailored to her individual needs.
Throughout the year, the Board engages in 
development through a series of consultations with 
subject matter experts on a range of topics including 
corporate governance and strategy. Presentations 
are also made by Executive Directors and senior 
management on various topics in relation to their 
areas of responsibility.
On an annual basis, an off-site Board meeting is 
scheduled at a Group location and is combined with 
a comprehensive schedule of activities over a week- 
long period, to enable non-Executive Directors to 
further develop their understanding of the Group’s 
activities and to meet with local senior management 
and emerging talent. In June 2024, the off-site Board 
meeting took place in the Netherlands. During the 
visit the Board had the opportunity to meet and 
engage with the European Leadership team and 
emerging talent in both formal and informal settings.
The Board received presentations on the dynamics 
and priorities of the European market and 
participated in a customer immersion experience 
which showcased the Group’s capabilities in helping 
customers to solve industry challenges with 
differentiated solutions.
As part of their personal development plans, 
individual non-Executive Directors are also afforded 
the opportunity to visit a number of the Group’s 
international facilities and operations. Individual 
Board members training requirements are reviewed 
with the Chairman and Company Secretary and 
training is provided to address these needs.
Board Performance Evaluation
In accordance with provisions of the Code, a 
performance evaluation of the Board is carried 
out annually and facilitated externally every third 
year. In 2024, the Board conducted an internal self- 
evaluation of the performance of the Board, Board 
Committees, the Chairman and Individual Directors 
against a set of pre-defined key criteria. The review 
was led by the Chairman of the Board and the Senior 
Independent Director and was facilitated by the 
Company Secretary. The review was undertaken 
using Thinking Board, Independent Audit Limited’s 
governance self-assessment process. Independent 
Audit Limited, based in the UK, is recognised as a 
leading firm of board reviewers, and has no other 
connections to the Group.
Topics covered during the Board Performance 
Evaluation included development and 
implementation of strategy, Board composition, 
succession planning at Board and senior 
management level, financial oversight, risk 
management, people and culture, Board meetings 
and papers, Board training, Committee performance 
and stakeholder engagement.
The Chairman met each of the non-Executive 
Directors individually and appraised their 
performance. The key areas reviewed were 
independence, contribution and attendance at Board 
meetings, interaction with Executive Directors and 
other non-Executive Directors, the Company Secretary 
and senior management, ability to communicate 
issues of importance and concern, their knowledge 
and effectiveness at meetings and the overall time and 
commitment to their role on the Board.
In addition, the Senior Independent Director 
formally appraised the performance of the 
Chairman. This appraisal was similar to the non- 
Executive Director evaluation process and included 
feedback from all Directors on the Chairman’s 
performance during the year.
During the year, the non-Executive Directors met 
without the presence of the Executive Directors and 
led by the Chairman, undertook a formal review of 
the performance of each Executive Director.
Overall, the Board concluded that the outcomes 
of the evaluation process have been positive and 
have confirmed to the Chairman that the Board and 
its Committees operate effectively and that each 
Director contributes to the overall effectiveness 
and success of the Group. The actions identified 
from the 2024 performance evaluation included 
recommendations relating to strategy formulation,  
Board and executive succession planning, Board 
training and Board meeting management.
Progress against recommendations from the 
previous external evaluation were also considered 
and the Board is satisfied that improvements have 
been made which have enhanced the operation and 
effectiveness of both the Board and its Committees.
The Chairman, along with the Company Secretary, 
will ensure that areas for improvement identified 
from the 2024 evaluation report, and areas for 
consideration arising from the Directors’ appraisal 
where identified, will be considered during 2025.
In line with the requirements of the Code, the next 
externally-facilitated performance evaluation of the 
Board will occur in 2025, three years after the last 
externally facilitated evaluation in 2022.
Audit, Risk and Internal Control
Risk Management and Internal Controls 
The internal control framework in the Group 
encompasses the policies, processes, tasks and 
behaviours, which together facilitate the Group’s 
effective and efficient operation by enabling it 
to respond appropriately to significant business, 
operational, financial, compliance and other risks to 
achieve its business objectives.
The systems which operate in Kerry Group provide 
reasonable, but not absolute, assurance on:
•	 the safeguarding of assets against unauthorised 
use or disposition; and
•	 the maintenance of proper accounting records 
and the reliability of the financial information 
produced.
The Board has delegated certain duties to the Audit 
Committee in relation to the ongoing monitoring 
and review of risk management and internal control 
systems. The work performed by the Audit Committee 
is described in its report on pages 85-90.
Full details of the risk management systems are 
described in the Risk Management Report on pages 
46-56.
The principal risks and uncertainties facing the 
Group, including those that could threaten the 
business model, future performance, solvency or 
liquidity are described on pages 49-54. Emerging 
risks are also identified, analysed and managed 
as part of the same process as the Group’s other 
principal risks as described on page 48. The 
Directors confirm that they have carried out a robust 
assessment of these risks and the actions that are in 
place to mitigate them.
The Directors confirm that they have also 
reviewed the effectiveness of the systems of risk 
management and internal control which operated 
during the period covered by the Sustainability 
Statement and financial statements and up to the 
date of this report. Based on the review performed, 
the Directors concluded that for the year ended 
31 December 2024, the Group’s systems of risk 
management and internal control were effective. 
The procedures adopted comply with the guidance 
contained in Guidance on Risk Management, 
Internal Control and Related Financial and Business 
Reporting as published by the Financial Reporting 
Council in the UK.
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
83
82
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
The Audit Committee supports 
the Board in meeting a number 
of its corporate governance 
responsibilities including oversight 
of the Group’s external reporting, 
reviewing the effectiveness of risk 
management and internal control 
systems and overseeing the external 
and internal audit processes.
Year In Review
As Chairman of the Audit Committee, I am pleased to 
provide an overview of our key activities during the 
year under review which included: 
•	 Overseeing the integrity of financial and 
sustainability reporting and formal announcements 
related to the Group’s performance;
•	 Reviewing and monitoring the effectiveness of 
the Group’s risk management and internal control 
systems including financial, operational and 
compliance controls;
•	 Overseeing, in conjunction with the Sustainability 
Committee, the Group’s readiness for reporting 
under the Corporate Sustainability Reporting 
Directive (CSRD) and the limited assurance process 
undertaken by the external auditor of the new 
Sustainability Statement; 
•	 Overseeing the relationship with the Group’s 
external auditor and preparing for the upcoming 
external audit tender; and
•	 Monitoring, reviewing and assessing the 
effectiveness of the Group Internal Audit function.
The Year Ahead
This year, in addition to delivering on its core 
responsibilities, the Audit Committee will lead the 
external audit tender process to ensure that an 
independent audit firm with the requisite technical 
competence and expertise is appointed as the Group’s 
external auditor for the year ending 31 December 
2026. The Committee will also ensure that the Group 
continues to enhance its sustainability disclosures 
while also monitoring developments in the broader 
regulatory landscape. In addition, the Committee will 
oversee preparations to comply with the 2024 UK 
Corporate Governance Code, with a particular focus on 
disclosure requirements related to material controls.
Features of Internal Control in Relation to the 
Financial Reporting Process
The main features of the internal control and risk 
management systems of the Group in relation to the 
financial reporting process include:
•	 the Board review and approve a detailed annual 
budget and monitor performance against the 
budget through periodic Board reporting;
•	 prior to submission to the Board with a 
recommendation to approve, the Audit Committee 
review the Interim Management Statements, 
the Interim and Annual Consolidated Financial 
Statements and all formal announcements relating 
to these statements;
•	 adherence to the Group Code of Conduct and 
Group policies published on the Group’s intranet 
ensures the key controls in the internal control 
system are complied with;
•	 monthly reporting and financial review meetings 
are held to review performance at business level 
ensuring that significant variances between the 
budget and detailed management accounts are 
investigated and that remedial action is taken as 
necessary;
•	 the Group has a Financial Compliance function 
to establish compliance policies and monitor 
compliance across the countries in which the 
Group operates;
•	 the Group operates an internal control self- 
assessment process covering material finance, 
operational and compliance controls across  
the Group;
•	 a well-resourced and appropriately skilled Finance 
function is in place throughout the Group;
•	 completion of key account reconciliations at 
reporting unit and Group level;
•	 centralised Taxation and Treasury functions and 
two Global Shared Service Centres established to 
facilitate appropriate segregation of duties;
•	 the Group Finance Committee has responsibility 
for raising finance, reviewing foreign currency 
risk, making decisions on foreign currency and 
interest rate hedging and managing the Group’s 
relationship with its finance providers;
•	 the Board, through the Audit Committee, 
completes an annual review of the effectiveness of 
risk management and control systems;
•	 appropriate ICT security environment; and
•	 the Internal Audit function continually reviews 
the internal controls and systems and make 
recommendations for improvement which are 
reported to the Audit Committee.
Fair, Balanced and Understandable
The Directors have concluded that the Annual Report 
and Consolidated Financial Statements, taken as 
a whole, provide the information necessary for 
shareholders to assess the Group’s and Company’s 
position and performance, business model and 
strategy and is fair, balanced and understandable. 
This assessment was completed by the Audit 
Committee and the activities undertaken in reaching 
this conclusion are outlined on page 87.
GOVERNANCE REPORT 
Audit Committee Report
Where to find out more
Membership
•	 Details of Committee members, including 
changes during the year, and their 
attendance at all meetings can be found on 
page 81. 
•	 Information on the skills and experience 
of Committee members can be found on 
pages 58 to 61.
Responsibilities
•	 The Committee Terms of Reference are 
available in the governance section of the 
Group’s website kerry.com or upon request.
Christopher Rogers
Chairman of the Audit Committee
85
84
Directors’ Report Corporate Governance Report
Directors’ Report Audit Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Committee Composition
The Committee currently comprises five independent 
non-Executive Directors. Both the Chairman, Mr. 
Christopher Rogers, and Ms. Liz Hewitt are Fellows of 
Chartered Accountants England and Wales and have 
significant financial experience in several sectors. Both 
they and Mr. Michael Kerr are considered to meet the 
specific requirements for recent and relevant financial 
experience as set out in the Code. 
The Board is also satisfied that together, the 
members of the Committee bring a broad range 
of relevant skills, experience and expertise, from a 
wide variety of industries and backgrounds, and as 
a whole have competence relevant to the sectors in 
which the Group operates. 
The Chairperson of the Sustainability Committee is a 
member of the Audit Committee which is supportive 
in ensuring alignment with the work of that 
Committee in the area of sustainability reporting.
Committee Evaluation
As outlined on page 82, an internal evaluation 
of Board effectiveness included a review by the 
Committee of its own effectiveness. The output was 
discussed by the Committee and it was concluded 
that the Committee continued to operate effectively 
throughout the year as well as identifying ongoing 
areas of focus for the 2025 financial year.
Financial and Sustainability Reporting
The Audit Committee reviewed the Interim 
Management Statements, the Interim and Annual 
Consolidated Financial Statements, the Sustainability 
Statement and all formal announcements relating to 
these statements before submitting them to the Board 
of Directors with a recommendation to approve. These 
reviews focused on, but were not limited to:
•	 the appropriateness and consistency of accounting 
policies and practices; 
•	 the going concern assumption;
•	 compliance with applicable financial and 
sustainability reporting standards, corporate 
governance requirements as well as the clarity and 
completeness of disclosures;
•	 considering the significant areas of complexity, 
management judgement and estimation that 
had been applied in the preparation of the 
Consolidated Financial Statements in accordance 
with the accounting policies; and
•	 considering the judgements, estimates and 
assumptions applied in the preparation of the 
Sustainability Statement in accordance with the ESRS.
The Committee considered the impact of climate 
change on the Group’s Consolidated Financial 
Statements and agreed that the disclosures outlined 
within the Sustainability Statement are prepared in 
accordance and compliance with the ESRS issued 
by the EU commission and the Companies Act 2014 
and recommendations of the Task Force on Climate-
related Financial Disclosures (TCFD) are appropriate 
and that the assumptions used in the financial 
statements as outlined in note 1 are consistent with 
these disclosures. 
The Committee has, with the support of PwC as 
external auditor, reviewed the suitability of the 
financial accounting policies which have been adopted 
and whether management have made appropriate 
judgements and disclosures. The table opposite 
sets out the significant matters considered by the 
Committee in relation to the Consolidated Financial 
Statements for the year ended 31 December 2024.
In addition, the Committee, in conjunction with senior 
management, has considered the reporting which 
forms the basis for preparation of the Sustainability 
Statement disclosures for the year ended 31 
December 2024 and whether management have made 
reasonable judgements, estimates and assumptions 
to ensure compliance with the ESRS, in particular for 
Scope 3 Emissions and Nutritional Reach metrics. 
The Committee also reviewed the limited assurance 
report of the external auditor and considered the 
outcomes of the external auditors limited assurance 
procedures over the Sustainability Statement. 
As a result, the Committee believes that the 
methods employed and judgements, estimates and 
assumptions made in compiling these disclosures are 
reasonable and appropriate. 
Significant Areas of Focus
Impairment  
of Goodwill and 
Indefinite Life 
Intangible  
Assets 
Goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets, as disclosed in note 13 to the 
Consolidated Financial Statements, represents the largest number on the Group 
balance sheet at €5 billion. The Committee considered the process to complete 
the annual impairment review of the Group’s goodwill and indefinite life intangible 
assets and specifically the assumptions used for the future cash flows, discount 
rates, terminal values and growth rates. This included consideration of the 
impact of climate change and other external and macroeconomic risks on such 
assessments and a consideration of the sensitivity analysis run by management. 
Following discussions with senior management and the external auditor, the 
Committee concluded that the methodology used for the above valuation and 
annual impairment review is appropriate and no impairment was identified.
Taxation
Significant judgement and a high degree of estimation is required when arriving 
at the Group’s tax charge and liability. The Committee, in conjunction with tax 
professionals, reviewed and discussed the basis for the judgments in relation to 
uncertain tax positions and challenged management on their assertions and also 
considered the outcome of the external auditors’ review of the tax charge and 
liability. As a result, the Committee believes the impact of uncertain tax positions 
has been appropriately reflected in the tax charge and liability.
Dairy Ireland  
Sale 
The Committee reviewed reports from management outlining the key accounting 
and disclosure impacts in relation to the sale of the Dairy Ireland business to 
Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited which completed on 31 December 2024. 
Following discussions with senior management and the external auditor, the 
Committee is satisfied that the related accounting considerations and disclosures 
in the Group’s Consolidated Financial Statements are appropriate.
Going Concern and Viability Statements
The Committee assessed the effectiveness of the 
process undertaken by management to evaluate 
going concern and longer-term viability, which 
included reviewing and challenging management’s 
assumptions and modelling of projected cash 
flows and in particular, those related to climate-
related risks, and their potential impact on future 
profitability and liquidity. The Committee also 
considered the Group’s financing facilities and 
future funding plans. Based on this, the Committee 
confirmed there were no material uncertainties 
that cast a significant doubt on the Group’s or the 
Company’s ability to continue as a going concern 
and therefore the application of the going concern 
basis for the preparation of the financial statements 
continued to be appropriate and recommended 
the approval of the viability statement. For further 
details see pages 55-56 of the Risk Management 
Report.
Fair, Balanced and Understandable
At the request of the Board, the Audit Committee 
undertook a review of the content of the Annual 
Report, including the Sustainability Statement and 
Consolidated Financial Statements to ensure that it is 
fair, balanced and understandable, and provides the 
information necessary for shareholders to assess the 
Group’s and the Company’s position, performance, 
business model and strategy.
In fulfilling this responsibility, the Committee 
considered the following:
•	 the timetable for the co-ordination and 
preparation of the Annual Report, Sustainability 
Statement and Consolidated Financial Statements, 
including key milestones as presented at the 
December Audit Committee meeting;
•	 the governance structure and systematic approach 
to review and sign-off carried out by senior 
management with a focus on consistency and 
balance; and
•	 a detailed report from senior finance management 
outlining the process through which they assessed 
the narrative, sustainability and financial sections 
of the 2024 Annual Report to ensure that the 
criteria of fair, balanced and understandable has 
been achieved.
87
86
Directors’ Report Audit Committee Report
Directors’ Report Audit Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
In order to comply with the Global Internal Audit 
Standards (GIAS) requirements of the Chartered 
Institute of Internal Auditors (CIIA), an External 
Quality Assessment (EQA) by a qualified, independent 
body is conducted at least once every five years. The 
most recent EQA was performed in 2022 and the next 
review will be completed in 2027. On an annual basis, 
to ensure ongoing compliance with the GIAS, the 
Group Internal Audit function has an internal quality 
assessment programme in place, the results of which 
are reported to the Audit Committee quarterly.  
On the basis of the above, the Committee concluded 
that for 2024 the Group Internal Audit function 
operated effectively and is satisfied that the 
quality, experience and expertise of the function is 
appropriate for the Group. 
External Auditor
On behalf of the Board, the Committee oversees the 
relationship with, and performance of, the external 
auditor, including recommendations to the Board on 
their appointment, re-appointment, and removal, 
assessing their independence and effectiveness, 
and approving the audit fee. During the year, the 
Committee met with the external auditor without 
management present to discuss any issues that 
may have arisen during the audit of the Group’s 
Consolidated Financial Statements and the limited 
assurance procedures over the Sustainability 
Statement. In addition to this, the Committee 
Chairman meets with the external auditor quarterly 
and additional meetings or private sessions are 
available upon request.
Independence and Provision of Non-Audit Services
The Committee is responsible for ensuring that the 
external auditor is independent and for implementing 
appropriate safeguards where the external auditor 
also provides non-audit services to the Group.
PwC confirmed to the Audit Committee that they are 
independent from the Group under the requirements 
of the Irish Auditing and Accounting Supervisory 
Authority’s Ethical Standards for Auditors. PwC were 
appointed as statutory auditors for the Group for 
the financial year ended 31 December 2016 and the 
Committee will ensure that in accordance with EU 
legislation in relation to Audit Reform as adopted in 
Irish legislation, the external auditor is rotated at least 
once every ten years. The audit lead engagement 
partner for the financial year ended 31 December 
2024 is Paul Barrie, who was appointed in July 2023. 
In accordance with the Group’s policy on the hiring 
of former employees of the current external auditor, 
the Committee reviews and approves any senior 
managerial appointments of individuals who were 
employed by the external auditor within the previous 
three years. 
A formal policy governing the provision of non-audit 
services by the external auditor is in place and is 
reviewed and approved by the Audit Committee 
annually. This policy is designed to safeguard 
the objectivity and independence of the external 
auditor and to prevent the provision of services 
which could result in a potential conflict of auditor 
independence. The policy outlines the services which 
can be provided by the external auditor, the relevant 
approval process for these services, and those 
services which the external auditor is prohibited 
from providing. In 2024, all non-audit services and 
fees as outlined in note 3 to the financial statements 
were approved by the Committee in line with the 
policy. The Committee is satisfied that the non-
audit fees paid to PwC, which were minimal, did not 
compromise their independence or objectivity.
Having considered all the above, the Committee 
concluded that the Group’s external auditor is 
independent.
Effectiveness
The Committee is committed to ensuring that 
the Group receives a high-quality and effective 
external audit.  Post completion of the 2023 audit, 
in conjunction with PwC, review meetings were held 
with senior finance management across all regions 
and it was confirmed by both parties that no issues 
had arisen during the audit process. 
At the October Audit Committee meeting, PwC 
outlined in detail the 2024 external audit plan and 
the Committee discussed the significant audit risks 
and key audit matters, audit scope and materiality 
amongst other matters. The Audit Committee 
agreed that the plan and the materiality at which 
any misstatements should be reported by PwC to the 
Committee was appropriate.
Prior to the finalisation of the 2024 Sustainability 
Statement and Consolidated Financial Statements, the 
Audit Committee received a detailed presentation and 
final report from PwC. The Committee also considered 
feedback from the lead partner and senior executives 
in concluding that PwC effectively delivered against 
the objectives of the agreed audit plan. 
In assessing the effectiveness of the external auditor, 
the Audit Committee also considered the following:
•	 the quality of presentations to the Board and Audit 
Committee; 
•	 the technical insights provided, relevant to  
the Group; 
•	 key audit findings, including their robustness and 
perceptiveness in handling of key accounting and 
audit judgements; and 
•	 their demonstration of a clear understanding of 
the Group’s business and key risks.
On the basis of the above the Committee is satisfied 
with the effectiveness of the external auditors.
Management ensured that the draft Annual Report, 
Sustainability Statement and Consolidated Financial 
Statements were available to the Audit Committee 
in sufficient time for review in advance of the 
Committee meeting to facilitate adequate discussion 
at the meeting. The Committee also received 
confirmation that the other Board Committees 
had signed off on each of its respective Committee 
reports and reviewed other sections for which it has 
responsibility under its Terms of Reference. 
Having considered the above, in conjunction with the 
consistency of the various elements of the reports, 
the narrative reporting and the language used, the 
Committee provided assurance to the Board to assist 
it in making the fair, balanced and understandable 
statement required of it under the Code, which is set 
out on page 67.
Internal Control and Risk Management
The Audit Committee supports the Board in its duties 
to review and monitor, on an ongoing basis, the 
effectiveness of the Group’s risk management and 
internal control systems. A detailed overview of the 
Group’s risk management framework is set out in the 
Risk Management Report on page 47.
Throughout the year, the Committee:
•	 reviewed and approved the assessment of the 
principal risks and uncertainties, including climate 
change and other emerging risks, that could 
impact the achievement of the Group’s strategic 
objectives as described on pages 49-54; 
•	 reviewed and approved the risk appetite for each 
of the Group’s principal risks and recommended 
them for approval by the Board; 
•	 received deep dive presentations from senior 
executives on a selection of principal risks, which 
included cybersecurity and ICT resilience, business 
acquisition and divestiture, margin management, 
intellectual property and taxation risks;
•	 reviewed quarterly reports from the Head of 
Internal Audit based on engagements completed 
outlining non-compliances with Group controls 
and managements’ action plans to address them;  
•	 considered reports from the Head of Internal 
Audit and the Group Financial Controller on fraud 
investigations or other significant control matters 
which occurred during the year and approved plans 
to address and remediate the issues identified; 
•	 received updates from the General Counsel and 
the Business Integrity & Legal Operations Director 
in relation to the Group’s business integrity 
programme; 
•	 considered the results of the Kerry Control Self-
Assessment (the internal control self-assessment 
review of material finance, operational and 
compliance controls) which concluded that the 
controls are operating effectively;
•	 received a detailed report from the Head 
of Internal Audit outlining the Group’s risk 
management and internal control framework in 
line with the FRC Guidance on Risk Management, 
Internal Control and Related Financial and 
Business Reporting and incorporating all material 
financial, operational and compliance controls; and
•	 reviewed the report from the external auditor in 
respect of significant financial accounting and 
reporting issues and internal control weakness 
observations.
The Audit Committee, having assessed the above 
information, is satisfied that the internal control and risk 
management framework operated effectively during the 
year and has reported this opinion to the Board.
Internal Audit
The Audit Committee is responsible for monitoring 
and reviewing the operation and effectiveness of the 
Group Internal Audit function including its focus, 
plans, activities and resources. To fulfil these duties 
the Committee:
•	 considered and approved an updated three-year 
Internal Audit strategy, the Internal Audit charter 
and annual plan;
•	 considered and were satisfied that the 
competencies, experience and level of resources 
within the Internal Audit team were adequate to 
achieve the proposed plan; 
•	 considered the role and effectiveness of Internal 
Audit in the overall context of the Group’s risk 
management framework and was satisfied that 
the function has appropriate standing within the 
Group; 
•	 received quarterly updates from the Head of 
Internal Audit on the delivery of the 2024 plan and 
on the principal findings from the work of Internal 
Audit and the status of management’s actions to 
remediate issues identified;
•	 received updates on the nature and extent of non-
audit activity performed by Internal Audit; 
•	 ensured that the Head of Internal Audit had 
regular meetings with the Chairman of the Audit 
Committee and the Committee met with the Head 
of Internal Audit without the presence of Executive 
Management; 
•	 ensured that the Head of Internal Audit had access 
to the Chairman of the Board if required; and 
•	 ensured co-ordination between Group Internal 
Audit and the external auditor to maximise the 
benefits from clear communication and co-
ordinated activities.
89
88
Directors’ Report Audit Committee Report
Directors’ Report Audit Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
GOVERNANCE REPORT 
Governance and Nomination Committee Report
Where to find out more
Membership
•	 Details of Committee members and their 
attendance at all meetings can be found on 
Page 81
•	 Information on the skills and experience of 
all Committee members can be found on 
pages 58 to 61.
Responsibilities
•	 The Terms of Reference are available in the 
governance section of the Group’s website 
kerry.com or upon request.
A Year In Review
During the year under review, the Committee 
continued to lead the Board refreshment process 
ensuring that the composition of the Board and its 
Committees has the appropriate balance of skills, 
knowledge, experience, diversity and independence. 
Key developments during the year included:
•	 Ms. Liz Hewitt joined the Board in March 2024 and 
she brings with her significant and wide-ranging 
business leadership as well as board and audit 
committee experience which compliments the 
skillset of the Board;
•	 The Committee oversaw the onboarding of the 
new Board members who joined in late 2023 / 
early 2024;
•	 Mr. Christopher Rogers was appointed Senior 
Independent Director and he is overseeing the 
Chair succession process ahead of my retirement 
at the conclusion of the AGM in 2026. This process 
is expected to be concluded in early 2026;
•	 The composition of the Committees was refreshed 
and a new designated workforce engagement 
Director was appointed following the board 
retirements that occurred during the year; and
•	 An internally facilitated self-assessment of the 
effectiveness of the Board and its Committees was 
conducted, the outcome of which is that the Board 
and Committees are operating effectively.
The Committee also oversaw senior leadership 
development and succession planning and kept 
up to date with the latest corporate governance 
developments including changes to the UK and Irish 
Listing rules, upcoming changes to the UK Corporate 
Governance Code and the implementation of a new 
Irish Corporate Governance Code.
The Year Ahead
The Committee’s priorities for 2025 will continue 
to focus on Board and Committee refreshment, 
including Chair succession, as well as senior 
leadership development and succession planning. 
The Committee will also keep up to date with 
evolving corporate governance requirements.
Tom Moran
Chairman of the Governance and 
Nomination Committee
On behalf of the Governance and 
Nomination Committee, I am pleased 
to present our report for the year 
ended 31 December 2024. This report 
sets out the Committee’s main areas 
of focus over the past financial year.
Appointment and Tenure 
On an annual basis, the Committee reviews 
the appointment of the external auditor, taking 
into account the auditor’s effectiveness and 
independence. On that basis, the Committee 
recommended to the Board that PwC should 
continue in office as the auditor to the Group in 
respect of the year ending 31 December 2025. The 
Audit Committee also approved the remuneration of 
the external auditor, details of which are set out in 
note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.
In line with rotation requirements, a new external 
auditor will be appointed for the audit of the 
sustainability and financial statements for the year 
ending 31 December 2026. The Committee began 
planning for the tender process during 2024 and 
intend to initiate a competitive tender process in 
early 2025 which will allow sufficient time for an 
orderly transition. The Committee considered the 
recommendations of the FRC’s Audit Committees 
and the External Audit: Minimum Standard while 
overseeing the effectiveness of the external audit 
process and planning for the upcoming tender 
process.
Directors’ Compliance Statement
During the year, the Audit Committee reviewed 
the appropriateness of the Directors’ Compliance 
Policy Statement and received a report from senior 
management on the review undertaken during 
the financial year of the compliance structures and 
arrangements in place to ensure the Company’s 
material compliance with its relevant obligations. 
Based on this review, the Committee confirmed 
to the Board that in its opinion the Company is in 
material compliance with its relevant obligations.
Whistleblowing and Fraud Arrangements
In accordance with the Provisions of the Code, the 
responsibility for overseeing whistleblowing is within 
the remit of the Board. During 2024, at the request 
of the Board, the Committee considered the Group’s 
whistleblowing arrangements and assisted the 
Board in its assessment of the adequacy of these 
arrangements. Details of the Group’s whistleblowing 
arrangements are outlined in the Corporate 
Governance Report on page 80 and are also 
described in our Code of Conduct, which is available 
from the Group’s website Kerry.com. 
The Committee also considered the Group’s 
procedures for fraud prevention and detection 
to ensure that these arrangements allow for the 
proportionate and independent investigation of such 
matters and appropriate follow up action. Following 
this review, the Audit Committee confirmed to the 
Board that it was satisfied that the Group’s fraud 
prevention procedures were adequate.
90
91
Directors’ Report Governance and Nomination Committee Report
Directors’ Report Audit Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Board Refreshment Policy
On an ongoing basis, the Governance and 
Nomination Committee reviews and assesses the 
structure, size, composition, diversity and overall 
balance of the Board and makes recommendations 
to the Board regarding refreshment.
Appointments to the Board are for an initial three- 
year term, subject to shareholder approval and 
annual re-election, after consideration of annual 
performance evaluation and statutory provisions 
relating to the removal of a Director. The Board 
may appoint such Directors for a further term 
not exceeding three years and may consider an 
additional term if deemed appropriate.
During the year, the Chairman conducted a rigorous 
review of all other non-Executive Directors as part of 
the Board evaluation process, considering the need 
for progressive refreshment of the Board. The Board 
explains to shareholders, in the papers accompanying 
the resolutions to elect and re-elect the non-Executive 
Directors, why it believes each individual Director 
should be re-elected based on the results of the formal 
performance evaluation. Details of Board refreshment 
activities during the year are outlined on pages 94-95.
Governance and Nomination Committee 
Advisors
The Governance and Nomination Committee 
is authorised to appoint external advisors and 
Korn Ferry assisted the Committee with Board 
refreshment during 2024. Korn Ferry also provides 
leadership and talent consulting services to the 
Group through a separate part of their business. 
They do not have any other connections with the 
Group or with any of the individual Directors that 
may impair its independence.
Nomination Process
There is a formal, rigorous and transparent 
procedure in appointing new Directors to the 
Board. Details of this process are outlined in the 
Governance in Action table.
The Committee also makes recommendations to 
the Board concerning the re-appointment of any 
non-Executive Director at the conclusion of their 
specified term and the re-election of all Directors at 
the AGM. The terms and conditions of appointment 
of non-Executive Directors are set out in formal 
letters of appointment, which are available for 
inspection at the Company’s registered office during 
normal office hours and at the AGM.
Succession Planning
The Governance and Nomination Committee 
reviews the succession plans for the Board and its 
Committees on an ongoing basis to ensure an orderly 
refreshment of membership, taking into account 
Group strategy, challenges and opportunities facing 
the Group and the skills, knowledge and experience 
required of Board members.
The Committee also reviews succession plans for 
senior leadership, which form part of the Group’s 
overall annual approach to succession planning 
and agrees these with the Chief Executive Officer 
before being presented to the Board. The succession 
planning process includes defining success criteria 
for key roles, identifying and evaluating candidate 
pools and aligning successor development activities 
with individual and business needs to ensure 
leadership continuity and to strengthen the quality of 
the leadership succession pipeline.
This process is fully documented and monitored 
throughout the year in conjunction with the 
Committee. Details of succession planning activities 
during the year are outlined in Our People on page 16.
Corporate Governance Developments
During 2024, the Committee also continued to keep 
up to date with existing and evolving corporate 
governance requirements and ensured that Board 
and Committee agendas were appropriately drafted 
to include same.
Diversity, Inclusion and Belonging Policy
At Kerry we strive to ensure that we reflect the 
communities in which we operate across the globe. 
We embrace, celebrate and harness our differences, 
seeking to foster an inclusive and supportive work 
environment which is positive and productive, and 
respectful of everyone.
We recognise the value that different perspectives 
and cultures bring to Kerry and encourage individuals 
to fully participate and contribute meaningfully to the 
overall success of the Group.
The Group’s Diversity, Inclusion and Belonging Policy 
is an integral part of the Group’s Code of Conduct 
ensuring that diversity and inclusion are embedded 
in Kerry Group’s core values.
Within this, the Group seeks to recruit and retain the 
best talent from varied backgrounds who bring the 
skills and experience necessary to drive innovative 
thinking to enable Kerry to maintain a sustained 
competitive advantage.
The Board believes in the benefits of having a 
diverse Board and the value that it can bring to its 
effective operation. In accordance with the Board 
and Board Committee Diversity Policy, differences in 
background, gender, skills, experiences, nationality, 
ethnicity and other attributes are considered in 
determining the optimum composition of the Board 
and its Committees with the aim being to balance it 
appropriately with different views and perspectives. 
All Board appointments are made on merit, with due 
regard to diversity. The Board currently has a 46% 
female representation. Diversity at Board level in 
terms of gender, nationality and ethnic background 
have all improved in recent years. In line with this 
policy, and recommended best practice, the Board is 
committed to maintaining a minimum of 40% female 
representation on the Board. It has an ambition to 
increase the representation of members with diverse 
backgrounds such as nationality, ethnicity and other 
attributes and to have an appropriate representation 
on each of its Committees. As at 31 December 2024 
and the date of this report, the Company has met 
the UK Listing Rule requirements in relation to Board 
diversity, as at least 40% of the Board members are 
women, at least one of the senior Board positions is 
held by a woman and at least one Board member is 
from an ethnic minority background.
In reviewing Board composition and agreeing a 
job specification for new non-Executive Director 
appointments, the Committee considers the benefits 
of all aspects of diversity including, but not limited 
to, those described above, to make appointments 
that complement the range and balance of skills, 
knowledge and experience on the Board. As part 
of the identification process, executive recruitment 
consultants present a list of potential candidates 
who meet the stated specification requirements, for 
consideration by the Committee.
Diversity goals have been agreed for senior 
leadership succession pools with the Executive 
Directors and approved by the Board to improve 
the diversity profile of senior leadership teams 
and ensure internal candidate pools better reflect 
the broader mix of capabilities and cultures within 
the Group. The Group is committed to achieving 
its goal of equal gender representation in senior 
management roles by 2030. The Committee reviews 
progress against these goals each year, while 
taking account of business growth and geographic 
expansion within the organisation. Currently the 
Group is on track to achieve these targets.
Further details of the Group’s approach to Diversity, 
Inclusion and Belonging, including our broader 
organisational goals focused on building an inclusive 
and diverse workplace, are outlined in our Sustainability 
Statement and in Our People on page 15.
1. Assessment
The Committee assessed the skill set, experience and diversity on the Board, the 
requirements to meet the Group’s future growth plans, together with the planned 
retirements from the Board over the coming years.
 2. Requirement
The Committee prepared a detailed role profile; identifying the need for a new non-
Executive Director with business leadership and listed company board experience as 
well as a finance skill set. The Committee also considered the Board’s commitment 
to enhance the gender profile of the Board in line with developing best practice and 
regulatory requirements.
3. Search 
The Committee instructed Korn Ferry to conduct a search for an appropriate 
candidate for appointment to the Board based on the profile and skillset agreed 
by the Committee.
4. Screening 
The Committee assessed a long list of candidates identified by Korn Ferry as having 
met the criteria.
5. Interview 
A shortlist of potential candidates was interviewed by Korn Ferry, the Chairman, the 
Committee and the Chief Executive Officer.
6. Approval 
A formal recommendation was made by the Committee to the Board proposing the 
appointment of Ms. Liz Hewitt as non-Executive Director. The Board approved the 
appointment of Ms. Liz Hewitt noting that she has a balance of skills, knowledge 
and experience that matched the requirements set. Appointment terms were 
drafted and agreed with her.
Governance in Action (example)
Non-Executive Director Appointment
Ms Liz Hewitt was appointed to the Board with effect from 1 March 2024. The key stages of the nomination 
process are outlined below.
93
92
Directors’ Report Governance and Nomination Committee Report
Directors’ Report Governance and Nomination Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
A summary of the Group’s current position relating to Board and Executive Management diversity, in line with 
the UK listing rule requirements, is provided in the table below:
Disclosure Table in the Format Prescribed by the UK Listing Rules
Number 
of Board
Members
Percentage
of the
Board
Number of senior 
positions on the 
Board (CEO, CFO,
SID and Chair)
Number in 
Executive
Management
Percentage 
of Executive
Management
Gender identity of sex
Men
7
54%
3
13
76%
Women
6
46%
1
4
24%
Not Specified/prefer not to say
-
-
-
-
-
Diversity of ethnicity
White British or other White 
(Including minority-white Groups)
12
92%
4
17
100%
Mixed/Multiple Ethnic Groups
-
-
-
-
-
Asian/Asian British
1
8%
-
-
-
Black/African/Caribbean/  
Black British
-
-
-
-
-
Other Ethnic group, including 
Arab
-
-
-
-
-
Not Specified/prefer not to say
-
-
-
-
-
Dr. Genevieve Berger	
Appointed to the Sustainability Committee on 2 May 2024.
Ms. Fiona Dawson	
Appointed to the Audit Committee on 2 May 2024.
Ms. Emer Gilvarry	
Appointed to the Governance and Nomination Committee and as Workforce 
Engagement Director on 2 May 2024. She retired from the Audit Committee 
on the same date.
Prof. Catherine Godson	
Appointed to the Sustainability Committee on 2 May 2024.
Ms. Liz Hewitt	
Appointed to the Board and the Audit Committee on 1 March 2024.
Mr. Micheal Kerr	
Appointed to the Remuneration Committee on 2 May 2024.
Mr. Christopher Rogers	
Appointed as Senior Independent Director and to the Governance and 
Nomination Committee on 2 May 2024. He retired from the Sustainability 
Committee on the same date. 
On the Committee’s agenda in 2024
The key activities of the Committee throughout the year are detailed below:
Changes to the composition of the Board and its Committees for the year ended 31 December 2024
Corporate Development & M&A
Sustainability
Board & Governance
Financial & Risk Management
Science, Technology & Innovation
International Markets
Food & Beverage Industry
Legal & Regulatory
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Summary of  
non-Executive 
Directors skills  
and experience1
Subject
Committee Activity
Board Size and 
Composition
In 2024, as part of its remit, the Committee considered the size and composition of the Board. On 31 
December 2024, the Board comprised 13 members following the appointment of Ms. Liz Hewitt and the 
retirement of Dr. Hugh Brady and Dr. Karin Dorrepaal during 2024. The Committee will continue to consider 
both Board size and composition during 2025.
Chairman 
Succession
During 2023, the Committee, recommended to the Board that Mr. Tom Moran continue as Chairman until 
the Annual General Meeting in 2026 and this was formally approved by the Board. Mr. Moran’s re-election as 
a Director was strongly supported by shareholders at the 2024 AGM.
A Chair succession committee is undertaking a formal succession process which is being led by Mr. 
Christopher Rogers in his role as Senior Independent Director.
Board 
Refreshment
Ms Liz Hewitt was appointed to the Board as non-Executive Director on 1 March 2024, following a search 
conducted by the Committee in conjunction with an executive recruitment consulting firm. The Committee 
and the Board agreed that she has a balance of skills, knowledge and experience that matched the 
requirements set.
Committee 
Refreshment
Following the planned retirements of Dr. Hugh Brady and Dr. Karin Dorrepaal as Directors at the conclusion 
of the AGM held on 2 May 2024, the Board, on the recommendation of the Committee, agreed to the 
following changes in Committee composition, all of which took effect at the conclusion of the 2024 AGM 
on 2 May 2024: Mr. Christopher Rogers and Ms. Emer Gilvarry joined the Governance and Nomination 
Committee; Mr. Michael Kerr joined the Remuneration Committee; Ms. Fiona Dawson joined the Audit 
Committee and Dr. Genevieve Berger and Prof. Catherine Godson joined the Sustainability Committee. Mr. 
Christopher Rogers resigned from the Sustainability Committee and Ms. Emer Gilvarry resigned from the 
Audit Committee. The Committee will continue to consider committee refreshment in 2025.
Designated 
Workforce 
Engagement 
Director
Dr. Karin Dorrepaal retired from the Board and as the designated Workforce Engagement Director at the 
conclusion of the AGM on 2 May 2024. The Committee completed a formal process and recommended to 
the Board that Ms. Emer Gilvarry be appointed as the designated Workforce Engagement Director effective 
from the conclusion of the 2024 AGM.
Re-
appointment 
of 
non‑Executive 
Directors
During the year, Ms. Dawson, Mr. Mike Kerr, Mr. Christopher Rogers and Mr. Jinlong Wang each completed 
terms as non-Executive Directors. Following a rigorous review of their skills, knowledge, experience and 
independence, the Board on the recommendation of the Committee, agreed that they continue to be 
effective and independent and make a valuable contribution to the Board, and re-appointed them to serve 
additional terms.
Board and 
Committees 
Effectiveness
As outlined in detail on pages 82-83, an internal evaluation of the Board and its Committees took place in 
2024 in line with the provisions of the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code.
The Committee considered the outcome of this review. Each recommendation was assessed, and an action 
plan was developed to address areas for potential improvement. These recommendations will be reviewed 
and considered by the Committee in 2025. The conclusion from the evaluation process is that the Board and 
its Committees are operating effectively.
Senior 
Leadership 
Development 
and 
Succession
During the year, the Committee reviewed senior leadership development and succession plans having 
regard to agreed diversity goals to ensure the appropriate level of skills and diversity will exist to support the 
delivery of the Group’s strategy.
Corporate 
Governance 
Review
During 2024, the Committee reviewed and updated the Company’s corporate governance related policies. 
In addition, the Committee monitored the Company’s compliance with the 2018 UK Corporate Governance 
Code and the Irish Corporate Governance Annex. The Committee also reviewed developments in corporate 
governance including the new UK and Irish Listing rules, the new UK Corporate Governance Code and the 
new Irish Corporate Governance Code.
Terms of 
Reference
During the year, the Committee reviewed and updated its Terms of Reference. A copy of these terms is 
available on the Group’s website kerry.com
•	
The reference date for the disclosures in this table is 31 December 2024. There has been no change in the data disclosed since that date.
•	
For the purpose of this disclosure Executive Management represents the Executive Leadership Team plus the Company Secretary. 
•	
The data in the table above was collected on the basis of self-reporting by the individuals concerned. When providing the data, the individuals were 
asked to select the gender and ethnicity background applicable to them by selecting from the list in the table above.
1 This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 GOV-1 21 c as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 132 - subject to limited assurance.
95
94
Directors’ Report Governance and Nomination Committee Report
Directors’ Report Governance and Nomination Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
GOVERNANCE REPORT
Sustainability Committee Report
A YEAR IN REVIEW
During the year, we welcomed Dr. Genevieve 
Berger, and Prof. Catherine Godson as members 
of the Committee. Both Genevieve and Catherine 
bring a wealth of ESG experience to discussions.  
Dr. Karin Dorrepaal and Mr. Christopher Rogers 
retired from the Committee, and I would like to 
thank them for their valued contribution during 
their tenure on the Committee. 
During 2024 the Committee’s core priority continued 
to be monitoring how the implementation of the 
Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy is 
progressing as well as reviewing performance versus 
our agreed sustainability related commitments. 
I am pleased to say that during the year we have 
made good progress and are on track to meet these 
commitments. Kerry now reaches 1.36bn people 
with positive and balanced nutrition solutions as 
we continue to support our customers in improving 
the nutritional profile of their products. Our Scope 1 
and 2 carbon emissions have decreased by 50% and 
the food waste reduction across our operations was 
38% versus our base year. Further details about our 
performance are set out in our Sustainability Review 
on pages 38-45 and in the Sustainability Statement 
on pages 127-233.
As part of the Group’s readiness for reporting in line 
with CSRD requirements, the Committee reviewed 
and approved the sustainability material topics for 
2024 which were identified following the completion 
of a double materiality assessment. 
Where to find out more
Membership
•	 Details of committee members and their 
attendance at all meetings can be found on 
page 81
•	 Information on the skills and experience of 
all Committee members can be found on 
pages 58 to 61.
Responsibilities
•	 The Terms of Reference are available in the 
governance section of the Group’s website 
kerry.com or upon request.
Where to find more detail
•	 More detail on Kerry’s Sustainability 
performance is available in the Sustainability 
Review on pages 38-45 and in the 
Sustainability Statement on pages 127-233
On behalf of the Sustainability 
Committee, I am pleased to present 
our report for the year ended 31 
December 2024, setting out the 
Committee’s main areas of focus.
Fiona Dawson
Chairperson of the Sustainability Committee
On the Committee’s agenda in 2024
The key activities of the Committee throughout the period are detailed below:
Subject
Committee Activities
Oversight of the 
Group’s Sustainability 
Strategy
The Committee provided guidance and oversight on the continued implementation of the 
Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy. The Committee was supported in this work 
by the Sustainability Executive Committee, whose members are invited to the Committee 
meetings to share their expertise on key sustainability topics and to update the Committee 
on the implementation of the sustainability strategy.
Performance Versus 
Sustainability 
Commitments
The Committee monitored progress against the commitments and targets included in  
the Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy and provided insight and feedback  
as appropriate.
Sustainability 
Reporting
The Committee, in conjunction with the Audit Committee, considered and approved the 
sustainability-related reporting in the 2024 Annual Report including the Sustainability Review 
and the Sustainability Statement.
CSRD Readiness
The Committee oversaw preparations for reporting under the Corporate Sustainability 
Reporting Directive (CSRD) framework and worked with management to ensure that an 
appropriate and adequately resourced action plan was in place and executed.
The Committee reviewed and approved the sustainability material topics for 2024 that were 
identified in the double materiality assessment completed as part of Group’s readiness for 
reporting in line with CSRD requirements.
Climate Related
Risks and the Climate 
Transition Plan
The Committee reviewed and approved the material climate related risks and opportunities 
facing the Group. The Committee also approved the Group’s Climate Transition Plan, which 
was published externally on kerry.com in December 2024, and in addition it reviewed and 
approved Kerry’s updated Scope 3 targets.
Committee Training
Since the establishment of the Committee, training materials have been shared with the 
Committee including the Group’s Sustainability Essentials education modules for their 
general update on sustainability matters as relevant to Kerry. A training programme for 
2024 was agreed and executed. As part of this training, one of the Committee members 
participated in a Leaders Sustainability Acceleration Programme which was run in 
conjunction with the UCD Michael Smurfit Graduate Business School.
Committee Evaluation
As outlined on pages 82-83, an internal evaluation of the Board and its Committees took 
place in 2024. The outcome of the review is that the Sustainability Committee is considered 
to be operating effectively.
Terms of Reference
During the year, the Committee reviewed and updated its Terms of Reference. A copy of 
these terms is available on the Group’s website kerry.com
The Committee oversaw the development and 
publication of the Group’s Climate Transition Plan. As 
part of this we received regular updates on the work 
completed, made decisions as required and approved 
changes to the plan as a result of the disposal of the 
Dairy Ireland business. The Committee assessed the 
key climate risks and opportunities under a number 
of climate change scenarios and considered what 
impacts may unfold under a range of pathways. We 
also considered the actions that can be taken to 
reduce the risks identified.
The Committee, in conjunction with the Audit 
Committee, considered and approved the 
sustainability-related reporting in the 2024 Annual 
Report including the Sustainability Review and the 
new Sustainability Statement. 
Finally, I would like to take this opportunity to 
thank the members of the Sustainability Committee 
for their input and support during the year and I 
look forward to making further progress on our 
sustainability journey during 2025.
97
96
Directors’ Report Sustainability Committee Report
Directors’ Report Sustainability Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
GOVERNANCE REPORT
Remuneration Committee Reportt
Section A
Chairperson’s Annual Statement
Dear Shareholder,
On behalf of the Remuneration Committee, I am pleased 
to present the Remuneration Committee Report for the 
year ended 31 December 2024 which contains:
•	 The current Directors’ Remuneration Policy, which 
was approved at the AGM on 2 May 2024; and
•	 The annual Remuneration Report, describing how 
the Remuneration Policy has been put into practice 
in 2024 and how it will be implemented in 2025.
Context for Remuneration Decisions in 2024 
2024 has been an important year for Kerry. In 
parallel to delivering a strong financial performance, 
our Executive Directors have continued to lead our 
strategic development including the sale of the Dairy 
Ireland business, culminating in Kerry becoming a 
pure play taste & nutrition company.
We could not have achieved this without the continued 
and excellent leadership of our Executive Directors, our 
leadership teams and our entire global workforce who 
continue to demonstrate tremendous commitment 
and agility. I would like to pay special tribute to the 
employees of Kerry Dairy Ireland and thank them 
sincerely for their contributions over the years.
From a remuneration perspective, I would also like to 
express my appreciation to our shareholders for their 
high level of support with a 95% vote in favour of the 
policy at our 2024 AGM. The approved policy enables 
the Committee to ensure that Executive Director 
remuneration continues to reinforce the Group’s 
strategy and medium-term targets in a manner that is 
aligned with its purpose and values, and will underpin 
success for all stakeholders.
Where to find out more
Membership
•	 Details of Committee members and their 
attendance at all meetings can be found on 
page 81.
•	 Information on the skills and experience of 
all Committee members can be found on 
pages 58 to 61.
Responsibilities
•	 The Terms of Reference are available in the 
governance section of the Group’s website 
Kerry.com or upon request.
Salary increases for the wider workforce in 2025 will 
again be aligned to market movements on a country-
by-country basis. We will continue to have flexibility in 
our pay review process to facilitate higher increases 
for lower-paid positions and to allow for more 
frequent reviews in inflationary economies.
Supporting our Colleagues
Throughout 2024, the Committee continued to 
ensure a focus on our wider workforce. In the 2023 
Remuneration Report we shared a summary of 
the targeted actions taken to support our people. 
We have continued to build on these actions in 
2024 with the additional measures and benefits 
highlighted below:
•	 Following on from a very successful Phase 1 launch 
of our Global All Employee Share Plan, (‘OurShare’), 
to 8 countries in 2023, we extended OurShare 
to a further 16 countries in 2024. OurShare is 
now available in 24 countries across all regions, 
covering more than 94% of our workforce.  1 in 
6 colleagues have chosen to join OurShare, and 
as shareholders, now own part of Kerry. Plans 
are well underway in preparation for our Phase 3 
roll out in 2025 which will focus on the remaining 
countries representing another significant 
milestone for Kerry.
•	 Continuing our focus on fostering a healthy, 
positive work environment, in 2024, together 
with a leading psychology-based organisation, 
we developed a structured Emotional Wellbeing 
Training Program for people leaders at Kerry. We 
commenced our phased rollout across all regions 
in 2024 and will continue our rollout in 2025.
•	 Throughout 2024, we partnered with the Global 
Fair Wage Network to enhance our Living Wage 
strategy, building on our current certification 
and experience in the UK where we have been an 
accredited Living Wage Employer since April 2023.
Remuneration Policy
2024 was the first year of operation of our new 
Remuneration Policy, which is outlined in Section C 
on pages 104-111. This policy was approved by 
shareholders at the 2024 AGM and provides the 
framework for remuneration decisions made by the 
Committee for the three-year period 2024 to 2026.
The Committee is confident that the Group’s 
Remuneration Policy is aligned with shareholder 
interests, promotes long-term sustainable success 
and is in line with applicable best market practice. 
Furthermore, it ensures that Executive Director 
remuneration is aligned with the Group’s purpose 
and values and can be clearly linked to the successful 
delivery of the Group’s strategy and medium-term 
financial targets.
The Committee is satisfied that the policy has 
operated as intended and that no changes are 
required to the policy, or its operation, for 2025.
Remuneration Outturn 2024
In determining the Executive Directors’ remuneration 
outturns for the financial year, the Committee 
maintained a clear and rigorous focus on aligning 
pay with performance.
2024 Short-Term Incentive Plan
For Executive Directors, the 2024 STIP was based on 
financial metrics aligned with the Group’s strategy 
with 30% based on Volume Growth, 25% on EBITDA 
Margin Expansion and 25% on Cash Conversion.
Performance against key Strategic Objectives formed 
the remaining 20% of the overall STIP weighting.
The calculated outturn of the STIP for 2024 was 
98% of the maximum available opportunity 
as outlined in further detail on page 115. The 
Committee reviewed the formulaic outcome of the 
quantitative metrics, and its assessment of the 
strategic component, in the context of the Group’s 
underlying performance and the stakeholder 
experience, and is satisfied that the overall outturn 
is reflective of the Group’s and the Executives’ 
strong performance during the year. 
In line with the Directors’ Remuneration Policy, one-
third of the STIP payout will be deferred into shares/
share options to be held for two years.
Kerry’s Remuneration Principles
Delivery of Group Purpose, Values and 
Strategy
The Group’s short and long-term 
remuneration philosophy is to ensure that 
Executive Director remuneration is aligned 
with the Group’s purpose, values and culture, 
supports strategy and promotes the long-
term success of the Group.
Creating Sustainable, Long-Term 
Performance
Remuneration includes performance-related 
elements designed to align Directors’ 
interests with those of shareholders and to 
promote long-term sustainable growth and 
performance at the highest levels, in line with 
the Group’s strategy.
Attract, Motivate and Retain Talent
Market-competitive total remuneration is 
structured to attract, motivate and retain 
individuals of the highest quality on an 
international basis.
Stakeholder Interests
By linking a high proportion of Executive 
Directors’ potential remuneration to short-
term and long-term performance metrics 
with robust share ownership requirements, 
the Remuneration Committee believes 
that the interests and risk appetite of the 
Executive Directors are properly aligned 
with the interests of shareholders and other 
stakeholders.
Pay For Performance
The Committee ensures alignment with 
shareholders’ long-term interests by aligning 
remuneration metrics with the Group’s 
business model and strategic objectives.
99
98
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Long-Term Incentive Plan 2022-2024 Outturn
The three-year performance period in respect of 
the 2022-2024 LTIP award ended on 31 December 
2024. The 2022 LTIP award was subject to growth in 
Adjusted Earnings per Share (EPS), Total Shareholder 
Return (TSR), Return on Average Capital Employed 
(ROACE) and Sustainability Measures; with weightings 
of 40%, 25%, 15% and 20% respectively. 
The final outturn of the 2022-2024 LTIP award was 
54% of the maximum opportunity as outlined in 
further detail on pages 118-119. 
The Committee reviewed the formulaic outcome 
of the LTIP metrics and is satisfied that the overall 
outturn is reflective of the Group’s underlying 
performance during the three-year performance 
period. In line with the Directors’ Remuneration 
Policy, 100% of the vested award will be deferred into 
shares/share options to be held for two years.
Remuneration Policy Implementation 2025
Basic Salary 
In reviewing the basic salaries for the Executive 
Directors, the Committee was again mindful of 
the broader external environment, the strong 
performance of our Executive team, and in 
particular our wider workforce experience as 
outlined previously.
For 2025, the basic salaries of the three Executive 
Directors will be increased by 3.3%. In line with 
the approach taken last year, the increases for 
the Executive Directors are again below the 
2025 increases available for the wider workforce 
population in Ireland and the US (both at 3.5%), with 
higher increases available for lower-paid employees 
or where market adjustments are required to 
maintain appropriate competitive positioning.
Pension 
Executive Directors’ pension contributions will remain 
aligned to those of Kerry’s wider workforce in Ireland.
Incentive Plans 
We have consistently ensured there is a very strong 
alignment between our short-term and long-term 
incentive metrics and the Group’s business strategy 
and financial targets. 
During 2024 the Remuneration Committee reviewed 
the incentive plan metrics and weightings to ensure 
full alignment with the Group’s purpose, values, 
culture, strategy and medium-term targets. Targets 
were also assessed in the context of the changes in 
the Group’s portfolio.
2025 Short-Term Incentive Plan 
A review of the STIP design and metrics was 
completed to ensure they are aligned to strategy, 
consistent with best practice, and the targets are 
appropriately stretching. 
The Committee concluded that the current metrics 
and weightings continue to be appropriate and 
will therefore remain unchanged for 2025. The 
annual STIP maximum opportunity will also remain 
unchanged for 2025, at 200% of basic salary.
2025 Long-Term Incentive Plan 
A review of the LTIP design and metrics was also 
completed in 2024. The Committee concluded that 
the current metrics and weightings continue to be 
closely aligned with key value drivers for the Group 
(see page 108) and will therefore remain unchanged 
for the 2025 award.
A review of the target calibrations for 2025 was also 
completed and the Committee concluded that the 
targets set for EPS, ROACE and TSR for the 2024 award 
continue to be appropriate for the 2025 award in the 
context of the internal and market reference points 
considered, as well as the award opportunities in place.
The Committee adjusted the target ranges for the 
sustainability metrics as the Group moves another 
year closer to the targets included in the Beyond the 
Horizon sustainability strategy and to reflect changes 
in the Group’s portfolio.
The Remuneration Policy approved by shareholders 
in 2024 provided for an increase in the maximum 
LTIP opportunity. As described last year, following 
feedback from shareholders during engagement on 
the Committee’s policy proposals, the Committee 
decided to implement its proposed increases in 
the LTIP opportunities for the Executive Directors 
on a phased basis over two years. The Committee 
concluded that it is appropriate to implement 
the second phase of the increase approved by 
shareholders in the 2025 award, given the strong 
performance of the Group and each Executive 
Director in 2024. As such, the CEO’s LTIP award 
opportunity for 2025 will be 375% of basic salary and 
the LTIP opportunity for the CFO and CEO Taste & 
Nutrition will be 300% of basic salary.
Pay for Performance 
Kerry has a strong track record of demonstrating 
appropriate rigour and discipline when setting 
stretching targets. The Committee is satisfied that 
the targets set for the 2025 STIP and LTIP awards are 
appropriately stretching, particularly given the current 
economic environment, overall weak consumer 
demand and subdued market growth rates as well as 
the level of capital expenditure required to support 
future growth ambitions.
Non-Executive Director Fees for 2025 
For 2025, no substantive increases are proposed 
and, in line with the Remuneration Policy, an annual 
increase of 3.3% will be applied to the base fee paid 
to the Chairman and the non-Executive Directors. 
This increase is lower than the increase available to 
the wider workforce in Ireland. No increases will be 
applied to Committee membership fees, Committee 
Chair fees or any other fees.
Other Matters
Committee Refreshment
Mr. Michael Kerr was appointed to the Committee in 
May 2024 following Dr. Karin Dorrepaal’s retirement 
from the Board and the Committee.
Committee Performance
An internal review of the Remuneration Committee’s 
performance was undertaken during 2024 and the 
outcome of this review is that the Committee is 
operating effectively.
Conclusion
The Committee continues to review the Group’s 
Remuneration Policy to ensure that it remains 
aligned to shareholders’ long-term interests and 
provides the right framework to attract, retain and 
motivate Executive Directors in line with the pay for 
performance principle. 
As in previous years, the Remuneration Report is 
being put to shareholders for an advisory vote.  
Last year, 97% of our shareholders who voted, voted 
in favour of the Remuneration Report and I hope 
shareholders continue to provide their support at  
this year’s AGM. 
Finally, I would like to take this opportunity to thank 
the members of the Remuneration Committee for 
their commitment and support during the year.
Emer Gilvarry
Chairperson of the Remuneration Committee
101
100
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Section B
Remuneration Committee and Key Activities
Role and Responsibilities
On behalf of the Board, the Remuneration Committee 
is responsible for determining the Remuneration 
Policy and its implementation for the CEO, other 
Executive Directors and members of the Executive 
Leadership Team on an annual basis. The CEO is 
invited to attend Remuneration Committee meetings 
but does not attend Committee meetings when his 
own remuneration is discussed. The Committee 
also has access to internal and external professional 
advice as required. The Committee follows an annual 
and tri-annual calendar with matters scheduled and 
planned well in advance. Decisions are made within 
agreed reference terms, with additional meetings 
held as required. In considering the agenda, the 
Committee gives due regard to overall business 
strategy, the interests of shareholders, employees, 
other stakeholders and the performance of the 
Group. The main responsibilities of the Committee, 
which were reviewed during 2024, are set out in 
written Terms of Reference which are available from 
the Group’s website Kerry.com or upon request.
Remuneration Activities 2024
The key activities undertaken by the Committee in 
discharging its duties during 2024 are set out below:
Work of the Committee in Determining 
Executive Director Remuneration
The Committee considers the appropriateness of 
the Executive Directors’ remuneration not only in 
the context of overall business performance and 
environmental, social and governance (ESG) matters 
but also in the context of wider workforce pay 
conditions (taking into account workforce policies and 
practices) and external market data to  ensure that it 
is fair and appropriate for the role, experience of the 
individual, responsibilities and performance delivered.
Remuneration Committee Advisors
The Remuneration Committee is authorised by 
the Board to appoint external advisors and Ellason 
LLP (“Ellason”) is the advisor to the Remuneration 
Committee, having been appointed in 2023.
The Committee is satisfied that the advice provided by 
Ellason is objective and independent and that Ellason 
does not have connections with the Group or any of the 
individual Directors that may impair its independence.
The fees incurred with Ellason for advising the 
Committee in 2024 were €58,549 (2023: €197,556).
Statement on Shareholder Voting
Below is an overview of the voting which took 
place at the most recent AGM to approve the 
Directors’ Remuneration Policy and the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report.
Subject
Remuneration Committee Activity
Remuneration Report
A review of best practice remuneration reporting was completed during 2024 to ensure 
ongoing compliance with relevant legislation and reporting requirements.
Remuneration Policy 
Review
The Committee reviewed the new policy and concluded that it has operated as intended, 
and that the second phase of the LTIP changes will be applied from 2025.
Basic Salary
The Committee continued to monitor the level of basic salaries of the CEO and Executive 
Directors in line with market practice.
STIP1
The STIP was reviewed during 2024 to ensure that the metrics are aligned with Group 
strategy, purpose and values, the weightings are appropriate, and the associated targets 
are appropriately stretching.
LTIP1
The Committee considered the overall effectiveness of the LTIP in 2024 to ensure that it  
is structured appropriately to incentivise Executive Directors and senior managers across 
the Group.
Chairman & non-
Executive Director Fees
As provided in the Remuneration Policy, the base fees for the Chairman and non-Executive 
Directors are reviewed annually.
Executive Leadership 
Team 
In accordance with the terms of the Code, the Committee set the remuneration 
arrangements for the Executive Leadership Team and the Company Secretary.
Workforce Remuneration 
and Related Policies
During the year, the Committee was provided with regular updates on pay policies and 
procedures for the wider workforce to ensure alignment with the Executive Directors’ 
Remuneration Policy. The updates included an overview of the approach for the annual 
pay reviews in all the countries in which the Group operates. Other agenda items included 
updates on gender pay gap reporting, CSRD reporting, living wage strategy and roadmap,  
and updates on employee wellbeing and recognition programmes.
All Employee Share Plan
The Committee received regular updates on the expansion of Kerry’s All Employee Share 
Plan (‘OurShare’) to 16 additional countries in 2024 in addition to the 8 countries launched 
in September 2023.
Workforce Engagement 
Activity
The Committee was updated by the Chief Human Resources Officer and the designated 
Workforce Engagement Director (who is also the Chair of the Committee) in relation to the 
dialogue with the workforce concerning executive and workforce remuneration policies. 
The feedback received informed the Committee’s decision making in relation to executive 
remuneration outcomes for 2024, as well as the level of salary increases for Executive 
Directors and the fee increase for non-Executive Directors applicable in 2025.
Shareholder Consultation
The Committee reviewed the results of the shareholder vote on the Remuneration Policy 
and Report at the 2024 AGM, noting that 95% of shareholders who voted supported the 
implementation of the new policy and 97% supported the Report. The Committee also 
reviewed the additional feedback received from proxy advisors.
Committee Evaluation
As outlined on pages 82-83 an internal review of the Board and its Committees was 
conducted during 2024. The outcome of the review is that the Remuneration Committee is 
operating effectively.
Terms of Reference
During the year, the Committee reviewed and updated its Terms of Reference. A copy of 
these terms is available on the Group website Kerry.com.
Votes on Remuneration
Total Votes Cast
Votes For
Votes Against
Votes Withheld/ 
Abstained
Directors’ Remuneration Policy (2024 AGM)
108,597,731
103,331,399
5,266,332
586,300
95.2%
4.8%
Directors’ Remuneration Report (2024 AGM)
108,582,536
105,508,410
3,074,126
601,495
97.2%
2.8%
The Committee appreciates the level of support shown by the shareholders for the Remuneration Policy  
and the Remuneration Reports and is committed to continued consultation with shareholders with regard  
to the Remuneration Policy.
1 This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 GOV-3 29 e as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 132 - subject to limited 
assurance.
103
102
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Section C
Remuneration Policy
Remuneration Principles
The Group’s Executive Director remuneration 
philosophy is to ensure that executive remuneration 
is: aligned to the Group’s purpose, values and 
culture; supports strategy; promotes the long-term 
success of the Group; properly reflects the duties and 
responsibilities of the Executives; and is structured 
to attract, retain and motivate individuals of the 
highest quality from its international talent market. 
Remuneration includes performance-related elements 
designed to align Directors’ interests with those of 
shareholders and to promote long-term sustainable 
growth and performance at the highest levels in line 
with the Group’s strategy.
A significant proportion of Executive Directors’ potential 
remuneration is based on short-term and long-term 
performance-related incentive programmes. By 
incorporating these elements, the Remuneration 
Committee believes that the interests and risk appetite 
of the Executive Directors are properly aligned 
with the interests of the shareholders and other 
stakeholders. When approving remuneration outturns, 
the Committee exercises independent judgement and 
discretion, taking account of Group and individual 
performance as well as the shareholder experience, 
environmental, governance and social matters and 
wider workforce pay conditions to ensure that it is 
fair and appropriate for the role, experience of the 
individual, responsibilities and performance delivered.
Drivers of Shareholder Return
As outlined in the Strategic Report on page 25, Volume 
Growth and Margin Expansion are the main drivers 
of Adjusted Earnings Per Share (EPS) which is the key 
performance metric for measuring growth. Return on 
Average Capital Employed (ROACE) is a key measure of 
how efficiently the Group employs its available capital. 
Cash Conversion is an important indicator of the cash 
the Group generates for reinvestment or for return to 
shareholders.
These are the main Group metrics included in the 
Executive Directors’ Short-Term Incentive Plan (STIP) 
and Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) underpinned 
by the Group’s sustainability metrics. Together these 
metrics drive positive Total Shareholder Return which 
aligns the interests of the Executive Directors with 
those of shareholders. Our remuneration philosophy 
also supports our long-term approach by deferring 
a significant part of short and long-term variable 
remuneration into share awards, which provides clear 
alignment with the long-term interests of shareholders, 
together with requiring Executive Directors to acquire 
and maintain significant shareholdings in the Group.
In designing the Remuneration Policy, the Committee considered the best practice features detailed in the  
2018 UK Corporate Governance Code as follows:
Matters
Examples
Clarity
The Committee is committed to having a transparent approach to pay, by engaging regularly 
with Executives, shareholders and their representative bodies in order to explain the approach 
to executive pay and how it links to the Kerry strategy. We are also committed to clear and 
transparent disclosure on all aspects of executive remuneration.
The Committee is informed of the feedback from the workforce in relation to executive and 
workforce remuneration matters through regular updates provided by the Chief Human 
Resources Officer and the designated Workforce Engagement Director.
Simplicity
The Committee considers that the Remuneration Policy is simple and easy to understand. 
The Remuneration Policy is aligned with the strategy and business model of the Group. The 
Committee has purposefully avoided any complex structures which have the potential to be 
misunderstood and deliver unintended outturns.
Risk
The Remuneration Policy is designed to discourage inappropriate risk taking and ensure that 
this is not rewarded. This is achieved by (i) the balanced use of both short-term and long-term 
incentive plans which employ a blend of financial, non-financial and shareholder return targets 
(ii) the significant role played by equity in our incentive plans together with shareholding 
requirements (iii) malus and clawback provisions and (iv) the ability of the Committee to utilise 
discretion to adjust formulaic outturns to ensure outturns are aligned to, and are reflective of, 
the underlying business performance of the Group.
Predictability
Executive Directors’ remuneration is subject to individual participation caps, with our share-
based plans also subject to market standard dilution limits. The scenario charts on page 111 
illustrate how the rewards potentially receivable by our Executive Directors vary based on 
performance delivered and share price growth.
Proportionality
There is a clear link between individual rewards, delivery of strategy and long-term 
performance. In addition, the significant role played by ‘at risk‘ pay delivered through the STIP 
and LTIP, together with the structure of the Executive Directors’ service contracts, ensures that 
poor performance is not rewarded.
Alignment to  
Culture
Kerry has a relentless focus on delivering for our shareholders and other stakeholders and 
this is fully aligned with our Remuneration Policy in that employee personal success is directly 
linked to the success of the Group through the short-term and long-term incentive plans and 
targets we operate.
The Committee is satisfied the Remuneration Policy is fully aligned with the Group’s diverse, 
entrepreneurial and results focused culture which is underpinned by our Values of Courage, 
Enterprising Spirit, Inclusiveness, Open-mindedness and Ownership.
The Company is operating its remuneration arrangements in line with the approved Remuneration Policy, which 
came into effect in 2024 and will apply for up to three years. The Committee is comfortable that the policy 
remains appropriate in supporting the Group’s strategy and currently believes that no changes will be required 
prior to the triennial vote at the 2027 AGM. The current policy is reproduced below for ease of reference.
Volume 
Growth
Margin
Expansion
ROACE
Cash 
Conversion
Return
Share 
Price
Dividend/ 
Share  
Buyback
EPS
Total 
Shareholder 
Return
Growth
Underpinned by Sustainability Measures
In line with best practice, malus and clawback 
provisions apply to the Executive Directors’ STIP and 
LTIP awards.
Remuneration Policy
Consistent with the Group’s commitment to comply 
with best corporate governance practice, and with our 
existing three year cycle, Kerry’s current Remuneration 
Policy was submitted to a non-binding advisory vote 
at the 2024 Annual General Meeting, one year earlier 
than required under the Shareholder Rights Directive as 
enacted in Ireland.
As an Irish incorporated company, Kerry is not obliged 
to comply with the UK legislation which requires UK 
companies to submit their remuneration policies to a 
binding shareholder vote every three years or earlier if 
changes are required prior to this. 
Similarly, Kerry is not required to comply with the 
remuneration reporting regulation contained in 
Schedule 8 of the Large and Medium-sized Companies 
and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008 
(as amended) but follows the requirements as a matter 
of best practice unless they conflict with Irish or other 
legal requirements or there are other reasons why it is 
considered not practical to do so.
In setting remuneration levels, the Committee has 
regard to FTSE 100 companies of comparable scale 
and complexity, and also to US and European sector 
peer companies (as secondary sources) to reflect the 
markets in which we compete for leadership talent. The 
Committee also considers workforce remuneration and 
related policies and employment conditions elsewhere 
in the Group.
105
104
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Remuneration Policy Table
The following table details the approved Remuneration Policy for the Executive Directors for the period 2024  
to 2026:
Purpose and Link  
to Strategy
Operation
Opportunity
Performance 
Metrics
Basic Salary
Reflects the value of the 
individual, their skills and 
experience.
Competitive salaries are set 
to promote the long-term 
success of the Group and 
attract, retain and motivate 
Executive Directors to deliver 
strong performance for 
the Group in line with the 
Group’s strategic objectives.
•	 Remuneration Committee sets the 
basic salary and benefits of each 
Executive Director.
•	 Determined after taking into 
account a number of elements 
including the Executive Directors’ 
performance, experience and level 
of responsibility.
•	 Paid monthly in Ireland and bi-
weekly in the US.
•	 Salary is referenced to job 
responsibility and internal/external 
market data.
•	 Set at a level to 
attract, retain and 
motivate Executive 
Directors.
•	 Typically reviewed 
annually with 
increases normally set 
by reference to the 
wider workforce in the 
relevant market.
•	 Full review undertaken 
every three years.
•	 Not applicable.
Benefits
To provide a competitive 
benefit package aligned with 
the role and responsibilities 
of Executive Directors.
•	 These benefits primarily relate to 
the use of a company car or a car 
allowance.
•	 Not applicable.
•	 Not applicable.
Pension
To provide competitive 
retirement benefits to 
attract and retain Executive 
Directors.
•	 Pension arrangements may vary 
based on the Executive Director’s 
location.
•	 Irish resident Executive Directors 
participate in the general employee 
defined contribution pension 
scheme or receive a contribution to 
an after-tax savings scheme (where 
the lifetime earnings cap has been 
reached) or receive a taxable cash 
alternative based on a percentage of 
basic salary.
•	 The existing Executive Director in 
the US participates in the Group’s 
defined benefit and defined 
contribution pension schemes.
•	 The pension 
contribution rates for 
incumbent Executive 
Directors are set at 
10% of basic salary, 
in line with the wider 
workforce rate in 
Ireland.
•	 The maximum 
company pension 
contribution rate 
for new Executive 
Director appointments 
is aligned to that of 
the wider workforce 
rate.
•	 Not applicable.
Short-Term Incentive Plan (STIP)
To incentivise the 
achievement, on an annual 
basis, of key performance 
metrics and short-term goals 
beneficial to the Group, 
the delivery of the Group’s 
strategy and value creation 
for all stakeholders.
One third of the award is 
deferred in shares/share 
options providing a two-year 
retention element and aligns 
Executive Directors interests 
with shareholders’ interests.
•	 Achievement of predetermined 
performance targets set by the 
Remuneration Committee.
•	 Performance targets aligned to the 
Group’s published strategic goals 
with the targets and weightings for 
financial and non-financial metrics 
subject to annual review.
•	 Two thirds of the award is payable  
in cash.
•	 One third of the award is awarded 
by way of shares/share options to 
be issued two years after vesting 
following a deferral period.
•	 Malus and clawback provisions are 
in place for awards under the STIP 
(see page 109).
•	 Maximum opportunity 
is 200% of basic 
salary.
•	 Target opportunity 
is 50% of maximum 
opportunity for on-
target performance.
•	 Threshold 
performance results 
in a STIP payable at 
0% of maximum.
For FY 2025
•	 Volume Growth
•	 Margin 
Expansion
•	 Cash Conversion
•	 Strategic 
Objectives
Purpose and Link  
to Strategy
Operation
Opportunity
Performance 
Metrics
Long-Term incentive Plan (LTIP)
Retention of key personnel 
and incentivisation of 
sustained performance 
against key Group strategic 
metrics over a longer period 
of time.
Share-based to provide 
alignment with shareholder 
interests.
A two-year post vesting 
deferral requirement aligns 
Executive Directors’ interests 
with shareholders’ interests.
•	 Conditional awards over shares or 
share options.
•	 The awards vest depending on a 
number of performance metrics 
being met over a performance 
period of at least three years.
•	 Following vesting, 100% of the 
earned award is deferred for a 
period of up to two years (i.e. to 
ensure a combined performance 
period and deferral period of five 
years).
•	 Malus and clawback provisions are 
in place for awards under LTIP (see 
page 109).
•	 Maximum opportunity 
is up to 375% of basic 
salary.
For FY 2025
•	 Adjusted Earnings 
Per Share “EPS”
•	 Total Shareholder 
Return “TSR”
•	 Return on 
Average Capital 
Employed 
“ROACE”
•	 Sustainability 
Metrics
Shareholding Requirement
Maintain alignment of the 
interests of the shareholders 
and the Executive 
Directors and demonstrate 
commitment over the long-
term.
•	 Executive Directors are required 
to build and to hold shares in the 
Company to a minimum level set in 
relation to the LTIP opportunity and 
expressed as a percentage of their 
basic salary.
•	 Shareholding requirement to be 
satisfied through retention of a 
minimum of 50% of vested STIP 
and LTIP shares (excluding the sale 
of shares to cover tax on vesting), 
until the shareholding requirement 
is met.
•	 A post-employment shareholding 
requirement obliges Executive 
Directors to hold the lower of (i) their 
actual shareholding and (ii) their 
in-service shareholding requirement 
for two years post-employment. 
Applies to shares acquired from 
awards granted after 2021 and does 
not apply to own purchased shares.
•	 300%-375% of basic 
salary.
•	 Not applicable.
107
106
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
How Remuneration Links with Strategy 
Performance 
Measures
Strategic Priority
Incentive Scheme
Volume Growth
Key driver of revenue growth
STIP
Margin Expansion
Key driver of profit growth
STIP
Cash Conversion
Cash generation for reinvestment or return to shareholders
STIP
Strategic Objectives
Development and execution of business strategies
STIP
Adjusted EPS Growth
Delivery of the Group’s long-term growth strategy
LTIP
TSR
Delivery of shareholder value
LTIP
ROACE
Balance growth and return
LTIP
Sustainability
Core to our strategy and long-term sustainable performance
LTIP
Malus/Clawback
The Committee has the discretion to reduce or 
impose further conditions on the STIP and LTIP 
awards prior to vesting (malus). The Committee 
further has the discretion to recover incentives paid 
within a period of two years from vesting (clawback). 
The timeframe over which clawback may apply is 
considered appropriate by the Committee, as it 
reflects the period over which the Group’s processes 
and systems are likely to flag any occurrence of any 
of the key trigger events.
The key trigger events for the use of malus and 
clawback provisions include material misstatement 
of the Group’s audited financial results, serious 
wrongdoing, payment made on the basis of 
erroneous data, gross misconduct, serious 
reputational damage and corporate failure.
Any recalculation of the award shall be effected in 
such manner and subject to such procedures as the 
Group determines to be measured and appropriate, 
including repayment of any excess incentive or offset 
against any amounts due or potentially due to the 
participant under any vested or unvested incentive 
awards.
The Company retains the right to apply the malus 
and clawback provisions to STIP and LTIP awards 
held or vested to former directors. Other elements of 
remuneration are not subject to malus or clawback 
provisions.
Committee Discretion
The Committee has discretion to adjust the formulaic 
outturns under STIP and LTIP, both upwards and 
downwards, to ensure outturns are aligned to and 
are reflective of the underlying business performance 
of the Group.
In line with plan rules, the Committee may, at its 
discretion, amend or vary the performance metrics 
of the STIP and LTIP, the calculation methodology for 
those performance metrics and the composition of 
the TSR peer group when appropriate, in the interest 
of alignment and fairness.
Service Contracts
The CEO and Executive Directors have service contracts 
in place which can be terminated by either party 
giving up to 12 months’ notice. In addition, all service 
contracts include pay in lieu of notice, non-compete 
and non-solicitation provisions of up to 12 months 
post departure, accompanied by such payments as are 
considered necessary or appropriate to sustain such 
provisions, in order to protect the Group’s customer 
base, employees and intellectual property.
No ex-gratia severance payments are provided for in 
respect of the CEO or Executive Directors.
 
Payments for Loss of Office
In the event of a Director’s departure, the Group’s 
policy on termination is as follows:
•	 the Group will pay any amounts it is required to 
make in accordance with or in settlement of a 
Director’s statutory employment rights and in line 
with their employment agreement;
•	 the Group will seek to ensure that no more is paid 
than is warranted in each individual case;
•	 	STIP and LTIP awards will be paid out in line with 
plan rules on exit (i.e. for good leavers as defined 
in the LTIP rules), with awards normally prorated to 
reflect the proportion of the performance period 
that has elapsed on the date of cessation, and 
subject to performance and a two-year deferral 
requirement; and
•	 	other payments, such as legal or other professional 
fees, repatriation or relocation costs and/or 
outplacement fees, may be paid if it is considered 
appropriate and at the discretion of the 
Committee.
A Director’s service contract may be terminated 
without notice and without any further payment or 
compensation, except for sums accrued up to the 
date of termination, on the occurrence of certain 
events such as gross misconduct.
Remuneration Policy for Recruitment of New  
Executive Directors
The Remuneration Committee will determine the 
contractual terms for new Executive Directors, 
subject to appropriate professional advice to ensure 
that these reflect best practice and are subject to the 
limits specified in the Group’s approved policy as set 
out in this report.
Salary levels for new Executive Directors will take into 
account the experience and calibre of the individual. 
Where it is appropriate to offer a lower salary initially, 
a series of increases to the desired salary positioning 
may be made over subsequent years (even if higher 
than the average increase awarded to the wider 
workforce), subject to individual performance and 
development in the role.
Pension and benefits will be provided in line with 
the approved policy, with relocation, travel or other 
expenses provided if necessary.
The structure of the variable pay element will be in 
accordance with and subject to the limits set out in 
the Group’s approved policy detailed above. Different 
performance metrics may be set initially for STIP in 
the year an Executive Director joins the Group taking 
into account the responsibilities of the individual and 
the point in the financial year they join the Board. 
Subject to the rules of the scheme, an LTIP award 
may be granted after joining the Group.
Selection of performance targets
STIP
•	 Financial performance targets under the STIP are set by the Remuneration Committee with 
reference to the prior year, current year budget, prevailing market conditions and medium-term 
financial targets. They align with the Group’s strategic objectives while also ensuring the long-term 
operational and financial stability of the Group. Targets are set at appropriately stretching levels to 
achieve threshold, target and maximum payout levels. Performance targets are based predominately 
on the financial metrics of Volume Growth, Margin Expansion and Cash Conversion (amounting to 
80% of maximum opportunity).
•	 Volume Growth and Margin Expansion are key performance metrics as they are the main drivers 
of Adjusted EPS Growth. Cash Conversion is key to ensuring there are sufficient funds available for 
reinvestment or for return to shareholders.
•	 Strategic objectives (amounting to 20% of maximum opportunity) are relevant to each Executive 
Director’s specific area of responsibility and are key in ensuring focus on the strategic and functional 
priorities of the business including relevant sustainability priorities.
•	 Due to commercial sensitivity, the Committee believes it would be detrimental to the Company 
to disclose targets in advance of or during the relevant performance period. The Committee will 
disclose the targets and performance against them in the Remuneration Report following the end of 
the performance year.
LTIP
•	 The performance targets under the LTIP are set to reflect the Group’s longer-term growth objectives 
and at a level where maximum vesting represents genuine outperformance. The performance 
measures are currently based on Adjusted EPS Growth, TSR, ROACE and Sustainability metrics.
•	 Adjusted EPS Growth is a key performance metric encompassing all the components of growth 
important to the Group’s stakeholders. EPS Growth is driven by the STIP metrics, Volume Growth 
and Margin Expansion. TSR is an important indicator of how successful the Group has been in terms 
of shareholder value creation. ROACE represents a good perspective on the Group’s internal rate of 
return and financial added value for shareholders. ROACE supports the strategic focus on growth and 
margins through ensuring cash is reinvested to generate appropriate returns. Sustainability metrics, 
which are core to maintaining our strategy and long-term sustainable performance, are reviewed at 
the time of each award.
109
108
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
If it is necessary to buyout incentive or benefit 
arrangements (which would be forfeited on leaving 
the previous employer) in the case of an external 
appointment, this would be provided for taking into 
account the payment vehicle (cash or shares), as well 
as the timing and expected value (i.e. likelihood of 
meeting any existing performance criteria) of the 
remuneration being forfeited. The general policy is 
that payment should be no more than the Committee 
considers is required to provide reasonable 
compensation for remuneration being forfeited. The 
Group’s policy is that the period of notice for new 
Executive Directors should not exceed 12 months and 
should include pay in lieu of notice, non-compete and 
non-solicitation provisions to protect the Group.
The Committee will ensure that any arrangements 
agreed will be in the best interests of the Group and 
shareholders.
Change of Control
Outstanding STIP and LTIP shares/share options 
would normally vest and become exercisable on a 
change of control, subject to plan rules, including the 
satisfaction of any performance conditions and pro- 
rating. The Committee may exercise its discretion 
to vary the level of vesting having regard to the 
circumstances and reasons for the events giving rise  
to the change of control.
Alignment with Workforce Pay and Policies
There is strong alignment between how we set pay 
for our Executive Directors and the wider workforce, 
as well as clear alignment in the mechanics of how 
we operate our pay review process and design our 
benefit and incentive plans. The key difference 
in remuneration structures is that, overall, the 
Remuneration Policy for the Executive Directors 
is more heavily weighted towards variable pay 
compared to other employees.
An update on wider workforce remuneration is tabled 
as a specific agenda item at every Remuneration 
Committee meeting to enable the Committee to 
consider the wider workforce experience when 
setting the Remuneration Policy for Executive 
Directors and making executive remuneration 
decisions.
The Remuneration Policy provides an overview of 
the structure that operates for the Group’s Executive 
Directors and senior management. Differences 
in quantum will depend on size of the role and 
responsibility, the location of the role and local 
market practice. Senior management are invited to 
participate in both the STIP and LTIP to incentivise 
performance through the achievement of short-term 
and long-term objectives and through the holding of 
shares in the Group.
 
To further strengthen the alignment between 
Executive Directors and the wider workforce, 
employees can participate in an All Employee Share 
Plan (‘OurShare’) which was launched in 2023 to 8 
countries and further expanded to an additional 16 
countries in 2024. The Committee and the Board 
believe that share ownership is a powerful and 
important way of creating an ownership culture and 
mindset. Plans are well underway in preparation for 
our Phase 3 roll out in 2025 which will focus on the 
remaining countries representing another significant 
milestone for Kerry. See page 16 for further details 
on the OurShare All Employee Share Plan.
Consultation with Employees
Our approach to employee engagement is set out 
in detail on page 76 including the approach to 
understanding the views of our wider workforce.  
Ms. Emer Gilvarry, Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee, is also the designated Workforce 
Engagement Director, and she works closely with 
our Chief Human Resources Officer to provide the 
Committee with regular updates on engagement 
with, and feedback from, employees.
When setting remuneration for Executive Directors 
the Committee takes into account the remuneration 
structures, policies and practices in the Group as a 
whole, the feedback from employee engagement 
activities and the information provided by our 
external advisors. The Group has a number of 
different channels for engagement including an 
engagement survey, targeted pulse checks with 
specific employee groups, regular town halls, a 
dedicated digital employee communication platform 
and our Speak Up facility. The Committee continually 
reviews and enhances these channels to enable 
the Committee to engage more effectively with 
the workforce to explain the alignment between 
Executive Directors’ Remuneration Policy and the 
pay policy and practices applicable to the wider 
workforce. In addition, through OurShare, employees 
are able to become shareholders in Kerry and 
exercise their voting rights as shareholders on all 
resolutions submitted for approval at the Annual 
General Meeting.
Consultation with Shareholders
The Committee considers the guidelines issued by 
major institutional shareholders and the bodies 
representing them, the guidelines and feedback 
provided by proxy advisors and direct feedback 
from shareholders, when completing its annual 
and triennial review of the Group’s Executive 
Remuneration policies and practices.
The Committee is committed to continued 
consultation with shareholders regarding the 
Remuneration Policy and its implementation.
Non-Executive Directors’ Remuneration 
Policy
Non-Executive Directors’ fees, (other than the Board 
Chair’s fee, which is determined by the Committee), 
are determined by the Executive Directors to fairly 
reflect the responsibilities and time spent by the 
non-Executive Directors on the Group’s affairs. In 
determining the fees, which are set within the limits 
approved by shareholders, consideration is given to 
both the complexity of the Group and the level of 
fees paid to non-Executive Directors in comparable 
companies. Fees are reviewed on an annual basis 
and the base fee is typically increased in line with the 
increase available to the wider workforce in Ireland. A 
detailed benchmark review is carried out on a three-
year basis and any recommendations are presented 
to the Executive Directors for approval.
Non-Executive Directors do not participate in the 
Group’s incentive plans, pension arrangements or 
other elements of remuneration provided to the 
Executive Directors. Non-Executive Directors are 
reimbursed for travel and accommodation expenses 
(and any personal tax that may be due on those 
expenses). Non-Executive Directors are encouraged 
to build up a shareholding in the Company.
Illustration of Remuneration Policy
The following diagrams show the minimum, 
target, maximum and maximum +50% share 
appreciation, composition balance between the 
fixed and variable remuneration components for 
each Executive Director, effective for 2025. For 
illustration purposes, target performance for LTIP 
is reflected as 50% of maximum opportunity. The 
innermost circle represents the minimum potential 
scenario for remuneration, with the second circle 
representing target, the third circle representing 
maximum potential opportunity and the outer circle 
representing maximum potential opportunity plus 
50% increase in the LTIP share value.
The charts above exclude the effect of any 
Company share price appreciation except 
in the ‘maximum +50%’  scenario.
 Basic Salary    Pension & Benefits
 STIP    LTIP
11%
15%
25%
64%
54%
46%
2%
23%
2%
29%
25%
4%
87%
13%
Edmond Scanlon
13%
16%
27%
59%
49%
41%
2%
26%
2%
33%
28%
4%
88%
12%
Marguerite Larkin
13%
16%
27%
59%
49%
41%
2%
26%
3%
32%
27%
5%
85%
15%
Gerry Behan
111
110
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Section D
Remuneration Policy Implementation
Part I: Remuneration Policy Implementation 
2025
This section of the report sets out how the 
Remuneration Policy, as described on pages 104-111, 
will operate in 2025.
Basic Salary and Benefits
The salaries of the Executive Directors effective for 
the year commencing on 1 March 2025, together with 
the comparative figures for 2024, are as follows:
Directors
2025 
€’000*
2024 
€’000*
 Increase 
%
Edmond Scanlon
1,379
1,335
3.3%
Marguerite Larkin
853
825
3.3%
$’000*
$’000*
 Increase 
%
Gerry Behan
1,136
1,100
3.3%
* The numbers above reflect rounding
For 2025, the basic salaries of the three Executive 
Directors will be increased by 3.3%. In line with 
the approach taken last year, the increases for 
the Executive Directors are again below the 
2025 increases available for the wider workforce 
population in Ireland and the US (both at 3.5%), with 
higher increases available for lower-paid employees 
or where market adjustments are required to 
maintain appropriate competitive positioning.
Benefits relate primarily to the use of a company 
car/car allowance. Any travel arrangements or travel 
costs required for business purposes will also be met   
by the Group, on a net of tax basis.
Pensions
The CEO participates in the general employee Irish 
defined contribution scheme and the CFO receives 
a taxable cash allowance based on a percentage 
of basic salary, in lieu of pension. The CEO T&N 
participates in a US-defined contribution scheme and 
a US-defined benefit pension scheme.
The pension contribution rate for Executive Directors 
is aligned to that of Kerry’s wider workforce in Ireland 
(currently a rate of 10%).
 
Short-Term Incentive Plan (STIP)
A review of the STIP metrics was completed in 2024 
to ensure that they remain appropriate, are linked to 
strategy, consistent with best practice and that the 
targets are appropriately calibrated. The Committee 
concluded that no changes are required to the 
metrics and weightings for 2025. 
The maximum STIP opportunity remains the same 
as 2024, at 200% of basic salary for the CEO, CFO and 
CEO Taste & Nutrition.
2025 STIP – Performance Metrics and Weightings
% of award
Group Metrics
Target
Max
Volume Growth
15%
30%
Margin Expansion
12.5%
25%
Cash Conversion
12.5%
25%
Strategic Objectives
10%
20%
Total
50%
100%
The Committee is of the view that a 50% of maximum 
award payout for on-target performance is 
appropriate, taking into account the level of stretch 
in the targets set. Due to the commercial sensitivity 
of the financial metrics and strategic objectives, 
the Committee believes it would be detrimental to 
the Company to disclose the targets in advance of, 
or during, the relevant performance period. The 
Committee will disclose the targets and performance 
against them in next year’s Remuneration Report.
Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP)
A review of the LTIP design and metrics was also 
completed in 2024. The Committee concluded that 
the current metrics and weightings continue to be 
closely aligned with the key value drivers for the 
Group and will therefore remain unchanged for 2025.
Consistent with the Committee’s proven track 
record of demonstrating rigour and discipline, a 
review of the target calibrations for 2025 was also 
completed. The Committee concluded that the 
targets set for EPS, ROACE and TSR for the 2024 
award continue to be appropriate in the context of 
the award opportunities in place, and reflect levels 
of performance that represent genuine stretch in 
the context of our strategic plan and external market 
conditions. Therefore, the financial performance 
ranges set for the 2025 LTIP will remain unchanged 
from those set for the 2024 award. 
The Committee adjusted the target ranges for the 
sustainability metrics as the Group moves another 
year closer to the targets included in the Beyond 
the Horizon sustainability strategy and to reflect the 
changes in our portfolio during the year.
LTIP Award Year
2025
Performance Metrics
Threshold
Maximum
EPS (40% weighting)1
Kerry’s EPS growth per 
annum
5%
11%
% of award which vests
25%
100%
ROACE (15% weighting)
ROACE achieved
9%
13%
% of award which vests
25%
100%
Relative TSR (25% weighting)
Position of Kerry in peer 
group2
Median
75th 
percentile 
and above
% of award which vests
25%
100%
Sustainability  
(20% weighting)3
Nutrition Reach Goal
1.36bn
1.52bn
Carbon Reduction
50%
52%
Food Waste Reduction
35%
40%
% of award which vests
25%
100%
1 Adjusted EPS is measured on a constant currency basis.
2 The TSR Peer Group companies are listed on page 118.
3 The sustainability metrics listed have a weighting of 8%, 6% 
and 6% respectively. This disclosure addresses ESRS 2 GOV-3 
29 d as referenced in the Sustainability Statement on page 
132 - subject to limited assurance.
The Committee is satisfied that the target ranges 
are appropriately stretching particularly given 
the current economic environment as well as 
overall weak consumer demand and subdued 
market growth rates. When setting the targets, the 
Committee also considered market expectations for 
future performance, the impact of M&A multiples 
on return-on-investment outcomes, the level of 
capital expenditure required to support future 
growth ambitions, performance achieved against the 
previous targets set and the medium-term targets 
included in the latest strategic plan (see pages 24-25).
See Group Key Performance Indicators (KPIs) on 
pages 26-27 for more information on the link 
between performance metrics used for incentive 
purposes and the Group’s Strategic Plan.
The Remuneration Policy approved in 2024 included 
an increase in the maximum LTIP opportunity, to be 
implemented on a phased basis over two years. In 
line with this, the second phase of the increase will 
be implemented in 2025 and each Executive Director 
will be awarded their maximum LTIP opportunity 
as follows; CEO 375% of basic salary (from 340%), 
CFO and CEO Taste & Nutrition 300% of basic salary 
(from 275%).
Non-Executive Director Remuneration Review
For 2025, no substantial increases are proposed 
and, in line with the Remuneration Policy, an annual 
increase of 3.3% will be applied to the base fee paid 
to the Chairman and non-Executive Directors. This 
increase is lower than the increase available to the 
wider workforce in Ireland.
The following fees will be applied effective 1 March 
2025:
Fee Type1
2025 Fees 
€’000
2024 Fees 
€’000
Chairman’s Fee
435
422
Non-Executive Director  
Base Fee
95
92
1 There are no changes to the Committee membership, 
Committee Chair fees or any other fees. The numbers above 
reflect rounding.
113
112
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Part II: Remuneration Policy Outturn 2024
Disclosures regarding Directors’ remuneration have been drawn up on an individual Director basis in 
accordance with the requirements of the 2014 Irish Companies Act, the EU Shareholder Rights Directive, 
the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code, the Irish Corporate Governance Annex, the Euronext Dublin Stock 
Exchange and the UK Listing Authority.
The information in the tables 1, 4, 5, 6 and 7 below including relevant footnotes (identified as audited) forms 
an integral part of the audited consolidated financial statements, as described in the basis of preparation on 
page 252. All other information in the Remuneration Report is additional disclosure and does not form an 
integral part of the audited consolidated financial statements.
Executive Directors’ Remuneration
Table 1: Individual Remuneration for the year ended 31 December 2024 (Audited)
Irish Based Directors  
Euros
US Based Director  
US Dollars
Edmond Scanlon 
CEO
Marguerite Larkin  
CFO
Gerry Behan6  
CEO T&N
2024 
€’000
2023 
€’000
2024 
€’000
2023 
€’000
2024 
$’000
2023 
$’000
Basic Salary1
1,327
1,283
821
793
1,092
1,053
Benefits2
74
74
35
35
87
80
Pensions3
133
128
82
79
110
103
Total Fixed Remuneration
1,534
1,485
938
907
1,289
1,236
% Fixed v Total
25%
32%
27%
35%
27%
36%
STIP4
2,601
1,822
1,608
986
2,141
1,308
LTIP5
1,907
1,287
983
716
1,265
848
Total Variable Remuneration
4,508
3,109
2,591
1,702
3,406
2,156
% Variable v Total
75%
68%
73%
65%
73%
64%
Total Remuneration
6,042
4,594
3,529
2,609
4,695
3,392
€’000
€’000
4,307
3,112
1 Annual pay increases are effective from 1st March each year.
2 These benefits primarily relate to the use of a company car or a car allowance.
3 The pension figure for Edmond Scanlon relates to Irish defined contribution pension benefits. Marguerite Larkin received a taxable 
cash payment in lieu of pension benefits. The pension figure for Gerry Behan includes both defined benefit and defined contribution 
retirement benefits. The employer pension contribution in 2024 for all Executive Directors was 10% of their basic salaries.
4 The 2024 STIP amount represents two thirds delivered in cash with one third delivered by way of shares/share options which are 
deferred for two years.
5 The share price used to calculate the value of the LTIP is the average share price for the three months up to the end of the year 
being reported. The negative share price movement versus that applicable at the date the conditional awards were granted has 
decreased the valuation of the awards (that will vest in 2025) over the three years by (€117k) for Edmond Scanlon, (€60k) for 
Marguerite Larkin and by (€71k) for Gerry Behan. The LTIP included in this table for 2024 was awarded in 2022.
6 The table shows the Executive Director’s pay in the currency of payment to ensure clarity in reflecting the year-on-year payment 
comparisons.
7 The total remuneration for Executive Directors was €13,878k (2023: €10,315k) using a US dollar exchange rate of 1.09 (2023: 1.09).
Basic Salary Increases
Effective 1 March 2024, Edmond Scanlon’s basic salary as CEO was increased by 3.5% and the basic salaries 
of Marguerite Larkin and Gerry Behan were increased by 3.5% and 3.75% respectively. These increases were 
below the increases for the wider workforce in Ireland (3.75%) and the US (4.0%) respectively. 
Annual Incentive Outturns (STIP)
Table 2: STIP Achievement Against Targets
Financial Metrics (CEO, CFO, and CEO T&N – 80% weighting)
Metric
1. Volume Growth1  
(30% weighting)
2. Margin Expansion2 
(25% weighting)
3. Cash Conversion  
(25% weighting)
Taste & Nutrition
Group
Group
Targets
Threshold
0%
0 bps
70%
Target
1.0%
+50 bps
80%
Max
3.0%
+70 bps
90%
Actual performance
3.4%
+90 bps
95%
Bonus outturn
30%
25%
25%
Link to strategy
Volume Growth is a key 
performance metric as it 
is one of the main drivers 
of Adjusted EPS Growth
EBITDA Margin 
Expansion is a key 
performance metric as 
it is also a main driver of 
Adjusted EPS Growth
Cash Conversion is key 
to ensuring there are 
sufficient funds available 
for reinvestment or for 
return to shareholders
1 The 2024 target for the Volume Growth metric was set at the Taste & Nutrition segment level which accounts for 86% of Group revenues. 
The target excludes volume performance in the Dairy Ireland segment as the key performance measure for this business segment is 
EBITDA, given the impact of raw material supply variability on volumes each year.
2 The targets and actual performance for the EBITDA Margin Expansion metric exclude the mathematical effect of implementing selling 
price increases/decreases to maintain cash margin in light of input cost inflation/deflation (+30 bps).
When setting the targets above, the Committee 
considered them to be appropriately stretching and, if 
achieved, reflective of a good underlying performance.
The target level set for the volume metric took account 
of a relatively flat market volume growth rate in 
2023, which was anticipated to remain challenged 
and uncertain through 2024, given muted overall 
consumer demand following a number of years 
of significant inflationary pressures. The actual 
volume growth rate achieved was 3.4%, which in 
the Committee’s opinion, reflects strong market 
outperformance driven by success in innovation and 
renovation across a wide customer base, especially 
within the foodservice channel. 
The targets also took account of the targets in the 
medium-term plan, planned investments (both capital 
and operational) that the Group is making to enable 
revenue growth and margin expansion, as well as 
necessary working capital investments to mitigate 
ongoing global supply chain challenges.
Strategic Objectives – 20% weighting
The Executive Directors are also measured against 
strategic objectives. Performance against these 
objectives is determined by the Committee by reference 
to key targets agreed with the Executives at the start 
of the year. The table below sets out the performance 
outturn for the strategic element of the STIP.
Metric
4. Strategic Objectives (All – 20% weighting)
CEO
CFO
CEO T&N
Targets
Threshold
0
0
0
Target
10
10
10
Max
20
20
20
Actual performance
18
18
18
Metric outturn
18%
18%
18%
Link to strategy
Specific to the Executive Directors’ responsibilities and linked to strategic plan implementation.
115
114
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Details of Strategic Objectives
The Committee reviewed progress against these objectives and concluded that strong progress was made by  
the Executive Directors against the objectives outlined below, which resulted in an above-target outcome.
Strategic 
Objective
Performance Assessment
CEO
Achievement: 18% (90%)
Portfolio & 
Strategy
•	 Completed the acquisition of part of the global lactase enzymes business of Novonesis in April 
2024, to expand biotechnology solutions capability and to extend enzyme capability  
and footprint.
•	 Divested Kerry Dairy Ireland to Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited, representing a 
significant portfolio evolution to a pure play global taste & nutrition company.
•	 Continued success in commercialising market-leading technology innovation, including 
salt and sugar reduction capabilities, preservation and food safety solution capabilities and 
masking of proteins.
Operating 
Model & Digital 
Enablement
•	 Further strengthened commercial capability with significant improvements in quality, service, 
lead times, and customer relationships; enabling market outperformance in volume growth.
•	 Strengthened connectivity between Technology, Integrated Operations and Process Science to 
drive operational excellence and enable innovation. 
•	 Accelerate Operational Excellence Programme delivered targeted 2024 efficiencies.
•	 Enhanced execution of Digital strategy, with digital products such as KerryNow & Supply Chain 
decision intelligence delivering value.
Stakeholder 
Engagement
•	 Extensive shareholder and customer engagement throughout the year which, based on 
stakeholder feedback, was positively received.
•	 Award winning Kerry All-Employee Share Plan (‘OurShare’) extended to a further 16 countries, 
bringing the total to 24 countries, and covering 94% of employees.
•	 Proprietary ‘This Is Sustainable Nutrition’ programme launched to enhance leaders’ and 
employees’ understanding of Kerry Foundational Technologies.
•	 Two years into the four-year partnership with Concern Worldwide, 4,400 farmers have been 
trained, 150 acres opened for production, 46 jobs created, over 1,000 children health screened, 
and post-harvest waste reduced by 20%.
Leadership Team 
and Succession 
Planning
•	 Senior leadership capability further strengthened through targeted development, strategic 
sourcing and execution of succession plans including key Executive Leadership Team roles.
•	 Achieved 35% female representation at senior leadership one year ahead of schedule, with 
strong progress in achieving equal representation at senior management level by 2030 (now 
at 39%).
CFO
Achievement: 18% (90%)
Portfolio & 
Strategy
•	 Completed the acquisition of part of the global lactase enzymes business of Novonesis in  
April 2024, to expand biotechnology solutions capability and to extend our enzyme capability 
and footprint.
•	 Divested Kerry Dairy Ireland to Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited, representing a 
significant portfolio evolution to a pure play global taste & nutrition company.
•	 Continued success in commercialising market-leading technology innovation, including salt  
and sugar reduction capabilities, preservation and food safety solution capabilities and 
masking of proteins.
Operating 
Model & Digital 
Enablement
•	 Global Business Services (GBS) full maturity assessment completed and phase 2 programme to 
further leverage shared services established.
•	 Significant progress in embedding Digital & Automation across Finance and as an enabler of 
business performance (e.g. further simplification of Procure to Pay process, enhanced pricing  
& costing tools, enhanced capital planning system).
•	 Vision and operating model for the Finance function refreshed, underpinned by Digital and GBS. 
Stakeholder 
Engagement
•	 Extensive engagement with shareholders and financial institutions. Successful US Investor Day 
held in October 2024 showcasing Kerry’s strategy and portfolio.
•	 €3bn European medium-term note programme (EMTN) for future Euro bond issuances 
established. Successfully issued €1bn of new public bonds at competitive rates under this 
programme ahead of €1bn bond maturity arising in September 2025. The €1.5bn Revolving Credit 
Facility was also extended. 
•	 Building on the 2023 programme, two additional Share Buyback programmes commenced in 
2024 with the objective of returning €600m of cash to shareholders.
•	 Significant focus on sustainability performance management and reporting with cross functional 
team delivering Kerry’s first CSRD report for 2024.
Leadership Team 
and Succession 
Planning
•	 Global Finance Leadership Team capability further strengthened through rigorous succession 
planning, targeted development and strategic sourcing.
•	 Achieved 35% female representation at senior leadership one year ahead of schedule, with strong 
progress in achieving equal representation at senior management level by 2030 (now at 39%).
CEO T&N
Achievement: 18% (90%)
Portfolio & 
Strategy
•	 Completed the acquisition of part of the global lactase enzymes business of Novonesis in April 2024, 
to expand biotechnology solutions capability and to extend our enzyme capability and footprint.
•	 Continued success in commercialising market-leading technology innovation, including salt and 
sugar reduction, preservation & food safety solution capabilities and masking of proteins.
•	 Evolved our Supplements EUM growth strategy, enhancing our technology portfolio offering and 
bringing clarity to prioritised routes to market and specialist capability to execute per market.
Operating 
Model & Digital 
Enablement
•	 Continued to build business development and technical sales capability to accelerate growth in 
priority areas of focus: proactive health, preservation, authentic taste, sodium & salt reduction 
solutions and foodservice brands.
•	 Significant evolution of our Foundational Technology manufacturing and process technology 
capabilities and footprint, to enable the growth of our portfolio.
•	 Kerry digital platforms effectively leveraged to drive awareness and understanding of our 
evolving foundational technology capability, both internally and externally.
Stakeholder 
Engagement
•	 Extensive customer engagement to further build Kerry’s profile as a leader in Sustainable 
Nutrition, combined with expansion of our customer base, and extension to new channels/
markets, driving significant growth in our overall pipeline. 
•	 Strong progress in building Kerry’s reputation as a specialist, with participation at key industry 
forums and events (e.g. Vitafoods, Supply Side West Expo, International Production & Processing 
Expo (IPPE)).
•	 Proprietary ‘This Is Sustainable Nutrition’ programme launched to enhance leaders’ and 
employees’ understanding of Kerry Foundational Technologies.
Leadership Team 
and Succession 
Planning
•	 Foundational Technology Leadership Team capability further strengthened through rigorous 
succession planning, targeted development and strategic sourcing.
•	 Achieved 35% female representation at senior leadership one year ahead of schedule, with strong 
progress in achieving equal representation at senior management level by 2030 (now at 39%).
Discretion
The Committee concluded that there was no requirement to exercise discretion as the 2024 STIP outturns 
reflected the strong underlying performance of the business, the broader stakeholder experience and the strong 
performance of the Executive Directors and their delivery against the strategic objectives set.
Final Outturn for 2024
The targets for the Executive Directors, which were set by the Remuneration Committee, were challenging and 
stretching in the context of the economic environment, overall weak consumer demand and subdued market 
growth rates. For 2024 a payout of 98% of maximum opportunity was achieved by each Executive Director.
Under the Remuneration Policy, two thirds of the award is payable in cash and one third is awarded by way of 
shares/share options to be issued two years after vesting following a deferral period.
117
116
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP)
The terms and conditions of the plan were approved 
by shareholders at the 2021 AGM. The Remuneration 
Committee approves the terms, conditions and 
allocation of conditional awards under the Group’s 
LTIP to Executive Directors and senior management. 
Under this plan, Executive Directors and senior 
management are invited to participate in conditional 
awards over shares or share options in the Company.
2022 LTIP awards were made in March 2022. The 
market price of the shares at the date of the award to 
Executive Directors was €96.76.
The vesting of the 2022 LTIP is subject to 
performance metrics being met over a three-year 
performance period, and the continued employment 
of a participant to the vesting date. To the extent that 
these conditions are met, awards shall vest in March 
2025 and be subject to a further two-year deferral 
period. This provides for a combined performance 
period and deferral period of five years for the award 
to the extent it vests.
The proportion of each conditional award which vests 
will depend on the Adjusted EPS Growth, TSR, ROACE 
and Sustainability performance during the three-year 
performance period.
2022 LTIP Award
Set out below is the performance against targets 
for the 2022 LTIP award where the three-year 
performance period ended on 31 December 2024 
and the award vests in March 2025.
EPS Performance Test
40% of the award vests according to the Group’s 
average adjusted EPS growth (‘EPS metric‘) over 
the performance period. This measurement is 
determined by reference to the Group’s adjusted EPS 
growth calculated on a constant currency basis in 
each of the three financial years in the performance 
period in accordance with the vesting schedule 
outlined in the following table:
Average 
Adjusted EPS 
Growth
Percentage 
of the Award 
which vests
Threshold
6%
25%
Maximum
12%
100%
Below threshold none of the award vests. Vesting between 
threshold and maximum points is on a straight line basis.
Vesting Level for EPS Metric
The outturn of the EPS performance test is an 
average adjusted EPS growth of 9.6% which results 
in an award outcome of 28% out of a possible 
maximum of 40%. When calculating the outturn for 
this metric, the adjusted EPS growth % achieved 
used for 2022, 2023 and 2024 excludes the dilutive 
effect which the significant business disposals 
completed during the performance period (the 
Russian business and the Sweet Ingredients 
Portfolio) had on the reported result for the 
adjusted EPS growth metric as these disposals were 
not anticipated when the targets were originally set 
three years ago. The reported adjusted EPS growth 
for 2022 at 7.3%,  2023 at 1.2% and 2024 at 9.7% 
recognised a dilution impact of these disposals of  
7.6%, 3.0% and 0.1% respectively.
TSR Performance Test
25% of the award vests according to the Group’s TSR 
performance over the period measured against the 
TSR performance of a peer group of listed companies 
over the same three-year performance period. The peer 
group consists of Kerry and the following companies:
Chr.Hansen**
Givaudan
Kellogg’s/ Kellanova*
Sensient Technologies
Barry Callebaut
Glanbia
McCormick & Co.
Symrise
Corbion
Greencore**
Nestlé
Tate & Lyle
Ingredion
Danone
Novozymes**
Unilever
General Mills
IFF
Premier Foods**
*   For awards granted from 2023 onwards, Kellogg’s / 
Kellanova will be removed from the peer group, following 
its acquisition by private company Mars, Inc, scheduled to 
complete within the first half of 2025.  
** For awards granted from 2024 onwards, the following 
companies have been removed from the peer group: Chr. 
Hansen, Novozymes, Greencore and Premier Foods. DSM-
Firmenich and Novonesis (formerly Novozymes/Chr. Hansen) 
have been added.
The awards vest in line with the following table:
Position of Kerry  
in the Peer Group
Percentage 
of the Award 
which vests
Below median
0%
Median
25%
75th percentile and above
100%
Below Median none of the award vests. Vesting between 
median and 75th percentile is on a straight line basis.
Vesting Level for TSR Metric
The outturn of the measurement of the TSR metric 
in relation to the 2022 award is below median, 
resulting in an award outturn of 0% out of a possible 
maximum of 25% as the threshold performance level  
for this metric was not achieved.
ROACE Performance Test
15% of the award vests according to the Group’s ROACE 
over the performance period. ROACE represents a good 
perspective on the Group’s internal rate of return and 
financial added value for shareholders. ROACE supports 
the strategic focus on growth and margins through 
ensuring cash is reinvested to generate appropriate 
returns. This measurement is determined by reference 
to the ROACE in each of the three financial years 
included in the performance period:
Return on 
Average 
Capital 
Employed
Percentage 
of the Award 
which vests
Threshold
9%
25%
Maximum
13%
100%
Below threshold none of the award vests. Vesting between 
threshold and maximum points is on a straight line basis.
Vesting Level for ROACE Metric
The outturn of the measurement of the ROACE 
metric in relation to the 2022 award is a ROACE of 
10.3% resulting in an award outturn of 7% out of a 
maximum of 15%.
Sustainability Performance Test
The 2022-2024 LTIP is the second award to include 
sustainability measures under the 2021 LTIP rules.
20% of the award vests according to the Group’s 
performance versus the commitments set out 
in its Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy. 
This measurement is determined by reference to 
three key sustainability metrics over the three-year 
performance period:
Sustainability 
Metrics
Percentage 
of the Award 
which vests
Nutrition 
Reach
Threshold
1.20bn
25%
Maximum
1.40bn
100%
Carbon 
Reduction
Threshold
40%
25%
Maximum
48%
100%
Food 
Waste 
Reduction
Threshold
20%
25%
Maximum
25%
100%
Below threshold none of the award vests. Vesting between 
threshold and maximum points is on a straight line basis. 
The sustainability metrics listed above for the 2022 LTIP award 
had a weighting of 8%, 6% and 6% respectively.
Vesting Level for Sustainability Metrics
The outturn of the measurement of the sustainability 
metrics over the three-year period is an award 
outturn of 19% out of a maximum of 20%. This was 
achieved through above maximum performance for 
Carbon Reduction (50%) and Food Waste Reduction 
(38%) and a solid performance in our Nutrition 
Reach measure (1.36bn) which was marginally below 
maximum performance.
The targets for the Sustainability metrics in the 2022 
LTIP award were aligned to the Group’s original 
Beyond the Horizon sustainability commitments 
which were set in 2020. Since then, the Group has 
accelerated its commitments on emissions reduction, 
aligning its Scope 1 and 2 target with the 1.5 degree 
pathway under the Paris Accord. The Group also 
fast-tracked certain activities, including transition 
to renewable electricity, all of which improved the 
Group’s performance in relation to Carbon Reduction 
versus the target set. In addition, the targeted 
deployment of our Reduce, Reuse, Repurpose, 
Recycle strategy improved our performance in 
relation to Food Waste versus the anticipated 
progress in 2020.
The strong outcomes achieved reflect the significant 
progress being made against our Beyond the Horizon 
sustainability commitments.
Table 3: Overall Outturn of the 2022 LTIP Award 
Vesting in 2025
LTIP Metric
Weighting 
%
Actual 
Vesting %
EPS
40%
28%
TSR
25%
0%
ROACE
15%
7%
Sustainability
20%
19%
Total
100%
54%
The Committee is satisfied that the Executive 
Directors did not benefit from a windfall gain taking 
into account the share price at grant and share price 
performance over the performance period.
Discretion
The Committee concluded that there was no 
requirement to exercise discretion as the 2022-
2024 LTIP outturn reflected the underlying business 
performance and the broader stakeholder experience 
during the three-year performance period.
119
118
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Summary of outstanding LTIP awards
The following table shows the Executive Directors’ and Company Secretary’s interests under the LTIP. 
Conditional awards at 1 January 2024 relate to awards made in 2021, 2022 and 2023 which have a three-year 
performance period. The 2021 awards vested in 2024. The 2022 and 2023 awards will potentially vest in 2025 
and 2026 respectively. The market price of the shares on the date of each award is disclosed in note 29 to 
the financial statements.
Executive Directors’ and Company Secretary’s Interests in Long-Term Incentive Plan
Table 4: Individual Interest in LTIP (Audited) 
LTIP Vesting and Conditional Awards
LTIP 
Scheme
Conditional 
Awards at 
1 January 
2024
Share 
Awards 
Vested 
During 
the Year
Share 
Option 
Awards 
Vested 
During 
the Year
Share/ 
Option 
Awards 
Lapsed 
During 
the Year
Conditional 
Awards 
Made 
During the 
Year
Conditional 
Awards 
at 31 
December 
2024
Share Price 
at Date of 
Conditional 
Award 
Made 
During the 
Year
Directors
Edmond Scanlon
2021
109,397
_
(17,245)
(11,025)
56,061
137,188
€80.94
Marguerite Larkin
2021
57,542
_
(9,598)
(6,136)
28,040
69,848
€80.94
Gerry Behan
2021
68,048
(10,425)
_
(6,665)
34,491
85,449
€80.94
Company Secretary
Ronan Deasy
2021
10,054
_
(1,798)
(1,150)
4,365
11,471
€80.94
Conditional LTIP awards made on 6 March 2024, under the 2021 LTIP Plan, have a three-year performance 
period and will potentially vest in March 2027. Under the 2021 LTIP Plan, 100% of the shares/share options 
which potentially vest under the 2024 LTIP will be issued to Executive Directors following a two-year deferral 
period in March 2029.
The following table shows the share options which are held by the Executive Directors and the Company Secretary 
under the STIP and LTIP:
Table 5: Share Options Held Under the STIP and LTIP (Audited)
Share 
Options 
Outstanding 
at 1 January 
2024
Share 
Options 
Exercised 
During the 
Year
Share 
Options 
Vested 
During the 
Year1
Share 
Options 
Outstanding 
at 31 
December 
2024
Exercise 
Price Per 
Share
Directors
Edmond Scanlon
50,698
_
24,748
75,446
€0.125
Marguerite Larkin
17,176
_
13,658
30,834
€0.125
Company Secretary
Ronan Deasy
7,448
_
1,798
9,246
€0.125
1 Share options which vested in March 2024 related to 2021 LTIP awards, and in the case of the Executive Directors also includes 
33% of the 2023 STIP (paid in March 2024).  
Once vested, share options under the LTIP can be exercised for up to seven years before they lapse. For 
share options subject to the two-year deferral period, they can be exercised for up to five years following the 
end of the two-year deferral period, before they lapse i.e., seven years following the vest date.
Executive Directors’ Pensions
The pension benefits under the defined benefit pension plan for Gerry Behan during the year are outlined in 
the following table.
Table 6: Defined Benefit – Pensions Individual Summary (Audited)
Accrued Benefits on Leaving Service at End of Year
Annual Pension Accrued During 
the Year (Excluding Inflation)
$’000
Total Annual Accrued 
Pension at End of Year
$’000
Transfer Value of Increase 
in Accrued Pension
$’000
Gerry Behan
2024
115
966
1,904
2023
134
851
2,130
Note:  The table shows the Executive Director’s pension in the currency of payment to ensure clarity in reflecting year-on-year 
payment comparisons.
Note:  Contributions were made to an Irish defined contribution plan in respect of Edmond Scanlon. Marguerite Larkin receives a taxable 
cash payment in lieu of pension benefits. These contributions are reflected in the single figure table (table 1) on page 114.
Payments to Former Directors
No payments were made to former Directors during 2024 (2023: €nil) in respect of their duties as Directors.
Vested 2019 LTIP awards, which were subject to a two-year deferral period and delivered in 2024 in respect 
of a former Executive Director, were disclosed in previous annual reports when earned and therefore are not 
disclosed separately.
Payment for Loss of Office
There were no payments for loss of office in 2024 (2023: €nil). 
Non-Executive Director Remuneration and Shareholdings
Table 7: Remuneration paid to non-Executive Directors in 2024 and Shareholdings (Audited)
Fees 2024
€’0001
Fees 2023
€’0001
31 December 2024
Ordinary Shares
Number1
31 December 2023
Ordinary Shares
Number
Tom Moran
419
405
1,029
1,029
Hugh Brady
42
123
6,850
6,850
Genevieve Berger
98
15
_
_
Fiona Dawson
133
109
167
167
Karin Dorrepaal
44
125
_
_
Emer Gilvarry
134
123
850
850
Catherine Godson
98
15
_
_
Liz Hewitt
85
_
                         1,810
_
Michael Kerr
148
138
20,000
10,000
Christopher Rogers
146
128
1,640
1,640
Patrick Rohan
101
93
5,511
3,289
Jinlong Wang
131
128
_
_
1,579
1,402
1 Non-Executive Directors fees are reflective of when the individuals were appointed to or retired from the Board (see page 94). 
Year-on-year fee level variances arise due to annual fee increases in line with the wider workforce and additional fees paid for 
appointment to different Committees/Chair roles. Shareholdings for retired non-Executive Directors are reflected as of their date of 
retirement.
Non-Executive Directors are reimbursed for travel and accommodation expenses and any personal tax that may 
be due on those expenses. The gross amount of these expenses that were deemed to be taxable is €39,000.
121
120
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Directors’ and Company Secretary’s Interests
There have been no contracts or arrangements with the Company or any subsidiary during the year, in which 
a Director of the Company was materially interested and which were significant in relation to the Group’s 
business. The interests of the Executive Directors and the Company Secretary of the Company and their 
spouses and minor children in the share capital of the Company, all of which were beneficial unless otherwise 
indicated, are shown in Table 8.
Table 8: Executive Directors and Company Secretary Shareholdings
31 
December 
2024 
Ordinary
Shares 
Number
31 
December 
2024 
Share 
Options
Number
31 
December
2024 
Total 
Number
31 
December 
2023 
Ordinary 
Shares
Number
31 
December 
2023 
Share 
Options
Number
31 
December
2023 
Total
Number
Directors
Edmond Scanlon	
44,806
41,283
86,089
39,806
32,633
72,439
- Deferred1	
_
34,163
34,163
_
18,065
18,065
Marguerite Larkin	
4,335
12,046
16,381
4,335
7,324
11,659
- Deferred1	
_
18,788
18,788
_
9,852
9,852
Gerry Behan	
62,588
_
62,588
65,644
_
65,644
- Deferred1	
21,805
_
21,805
12,098
_
12,098
Company Secretary
Ronan Deasy	
3,230
8,966
12,196
3,230
6,849
10,079
- Deferred1	
_
280
280
_
599
599
1 The deferred shares and share options above, relate to 33% of the awarded amount of the Executive Directors’ 2022 and 2023  STIP 
awards, 50% of the 2020 LTIP award (vested in March 2023), and 100% of the 2021 LTIP Award (vested in March 2024). These awards 
are subject to a two-year deferral period and will be delivered in shares/share options in March 2025 and March 2026 respectively.
Shareholding Guidelines
The table below sets out the Executive Directors’ shareholding at 31 December 2024 shown as a multiple 
of basic salary. Refer to the Remuneration Policy Table on page 107 in Section C for details of the Executive 
Director shareholding requirements.
Table 9: Individual Shareholding as a Multiple of Basic Salary
Executive Director
As a Multiple of Basic Salary1
Edmond Scanlon
8x
Marguerite Larkin
4x
Gerry Behan
8x
1 The share price used to calculate the above is the share price as at 31 December 2024 and the shareholding is based on all  shares held 
and vested option awards (including deferred) reflected in table 8.
TSR Performance and Chief Executive Officer Remuneration
The graph below illustrates the TSR performance of the Group over the past ten years showing the increase in 
value of €100 invested in the Group’s shares from 31 December 2014 to 31 December 2024. The remuneration 
of the Chief Executive Officer is calculated in line with the methodology captured under legislation which was 
enacted for UK incorporated companies and is outlined in Table 11 on page 124.
The indices below have been selected as appropriate indices as they comprise other companies within the 
same broad sector as Kerry.
10 Year Shareholder Return 
(Value of €100 invested on 31/12/2014)
Table 10: Remuneration Paid to the CEO 2015 – 2024
The Committee believes that the policy and the supporting reward structure provide a clear alignment with 
the strategic objectives and performance of the Group. To maintain this relationship, the Committee regularly  
reviews the business priorities and the environment in which the Group operates. The table below shows the 
CEO’s total remuneration over the last 10 years and the achieved annual variable and long-term incentive pay 
awards as a percentage of the plan maximum.
€0
€50
€100
€150
€200
€250
2014
2016
2021
2022
2023
2024
2020
2019
2018
2015
2017
Kerry
MSCI Europe Food Producers
E300 Food & Beverage
Total 
Remuneration 
€000
Annual incentive 
achieved as a 
% of maximum
LTIP achieved as a 
% of maximum
CEO - Stan McCarthy
2015
4,161
58%
61.8%
2016
3,625
62%
29.4%
2017
5,285
75%
62.3%
CEO - Edmond Scanlon
2017
808
75%
62.3%
2018
2,577
60%
63.7%
2019
3,991
76%
62.8%
2020
2,323
0%
32.5%
2021
3,855
72%
22.0%
2022
3,899
78%
21.3%
2023
4,594
71%
61.0%
2024
6,042
98%
54.0%
1 Edmond Scanlon was appointed CEO and to the Board on 1 October 2017 and his remuneration reflected in the table above relates to 
remuneration from that date.
178.3
123
122
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

DIRECTORS’ REPORT
Table 11: Annual change in pay for Directors and all Employees
In line with the implementation of Articles 9a and 9b of European Directive 2017/828/EC1 (commonly known 
as the Revised Shareholder Rights Directive or SRDII) into the Irish Companies Act 2014, the table below shows 
the percentage change in each Director’s total remuneration and the global average total remuneration of an 
employee from the year ended 31 December 2023 to the year ended 31 December 2024.
Year-on-year change in pay for Directors compared to the global average employee
Executive Directors
2024
€’000
2023
€’000
2023 to 
2024
Change %
2022 to 
2023
Change %
2021 to 
2022
Change %
2020 to 
2021
Change %
2019 to 
2020 
Change %
Edmond Scanlon*
6,042
4,594
32%
18%
1%
66%
(42%)
Marguerite Larkin*
3,529
2,609
35%
17%
1%
98%
(28%)
$’000
$’000
Gerry Behan*
4,695
3,392
38%
13%
(0.1%)
44%
(47%)
Non-Executive Directors1
€’000
€’000
Hugh Brady
42
123
(66%)
2%
6%
24%
(6%)
Genevieve Berger
98
15
553% 
100%
–
–
–
Gerard Culligan
–
–
–
(100%)
(67%)
15%
(6%)
Fiona Dawson
133
109
22%
15%
100%
–
–
Karin Dorrepaal
44
125
(65%)
10%
10%
13%
(6%)
Joan Garahy
–
–
–
–
–
–
(6%)
Emer Gilvarry
134
123
9%
6%
16%
581%
100%
Catherine Godson
98
15
553%
100%
–
–
–
Liz Hewitt
85
–
100%
–
–
–
–
Michael Kerr
148
138
7%
6%
67%
–
–
Tom Moran
419
405
3%
32%
144%
22%
(2%)
Con Murphy
–
–
–
(100%)
(67%)
15%
(6%)
Christopher Rogers
146
128
14%
6%
2%
17%
(1%)
Patrick Rohan
101
93
9%
100%
–
–
–
Philip Toomey
–
–
–
(100%)
(66%)
15%
(6%)
Jinlong Wang
131
128
2%
2%
5%
–
–
All Group Employees2
57
55
4%
2%
19%
2%
1%
* The table shows each Executive Director’s pay in the currency of payment to ensure clarity in reflecting the year-on-year payment 
comparisons.
1 Non-Executive Directors’ fees are reflective of when the individuals were appointed to or retired from the Board (see page 94). 
Year-on-year fee level variances arise due to annual increases in line with the wider workforce and additional fees paid for 
appointment to different Committees/Chair roles.
2 Calculated by dividing the aggregate payroll costs of employees in 2024 (excluding social welfare costs and costs related to 
Executive Directors) by the average number of employees in 2024, as disclosed in note 4 to the consolidated financial statements. 
3 The Company performance can be seen in the 10 Year Total Shareholder Return graph on page 123.
Relative Importance of Spend on Pay
The total amount spent on Executive Director remuneration (including Long-Term Incentive Plan) and overall 
employee pay is outlined below in relation to retained profit, dividends paid and taxation paid.
Dilution
The Group offers Executive Directors and senior management the opportunity to participate in share-based 
schemes as part of the Group’s Remuneration Policy. In line with best practice guidelines, the Company 
ensures that the level of share awards granted under all share schemes does not exceed 10% of the Group’s  
share capital over a rolling ten-year period, with a further limitation of 5% in any ten-year period in respect of 
discretionary schemes. The dilution resulting from all vested shares/share options for the ten-year period to 
31 December 2024 is 1.2%. This level of dilution is well below the maximum dilution level recommended for 
executive share-based incentive plans.
The potential future dilution level from unvested shares/share options as a result of these schemes is a further 1.1%.
CEO Ratio
The UK Companies (Miscellaneous Reporting) Regulations 2018 mandate that certain UK-incorporated 
companies disclose the ratio of CEO remuneration to UK staff pay. Although Kerry, as an Irish-incorporated 
company, is not obligated to publish this ratio, we have voluntarily reported the ratio of CEO remuneration to 
Irish employees since 2019.
Following the introduction of the Corporate Sustainability Reporting Directive (CSRD) with which Kerry is 
complying, we are reporting the ratio of CEO remuneration to our global employees for the first time. The 
required disclosure under CSRD, and the prescribed calculation methodology for the ratio, will be the standard 
for our CEO pay ratio reporting moving forward. For 2024, the ratio on a total remuneration basis is 118:1, 
and the ratio excluding variable pay elements is 39:1. Further information is available on page 202 of our 
Sustainability Statement.
2024
	 Director  
Remuneration (0.6%)
	 Profit after tax before NTIs 
(30.0%)
	 Dividends Paid (8.2%)
	 Taxation Paid (11.2%)
	 Employee Costs (50%) 
2023
	 Director  
Remuneration (0.4%)
	 Profit after tax before NTIs 
(29.6%)
	 Dividends Paid (8%)
	 Taxation Paid (12%)
	 Employee Costs (50%) 
125
124
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
Directors’ Report Remuneration Committee Report
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
We have included this Sustainability Statement in our Annual Report, in accordance with the 
Companies Act 2014 and in compliance with the European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS) 
issued by the EU Commission.
Sustainability Statement
126
127
Sustainability Statement General
SUSTAINABILITY 
STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report	
128
General 	
Basis for Preparation	
131
Governance	
133
Our Sustainability Strategy	
137
Double Materiality Assessment Process 	
140
Environmental 	
Climate Change (E1)	
146
Water and Marine Resources (E3)	
165
Biodiversity and Ecosystems (E4)	
169
Resource Use and Circular Economy (E5)	
175
EU Taxonomy	
178
Social	
Human Rights Overview	
186
Own Workforce (S1)	
187
Workers in the Value Chain (S2)	
206
Consumers and End-Users (S4)	
213
Appendix	
1. ESRS 2 Appendix B	
223
2. Index of compliance with disclosure requirements	
230
3. Disclosures for which phase-in reliefs have been availed of within 	
233 
this Sustainability Statement

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
128
Sustainability Statement Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report
129
Sustainability Statement
Independent practitioners' 
limited assurance report 
on Kerry Group plc’s 
Sustainability Statement 
To the Directors
Limited assurance conclusion
We have conducted a limited assurance engagement on 
the consolidated Sustainability Statement of Kerry Group 
plc (the “Group”), included in the Sustainability Statement 
section of the Directors’ Report (the “Sustainability 
Statement”), as at 31 December 2024 and for the year 
then ended, prepared in accordance with Part 28 of the 
Companies Act 2014.
Certain required disclosures have been presented 
elsewhere in the Annual Report, rather than in the 
Sustainability Statement. These are cross referenced from 
the Sustainability Statement and are identified as subject to 
limited assurance.
Based on the procedures we have performed and the 
evidence we have obtained, nothing has come to our 
attention that causes us to believe that the Sustainability 
Statement is not prepared, in all material respects, in 
accordance with Part 28 of the Companies Act 2014, 
including:
•	 compliance of the sustainability reporting with the 
European Sustainability Reporting Standards (“ESRS”);
•	 the process carried out by the Group to identify the 
information reported pursuant to the sustainability 
reporting standards, is in accordance with the 
description set out in the basis for preparation section 
of the Sustainability Statement; and
•	 compliance of the disclosures in the EU Taxonomy 
section of the Sustainability Statement with Article 8 of 
EU Regulation 2020/852 (the “Taxonomy Regulation”).
Basis for conclusion
We conducted our limited assurance engagement in 
accordance with the International Standard on Assurance 
Engagements (Ireland) 3000, Assurance engagements 
other than audits or reviews of historical financial 
information - assurance of sustainability reporting 
in Ireland (“ISAE (Ireland) 3000”), issued by the Irish 
Auditing & Accounting Supervisory Authority (IAASA). The 
procedures in a limited assurance engagement vary in 
nature and timing from, and are less in extent than for, a 
reasonable assurance engagement. Consequently, the level 
of assurance obtained in a limited assurance engagement 
is substantially lower than the assurance that would have 
been obtained had a reasonable assurance engagement 
been performed.
We believe that the evidence we have obtained is sufficient 
and appropriate to provide a basis for our conclusion. Our 
responsibilities under this standard are further described in 
the Practitioners' responsibilities section of our report.
Our independence and quality management
We have complied with the independence and other 
ethical requirements of the International Code of Ethics 
for Professional Accountants (including International 
Independence Standards) issued by the International Ethics 
Standard Board for Accountants (IESBA Code), which is 
founded on fundamental principles of integrity, objectivity, 
professional competence and due care, confidentiality 
and professional behaviour and the independence 
requirements of the Companies Act 2014 and the Code 
of Ethics issued by Chartered Accountants Ireland that 
are relevant to our limited assurance engagement of the 
Sustainability Statement in Ireland.
The firm applies International Standard on Quality 
Management (Ireland) 1, which requires the firm to design, 
implement and operate a system of quality management 
including policies or procedures regarding compliance 
with ethical requirements, professional standards and 
applicable legal and regulatory requirements. 
Directors’ responsibilities for the 
Sustainability Statement
As explained more fully in the Directors’ Responsibility 
Statement as set out on pages 66-67, the Directors’ of the 
Group are responsible for designing and implementing 
a process to identify the information reported in the 
Sustainability Statement in accordance with the ESRS 
and for disclosing this process in the Double Materiality 
Assessment Process (IRO-1) section of the Sustainability 
Statement. This responsibility includes:
•	 understanding the context in which the Group’s activities 
and business relationships take place and developing an 
understanding of its affected stakeholders;
•	 the identification of the actual and potential impacts 
(both negative and positive) related to sustainability 
matters, as well as risks and opportunities that affect, 
or could reasonably be expected to affect, the Group’s 
financial position, financial performance, cash flows, 
access to finance or cost of capital over the short, 
medium, or long-term;
•	 the assessment of the materiality of the identified 
impacts, risks and opportunities related to 
sustainability matters by selecting and applying 
appropriate thresholds; and
•	 making assumptions that are reasonable in the 
circumstances.
The Directors of the Group are further responsible for the 
preparation of the Sustainability Statement, in accordance 
with Part 28 of the Companies Act 2014, including:
•	 compliance with the ESRS;
•	 preparing the disclosures in the EU Taxonomy section 
of the Sustainability Statement, in compliance with the 
Taxonomy Regulation;
•	 designing, implementing and maintaining such 
internal control that the Directors determine 
is necessary to enable the preparation of the 
Sustainability Statement that is free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; and
•	 the selection and application of appropriate 
sustainability reporting methods and making 
assumptions and estimates that are reasonable in the 
circumstances.
Inherent limitations in preparing the 
Sustainability Statement
Certain metrics reported within the Sustainability 
Statement may be subject to inherent limitations, for 
example, value chain information relating to emissions 
data provided by third parties (as discussed in Section 
- Climate Change (E1), subsection 6 - Metrics, Scope 3 
Emissions Methodology and Key Assumptions of the 
Sustainability Statement) and third party data used in 
the nutritional reach metric (as discussed in Section - 
Consumer and End Users (S4), subsection 6 - Targets  
and Metrics of the Sustainability Statement). 
In reporting forward-looking information in accordance 
with ESRS, the Directors of the Group are required to 
prepare the forward-looking information on the basis of 
disclosed assumptions about events that may occur in the 
future and possible future actions by the Group. Actual 
outcomes are likely to be different since anticipated 
events frequently do not occur as expected.
Practitioners' responsibilities
Our responsibility is to plan and perform the assurance 
engagement to obtain limited assurance about whether 
the Sustainability Statement is free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue 
a limited assurance report that includes our conclusion. 
Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are 
considered material if, individually or in the aggregate, 
they could reasonably be expected to influence decisions 
of users taken on the basis of the Sustainability Statement 
as a whole.
As part of a limited assurance engagement in accordance 
with ISAE (Ireland) 3000 we exercise professional 
judgement and maintain professional scepticism 
throughout the engagement. Our responsibilities in 
respect of the Sustainability Statement, in relation to the 
Process, include:
•	 Obtaining an understanding of the Process, but not 
for the purpose of providing a conclusion on the 
effectiveness of the Process, including the outcome of 
the Process;
•	 Considering whether the information identified 
addresses the applicable disclosure requirements of 
the ESRS; and
•	 Designing and performing procedures to evaluate 
whether the Process is consistent with the Group’s 
description of its Process set out in the Double 
Materiality Assessment Process (IRO-1) section of the 
Sustainability Statement.
Our other responsibilities in respect of the Sustainability 
Statement include:
•	 Identifying where material misstatements are likely to 
arise, whether due to fraud or error; and
•	 Designing and performing procedures responsive to 
where material misstatements are likely to arise in 
the Sustainability Statement. The risk of not detecting 
a material misstatement resulting from fraud is 
higher than for one resulting from error, as fraud 
may involve collusion, forgery, intentional omissions, 
misrepresentations, or the override of internal control.
Summary of the work performed
A limited assurance engagement involves performing 
procedures to obtain evidence about the Sustainability 
Statement. The procedures in a limited assurance 
engagement vary in nature and timing from, and 
are less in extent than for, a reasonable assurance 
engagement. Consequently, the level of assurance 
obtained in a limited assurance engagement is 
substantially lower than the assurance that would 
have been obtained had a reasonable assurance 
engagement been performed.
The nature, timing and extent of procedures selected 
depend on professional judgement, including 
the identification of disclosures where material 
misstatements are likely to arise in the Sustainability 
Statement, whether due to fraud or error.
In conducting our limited assurance engagement, with 
respect to the Process, we:
•	 Obtained an understanding of the Process by:
	»
performing inquiries to understand the sources 
of the information used by management (e.g., 
stakeholder engagement, business plans and 
strategy documents); and
	»
reviewing the Group’s internal documentation of 
its Process.
•	 Evaluated whether the evidence obtained from our 
procedures with respect to the Process implemented 
by the Group was consistent with the description of the 
Process set out in the Double Materiality Assessment 
Process (IRO-1) section of the Sustainability Statement.
In conducting our limited assurance engagement, with 
respect to the Sustainability Statement, we:
•	 Obtained an understanding of the Group’s reporting 
processes relevant to the preparation of its 
Sustainability Statement by:
	»
obtaining an understanding of the Group’s 
control environment, processes and information 
systems relevant to the preparation of the 
Sustainability Statement, but not for the purpose 
of providing a conclusion on the effectiveness of 
the Group’s internal control.
•	 Evaluated whether the information identified by the 
Process is included in the Sustainability Statement;
•	 Evaluated whether the structure and the 
presentation of the Sustainability Statement is in 
accordance with the ESRS;
•	 Performed inquiries of relevant personnel and 
analytical procedures on selected information in the 
Sustainability Statement;
•	 Performed substantive assurance procedures to 
limited assurance on selected information in the 
Sustainability Statement;
•	 Where applicable, compared disclosures in the 
Sustainability Statement with the corresponding 
disclosures in the Financial Statements and 
Directors’ Report;
•	 Evaluated the methods assumptions and data 
for developing estimates and forward-looking 
information;
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
130
131
Sustainability Statement
•	 Obtained an understanding of the Group’s process 
to identify taxonomy-eligible and taxonomy-aligned 
economic activities and the corresponding disclosures 
in the Sustainability Statement; and
•	 Performed substantive assurance procedures to 
limited assurance on selected information with respect 
to the EU taxonomy disclosures.
Other Matter – Compliance with the 
requirement to mark-up the Sustainability 
Statement
Section 1613(3)(c) of the Companies Act 2014 requires 
us to report on the compliance by the Group with the 
requirement to mark-up the Sustainability Statement in 
accordance with Section 1600 of that Act. Section 1600 
of the Companies Act 2014 requires that the Directors’ 
Report is prepared in the electronic reporting format 
specified in Article 3 of Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2019/815 and shall mark-up the Sustainability Statement. 
However, at the time of issuing our limited assurance 
report, the electronic reporting format has not been 
specified nor become effective by Delegated Regulation. 
Consequently, the Group is not required to mark-up the 
Sustainability Statement. Our conclusion is not modified 
in respect of this matter.
Other Matter - References to external 
sources or websites
The references to external sources or websites in the 
Sustainability Statement are not part of the Sustainability 
Statement and therefore are not within the scope of our 
limited assurance engagement.
Other Matter - Comparative Information
The comparative information included in the Sustainability 
Statement of the Group as at 31 December 2023 and for 
the year then ended was not subject to an assurance 
engagement. Our conclusion is not modified in respect of 
this matter.
Use of this report
Our report is made solely in accordance with Section 1613 
of the Companies Act 2014 to the Directors of the Kerry 
Group plc.
Our assurance work has been undertaken so that 
we might state to the Directors those matters we are 
required to state to them in a limited assurance report 
and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted 
by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to 
anyone other than the Group and its Directors, as a body, 
for our limited assurance work, for this report, or for the 
conclusions we have formed.
Paul Barrie 
For and on behalf of PricewaterhouseCoopers 
Dublin 
17 February 2025
Sustainability Statement General
General
Introduction
Our vision to be our customers' most valued partner, 
creating a world of sustainable nutrition is underpinned 
by our Beyond the Horizon strategy. This Sustainability 
Statement details Kerry’s strategic management of the 
impacts, risks and opportunities identified for our material 
topics based on our double materiality assessment. The 
reporting period for the Sustainability Statement coincides 
with that of the Financial Statements. 
Basis for Preparation
General Basis for Preparation
ESRS 2 BP-1 – General basis for preparation of sustainability 
statements
The Sustainability Statement is prepared in accordance with 
Part 28 of the Companies Act 2014 and in compliance with the 
European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS) issued by 
the EU Commission. The purpose of the General section is to 
provide stakeholders with an understanding of the material 
sustainability-related impacts, risks, and opportunities and 
our principles for sustainability reporting which form the basis 
for preparation of this Sustainability Statement.
This Sustainability Statement is prepared on a 
consolidated basis for the Group for the year ended 31 
December 2024. Joint ventures are not included in the 
consolidated sustainability data. The consolidation scope 
is consistent with that used for the Financial Statements 
unless otherwise disclosed. This Sustainability Statement 
discloses information related to Kerry’s value chain and to 
its own operations. Where information relates to activities 
outside of the direct control of the Group, such as Kerry’s 
upstream and downstream value chain, it is clearly 
identified as such. On 31 December 2024, the Group 
completed the sale of the Kerry Dairy Ireland business. 
In the relevant topical sections we have quantified 
the potential impact of the sale on key metrics where 
considered relevant to stakeholders.
In accordance with section 1613 of the Companies Act 
2014, this Sustainability Statement, set out on pages 
131 to 233, has been subject to limited assurance by 
PricewaterhouseCoopers, Chartered Accountants and 
Sustainability Assurance Service Providers. Their limited 
assurance procedures do not extend to any links or 
references to material outside of the Annual Report nor to 
other sections of the Annual Report unless clearly indicated 
to the contrary. Their limited assurance report is included on 
pages 128-130 of the Annual Report and should be read in 
conjunction with this Sustainability Statement.  
Our broad technology foundation, customer-centric 
business model, and recognised integrated solutions 
capability are core to the achievement of our vision. Our 
business model fundamentally depends on inputs across 
our business, including key intangible resources such as 
brand reputation, employee expertise, intellectual property 
and technology innovation. Guided by our vision, these 
key intangible resources drive our engagements with our 
customers and our stakeholders. By leveraging these, we 
continue to embed sustainability into all aspects of our 
business, driving sustainable nutrition.
During the preparation of this statement, the option to omit 
any applicable specific pieces of information corresponding 
to intellectual property, know-how or the results of 
innovation in accordance with ESRS 1 section 7.7 has not 
been used. Kerry Group plc is located in Ireland which is an 
EU member state. It allows the exemption from disclosure 
of impending developments or matters in the course of 
negotiation, as provided for in Articles 19a(3) and 29a(3) of 
Directive 2013/34/EU. We declare that this exemption has 
not been used as it is not applicable to the Group.
Disclosures in relation to Specific 
Circumstances
ESRS 2 BP-2 – Disclosures in relation to specific circumstances
Time Horizons
In disclosing certain sustainability information, Kerry 
considers sustainability matters over future timeframes. 
Kerry defines short, medium and long-term time horizons 
as follows:
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
Metric Estimation and Measurement 
Uncertainty
Kerry has processes in place governing the collection, review 
and validation of financial and non-financial data included 
in this statement. As we evolve our processes in this area 
we are incorporating more automation to enhance the 
collection and verification of data where possible. We are 
continuously strengthening our data collection processes 
and underlying controls. Our operating companies and 
data owners report fairly and in accordance with agreed 
procedures and instructions, however entities within our 
value chain are at different levels of maturity in sustainability 
reporting. We will continue to look for opportunities to 
minimise our use of data estimated using indirect sources.
As part of determining the measurement of material 
metrics, Kerry considers any key judgements, estimates 
and assumptions relating to specific matters. Certain 
metrics are calculated based on judgements applied in 
the implementation of policies. Estimates and underlying 
assumptions are based on historical experience and other 
factors determined by management and reviewed on an 
annual basis. Significant assumptions and estimates have 
been disclosed where relevant, unless otherwise stated 
there are none. Furthermore, Kerry is subject to certain 
risks and uncertainties that may lead to outcomes differing 
from these estimates and assumptions. Previous estimates 
and assumptions may need to be revised due to evolving 
factors or subsequent events that impact the basis on which 
they were originally made. Such changes are recognised 
in the period in which the estimate is revised unless new 
information provides evidence of circumstances that existed 
in the prior period, in such rare cases the comparatives are 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
132
Sustainability Statement General
133
Sustainability Statement
revised. The Scope 3 GHG emissions metric, on pages 161-
164, and the Nutritional Reach metric, on page 219, have a 
higher level of estimation uncertainty. No other quantitative 
sustainability metrics and monetary amounts reported in 
this statement are deemed to be subject to a high level of 
measurement uncertainty. Our reported metrics are subject 
to limited assurance procedures by our assurance provider 
and are not further validated by another external body, 
unless specifically identified.
The metrics that are measured directly or estimated 
based on sources, such as third-party data or sector 
averages and that use value chain data estimated using 
indirect sources are identified in the following table. Refer 
to the pages referenced for a description of each metrics' 
basis of preparation.
Metric
Page
Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions
160-164
Scope 3 GHG emissions
161-164
Deforestation and Conversion
173-174
Adequate Wages
201
Nutritional Reach
219
Comparative Information 
Kerry has previously reported sustainability information 
within our Annual Report and in a separate Sustainability 
Report. This is the first year in which Kerry is reporting 
under the requirements of the ESRS. We have opted to 
include comparative information for metrics that we 
have reported previously, and refrained from including 
comparative information for those metrics which we are 
reporting for the first time under ESRS. This comparative 
information is not covered by the Independent 
Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report, and to enable 
clarity for the reader this comparative information is 
denoted with a Greek letter β (beta). For the metrics in 
the following table the comparative information has 
been updated to ensure consistency with the calculation 
methodology used in the current year, refer to the 
pages referenced for further details around the basis 
of preparation for each metric. Where baseline data is 
required, the metrics have been updated to reflect the 
current reporting boundary.
Metric
Page
Employee Turnover
199
Work-related injuries/accidents rate
204
Where baseline data is required, the metrics have been 
updated to reflect the current reporting boundary.
Disclosure stemming from other legislation 
or generally accepted sustainability 
reporting pronouncements 
For a table disclosing all data points that derive from 
other EU legislation, as listed in ESRS 2 Appendix B, please 
refer to Appendix 1 to this Sustainability Statement.
Compliance with disclosure requirements
For a table outlining the disclosure requirements complied 
with, please refer to Appendix 2 to this Sustainability 
Statement.
Disclosures for which phase-in reliefs have 
been availed of within this Sustainability 
Statement
For a table outlining the disclosure requirements to which 
phase-in provisions apply, as specified in ESRS 1 Appendix 
C and utilised by Kerry, please refer to Appendix 3 to this 
Sustainability Statement.
Incorporation by reference
Certain mandatory disclosures are disclosed in 
other parts of the Annual Report rather than in 
the Sustainability Statement. These are therefore 
incorporated by reference as set out in the table below:
ESRS 
Requirement
ESRS Requirement Description
Section in Annual 
Report
Page
ESRS 2  
GOV-1 21 a
The undertaking shall disclose the following information about the 
composition and diversity of the members of the undertaking’s 
administrative, management and supervisory bodies:
(a) the number of executive and non-executive members;
Directors’ Report -  
Board of Directors
61
ESRS 2  
GOV-1 21 c
(c) experience relevant to the sectors, products and geographic locations 
of the undertaking;
Directors’ Report -  
Governance 
and Nomination 
Committee Report
94
ESRS 2  
GOV-3 29 d 
and e
The undertaking shall disclose the following information about the 
incentive schemes and remuneration policies linked to sustainability 
matters for members of the undertaking’s administrative, management 
and supervisory bodies, where they exist:
(d) the proportion of variable remuneration dependent on sustainability-
related targets and/or impacts; and
(e) the level in the undertaking at which the terms of incentive schemes 
are approved and updated.
Directors’ Report - 
Remuneration 
Committee Report
113 
102
ESRS 
Requirement
ESRS Requirement Description
Section in Annual 
Report
Page
ESRS 2  
SBM-1 40 a i
The undertaking shall disclose the following information about the key 
elements of its general strategy that relate to or affect sustainability 
matters:
(a) a description of:
i. significant groups of products and/or services offered, including 
changes in the reporting period (new/removed products and/or 
services);
Our Strategy
12
ESRS 2  
SBM-1 40 a ii
ii. significant markets and/or customer groups served, including 
changes in the reporting period (new/removed markets and/or 
customer groups);
Our Markets
22
ESRS 2  
SBM-1 42 a, 
b, c
The undertaking shall disclose a description of its business model and 
value chain, including:
(a) its inputs and its approach to gathering, developing and securing those 
inputs;
(b) its outputs and outcomes in terms of current and expected benefits for 
customers, investors and other stakeholders; and
(c) the main features of its upstream and downstream value chain and the 
undertaking’s position in its value chain, including a description of the 
main business actors (such as key suppliers, customers, distribution 
channels and end-users) and their relationship to the undertaking. 
When the undertaking has multiple value chains, the disclosure shall 
cover the key value chains.
Our Business 
Model
18-19
Governance
Sustainability Governance Structure
ESRS 2 GOV-1 – The role of the administrative,  
management and supervisory bodies
Our strategy puts sustainable nutrition at the core of what 
we do every day and enables us to deliver on our purpose, 
Inspiring Food, Nourishing Life. The Group’s Board has 
overseen the continued evolution of our business in line 
with our purpose, including the review and approval of 
the Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy and 
commitments. The commitments encompass a clear focus 
on climate action and societal impact. The Board has 
ongoing responsibility for overseeing performance and 
strategies to deliver our commitments. The Board and 
the Sustainability Committee also assess how the Group 
is responding to climate-related risks and opportunities 
associated with identified impacts, as part of the overall 
risk management process. 
The Sustainability Committee, a committee of the 
Board, is responsible for overseeing the Group’s 
sustainability objectives and performance, including the 
delivery of the Group’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability 
strategy, as outlined in the Committee’s Terms of 
Reference, available on kerry.com. Membership of 
this Committee includes Board members with deep 
experience across food and beverage, as well as 
experience in addressing sustainability-related matters. 
The Audit Committee supports the Board by overseeing 
the Group’s external reporting and reviewing and 
monitoring the effectiveness of the Group’s risk 
management and internal control processes. This includes 
the Group’s preparations for compliance with the ESRS. 
See the ‘Board Performance Evaluation’ paragraph on 
page 82 for details of Kerry’s approach to performance 
evaluation of the Board and its Committees.	
The Sustainability Committee is in turn supported by 
the Sustainability Executive Committee which steers the 
Group’s investment decisions and progress towards our 
2030 commitments across people, society, and planet 
including plans to reach net zero before 2050, as outlined 
in our Beyond the Horizon strategy. Membership of the 
Sustainability Executive Committee includes Kerry’s CEO,  
CFO and other members of our Executive Leadership Team 
who meet throughout the year to consider our strategy, 
review progress and prioritise activities and investment.
The Sustainability Executive Committee is supported 
by additional governance councils at functional levels 
who have accountability for specific environmental 
and social areas, as represented in the Sustainability 
Governance chart graphic (see page 134). Each council 
is led by a member of our Executive Leadership Team 
or a senior leader and meets at least quarterly. These 
councils discuss strategies and initiatives that are 
helping to reach the targets we have stipulated in 
our Beyond the Horizon strategy, as well as reviewing 
performance against those strategies and initiatives.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
134
135
Sustainability Statement
Oversight
ESRS 2 GOV-2 – Information provided to and sustainability 
matters addressed by the undertaking’s administrative, 
management and supervisory bodies
The Board, along with the Sustainability and Audit 
Committees, receive regular updates from senior 
executives including the Chief Corporate Affairs Officer, 
the Group Head of Sustainability and the Sustainability 
Reporting team on sustainability matters. During 2024, 
these included the Group’s performance against our 
goals, targets and strategy, our climate-related risks and 
opportunities associated with identified impacts, the 
evolution of human rights and our double materiality 
process and topics. The Board and the Sustainability 
Committee also reviewed and approved Kerry’s Climate 
Transition Plan (CTP) and our new Scope 3 targets. In 
addition, details relating to climate change are provided 
to the Board and the Committees by other leaders as part 
of their functional updates, ensuring that it is increasingly 
integrated into the broader strategic decision-making 
process. Input from the Chief Corporate Affairs Officer, 
the Group Head of Sustainability and the Sustainability 
Reporting team is also included for respective relevant 
sustainability matters reported to other committees of 
the Board as needed, for example updates on metric 
performance to the Remuneration Committee.
In 2024, the Board also considered climate-related metrics 
as part of the Group’s financial and business planning 
cycle. Climate-related metrics were incorporated within 
the budget review process, alongside indicators on 
growth, financial performance and returns. Potential 
climate impacts were considered by the Board in a range 
of areas including decisions on major capital expenditure 
and business portfolio decisions.
The Sustainability Committee engaged with Executive 
Leadership on climate-related risks and reviewed how 
these have been assessed, considered and the risks 
and potential impact determined as part of the overall 
risk management process in 2024. The output of the 
assessment was also shared with the Audit Committee.
The Group Internal Audit function incorporate the audit 
of sustainability processes, controls and reporting in their 
assurance engagement planning and audit execution 
each year.	
	
Board Composition 
ESRS 2 GOV-1 – The role of the administrative, management 
and supervisory bodies
The Board’s average gender ratio was 46% to 54%, female 
to male for the year ending 31 December 2024. Our 
Governance and Nomination Committee Report (page 
94) provides a summary of our current position relating 
to Board and Executive Management diversity, in line 
with listing requirements. For further information about 
the composition, experience and diversity of our Board, 
please see our Directors' Report on pages 61 and 94. 
The Board has assessed the independence of the non-
Executive Directors’ and confirm in its opinion, all non-
Executive Directors representing 77% of the Board, are 
independent in judgement and character.
In relation to Board representation of employees and 
related activities, the Board:
•	 Received and considered reports from the designated 
Workforce Engagement Director on her activities 
during the year. Details are outlined in Governance in 
Action on page 79;
•	 Assessed talent and succession planning activities 
following presentations from the Chief Executive 
Officer and Chief Human Resources Officer;
•	 Approved the rollout of the All Employee Share Plan 
(which was adopted by shareholders at the 2023 AGM) 
to a further 16 countries;
•	 Reviewed the actions taken to support lower-paid 
employees following a number of years of cost 
inflation; and
•	 Monitored and assessed the culture of the Group 
to ensure it promotes integrity and openness, is 
aligned with strategy and is responsive to the views of 
shareholders and wider stakeholders. 
Sustainability Statement General
Board Level  
Executive Level
Functional Level
Board of Directors
Sustainability Executive Committee
Remuneration Committee
Audit Committee
Sustainability Committee
Climate 
Council
Portfolio 
Council
Responsible 
Sourcing 
Council
Commercial 
Council
Social
Sustainability
Council
Diversity, 
Inclusion & 
Belonging
Council
Circular 
Economy
Council
Sustainability Governance
Sustainability and Remuneration
ESRS 2 GOV-3 – Integration of sustainability-related 
performance in incentive schemes
Kerry’s remuneration philosophy ensures that executive 
remuneration is aligned to the Group’s purpose, culture 
and values, supports strategy and promotes the long-
term success of the company. The Long-Term Incentive 
Plan (LTIP) for Executive Directors and senior leaders 
reflects this through the three key areas of growth, return 
and sustainability. The incentive plan considers core 
sustainability metrics linked to our Beyond the Horizon 
sustainability strategy. The metrics used include Nutritional 
Reach, Carbon Reduction (specifically the progress towards 
our science-based targets on Scope 1 and 2 emissions) 
and Food Waste Reduction. The LTIP section of the 
Remuneration Committee Report (page 113) outlines the 
detail of how sustainability metrics are incorporated into 
the incentive plan, while the Key Performance Indicators 
section of the Strategic Report, on pages 26-27, outlines 
the strategic importance of these metrics. 
Due Diligence
ESRS 2 GOV-4 – Statement on due diligence
All identified material sustainability topics are considered 
in the definition of Kerry’s overall strategy. The overall 
strategy is supported by specific strategies on climate 
change, environment and people. The following table 
provides a mapping of how Kerry applies the core 
elements of due diligence and where they are presented 
in this Sustainability Statement.
Core Elements of Due 
Diligence
Reporting 
Area
Disclosures 
in the 
Sustainability 
Statement
Description
Page 
Number
a)
Embedding due diligence 
in governance, strategy 
and business model 
Governance
ESRS 2 GOV-1
ESRS 2 GOV-2
ESRS 2 GOV-3
ESRS 2 GOV-5
Governance and Board Composition
Oversight 
Sustainability and Remuneration
Risk Management
133-134
134
135
136-137
Strategy
ESRS 2 SBM-1
ESRS 2 SBM-3
SBM-3 – E1
SBM-3 – E4
SBM-3 – S1
SBM-3 – S2
Our Sustainability Strategy
Our Sustainability Strategy
Climate Strategy and Business Model
Biodiversity Assessing Our Operations
Own Workforce Strategy
Workers in the Value Chain Strategy
137-138
137-138
156-157
170
188-189
207
Policies 
E1-2
E3-1 
E4-2
S1-1
S2-1
Climate Policy
Water Policy
Biodiversity Policy
Own Workforce Policies
Workers in the Value Chain Policy
157
165-166
170-171
189-190
208
b)
Engaging with affected 
stakeholders in all key 
steps of the due diligence
Governance
ESRS 2 GOV-2
Oversight 
134
Strategy
ESRS 2 SBM-2
SBM-2 – S1 
SBM-2 – S2
Stakeholder Engagement
Interests and Views of Our People
Interests and Views of Upstream 
Value Chain Workers
138-139
191
208
IRO
ESRS 2 IRO-1
ESRS 2 IRO-1-E1 
ESRS 2 IRO-1-E3 
ESRS 2 IRO-1-E4
Double Materiality Assessment
Climate Material Impacts, Risks and 
Opportunities
Water Material Impacts, Risks and 
Opportunities
Biodiversity Material Impacts, Risks 
and Opportunities
140-141
151-156 
165 
169-170
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
136
137
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement General
Core Elements of Due 
Diligence
Reporting 
Area
Disclosures 
in the 
Sustainability 
Statement
Description
Page 
Number
b)
Engaging with affected 
stakeholders in all key 
steps of the due diligence
Policies 
Refer to the Policies described in 
section a) above.
Processes for 
Engaging
S1-2 
S1-3
S2-2 
S2-3
S4-2 
S4-3
Processes for Engaging with Our 
People
Employee Support Channels
Processes for Engagement with 
Upstream Value Chain Workers
Grievance Mechanisms
Processes for Engaging with our 
Consumers and End-Users
Grievance Mechanisms
191-192 
192
209 
209
215 and 221 
216 and 221
c)
Identifying and assessing 
adverse impacts
IRO
ESRS 2 IRO-1
Double Materiality Assessment
Human Rights Overview
140-141
186
Strategy
ESRS 2 SBM-3
SBM-3 – E1
SBM-3 – E4
SBM-3 – S1
SBM-3 – S2
Our Sustainability Strategy
Climate Strategy and Business Model
Biodiversity Assessing Our Operations
Own Workforce Strategy
Workers in the Value Chain Strategy
137-138
156-157
170
188-189
207
d)
Taking actions to address 
those adverse impacts
Strategy
E1-1
Climate Transition Plan
147-150
Actions 
E1-3
E3-2
E4-3
S1-4
S2-4
Climate Change Actions
Water Actions
Biodiversity Actions
Human Rights Overview 
Own Workforce Actions
Workers in the Value Chain Actions
147-149
166-167
171-173
186 
192-196
210-211
e)
Tracking the effectiveness 
of these efforts and 
communicating
Targets and 
Metrics
E1-4 to E1-8
E3-3
E4-4 to E4-5
S1-5 to S1-17
S2-5
Climate Change Targets and Metrics
Water Targets and Metrics
Biodiversity Targets and Metrics
Own Workforce Targets and Metrics
Workers in the Value Chain Targets and 
Metrics
158-164
168
173-174
196-205
212
Risk Management
ESRS 2 GOV-5 – Risk management and internal controls over 
sustainability reporting
The identification, assessment and management of climate-
related risks follow the Group’s existing risk management 
framework. However, the time horizons have been extended 
to allow for the longer-term impacts of climate change.
The Audit Committee is responsible for providing structured 
and systematic oversight of the Group’s risk management 
and internal control systems. The Group’s risk assessment 
process is a coordinated bottom-up and top-down 
group-wide approach that facilitates the identification 
and evaluation of risks, as well as assessing how the risks 
are monitored, managed and mitigated. This process is 
facilitated annually by our Internal Audit function and 
overseen by the Risk Oversight Committee.
The Group’s risk appetite is agreed annually with the Board 
and as a result we seek to minimise climate-related risks, 
while ensuring the ongoing success of our business. The 
management of these climate-related risks is undertaken 
within the function where the risk may occur.
We also continue to plan for emerging non-financial 
reporting regulations across multiple jurisdictions.  
The divergence in approach, scope and timelines across 
different frameworks pose a risk for businesses. We 
have engagement with our Board, Executive Leadership 
and functional teams to ensure they understand these 
forthcoming requirements and that the business can 
respond appropriately.
Please refer to the table outlining the material impacts, 
risks and opportunities (IROs) from the double materiality 
assessment on pages 142-145 for information on the 
sustainability material topics addressed by the Board and 
the Sustainability Committee during the year.
Our Sustainability Strategy 
ESRS 2 SBM-1 – Strategy, business model and value chain 
ESRS 2 SBM-3 – Material impacts, risks and opportunities and 
their interaction with strategy and business model
As a global player in the food industry, Kerry 
acknowledges that innovation is key to address the 
adverse effects food production and consumption can 
have on both society and the environment. Recognising 
the magnitude of the task at hand, encompassing issues 
like deforestation, greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, food 
waste, obesity, and malnutrition, we are committed to 
developing and executing solutions that promote a more 
environmentally responsible and resilient future.
Kerry has an important role to play in influencing positive 
change, both within our own operations and across our 
supply chain. Kerry is uniquely placed to influence the 
impact of business partners downstream and to that 
effect, we partner with customers to co-create solutions 
that provide positive and balanced nutrition to consumers 
globally, while minimising negative impacts on the Earth's 
resources. 
Our Beyond the Horizon strategy is built on three pillars; 
Better for People, Better for Society and Better for Planet, 
and sets out our commitment to deliver better nutrition 
for consumers, manage our business and source our 
materials responsibly, while reducing our environmental 
footprint and that of our customers.
Our broad technology foundation, customer-centric 
business model and integrated solutions capability are 
core to the achievement of our vision, of creating a world 
of sustainable nutrition. These solutions are managed 
primarily through the lens of the food, beverage and 
pharma & other end use markets, through which we sell 
a broad portfolio of products that support customers as 
they seek to innovate to win in today’s food and beverage 
markets.
At Kerry, we define sustainable nutrition as the ability to 
provide positive and balanced nutrition solutions that 
help maintain good health, while protecting people and 
the planet.
Core to our strategy is our ambition to reach over two 
billion people with sustainable nutrition solutions by the 
end of 2030. We will achieve this by innovating to create 
products and solutions that maintain good health, while 
protecting people and the planet. These products and 
solutions form part of our overall portfolio, for further 
details relating to our products and markets in which we 
operate, see the Our Markets (page 22) and Our Strategy 
(pages 12-13) sections within our Strategic Report. Our 
strategy is enabled through our people. For information 
relating to our total number of employees, please see the 
S1-6 Our Employee Profile disclosures on pages 197-199. 
Please see pages 18-19 of our Strategic Report for a 
description of our business model and value chain.
We have reviewed the material risks and opportunities 
identified and assessed as part of the double materiality 
assessment process on pages 140-141 and considered 
the current financial effects on our performance for the 
current year. The opportunity to expand nutritional reach 
through sustainable nutrition within our Taste & Nutrition 
business is reflected in increased sales volume growth in 
2024. While there have been some climate-related costs 
associated with the transition to net zero in line with our 
Climate Transition Plan, there was no material current 
effect on our business performance. We considered the 
current impact on the financial judgements and estimates 
and as a result determined there is no material impact 
on the valuations of the Group’s assets and liabilities 
from these risks as at 31 December 2024. We have not 
identified a significant risk of a material adjustment 
We are committed to doing business with integrity and seek 
to enhance the lives of all those with whom we engage
We are reducing our environmental footprint and enabling 
our customers to lower their product impacts in areas like 
carbon and waste
We co-create products that deliver better nutrition for 
consumers with no compromise on taste
Our 2030 goal is to reach over two billion people with 
solutions that maintain good health while protecting people 
and the planet
SUSTAINABLE 
NUTRITION
BETTER FOR
PLANET
BETTER FOR
PEOPLE
BETTER FOR
SOCIETY
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
138
139
Sustainability Statement
within the next annual reporting period to the carrying 
amounts of assets and liabilities reported in the related 
Financial Statements. 
We have opted to exercise the phase-in allowance to omit 
the disclosure of anticipated financial effects of material 
risks and opportunities on financial position, financial 
performance, and cash flows over the short, medium and 
long term.
Some of our identified IROs have been covered by 
Kerry-specific disclosures, including IROs relating to 
our Kerry-defined material topics Consumer Health and 
Food Waste. We have further defined additional metrics 
and targets to measure and track progress against IROs 
in each topical ESRS section. Please refer to the topical 
sections for more information.
Stakeholder Engagement
ESRS 2 SBM-2 – Interests and views of stakeholders
To effectively address the complex challenges within 
our industry, it is clear that a collaborative approach 
is essential. We are committed to forming strategic 
partnerships aimed at delivering tangible results. 
Our engagement with stakeholders is focused on 
understanding their perspectives and integrating them 
into our decision-making processes and responding to 
their feedback effectively.
Through the convergence of our scientific, technological 
and innovative capabilities, we strive to develop new and 
enhanced taste and nutrition solutions for consumers 
worldwide, contributing to the transformation of global 
food production. However, we recognise that this cannot 
be achieved in isolation. Our business actively engages 
with a broad range of stakeholders, including employees, 
suppliers, customers, local and regional governments, 
shareholders and communities, to ensure that their views 
are incorporated within our business planning and are 
considered by our senior management, including the 
Board on a regular basis, in particular as they reviewed 
the double materiality process in early 2024. Relevant 
stakeholders across Kerry's value chain participated in 
Kerry’s double materiality assessment process, providing 
valuable perspectives and insights on sustainability 
matters relevant to Kerry. See the stakeholder 
engagement disclosure, as the third step to our double 
materiality process on page 140 for more details.
Conducting stakeholder analysis allows us to identify 
groups impacted by our activities, as well as those 
that influence Kerry. We engage with these key 
stakeholders through various channels, including direct 
interactions, engagement with representative bodies, 
and participation in relevant multi-stakeholder platforms. 
Kerry also maintains channels that enable stakeholders to 
directly engage where appropriate.
Our Engagement and Purpose
Outcomes from Engagements
Stakeholder: Customers and Consumers
Strong engagement with our customers and consumers enables 
us to operate a customer-centric business model and act as our 
customers’ most valued partner, creating a world of sustainable 
nutrition. Our commercial and sustainability teams have ongoing 
engagement with our customers through day-to-day operations, 
customer conferences and industry events. Scientific and thought 
leadership is enabled through collaboration, including the Kerry 
Health and Nutrition Institute® and events such as Climate Week in 
New York. 
•	 Co-creation and innovation of healthier 
products.
•	 Improving the visibility of sustainability 
impacts from our products and our 
customers products through tools such 
as Kerry Nutri Guide, Kerry Food Waste 
Estimator and Kerry Carbon Guide.
•	 Enhanced awareness around the importance 
of sustainable nutrition topics e.g. climate, 
sodium reduction etc.
Stakeholder: Our Employees
Regular and ongoing engagement with our employees is key 
to attracting, developing and retaining a talented workforce to 
successfully deliver our strategy and bring our vision to life. We are 
committed to fostering an environment where our people are highly 
engaged and collaborate to shape Kerry’s successful growth. We 
engage employees through leadership and learning development, 
our regular employee experience survey, leadership pulse checks 
and physical/virtual town halls. We encourage all of our people to 
have the courage to speak up, creating a safe environment in which 
everyone feels comfortable to do so.
•	 Enhanced awareness of training and career 
development opportunities.
•	 Inclusion of OurVoice employee experience 
feedback in action planning and delivery.
•	 Improved employee health, safety and 
wellbeing.
•	 Enhanced rewards and recognition. 
•	 Continuing to promote supports like our 
Employee Assistance Programme and  
Speak Up. 
Sustainability Statement General
Our Engagement and Purpose
Outcomes from Engagements
Stakeholder: Shareholders
Active engagement with our shareholders ensures they are aware 
of the Group's business, environmental and social performance. 
Engagement occurs throughout the year through investor meetings, 
conferences, our annual reporting process, published materials and 
analysts’ briefings. This process allows us to receive feedback across 
a range of key topics and shareholder focus areas. Events such as 
the investor day at our Beloit, Wisconsin, facility showcase Kerry’s 
capabilities.
•	 Increased awareness of our growth strategy 
leveraging sustainable nutrition across the 
different channels and regions.
•	 Clarity on social and environmental 
performance and targets. 
•	 Improved understanding of marketplace 
dynamics.
•	 Incorporation of insights to enhance our 
approach on key topics.
Stakeholder: Suppliers
We engage with our suppliers regularly through day-to-day 
operations to ensure the quality, safety and sustainability of our raw 
materials. This is facilitated through direct engagement, supplier 
assessments and audits. We also engage through industry events 
and multi-stakeholder platforms focused on areas such as carbon 
reduction, deforestation and regenerative agriculture. These 
platforms include the Consumer Goods Forum, the Sustainable 
Dairy Partnership, the Palm Oil Collaboration Group and more. We 
use these platforms to engage collaboratively with peers, customers 
and suppliers on challenges that are common to our industry and 
where collaboration is essential to ensure progress. 
•	 Adherence to Kerry’s Supplier Code of 
Conduct.
•	 Improved product safety, quality and 
sustainability standards including 
certifications.
•	 Progress towards reducing Scope 3 
emissions.
•	 Understanding our requirements on the 
rights of workers throughout the supply 
chain.
•	 Contingency supply arrangements in 
response to ongoing global challenges.
Stakeholder: Government
Through our engagement with government and state authorities, 
we outline our contribution to sustainable development at local, 
regional and national level. We inform them of our corporate 
position on the concerns facing our industry and we can increase 
our understanding of wider issues, enabling us to engage as 
appropriate in relevant policy and regulatory debates.
•	 Improved understanding of policy 
development and outcomes. 
•	 Preparation for adherence to legislative 
changes.
•	 Enhanced policies and further transparency 
in our reporting.
•	 Access to supports that enable our climate 
transition.
Stakeholder: Community
We play an important role in the socio-economic development of 
communities where we operate and source our materials. This 
goes beyond our business activities through financial support for 
community projects, our sponsorships and employee volunteering 
initiatives. By fostering strong relationships within these 
communities, we can work together to promote positive outcomes 
for our business, society and the environment. 
•	 Continued economic development. 
•	 Improved access to services and/or facilities.
•	 Enhanced nutrition for targeted 
communities.
•	 Employee engagement and community 
involvement.
•	 Promoting sport and active lifestyles.
The ‘ESRS 2 SBM-2 – Interests and views of stakeholders’ social topical disclosures are disclosed on the following pages:
•	 Own Workforce (S1) page 191; 
•	 Workers in the Value Chain (S2) page 208; and 
•	 Consumers and End-Users (S4) pages 215 and 221. 
Please refer to the table outlining the material impacts, risks and opportunities (IROs) in ESRS 2 SBM-3 on pages  
142-145 for information on IROs addressed by the Board and the Sustainability Committee during the year.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
140
141
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement General
Double Materiality 
Assessment Process 
Double Materiality Assessment 
ESRS 2 IRO-1 – Description of the processes to identify and 
assess material impacts, risks and opportunities
Introduction
We completed our double materiality assessment in early 
2024. Double materiality has two-dimensions, namely, 
impact materiality and financial materiality. Impact 
materiality assessment involves evaluating the impact 
of Kerry on environmental, social and governance (ESG) 
issues (inside-out) while financial materiality assessment 
involves evaluating the impact of these issues on Kerry 
(outside-in). Our assessment is based on definitions within 
the ESRS issued by the European Commission and will be 
reassessed in full every three years, or earlier, if required.
The double materiality assessment identifies our 
most relevant ESG topics and their related impacts, 
risks and opportunities (IROs) at which we direct 
appropriate action and resources, through our policies 
and programmes. It informs the continued evolution 
of our Beyond the Horizon strategy and provides input 
into our risk management processes, while also 
forming the basis for the required disclosures within 
this Sustainability Statement. Our material topics 
were defined through a five-step process, as outlined 
in the following graphic. The process was centrally 
managed and involved substantial consultation with 
our business leaders, subject matter experts, and a 
wide range of stakeholders, including employees, 
investors, customers, suppliers and community-
based representatives. Their insights have helped 
to inform the materiality of specific topics and the 
associated IROs. This ensured that the assessment was 
comprehensive and considered impacts across our 
entire organisation and the value chain. 
This process was underpinned by a robust governance 
structure, led by a core group of senior leaders, an 
Executive-led steering committee and a Decision-
Making Authority who were a smaller cohort of steering 
committee members. Each of our material topics were 
reviewed in detail to consider any actual or potential 
effects from the sale of the Kerry Dairy Ireland business 
on 31 December 2024 and it was concluded that no 
changes were required to the list of material topics or the 
underlying IROs, as a result of this transaction.
1. Understand the Context
To understand the sustainability context within which 
we operate, we conducted a landscape assessment to 
identify potential material sustainability topics that may 
arise in relation to our business and value chain. The 
assessment was based on knowledge of our operations, 
business relationships, and relevant sector and regulatory 
factors. It incorporated media and regulatory reviews, 
and analysis of our peers and value chain to gain deep 
insight into sustainability topics which matter most to 
Kerry’s stakeholders. The landscape assessment resulted 
in the identification of sustainability matters that could 
potentially be material for Kerry. 
2. Topic Selection 
Our next step was to refine and consolidate matters from 
the landscape assessment into thematic sustainability 
topics and map them to each of the matters listed within 
the ESRS. These were further validated and refined where 
necessary, before definitions were assigned to each topic 
to capture the anticipated IROs, ensuring alignment with 
relevant ESRS sub-topics and sub-sub-topics. The topics 
were validated by the Executive-led steering committee, 
comprising senior management, functional executives 
and other key internal stakeholders. The objective of this 
phase was to generate an appropriate list of topics and 
related IROs to allow for meaningful engagement with a 
wider group of internal and external stakeholders.
3. Stakeholder Engagement
To capture stakeholder perspectives, relevant 
stakeholders were identified and mapped against the 
value chain and an engagement approach was defined 
for each (e.g. by survey and/or interview). To ensure we 
engaged a broad set of stakeholders, we developed a 
double materiality survey based on the long list of topics 
and issued that to our selected external and internal 
stakeholders. The survey required respondents to score 
the topics and allowed them to provide further context 
to explain their scoring of the topics. For a deeper 
understanding of the sustainability matters we selected 
a sub-set of external and internal stakeholders across 
our value chain for in-depth interview. This included 
employees in various functions, suppliers, customers, 
industry bodies and shareholders.
4. Double Materiality Assessment
Our Double Materiality Process:
1.  
Understand the 
Context
2.  
Topic 
Selection
3.  
Stakeholder 
Engagement
4. 
Double 
Materiality 
Assessment
5. 
Review  
and Report
Assessment of 
the external 
environment 
to determine 
universe of 
topics.
Refined topic 
list developed 
with reference to 
ESG standards 
and definitions 
agreed.
Detailed feedback 
received 
across varied 
stakeholder 
groups.
Qualitative and 
quantitative 
inputs used 
to determine 
material topics 
and IROs.
Topics validated 
through internal 
governance 
process and 
disclosed.
Stakeholder input was carefully assessed, and the IROs 
were scored using a predefined scale for both impact 
and financial materiality. The scoring approach, including 
the weighting of survey and interview responses and the 
process to assign numerical scores to interview data, was 
reviewed and approved by the Decision-Making Authority. 
Impact Materiality
The evaluation of impact materiality involved gathering 
insights from surveys and interviews with internal and 
external stakeholders. Numerical scores from the survey 
and qualitative interview data, were combined to generate 
an overall survey and interview score for each topic. This 
accounted for positive and negative impacts, as well as 
whether an impact was actual or potential. 
The severity of impacts was evaluated, considering the scale, 
scope, and irremediable nature of each impact for affected 
stakeholders across short, medium and long-term time 
horizons. This evaluation determined the impact materiality 
score for actual impacts. For potential impacts, an additional 
parameter of ‘likelihood’ was scored. 
Financial Materiality
Financial Materiality scores were determined through a 
financial materiality workshop involving finance, strategy, 
and sustainability leaders. The scale used to determine 
the financial materiality score was calibrated against 
Kerry’s Enterprise Risk Management (ERM) financial 
threshold scale and assessed across short, medium and 
long-term time horizons using both financial magnitude 
and likelihood scores. 
Validation
On completion of the scoring, we held validation workshops 
with the Decision-Making Authority to review the results. 
Topics that scored close to the impact and financial 
materiality thresholds warranted additional review and 
consideration. As a result of this review, these topics and 
their related IROs were deemed not to be material.
5. Review and Report
Following the completion of the process, the final results 
went through the appropriate governance process and, 
finally, were approved by the Sustainability Committee. The 
following graphic provides an overview of the material topics 
for Kerry, accompanied by the tables on pages 142-145 
which identifies the material IROs. 
Our Material Topics
This matrix represents the topics that were deemed 
to be material, along with those that were deemed 
not to be material following the double materiality 
assessment process, as described. Refer to Impacts, 
Risks and Opportunities section on page 142 for 
details of the IROs for each material topic, respectively. 
Refer to each of the material topic sections within the 
Environmental section of this report for details of the 
environmental IRO-1 topical disclosures.
Financial Materiality
Impact Materiality
 Environmental Topic   
 Social Topic   
 Governance Topic
Financial Material Topics
Not Material Topics
Impact and Financial Material Topics
Impact Material Topics
  Pollution (E2)
  Waste and Circular Economy (E5)
  Community Relations (S3)
  Animal Welfare (G1)
  Ethics and Integrity (G1)
  Water Stewardship (E3)
  Responsible Employer (S1)
  Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging (S1)
  Responsible Communications (S4)
  Climate Change (E1)
  Biodiversity and Ecosystems (E4)
  Food Waste (E5)
  Working Conditions in the Upstream Value 
Chain (S2)
  Consumer Health (S4)
The topics are illustrated in order of E, S and G topics and by the numerical order of the topics within each ESRS topical 
standard. This order is not intended to represent the topics’ relative materiality within each quadrant. 
The assessment was conducted without reference to 
existing or future mitigations, however, consideration was 
given to Kerry’s current controls and processes to help 
inform the likelihood of potential risks and opportunities.
As part of our Beyond the Horizon strategy, reducing food 
waste is an important topic for Kerry. As identified through 
our double materiality assessment, the impact is greatest 
in our downstream value chain, partnering with customers 
to manage and reduce their food waste. While the impact 
from our own operations has become less material over 
time, we retain a focus on halving food waste across our 
manufacturing sites. 
Pollution was a topic for consideration through the double 
materiality assessment process and we consulted with 
stakeholders ahead of determining that this was not 
material at Group level. Our assessment of this topic 
included a high-level consideration of our operations and 
key activities across the value chain. 
As part of the double materiality process, the topic of 
governance across the value chain was assessed and 
thoroughly evaluated, considering the nature of our 
business and the transactions undertaken. Business 
integrity is a fundamental non-negotiable value for Kerry 
that is incorporated into our ways of working throughout 
our material topics.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
142
143
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement General
Impacts, Risks and Opportunities 
ESRS 2 SBM-3 – Description of material impacts, risks and opportunities resulting from materiality assessment
The material impacts, risks and opportunities (IRO) identified during the double materiality assessment are described 
for each material topic, along with the respective time horizon and value chain mapping for each. For impacts, the IRO 
Category describes whether they are deemed to be actual or potential, positive or negative.
IRO Description ​
IRO 
Category​
Time  
Horizon​
Value Chain  
Mapping
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
ESRS Topic - E1 Climate Change
Kerry Topic - Climate Change
Reducing GHG emissions across the value chain by working 
with stakeholders to create products with a lower carbon 
footprint and/or technologies that reduce emissions.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact ​
Impact through the utilisation of high carbon raw materials 
whose production results in substantial Scope 3 emissions.
Actual 
Negative 
Impact​
 
 
Damage to brand and/or business relationships if we fail to 
meet stakeholder expectations on climate change.
Risk ​
Policy changes and the introduction of legislation designed 
to constrain emissions which have the potential to add cost 
to our operations.
Risk ​
 
Cost of adopting and implementing new technology and 
interventions to enable the transition to net zero.
Risk ​
Physical risk due to extreme weather events, which may 
affect Kerry's ability to operate, and negatively impact on 
cost and/or revenue.
Risk ​
 
Increased consumer and customer demand for low-carbon 
products leads to increased demand/revenue associated 
with Kerry’s sustainable solutions. 
Opportunity​
 
 
ESRS Topic - E3 Water and Marine resources
Kerry Topic - Water Stewardship
The discharge of wastewater from our sites and the 
potential for adverse environmental consequences.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact​
 
 
Impact on water availability due to water withdrawals at 
Kerry's own operations and/or upstream in the value chain.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact​
​
 
1Own Ops = Own Operations
IRO Description ​
IRO 
Category​
Time  
Horizon​
Value Chain  
Mapping
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
ESRS Topic - E4 Biodiversity and Ecosystems
Kerry Topic - Biodiversity and Ecosystems
Land and ecosystem degradation from deforestation and 
conversion related to the sourcing of specific forest risk raw 
materials.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact​
 
 
Land and ecosystem degradation through climate change 
related to Scope 3 emissions.
Actual 
Negative 
Impact​
 
 
Raw material supply risk due to unsustainable resource 
extraction and land use practices, resulting in increased 
costs and lower operating profits.
Risk ​
​
 
 
Regulatory compliance risk due to additional regulatory 
burden and due diligence requirements, with reputational 
risk and or financial penalties for failure to comply.
Risk ​
​
 
Increased consumer and customer demand for products 
with better biodiversity outcomes leads to increased 
demand/revenue associated with Kerry's innovation 
expertise and sustainable solutions. ​
Opportunity​
 
 
ESRS Topic - E5 Resource Use and Circular Economy
Kerry Topic - Food Waste
Reducing the level of food loss and waste generated 
downstream through customer use of Kerry’s food 
technologies.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact ​
 
 
Increased revenue due to expansion and development of 
the market for longer product shelf-life through food waste 
technologies and innovations. 
Opportunity​
​
 
 
ESRS Topic - S1 Own Workforce 
Kerry Topic - Responsible Employer
Own workforce health, safety and wellbeing within the 
work-related environment.
Actual 
Negative 
Impact​
 
 
Employment security, stability, and engagement, by 
respecting employee representation in all regions 
according to local law, by having positive relationships 
with employee representatives, and maintaining a direct 
dialogue with employees.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact ​
 
 
Creating positive and engaging working conditions and 
safeguarding employee rights through compliance with 
national labour laws. 
Actual 
Positive 
Impact ​
 
 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
144
145
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement General
IRO Description ​
IRO 
Category​
Time  
Horizon​
Value Chain  
Mapping
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
ESRS Topic - S1 Own Workforce 
Kerry Topic - Responsible Employer
Employee attraction, retention, and development through 
flexibility, upskilling and career advancement opportunities.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact ​
 
 
Equal treatment and opportunities for employees by 
creating an environment that is safe from bullying and 
harassment and free from violence in all its forms.
Potential 
Positive 
Impact​
 
 
ESRS Topic - S1 Own Workforce 
Kerry Topic - Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging
Equal treatment and opportunities for employees by 
creating an environment of gender fairness, that is open to 
different cultures and abilities, and pays employees equal 
pay for work of equal value.
Potential 
Positive 
Impact​
 
 
Focusing on gender, ethnic and cultural diversity to ensure 
appropriate representation in Kerry. 
Potential 
Positive 
Impact​
 
 
ESRS Topic - S2 Workers in the Value Chain
Kerry Topic - Working Conditions in the Upstream Value Chain
Possible human rights infringements, particularly in higher-
risk geographies.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact​
 
 
Enhancing working conditions in geographies with poor 
labour laws by promoting responsible labour practices, fair 
wages, a safe working environment and providing support 
for representation and collective bargaining for workers in 
the upstream value chain.
Potential 
Positive 
Impact​
 
 
Potential risk to reputation and exposure to legal action 
arising from business relationships with suppliers that 
may breach workers rights and/or health and safety 
requirements.
Risk
 
 
Potential regulatory risk associated with supplier non-
compliance with human rights laws and expectations of 
stakeholders resulting in claims and/or fines.
Risk
 
 
IRO Description ​
IRO 
Category​
Time  
Horizon​
Value Chain  
Mapping
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
ESRS Topic - S4 Consumers and End-Users
Kerry Topic - Consumer Health
Access to sustainable and healthy nutrition through Kerry’s 
portfolio of products that contribute positive and balanced 
nutrition to consumer products.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact ​
 
 
Harm to consumer health resulting from failure to  
achieve our stringent food safety management standards 
and high product quality.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact​
 
 
Regulatory risk due to possible non-compliance with food 
ingredients and labelling regulations resulting in fines and 
legal consequences.
Risk
 
 
Market risk due to consumer preferences changing faster 
than Kerry’s business assumptions, resulting in lost revenue 
as Kerry lags behind the market shift.
Risk
 
 
Regulatory and compliance risk due to increase 
in regulatory burden resulting from governments 
implementing restrictions on specific food products to 
reduce diet-related non-communicable diseases in the 
general public.
Risk
 
Opportunity to expand market position and gain new 
customers through sustainable nutrition innovation.
Opportunity​
 
 
ESRS Topic - S4 Consumers and End-Users
Kerry Topic - Responsible Communications
Provide accurate and substantiated information, and 
increased transparency on nutritional labels and claims, 
thereby enabling product users to make more informed 
consumption decisions.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact ​
 
Reduced stakeholder trust through inaccurate or 
misleading communication surrounding progress on 
sustainability.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact ​
 
 
1Own Ops = Own Operations
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
146
147
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
1. Material Impacts, Risks  
and Opportunities 
ESRS 2 IRO-1 – Description of the processes to identify 
and assess material climate-related impacts, risks and 
opportunities
As part of Kerry’s double materiality assessment, we 
identified material climate-related impacts, risks and 
opportunities (IROs). The material IROs relate to climate 
change mitigation, including energy, in addition to climate 
change adaptation and are shown in the following table.  
Our approach to the materiality assessment is outlined in 
the General section on pages 140-145.
Within our double materiality assessment, we defined the 
following short, medium and long-term time horizons:
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short-term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
Description ​
Time  
Horizon​
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Reduced Emissions  
Reducing greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions across 
the value chain by working with stakeholders to 
create products with a lower carbon footprint and/or 
technologies that reduce emissions.
Actual 
Negative 
Impact
Scope 3 Emissions 
Impact through the utilisation of high carbon raw materials 
whose production results in substantial Scope 3 emissions.
 
 
Risk
Transition Reputation Risk 
Damage to brand and/or business relationships if we fail 
to meet stakeholder expectations on climate change.
 
 
Risk
Transition Policy Risk  
Policy changes and the introduction of legislation 
designed to constrain emissions which have the potential 
to add cost to our operations.
 
Risk
Transition Technology Risk 
Cost of adopting and implementing new technology and 
interventions to enable the transition to net zero.
Risk
Acute and Chronic Physical Risk  
Physical risk due to extreme weather events, which may 
affect Kerry’s ability to operate, and negatively impact on 
cost and/or revenue.
 
Opportunity
Increased Consumer Demand  
Increased consumer and customer demand for low-
carbon products leads to increased demand/revenue 
associated with Kerry’s sustainable solutions.
 
 
1Own Ops = Own Operations
Climate Change (E1)
1. Material Impacts, Risks and	
146 
Opportunities
2. Climate Transition Plan	
147
3. Climate Resilience Analysis	
151
4. Policies	
157
5. Targets	
158
6. Metrics	
159
Climate Change
2. Climate Transition Plan 
E1-1 – Transition plan for climate change mitigation  
E1-3 – Actions and resources in relation to climate  
change policies
As a global player in the food industry, Kerry has an 
important role to play in combating climate change 
and continues to develop and implement solutions 
contributing to a more environmentally responsible 
future. Our Climate Transition Plan (CTP) details our 
journey to net zero before 2050. As part of this, Kerry’s 
Scope 1 and 2 target to 2030 is science-based and verified 
by the Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi). Kerry's 
Scope 1 and 2, and Scope 3 targets before 2050, and 
Scope 3 target for 2030 were developed based on SBTi 
tools and have been submitted to SBTi for validation. 
Our targets have been developed to align with the Paris 
Agreement goals to limit the global average increase in 
temperatures to 1.5⁰C. Addressing climate change and 
the transition to a low carbon economy are complex and 
systemic challenges that present risks and opportunities 
for our industry. We have modelled how we expect our 
GHG emissions to change over time as a result of our 
business growth and planned climate actions. Our CTP 
sets out a selected range of decarbonisation actions to 
reduce our carbon footprint, while collaborating with 
others to drive meaningful change for our industry. 
Ambition
Through our Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy, 
Kerry has set ambitious GHG emissions reductions 
targets. We are committed to reaching net zero before 
2050 and have established 2030 science-based targets for 
our Scope 1 and 2 emissions. In 2024, we strengthened 
our commitment by updating our 2030 Scope 3 target 
and more clearly defining our long-term targets.   
Near-term Targets (2030)
•	 55% reduction in absolute Scope 1 and 2 emissions 
versus a 2017 base year
•	 30% reduction in absolute Scope 3 Forest, Land and 
Agriculture (FLAG) emissions versus a 2022 base year
•	 25% reduction in absolute Scope 3 non-FLAG 
emissions versus a 2022 base year
Net Zero Targets (Before 2050)
•	 90% reduction in absolute Scope 1 and 2 emissions 
versus a 2017 base year
•	 90% reduction in absolute Scope 3 non-FLAG 
emissions versus a 2022 base year
•	 72% reduction in absolute Scope 3 FLAG emissions 
versus a 2022 base year  
In 2024, we achieved a 50% decrease in our Scope 1 and 2 
emissions, versus our 2017 base year, and a 5% reduction 
in our total Scope 3 emissions, versus a 2022 base year. 
For more information on Kerry’s GHG emission reduction 
targets that support our CTP, please refer to the Targets 
section on pages 158-159.
Actions 
Scope 3 Emissions (Upstream)
Approximately 95% of our emissions are generated outside of our direct operations, with 83% attributable to the 
procurement of goods and services. We understand that achieving our emissions targets is largely driven by our ability 
to engage effectively across our value chain. This necessitates collaboration with our suppliers, industry peers, and a 
broader ecosystem of stakeholders across our industry. In 2024, incorporated within our activities were the following 
key actions to progress towards the achievement of our climate-related policy objectives and targets: 
Action Area
Key Actions Taken in 2024
GHG Emission 
Achieved in 
2024 or Full 
Year Expected 
Reduction 
'000 tCO₂e
Agriculture
•	 We initiated sustainable sourcing programmes with dairy, wheat and 
corn suppliers in North America, incentivising farmers to implement 
regenerative agriculture practices, for the purpose of reducing carbon 
emissions. Compensation under these programmes is outcome-based 
with producers rewarded for the actual carbon reduction achieved and 
supported by third-party verification. The reduction in emissions relating 
to these initiatives are expected to be realised beginning in 2025.  
•	 In addition to existing sustainable farming practices within the Evolve 
programme, we further expanded the programme adding a further 
five eligible actions for incentivisation. The programme's primary 
goal is to reward suppliers for sustainable farming practices and to 
incentivise adoption of additional sustainability measures resulting in 
further reductions in carbon emissions.
13 
Full year 
expected 
 
 
 
 
122 
Achieved 
in year
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
148
149
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
Scope 1 and 2 Emissions (Own Operations)
Although our own operations represent just 5% of our overall GHG emissions, it is the area where we have the most 
direct impact. In 2024, incorporated within our activities were the following key actions to progress towards the 
achievement of our climate-related policy objectives and targets:
Action Area
Key Actions Taken in 2024
GHG Emission 
Achieved in 
2024 or Full 
Year Expected 
Reduction 
'000 tCO₂e
Energy 
Efficiency
•	 We invested in advanced process efficiency equipment aimed at reducing 
fuel consumption and lowering associated emissions. This included initiatives 
such as equipment upgrades and the integration of heat recovery systems. 
These investments underscore our commitment to operational sustainability, 
enabling energy efficiency and progress toward our emissions reduction 
targets. 
10 
Full year 
expected
Renewable 
Energy
•	 We signed Power Purchase Agreements (PPAs) with RWE in the UK. Due to 
commence in 2025, these agreements are for 11 years and will meet over 
50% of Kerry's current UK electricity consumption. It also supports the UK’s 
transition to lower carbon electricity, helping to fund development of two solar 
projects. We are currently assessing PPA opportunities across other regions.
•	 We made ongoing use of Renewable Energy Certificates (RECs) to reduce our 
Scope 2 emissions in 2024. Our procurement of market-based certifications 
means we align a greater portion of our electricity consumption with certified 
renewable energy sources. For more information on Kerry’s Scope 2 market-
based emissions, please refer to the Metrics section on pages 159-164. 
 
 
 
 
279 
Achieved 
in year
Our Pathway to Net Zero
Our ambition to reach net zero before 2050 is a core element of our Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy, ensuring 
we deliver a positive impact while mitigating future risks and safeguarding the long-term success of our business. 
Building on our pathway reported in 2023, we developed a more detailed roadmap to support our transition including 
targeted areas for intervention and associated actions. They provide the focus for us globally as we deliver on our 
2030 science-based targets and our longer-term journey towards net zero. We will seek to integrate new technologies 
and solutions as these become available. Our planned actions, and their estimated contribution towards Kerry’s 2030 
reduction targets are set out by GHG scope and action area.
Scope 3 Emissions (Upstream)
Action Area
Future Actions Planned
Estimated 
Emissions 
reduction 
potential 
to 2030 
'000 tCO₂e
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Agriculture
Support increased use of practices to reduce inputs and 
emissions, restore soil health and increase biodiversity, e.g. 
regenerative practices like no- and low-till, optimisation of fertiliser 
use, reduction of livestock methane emissions through better 
herd and feed management.
1,195
Land Use & 
Deforestation
Prevent deforestation and conversion of land in our supply 
chain and seek opportunities for reforestation, which will reduce 
emissions related to inputs used in our products.
120
 
Product 
Reformulation
Innovate with lower carbon raw materials in partnership with 
customers to reduce the carbon footprint of our portfolio and our 
customer solutions. 
130
Action Area
Future Actions Planned
Estimated 
Emissions 
reduction 
potential 
to 2030 
'000 tCO₂e
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Logistics
Optimise transport and distribution practices, including 
encouraging increased renewable energy use among our logistics 
partners to reduce emissions.
255
 
Energy 
Management
Improved energy management and the use of renewable energy 
resources by suppliers.
165
Other
Optimise product design and increase use of renewable 
feedstocks for inputs including plastic packaging. 
80
 
Scope 1 and 2 Emissions (Own Operations)
Action Area
Future Actions Planned
Estimated 
Emissions 
reduction 
potential 
to 2030 
'000 tCO₂e
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Energy 
Efficiency
Continued investment in energy efficiency to reduce consumption 
and associated emissions while exploring opportunities for 
increased electrification of processes. 
45
 
Renewable 
Energy
Investigation, piloting and scaling of new renewable thermal 
energy sources across our manufacturing sites (e.g. biomethane, 
hydrogen), which will reduce our emissions, while continuing to 
ensure our electricity is backed by renewable sources.  
55  
For actions disclosed in this section, the specified 
location of the actions across our value chain reflects 
where the impacts, risks and opportunities arise. We 
acknowledge that Kerry will need to initiate many of 
these activities from within our own operations. 
Integrating our CTP into our Strategy, 
Business Model and Investments
Our Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy, which 
includes our response to climate change, is embedded 
into our overall business strategy. Existing partnerships 
with customers create healthier, tastier, and more 
sustainable products, helping mitigate and adapt to 
climate change. We will continue to evolve our actions 
and make investments that are aligned with our overall 
strategic priorities. Our climate action plan identifies 
key areas of focus across our operations and wider 
value chain that will be integrated into our business 
decisions and financial planning. We will evolve our 
approach as we implement initiatives, gain insights, 
and adopt new technologies, recognising that there will 
be challenges along the journey. Our CTP will ultimately 
strengthen the resilience of our business and support 
our growth.
We continue to develop and invest in the initiatives 
necessary to achieve our 2030 and longer-term net 
zero targets. We consider carbon efficiency and 
sustainability impacts as part of our investment 
programmes. In 2024, we invested €13m of capital 
expenditure in the energy efficiency actions outlined 
on page 148, this capital expenditure is included 
in the additions line within note 12 of the Financial 
Statements. The expenditure in 2024 was not eligible 
and aligned under the EU Taxonomy, with the majority 
of the spend on activities not defined under the climate 
objectives. We anticipate that elements of our capital 
expenditure, particularly those relating to our planned 
energy efficiency projects, e.g. heat pumps and heat 
recovery, will meet the eligibility and alignment criteria 
under the EU Taxonomy. These investments are directly 
linked to our efforts to reduce Scope 1 and 2 emissions, 
aligning with the EU Taxonomy’s focus on sustainable 
economic activities. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
150
151
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
Our ability to implement climate-related actions is 
closely tied to the availability and allocation of resources, 
particularly financial resources. We estimate that the 
level of investment to realise future Scope 1, 2, and 3 
actions will be approximately 1% of revenue per annum, 
on average, in the period to 2030 with funding for 
investments expected to come from free cash flow. This 
estimate is based on a number of assumptions about the 
future of our business, the associated level of emissions 
and the potential cost to reduce these. Investments 
associated with new initiatives or projects we might 
undertake in the future are not fixed or predetermined 
and these will be influenced, particularly for Scope 3, by 
policy supports, collaborative funding opportunities and 
the outcome of engagement with stakeholders in our 
value chain. 
Locked-in GHG emissions are future emissions that 
will occur over the lifetime of an asset or product due 
to choices we make today. Our CTP sets out how we 
will reduce the majority of our emissions, recognising 
that some residual emissions will remain. Any potential 
locked-in Scope 1 and 2 GHG emissions are expected 
to be small. We anticipate being able to decarbonise 
90% or more of our operational emissions. By 2050, we 
may have some remaining hard-to-reduce Scope 3 GHG 
emissions. To achieve our net zero targets, we will offset 
these emissions as necessary in line with SBTi guidelines 
using carbon removals, i.e. natural or technical strategies 
that remove CO₂ from the atmosphere and provide 
secure long-term storage. Within a small number of our 
manufacturing sites, we use natural gas in combined 
heat and power plants. In 2024 there were no material 
capital expenditure (CapEx) investments in these 
assets. Kerry is not excluded from the EU Paris-aligned 
Benchmarks in accordance with the exclusion criteria 
stated in Articles 12.1 (d) to (g) and 12.2 of Commission 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 2020/1818 (Climate 
Benchmark Standards Regulation).	
Collaboration
We directly control only a small portion of our value 
chain emissions and driving transformation requires 
leadership and collaboration with suppliers, farmers, 
ingredient and packaging producers, transport providers, 
and customers. Mitigating climate change also requires 
collective action across industries and broader society. 
At Kerry, we are committed to taking action to reduce 
our carbon footprint where feasible solutions exist. We 
engage closely with suppliers and industry experts to 
drive initiatives and explore innovative solutions aimed at 
addressing known challenges and accelerating progress 
within key raw material categories, for example our 
engagement with the Palm Oil Collaboration Group. As 
more consumers seek products that make a positive 
impact on both the environment and society, we partner 
with our customers and suppliers to calculate product-
level carbon footprints. This effort enhances transparency 
in internal decision-making and fosters collaboration with 
stakeholders across the value chain. Recognising that 
we often share value chain partners with our peers, we 
believe in the collective benefits of helping our mutual 
suppliers set and achieve their climate goals. Through 
joint efforts in training, support, and the standardisation 
of data collection, we can overcome barriers and expedite 
progress towards reducing GHG emissions.
Governance
Climate Governance 
The Sustainability Committee of the Board guides 
and oversees Kerry’s Beyond the Horizon sustainability 
strategy, including our efforts on climate. It is supported 
by the Sustainability Executive Committee, which 
comprises Kerry’s CEO, CFO, and other members of our 
Executive Leadership Team. Together, they assess climate-
related impacts, risks, and opportunities, determine 
strategy, review progress, and prioritise actions. The Chief 
Operating Officer and our Procurement and Integrated 
Operations teams play a lead role in driving climate 
action across our business and wider supply chain with 
the support of other functional leaders and sustainability 
teams.
The Sustainability Executive Committee steered 
development of Kerry’s CTP with extensive cross-
functional support. Our CTP has been reviewed and 
approved by the Group’s Board of Directors. Progress 
against our plan will be monitored by the Sustainability 
Executive Committee and the Sustainability Committee. 
See pages 133-137 in the General section for further 
information on climate governance.
Reporting
Continuous monitoring of GHG emissions is critical to 
making progress. We track performance against our 
targets, with progress reported through the relevant 
functional sustainability councils, to the Sustainability 
Executive Committee and the Board’s Sustainability 
Committee. Updates on performance versus our 2030 
targets are shared externally in our Annual Report. 
We align our reporting with the following recognised 
standards and frameworks to maintain consistency and 
enable meaningful comparisons of our progress over 
time, including the European Sustainability Reporting 
Standards (ESRS), EU Taxonomy, Task Force on Climate-
related Financial Disclosures (TCFD), and the Greenhouse 
Gas (GHG) Protocol.
Linking Performance to Remuneration
Kerry’s remuneration philosophy ensures that executive 
remuneration is aligned to the Group’s purpose, 
culture and values, supports strategy and promotes 
the long-term success of the company. The Long-Term 
Incentive Plan (LTIP) for Executive Directors and senior 
leaders reflects this in three key areas of growth, return 
and sustainability. The incentive plan considers core 
sustainability metrics linked to our Beyond the Horizon 
sustainability strategy. The metrics used include Carbon 
Reduction, specifically the progress towards our science-
based targets on Scope 1 and 2 emissions. 
3. Climate Resilience Analysis 
Building on our previous climate scenario analysis, during 
2024 we conducted a comprehensive refresh to assess the 
resilience of our strategy and business model to climate-
related risks and opportunities.  
Identifying Climate-Related Risks  
and Opportunities
ESRS 2 IRO-1 – Description of the processes to identify 
and assess material climate-related impacts, risks and 
opportunities
In 2024, we enhanced our process for identifying and 
assessing climate-related impacts, risks and opportunities 
(IROs) in our operations and across our value chain, in 
line with the ESRS requirements. Our comprehensive 
approach incorporated several critical inputs: 
1.	 ESRS Double Materiality Assessment: As part of 
Kerry’s double materiality assessment, we identified 
material climate-related IROs as outlined on page 146. 
2.	 Previous Climate Risk Assessment: Insights from 
our previous detailed assessments provided the 
foundation for understanding potential climate risks 
and opportunities relevant to our business.
3.	 Peer Benchmarking and Gap Analysis: We conducted 
a benchmarking analysis of industry peers, identifying 
areas where our approach could be strengthened.
4.	 Screening of Actual and Potential GHG Emissions 
Sources: We analysed Kerry’s value chain to identify 
actual and potential future GHG emission sources 
including consideration of Kerry’s decarbonisation 
pathway. 
5.	 Climate Hazards: We considered the 28 climate 
hazards listed in ESRS E1 AR11, ensuring a thorough 
assessment of potential climate-related physical risks 
across our operations. 
Climate Hazard Screening Process: To identify relevant 
climate-related hazards and assess our exposure across 
economic activities and assets, we followed a systematic 
screening approach:
•	 Hazard Review: Reviewed the climate hazards 
listed in ESRS E1 AR11 and filtered hazards based 
on geographical relevance to our global operating 
locations. Hazards which are applicable from a 
geographical and business perspective were taken into 
consideration in the physical risk scenario analysis. All 
categories of transition risks as per ESRS E1 AR 12 were 
analysed to define significant transition risks for Kerry.
•	 Significance Evaluation: Assessed the remaining 
hazards to identify those representing potentially 
significant adverse effects on our economic activities. 
For physical risks, third-party climate data was 
employed to help assess the potential impact on sites 
through projection of exposure to extreme weather 
events. For transition risks, we evaluated the Group's 
exposure and sensitivity to identified transition events, 
considering the likelihood, magnitude, and duration of 
these events.
•	 Data Collection: Gathered data on historical exposure 
and projected changes for the identified hazards for 
our operating locations. 
•	 Future Intensity Screening: Filtered hazards and 
assets potentially exposed to significant increases in 
hazard intensity in the future.
•	 Risk Integration: Integrated the results with 
information on new assets and those with potential 
financial exposure, based on our previous risk 
assessment.
Identified risks and opportunities were categorised in line 
with the ESRS requirements: physical risks, encompassing 
the direct impacts of climate change on Kerry’s operations 
and value chain, and transition risks, arising from the 
global transition to a low-carbon economy and evolving 
carbon policies. The risks were further classified by risk 
types, distinguishing physical risks (acute and chronic) 
from transition risks (policy, technology, reputation, 
and market). Further details on the methodology used 
to assess climate-related hazards are provided in the 
Physical Risk Assessment section below.
Through a process of stakeholder engagement, regulatory 
guidance, Kerry’s risk management practices and expert 
judgement, we defined and documented a prioritised 
set of risks and opportunities for detailed quantitative 
assessment. This work was governed by a Decision-
Making Authority and the outputs were reviewed by the 
Sustainability Executive Committee, the Sustainability 
Committee and members of the Audit Committee. 
Assessing Climate-Related Risks  
and Opportunities
Time Horizons and Climate Scenario Analysis 
Approach
Within our climate scenario analysis, we defined the 
following short, medium and long-term time horizons:
•	 Short term: (January 2025 – December 2025)
•	 Medium term: (January 2026 – December 2030)
•	 Long term: (January 2031 – December 2049)
We evaluated the prioritised climate-related risks and 
opportunities using recognised sources to inform 
state-of-the-art scientific climate scenarios. This 
analysis drew on three climate scenarios informed 
by the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change 
(IPCC), Shared Socioeconomic Pathways (SSPs) and two 
International Energy Agency (IEA) World Energy Outlook 
(WEO) scenarios.
The climate scenario analysis covered Kerry’s entire value 
chain, encompassing upstream, manufacturing sites in 
own operations, and downstream activities. 
Climate Scenario Selection
The following climate scenarios were selected to 
assess potential physical risks and transition risks and 
opportunities over the short, medium, and long term:
•	 High Carbon Scenario; +4.3°C: IPCC Representative 
Concentration Pathway (IPCC SSP5-8.5).
•	 Medium Carbon Scenario; +2.4°C: IPCC Shared 
Socio-Economic Pathway (SSP2-4.5); IEA Stated Policies 
Scenario (STEPS).
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
152
153
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
•	 Low Carbon Scenario; +1.5°C Transition/<+2°C  
Physical: IPCC Shared Socio-Economic Pathway (SSP1-
1.9 & SSP1-2.6); IEA WEO Net Zero Emissions by 2050 
(NZE). SSP1-2.6 was used to assess physical risk due 
to limited integration of SSP1-1.9 within existing risk 
models.
The three scenarios represent the potential outcomes of 
temperature increases exceeding specific thresholds by 
the end of this century. Additionally, data from sources 
such as the Network for Greening the Financial System 
(NGFS), World Bank, Aqueduct, and Copernicus were 
used, among others, to assess risk and opportunity 
impacts across different climate scenarios.
By incorporating a Low Carbon Scenario (IPCC SSP1-1.9) 
and a High Carbon Scenario (IPCC SSP5-8.5) for both 
transition and physical risks, along with a Medium Carbon 
Scenario (IPCC SSP2-4.5), we have comprehensively 
assessed the combined potential impacts on our 
business.
Climate Scenarios - Key Forces and Drivers 
The three carbon scenarios reflect varying levels of 
policy commitment and technological advancement. The 
Low Carbon scenario (+1.5°C/below +2.0°C) anticipates 
stringent global policies and rapid renewable energy 
advancements, while the Medium Carbon scenario 
(+2.4°C) projects moderate policy coordination and 
technology progression. The High Carbon scenario 
(+4.3°C) represents limited policy action and a slower pace 
in sustainable technology adoption, leading to substantial 
increases in GHG emissions.
Scenario 
Name
+1.5°C/below +2.0°C 
Low Carbon Scenario
+2.4°C 
Medium Carbon Scenario 
+4.3°C 
High Carbon Scenario
Description
Examines the potential 
changes that may occur if 
global collaboration enables 
aggressive emissions reduction 
to meet Paris Agreement goals, 
thereby keeping global average 
temperature increase below 1.5°C, 
for transition, or below 2.0°C for 
physical risks, by 2100. 
Assumes that governments take an 
uncoordinated response based on 
announced policy commitments, 
which is insufficient to meet 
Paris Agreement goals, resulting 
in global average temperature 
increase exceeding 2.4°C by 2100.
Represents a high-risk future with 
rapid economic growth fuelled 
by fossil fuels, minimal climate 
action, and significant global 
warming. Temperatures could rise 
over 4°C by 2100, causing severe 
environmental and economic 
impact.
Sources  
Used 
IPCC SSP1-1.9 (Transition Risks) 
IPCC SSP1-2.6 (Physical Risks) 
IEA Net Zero Emissions by 2050 
(NZE2050)
IPCC SSP2-4.5 
IEA Stated Policies Scenario 
(STEPS)
IPCC SSP5-8.5
Policy
Governments globally 
implement aggressive climate 
policies, including high carbon 
prices.
Policy commitments are 
implemented; however, they lack 
coordination and enforcement. 
Carbon pricing levels are 
moderate, aligning with existing 
policy commitments.
Minimal or ineffective climate 
policy action globally, with 
minimal or no carbon pricing 
implemented.
Technology 
Rapid advancements in 
renewable energy technologies 
deployment and energy 
efficiency improvements.
Moderate advancements in 
renewable energy technologies 
deployment and energy 
efficiency improvements.
Technological advancements 
primarily focused on enhancing 
fossil fuel extraction and 
consumption efficiency.
Energy 
Consumption
Global energy consumption 
growth slows down.
Global energy demand continues 
to rise.
Global energy consumption 
sees significant increases.
Energy Mix
A substantial increase in the 
share of renewable energy 
sources (solar, wind, hydro) 
and a decrease in fossil fuel 
dependency.
A gradual increase in the share 
of renewables, but fossil fuels 
remain a significant part of the 
energy landscape.
The global energy mix is 
dominated by fossil fuels.
Energy Prices The cost of renewable energy 
technologies continues to 
decline, fossil fuel prices 
increase.
While renewable energy costs 
decrease, fossil fuel prices 
remain relatively stable.
Fossil fuel prices remain 
competitive, renewable 
energy costs do not decrease 
significantly.
Scenario 
Name
+1.5°C/below +2.0°C 
Low Carbon Scenario
+2.4°C 
Medium Carbon Scenario 
+4.3°C 
High Carbon Scenario
Environment
Reduced greenhouse gas 
emissions leading to slower 
environmental degradation and 
less extreme climate change 
impacts, such as extreme  
weather events.
Persistent greenhouse gas 
emissions, contributing to 
increasing global temperatures, 
more frequent and extreme 
weather events.
Continued high levels of 
greenhouse gas emissions lead 
to severe environmental impacts, 
including significant increases 
in average global temperatures, 
more frequent and intense 
extreme weather events.
Economy
Initial economic costs incurred 
due to the transition, long-term 
economic benefits from green 
job creation, reduced health costs 
from pollution, and improved 
energy security.
Economic growth continues, with 
uneven regional distribution. 
Certain regions experiencing 
more significant impacts from 
climate-related disruptions which 
affect global supply chains, 
agricultural productivity, and 
overall economic stability.
Rapid economic growth 
increasingly hindered by the 
adverse impacts of climate 
change, such as damage from 
extreme weather, resource 
scarcity, and escalating costs 
from climate-related disruptions.
Scenario Constraints and Areas of Uncertainty
The selected scenarios offer meaningful insights but 
are subject to inherent limitations. The complex array of 
variables impacting future outcomes introduces unavoidable 
uncertainties. To navigate these challenges and address 
data gaps, we have made strategic assumptions regarding 
the future trajectory of our business. These assumptions are 
grounded in credible third-party data sources and expert 
judgement. While third-party climate models provide tools 
for evaluating physical risks, the transition to a low-carbon 
economy remains uncertain, as differing approaches are 
adopted by governments, consumers, and industries at 
varied timelines.
The effectiveness of our scenario analysis is contingent 
upon several key inputs and constraints:
•	 Geospatial Specificity: Our analysis incorporates 
geospatial coordinates specific to our operational 
locations. This allows for a more granular assessment 
of physical climate-related risks, enabling us to identify 
localised hazards such as extreme weather, coastal 
inundation, and water stress that could impact our 
assets and operations.
•	 Value Chain Interaction with Suppliers: In assessing 
raw materials risk, we have assumed that suppliers will 
transfer all potential carbon emission-related costs to 
Kerry, leading to increased costs for the Group. 
•	 Impact of Global Warming on Crop Yields: Global 
warming may impact the yields of certain key crops 
sourced by Kerry. Nevertheless, crop response to 
warming remains uncertain, with effects likely to vary 
significantly by region and over time.
•	 Cost of Net Zero Transition Across Value Chain: 
The cost of interventions across Kerry’s value 
chain is expected to vary significantly based on 
commodity type and geographic region. Our 
analysis considers CO₂ pricing impacts as a reliable 
indicator of potential worst-case scenarios, allowing 
us to quantify the financial risks associated with 
increasing carbon prices.
•	 Macroeconomic Assumptions: CO₂ prices, energy 
costs, consumer demand and other scenario 
assumptions vary across climate scenario sources and 
are subject to evolving market and policy conditions. 
•	 Timing and Scale of Interventions: The timing and 
scope of policy measures aimed at reducing emissions 
will vary. For transition risks, we assume a level of 
intervention aligned with a +1.5°C temperature 
pathway, even where the likelihood and timing of these 
interventions remains uncertain.
Assessment of Physical Risks
We have established short, medium, and long-term time 
horizons to guide our assessment of physical climate 
risks. These timeframes are aligned with the expected 
lifespan of our assets, our strategic planning cycles, and 
capital allocation strategies:
•	 Short term (1 year): This horizon is aligned with our 
annual operational planning and budgeting cycle, 
focusing on immediate physical risk impacts affecting 
our operational assets.
•	 Medium term (2–5 years): This period corresponds 
to our mid-term strategic planning and the initial 
phases of capital allocation, addressing emerging risks 
that may influence asset performance and resource 
allocation.
•	 Long term (6–25 years): The long-term horizon 
reflects the anticipated operational lifespans of our key 
assets and supports our long-range strategic objective 
to achieve net zero before 2050.
The scope of this assessment focused on identified risks 
across our operations and upstream value chain, and was 
based on the high-emission climate scenario IPCC SSP5-
8.5, which identified relevant climate-related hazards 
under a worst-case scenario. 
Types of Physical Risks Assessed: 
•	 Acute physical risks refer to those risks that are 
event driven, including increased severity of extreme 
weather events.
•	 Chronic physical risks refer to longer-term shifts in 
climate patterns that may lead to impacts such as 
rising sea levels or water stress.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
154
155
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
To understand the potential exposure and sensitivity of our 
assets and business activities to relevant climate-related 
hazards, we considered the likelihood, magnitude, and 
duration of these hazards. Kerry’s global manufacturing 
footprint was screened for exposure across defined time 
horizons using third-party climate models and geospatial 
coordinates specific to each of our locations, while risks 
to key raw materials were assessed on a global basis 
using independent published data, including World Bank 
commodity prices.  
Operations
To assess risks to our manufacturing footprint we reviewed 
the list of climate hazards and filtered these based on 
geographical relevance to our global operating locations. 
We assessed which remaining hazards could potentially 
have adverse effects on our economic activities and where 
there was potential for significant increases in hazard 
intensity over time. By combining this data with outputs 
from our previous risk assessment, we prioritised a subset 
of sites for further analysis of exposure to relevant hazards. 
Extreme Weather and Coastal Inundation: To assess the 
potential impact on operational sites, we combined site 
revenue and asset information with third-party climate 
data to help quantify value at risk and/or losses associated 
with potential business interruption. 
Water Stress: Sites with higher exposure to water risk were 
identified using inputs including water use and data from 
the World Resource Institute’s Aqueduct tool. By modelling 
potential impacts on production at these sites as a result 
of variations in precipitation patterns, we determined 
potential revenue losses due to limited water availability.
Raw Material Supply Chain
We examined how future physical climate changes may 
impact global raw material availability, focusing on a 
selected basket of key agricultural inputs – corn, soy, wheat, 
and dairy – used across our business. To assess potential 
cost increases, we modelled forecasted purchase volumes 
and potential price increases considering anticipated 
climate change impacts. While the assessment indicated 
the potential for some acute impacts to agricultural output, 
with impacts varying by commodity, the most significant 
impacts for the selected raw materials are not anticipated 
to take effect within the period examined. Given the 
uncertainty relating to these impacts, we will continue to 
keep this assessment under review. 
Physical Risk Assessment – Key Findings 
We assessed the physical risks outlined across a range 
of scenarios, including a high emissions scenario, and 
while we identified a small number of sites with higher 
levels of exposure to climate hazards, our assessment has 
indicated a low level of financial risk across the period to 
2050. Therefore, as the scenario analysis performed has 
not shown these risks to be material either individually 
or in aggregate, we have not disclosed these separately. 
This quantitative modelling provides important insights 
into climate-related risks while being subject to inherent 
uncertainties and limitations. These models depend on 
numerous assumptions, such as future greenhouse gas 
emission trajectories, the success of climate mitigation 
measures, and the complex responses of natural systems 
to rising temperatures. Consequently, forecasts for 
physical risks, including floods, storms, heatwaves, 
and sea-level rise, can differ considerably based on the 
scenario applied, reflecting the range of potential future 
climate conditions and the challenges in predicting 
specific outcomes with precision. Our double materiality 
assessment incorporates the results of the scenario 
analysis, while acknowledging its limitations, and also 
considering the views of stakeholders on the scale, scope 
and irremediable character of risks. 
Assessment of Transition Risks  
and Opportunities
Transitioning to a lower-carbon economy may entail 
extensive policy, technology and market changes. 
Depending on the nature, speed and focus of these 
changes, transition risks may pose varying levels of 
financial risk or opportunity to Kerry. In this analysis, we 
evaluated the Group’s exposure and sensitivity to identified 
transition events, considering the magnitude and duration 
of these events. Climate-related scenario analysis was used 
for the assessment of transition risks and opportunities 
over the short, medium and long term. The analysis 
focused on a +1.5°C pathway consistent with the Paris 
Agreement, based on IPCC (SSP1-1.9) and IEA (Net Zero 
Emissions by 2050) scenarios. 
As part of our assessment of transition risks and 
opportunities, we reviewed assets and activities that may 
present challenges in aligning with a climate-neutral 
economy. With 5% of total emissions arising from Scope 1 
and 2 (market-based) sources, Kerry’s exposure to locked-
in emissions is limited. 
Policy 
Regulatory risks, both current and emerging, are a 
key climate consideration for the Group. Given our 
global footprint, Kerry may be subject to a range of 
regulatory requirements across jurisdictions and the 
varying scope, scale, and speed of implementation will 
pose challenges for all organisations. Among the most 
prominent policy risks for our business is the expansion 
of carbon pricing by governments aiming to reduce 
emissions in line with the Paris Agreement. Currently, 
three of our manufacturing facilities are subject to the 
EU and UK emissions trading schemes; the expansion 
of these schemes, the introduction of similar pricing 
mechanisms in other regions, or the application of 
carbon pricing to raw material inputs may result in 
significant future costs for our business. 
Technology 
As detailed in the CTP section above, our journey to 
net zero will involve upgrading assets and deploying 
new interventions to reach our targets within our own 
operations, while new processes, technologies and 
innovations will be required across our value chain. 
Through our CTP, we have identified key levers for 
achieving net zero. For own operations, we modelled the 
potential investment to 2030, along with the anticipated 
cost savings from a targeted energy mix. The assessment 
indicates that decarbonisation of our operations presents 
an opportunity for our business. The energy transition will 
mitigate potential increases in energy and carbon costs 
from fossil fuel-based energy and lead to lower operating 
expenses. For our value chain, we modelled potential 
increases in the costs of key raw materials associated 
with implementing new processes, technologies and 
innovations using expected carbon prices under the  
low carbon (+1.5°C) transition scenario as a proxy for  
the investment required over the medium to long term. 
The assessment indicates the potential for significant  
costs for our business. 
Reputation
We realise that climate change also represents a significant 
reputational risk for organisations. Kerry works with the 
world’s leading food and beverage brands, many of whom 
have made their own commitments on climate change. 
They increasingly seek partners that are aligned with 
their own objectives and can support them in achieving 
their targets. This presents an opportunity for Kerry as 
we deliver on our Beyond the Horizon commitments. 
Conversely, failure to take adequate action on climate 
change could impact our reputation and damage 
commercial and other important stakeholder relationships, 
resulting in the loss of revenue from customers.
Market
While climate change presents potentially significant risks 
for our industry, it also offers considerable opportunities 
for Kerry, especially as customer and consumer 
preferences shift. Our assessment considered how 
consumer sentiment may drive demand for lower-carbon 
alternatives in the food and beverage sector. Proprietary 
research indicates that consumers increasingly favour 
healthier products with a reduced environmental impact.
Potential Financial Effects of Material Transition-Related Risks and Opportunities
Risk/Opportunity 
Type
Risk/Opportunity
Description
Description of +1.5⁰C Scenario Modelled
Short Term: 
2025
Medium Term: 
2026 - 2030 
(Cumulative Impact)
Long Term: 
2031 - 2049 
(Cumulative Impact)
Policy 
Risk
Policy changes and  
the introduction 
of legislation designed to 
constrain emissions have the 
potential to add cost to our 
operations.
We modelled the impact of a carbon price 
applied across both our operations and 
selected raw materials based on IEA (Net 
Zero Emissions by 2050) projections. 
Low
High
High
Technology
Risk
Cost of adopting 
and implementing 
new technology and 
interventions to enable  
the transition to net zero.
We modelled the potential costs and cost 
savings associated with a targeted energy 
mix and the expected level of investment 
required to achieve our Scope 1 and 2 
targets. For Scope 3, we modelled the 
potential increase in the costs of key raw 
materials associated with implementing 
new processes, technologies and 
innovations using expected carbon prices 
under the low carbon scenario (+1.5°C) as 
a proxy for the investment required.
Medium
High
High
Reputation
Risk
Damage to brand and/or 
business relationships if 
we fail to meet stakeholder 
expectations on climate 
change​.
We modelled a potential reduction in 
revenue with a selection of customers that 
have made strong climate commitments.  
Low
High
High
Market
Opportunity
Increased consumer and 
customer demand for lower-
carbon products leads to 
increased demand/revenue 
associated with Kerry’s 
sustainable solutions. 
We modelled a potential uplift in revenue 
for selected lower carbon technologies 
(Plant, Food Protection & Preservation and 
Smoke Flavours), due to anticipated shifts 
in consumer buying preferences.  
Med
High
High
Note: Climate risks and opportunities are considered separately, and the potential impacts are not cumulative. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
156
157
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
The Impact of Climate Change Risks 
on Our Financial Statements
We considered the potential impacts of individual 
climate change risks when preparing our Consolidated 
Financial Statements and have determined that there is 
no material impact on the financial reporting judgements 
and estimates and as a result there is no impact on 
the valuations of the Group’s assets and liabilities from 
these risks as at 31 December 2024. The impact of some 
of the climate-related scenarios have been considered 
in the impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite 
life intangible assets, using the outputs of the climate 
scenario analysis. The Group performed a number of 
sensitivity scenarios to incorporate climate-related risks 
and opportunities including impacts on revenue and 
profitability, future capital expenditure and investments, as 
well as volatility associated with other risks identified. The 
useful lives of assets are based on historical experience 
with similar assets, as well as anticipation of future events, 
which may impact their life, such as changes in technology 
or the location of the asset and its climate-related risk. 
As outlined in our CTP, Kerry does not anticipate 
significant levels of locked-in GHG emissions. By 2050, 
we may have some remaining hard-to-reduce emissions 
across Scope 1 and 2, and Scope 3. We will offset these 
emissions as necessary, in line with SBTi guidelines using 
carbon removals, i.e. natural or technical strategies that 
remove CO₂ from the atmosphere and provide secure 
long-term storage. We anticipate that elements of our 
capital expenditure, particularly those related to our 
planned energy efficiency projects, e.g. heat pumps and 
heat recovery, will meet the eligibility and alignment 
criteria under the EU Taxonomy. 
Strategy and Business Model 
ESRS 2 SBM-3 – Material impacts, risks and opportunities and 
their Interaction with strategy and business model
Scope of the Resilience Analysis
The resilience analysis was conducted in 2024 and aligns 
with the time horizons used for scenario analysis and 
our climate targets. It takes account of the key drivers 
outlined on pages 152-153 and covers our full value 
chain, considering the raw materials we source, locations 
where we manufacture our products and the potential for 
changing customer and consumer demands. 
Results of the Resilience Analysis 
When reviewing our strategy, considering various 
climate-related scenarios, including a +1.5°C scenario 
for transition risk, we observe a high level of resilience. 
Kerry acknowledges the significant risks posed by climate 
change to its operations, supply chain, and business 
relationships. Where risks are identified, we implement 
mitigating actions to ensure long-term resilience and 
sustainability. 
The overall resilience analysis was conducted on a Group-
wide basis and used the outputs of our scenario analysis 
and CTP as key inputs. Our extensive geographic footprint 
and strategy of co-locating operations close to our 
customers results in more limited exposure to climate-
related physical hazards at any single location. 
In our value chain, while acute weather impacts on 
crop production have the potential to create short-term 
disruptions and/or price increases, these are managed 
through our diversified global sourcing strategy and 
pricing model. We assessed the potential for more 
chronic climate-related changes on raw material 
production in our scenario analysis and expect these to 
emerge over a longer time horizon. We acknowledge the 
uncertainty within climate models and the potential for 
impacts to materialise more quickly and will keep these 
risks under ongoing review. 
Transition risks and opportunities may emerge more 
quickly, and Kerry’s net zero ambition and CTP are crucial 
to managing these effectively. The implementation of this 
plan will support us in lowering our total emissions thereby 
mitigating the impacts of policy and reputational transition 
risks and ensuring ongoing resilience of our business. 
For climate-related transition opportunities, the 
commitment to net zero and decarbonisation of our 
operations in line with our published plan will help us 
to capitalise on the energy transition. Our innovation 
capabilities, our product portfolio and existing strategy, 
rooted in sustainable nutrition, means we are ideally 
placed to capture the market opportunity for lower-
carbon alternatives as customers and consumers 
increasingly integrate climate considerations into their 
product choice. 
Strategy and Business Model Resilience
Our strategy and business model are centred on 
partnering with customers to create healthier, tastier, and 
more sustainable products. Given sustainable nutrition 
is core to our strategy, climate-related considerations are 
increasingly integrated into our strategic planning and 
investment decisions. With a global presence, leading 
product portfolio and science-backed innovation capability, 
we can already integrate climate solutions to create 
lower-carbon products for customers and/or to help them 
adapt to impacts of climate change on their portfolio. We 
continue to develop lower-carbon technologies to further 
expand our portfolio of sustainable solutions. 
The Group’s CTP sets out how we will reduce our carbon 
footprint to reach net zero aligned with the +1.5°C 
pathway. The emissions reductions to date and ongoing 
achievement of our targets will help to ensure our 
progress. Meeting these reductions by 2050 will help 
ensure our resilience to transition risks. 
To address physical climate-related risks across our 
sites, our integrated operations teams assess risks and 
manage these at site level or through engagement 
with stakeholders such as our insurance providers and 
expert partners. A clearly defined approach to crisis 
management and business continuity planning also 
ensures the resilience of our operations in the event of 
impacts from a climate-related hazard. 
We are increasingly engaged with our raw material 
suppliers on climate change and exploring how raw 
materials can be produced with lower impacts. This 
work helps us to better understand climate risks within 
specific raw material categories. The interventions we 
have identified for lowering emissions, like regenerative 
agriculture, can also help farms become more resilient to 
the future impacts of climate change.
Adaptability of Strategy and Business Model 
to Climate Change
We consider our current strategy and business model 
to be well positioned to manage risks and capture 
opportunities presented by climate change over the short, 
medium, and long term. Our assessment of climate-
related risks and opportunities enables us to identify 
potential impact areas and necessary actions. The global 
and diverse nature of our business, combined with our 
capacity to innovate at pace in response to customer 
and consumer needs, supports our ability to adapt to 
evolving external conditions and industry requirements. 
This allows us to ensure continued access to finance at 
an affordable cost of capital, to redeploy, upgrade, or 
decommission assets as needed, to shift our product and 
service offerings, and to invest in reskilling our workforce 
to remain responsive and resilient in a changing climate 
landscape.
Prioritisation of Sustainability-Related Risks
Within our risk management framework, we adopt an 
integrated approach to assessing and managing climate-
related risks across our business and wider value chain, 
which involves a dual approach as follows: 
•	 We include 'climate change' as a standalone principal 
risk for our business, considering the longer-term 
systemic nature of the risk and the requirements for 
shorter-term action to mitigate and plan for this. 
•	 We also consider how discrete climate-related impacts 
can affect other risk areas and integrate climate 
considerations within additional principal risks, for 
example, the potential impacts of extreme weather on 
raw material availability. 
As part of the Group’s enterprise risk management 
framework, we have defined parameters under which we 
quantify potential impact. The significance of this risk is 
determined using a standard risk scoring methodology 
to ensure consistency in reporting and evaluation of risks. 
For more see our Risk Management Report on page 46.
Areas of Uncertainty
Our resilience analysis is global in nature and areas of 
risk considered are included within our broader business 
strategy and investment decisions, with our CTP helping 
to identify relevant mitigations. The analysis is informed 
by relevant climate scenarios and as such is subject to 
certain limitations relating to the assumptions we have 
made about the future of our business, the climate 
models used to assess physical risk and timing and scope 
of transition impacts. Further details are available on page 
153. 
4. Policies
E1-2 – Policies related to climate change mitigation and 
adaptation 
Our Environmental Responsibility Policy supports the 
achievement of our climate targets under our Beyond the 
Horizon sustainability strategy. It summarises the strategies 
to manage our material climate change impacts, risks, and 
opportunities and encompasses climate change mitigation, 
including energy, and adaptation. 
For climate mitigation, we are committed to reducing 
emissions across our operations and value chain, 
investing in research and development for low-carbon 
products and collaborating to reduce Scope 3 emissions. 
The policy underscores our commitment to energy 
efficiency through innovation and our goal to achieve 
100% renewable purchased electricity by the end of 2025. 
For climate adaptation, we focus on managing risks 
related to the physical impacts of climate change, such as 
extreme weather events, which could affect raw material 
availability and operational facilities.
The policy applies globally to Kerry Group plc, including 
our subsidiaries, partners, and suppliers, and covers 
all business locations and activities. It is designed to 
encompass the entire value chain, from raw materials 
through to customer use, with potential adjustments to 
align with local laws. Key stakeholders impacted by this 
policy include Kerry employees, suppliers, customers, and 
the local communities in which we operate. We engage 
with these stakeholders to incorporate their interests 
into our policy framework. For more information on our 
stakeholder engagement please see our General section 
on pages 138-139. 
Kerry is committed to respecting internationally 
recognised guidelines and third-party standards through 
implementing the policy, including the Paris Climate 
Agreement, RE100, Science Based Target initiative (SBTi), 
United Nations Global Compact, applicable United Nations 
Sustainable Development Goals (UN SDGs), and several 
industry-wide initiatives. More information on these 
industry initiatives can be found in our full Environmental 
Responsibility Policy.
We periodically review our commitments to maintain 
a science-based approach to effectively mitigate our 
impacts. Our performance is monitored and reported 
using climate-related metrics, with accountability upheld 
by our Chief Operating Officer, who provides ongoing 
oversight of our strategies and progress toward achieving 
our climate commitments.
Kerry’s Environmental Responsibility Policy is available on 
our intranet and on kerry.com.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
158
159
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
5. Targets1
E1-4 – Targets related to climate change mitigation and 
adaptation 
Kerry generates GHG emissions directly from the fuels 
consumed at our facilities (Scope 1), indirectly from the 
electricity and heat we procure (Scope 2), and from a 
variety of activities throughout our value chain (Scope 
3), including the production of raw materials. These 
emissions contribute to climate change, which presents 
significant environmental and social challenges. 
In 2024, we strengthened our commitment to net zero 
by updating our 2030 Scope 3 target and establishing 
long-term targets, all of which have been submitted to 
the Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi) for validation. 
This disclosure details our specific GHG emissions targets, 
progress, and governance structure.
Our GHG Emission Reduction Targets
In alignment with the Paris Agreement and to achieve the 
climate objectives set out in our environmental policy and 
CTP, Kerry has set targets to achieve net zero emissions 
before 2050, reinforcing our commitment to climate 
action. These targets cover our operations and value 
chain and are informed by ongoing engagement with 
both internal and external stakeholders, through various 
avenues and forums, including surveys and interviews 
conducted as part of the double materiality assessment. 
For more information on our stakeholder engagement 
please see our General section on pages 138-139. The 
targets were set using a combination of cross-sector 
and sectoral pathways available from SBTi to ensure 
they are compatible with limiting global temperature 
increase to 1.5°C. The SBTi validation process ensures 
alignment. We use a range of primary and secondary 
data to calculate our GHG emissions and set our targets 
and this can require us to make assumptions for certain 
Scope 3 categories for example, on the processing of our 
products by customers. All our GHG emissions targets 
are measured in kilotonnes of CO₂ equivalents.  For more 
information on our stakeholder engagement please see 
our General section on pages 138-139.  
Operational Emissions (Scope 1 and 2)
Our Scope 1 and 2 targets are based on the SBTi 
Corporate Net Zero Standard and follow a cross-sectoral 
decarbonisation pathway, absolute contraction approach 
(ACA), that aligns with +1.5°C scenarios. This cross-sectoral 
pathway provides a scientifically robust foundation for our 
emissions reduction. Our 2030 target is for a 55% absolute 
reduction in Scope 1 and 2 (market-based) GHG emissions 
by 2030, compared to our 2017 base year. The target 
increases to a 90% reduction of emissions before 2050. 
100% of emissions reported in the emissions summary 
table on page 163 are in scope and a 2017 base year was 
selected as an appropriate base year, as it represented 
a normal operating period, when this target was first 
developed in 2019. The GHG emission reduction targets 
are gross targets, meaning that Kerry does not include 
GHG removals, carbon credits or avoided emissions as a 
means of achieving our GHG emission reduction targets. 
Our 2030 target is recognised by SBTi as aligned with a 
+1.5°C temperature pathway and our before 2050 target 
has recently been submitted for validation. Please refer 
to the emissions summary table on page 163 for more 
information on Scope 1 and 2 emissions.
Other Indirect Emissions (Scope 3)
Kerry’s Scope 3 target follows the SBTi Forest, Land, and 
Agriculture (FLAG) guidelines to address emissions tied 
to agriculture, forestry, and other land use, which are 
particularly relevant to our upstream value chain. For non-
FLAG emissions, we used a cross-sectoral decarbonisation 
pathway, ACA. Both targets align with climate and 
policy scenarios that support a +1.5°C pathway. In 2024, 
we adopted this approach, categorising our Scope 3 
emissions into FLAG and Non-FLAG. These targets have 
been submitted to SBTi for validation and are detailed 
below. 
•	 FLAG Emissions: Achieve a 30% absolute reduction in 
FLAG emissions by 2030 compared to a 2022 base year 
and a 72% reduction before 2050.
•	 Scope 3 Non-FLAG Emissions: Achieve a 25% 
reduction in absolute Scope 3 non-FLAG emissions 
by 2030, compared to a 2022 base year and a 90% 
reduction before 2050.
Key Assumptions in Target Setting
When setting these targets, we made several critical 
assumptions related to potential future developments, 
including the anticipated increase in sales volumes and 
associated impact on emissions. We also considered 
the potential impact of regulatory changes, changes to 
customer preferences and the advent of new technologies 
that will help to advance our climate transition. In doing 
so, we ensure our targets and CTP are more resilient 
and responsive to evolving market, regulatory, and 
technological trends.
Target Boundaries 
In line with SBTi requirements, Kerry has defined 
boundaries for the application of these targets, with 
coverage increasing over time. Our Scope 1 and 2 
targets include all emissions. For Scope 3, the following 
boundaries apply and are consistent with SBTi guidance: 
•	 Near-Term Boundary (2030): Includes 70% of FLAG 
emissions and 68% of our non-FLAG emissions.
•	 Long-Term Boundary (2050): Covers 90% of our FLAG 
and non-FLAG emissions for comprehensive long-term 
reduction.
Kerry’s target boundaries focus on categories contributing 
most to our emissions, emphasising a strategic approach 
to reductions. For further details on our Scope 3 inventory 
see pages 161-162. 
Base Year and Baseline Value
Prior to 2024 and Kerry’s submission of an absolute 
emissions reduction target to SBTi, Kerry had set a 
Scope 3 emissions intensity reduction target of 30% 
to be achieved by 2030, against a 2017 base year. In 
selecting a base year for our updated Scope 3 targets, 
Kerry considered previous acquisitions, divestments and 
the impacts of COVID-19 and determined that 2022 best 
represented a normal operating environment. 
1Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
Achieving our GHG Emission Reduction Targets
Our CTP outlines our path to net zero before 2050, 
highlighting key intervention areas and specific actions 
that will drive our global efforts to achieve our 2030 
science-based targets and form the foundation of our 
long-term net zero journey. We will incorporate emerging 
technologies and solutions as they become available. 
The CTP, found on pages 147-150, provides details on the 
actions Kerry will take by decarbonisation lever, along with 
the estimated contribution of these actions towards the 
achievement of Kerry’s 2030 reduction targets. 
In 2024, we made further progress towards our Scope 1 
and 2 target with a 50% reduction since our 2017 base 
year. The use of renewable electricity across our sites 
continues to play an important role in our progress with 
99% of our purchases coming from renewable sources or 
backed by renewable energy certificates. 
Our efforts to reduce Scope 3 emissions are categorised 
under FLAG and non-FLAG interventions, in line with our 
targets under SBTi. We outline below our performance in 
each category, which has contributed towards the overall 
reduction of 5% in total Scope 3 emissions since our 2022 
base year. We have recorded an 11% reduction in our 
non-FLAG emissions supported by reductions relating to 
transportation and waste and a 1% reduction in our FLAG 
emissions  since our 2022 base year. While we have seen a 
year-on-year increase in total Scope 3 emissions, resulting 
from increased raw material purchases, the deployment 
and scale-up of initiatives, such as the regenerative 
agriculture programmes launched in North America in 
2024, are expected to positively impact on our Scope 3 
FLAG emissions in future years.
Other Climate-Related Targets
In addition to our Scope 1 and 2, and Scope 3 GHG 
emissions reduction targets, we have also established the 
following targets which support our ambition to reach net 
zero before 2050:
Renewable Electricity: 
Source 100% of our electricity from renewable sources by 
end of 2025.
Zero Deforestation: 
Eliminate deforestation and land conversion from high-
risk raw material categories by end of 2025, details of 
which are reported in E4 Biodiversity and Ecosystems on 
pages 173-174. 
Our approach on climate change is led by the Chief 
Operating Officer (COO) with the support of other senior 
leaders. A structured governance framework oversees 
climate initiatives, led by the Sustainability Executive 
Committee with strategic oversight from the Board. The 
Chief Corporate Affairs Officer chairs the Sustainability 
Executive Committee, which includes the CEO, CFO, 
and other executive leaders, leading the delivery of our 
climate targets. In parallel, the COO leads the Group’s 
Climate Council, which focuses on managing climate 
actions within our operations.
For information regarding Kerry’s remuneration policies 
linked to our GHG emission reduction targets, please refer 
to the General section on page 135.
6. Metrics1
Energy 
E1-5 – Energy consumption and mix 
Our sites use energy for a range of processes including 
heating, cooling and conveying. Management of our 
energy consumption plays an important role in our ability 
to achieve our Scope 1 and 2 carbon reduction targets. 
The integrated operations team has developed and 
implemented comprehensive guidelines that provide site 
personnel with clear strategies for optimising energy 
usage through improved measurement, management 
and control practices. In line with our Scope 1 and 2 
carbon reduction targets, Kerry is a member of RE100, a 
group committed to transitioning 100% of its electricity 
consumption to renewable sources by the end of 2025. 
To support this goal, Kerry uses Renewable Energy 
Certificates (RECs) to confirm that the electricity we 
consume is matched by renewable generation. These 
certificates follow US Green-e programme guidelines, so 
they may not always align precisely with specific sites or 
1Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
2030 GHG Emission Reduction Targets Performance
Scope 1 and 2 GHG Emissions
Base Year 
2017 
'000 tCO₂e
2024 
'000 tCO₂e
2023β 
'000 tCO₂e
Target 
reduction 
by 2030
Performance 
vs Base Year 
Total Scope 1 and 2 (market-based)  
GHG Emissions
926.4
462.4
481.1
-55%
-50%
Scope 3 GHG Emissions
Base Year 
2022 
'000 tCO₂e
2024 
'000 tCO₂e
Target 
reduction 
by 2030
Performance 
vs Base Year
Total Scope 3 Emissions
9,316.4
8,855.9
-5%
FLAG Emissions in Scope of 2030 Target
4,235.5
4,194.1
-30%
-1%
Non-FLAG Emissions in Scope of 2030 Target
2,072.5
1,835.4
-25%
-11%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
160
161
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
exact times of use and are typically applied on a country or market level rather than for individual locations.
Further progress has been made in 2024, with 99% of purchased electricity now sourced from renewable energy 
(2023β: 94%).
The table below presents a summary of Kerry’s energy consumption and energy mix for 2024 and 2023β:
Types of consumption
Unit
2024
2023β
[1] 	 Fuel consumption from coal and coal products 
MWh
-
[2] 	 Fuel consumption from crude oil and petroleum products 
MWh
44,241
[3] 	 Fuel consumption from natural gas 
MWh
2,214,874
[4] 	 Fuel consumption from other fossil sources
MWh
-
[5] 	 Consumption of purchased or acquired electricity, heat, steam, and cooling 
from fossil sources
MWh
134,965
[6] 	 Total fossil energy consumption (calculated as the sum of lines 1 to 5)
MWh
2,394,080
2,376,011
Share of fossil sources in total energy consumption
%
70%
72%
[7] 	 Consumption from nuclear sources
MWh
-
Share of consumption from nuclear sources in total energy consumption
%
-
[8] 	 Fuel consumption for renewable sources, including biomass (also comprising 
industrial and municipal waste of biologic origin, biogas, renewable hydrogen, etc.)
MWh
298,743
[9] 	 Consumption of purchased or acquired electricity, heat, steam, and cooling 
from renewable energy sources
MWh
724,107
[10] 	The consumption of self-generated non-fuel renewable energy
MWh
272
[11] 	Total renewable energy consumption (calculated as the sum of lines 8 to 10)
MWh
1,023,122
928,092
Share of renewable sources in total energy consumption 
%
30%
28%
Total energy consumption (calculated as the sum of lines 6, and 11)
MWh
3,417,202
3,304,103
In 2024, energy intensity per net revenue in high climate impact sectors was 428 MWh/€m. Kerry Group's revenue 
from high climate impact sectors, as defined in ESRS, is 
equal to total net revenue reported in the 2024 Financial 
Statements,€7,980.6m. 
In accordance with Commission Delegated Regulation 
(EU) 2022/1288, high climate impact sectors encompass 
those listed under NACE Sections A to H and Section L. As 
Kerry activities fall under NACE Section C: Manufacturing, 
we have utilised the Group’s total revenue to determine 
the required energy intensity, as outlined in paragraph 
40 of the regulation. We convert all energy related 
information to MWh using conversion factors sourced 
from the UK Department for Environment, Food & Rural 
Affairs (DEFRA) public databases.
In 2024, the amount of internally generated non-
renewable energy was 332,434 MWh and internally 
generated renewable energy was 272 MWh.
Gross Scopes 1, 2, 3 and Total GHG 
Emissions 
E1-6 – Gross Scopes 1, 2, 3 and total GHG emissions
Scope 1 and 2 GHG Emissions
Scope 1 Emissions:
Kerry’s Scope 1 emissions are direct emissions from 
sources owned or controlled by Kerry, including fuel 
combustion, on-site operations, and company-owned 
transport. Our Scope 1 emissions for 2024 totalled  
433.6 ktCO₂e, (2023β: 430.3 ktCO₂e). 
Biogenic CO₂ emissions from the combustion or 
biodegradation of biomass, which are not included in 
Scope 1 GHG emissions, were 103.3 ktCO₂e in 2024. 
To reduce Scope 1 emissions, we are focused on key 
initiatives as identified within our CTP on pages 148-149.
Scope 2 Emissions:
Kerry’s Scope 2 emissions are indirect emissions from 
our consumption of purchased electricity, heating and 
cooling.
Scope 2 market-based emissions in 2024 totalled 
28.7 ktCO₂e (location-based 307.5 ktCO₂e). To manage 
Scope 2 GHG emissions, Kerry employs a variety of 
contractual instruments. The proportion of unbundled 
energy attributes for managing Scope 2 emissions 
made up 83% of our total Scope 2 management 
approach in 2024. Additionally, agreements involving 
market-based Scope 2 GHG emissions associated with 
purchased electricity bundled with these instruments 
was 8% in 2024.
Scope 1 and 2 Emissions: Methodology and  
Key Assumptions
We report our Scope 1 and 2 emissions in line with the 
Greenhouse Gas Protocol Corporate Accounting and 
Reporting Standard.
Our primary sources of GHG emissions are from 
stationary and mobile combustion and refrigerants. Our 
Scope 1 and 2 emissions are generally calculated using 
primary activity data along with secondary emission 
factors sourced from the UK DEFRA and Environmental 
Protection Agency (EPA) public databases. Primary 
activity data includes utility bills, invoices and on-site 
metering data. We translate all GHG emissions to carbon 
equivalents using the latest Global Warming Potential 
(GWP) values from IPCC Assessment Report 6. 
For Scope 2 emissions, we source location-based emission 
factors from the EPA for the United States, Department 
of Climate Change, Energy, the Environment and Water 
(DCCEEW) for Australia and from the International Energy 
Agency  (IEA) for all other countries. To calculate market-
based emissions, we deduct all emissions from electricity 
which is backed by bundled or unbundled Renewable 
Electricity Contracts (RECs) from location-based emissions 
for that site.
These sources of emission factors were chosen as we 
consider them to be reliable sources of secondary 
emission factors that are publicly available and are issued 
from recognised governmental or intergovernmental 
organisations.
Scope 3 GHG Emissions
Kerry’s Scope 3 emissions include all other indirect 
emissions across our value chain, including emissions 
from purchased goods and services, employee 
commuting, transportation and distribution, and end-of-
life treatment of sold products.
Scope 3 emissions totalled 8,855.9 ktCO₂e in 2024, 
representing the majority of our total GHG footprint. The 
percentage of Scope 3 GHG emissions calculated using 
primary data was 18% for 2024.
Scope 3 Emissions Methodology and Key 
Assumptions
We report our Scope 3 emissions in accordance with the 
methodology set out in the GHG Protocol (GHGP) Corporate 
Value Chain (Scope 3) Accounting and Reporting Standard.
We use primary activity data to calculate Scope 3 
emissions whenever possible and combine this with 
the most relevant emission factors. If primary data is 
unavailable, we employ average-data or spend-based 
methods for estimation. Methodologies are reviewed 
annually to ensure alignment with industry best practices 
and accuracy in emissions reporting.
Our Scope 3 footprint consists of 12 relevant Scope 3 
emission categories (out of 15 defined by the GHGP). 
The 12 relevant categories are set out in the table 
below and include categories 1-7, 9-12 and 15. Category 
8 (operation of leased assets) is included within our 
Scope 1 and 2 reporting. Category 13 (Downstream 
Leased Assets) is not applicable due to the absence of 
asset leasing to customers. Category 14 (Franchises) is 
not applicable as Kerry does not operate franchises as 
part of its operating model.   
To calculate Kerry’s Scope 3 emissions, we have defined 
and documented the boundaries and exclusions after a 
thorough review of our operations and value chain. Our 
assessment includes the full scope of Kerry’s operations 
and value chain, covering all sites under our control or 
influence. 
Scope 3 Emissions Methodology Limitations
Obtaining accurate Scope 3 data is a challenge across 
industries. In the absence of verified supplier data, we 
must estimate the emissions in our value chain with 
standard emission factors. Using standardised factors 
creates barriers to fully understanding our emissions 
profile, measuring progress and identifying opportunities 
for reduction.
The GHG Protocol Corporate Value Chain (Scope 3) 
methodology allows flexibility in calculation methods, 
which can result in varying estimations between 
companies and make accurate comparisons of Scope 3 
data challenging.
The following section outlines the methodologies, 
assumptions, and emission factor sources employed in 
calculating our Scope 3 emissions. Emission factors are 
selected from internationally recognised databases that 
provide comprehensive, sector-specific coverage relevant 
to Kerry’s value chain.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
162
163
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Climate Change (E1)
Category
Methodology
Emission Factor 
Sources
Category 1 –  
Purchased Goods  
and Services:
1a. Kerry applies a volume-based calculation. Kerry utilises both 
primary and secondary emission factor sources for this category. 
Where relevant, Kerry utilises country and/or regional specific 
emission factors and global emission factors. Where a country/
regional emission factor is not available a global emission factor is 
applied. Kerry’s emission factors are sourced from World Food LCA 
Database (WFLDB) and Ecoinvent. 
1b. Spend-based calculations are applied, multiplying the 
spend relevant to these categories by emission factors from 
Environmentally Extended Input-Output (EEIO) models.
WFLDB 
Ecoinvent 
Primary Data from 
Suppliers 
EEIO
Category 2 –  
Capital Goods:
Spend-based calculations are applied by multiplying the expenditure 
for these categories by the applicable EEIO emission factor.
EEIO
Category 3 – Fuel 
and Energy Related 
Emissions:
An energy usage-based approach is used to calculate the kWh of 
energy by applying the corresponding energy emission factor from 
the UK Department for Business, Energy & Industrial Strategy (BEIS), 
the UK Department for Environment, Food & Rural Affairs (DEFRA), 
and/or the International Energy Agency (IEA).
BEIS 
DEFRA 
IEA
Category 4 – Upstream 
Transportation and 
Distribution:
Spend-based calculations are applied by multiplying the expenditure 
for these categories by the applicable EEIO emission factor. We use 
a distance-based method to calculate emissions from transportation 
of materials from suppliers’ location to Kerry.
BEIS 
Category 5 – Waste 
Generated in Own 
Operations:
Emissions from waste within our operations is calculated based on 
the volume of waste generated. The emission factor assigned is 
determined based on the disposal method of the waste.
BEIS 
DEFRA
Category 6 –  
Business Travel:
Spend-based calculations are applied by multiplying the expenditure 
for these categories by the applicable EEIO emission factor. Flight 
data is used to calculate emissions from flying for business travel.
EEIO 
BEIS
Category 7 –  
Employee Commuting:
Employee commuting uses an average data method to estimate 
emissions from employee commute to Kerry work locations.
BEIS 
Category 9 – Downstream 
Transportation and 
Distribution:
A distance-based method is used to calculate emissions based on 
the distance the product travels, the mode of transport, and the 
shipping or transportation conditions.
EEIO  
BEIS
Category 10 – Processing 
of Sold Products:
An average data method is used to calculate emissions  
processing and use of sold goods and end-of-life treatment of the 
sold products.
IEA
Category 11 – Use of  
Sold Products:
Category 12 – End-of-
life Treatment of Sold 
Products:
Category 15 – 
Investments:
A volume-based calculation is used to calculate the emissions from 
the product's volume.
Primary EF Data
Scope 1 and 2, and Scope 3 Emissions Summary
The following table outlines Kerry’s total GHG emissions for 2024. As noted on pages 158-159, Kerry has ambitious 
climate targets across all scopes in support of our net zero goal. In 2024, we achieved a 50% decrease in our Scope 1 
and 2 emissions, versus our 2017 base year, and a 5% reduction in our total Scope 3 emissions, versus a 2022 base year. 
More details of performance versus our targets can be found on page 159.
Retrospective
Milestones and target years
Scopes
Base 
Year
2024 
'000 
tCO₂e
2023β 
'000 
tCO₂e
% 
2024/ 
2023
2025
2030
2050
Annual 
% target/ 
base Year
Scope 1
Gross Scope 1 GHG emissions
433.6
430.3
101%
Scope 1 GHG emissions from regulated 
emissions trading scheme (%)
26%
Scope 2
Gross location-based Scope 2 GHG 
emissions
307.5
Gross market-based Scope 2 GHG 
emissions
28.7
50.8
57%
Significant Scope 3 GHG emissions
Total Gross indirect (Scope 3) GHG 
emissions
8,855.9
8,499.0
104%
1.	 Purchased goods and services
7,362.2
2.	 Capital goods
88.7
3.	 Fuel and energy-related Activities (not 
included in Scope1 or Scope 2)
148.4
4.	 Upstream transportation and 
distribution
437.6
5.	 Waste generated in operations
13.9
6.	 Business traveling
43.0
7.	 Employee commuting
11.8
8. Upstream leased assets
-
9.	 Downstream transportation
156.5
10.	Processing of sold products
302.8
11.	Use of sold products
203.3
12.	End-of-life treatment of sold products
82.7
13.	Downstream leased assets
-
14.	Franchises
-
15.	Investments
5.0
Total GHG Emissions
Total GHG emissions (location-based)
9,597.0
Total GHG emissions (market-based)
9,318.2
8,980.1
104%
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
164
165
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Water Stewardship (E3)
On 31 December 2024, the Group completed the sale of 
the Kerry Dairy Ireland business. Kerry’s GHG emissions 
for Scope 1 and 2 (market-based) would be 365.5 ktCO₂e 
and for Scope 3 would be 7,617.8 ktCO₂e, if they were 
adjusted for the sale of that business. 
GHG Emission Intensity
GHG Emission Intensity
2024
GHG emissions intensity, location-based 
(total GHG kilotonne emissions per €m  
net revenue)
1.2
GHG emissions intensity, market-based 
(total GHG kilotonne emissions per €m  
net revenue)
1.2
Net revenue used as the denominator in the GHG 
emission intensity calculation is equal to total net revenue 
reported in the 2024 Financial Statements, €7,980.6m. 
Biogenic CO₂ emissions relating to Scope 2 and Scope 
3 are not reported separately due to an industry-wide 
challenge  around availability of appropriate emission 
factors. We will continue to make efforts to obtain the 
required information to enable reporting of biogenic  
CO₂ emissions relating to Scope 2 and 3 in a future year. 
GHG Removals and GHG Mitigation 
Projects Financed Through Carbon 
Credits
E1-7 – GHG removals and GHG mitigation projects financed 
through carbon credits
As part of a regional strategy to meet customer demand, 
two of our sites in APMEA have achieved carbon 
neutrality. The carbon neutral claims have been made 
with the support of carbon credits for residual GHG 
emissions relating to their direct operations. In 2024 there 
were no carbon credits relating to carbon neutral claims 
cancelled. The amount of carbon credits planned to be 
cancelled in 2025 is 3.0 ktCO2e, with 1.7 ktCO2e contracted 
and 1.3 ktCO2e, which have not yet been contracted. 
The use of carbon credits is not deducted from site 
performance, nor the emissions we report in the Metrics 
section and is not included when tracking progress 
towards the targets, detailed under Targets above. As a 
result, we do not believe the limited use of carbon credits 
impacts our progress towards achieving our GHG emission 
reduction goals and our overall net zero target. For further 
information on Kerry’s plans to neutralise our residual 
emissions, see our section on ‘Integrating our CTP into our 
Strategy, Business Model & Investments’. 
The carbon credits contracted in 2024 relate to carbon 
reduction projects and are certified under the Gold 
Standard for the Global Goals, as this helps to ensure they 
originate from specified and audited sources and prevent 
double counting. None of the carbon credits have been 
issued from projects within the European Union and do 
not qualify as corresponding adjustments under Article 6 
of the Paris Agreement. 
Internal Carbon Pricing
E1-8 – Internal Carbon Pricing
In December 2024 we applied a new internal carbon price 
scheme, applying a shadow price for Scope 1 and 2 GHG 
emissions for CapEx projects within the Group with a 
value of more than €1m. 
The introduction of the scheme is intended to help 
with the alignment of our financial and environmental 
decisions when approving CapEx. The internal shadow 
price of carbon utilised is €70 per tonne of carbon, 
which has been set taking into consideration carbon 
prices applied in existing mandatory emission trading 
schemes and the expected development in price and 
implementation across relevant jurisdictions.  
Types of internal 
carbon prices
Volume 
at stake 
'000 
tCO₂e
Prices 
applied 
€/tCO₂e
Perimeter 
description
CapEx shadow 
price
0.1
€70/
tCO₂e
Scope 1 
and 2 GHG 
Emissions for 
projects over 
€1m 
1. Material Impacts, Risks and 
Opportunities 
ESRS 2 IRO-1 Description of the process to identify and 
assess material water and marine resources-related impacts, 
risks and opportunities 
As part of Kerry's double materiality assessment, we 
defined the following short, medium and long-term time 
horizons: 
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short-term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
As part of our double materiality assessment, we screened 
our operations and upstream and downstream value chain 
to help identify actual and potential impacts, risks and 
opportunities related to water and marine resources. 
Across our operations, we assessed manufacturing sites 
based on several factors including the volume of water 
withdrawals, source of withdrawals, discharges and 
consumption, destination of discharges, and any overlap 
with areas of high or extremely high water stress (based 
on sites' geolocation and using the World Resources 
Institute’s Aqueduct Tool).
We also considered exposure to water-related risks, 
incorporating outputs from climate scenario analysis. 
Water stress was considered as a physical risk in the 
climate scenario analysis, details of which can be 
found  in E1 Climate section on page 154. Outside of 
our direct operations, we screened our upstream and 
downstream value chain to identify actual or potential 
impacts, risks and opportunities (IROs), including 
those related to raw materials used in our processes, 
technologies and products.
Our stakeholder engagement on water and marine 
resources included engagement with suppliers, industry 
bodies, customers and leaders across our business. 
Although we did not engage directly with affected 
communities, representative groups such as NGOs were 
included as part of our double materiality assessment. 
For more information on our approach to determining 
material water-related impacts, risks and opportunities see 
the General section on pages 140-145.
2. Policies 
E3-1 – Policies related to water and marine resources
Kerry’s Environmental Responsibility Policy summarises 
the key activities we undertake to manage our material 
water-related impacts on local communities and 
stakeholders in the upstream value chain, and supports 
the achievement of our water targets under our Beyond 
the Horizon sustainability strategy. 
Water is an important resource across our operations 
and we continuously work towards more responsible and 
efficient use of water, implementing new technologies 
and innovation where appropriate. We are committed to 
preventing water pollution and upholding water quality 
standards across our operations, ensuring equitable 
access for all users, particularly in water-stressed 
areas. Most of Kerry’s sites discharge wastewater to 
Water
Description ​
Time  
Horizon
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Wastewater Discharge  
The discharge of wastewater from our sites and the 
potential for adverse environmental consequences
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Water Withdrawal 
Impact on water availability due to water withdrawals 
at Kerry’s own operations and/or upstream in the value 
chain
 
1Own Ops = Own Operations
Water and Marine Resources 
(E3)
1. Material Impacts, Risks and	
165 
Opportunities
2. Policies	
165
3. Actions	
166
4. Targets and Metrics	
168
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
166
167
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Water Stewardship (E3)
municipal systems for treatment, before being returned 
to the environment. At sites where wastewater is 
discharged directly into the environment, site-level 
treatment significantly diminishes the potential for 
harmful pollutants to enter local water sources. Kerry's 
manufacturing sites monitor the discharge of wastewater 
against site-specific consent limits included within their 
licences and takes corrective actions to operate within 
these limits where any deviations occur.
Kerry is committed to reducing the water withdrawal 
intensity within its operations. We recognise the human 
right to water as reflected in the UN Sustainable 
Development Goals (SDGs) and are committed to limiting 
the impact of water withdrawals on the needs of local 
communities and other water users.
Our Environmental Responsibility Policy applies to Kerry 
Group plc, its subsidiaries, partners, and suppliers, 
covering all business locations and activities. It may be 
supplemented by additional obligations subject to specific 
requirements under local law. Key stakeholders impacted 
by this policy include Kerry employees, suppliers, 
customers, and the local communities in which we 
operate, and we seek to incorporate their interests in our 
policy. 
Kerry's current focus is on water management across 
our manufacturing locations. We acknowledge that 
our influence extends to the upstream value chain and 
remain committed to collaborating with stakeholders 
on water stewardship initiatives. Given its limited 
direct impact, Kerry does not have specific policies 
or practices related to sustainable oceans and seas. 
However, we continually evaluate our environmental 
responsibility policies and encompass broader 
ecological aspects as appropriate. Our policy also 
includes our commitment to reduce water consumption 
at sites located in areas of water stress, to help 
preserve water resources and ensure their quality.
We monitor and report on our performance through 
water-related metrics, and our Chief Operating 
Officer has accountability for ongoing oversight of 
performance and strategies aimed at delivering our 
water commitments. The policy is informed by third-party 
standards or initiatives such as ISO 14001, a globally 
recognised standard for environmental management 
covering various issues including water management.
Kerry’s Environmental Responsibility Policy is available on 
our intranet and on kerry.com.
3. Actions
E3-2 – Actions and resources related to water and marine 
resources
Water is important for our business, and we recognise 
that it is a resource we share with others. Kerry is 
implementing a range of best practice techniques to 
reduce water withdrawal intensity and protect local water 
quality and ecosystems. These help to safeguard water 
sources and allow equitable access to water for our 
business and other stakeholders. 
Our action plan seeks to address the potential negative 
impacts relating to water withdrawal and water discharge, 
as identified in our double materiality assessment.
In 2024, we took action to progress towards the 
achievement of our water-related policy objectives  
and targets. For actions disclosed in this section, the 
specified location of the actions across our value chain 
reflects where the impacts arise. We acknowledge that 
Kerry will need to initiate many of these activities from 
within our own operations.
Water Withdrawal Action Plan
Kerry has implemented targeted initiatives to address 
potential water withdrawal impacts and advance our 
water withdrawal policy objectives and targets. We 
understand that our impact on water is not limited to 
our operations and are committed to collaborating with 
suppliers to take collective action in line with the Alliance 
for Water Stewardship principles. In 2024, our key actions 
included the following: 
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Water 
Withdrawal
We completed an investment at our site in in Montgomery, Alabama, which significantly reduced 
single pass-through cooling at the site, contributing to the Group's improved water withdrawal 
intensity efficiency.
We also undertook various smaller initiatives at sites as part of ongoing operational efficiency 
measures, including leak repairs, metering, and optimisation of clean-in-place processes, with some 
of these initiatives at sites located in areas with high or extremely high water stress. While these are 
smaller interventions, collectively they contribute to performance against our target.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Water 
Withdrawal
As part of continuing operational efficiency measures, we will improve water 
withdrawal efficiency and focus on continuous improvement. 
Evolve current water risk assessment for raw materials and suppliers, 
developing metrics and action plans to mitigate impacts as appropriate.
Engage with stakeholders potentially affected by our sites located in areas 
of high or extremely high water stress, in alignment with water stewardship 
principles.
Water Discharge Action Plan
We understand that water discharged from our sites can have an impact on local water quality, and have 
measures in place across our operations to ensure we protect local water sources. Water discharged from our 
sites undergoes appropriate screening and/or treatment, to meet effluent discharge limits and minimise potential 
negative impacts on local biodiversity. At a site level, processes are implemented to monitor compliance with 
effluent discharge limits and we are considering appropriate enhancements to the process to support additional 
monitoring and performance review at Group level.
In 2024, we took the following key actions to improve the treatment of wastewater from Kerry facilities:
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Water 
Discharge
In addition to various projects to maintain water treatment facilities across our operations, we 
completed an investment at our site in Norwich, New York to help maintain water quality and 
mitigate against potential negative impacts from waste water discharged from the site. 
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Water 
Discharge
Improve central monitoring of water discharges to ensure effective 
management and performance review.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
168
169
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Biodiversity & Ecosystems (E4)
4. Targets and Metrics1
E3-3 – Targets related to water and marine resources 
We withdraw, use and discharge water across all 
our manufacturing sites, including those located 
in water-stressed areas. Recognising water as a 
shared resource, we acknowledge the importance of 
responsible water management and are committed 
to reducing our water withdrawal intensity per tonne 
of production, contributing to equitable access for all 
stakeholders, and protecting water sources. 
Water Withdrawal in our Own Operations
To help manage the potential impact from water 
withdrawals at our manufacturing sites, we are 
targeting a 15% reduction in water withdrawal 
intensity per tonne of production by end of 2025, 
versus our 2017 base year. This voluntary target 
was informed by outputs from previous materiality 
assessments, which involved engagement with 
various stakeholders, and Sustainable Development 
Goal (SDG) 6.4 which aims to sustainably increase 
water-use efficiency across all sectors. For more 
information on our stakeholder engagement please 
see our General section on pages 138-139.
Our Environmental, Health & Safety (EHS) teams 
continually monitor and evaluate efforts to reduce 
our intensity, collaborating closely with Engineering 
and Research, Development & Application functions 
to identify and implement appropriate measures. To 
achieve our target, we focus on water efficiencies 
across our sites and investment in capital projects at 
key locations. 
In 2024, we achieved an 11% reduction in our water 
withdrawal intensity per tonne of production, versus 
our 2017 base year (2023β: 4%). The investments at 
our site in Plant City, Florida, completed at the end of 
2023, and our site in Montgomery, Alabama, were key 
contributors to performance in the year. We expect 
that a continued focus on measures to reduce water 
withdrawals, improve water efficiency, and continuous 
improvement will enable us to achieve our target by 
end of 2025.  
Water withdrawal intensity per tonne of production is 
recorded monthly at site level and progress towards 
the target is reported through the Climate Council 
to the Sustainability Executive Committee and the 
Board’s Sustainability Committee. It is calculated 
using the total volume of water withdrawals at our 
manufacturing sites divided by the total tonnes of 
production. The volume of water withdrawn is based 
on meter readings or invoices. Water withdrawal 
intensity in 2024 was 6.07 megalitres per tonne 
of production, and our 2017 base year was 6.78 
megalitres per tonne of production.
The target we have set to help manage the potential 
negative impact from water withdrawals applies to 
Group performance, and includes any areas at water 
risk. While the target is not a science-based target, 
we keep developments relating to target setting for 
environmental matters under review.
On 31 December 2024, the Group completed the sale of 
the Kerry Dairy Ireland business. If water withdrawals and 
tonnes of production for that business were excluded, 
2024 water withdrawal intensity per tonne of production 
would be 6.15.
Water Discharge in our Own Operations
To help manage the potential impact of water discharges 
from our manufacturing operations we are working to 
increase the proportion of our sites certified under ISO 
14001. Implementing the process required for certification 
helps sites to manage their discharges more effectively 
and contributes to reducing potential environmental 
impacts. We centrally track the number of sites with ISO 
14001 certification and report progress annually. 
At the end of 2024, 74% of Kerry’s manufacturing sites 
were certified to ISO 14001 Environmental Management 
Systems (2023β: 66%). The percentage of sites certified 
to ISO 14001 is calculated by dividing the total number of 
manufacturing sites with ISO 14001 certification, by the 
total number of manufacturing sites. 
We are reviewing our approach to evaluating the impact 
of water discharges and are working towards metrics that 
can more effectively monitor progress against our policy 
commitments. We do not currently have a target set for 
water discharge in our own operations.
Water Withdrawal in our Supply Chain
We continue to evolve our risk assessment and approach 
to water withdrawal in our supply chain. As part of this, we 
will develop outcome-focused metrics where appropriate, 
which can assist with measuring the effectiveness of our 
policies and actions in this area.
We have not identified any material impacts, risks or 
opportunities relating to responsible management of 
marine resources nor reduction of water consumption.  
As a result, we have not set targets relating to these areas. 
1Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
As part of our double materiality assessment, we 
defined the following short, medium and long-term time 
horizons: 
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short-term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
To understand our impacts, we involved key stakeholder 
groups in our double materiality assessment, including 
business leaders, sustainability leaders, employees, 
investors, customers, suppliers, and community-based 
representatives. The insights from these engagements 
helped us to assess biodiversity impacts, risks and 
opportunities across multiple factors including the scale, 
scope, irremediable character, likelihood and time horizon. 
Through our assessment we identified several areas of 
impact upstream in our value chain including specific raw 
material categories palm oil, soy, and paper and pulp-
based products. Based on the current assessment, the 
impacts on communities from our direct operations or 
value chain activities were not deemed material. This is 
Description ​
Time  
Horizon​
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Potential 
Negative 
Impact 
Deforestation and Conversion 
Land and ecosystem degradation from deforestation and 
conversion related to the sourcing of specific forest risk 
raw materials. 
Actual 
Negative 
Impact
Scope 3 GHG emissions 
Land and ecosystem degradation through climate change 
related to Scope 3 emissions.
Risk
Raw Material Supply 
Raw material supply risk due to unsustainable resource 
extraction and land use practices, resulting in increased 
costs and lower operating profits.
Risk
Regulatory Compliance  
Regulatory compliance risk due to additional regulatory 
burden and due diligence requirements, with reputational 
risk and or financial penalties for failure to comply.
Opportunity
Market Expansion 
Increased consumer and customer demand for products 
with better biodiversity outcomes leads to increased 
demand/revenue associated with Kerry's innovation 
expertise and sustainable solutions.
1Own Ops = Own Operations
1. Material Impacts, Risks and 
Opportunities 
ESRS 2 IRO-1 – Description of the processes to identify and 
assess material biodiversity and ecosystem-related impacts, 
risks, dependencies and opportunities 
Due to the nature of our business and our role in the 
food and beverage industry, Kerry depends on sourcing 
high-quality raw materials of natural origin. We recognise 
that many of the impacts on biodiversity and ecosystems 
associated with our products relate to these raw materials 
and occur at farm level, beyond our direct operational 
control. 
We identified the following material impacts, risks and 
opportunities relating to Biodiversity and Ecosystems:
Biodiversity and Ecosystems 
(E4)
1. Material Impacts, Risks and	
169 
Opportunities
2. Biodiversity Resilience Analysis	
170
3. Policies	
170
4. Actions	
171
5. Targets and Metrics	
173
Biodiversity and Ecosystems
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
170
Sustainability Statement Biodiversity & Ecosystems (E4)
171
Sustainability Statement
an area that we will continue to explore in greater detail 
as we undertake a more comprehensive assessment of 
biodiversity in the coming year.  
Our consideration of transition and physical risks and 
opportunities was informed by our assessment of impacts 
and dependencies identified through the double materiality 
process, including a review of the wider landscape 
assessment and engagement with relevant stakeholders. 
Within the food and beverage industry, dependencies 
commonly include soil health, clean water and a stable 
climate that are needed for production of agriculture raw 
materials. Intensive resource extraction and unsustainable 
land use practices can degrade these ecosystem services, 
potentially creating systemic risks over the longer term. 
These have the potential to impact Kerry and the wider 
industry. Conversely, innovations and creating products 
that help address biodiversity impacts can also present an 
opportunity for Kerry with customers seeking to address 
these risks. The relevant risks and opportunities identified 
were assessed for financial impact on Kerry, considering the 
likelihood and time horizon over which they may occur. 
Assessing Our Operations 
SBM 3 – Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their 
interaction with strategy and business model
We have conducted an assessment of our direct 
operations with the support of the Integrated Biodiversity 
Assessment Tool. This analysis shows where we have 
sites located in or near (within 5km) a biodiversity 
sensitive area. Based on our initial assessment, these 
sites do not negatively impact these biodiverse areas or 
threatened species and as a result it was concluded that 
it is not necessary to implement additional mitigation 
measures at these locations. While we have not identified 
any material IROs relating to our sites, we will further 
review our site-level impacts as we evolve our work 
on biodiversity in the coming year. Our Environmental 
Responsibility Policy outlines our commitments to 
biodiversity and ecosystems protection, which applies to 
all locations where Kerry conducts business. 
For more information on our approach to determining 
material biodiversity and ecosystem-related impacts, 
risks and opportunities see the General section on 
pages 140-145.
2. Biodiversity Resilience Analysis
E4-1 – Transition plan and consideration of biodiversity and 
ecosystems in strategy and business model
Based on the outputs of our double materiality assessment 
we performed a qualitative assessment of the resilience 
of our strategy and business model to the material risks 
related to biodiversity and ecosystems. The analysis 
considered the raw material supply and regulatory 
compliance risks and the potential impact on the Group's 
strategy and business model. It drew on input from 
internal stakeholders. The time horizons used align with 
those used for our double materiality assessment.
Raw material supply: In the short to medium term, 
we see potential for seasonal or limited disruption in 
specific raw material categories linked to disease and/or 
other challenges. Over the longer term, this disruption 
is expected to increase if key impact drivers are not 
addressed and ecosystem degradation continues. In such 
a scenario, raw material scarcity could potentially drive up 
costs and disrupt supply chains. Proactively addressing 
these challenges through supplier engagement on 
sustainable sourcing practices and promoting responsible 
land-use strategies will be critical for Kerry to support 
supply chain stability and mitigate risk.
Regulatory compliance: Biodiversity-related regulations, 
including mandatory due diligence requirements, 
increased complexity and potential reputational and 
compliance risks. Working with suppliers to ensure 
their practices align with regulatory expectations will be 
important to effectively mitigate these risks and maintain 
stakeholder trust.
Our strategy and business model are centred on 
partnering with customers to create healthier, tastier, and 
more sustainable products. Given our diversified portfolio 
and global sourcing strategy, we are well positioned to 
overcome potential risks that may emerge. Our innovation 
capability, global presence and leading product portfolio 
also allow us to integrate new solutions where raw 
material challenges emerge, supporting our customers to 
reformulate products and adapt to impacts on availability. 
We are also increasingly engaged with our raw material 
suppliers on biodiversity, working to reduce the potential 
impact from the raw materials we purchase and prevent 
deforestation and land conversion associated with 
selected inputs.
We consider our current strategy and business model 
to be well positioned to manage risks and capture 
opportunities identified over the short, medium, and 
long-term. The Group's focus on sustainable nutrition, 
combined with our capacity to innovate at pace in 
response to customer and consumer needs, or sourcing 
constraints, supports our ability to adapt to evolving 
external conditions and industry requirements.
Given the complex and often interconnected nature of 
biodiversity and ecosystems, this is an area where we will 
continue to develop our understanding and further assess 
our impacts, risks and opportunities as we learn. 
Key assumptions used in the qualitative assessment of 
the resilience of our strategy and business model to the 
material risks related to biodiversity and ecosystems are 
as follows:
•	 We will achieve our deforestation and conversion-free 
commitments covering palm oil, soy, and paper and 
pulp-based products.  
•	 Awareness of biodiversity loss will increase, and costs 
associated with raw material sourcing will rise due to 
regulatory pressures and reduced resource availability.
•	 Stakeholders including customers, regulators and 
investors will demand greater transparency and 
accountability for biodiversity impacts. 
3. Policies 
E4-2 – Policies related to biodiversity and ecosystems
Biodiversity and Ecosystems Policy
Kerry’s Environmental Responsibility Policy summarises 
the key activities we undertake to manage our material 
biodiversity and ecosystem related impacts, risks and 
opportunities in the value chain, and supports the 
achievement of our biodiversity targets under our 
Beyond the Horizon sustainability strategy. Our policy on 
biodiversity and ecosystems is focused on managing the 
material impacts, risks and opportunities. This includes 
the effects stemming from Kerry’s raw material sourcing 
within our value chain, notably deforestation and land 
conversion, land-use change, ecosystem degradation, 
and the direct impact of climate change as a driver of 
biodiversity loss.  
Kerry is committed to ensuring responsible sourcing, 
and the achievement of 100% deforestation and 
conversion-free (DCF) sourcing for targeted supply chains 
for palm oil, soy, and paper and pulp-based products. 
For more information on Kerry’s responsible sourcing 
programmes, which encompass environmental and social 
consequences of biodiversity loss, including our stated 
requirement for suppliers to respect human rights, land 
rights of communities and the rights of indigenous and 
forest dependent people, please see Kerry’s Deforestation 
and Conversion-Free Policy on kerry.com.  
Our Environmental Responsibility Policy focuses 
on climate and land-use change as a contributor to 
biodiversity loss. This policy covers Kerry’s operational 
sites, sustainable land and agriculture practices and 
deforestation. Our primary focus has been on areas 
directly related to our operations and value chain, and 
while we recognise the importance of sustainable oceans 
and seas, these are not within the scope of this policy. 
Similarly, direct exploitation, invasive alien species and 
pollution are not addressed as no material impact, risk 
or opportunity was identified in this area during Kerry’s 
materiality assessment. 
The policy applies globally to Kerry Group plc, including 
our subsidiaries, partners, and suppliers, and covers 
all business locations and activities. It is designed to 
encompass the entire value chain, from raw materials 
through to customer use, with potential adjustments to 
align with local laws. Key stakeholders impacted by this 
policy include Kerry employees, suppliers, customers, and 
the local communities in which we operate. We engage 
with these stakeholders to incorporate their interests 
into our policy framework. For more information on our 
stakeholder engagement please see our General section 
on pages 138-139.
The policy is implemented through various measures 
such as participation in responsible sourcing 
programmes, stakeholder collaboration and partnerships 
to support the traceability of raw materials associated 
with material impacts or risks.
We monitor and report on our performance through 
biodiversity-related metrics, with a current focus on DCF. 
For further information on our biodiversity and ecosystem 
targets and metrics, please refer to pages 173-174. 
Our Chief Operating Officer (COO), who is a member 
of our Executive Leadership Team, provides ongoing 
oversight of our metrics, strategies and progress toward 
achieving our biodiversity and ecosystem commitments. 
The policy is informed by third-party standards and 
initiatives such as the Accountability Framework Initiative 
(AFI), for addressing deforestation and conversion 
impacts in the supply chain. 
Kerry’s Environmental Responsibility Policy is available on 
our intranet and on kerry.com.
4. Actions
E4-3 – Actions and resources related to biodiversity and 
ecosystems
At Kerry, our continued success is closely linked to 
ecosystem health. Our actions are intended to help 
address the actual and potential impacts, risks and 
opportunities to biodiversity and ecosystems that we 
identified as part of our double materiality assessment.
In 2024, we took action to progress towards the 
achievement of our biodiversity-related policy objectives 
and targets, with our main focus on addressing the 
potential negative impact from deforestation and land 
conversion and the actual negative impact from Scope 3 
GHG emissions, while continuing to develop our approach 
to other important areas of biodiversity. For actions 
disclosed in this section, the specified location of the 
actions across our value chain reflects where the impacts, 
risks and opportunities arise. We acknowledge that Kerry 
will need to initiate many of these activities from within 
our own operations. 
Deforestation and Conversion-Free 
Action Plan
Kerry has implemented concentrated initiatives to make 
progress towards our deforestation and conversion-free 
(DCF) target. These will help mitigate the potential negative 
impacts related to the sourcing of specific forest risk raw 
materials. As we complete additional comprehensive 
assessments of impacts and dependencies, we will 
introduce further actions as appropriate.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Deforestation 
and Conversion
We proactively engaged with key suppliers to evaluate the status of their DCF commitments and 
implementation plans. The aim was to ensure that suppliers’ practices align with Kerry’s goal of 
sourcing 100% DCF palm oil, soy, and paper and pulp-based products by the end of 2025. In these 
engagements, we reinforced our targets and approach with our largest suppliers, while also 
providing them with an opportunity to outline their commitments and roadmap for DCF. 
Beyond direct supplier engagement, we actively participated in multi-stakeholder industry groups 
such as the Palm Oil Collaboration Group (POCG) and the Sustainable Agriculture Initiative (SAI) 
Platform’s DCF working group. These groups concentrate on accelerating DCF commitments, 
enhancing supply chain traceability, and driving collective solutions to increase DCF volumes across 
commodities.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
172
173
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Biodiversity & Ecosystems (E4)
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Deforestation 
and Conversion
Direct engagement with our suppliers of palm oil, soy, and paper and pulp-
based products. These efforts may encompass global or regional meetings, 
targeted one-to-one engagements or engagement by category buyers as part 
of their commercial activities.
Participation in multi-stakeholder platforms, such as the POCG and SAI 
Platform.
Scope 3 GHG Emissions Action Plan
Please refer to our Climate Change section on pages 147-150 for actions relating to Kerry’s Scope 3 GHG emissions.
Raw Material Supply Risk Action Plan
Beyond our deforestation and conversion-free initiatives, we have expanded our efforts across other key raw material 
categories to address risks related to unsustainable resource extraction and land use. 
Risk
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Raw Material 
Supply
In partnership with suppliers and farmers, Kerry launched three programmes in 2024 focused on 
implementing regenerative agriculture practices with dairy, wheat and corn suppliers in North 
America. The objective of the pilot programmes is to enable our upstream value chain partners to 
reduce impacts across carbon emissions, water, and biodiversity contributing to mitigation of raw 
material supply risk. 
We participated in the SAI Platform’s Regenerating Together framework, a global initiative 
promoting regenerative agriculture. The framework defines regenerative agriculture as an 
outcome-based farming approach that enhances soil health, biodiversity, climate resilience,  
and water resources while supporting farm businesses. Kerry also contributed to the SAI 
Platform’s Dairy Working Group and Crops Working Group, both emphasising nature and 
biodiversity as core priorities.
Building on our dairy heritage and direct relationship with our supplier farmers, Kerry’s Evolve 
programme was launched in 2022. The programme is designed to support the accelerated 
adoption of sustainable science-based actions and best practices within our dairy supply 
chain in the Southwest of Ireland. In 2024, we continued to engage our suppliers in the 
programme, focusing on initiatives that help improve soil health and water quality, and 
promote biodiversity and grassland management. This programme also provides an important 
blueprint to guide the successful development and implementation of farm level programmes 
in other regions and categories. 
Risk
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Raw Material 
Supply
Engagement in supply chain projects which will have a positive impact 
on biodiversity and mitigate the potential negative impact of agriculture 
practices.
Participation in multi-stakeholder platforms, such as the SAI Platform and 
the Sustainable Spice Initiative.
Regulatory Compliance Action Plan
Ethical and compliant business practice is a priority for Kerry. By adapting to the dynamic world around us and 
adopting new and enhanced ways of working we are well placed to comply with new and emerging regulation.
Risk
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Regulatory 
Compliance
We engaged directly with the relevant suppliers of our raw materials covered by the EU Regulation on 
Deforestation-free Products (EUDR), to ensure our compliance with the regulation which is expected to 
come into effect at the end of 2025. This collaboration and engagement with suppliers will continue in 
preparation for the regulation coming into force. 
Risk
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Regulatory 
Compliance
Continuous monitoring of regulatory developments relating to biodiversity 
and proactively developing and implementing appropriate actions to ensure 
compliance.
Enhancement of our existing supplier requirements relating to biodiversity, 
as we strive to improve transparency and accountability and ensure 
compliance with developing regulatory environments. 
Market Expansion Action Plan
As a leader in sustainable nutrition, we partner with customers to innovate and create more nutritious products with lower 
environmental impacts. This approach helps us create opportunities for customers to win with products providing positive 
biodiversity outcomes and/or enable reformulation of existing products to reduce inputs that have a potentially negative 
impact on biodiversity. Our technologies also allow us to partner with our customers to adapt to sudden changes in the 
availability or the supply of specific raw materials. For example, in 2024 Kerry's range of innovative citrus technologies 
enabled our customers to adapt to significant supply chain challenges due to decreased orange production, driven by 
adverse climate events and citrus greening disease in orange trees in Brazil and Florida.
Opportunity
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Market 
Expansion
Support our strategy with more detailed execution plans, encompassing 
biodiversity-related actions already underway and prioritising future areas as 
we move beyond our 2025 DCF targets.
5. Targets and Metrics1
E4-4 – Targets related to biodiversity and ecosystems 
E4-5 – Impact metrics related to biodiversity and ecosystems change
Driven by industrial farming and land expansion, deforestation and land conversion for agriculture has a devastating 
impact on some of the world’s most biodiverse regions, particularly tropical forests. We recognise that we can have a 
material impact through the raw materials we source and are committed to mitigating our potential and actual impacts 
relating to biodiversity and ecosystems.
Deforestation and Conversion 
Our target is for 100% of Kerry's direct volumes of palm oil, soy, and paper and pulp-based products to be deforestation 
and conversion-free (DCF) by the end of 2025. While these targets are directly addressing deforestation and land 
conversion, they also contribute to the mitigation of the other impacts and risks, and realisation of the opportunity 
identified for biodiversity.
1Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
174
175
Sustainability Statement
Our Responsible Sourcing team leads the monitoring 
and evaluation of efforts to increase the proportion 
of DCF raw materials, working closely with the wider 
procurement function including global and regional 
buyers. To achieve our targets, we focus on supplier 
engagement to improve traceability and purchase third-
party DCF certified volumes, as appropriate.
Palm Oil
In 2024, 78% of our palm oil volumes complied with our 
DCF requirements (2023β: 47%), with 29% certified by the 
Roundtable on Sustainable Palm Oil (RSPO) Segregated 
(SG) or Identity Preserved (IP) and an additional 49% 
verified DCF through supplier Implementation Reporting 
Framework (IRF) profiles which have third-party 
verified compliance with No Deforestation, No Peat, 
No Exploitation (NDPE) standards.  We expect that our 
approach of engaging our suppliers with NDPE IRF profiles 
and continued purchase of RSPO SG and IP certified 
volumes will allow us to achieve our target by end of 2025. 
RSPO SG or IP certificates are recorded, where applicable 
within our procurement system. The volumes confirmed 
as DCF using NDPE IRF profiles are calculated based on 
suppliers annual third-party verified profiles which have 
been certified by independent organisations to ensure 
supplier compliance with NDPE requirements. 
Soy
While there have been improvements in transparency 
around soy sourcing in recent years, challenges to 
tracing raw materials back to agricultural origin 
remain. Maintaining segregation during storage and 
transportation in particular makes procuring DCF-
compliant products challenging. We take a risk-based 
approach to confirming DCF requirements for our soy 
volumes, using agricultural country of origin, with 
countries at low risk of deforestation and conversion 
deemed to have met our DCF requirements. 
In 2024, we made progress collecting traceability data for 
our soy volumes sourced, with 34% of the soy products 
identified as originating from countries with a low risk of 
deforestation and conversion (2023β: 31%). We continue 
to engage suppliers and industry stakeholders working 
towards achieving our target by the end of 2025, with an 
expectation that continued changes in market supply and 
demand will assist with this.
Paper and Pulp-Based Products
In 2024, 84% of the paper and pulp-based products we 
purchased complied with our DCF requirements for this 
category. During the year, supplier engagement confirmed 
that 55% of the volumes were from Forest Stewardship 
Council (FSC) or Programme for the Endorsement of Forest 
Certification (PEFC) certified forests, with an additional 
22% coming from recycled fibres, and 7% manufactured in 
countries which are considered at low risk of deforestation 
and conversion. Direct engagement with suppliers has 
been key to confirming DCF status of our volumes and 
our expectation is that ongoing engagement during 2025 
will allow us to confirm DCF compliance for our remaining 
volumes. DCF-compliant volumes of paper and pulp-based 
products are confirmed through supplier engagement, 
with confirmation received on whether the volumes are 
from FSC or PEFC certified forests, recycled fibres or the 
country of harvest. This information is then used to risk 
assess the volumes for deforestation and conversion.
Outputs from previous materiality assessments, which 
involved engagement with various stakeholders, were 
considered when setting our DCF targets. The targets 
apply to all Kerry’s direct operations and we did not use 
biodiversity offsets whilst setting the targets. Progress 
towards our targets is reported through the Responsible 
Sourcing Council, to the Sustainability Executive 
Committee and the Board’s Sustainability Committee. The 
percentage of key raw materials we source that are DCF 
compliant is recorded monthly or annually depending 
on the source of information. To assess our performance 
against our DCF targets we measure the volumes of our 
palm oil, soy, and paper and pulp-based products which 
meet our category-specific DCF requirements, divided by 
the total volume of that raw material. Due to the annual 
nature of certain inputs required to allow us to calculate 
the percentage of volumes which are compliant with our 
DCF requirement, metrics are currently reviewed bi-
annually. 
Our DCF targets are intended to help avoid deforestation 
and conversion and as a result are aligned with the 
objectives of the Kunming-Montreal Global Biodiversity 
Framework and the EUDR. The absolute nature of the 
targets and their alignment with Science Based Targets 
initiative (SBTi) FLAG requirements support a science-
based approach, albeit the targets were not originally 
set using specific ecological thresholds.  The targets 
do not relate to the Do No Significant Harm criteria for 
Biodiversity as defined in the climate and environmental 
delegated acts. 
On 31 December 2024, the Group completed the sale 
of the Kerry Dairy Ireland business. If 2024 raw material 
volumes for that business were excluded from the 
total volumes purchased, volumes meeting our DCF 
requirements would be 74% palm oil, 49% soy, and 82% 
paper and pulp-based products. 
Scope 3 GHG emissions
For information regarding our Scope 3 Forest, Land 
and Agriculture (FLAG) and SBTi commitments, refer to 
our Scope 3 targets detailed within the Climate section 
on pages 158-159.
Raw Material Supply, Regulatory Compliance 
and Market Expansion
Our DCF targets assist in mitigating the biodiversity-
related risks associated with the production of 
raw materials we source and achieving regulatory 
compliance, while also contributing to the provision 
of DCF or more positive biodiversity products. We 
are working to develop additional outcome-focused 
metrics to allow us to further measure the effectiveness 
of our policies and actions on raw material supply or 
regulatory compliance risks and the market expansion 
opportunity we identified through our double 
materiality assessment. 
Sustainability Statement Resource Use and Circular Economy (E5)
1. Material Impacts and 
Opportunities 
IRO-1 – Description of the processes to identify and assess 
material resource use and circular economy-related impacts, 
risks and opportunities 
As a leading provider of food protection and preservation 
technologies, Kerry can support the reduction of food 
waste downstream. As a part of our double materiality 
assessment, we identified material resource use and 
circular economy-related impact and opportunity, as 
outlined in the following table.
Within our double materiality assessment, we defined the 
following short, medium and long-term time horizons: 
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short-term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
As part of our double materiality assessment, we 
screened our operations and upstream and downstream 
value chain to help identify actual and potential resource 
use and circular economy-related impacts, risks and 
opportunities. 
Within our direct operations we assessed the outflows 
from our sites, taking into account the types of products 
and materials generated by our production processes, 
and customers' use of our products. We also considered 
various factors relating to waste originating from our 
operations, including the volumes and types of waste, 
and the waste disposal methods available to our sites. 
Outside of our direct operations these factors were also 
considered as part of our screening of our downstream 
value chain. In addition, we screened our upstream value 
chain, considering the volumes and types of packaging 
and raw materials used as inputs in our production 
processes. 
Our assessment included consultation with suppliers, 
industry bodies, customers and internal functions. 
Food waste arises in many ways across multiple end-
use markets. Given the challenge of involving such a 
disparate group in the consultation, we did not engage 
directly with these affected communities. However, our 
assessment was informed by internal stakeholders, 
customers and industry bodies. For more information on 
our approach to determining material resource use and 
circular economy-related impacts, risks and opportunities 
see the General section on pages 140-145.
Description ​
Time  
Horizon​
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Reduce Food Waste 
Reducing the level of food loss and waste generated 
downstream through customer use of Kerry's food 
technologies
Opportunity
Extend Shelf-life 
Increased revenue due to expansion and development 
of the market for longer product shelf-life through food 
waste technologies and innovations
1 Own Ops = Own Operations
Resource Use and  
Circular Economy (E5)
1. Material Impacts and Opportunities	
175
2. Policies	
176
3. Actions	
176
4. Targets and Metrics	
177
Food Waste Downstream
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
176
177
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Resource Use and Circular Economy (E5)
2. Policies
E5-1 – Policies related to resource use and circular economy
Kerry’s Environmental Responsibility Policy summarises 
the key activities we undertake to achieve the material 
resource use and circular economy positive impact and 
opportunity downstream in our value chain.
Kerry is committed to supporting our customers 
to reduce their environmental impact through the 
provision of more sustainable solutions, helping 
to prevent food waste. By collaborating with our 
customers and offering innovative solutions, we aim 
to contribute to the UN Sustainable Development Goal 
12: Responsible Consumption and Production. This 
goal seeks to halve per capita global food waste by 
2030, helping to ensure sustainable consumption and 
production patterns.  
Our Environmental Responsibility Policy outlines how 
we bring Kerry’s commitment to reducing food waste in 
line with the waste hierarchy’s principles of prevention 
and recycling and reflects our priority to minimise waste 
production over waste treatment.  
The broader policy applies globally to Kerry Group plc, 
its subsidiaries, partners, and suppliers, covering all 
business locations and activities. The food waste section 
of the policy applies to our operations as it is focused 
on the key activities we will undertake in relation to the 
material impact and opportunity identified under this 
topic. Key stakeholders impacted by this policy include 
Kerry employees, customers and consumers, and we seek 
to incorporate their interests in our policy. 
The Chief Science and Technology Officer and Chief 
Operating Officer share ultimate accountability for the 
implementation of policies relating to resource use and 
circular economy, which includes the material impacts 
and opportunities we have identified. 
Kerry’s Environmental Responsibility Policy is available on 
our intranet and on kerry.com. 
3. Actions
E5-2 – Actions and resources related to resource use and 
circular economy
The food system relies heavily on the Earth’s natural 
resources. We recognise Kerry's role in transitioning 
towards more sustainable consumption and production 
patterns, contributing to a more resilient, equitable and 
environmentally sustainable future.
As part of our double materiality assessment, we identified 
an actual positive impact downstream in our value chain 
from use of our technologies to reduce levels of food 
waste. There is a related opportunity from the technologies 
we develop to extend shelf-life. Due to the interconnected 
nature of the positive impact and opportunity, our action 
plan outlines the steps that we are taking which can 
contribute to both outcomes. For actions disclosed in this 
section, the specified location of the actions across our 
value chain reflects where the impact and opportunity 
arise. We acknowledge that Kerry will need to initiate many 
of these activities from within our own operations.
We leverage our internal expertise and food waste 
insights to support our customers in reducing food waste 
generated downstream in our value chain. For example, 
our proprietary ‘Left on the Shelf’ consumer research, 
which involved more than 5,000 consumers across 
ten countries, provides valuable insight into consumer 
behaviours and attitudes, aiding our customers in better 
understanding and addressing these issues. 
In partnership with the Department of Food Science and 
Technology at the University of Georgia, we also shared 
insights with the wider industry on how digital tools, 
like the Kerry Food Waste Estimator, can help combat 
food waste. Launched in 2022, our proprietary tool can 
be used to showcase the potential impact of extending 
shelf-life and is available to manufacturers and consumers 
to quantify and understand the potential economic and 
environmental benefits from reducing food waste. The 
Kerry Food Waste Estimator tool is accessible on kerry.com.
In 2024, we also took the following actions towards the achievement of our resource use and circular economy-related 
policy objectives:
Actual 
Positive 
Impact and 
Opportunity
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Reduce  
Food Waste
and
Extend  
Shelf-life
In 2023, Kerry established a technology hub for food protection, in partnership with Wageningen University 
& Research (WUR). The technology hub operates within the University to support the work undertaken in 
Kerry’s Global technology and innovation centre. During 2024, the technology hub provided accelerated 
innovation and validation studies, identifying shelf-life limiting factors in customer products, validating 
effectiveness of Kerry’s food waste technologies and assisting with timely delivery of food waste prevention 
solutions to the market.
Kerry co-creates with our customers to deliver solutions for improved shelf-life extension, including clean 
label solutions and innovation providing extra protection from pathogens and spoilage. An example 
of this involved a collaboration allowing our customer to remove a freezer stage in their supply chain 
process. This provided extra protection from pathogens and spoilage while also enabling the customer to 
reduce their carbon footprint.
In 2024, we actively engaged in customer education to raise awareness about the impacts of food waste 
and the benefits of our food protection and preservation products. This included publications, conferences, 
tradeshows, webinars, campaigns, and industry partnerships. For example, sharing our tools and insights 
with retailers and manufacturers through the food waste coalition within the Consumer Goods Forum.  
The following planned future actions are designed to maintain our commitment to continuous innovation and further 
reduction in food waste. As we continue to evolve Kerry’s food waste prevention technologies and our suite of innovative 
tools, which can provide insight on food preservation to our customers, we will introduce further actions as appropriate.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact and 
Opportunity
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Reduce  
Food Waste
and
Extend  
Shelf-life
Ongoing development of tools that can provide insight and support our 
customers to reduce food waste through their use of Kerry’s technologies. 
Continued collaboration with universities, researchers, accelerators, and 
startups, to co-develop new solutions, deliver innovation, and drive adoption of 
food waste reduction solutions. 
4. Targets and Metrics1
E5-3 – Targets related to resource use and circular economy
Kerry is tackling food waste through actions including the provision of shelf-life extension technologies and 
establishment of a food protection innovation hub to support our customers. We recognise that it is only through 
partnership with these customers that we can deliver on our food waste impact and related opportunity, and we seek 
to understand their specific product challenges in detail. This customer engagement is crucial to creating effective 
solutions that are tailored to their business needs and individual product requirements, and can deliver an impact on 
downstream food waste reduction. As we continued to advocate for action, we engaged directly with 377 customers in 
2024, to help address their food waste challenges, representing a 9% increase on the previous year (2023β: 345). 
We track and measure the number of engagements with customers to help support our impact and overall business 
objectives. This metric is calculated by recording the number of unique customer engagements focused on food 
protection and preservation in the reporting year, excluding those which are employed for use in animal and/or pet 
nutrition. We continue to explore the development of other outcome-focused metrics and targets to allow us to 
measure the effectiveness of our policies and actions relating to food waste.
1Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
178
Sustainability Statement EU Taxonomy
179
Sustainability Statement
1. Background 
To meet the EU’s climate and energy targets for 2030 
and reach the objectives of the European Green Deal, the 
European Commission established an action plan to direct 
investments towards sustainable projects and activities. 
The EU Taxonomy (Regulation (EU) 2020/852, “Taxonomy 
Regulation”) and supplementary Delegated Regulations 
are designed to increase transparency of environmental 
information and define, for a limited number of sectors 
and activities, a taxonomy of sustainable activities.
At present, the Climate and Environmental Delegated 
Acts, which detail the classification criteria under the 
six environmental objectives, do not include activities 
specifically related to the food and beverage sector. As a 
result, only a limited amount of EU Taxonomy activities 
will be applicable to Kerry’s operations, limiting the value 
reported as taxonomy-eligible but not taxonomy-aligned 
(eligible) and taxonomy-aligned (aligned) under EU 
Taxonomy.
In 2023, while all six objectives were considered for 
eligibility, only climate change mitigation (CCM) and 
climate change adaptation (CCA) were assessed for 
alignment. In 2024, the Group is required to disclose 
eligibility and alignment for all six of the environmental 
objectives, with the additional four objectives being 
sustainable use and protection of water and marine 
resources (WTR), transition to a circular economy (CE), 
pollution prevention and control (PPC) and protection and 
restoration of biodiversity and ecosystems (BIO). 
In accordance with the requirements for the 2024 
financial year, the Group has outlined the extent to which 
the Group’s operations are associated with eligible and 
aligned activities as defined in the applicable Climate 
and Environmental Delegated Acts. These disclosure 
requirements cover Kerry’s global activities.
2. Assessment and Methodology 
The evaluation of eligibility and alignment was conducted 
by a cross-functional group, involving members of 
the Sustainability Reporting, Engineering, Integrated 
Operations, Commercial Finance and Research, 
Development & Application (RD&A) teams. 
2.1 Eligibility Assessment
The cross-functional team reviewed all activities 
defined under the Climate and Environmental 
Delegated Acts to identify those activities that might 
be relevant to Kerry’s current operations, based on the 
activity description, taking into consideration sector 
classification and potentially associated NACE Codes. 
It created a shortlist of activities that were applicable, 
or potentially applicable, to Kerry for a more detailed 
review to confirm those activities where there had been 
actual spend or revenue in the current year. 
For turnover, a cross-functional group comprising the 
Sustainability Reporting and Commercial Finance teams 
reviewed Kerry technologies in the shortlisted eligible 
activities to assess whether any matched the eligibility 
requirements. This included a full review of all entities 
acquired in the year. The Group’s Chief Science and 
Technology Officer reviewed and approved the final list 
of eligible turnover.
For CapEx, a cross-functional group comprising the 
Sustainability Reporting, Integrated Operations 
Finance and Engineering teams, as well as the Global 
Sustainability Engineering Lead assessed project 
descriptions and asset information to determine eligibility 
by comparing them to EU Taxonomy definitions. 
Approved eligible spend was then assessed for 
alignment, against the specific Technical Screening 
Criteria (TSC) for each eligible activity as described in 
the Climate and Environmental Delegated Acts.
2.2 Alignment Assessment – Technical 
Screening Criteria
Once the eligible activities had been identified, they 
were assessed to confirm whether they met the 
required TSC. The TSC assessment included a detailed 
review of the Substantial Contribution (SC) criteria to 
confirm whether the activity met the SC requirements 
detailed for its activity category. The Do No Significant 
Harm criteria (DNSH) were then reviewed for each 
activity that met the SC criteria, with activities which 
met both the SC and DNSH criteria being considered to 
have met the TSC for that activity. 
For CapEx, the final list of potentially aligned CapEx was 
reviewed and approved by the cross-functional group. 
Under the EU Taxonomy, we have only reported aligned 
activities under the climate change mitigation objective. 
As a result, there is no double counting with the six 
objectives that are in scope. In order to avoid any double 
counting in the numerator across economic activities, we 
reconcile the total value of each KPI's numerator (section 
A1, A2 and B on the KPI templates) back to our Financial 
Statements to ensure values have only been allocated 
once.
2.3 Alignment Assessment – Minimum 
Safeguards
An economic activity can only be classified as 
environmentally sustainable within the meaning of the 
Taxonomy if it is also conducted in accordance with 
certain minimum standards based on international 
EU Taxonomy
1. Background	
178
2. Assessment and Methodology	
178
3. Turnover	
179
4. Operating Expenditure	
179
5. Capital Expenditure	
180
6. KPI Tables	
181
frameworks. We have referred to the Final Report on 
Minimum Safeguards, published by the Platform on 
Sustainable Finance in October 2022, to support our 
interpretation of the scope and application of the 
minimum standards. Kerry has policies and processes in 
place to align our activities with the minimum safeguards, 
as set out in Article 18 of the Taxonomy Regulation:
•	 Human Rights: Kerry is committed to respecting the 
rights of stakeholders. Read more about our approach 
to conducting human rights due diligence on page 
186 and in the topical disclosures related to S1 Own 
Workforce on pages 187-205 and S2 Workers in the 
Value Chain on pages 206-212.
•	 Anti-Bribery and Corruption: Kerry’s zero tolerance 
approach to bribery and corruption is established in 
our Anti-Bribery and Corruption policy and related 
training, which provides information and guidance 
on how to recognise, address and report bribery and 
corruption issues. 
•	 Fair Competition: Our Group Code of Conduct, along 
with our Fair Competition Policy and related training, 
sets out our commitment to free and fair competition 
and clearly defines the expectations of all employees 
to uphold our compliance standards.  
•	 Taxation: We ensure compliance with tax laws through 
our responsible tax practices, see note 7 in the 
Financial Statements for further details.
Kerry has not been convicted for material violations 
of Human Rights, Anti-Bribery and Corruption, Fair 
Competition, or Taxation laws.
3. Turnover1
The denominator used for the turnover key performance 
indicator (KPI) is based on the total revenue recognised 
under IAS 1, as reported in our Financial Statements. 
For further details on Kerry’s revenue accounting policy, 
see note 1 of the Financial Statements. To determine 
the turnover KPI, the amount that is either aligned 
(numerator) or eligible but not aligned (numerator) is 
divided by the turnover denominator.
Kerry’s ordinary business, the manufacture of food and 
beverage products, is not eligible as these activities are 
currently not defined in the Climate and Environmental 
Delegated Acts. As part of the assessment outlined 
in section 2.1, we identified a negligible amount of 
eligible turnover, 0.2%, in 2024 (2023β: 0.2%). This 
turnover is associated with activities that do not directly 
relate to, or act as, ingredients for use in the food and 
beverage industry. The activities specifically relate to the 
manufacture of chlorine (CCM 3.13), the manufacture 
of organic basic chemicals (CCM 3.14) and a new activity 
which commenced in 2024, the manufacture of active 
pharmaceutical ingredients (API) or active substances 
(PPC 1.1).
In 2024 no eligible turnover satisfied the Substantial 
Contribution criteria, and therefore turnover was not 
further assessed for alignment beyond this point.
EU Taxonomy - 
Turnover
Reference 
to Financial 
Statements
2024 
€m2
2023 
€m
Revenue
Consolidated 
Income Statement 
7,980.6
8,020.3
Turnover 
denominator 
7,980.6
8,020.3
4. Operating Expenditure (OpEx)
At present activities specific to the food and beverage 
sector are not defined within the Climate and 
Environmental Delegated Acts and as a result there is a 
limited amount of Kerry’s ordinary activities in scope. The 
EU Taxonomy allows for an exemption from disclosure of 
the OpEx KPI under Delegated Regulation (EU) 2021/2178. 
Following assessment of our OpEx denominator we have 
determined that the exemption is applicable.
The limited scope of the Climate and Environmental 
Delegated Acts relative to our ordinary operations 
is reflected in 99.8% of our turnover being deemed 
Taxonomy non-eligible. Within our OpEx denominator, the 
largest OpEx spend relates to research and development 
costs, recognised as an expense in our Consolidated 
Income Statement as stated in note 3 to the Financial 
Statements. It represents 45% of the total OpEx 
denominator in 2024 (2023β: 47%). This spend supports 
Kerry’s turnover generating activities, which are not in 
scope of the activities currently defined in the Climate 
and Environmental Delegated Acts, and does not support 
other taxonomy activities reaching their substantial 
contribution thresholds. 
Short-term leases, as included in note 12 iii.i, repairs and 
maintenance and other direct expenditure relating to 
the day-to-day servicing of assets of property, plant and 
equipment, including the internal and external people 
cost for the Engineering teams maintaining buildings 
and equipment, included in other general overheads 
and staff costs in note 3 to the Financial Statements is 
equal to 4.2% of Group OpEx in 2024 (2023β: 3.8%), and is 
considered not material.
EU Taxonomy – Operating 
Expenditure
2024 €m
2023β €m3
Research and development costs 
235.5
235.9
Short-term leases
3.7
3.7
Maintenance and repairs 
141.1
131.6
Other direct expenditures 
137.3
128.4
Operating expenditure 
denominator 
517.6
499.6
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
2 The revenue included is total revenue, including revenue of Kerry Dairy Ireland, consistent with the total revenue of the Group for the 2024 
financial year.
3 In 2024, the method for identifying activities included in the operating expenditure denominator has been refined to better align with the EU 
Taxonomy definition. The following items were originally reported in 2023β as Research and development cost €301.3m, Maintenance and 
repairs €157.9m, Other direct expenditure €128.6m, and total operating expenditure denominator €591.5m.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
180
181
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement EU Taxonomy
5. Capital Expenditure1
The denominator used for the CapEx KPIs is calculated 
based on additions and businesses acquired for property, 
plant, and equipment (IAS 16), leases (IFRS 16) and 
intangible assets (IAS 38) as reported in the Financial 
Statements. The denominator does not include any 
investment property (IAS 40) or agriculture (IAS 41) 
assets, as they are not applicable to Kerry. As defined 
in the Taxonomy, goodwill is not included in the CapEx 
KPI. In determining the KPIs for CapEx, the amount that 
is either aligned (numerator) or eligible but not aligned 
(numerator) is divided by the CapEx denominator.
The CapEx aligned numerator includes assets that are 
associated with taxonomy aligned activities. In 2024, 
there were four activities which were eligible and aligned 
under the Climate Change Mitigation objective. These 
activities related to acquisition of heating, ventilation and 
air-conditioning systems (CCM 7.3), charging stations 
for electric vehicles (CCM 7.4), building automation and 
control systems and energy management systems (CCM 
7.5), all of which are property, plant and equipment 
additions and commercial offices (CCM 7.7), which are 
right-of-use assets. The process for determining the 
aligned numerator is set out in section 2.2 above.
Comparing the aligned and eligible but not aligned 
capital additions (numerator) to our additions and 
businesses acquired, property, plant and equipment, right 
of use assets and intangible assets (denominator) in 2024, 
the proportion of aligned activities is 2.6% (2023β: 3.2%) 
and of eligible but not aligned is 21.1% (2023β: 22.0%2). 
The small decrease in the proportion of aligned activities 
in 2024 is due to a higher value of business combinations  
included in the 2024 denominator, compared to the 2023 
denominator. The majority of the assets in the current 
year business combinations are not eligible under the 
activities defined under EU Taxonomy.
EU Taxonomy - Capital 
Expenditure
Reference 
to Financial 
Statements 
2024 
€m
2023 
€m
Property, plant and 
equipment – Additions
Note 12 i
266.1
273.1
Property, plant and 
equipment - Businesses 
acquired
Note 12 i
43.0
7.1
Right of use assets – 
Additions
Note 12 ii
64.2
36.4
Right of use assets - 
Businesses acquired
Note 12 ii
0.1
2.6
Intangible assets – 
Additions
Note 13
27.5
15.9
Intangible assets - 
Businesses acquired -  
Brand-related intangibles3
Note 13
86.8
23.1
Capital expenditure 
denominator
487.7
358.2
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
2 Comparative information for 2023 proportion of eligible but not aligned activities reported as 18.5% in 2023β, has been re-presented due to 
change in 2023 denominator and to include additional eligible activities in 2023. Details of additional activities included on pages 184-185.
3 Comparative information for 2023 Intangible assets - Businesses acquired - Brand-related intangibles has been re-presented, reported as 
€41.6m in 2023β. For further information on this, please see note 31 in the Financial Statements. 
Our eligibility assessment for EU Taxonomy did not identify any activities relating to nuclear energy or fossil gas, as a 
result we have only disclosed Template 1, as per ANNEX XII of Commission Delegated Regulation (EU) 2021/2178.
Nuclear energy related activities
1
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to research, development, demonstration and deployment of innovative 
electricity generation facilities that produce energy from nuclear processes with minimal waste from the fuel cycle.
No
2
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construction and safe operation of new nuclear installations to produce 
electricity or process heat, including for the purposes of district heating or industrial processes such as hydrogen production, as 
well as their safety upgrades, using best available technologies.
No
3
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to safe operation of existing nuclear installations that produce electricity 
or process heat, including for the purposes of district heating or industrial processes such as hydrogen production from nuclear 
energy, as well as their safety upgrades.
No
Fossil gas related activities
4
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construction or operation of electricity generation facilities that produce 
electricity using fossil gaseous fuels.
No
5
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construction, refurbishment, and operation of combined heat/cool and 
power generation facilities using fossil gaseous fuels.
No
6
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construction, refurbishment and operation of heat generation facilities 
that produce heat/cool using fossil gaseous fuels.
No
Financial year N
Year
Substantial contribution criteria
DNSH criteria  
(“Does Not Significantly Harm”)
Economic Activities (1)
Code (2)
Turnover (3)
Proportion of 
Turnover, year N (4)
Climate Change 
Mitigation (5)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (6)
Water (7)
Pollution (8)
Circular  
Economy (9)
Biodiversity (10)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (11)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (12)
Water (13)
Pollution (14)
Circular Economy 
(15)
Biodiversity (16)
Minimum  
Safeguards (17)
Proportion of 
Taxonomy-aligned 
(A.1.) or-eligible 
(A.2.) turnover, year 
N-1β (18)
Category enabling 
activity (19)
Category 
transitional 
activity (20)
Text
€’m
%
Y; N;  
N/EL 
Y; N; 
N/EL 
Y; N;  
N/EL 
Y; N; 
N/EL 
Y; N; N/
EL 
Y; N; 
N/EL 
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
%
E
T
A. TAXONOMY-ELIGIBLE ACTIVITIES
A.1. Environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned)
Turnover of environmentally sustainable activities 
(Taxonomy-aligned) (A.1)
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
Of which enabling 
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
E
Of which transitional 
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
T
A.2. Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (g)
EL; 
N/EL 
EL; 
N/EL 
EL; 
N/EL  
EL; 
N/EL  
EL; 
N/EL  
EL; 
N/EL  
Manufacture of chlorine
CCM 3.13 
8.7
0.1%
EL 
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.1%
Manufacture of organic basic chemicals
CCM 3.14
7.7
0.1%
EL 
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.1%
Manufacture of active pharmaceutical 
ingredients (API) or active substances
PPC 1.1
0.2
0.0%
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
EL 
N/EL
N/EL
0.0%
Turnover of Taxonomy-eligible but not 
environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-
aligned activities) (A.2)
16.6
0.2%
0.2%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.2%
A. Turnover of Taxonomy-eligible activities (A.1+A.2)
16.6
0.2%
0.2%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.2%
B. TAXONOMY-NON-ELIGIBLE ACTIVITIES
Turnover of Taxonomy-non-eligible activities
7,964.0
99.8%
TOTAL2
7,980.6
100%
 Proportion of turnover from products or services associated with Taxonomy-aligned economic activities – disclosure covering 2024 (year N)1
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
2 The revenue included is total revenue, including revenue of Kerry Dairy Ireland, consistent with the total revenue of the Group for the 2024 financial year.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
182
Sustainability Statement
183
Sustainability Statement EU Taxonomy
Financial year N
Year
Substantial contribution criteria
DNSH criteria  
(“Does Not Significantly Harm”)
Economic Activities (1)
Code (2)
OpEx (3)
Proportion of 
OpEx, year N (4)
Climate Change 
Mitigation (5)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (6)
Water (7)
Pollution (8)
Circular  
Economy (9)
Biodiversity (10)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (11)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (12)
Water (13)
Pollution (14)
Circular Economy 
(15)
Biodiversity (16)
Minimum  
Safeguards (17)
Proportion of 
Taxonomy-aligned 
(A.1.) or-eligible 
(A.2.) OpEx, year 
N-1β (18)
Category enabling 
activity (19)
Category 
transitional 
activity (20)
Text
€’m
%
Y; N; 
N/EL 
Y; N;  
N/EL 
Y; N;  
N/EL 
Y; N; 
N/EL 
Y; N; N/
EL 
Y; N; 
N/EL 
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
%
E
T
A. TAXONOMY-ELIGIBLE ACTIVITIES
A.1. Environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned)
OpEx of environmentally sustainable 
activities (Taxonomy-aligned) (A.1)
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
Of which enabling 
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
E
Of which transitional 
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
T
A.2. Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (g)
EL; 
N/EL 
EL; 
N/EL 
EL; 
N/EL 
EL; 
N/EL 
EL; 
N/EL 
EL; 
N/EL 
OpEx of Taxonomy-eligible but not 
environmentally sustainable activities (not 
Taxonomy-aligned activities) (A.2)
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
A. OpEx of Taxonomy-eligible activities 
(A.1+A.2)
0.0
0.0%
0.0%
B. TAXONOMY-NON-ELIGIBLE ACTIVITIES
OpEx of Taxonomy-non-eligible activities
517.6
100%
TOTAL
517.6
100%
 Proportion of OpEx from products or services associated with Taxonomy-aligned economic activities – disclosure covering 2024 (year N)1
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
Financial year N
Year
Substantial contribution criteria
DNSH criteria  
(“Does Not Significantly Harm”)
Economic Activities (1)
Code (a) (2)
CapEx (3)
Proportion of  
CapEx, year N (4)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (5)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (6)
Water (7)
Pollution (8)
Circular Economy 
(9)
Biodiversity (10)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (11)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (12)
Water (13)
Pollution (14)
Circular Economy 
(15)
Biodiversity (16)
Minimum  
Safeguards (17)
Proportion of 
Taxonomy-aligned 
(A.1.) or-eligible 
(A.2.) CapEx, year 
N-1β (18)2
Category enabling 
activity (19)
Category 
transitional 
activity (20)
Text
€’m
%
Y; N; 
N/EL  
Y; N; 
N/EL  
Y; N; 
N/EL  
Y; N; 
N/EL  
Y; N; 
N/
EL 
Y; N; 
N/EL  
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
Y/N
%
E
T
A. TAXONOMY-ELIGIBLE ACTIVITIES
A.1. Environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned)
Installation, maintenance and repair of 
energy efficiency equipment
CCM 
7.3
0.1
0.0%
Y 
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
3.2%
E
Installation, maintenance and repair of 
charging stations for electric vehicles in 
buildings (and parking spaces attached to 
buildings)
CCM 
7.4
0.1
0.0%
Y
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
0.0%
E
Installation, maintenance and repair of 
instruments and devices for measuring, 
regulation and controlling energy 
performance of buildings
CCM 
7.5
0.4
0.1%
Y
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
0.0%
E
Acquisition and ownership of buildings
CCM 
7.7
12.1
2.5%
Y
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
0.0%
CapEx of environmentally sustainable activities 
(Taxonomy-aligned) (A.1)
12.7
2.6%
2.6%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
3.2%
Of which enabling 
0.1%
0.1%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
3.2%
E
Of which transitional 
0.0%
0.0%
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
0.0%
T
Proportion of CapEx from products or services associated with Taxonomy-aligned economic activities – disclosure covering 2024 (year N)1
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
2 Comparatives for CCM 7.3 represented, reported as 3.1% in 2023β EU Taxonomy disclosure. Re-presented due to change in the denominator explained on page 180, there was no change in the numerator.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
184
185
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement EU Taxonomy
Financial year N
Year
Substantial contribution criteria
DNSH criteria  
(“Does Not Significantly Harm”)
Economic Activities (1)
Code (a) (2)
CapEx (3)
Proportion of  
CapEx, year N (4)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (5)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (6)
Water (7)
Pollution (8)
Circular Economy 
(9)
Biodiversity (10)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (11)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (12)
Water (13)
Pollution (14)
Circular Economy 
(15)
Biodiversity (16)
Minimum  
Safeguards (17)
Proportion of 
Taxonomy-aligned 
(A.1.) or-eligible 
(A.2.) CapEx, year 
N-1β (18)2
Category enabling 
activity (19)
Category 
transitional 
activity (20)
A.2. Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (g)
EL; 
N/EL  
(t)
EL; 
N/EL  
(t)
EL; 
N/EL  
(t)
EL; 
N/EL  
(t)
EL; 
N/
EL  
(t)
EL; 
N/EL  
(t)
Installation and operation of electric heat 
pumps
CCM 
4.16
0.0
0.0%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.0%
Cogeneration of heat/cool and power from 
renewable non-fossil gaseous and liquid fuels
CCM 
4.19
0.0
0.0%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.0%
Production of heat/cool using waste heat
CCM 
4.25
1.1
0.2%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.3%
Construction, extension and operation of 
waste water collection and treatment1
CCM 
5.3
7.1
1.5%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
2.1%
Transport by motorbikes, passenger cars 
and light commercial vehicles
CCM 
6.5
3.8
0.8%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
1.2%
Freight transport services by road
CCM 
6.6
0.7
0.1%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.0%
Construction of new buildings
CCM 
7.1/CE 
3.1
0.0
0.0%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
EL
N/EL
10.4%
Renovation of existing buildings
CCM 
7.2/CE 
3.2
12.0
2.5%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
EL
N/EL
0.8%
Installation, maintenance and repair of 
energy efficiency equipment
CCM 
7.3
12.6
2.6%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
2.5%
1 Comparative information for 2023 activity CCM 5.3 (2023β: €7.5m) has been re-presented to include eligible activity in 2023.
2 Comparatives for following activities re-presented due to change in denominator explained on page 180, there was no change in the numerator. Reported in 2023β EU Taxonomy disclosure as CCM 4.25 (0.3%), CCM 
6.5 (1.2%), CCM 7.1 / CE 3.1 (9.9%), CCM 7.2 / CE 3.2 (0.8%), CCM 7.3 (2.4%).
Financial year N
Year
Substantial contribution criteria
DNSH criteria  
(“Does Not Significantly Harm”)
Economic Activities (1)
Code (a) (2)
CapEx (3)
Proportion of  
CapEx, year N (4)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (5)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (6)
Water (7)
Pollution (8)
Circular Economy 
(9)
Biodiversity (10)
Climate Change  
Mitigation (11)
Climate Change 
Adaptation (12)
Water (13)
Pollution (14)
Circular Economy 
(15)
Biodiversity (16)
Minimum  
Safeguards (17)
Proportion of 
Taxonomy-aligned 
(A.1.) or-eligible 
(A.2.) CapEx, year 
N-1β (18)2
Category enabling 
activity (19)
Category 
transitional 
activity (20)
A.2. Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (g)
Installation, maintenance and repair of 
charging stations for electric vehicles in 
buildings (and parking spaces attached to 
buildings)
CCM 
7.4
0.0
0.0%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.0%
Installation, maintenance and repair of 
instruments and devices for measuring, 
regulation and controlling energy 
performance of buildings
CCM 
7.5
0.0
0.0%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
0.0%
Acquisition and ownership of buildings
CCM 
7.7
63.4
13.0%
EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
4.1%
Production of alternative water resources for 
purposes other than human consumption1
CE 2.2
0.2
0.0%
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
EL
N/EL
0.1%
Sorting and material recovery of non-
hazardous waste1
CE 2.7
0.2
0.0%
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
EL
N/EL
0.1%
Provision of IT/OT data-driven solutions1
CE 4.1 
1.6
0.3%
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
N/EL
EL
N/EL
0.4%
CapEx of Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally 
sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned 
activities) (A.2)	
102.7
21.1%
20.7%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.4%
0.0%
22.0%
A. CapEx of Taxonomy-eligible activities (A.1+A.2)
115.4
23.7%
23.3%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.4%
0.0%
25.2%
B. TAXONOMY-NON-ELIGIBLE ACTIVITIES
CapEx of Taxonomy-non-eligible activities
372.3
76.3%
TOTAL
487.7
100%
1 Comparative information for 2023 activities CE 2.2 (2023β: €0.3m), CE 2.7 (2023β: €0.2m), CE 4.1 (2023β: €1.3m) have been re-presented to include an eligible activity in 2023.
2 Comparatives for CCM 7.7 re-presented, reported as 3.9% in 2023β EU Taxonomy disclosure. Re-presented due to change in the denominator explained on page 180, there was no change in the numerator.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
186
187
Sustainability Statement
Human Rights Overview
Our Approach to Human Rights
Kerry is committed to respecting and upholding human 
rights across our value chain. Our approach aligns 
with internationally recognised frameworks, including 
the United Nations Guiding Principles on Business 
and Human Rights, OECD Guidelines for Multinational 
Enterprises on Responsible Business Conduct, 
International Labour Organization's (ILO) Declaration on 
Fundamental Principles and Rights at Work, and the UN 
Sustainable Development Goals (UN SDGs). 
Kerry’s Human Rights Policy is central to our responsible 
business practices, which are documented in our 
Group Code of Conduct, Supplier Code of Conduct and 
Responsible Employer Policy, amongst others. 
Human Rights Management
As part of our human rights management, we identify 
human rights risks most likely to be impacted by our 
business activities. Through a formalised human 
rights assessment with a third-party, we identified and 
prioritised our salient human rights risks, which are 
primarily concentrated in our upstream value chain and 
operational activities. This assessment provides Kerry 
with the potential severity of harm and salience of impact 
of the risk to the rightsholder. 
We maintain grievance mechanisms to capture any 
potential negative impacts, ensure access to remedies, 
and continuously improve our processes so that human 
rights are upheld in our own operations and value chain 
activities. We use a third-party platform, Sedex (Supplier 
Ethical Data Exchange), to support our due diligence 
approach in both our operations and upstream value 
chain. The Sedex platform offers a robust and widely used 
social audit methodology, SMETA (Sedex Members Ethical 
Trade Audit).
The Chief Human Resources Officer (CHRO) and Chief 
Operating Officer (COO), who are members of the 
Executive Leadership Team, are jointly accountable for the 
implementation of our Human Rights Policy. Our Social 
Sustainability Council, supported by the cross functional 
Social Sustainability Working Group, is responsible for 
delivering on the Group's human rights commitments.
Human Rights Management  
(Own Operations)
At Kerry, we prioritise integrity and ethical conduct in all 
business activities. Our practices align with internationally 
recognised human rights frameworks and focus on 
safeguarding employee rights across all geographies. 
Kerry manufacturing sites are registered on Sedex and 
maintain an up-to-date Self-Assessment Questionnaire 
(SAQ), which includes questions about business practices, 
management systems, policies, and information about 
our own workforce. This allows designated personnel 
at each site to self-assess their sites compliance with 
requirements identifying human rights risks and 
opportunities to make improvements to working 
conditions. We also use Sedex Members Ethical Trade 
Audits (SMETA) and independent social compliance audits 
to enable comprehensive risk monitoring. Through 
our use of Sedex, we identify areas for improvement to 
enhance our due diligence processes.
For more information on how we manage and mitigate 
human rights risks within our operations, please refer to 
the Own Workforce section on pages 187-205. 
Human Rights Management  
(Upstream Value Chain)
Kerry’s suppliers are required to adhere to the standards 
outlined in our Supplier Requirements Manual, which 
incorporates our Supplier Code of Conduct. To address 
salient human rights risks in our upstream value chain, 
we follow a risk-based approach to identify, monitor, and 
address these risks effectively. We conduct an annual risk 
assessment to identify suppliers with a high potential 
for human rights risks. This begins with a sector risk 
evaluation, focusing on sectors deemed high-risk. For 
these sectors, we perform a detailed analysis considering 
inherent manufacturing, forced or compulsory labour, 
children and young workers, and commodity country 
risks. Suppliers that are located in countries deemed high-
risk are expected to become Sedex members, initiate and 
maintain an active link with Kerry, complete SAQs, and 
undergo SMETA audits. We continuously monitor and 
engage with suppliers to improve adherence to these 
requirements.
For more information on how we manage and mitigate 
human rights risks within our upstream value chain, 
please refer to the Workers in the Value Chain section on 
pages 206-212.
Human Rights Management  
(Downstream Value Chain)
Downstream value chain partners are low risk, as 
determined by our third-party assessment. In addition, 
we have not become aware of any significant human 
rights risks amongst our downstream value chain 
partners. Our grievance mechanisms, such as the Speak 
Up channel, are available to downstream partners and 
will continue to be monitored for potential issues.
Own Workforce (S1)
1. Material Impacts, Risks	
187 
and Opportunities
2. Strategy	
188
3. Policies	
189
4. Engagement Process	
191
5. Actions	
192
6. Targets	
196
7. Metrics	
197
Responsible Employer 
Kerry’s responsible employer-related material impacts are concentrated within our own operational activities: 
Description ​
Time  
Horizon​
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Actual 
Negative 
Impact
Health, Safety and Wellbeing  
Own workforce health, safety and wellbeing within the 
work-related environment.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Working Conditions and Labour Law Compliance  
Creating positive and engaging working conditions and 
safeguarding employee rights through compliance with 
national labour laws. 
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Employee Attraction, Retention and Development   
Employee attraction, retention, and development 
through flexibility, upskilling and career advancement 
opportunities.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Employment Security    
Employment security, stability, and engagement, by 
respecting employee representation in all regions 
according to local law, by having positive relationships 
with employee representatives, and maintaining a direct 
dialogue with employees.
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Equal Treatment and Safe Working Environment 
Equal treatment and opportunities for employees by 
creating an environment that is safe from bullying and 
harassment and free from violence in all its forms.
 
1. Material Impacts, Risks  
and Opportunities 
As part of Kerry’s double materiality assessment, we 
identified material own workforce-related impacts, as 
outlined in the tables below, for two material topics 
being Responsible Employer and Diversity, Inclusion 
and Belonging (DI&B). The term our 'own workforce' 
encompasses both employees and non-employees of 
the Group. Throughout this disclosure the term ‘own 
workforce’ and ‘our people’ will be used interchangeably. 
The term ‘employee’ refers specifically to Kerry’s direct 
employees, as described in note S1-6 on page 197, while 
the term ‘non-employees’ describes individuals who supply 
their labour to Kerry under non-contractual employment 
arrangements, refer to note S1-7 on page 200 for further 
details. Our approach to determining own workforce-
related material impacts is described in the General section 
on pages 140-141.
As part of our double materiality assessment, we defined 
the following short, medium and long-term time horizons:
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short-term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
1Own Ops = Own Operations
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
188
Sustainability Statement
189
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging
Kerry’s diversity, inclusion and belonging-related material impacts are concentrated within our own operational activities:  
Description ​
Time  
Horizon​
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Equal Opportunity and Fairness  
Equal treatment and opportunities for employees by 
creating an environment of gender fairness, that is open 
to different cultures and abilities, and pays employees 
equal pay for work of equal value.
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Gender, Ethnic and Cultural Diversity 
Focusing on gender, ethnic and cultural diversity to 
ensure appropriate representation in Kerry. 
 
2. Strategy
ESRS 2 SBM-3 – Material impacts, risks and opportunities and 
their interaction with strategy and business model
Responsible Employer 
The material responsible employer-related impacts 
influence our strategy and business model in the 
following ways:
Health, Safety and Wellbeing: We have identified 
a material negative impact on our own workforce’s 
health, safety and wellbeing within the work-related 
environment. To manage this actual impact, we continue 
to prioritise a culture of Safety First, Quality Always across 
every Kerry location, which includes a specifically targeted 
focus on our manufacturing facilities. Through a range 
of programmes and ongoing operational measures, 
we have implemented a comprehensive health, safety, 
and wellbeing approach to promote a safe working 
environment in which everyone can be at their best.
Working Conditions and Labour Law Compliance: 
At Kerry, we create positive and engaging working 
conditions and safeguard employee rights through 
compliance with national labour laws. We ensure fair 
treatment through policies focused on merit-based 
progression, equal pay, and inclusive practices while 
monitoring metrics on pay equity.
Employee Attraction, Retention and Development: 
Kerry’s reward and talent strategy includes initiatives to 
attract and retain top talent through competitive benefits, 
career development programmes, and a strong employer 
brand. This supports operational efficiency, enhances our 
ability to innovate, and reduces recruitment costs.
Employment Security: We have identified actual 
positive impacts on our employees' employment 
security, stability, and engagement, by respecting the 
employee representation rights in all regions according 
to local and federal law, by having positive relationships 
with employee representatives, and by maintaining a 
direct dialogue with employees. 
Equal Treatment and Safe Working Environment:  
We ensure equal treatment and opportunities for 
employees by creating a safe working environment 
through promoting a zero-tolerance approach to bullying 
and harassment and violence in all its forms.
Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging
The material impacts related to DI&B influence our 
strategy and business model in the following ways:
Equal Opportunity and Fairness: We ensure fair 
treatment through our policies focused on merit-
based progression, equal pay, and inclusive hiring 
practices. We also monitor metrics on pay equity, 
promotion, and employee demographics to uphold 
our commitment to fairness.
Gender, Ethnic and Cultural Diversity: Kerry’s DI&B 
initiatives are designed to promote a workforce that 
reflects our broad customer and community base. 
Our programmes focus on recruitment, leadership 
development, and inclusive workplace practices, fostering 
an environment where our people feel a sense of 
belonging and respect. By building an inclusive culture, 
we create a competitive advantage, increase employee 
engagement and reduce employee turnover.
1Own Ops = Own Operations
Relationship Between Own Workforce-Related 
Impacts, Risks, Opportunities and Strategy 
Insights from these impacts inform our strategic 
adaptations, including expanding safety initiatives, 
enhancing employee engagement programmes, and 
increasing focus on DI&B initiatives to meet our business 
and sustainability goals. Kerry’s OurVoice employee 
experience survey helps build our understanding of our 
overall employee experience and how employees could 
be impacted by our strategic decisions. This information 
helps refine the actions taken to address those potential 
impacts for the benefit of our people. Our non-employees 
are incorporated as part of ongoing local management 
practices and engagement, including town halls, role 
training and/or other local engagement and information 
practices.
Our sustainability commitments result in impacts for 
our own workforce, particularly as we aim to transition 
to more sustainable operations. To support this, we are 
investing in upskilling programmes focused on building 
sustainability skills and fostering job creation in roles 
dedicated to enable sustainable nutrition. 
We are committed to respecting human rights at Kerry 
operations. Further information on Kerry’s approach 
to Human Rights Due Diligence can be found in the 
Human Rights Overview on page 186. 
3. Policies
S1-1 – Policies related to own workforce 
At the foundation of Kerry’s purpose, vision, and 
values lies a strong commitment to our people and our 
responsible employer practices. We have an established 
Code of Conduct including a comprehensive set of 
policies and processes. Our responsible employer-related 
policies, which are publicly available on our website, 
apply to all employees worldwide (including directors, 
contracted personnel, part-time workers, casual workers, 
agency workers, interns, etc.).
The Chief Human Resources Officer (CHRO), who is a 
member of the Executive Leadership Team, is ultimately 
accountable for the implementation of the following 
policies (unless otherwise stated) and exercises 
ongoing oversight of performance and strategies 
aimed at delivering our people commitments.
Our Responsible Employer Policies 
Health & Safety Policy
At Kerry, we reinforce a culture of safety at work 
and are committed to providing a safe and healthy 
workplace for our people in our own operations. We 
responsibly manage our business in accordance with the 
Group’s Health and Safety Policy, which establishes the 
fundamental principles that employees must integrate 
into their role and the business decisions they make for 
the protection of co-workers and others. 
To enable this, we define Health & Safety responsibilities 
and accountabilities at all levels of the organisation, 
and ensure that our people have the awareness, skills 
and capabilities they need to deliver health and safety 
excellence in every part of our business. We use a single 
standardised global Environmental, Health & Safety (EHS) 
Management System to comply with a set of risk-based 
global workplace standards that we deem essential 
across every Kerry location.
We will continue to review the impact and progress 
of our commitment by monitoring and reporting 
specific measures and KPIs in all our operations. 
Accountability sits with our Global Quality Health Safety 
and Environmental (QHSE) Officer, who will ensure 
compliance with local laws and relevant standards 
while guiding our performance and strategies.
In line with our Health and Safety Policy, our 'Eye for 
Safety' is a one-page statement summarising how we 
deliver on our commitment to our Safety First, Quality 
Always guiding principle of never compromising on the 
safety of our people and providing a safe and healthy 
workplace. This is displayed in local languages in Kerry 
locations. All our people have a role in delivering on 
our health and safety commitments, and everyone is 
expected to challenge any conditions or behaviours that 
are considered to be unsafe.
Responsible Employer Policy
At Kerry, we are passionate about creating positive 
working conditions that inspire all our people to 
give their best, enabled by ongoing direct dialogue. 
We are committed to safeguarding employee rights 
and contributing to their wellbeing as we grow our 
business together. This commitment is governed by our 
Responsible Employer Policy.
Kerry's policies and processes ensure that we consistently 
provide our employees with fair and compliant 
compensation and working conditions, meeting or 
exceeding all federal and local laws, including those 
relating to:
•	 Adequate wages;
•	 Freedom of association, social dialogue and collective 
bargaining;
•	 Secure employment;
•	 Work-life balance; and
•	 Working time. 
Pay equity is fundamental to Kerry’s reward philosophy. 
Our ongoing relationship and work with the Global Fair 
Wage Network is an active and focused commitment to 
paying a living wage in line with accepted local standards.
To facilitate career management and progression, 
Kerry has established a robust annual career and talent 
review process. This comprehensive approach aims to 
support employees in both their current position and 
when planning for future roles within the Group. Kerry is 
dedicated to implementing necessary policies, structures, 
and systems designed to empower employees to take 
charge of their development and enhance their skills 
as they advance their careers within the organisation, 
irrespective of their location, function, or role. 
To further support our employees, we provide access 
to an Employee Assistance Programme (EAP) for all 
employees at every location, offering an additional 
confidential support mechanism for employees to discuss 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
190
191
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
issues relating to their working or personal life. 
We also track any formally reported complaints through 
our systems (AskHR and Speak Up), ensuring that they are 
investigated thoroughly in a timely manner and with any 
necessary remediations taken.
Violence-Free Workplace Policy and Bullying 
and Harassment-Free Workplace Policy 
At Kerry, we have a zero tolerance for violence, bullying 
and harassment of any kind. Our focus is on developing a 
highly engaged workforce and a safe work environment 
where we treat each other with dignity and respect and 
where all workplaces are safe and free from harmful 
situations. 
All employees have an important role to play in 
preventing bullying and harassment, both through their 
behaviour and by being alert to the actions of others. Any 
behaviour which disrespects an employee or is at odds 
with our commitment to a respectful and dignified work 
environment will not be tolerated. 
We have developed these policies to establish 
and maintain a safe, healthy, and supportive work 
environment. We adhere to legal and regulatory 
requirements within our operations for working 
conditions that foster wellbeing, respect, and growth for 
all members of our team.
Kerry promptly investigates all alleged violence, 
bullying and harassment in the workplace, including 
engagement with the appropriate local authorities 
(with the consent of the alleged victim, where 
applicable). We track any formally reported complaints 
regarding violence, bullying and harassment through 
our systems, ensuring that any such complaints 
are investigated in a timely manner in line with all 
guidelines which includes a structured analysis of 
complaint types across all locations.
Our Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging 
Policy
Our Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging (DI&B) Policy is 
rooted in Kerry’s core values of Courage, Enterprising 
Spirit, Inclusiveness, Open-mindedness, and 
Ownership. We value the unique contributions of 
employees with a variety of backgrounds, experiences, 
and viewpoints, fostering an inclusive culture where 
everyone can belong. The policy ensures respectful 
and professional treatment for all employees, with 
their uniqueness and perspectives valued. This policy 
is part of Kerry’s standard employment-related policies 
and practices. It is shared with employees when they 
join the business as part of their onboarding process 
and is available to all Kerry employees through the 
employee intranet (MyKerry).
We follow all related laws in employment decisions 
in the different locations in which we operate, and 
do not discriminate based on age, colour, disability, 
ethnic origin, gender identity, political opinion, racial 
origin, religion, sex, sexual orientation, social origin, 
any other status unrelated to the ability to perform 
the job, or any other category protected by law. 
Employees’ terms and conditions of employment, 
including hiring, training, working conditions, 
compensation, benefits, or promotions are based 
on the individual’s qualifications, performance, 
contribution, motivation, skills, and experience.
Kerry is committed to providing equal access to people 
in all aspects of employment. This includes ensuring that 
people with disabilities have full access to employment, 
training, promotion, and career development in 
the organisation, and, where feasible, alteration to 
workstations and the adjustment or modification of 
equipment. 
To monitor the effectiveness and implementation of 
our DI&B initiatives, we track employee experience 
on a recurring basis through a formal process. We 
conduct annual talent and succession review processes 
across all locations as appropriate. We track any 
formally reported complaints regarding DI&B through 
our systems, ensuring that any such complaints 
are investigated in a timely manner in line with all 
guidelines, which includes a structured analysis of 
complaint types across all locations.
We are committed to increasing awareness and 
understanding, and to developing skills so that our 
leaders, managers, and all employees can play their part 
in building a diverse and inclusive organisation.
Our Human Rights Policy
Kerry is dedicated to maintaining the highest standards 
of business and ethical conduct, ensuring compliance 
with applicable laws, regulations, and internal policies. 
Kerry’s Human Rights Policy outlines our commitment 
to upholding internationally recognised workers' 
rights throughout our value chain. This section 
focuses on our human rights commitments for our 
own operations. Our Human Rights Policy aligns with 
internationally recognised frameworks, including the 
UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights, 
the International Labour Organization's Declaration on 
Fundamental Principles and Rights at Work, and the 
OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises. This policy 
underscores our commitment to uphold essential human 
rights within our own workforce, explicitly opposing 
human trafficking, forced labour, and child labour. For 
further details on how we manage our human rights 
impacts and risks, please refer to the Human Rights 
Overview section on page 186. 
Kerry’s CHRO and Chief Operating Officer (COO), both part 
of the Executive Leadership Team, are jointly responsible 
for executing our Human Rights Policy. This policy reflects 
our commitment to recognised guidelines and third-party 
standards, and we actively participate in various trade 
organisations and multi-stakeholder platforms to further 
our commitment to human rights.
All of Kerry’s people-related policies are available 
on our intranet and website. Further details on the 
implementation of these policies through employee 
engagement are provided in the Stakeholder Engagement 
disclosure on pages 138-139 and in the following 
Engagement Process section. 
4. Engagement Process
Interests and Views of Our People 
ESRS 2 SBM-2 – Interests and views of stakeholders
At Kerry, we recognise that our people are key affected 
stakeholders, and we are committed to incorporating 
their interests, views, and rights, including respect for 
their human rights, into our strategy and business 
model. Employee representatives from across Kerry’s 
key functional areas actively participated in our double 
materiality assessment process where they had the 
opportunity to voice their opinions and views on the 
materiality of the Group’s impact on sustainability topics 
and the impact of sustainability topics on the Group. 
For more details on Kerry’s stakeholder engagement 
approach, please refer to the Stakeholder Engagement 
section on pages 138-139.
The interests and views expressed by our people, have 
been considered when there have been strategy and 
business model updates. The following section outlines 
our comprehensive stakeholder engagement process to 
ensure that the voices of our employees are heard and 
considered in our decision-making processes. 
Processes for Engaging with Our 
People
S1-2 – Processes for engaging with own workforce and 
workers’ representatives about impacts
As previously outlined, our people's perspectives and 
interests play a vital role in identifying material impacts, 
risks, and opportunities for our organisation. Responsibility 
for Kerry’s overall employee engagement strategy and 
standards rests with the CHRO, while our Executive 
Leadership Team (ELT) holds responsibility for executing 
our employee engagement approach. Additionally, our 
designated Workforce Engagement Director plays a key 
role at Board level, ensuring employee perspectives are 
integrated into high-level decision-making.
People Engagement Mechanisms
We employ multiple approaches to ensure the voices of 
our employees and non-employee workers throughout 
our organisation are heard and considered in our 
decision-making. Our approach includes the following key 
mechanisms: 
•	 Kerry’s employee experience survey;
•	 Regular town hall meetings;
•	 Ongoing two-way engagement through our employee 
representative groups; 
•	 Our people health and safety governance forums; and
•	 A Designated Workforce Engagement Non-Executive 
Board Director. 
Kerry’s Employee Experience Survey
Kerry’s employee experience survey, OurVoice, 
regularly assesses our employee engagement and 
collects feedback on employee experience across a 
range of dimensions including Safety, Rewards, Talent 
Development and Manager Effectiveness. Participation in 
Kerry’s OurVoice employee experience survey continues 
to be high, with a 93% participation level in our most 
recent survey in April 2024. As part of this survey in 
2024, we also asked employees to share information on 
disability and ethnicity on a voluntary basis in order to 
gain further insights. Following our employee experience 
survey and follow-up listening sessions together with 
employees, we identified engagement initiatives by 
function and individual team. These are progressed 
to completion per agreed timelines with ongoing 
communication on progress through our ‘Making it better, 
clearer and easier’ campaign.
Regular Town Hall Meetings
We hold regular town hall meetings at both regional 
and local site level, providing dedicated forums for open 
communication, sharing business updates and reinforcing 
key messages such as the importance of safety within the 
organisation. These forums also provide opportunities 
for employees to raise questions and suggestions with 
leadership team members. In addition, as part of ongoing 
communication and social dialogue at regional and site 
level, we engage with the European Employee Forum 
(EEF), works councils, trade unions and other employee 
representative groups across our business.   
Ongoing Two-Way Engagement through our 
Employee Representative Groups
As one example of ongoing two-way engagement, 
our DI&B Global Taskforce, established in 2024, brings 
together representatives from our leadership and 
employee base from across different functions, Regional 
DI&B Committees and our global employee network 
groups. This taskforce enables us to showcase and 
promote understanding of the value of diversity and 
inclusion in Kerry. This taskforce also plays a key role in 
raising awareness of and celebrating our achievements 
at local level through events to mark and celebrate 
several World Days, including International Women’s Day, 
World Day for Cultural Diversity for Dialogue, Pride, and 
International Day for People with Disabilities.
Our People Health and Safety Governance Forums
To support safety engagement and foster a proactive 
safety culture amongst our people, all manufacturing 
locations are required to have a Health and Safety 
committee. This is chaired by the Plant Leader and 
is required to have an equal representation from 
management and non-management employees, as well 
as both union and non-union employees. The committee 
meetings are held regularly as a requirement. Each 
Health and Safety committee is responsible for local 
adherence to our ‘eight LIFE saving rules’, created with the 
purpose of preventing life changing injuries and fatalities. 
Deployment toolkits are available in local languages 
for use at Kerry locations, including posters, banners, 
commitment boards and training materials. In addition, 
our 'Eye for Safety' commitment statement which 
summarises how we deliver on our commitment to our 
Safety First, Quality Always guiding principle is displayed 
in local languages in Kerry locations. World Day for Safety 
& Health at Work is celebrated over a week every April, in 
2024 the theme was ‘My Safety is Your Safety’ to continue 
to build mindset and awareness around safety being 
everyone’s responsibility.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
192
193
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
A Designated Workforce Engagement Non-
Executive Board Director 
In line with the UK Corporate Governance code, we 
have a designated Non-Executive Director in the role 
of Workforce Engagement Director. The role of the 
designated Workforce Engagement Director is to 
amplify and represent the voice of employees in Board 
discussions and to actively engage with a range of 
employees through various workplace activities. This 
approach enables the Board to gain deeper insights into 
the workforce’s perspectives, supporting more informed 
discussions and decision-making. In 2024, Emer Gilvarry 
succeeded Dr. Karin Dorrepaal as Kerry’s designated 
Workforce Engagement Director upon Dr. Dorrepaal’s 
retirement from the Board of Directors. During the year 
our Workforce Engagement Director participated in and 
reflected on numerous events, including manufacturing 
and office site visits, and participation in our global 
Commercial Conference in Beloit, Wisconsin, our Kerry 
Inspiring People Recognition Awards ceremony, and 
various Culture Week initiatives.
To ensure that our peoples’ perspectives were 
represented in our double materiality assessment, we 
involved employee representatives from key functional 
areas, together with representatives from our HR 
function, in the assessment process. Their views and 
perspectives were a crucial input in determining the 
impact of Kerry on sustainability matters and the impact 
of sustainability matters on Kerry. For details on our 
two-way employee engagement approach, refer to pages 
138-139 of the Stakeholder Engagement section. 
Employee Support Channels
S1-3 – Processes to remediate negative impacts and 
channels for own workforce to raise concerns
Kerry strives to create an environment where open and 
honest communications are the expectation, not the 
exception. We want our people to feel comfortable in 
approaching their line manager, a senior manager, a HR 
Partner, our Ethics and Compliance team or in utilising 
our systems to report where they believe potential 
violations of our Code of Conduct, policies, regulations, 
industry standards or applicable laws have occurred.  
To support our employees globally we provide access to 
an Employee Assistance Programme (EAP), offering an 
additional confidential support mechanism for employees 
to discuss and gain advice on issues relating to their 
working and/or personal life.
Kerry’s AskHR platform (available internally to employees 
in 18 languages) allows our employees to log their 
concerns or incidents. In addition, Kerry’s independent 
Speak Up platform (available as a website and hotline 
to employees and third-parties 24 hours a day, seven 
days a week in over 99 languages) enables them to 
report concerns confidentially, safely, and anonymously 
(where permitted by local laws). We track any reported 
complaints, ensuring that they are investigated in line 
with established processes, and appropriate action taken 
where complaints are substantiated.   
All reports received to the Speak Up platform are 
reviewed by Kerry’s Ethics and Compliance team and 
are treated promptly and confidentially. The Speak Up 
programme is overseen by Kerry’s Business Integrity 
and Legal Operations Director, who reports directly into 
the General Counsel, an executive-led Business Integrity 
Committee and the Audit Committee of the Board. 
Updates are provided on the Speak Up programme and 
activity throughout the year.   
As per Kerry’s Speak Up Policy (available on kerry.com), 
Kerry does not tolerate retaliation against those who 
speak up in good faith in relation to potential, perceived 
or actual wrongdoing, no matter what channel they 
use to speak up. We seek to provide a safe, healthy and 
productive workplace for our people and our business 
partners who assist us in our business operations.   
All employees receive specific Speak Up training 
and regular communications about the Speak Up 
platform and how to report concerns; furthermore, this 
information is also incorporated in other trainings and 
company policies.  
An effective reporting system supports and enhances our 
efforts to foster a culture of integrity and ethical decision-
making. By creating open channels of communication, 
we promote a positive work environment and maximise 
productivity.
5. Actions
S1-4 – Taking action on material impacts on own 
workforce, and approaches to managing material risks and 
pursuing material opportunities related to own workforce, 
and effectiveness of those actions
Kerry has processes in place to manage workforce-
related impacts, with planned and budgeted initiatives 
to advance our policy objectives and achieve our 
organisational targets for DI&B and our role as a 
responsible employer. We monitor the efficacy of these 
actions through selected metrics that align with our policy 
commitments and targets. For more details please refer 
to the 7. Metrics section on pages 197-199. Additionally, 
Kerry is committed to promoting the welfare of our 
people and to ensuring that human rights are respected 
and upheld throughout our operations. For more 
information on our policies in this area, please refer to 
section 3. Policies on pages 189-190. For actions disclosed 
in this section, the specified location of the actions across 
our value chain reflects where the impacts arise. We 
acknowledge that Kerry initiates these activities from 
within our own operations.
Responsible Employer Action Plans
Health, Safety and Wellbeing 
To avoid contributing to material negative impacts, 
Kerry locations implement a comprehensive global 
Environmental, Health & Safety (EHS) management 
system, which defines responsibilities and accountabilities 
at all levels. This system is underpinned by our health 
and safety ambition and enables full engagement and 
support for our health and safety programmes and 
initiatives. It also provides a method for our people to 
play an active role in promoting a safe working environment through recording observations around potentially unsafe 
conditions and behaviour. We have processes to review and monitor locally relevant health and safety regulations 
(incorporated as part of the EHS Management system), including taking into consideration impacts on the design and 
modification of local equipment, processes, materials, products, and procedures based on these reviews. Based on risk, 
our LIFE programme, which sits within the management system, is primarily focused on our manufacturing locations 
due to the nature of activities taking place in these locations.
Placing a high priority on the health and wellbeing of our employees, Kerry offers a balanced set of programmes under 
its Health and Wellbeing Framework, including a Global EAP and a Global Sabbatical Leave Policy. These programmes 
provide resources and promote physical, emotional, nutritional, and financial wellbeing for employees at various life 
stages. Our engagement in global initiatives like World Safety and Wellbeing Day and World Mental Health Awareness 
Day helps to highlight the further support available to our people and their families.
In 2024, we took the following key actions to progress our health, safety and wellbeing-related policy objectives 
and targets. 
Actual 
Negative 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Health, 
Safety  
and 
Wellbeing
We reinforced our commitment to health and safety for our people by launching the Global Safety 
Guardians programme alongside comprehensive toolkits. These resources aim to raise safety 
standards, track leading indicators, and implement proactive strategies to manage safety and reduce 
risk.
Kerry recognises that in order for our colleagues to be at their best and deliver superior performance, 
they need an environment that helps them lead balanced lives. In 2024, we launched a pilot 
programme covering emotional wellbeing training for a cohort of our people leaders, reinforcing our 
commitment to promoting work-life balance and supporting employee wellbeing for our people.
We recognise that health, safety and wellbeing-related impacts require continuous monitoring and proactive 
management to protect our people and maintain a safe working environment. To achieve this, we have developed a 
robust plan.
Actual 
Negative 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Health, 
Safety and 
Wellbeing
Building on the success of the 2024 pilot programme, Kerry will roll out the 
emotional wellbeing training for people leaders to all regions. This programme 
supports work-life balance and reinforces our commitment to our people’s 
wellbeing, equipping people leaders with tools to foster a balanced and 
supportive environment1.
Conduct a safety perception survey to capture employees’ perspectives on 
current safety practices. Following the analysis of the survey results, we will 
implement targeted plans to address key findings1.
Develop programmes to enhance environmental, health & safety (EHS) 
awareness at leadership levels1.
Develop additional priority standards to strengthen Kerry’s Global EHS 
Management System1.
1Affected stakeholders include our people. 
Working Conditions and Labour Law Compliance 
Total Reward at Kerry is informed by our principles of fairness and equitability and extends beyond pay and financial 
incentives to encompass career development, personal growth, opportunities and recognition for the contribution of 
employees. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
194
195
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
In 2024, we took the following key actions to progress our responsible employer-related policy objectives and targets: 
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Working 
Conditions 
and Labour 
Law 
Compliance
Throughout 2024, we partnered closely with the Global Fair Wage Network to develop our Living 
Wage strategy, building on our current certification and experience in the UK where we have been an 
accredited Living Wage Employer since April 2023.
The Global Fair Wage Network conducted an assessment of our living wage position across all Kerry’s 
locations. Based on this analysis we have established a Living Wage roadmap to achieve Living Wage 
coverage across all regions.
The Executive Leadership Team honoured our 2024 Inspiring People winners and presented a 
recognition award to Kerry’s 12,000 frontline operators across 130 manufacturing sites worldwide. This 
award highlights the critical role these operators play in supporting our vision of becoming the most 
valued partner for customers and promoting sustainable nutrition. In recognition of their contributions, 
Kerry authorised an additional day of paid annual leave in 2024 for all frontline operators.
Building on the success of our employee share plan OurShare in 2023, we expanded the plan to a 
further 16 countries. This plan allows employees to become shareholders in the organisation, fostering 
a stronger sense of ownership and engagement. The OurShare plan is currently available to 94% of 
employees across 24 countries. 
We are proud of our achievements to date and recognise that there is still more to do to strengthen working conditions 
and impacts related to labour law compliance.
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Working 
Conditions  
and Labour 
Law 
Compliance
Leveraging our Living Wage roadmap, we will achieve full Living Wage  
coverage in Europe and North America in 2025, followed by LATAM and  
APMEA thereafter.
Building on the success of the 2024 OurShare Phase 2 expansion, plans are well 
underway in preparation for our Phase 3 roll-out. During 2025, we will extend the 
plan to the majority of countries in which we operate. 
Employee Attraction, Retention and Development
At Kerry, we recognise the critical importance of leadership development and learning and development in driving 
organisational success. Our approach focuses on continuous improvement, structured talent development, and 
alignment with Kerry’s strategic priorities. We understand the unique influence of our people leaders in driving both 
performance and engagement. Our learning and development strategy also focuses on enhancing core capabilities 
through five key priorities: customer centricity, science & technology, innovation, automation & efficiency, and digital 
& analytics. By focusing on these areas, we empower our people to drive sustainable business growth while enhancing 
their expertise to support their career ambitions.
These initiatives foster a culture of continuous learning and skills development aligned with Kerry’s strategic priorities. 
In 2024, we took the following key actions to progress towards the achievement of our responsible employer-related 
policy objectives and targets. 
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Employee 
Attraction, 
Retention and 
Development 
In 2024, we launched a new learning platform for our Digital and Global Business Service teams, 
providing access to a curated library of courses. This initiative features the creation of targeted 
learning paths, enabling these employees to deepen their expertise and align their skills development 
with their career objectives.
The following future-orientated actions will progress our employee attraction, retention and development-related impacts.
Actual  
Positive 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Employee 
Attraction, 
Retention and 
Development
Our new learning platform will be extended to all functions and relevant roles 
providing access to curated courses. Learning paths will be developed for all 
functions across Kerry’s business1.
Early career development programmes, which currently attract graduates in 
Europe and North America, will be expanded to other key regions in which 
Kerry operates.
1Affected stakeholders include employees globally.
Diversity, Inclusion & Belonging Action Plans
At Kerry, we value the unique contributions of employees with varied perspectives and backgrounds. This enhances 
creativity and innovation, enabling the organisation to develop solutions to business challenges and achieve Kerry’s 
sustainable nutrition goals. By working together we have achieved our target of women representing 35% of senior 
leadership roles a year earlier than planned.
To continue our progress in this area, Kerry is committed to integrating and reinforcing DI&B principles across all 
processes and practices whilst ensuring at all times that this is done in compliance with regional law and regulations. 
For further detail on our 2024 performance towards our gender representation goals see pages 199-200. 
The DI&B Global Taskforce is responsible for execution against the following key actions to further our DI&B related 
policy objectives and targets.
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Equal 
Opportunity 
and Fairness
Kerry launched a new Diversity, Inclusion, and Belonging Framework, outlining priorities to enhance 
inclusive leadership behaviours, promote equitable experiences for all employees, and improve 
education and awareness across all dimensions of diversity. 
Gender, Ethnic 
and Cultural 
Diversity
In 2024, recruitment practices were reviewed to ensure that all qualified candidates are objectively 
considered for executive and key roles, including ensuring appropriate involvement of diverse 
interview panels to mitigate and reduce bias in the selection process.
To support our target of increasing women in leadership roles, we implemented our Women in 
Leadership programme in Europe and LATAM. The objective of this programme is to accelerate 
female talent to build a more sustainable and balanced organisation. This is achieved by enhancing 
participants’ leadership skills through action learning processes, knowledge of how to create 
cultures of equality in their own spheres of responsibility and how to inspire other female leaders, as 
examples of programmatic activities.
We have made strong progress but are ambitious to further our diversity, inclusion and belonging-related impacts. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
196
197
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Equal 
Opportunity 
and Fairness
Kerry has developed a plan to improve Equal Opportunity & Fairness practices. 
This initiative seeks to gain deeper insights into workforce diversity and ensure 
merit based workforce opportunities for all employees.
Gender, Ethnic 
and Cultural 
Diversity
Design and implement an executive leadership development programme 
which continues to reinforce the importance of inclusive leadership.
We will continue to rollout a number of DI&B training programmes to other 
regions, whilst ensuring compliance with regional law and regulations.
For both material topics, we have reviewed the effectiveness of the key actions taken in 2024, together with our metrics’ 
performance and will carry forward the lessons learned as we execute the delivery of our short-term actions in 2025 
and conduct further planning for our medium-term actions thereafter.
6. Targets1
S1-5 – Targets related to managing material negative impacts, advancing positive impacts, and managing material risks and 
opportunities
Diversity of Our Employees
At Kerry, we are committed to mirroring the communities we serve globally. We embrace differences and are dedicated 
to fostering an inclusive environment that empowers all employees to actively contribute. Our people deserve a safe and 
supportive workplace, where they can grow professionally and have platforms to express their perspectives, such as through 
our employee experience surveys and network groups.
Target
Our social targets are integral to our Beyond the Horizon strategy and continue to accelerate our journey towards 
building and sustaining a highly inclusive workplace at Kerry. Gender representation continues to be an important 
underlying indicator of our ongoing progress across our broader DI&B strategy and we continue to assess our 
approach to ensure continued compliance with all applicable law and regulations in the locations in which we operate. 
There have been no changes to our target during the current or preceding period.
We are committed to achieving 35% representation of women in senior leadership roles by the end of 2025 and reaching 
equal gender representation in senior management by the end of 2030, whilst ensuring we remain in compliance with 
applicable law and regulations in the regions in which we operate. Kerry has defined our senior management group and 
this is Kerry’s equivalent of the ‘top management’ term under ESRS. Our representation targets are measured in relative 
terms, with the senior leadership target representing 35% of all senior leadership positions filled by women, and the senior 
management target aiming for a 50/50 gender balance, to the extent permitted by law. Progress toward these targets 
will be monitored and reported annually. For more information on the methodology, definitions and assumptions used to 
calculate the respective metrics, please refer to the Diversity of our Employees S1-9 metric disclosure on page 199.
Progress and Achievements
We continue to see positive momentum in terms of increasing female representation at both senior leadership  
and management levels. At the end of 2024, women held 35% (2023β: 34%) of senior leadership roles and 39% 
(2023β: 37%) of our senior management roles. Our commitment to achieve our gender targets, conducting 
strategic talent and succession reviews, and supporting employee-led initiatives and external partnerships is 
driving improved outcomes.
During 2023, we engaged in an independent review of our DI&B progress to date, involving representatives from 
different functions, businesses and from all levels of the organisation as well as referencing external research and 
best practices. The objective of this review was to help inform our focus moving forward. Our Global DI&B Council 
have spent significant time understanding our strengths and identifying key opportunities for accelerating our 
progress, ensuring this reflects the voice of our people and benefits from external inputs, to collectively agree 
prioritised actions from 2024 onwards, see the future action plans disclosed above for more details.
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
Our Inclusion Index allows us to understand employee perception across important externally validated 
dimensions of inclusion: Psychological Safety, Belonging, Fair Treatment, Inclusion and Integrating Difference. 
In 2024, we scored in the third quartile, reporting an increase of four percentage points within the third 
quartile from the previous year, reinforcing our confidence in the approach we are taking to building and 
sustaining a truly inclusive workplace globally.
Health and Safety
A safe and healthy workplace is a fundamental priority for Kerry. It is a basic employee right and we have a 
responsibility to protect our people, and ensure their wellbeing, both physically and mentally.
Every day, we focus on our culture of safety and our safety performance is an ongoing priority. Safety First, Quality 
Always is our guiding principle and our commitment of never compromising on the safety of our people, or the 
quality and safety of our products  has become a proactive mindset in our operations. 
Target
In alignment with our strategic objectives and in consultation with our employee representatives, we set a Total 
Incident Rate (TIR) target of less than five for the end of the 2025 financial year. For more information on the 
methodology and assumptions used to calculate the TIR and related health and safety metrics, please refer to our 
Health and Safety S1-14 metric disclosure on page 203.
This target aligns with our broader policy goals of being committed to continuous improvement in providing a safe and 
healthy workplace for our people. 
Progress and Achievements
The actions taken have delivered a TIR performance of 4.5 (2023β: 4.8) when calculated based on 1,000,000 hours. 
Looking ahead, we remain dedicated to continuous improvement and will outline a new target for the 2025 
financial year.
Everyone has a role to play in our health and safety ambition, so our approach to safety starts with our people. Much of 
our strategy is centred around training and upskilling, ensuring our people have the skills and capabilities they need to 
feel empowered, to lead by example and to challenge unsafe conditions and behaviours using our Speak Up channel, 
which is available on our website.
7. Metrics1
Our Employee Profile
S1-6 – Characteristics of the undertaking’s employees
This section provides details of our people, including the total headcount with gender, regional and country 
breakdowns. Details of contract type and gender and employee turnover during the reporting period are also 
disclosed. 
Employee data is reported based on headcount as at 31 December, as recorded in our central HR system. The figures 
below include Kerry employees and exclude non-employee workers. See note S1-7 for details of non-employees in our 
own workforce on page 200.
For corresponding information in our Financial Statements relating to our headcount, see note 4 on page 266 which 
presents headcount as an average.
Employee Headcount by Gender
Gender
2024
2023β
Female
7,205
6,970
Male
14,522
14,431
Other*
-  
2
Not Disclosed
1
- 
Total Employees
21,728
21,403
*Gender as specified by the employees themselves.
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
198
199
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
On 31 December 2024, the Group completed the sale of the Kerry Dairy Ireland business. If employee figures for that 
business were excluded from the Employee Headcount by Gender table, the employee headcount would be 6,828 
female, 13,300 male and 1 not disclosed.
Employee Headcount by Gender and Contract Type
2024
Female
Male
Other*
Not 
Disclosed
Total
Number of employees
7,205
14,522
-  
1
21,728
Number of permanent employees
6,922
14,077
-  
1
21,000
Number of temporary employees
283
445
-  
-  
728
Number of non-guaranteed hours employees
- 
- 
- 
- 
- 
Number of full-time employees
7,023
14,437
-  
1
21,461
Number of part-time employees
182
85
-
-
267
*Gender as specified by the employees themselves.
2023β
Female
Male
Other*
Not 
Disclosed
Total
Number of employees
6,970
 14,431
2
-
 21,403
Number of permanent employees
6,780
13,587
2
-
20,369
Number of temporary employees
190
844
- 
- 
1,034
Number of non-guaranteed hours employees
- 
- 
- 
- 
- 
Number of full-time employees
6,789
14,284
2
-
21,075
Number of part-time employees
181
147
- 
- 
328
*Gender as specified by the employees themselves.
Employee Headcount by Contract Type and Region
2024
Europe
Americas
APMEA
Total
Number of employees
6,021
9,468
6,239
21,728
Number of permanent employees
5,781
9,284
5,935
21,000
Number of temporary employees
240
184
304
728
Number of non-guaranteed hours employees
 -
 -
 -
                    - 
Number of full-time employees
5,788
9,440
6,233
21,461
Number of part-time employees
233
28
6
267
If employee figures for the Kerry Dairy Ireland business were excluded from the Employee Headcount by Contract Type 
and Region table above, the total number of employees in Europe would be 4,424.
2023β
Europe
Americas
APMEA
Total
Number of employees
6,123
9,164
6,116
21,403
Number of permanent employees
5,882
9,039
5,448
20,369
Number of temporary employees
241
125
668
1,034
Number of non-guaranteed hours employees
-
-
-
-
Number of full-time employees
5,891
9,134
6,050
21,075
Number of part-time employees
232
30
66
328
Methodology and Key Assumptions 
Permanent employees include those full-time and part-
time employees on permanent contracts. Where there 
are specific country legislations or country practices, 
contracts will be considered permanent accordingly.
Temporary employees include those full-time and part-
time employees on fixed-term contracts or specified 
purpose contracts.
Non-guaranteed hours employees are those with zero 
contracted weekly hours. Kerry has no employees with 
zero contracted hours. 
Full-time employees are those whose standard weekly 
hours and contract weekly hours per week are equal.
Part-time employees are those whose standard weekly 
hours and contract weekly hours vary.
Employee Headcount by Country
This table displays all countries in which Kerry has 
employees representing at least 10% of our total workforce.
Country
2024
2023β
United States
5,009
4,929
Republic of Ireland 
2,290
2,267
Malaysia
2,213
2,182
Total Headcount
9,512
9,378
On 31 December 2024, the Group completed the sale 
of the Kerry Dairy Ireland business. If employee figures 
for that business were excluded from the Employee 
Headcount by Country table, the Republic of Ireland 
would not meet the threshold for disclosure.
Employee Turnover
Our employee turnover in 2024 was 4,332 (2023β: 4,436) 
employees representing an annual employee turnover 
rate of 20.6% (2023β: 21.8%). 
Employee turnover is defined as the number of 
permanent employees who leave voluntarily or due to 
dismissal, retirement, or death in service during the year. 
Employees who leave voluntarily are those who resign 
or retire. At Kerry, dismissal is defined as an employee 
contract being terminated based on underperformance, 
misconduct, redundancy, restructuring or compromise 
agreement.
Employee turnover rate is defined as the number of 
permanent employees who left the company voluntarily, 
or due to dismissal, retirement, or death in service during 
the year divided by the number of permanent employees 
at year end, multiplied by 100.
Note that the 2023 comparative figures, as disclosed have 
been revised to align with the employee turnover and 
rate definitions above. Employee turnover and rate were 
defined in our 2023 external reporting as the number of 
permanent employees who left voluntarily divided by the 
number of permanent employees at year end, multiplied 
by 100.
Diversity of our Employees
S1-9 – Diversity Metrics
We continue to see positive momentum towards our 
goal of building a representative organisation. Women 
represent 35% (2023β: 34%) of our senior leadership 
roles and 39% (2023β: 37%) of our senior management. 
If employee figures for the Kerry Dairy Ireland business 
were excluded, there is no change to the percentage 
of women represented, as disclosed, for both metrics. 
As outlined in our Targets section on page 196, 
Kerry remains committed to achieving equal gender 
representation among senior management roles by 2030, 
with women representing 35% of senior leadership roles 
by 2025, subject to compliance with law and regulations 
in the regions in which we operate. 
Senior management encompasses approximately the 
top 1,500 employees. Senior leadership encompasses 
approximately the top 450 employees.
As referenced in our General section (page 134), for 
information in relation to the composition, experience 
and diversity of our Board of Directors, please see our 
Directors’ Report on pages 61 and 94. 
The tables below summarise the gender distribution 
of Kerry’s global senior management and the age 
distribution among all Kerry employees as at 31 
December. See note S1-6, on page 197, for details of the 
gender distribution for all Kerry employees. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
200
201
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
Gender Distribution Senior Management
2024 
Number
2024 
Percentage
2023β 
Number
2023β 
Percentage
Female
569
39%
536 
37%
Male
874
61%
895
63%
Other*
-
-
- 
0%
Not Disclosed
-
-
-
0%
Total 
1,443
100%
1,431 
100%
*Gender as specified by the employees themselves.
Age Distribution All Employees 
2024 
Number
2024 
Percentage
2023β 
Number
2023β 
Percentage
Under 30 years old
4,357
20%
4,274 
20%
30 - 50 years old
12,599
58%
12,747 
60%
Over 50 years old 
4,772
22%
4,382 
20%
Total 
21,728
100%
21,403 
100%
Non-employees in our Workforce
S1-7 – Characteristics of non-employees in the undertaking’s own workforce
In 2024, there was an average of 1,339 non-employees in Kerry’s own workforce. Non-employees are defined as all 
individuals who are not contractual employees of the Group but are engaged to perform activities on behalf of Kerry, 
including temporary workers employed through labour agencies or self-employed individuals who are contracted to 
provide work to Kerry as a non-employee. 
The total number of non-employees is reported based on full-time equivalents (FTEs). FTE data is calculated as actual 
hours worked divided by standard hours (standard hours is 40 hours per week) multiplied by the number of weeks in a 
month for the fiscal calendar. Non-employee data is reported based on data recorded in our central system of record.
This is the first year we have reported this metric. 2024 is deemed to be representative of a standard year in relation to the 
numbers of non-employees in our own workforce.
Collective Bargaining Coverage and Social Dialogue​
S1-8 – Collective bargaining coverage and social dialogue
At Kerry, we respect our employees’ right to form, join or not join a labour union, or a trade union or to have recognised 
employee representation in accordance with local law without fear of reprisal, intimidation, harassment, or discrimination. 
Collective Bargaining Agreements (CBA) can be negotiated at group, regional or country level. 
As at the end of 2024, 30% (2023β: 30%) of all Kerry employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements. For those 
employees not part of a collective bargaining agreement, we have a formal pay planning process in all locations covering 
terms and conditions for all employees. This table displays the CBA coverage rate in percentage terms for all Kerry 
employees in the European Economic Area (EEA) and non-EEA and the percentage of workplace representation for the EEA 
only, for countries and regions in which Kerry has employees representing at least 10% of our total workforce.
Collective Bargaining Coverage and Social Dialogue
2024
                  Collective Bargaining Coverage
Social dialogue
Coverage Rate
Employees – EEA 
(Country)
Employees – Non-EEA 
(Region)
Workplace 
representation - 
EEA only (Country)
0-19%
-
APMEA
-
20-39%
Republic of Ireland
Americas
-
40-59%
-
-
-
60-79%
-
-
-
80-100%
-
-
Republic of Ireland
On 31 December 2024, the Group completed the sale of the Kerry Dairy Ireland business. If employee figures for that 
business were excluded from the analysis in this table, the Republic of Ireland would not be disclosed for Collective 
Bargaining Coverage and Social Dialogue, as presented, respectively.
Social Dialogue
The Kerry European Employees Forum (EEF) was established by Kerry to enable social dialogue at a European level. This 
forum respects Irish regulations which are aligned with the European Works Councils Directives. In addition to this, we 
have local Works Council and Trade Union representation across multiple Kerry locations, which provides for ongoing 
social dialogue, including collective bargaining at company, sector or cross-industry level.   
Adequate Wages
S1-10 – Adequate Wages
At Kerry, we are committed to achieving and sustaining 
pay equity through education, awareness, and 
comprehensive analysis. Our approach is underpinned 
by robust policies and governance frameworks, ensuring 
alignment with our reward philosophy and adherence 
to best practices in corporate governance. Our reward 
philosophy supports us in striving to be the first choice 
for the best talent by providing fair, transparent, and 
competitive offerings that our employees value and that 
drive an ownership mindset to achieve Kerry’s goals. 
During 2024, Kerry's own employees, as described in S1-6 
on page 197, were paid an adequate wage.
To ensure that our own employees receive an adequate 
wage, Kerry has compared actual pay to local minimum 
wage requirements on a country-by-country basis. 
Where a local statutory requirement does not exist, an 
appropriate alternative wage standard was identified as 
a benchmark for those countries. We engaged the Fair 
Wage Network, an independent third-party, to supply 
these alternative wage standards. 
Key Assumptions 
The payroll data used for comparison of pay levels was 
base salary, fixed allowances and variable pay while 
payments related to overtime were excluded. The payroll 
data, for base pay and any fixed allowances, was an 
annualised figure based on May, which incorporated the 
latest annual salary adjustments occurring every March  
as part of our annual pay planning review cycle. 
Social Protection
S1-11 – Social protection 
Kerry's policies and processes ensure that we, at the very 
least, comply with social protection requirements in all 
locations. Kerry provides coverage to all own employees 
for social protection through public programmes or 
through benefits offered by Kerry, against loss of income 
due to any of the following circumstances: 
1.	 Sickness;
2.	 Unemployment starting from when the own worker is 
working for the undertaking;
3.	 Employment injury and acquired disability;
4.	 Parental leave; and
5.	 Retirement.
Our reward programmes are tailored to meet the specific 
needs of each location, offering a wide range of retirement 
and protection benefits. These programmes, supported 
by either government or company initiatives, are designed 
to protect the wellbeing of our employees and their 
families. The scope and structure of these benefits differ 
by location, informed by local market insights, government 
provisions, and other factors such as workforce size.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
202
203
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
Remuneration
S1-16 – Remuneration metrics (pay gap and total 
remuneration)
As part of our commitment to diversity, inclusion, and 
belonging, we prioritise equal opportunity and fairness 
through merit-based advancement, equal pay, and 
inclusive hiring practices. We conduct regular reviews of 
pay equity, promotion, and workforce demographics to 
ensure our policies consistently promote fairness and 
inclusivity. We have invested in education, awareness 
and analysis on pay equity and continue to evolve and 
iterate our underlying processes and practices to reflect 
our reward philosophy and best corporate governance 
practices.
Gender Pay Gap
The gender pay gap for 2024 is favourable to female 
employees by 4.8%. The gender pay gap is calculated 
by comparing the average pay levels between female 
and male employees, expressed as a percentage of the 
average pay level of male employees.
Total Remuneration - CEO : Median Employee
The annual total remuneration ratio for 2024 is 118x. 
The annual total remuneration ratio is calculated by 
comparing the CEO's remuneration (highest paid 
individual) to the median annual total remuneration for 
all Kerry's own employees (excluding the CEO).
A significant portion of the CEO’s remuneration is 
delivered through Kerry’s short-term and long-term 
incentive plans where awards are linked to Group 
performance and share price movements over time. This 
means that ratios will depend significantly on short-term 
and long-term incentive outturns and may fluctuate from 
year to year as a result. As the median employee does 
not typically participate in Kerry’s short-term or long-term 
performance-related incentive plans, the ratio has also 
been calculated to exclude these variable pay elements 
which results in a ratio of 39x.
Key Assumptions 
The payroll data used for comparison of pay levels was 
base salary, fixed allowances and variable pay while 
payments related to overtime were excluded. The payroll 
data, for base pay and any fixed allowances, was an 
annualised figure based on May, which incorporated the 
latest annual salary adjustments occurring every March 
as part of our annual pay planning review cycle. Variable 
pay was aggregated across a twelve-month period.
Training and Skills Development
S1-13 – Training and skills development metrics
Training Hours 
Our overall learning approach is focused on accelerating 
a culture of learning to enable and support individual and 
organisational growth. At Kerry, we have implemented 
the 70:20:10 learning model meaning that approximately 
70% of our learning and development comes from job-
related experience, 20% comes from feedback, social 
interactions and working with others, and 10% from 
formal learning experiences.
We define formal learning experiences as planned 
activities designed to develop skills, knowledge or 
behaviours. This includes e-learning and other self-paced 
learning such as engagement with digital content. We 
include instructor-led training events conducted both 
online and/or in-person.
Our average number of recorded training hours for 
all employees of nine hours has increased year-on-
year (2023β: seven hours), see a split by gender in the 
following table. Average training hours are calculated 
as the total number of training hours completed by 
employees per gender category, divided by the total 
number of employees per gender category. 
Average Employee Training Hours by 
Gender
2024 
Hours
Female
9 
Male
9 
Other*
- 
Not Disclosed
11 
Average Number of Training Hours 
per employee
9 
*Gender as specified by the employees themselves.
Performance and Career Development Reviews 
Performance management and career development is a key part of the personal growth agenda at Kerry and a critical 
enabler for Kerry’s business performance and future growth.  
All employees participate in formal performance and career conversations. The following tables show the total 
participation rate. Of the total headcount, an online performance review process is available to 51% of employees and 
an online career development review process is available to 52% of employees. The outputs of these conversations are 
recorded centrally in our Global HR Information system. 
When participation is calculated for those employees for which online processes are available, 97% participated in 
performance reviews and 63% in career development reviews. See details of the participation by gender expressed as a 
percentage of all employees and those recorded in our online systemised process in the following table:
Employees who Participated in  
Performance Reviews
2024 
Participation based on 
Total Headcount2 
Percentage
2024 
Participation based on our 
Online Systemised Process3 
Percentage
Female
25% 
47%
Male
25% 
50%
Other1
-
-
Not Disclosed
-
-
Total
50% 
97%
Employees who Participated in  
Career Development Reviews
2024 
Participation based on 
Total Headcount2 
Percentage
2024 
Participation based on our 
Online Systemised Process3 
Percentage
Female
17%
33% 
Male
16% 
30% 
Other1
- 
-
Not Disclosed
-
-
Total
33% 
63%
1 Gender as specified by the employees themselves.
2 Participation in performance and career development reviews calculated by setting out the number of employees who participated in our 
annual performance and career development cycle recorded centrally in our Global HR Information system divided by the total number of 
employees.  
3 Participation in performance and career development reviews calculated by setting out the number of employees who participated in 
our annual performance and career development cycle recorded centrally in our Global HR Information system divided by the number of 
employees who have the ability to engage with the process online, being 51% and 52% of the total number of employees respectively.
Health and Safety
S1-14 – Health and safety metrics 
At Kerry, we work diligently to drive a culture of safety at work, and we strive for zero harm. We foster a Safety First, 
Quality Always culture within the organisation, and through targeted communication, workshops, and various 
leadership initiatives, we have seen further improvement in health and safety outcomes in 2024. Our EHS based 
approach is subject to internal audit and covers 100% of our people.
During 2024, we sadly lost a Kerry colleague (employee) to a workplace fatality (2023β: one employee) at one of 
our manufacturing facilities. We extend our deepest sympathy to their family, friends and colleagues. A full and 
comprehensive investigation was immediately initiated following the accident. This investigation involved Kerry 
teams working in close partnership with all relevant third-party authorities and external experts. Learnings from this 
investigation have been shared across our manufacturing network. Our determination to uphold a safe and secure 
working environment has been further reinforced. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
204
205
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Own Workforce (S1)
Work-Related Injuries and Ill Health
The following table outlines our data in relation to 
work-related injuries and ill health. Work-related 
injuries includes but is not limited to, bruising, cuts and 
lacerations, burns, muscle pulls/strains (ergonomic 
related), fractures and/or contact with chemicals. Work-
related ill health includes diseases caused by chemical 
and physical agents, biological agents and infectious 
or parasitic diseases, respiratory and skin diseases, 
musculoskeletal disorders, mental and behavioural 
disorders, occupational cancer and other occupational 
diseases as listed in the ILO list of Occupational Diseases. 
Total recordable injuries and ill-health are captured 
according to the Occupational Safety and Health 
Administration (OSHA) definition.  
Figures include Kerry employees and non-employees. 
Calculations are based on 1,000,000 hours and 
46,398,729 total hours in 2024 (2023β: 46,777,468). Note 
that the 2023 rate calculations, as disclosed, have been 
revised to be based on 1,000,000 hours as required. Rate 
calculations disclosed in our 2023 external reporting were 
based on 200,000 hours. 
TIR for our own workforce combines work-related injuries 
and ill health.
Unit
2024
2023β
Total work-related injuries/accidents ¹ ⁴
Number
208
221
Employees
Number
195
208
Non-employees
Number
13
13
Total work-related injuries/accidents rate ²
Injuries per million hours worked
4.5
4.7
Employees
Injuries per million hours worked
4.5
4.8
Non-employees
Injuries per million hours worked
4.6
3.9
Total work-related ill health ³
Number
-
2
Employees
Number
-
2
Non-employees
Number
-
-
Total work-related ill health rate ³
Injuries per million hours worked
-
0.1
Employees
Injuries per million hours worked
-
0.1
Non-employees
Injuries per million hours worked
-
-
Lost days due to fatality, illness or injury from  
work-related injuries and ill health 4 5
Number
5,847
Employees
Number
5,698
Non-employees
Number
149
1 Work-related injuries/accidents include fatalities, lost time incidents, restricted cases and medical treatment cases (as per OSHA definitions) for 
more details refer to the 'Work-related Injuries and Ill health' disclosure on this page above. 
2 Total recordable injuries/accidents and ill health, according to the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) definition. 
Calculations are based on 1,000,000 hours.
3 Refer to the 'Work-related Injuries and Ill health' disclosure on this page above for details of what is captured and reported for work-related ill 
health.  
4 We only use personal information in accordance with the law. Our Employee Data Protection Policy outlines the types of personal data we 
hold about employees and may include information about health, including any medical conditions, health and sickness records. We have 
put in place appropriate security measures to prevent employee personal information from being accidentally lost, used or accessed in an 
unauthorised way, altered or disclosed.
5 Lost days refers to the total number of calendar days that were lost as a result of workplace injuries, illnesses or fatalities during the reporting 
period.  
Human Rights related Complaints 
S1-17 – Incidents, complaints and severe human rights impacts
This metric addresses work-related incidents, issues, complaints, and severe human rights impacts affecting our 
people as captured and managed through our AskHR and Speak Up systems, described on page 192. It encompasses 
issues reported by current Kerry employees as well as those raised by individuals linked to Kerry through our direct 
and indirect business relationships. This includes any incidents of discrimination based on gender, race or ethnicity, 
nationality, religion or belief, disability, age, sexual orientation, or other relevant factors involving both internal 
and external stakeholders during the reporting period. Additionally, it covers harassment as a distinct form of 
discrimination. Of the total incidents/complaints received, all 171 were reviewed and 91% have been closed following 
review and relevant action. In 2024, we had no severe human rights issues or incidents connected to our people.
Numerical Metric
2024
Number of incidents of discrimination, including harassment
56 
Number of complaints filed through channels for people in own workforce to raise concerns*
115 
Number of severe human rights issues and incidents connected to own workforce
- 
Number of severe human rights issues and incidents connected to own workforce that are cases of non-
respect of UN Guiding Principles and OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises
-
Number of severe human rights cases where undertaking played a role in securing remedy for those 
affected 
 -
*No complaints were filed to National Contact Points for OECD Multinational Enterprises.
Fines and Penalties
2024
Amount of fines, penalties, and compensation for damages as a result of incidents of discrimination, 
including harassment and complaints filed
-
Amount of fines, penalties, and compensation for severe human rights issues and incidents connected 
to own workforce
- 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
206
207
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Workers in the Value Chain (S2)
1. Material Impacts, Risks  
and Opportunities 
As part of Kerry’s double materiality assessment, we 
identified material impacts and risks relating to working 
conditions in the upstream value chain, as outlined in the 
table below. Our approach to determining these impacts 
and risks is described in the General section on pages 
140-141.
As part of our double materiality assessment, we 
defined the following short, medium and long-term time 
horizons:
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short-term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
Workers in the Value Chain 
(S2)
1. Material Impacts, Risks	
206 
and Opportunities
2. Strategy	
207
3. Policies	
208
4. Engagement Process	
208
5. Actions	
210
6. Targets and Metrics	
212
Working Conditions in the Upstream Value Chain 
Description ​
Time  
Horizon​
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Possible Human Rights Infringements  
Possible human rights infringements, particularly in 
higher-risk geographies.
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Enhancing Working Conditions Through Responsible 
Labour Practices in High-Risk Geographies 
Enhancing working conditions in geographies with poor 
labour laws by promoting responsible labour practices, 
fair wages, a safe working environment and providing 
support for representation and collective bargaining for 
workers in the upstream value chain.
Risk
Reputation and Legal Risk Due to Supplier  
Non-Conformance 
Potential risk to reputation and exposure to legal action 
arising from business relationships with suppliers that 
may breach worker’s rights and/or health and safety 
requirements.
Risk
Regulatory Risk Due to Supplier Non-Conformance  
Potential regulatory risk associated with supplier non-
compliance with human rights laws and expectations of 
stakeholders resulting in claims and/or fines.
1Own Ops = Own Operations
2. Strategy
ESRS 2 SBM-3 – Material impacts, risks and opportunities and 
their interaction with strategy and business model
How Our Material Impacts and  
Risks Shape Our Strategy and 
Business Model
Our material impacts and risks relating to working 
conditions and other work-related rights in the value 
chain are concentrated within our upstream value chain. 
Potentially impacted workers include those engaged 
in raw material processing and production, particularly 
in high-risk geographies. While our efforts and direct 
influence are largely on our supplier base, we also 
leverage industry collaborations and engagements with 
our suppliers who can influence our wider supply chain. 
The risks associated with negative impacts to working 
conditions in Kerry’s upstream value chain are managed 
through our human rights framework which incorporates 
our due diligence approach. For more details on Kerry’s 
commitment to human rights and our approach to 
managing related impacts and risks, please refer to our 
Human Rights Overview on page 186.
Our material impacts and risks relating to working 
conditions in the upstream value chain influence our 
strategy and business model in the following ways:
Possible Human Rights Infringements in 
High-Risk Geographies: 
We source a range of raw materials to produce value-
add ingredient solutions for customers and this range 
of sourcing may open our business model to potential 
negative impacts, including risks of forced, compulsory 
and child labour within our upstream value chain. These 
challenges can relate to wider issues within specific 
supply chains, such as poverty and inadequate regulatory 
oversight. Across our global sourcing footprint, there 
are geographies including Malaysia, India and Pakistan 
where we source key raw materials that are associated 
with a heightened risk of human rights infringements, 
as determined through our use of an independent risk 
assessment tool. Our human rights due diligence process, 
outlined in our Human Rights Overview on page 186, 
enables us to identify and mitigate against these risks.
Enhancing Working Conditions Through 
Responsible Labour Practices in High-Risk 
Geographies: 
At Kerry, we aim to make a positive impact through 
collaboration. Partnering with non-governmental 
organisations, local governments, and industry groups, 
we work to promote responsible sourcing and improve 
labour standards in high-risk geographies.  
Reputation, Legal and Regulatory Risk Due to 
Supplier Non-Conformance:
The complex nature of our global supply chain could 
potentially lead to reputational, legal, and/or regulatory 
risks arising from supplier non-conformance. Non-
conformance by suppliers, particularly in high-risk 
geographies where forced, compulsory or child labour 
may exist, could erode stakeholder trust, damage our 
brand reputation, and lead to significant legal and 
financial penalties.
Management of Impacts and Risks Relating 
to Upstream Value Chain Workers
At Kerry, we manage these risks through our human 
rights due diligence process which includes the following 
key aspects: 
Supplier Standards and Compliance:
•	 Our suppliers are required to adhere to our Supplier 
Code of Conduct, which details requirements on the 
provision of a safe working environment, free from 
child or forced labour, with reasonable working hours, 
fair wages, and which is free from discrimination, 
amongst other standards.  
Conformance Tracking: 
•	 We use a third-party platform, Sedex (Supplier Ethical 
Data Exchange), to manage information on our direct 
suppliers and their workers, to support our due 
diligence process in our upstream value chain. 
•	 Through Sedex, Kerry has access to the findings 
of social audits carried out using SMETA (Sedex 
Members Ethical Trade Audit) audits. These audits 
allow Kerry to evaluate the outcomes of supplier 
conformance with human rights standards, 
identify areas for improvement and monitor 
the implementation of corrective action where 
necessary, to manage and mitigate potential 
human rights risks and impacts in the upstream 
value chain. 
Training and Capability Building:
To increase our engagement with our suppliers in high-
risk countries, we provide targeted training to suppliers 
which covers:
•	 Our expectations of suppliers regarding their 
management of human rights; and
•	 Why and how to utilise Sedex’s SAQ (Self-
Assessment Questionnaire) and SMETA audits for 
improved engagement on human rights standards.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
208
209
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Workers in the Value Chain (S2)
3. Policies
S2-1 – Policies related to value chain workers
We recognise the vital role that workers in our 
upstream value chain play in achieving our purpose, 
vision, and values. We are committed to supporting 
these workers through a comprehensive set of policies 
and processes designed to uphold internationally 
recognised human rights. This policy applies to all 
suppliers and upstream business partners within our 
upstream value chain and covers all geographies in 
which Kerry conducts business.
Our Human Rights Policy 
Our Human Rights Policy outlines our commitment to 
upholding internationally recognised workers’ rights 
throughout our entire value chain. This section focuses 
on our policy’s commitments for our upstream value 
chain. We seek to safeguard the rights of those involved 
in the provision of goods and services we procure, in 
accordance with global human rights standards. Our 
Human Rights Policy is supported by our Supplier Code of 
Conduct.
We communicate our policies to relevant stakeholders 
and entities through multiple channels, including 
our website and annual report. The Supplier Code 
of Conduct is shared with existing suppliers and is 
provided to new suppliers as part of their onboarding 
process. It outlines clear expectations for suppliers to 
meet our standards, including provisions on worker 
safety, human trafficking, and the prohibition of 
forced, compulsory or child labour.
We are committed to respecting key internationally 
recognised guidelines and third-party standards. These 
include the United Nations (UN) Global Compact, UN 
SDGs, United Nations Guiding Principles on Business 
and Human Rights, OECD Guidelines for Multinational 
Enterprises on Responsible Business Conduct, ILO's 
Declaration on Fundamental Principles and Rights at Work, 
and others. These frameworks underpin the policy and our 
commitment to human rights throughout our entire value 
chain.  
The policy outlines our commitment to implementing 
the UN Guiding Principles and to respect human rights 
through ongoing human rights due diligence. Our policy 
explicitly addresses forced or compulsory labour and child 
labour. It also outlines key activities to address material 
impacts and risks related to salient human rights issues in 
our upstream value chain. 
We are committed to engaging with key stakeholders, 
including our employees, business partners, primary 
producers, and local communities to better understand 
our impacts and incorporate these perspectives into our 
business activities. Kerry is a member of a number of trade 
organisations and multi-stakeholder groups through which 
it engages with key stakeholders and interest groups.
We have grievance mechanisms in place to provide or 
enable remedies for human rights impacts. For further 
details on our grievance mechanisms, please refer to the 
following Engagement Process section.  
Kerry is committed to the continuous review and 
enhancement of our due diligence processes, and we are 
committed to reporting on actions taken to implement this 
policy and disclosing cases of severe non-respect of human 
rights connected to our upstream value chain. 
The CHRO and COO, who are members of the 
Executive Leadership Team, are jointly accountable 
for the implementation of our Human Rights Policy. 
Our Social Sustainability Council, supported by the 
Social Sustainability Working Group, oversees the 
protection of human rights across our value chain. 
This cross-functional working group is responsible for 
delivering on the Group’s human rights commitments, 
including the creation, administration, updating, and 
communication of related policies and training.
4. Engagement Process
Interests and Views of Upstream Value  
Chain Workers
ESRS 2 SBM-2 – Interests and views of stakeholders 
At Kerry, we are keen to understand how workers in the 
upstream value chain experience potential negative and 
potential positive impacts while working for our suppliers. 
This allows us to enrich how we support and engage with 
our supplier base, and the areas of focus for continuous 
improvement. We continue to increase our collaboration 
with multi-stakeholder groups to ensure we have the 
best tools, resources and knowledge needed to influence 
human rights in our suppliers, and further up the value 
chain to our suppliers’ suppliers.  
As part of our engagement processes, we utilise the 
SMETA audit programme to indirectly gather perspectives 
and views from workers in our upstream value chain. 
Value chain workers including those that may be 
deemed to be most at risk are interviewed as part 
of the programme. Our Procurement teams actively 
engage with new and existing suppliers that are located 
in high-risk countries. For details on how we identify 
suppliers in a high-risk country, refer to the 'Human 
Rights Management (Upstream Value Chain)' section of 
the Human Rights Overview on page 186. As part of our 
due diligence process we engage directly with suppliers, 
through their employee representatives, to support 
corrective actions identified through SMETA audits, 
as deemed relevant. Kerry also engages with multi-
stakeholder groups and industry bodies to gain insights 
on best practices, including those that can support 
strengthened remediation efforts.
Additionally, relevant stakeholders including upstream 
value chain representatives participated in Kerry’s 
double materiality assessment process, providing 
valuable perspectives and views on sustainability matters 
material to Kerry. For more details on Kerry’s stakeholder 
engagement approach, please refer to the Stakeholder 
Engagement section on pages 138-139.
Processes for Engagement with Upstream 
Value Chain Workers 
S2-2 – Processes for engaging with value chain workers 
about impacts
Our Executive Leadership Team supports Kerry’s 
engagement processes with upstream value chain 
workers by providing governance, resourcing and support 
through our CHRO and COO.
The Procurement team have day-to-day responsibility 
for engaging with upstream value chain partners who 
supply materials to our manufacturing facilities in line 
with our Supplier Requirements Manual and Supplier 
Code of Conduct. Core to these supplier requirements 
is upholding human rights and ensuring human rights 
abuses do not occur in the upstream value chain. Regular 
training is provided by the Responsible Sourcing team 
to both Procurement and our upstream value chain 
partners, to build capability on:  
•	 Our expectations for suppliers on human rights;
•	 The value of SMETA audit engagement for suppliers’ 
operations and human rights practices; and
•	 Our expectations of suppliers on Sedex and SMETA 
audit protocols.
These ongoing engagement initiatives play a crucial role 
in integrating human rights management into our core 
procurement business practices and allow for feedback 
from our suppliers.
The SMETA audit process, a key component of our human 
rights due diligence process, involves interviews with a 
representation of all workers including migrant workers, 
casual, temporary, seasonal workers, and women. These 
interviews explore critical issues such as workplace 
conditions, workers' access to legal documentation, 
discrimination (based on race, sex, disability and other 
issues). Insights gathered through this process are shared 
through the Sedex platform and reviewed by Kerry and 
play a vital role in shaping how we engage with suppliers 
to uphold human rights for workers in the value chain.
Kerry is a member of various trade organisations 
and multi-stakeholder platforms, fostering dialogue 
with key upstream value chain stakeholders and their 
representatives. Our involvement spans several industry 
initiatives, including the Roundtable on Sustainable 
Palm Oil (RSPO), Palm Oil Collaboration Group (POCG), 
Sustainable Agriculture Initiative (SAI), Sustainable Spices 
Initiative (SSI), and the Sustainable Vanilla Initiative (SVI). 
This comprehensive engagement strategy enables Kerry 
to better understand upstream value chain impacts and 
risks, as well as best practices for addressing them.  
Our approach for engaging with workers in our upstream 
value chain is designed to further a mutual understanding 
of human rights requirements with our suppliers and 
enhance their compliance. This engagement highlights 
the challenges and opportunities, informing actions for 
continuous improvement in our suppliers’ due diligence 
practices. For more details on Kerry’s stakeholder 
engagement approach, please refer to the Stakeholder 
Engagement section on pages 138-139.
Grievance Mechanisms
S2-3 – Processes to remediate negative impacts and 
channels for value chain workers to raise concerns
We encourage our employees to report, to their line 
manager, a member of the Procurement or Responsible 
Sourcing teams, where they believe potential negative 
human rights impacts may be occurring in our upstream 
value chain. The teams will assess the complaint in line 
with our due diligence process, investigating the severity 
and will work with the supplier to cease, prevent and 
mitigate the potential negative impact on workers' human 
rights. Third-party input may be sought to support our 
efforts in investigating and providing remedy on an issue. 
Employees of our suppliers have an opportunity 
through SMETA audit interviews to raise a grievance 
which can be viewed through the Sedex platform 
and remedied by the supplier or with intervention by 
Kerry through our due diligence process. Our Speak 
Up channel, provides a safe and confidential means 
for upstream value chain workers to raise concerns or 
report issues while ensuring their anonymity, where 
legally permissible. As per Kerry’s Speak Up Policy 
(available on our website), Kerry adopts a zero tolerance 
approach to any threats, intimidation, violence, or 
reprisals against anyone, including employees and 
human rights defenders, who reports a concern 
involving Kerry. We monitor all complaints through the 
Speak Up channel to ensure they are investigated, and 
appropriate actions are taken to address and remedy 
any substantiated violations of human rights laws 
impacting upstream value chain workers.  
Our current process for assessing value chain workers' 
awareness of our Speak Up channel occurs through 
our engagement with upstream value chain employee 
representatives when sharing our Supplier Code of 
Conduct during the onboarding process. Our existing 
suppliers are reminded of our Speak Up channel as 
they reconfirm their adherence to our Supplier Code of 
Conduct during the retendering process. 
Our Human Rights Policy also highlights the availability of 
our Speak Up channel, in addition to our Supplier Code of 
Conduct which also provides information on how to raise 
a grievance.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
210
211
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Workers in the Value Chain (S2)
5. Actions
S2-4 – Taking action on material impacts on value chain workers, and approaches to managing material risks and pursuing 
material opportunities related to value chain workers, and effectiveness of those actions
For the actions disclosed throughout this section, the specified location of the actions across our value chain reflects 
where the impacts and risks arise. We acknowledge that Kerry will need to initiate many of these activities from 
within our own operations. 
Possible Human Rights Infringements Action Plan
In 2024, Kerry implemented targeted initiatives to address potential human rights infringements in our upstream value 
chain. Kerry has actions, with planned and budgeted initiatives in place to advance our Human Rights Policy objectives. 
We monitor the efficacy of these actions through the metrics disclosed on page 212. Our key actions included:
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Possible 
Human Rights 
Infringements
We expanded our risk assessment to include a new dimension. Commodity risk was assessed to 
identify additional raw materials sourced from countries with an elevated risk of potential human rights 
infringements. The associated suppliers were added to our scope of suppliers considered to be high risk. 
For more details around the next steps when a supplier is identified to be located in a country deemed 
as high-risk, see the Human Rights Management (Upstream Value Chain) paragraph on page 186.
We recognise that potential negative human rights impacts require continuous monitoring and proactive management. 
To achieve this, we have developed the following planned actions:
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Possible 
Human Rights 
Infringements
Further enhance our risk assessment process by integrating additional 
commodity-specific human rights risks and mapping these newly identified 
risks to relevant suppliers and potentially affected stakeholders.
Integrate additional mechanisms into our due diligence process to monitor 
and evaluate human rights impacts within our upstream value chain. 
Enhancing Working Conditions Through Responsible Labour Practices Action Plan
Enhancing working conditions in our upstream value chain is a key policy objective for Kerry, offering potential for a 
positive impact. In 2024, we implemented the following key actions to further our human rights policy objectives:
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Enhancing 
Working 
Conditions 
Through 
Responsible 
Labour 
Practices 
We engaged with industry bodies to assess potential targeted initiatives to enhance our 
human rights due diligence process. Our Responsible Sourcing team joined the Tech 
Against Trafficking Summit to explore data-driven solutions for modern slavery. The team 
also participated in a Child Rights in Business (CRIB) working group which focused on 
understanding child labour risks and safeguarding children’s rights in supply chains. We also 
identified and engaged with a qualified partner to provide expert support on remediation, 
should a serious incident be identified in our upstream value chain.
 
Potential 
Positive 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon​
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Enhancing 
Working 
Conditions 
Through 
Responsible 
Labour 
Practices
Expand engagement with industry bodies to develop a suite of actions, tools 
and resources that can be used by suppliers to increase engagement on 
human rights, thereby improving human rights issues through improved 
human rights due diligence processes in the value chain.
Reputation, Legal and Regulatory Risk Due to Supplier Non-Conformance Action Plan
The complex nature of Kerry’s global supply chain could potentially lead to reputational, legal, and/or regulatory 
risks arising from supplier non-conformance, and this is considered in our risk assessment process. In 2024, we 
implemented the following key actions to further our human rights policy objectives:
Risk
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Reputation, 
Legal and 
Regulatory 
Risk Due to 
Supplier Non-
Conformance
To enhance awareness of human rights standards and build compliance capacity among our supply 
chain partners in 2024, we conducted training for suppliers in India and China. This enabled us to 
showcase the importance of Sedex and SMETA audit engagement for suppliers’ operations and 
human rights practices.
Avoidance of reputation, legal and regulatory risk due to supplier non-conformance requires continuous monitoring, 
proactive management and ongoing development of our roadmap of targeted initiatives expanding the scope of our 
management of salient human rights issues. To achieve this, we have developed the following planned actions:
Risk
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Reputation, 
Legal and 
Regulatory 
Risk Due to 
Supplier Non-
Conformance
Building on our supplier training programmes delivered in China and India 
in 2024, we will expand our programmes to further enhance awareness of 
human rights standards and build compliance capacity in additional high-risk 
geographies.
Incorporate our updated Human Rights Policy into our Supplier Code of 
Conduct to ensure suppliers align with our commitment to respecting human 
rights. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
212
213
Sustainability Statement
6. Targets and Metrics1
S2-5 – Targets related to managing material negative 
impacts, advancing positive impacts, and managing material 
risks and opportunities
Kerry has set metrics to track the effectiveness of its 
policies and actions in relation to the material impacts 
and risks relating to working conditions in the upstream 
value chain. This allows us to understand potential 
negative impacts and manage corrective actions to 
reduce the impact on upstream value chain workers. 
We have not set a target for working conditions in 
the upstream value chain. We continue to measure 
the following Kerry-defined metrics to inform the 
effectiveness of our actions and progress towards our 
policy commitments.
Suppliers in high-risk countries 
linked on Sedex
The following table outlines the percentage of our 
suppliers in high-risk countries that are registered 
on the Sedex platform. This metric is derived from a 
comprehensive evaluation of all Kerry suppliers classified 
as high-risk, based on the results of our detailed risk 
assessment process, as outlined in our 'Human Rights 
Management (Upstream Value Chain)' on page 186.
By concentrating on these suppliers, the metric aims to 
provide a targeted approach for managing and mitigating 
potential risks, focusing resources on the most critical 
areas of vulnerability within our upstream value chain. 
This metric is calculated as spend with suppliers in high-
risk countries linked on Sedex divided by spend with 
suppliers in high-risk countries.
Connected with our key action taken on possible 
human rights infringements impact on page 210, our 
base for calculation has expanded in 2024 to include 
commodity risk.
2024 
Percentage
2023β 
Percentage
Suppliers in high-risk 
countries linked on Sedex 
88%
88%
Suppliers in high-risk countries that 
have completed a SMETA audit 
SMETA audits enable us to evaluate supplier compliance, 
identify areas for improvement, and implement corrective 
action plans where necessary. 
This metric is calculated as spend with suppliers in high-
risk countries linked on Sedex that have completed a 
SMETA audit within the past three years, divided by spend 
with suppliers in high-risk countries linked on Sedex.
2024 
Percentage
2023β 
Percentage
Suppliers in high-risk 
countries who are linked 
on Sedex and have 
completed a SMETA audit 
within the past three years 
72%
65%
These audits provide valuable insights from upstream 
value chain workers through interviews that address 
working conditions and potential human rights 
impacts, forming a key component of our continuous 
improvement efforts.
Human Rights Issues and Incidents 
(Upstream Value Chain)
As outlined on page 190, our Human Rights Policy is 
aligned with the UN Guiding Principles on Business and 
Human Rights, the ILO Declaration on Fundamental 
Principles and Rights at Work, and the OECD Guidelines 
for Multinational Enterprises. Kerry is committed to 
enforcing the policy across its upstream value chain and 
expects its business relationships to uphold the policy. 
Through the SMETA audit process, incidents of supplier 
non-conformance were identified, which may serve as 
indicators of potential human rights issues. These non-
conformances primarily related to occupational health 
and safety, economic inclusion and living standards, 
and working conditions. We engage directly and 
indirectly with suppliers to facilitate the implementation 
of corrective actions for identified non-conformances, 
ensuring that these corrective actions are sufficiently 
robust. We monitored and investigated all formally 
reported complaints received through our Speak Up 
channel, ensuring appropriate actions are taken.
Aligned to the characteristics of severity outlined in the 
UNGP Reporting Framework in the form of scale, scope, 
or irremediable character, no severe human rights issues 
or incidents were reported in the upstream value chain in 
2024 through either the SMETA audit process or Speak Up 
channel.
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
Material Impacts, Risks and 
Opportunities
As part of Kerry’s double materiality assessment, we 
identified material impacts, risks and opportunities 
relating to consumers and end-users. Our approach to 
determining these IROs is described in the General section 
on pages 140-141. Our material impacts and opportunities 
relating to consumers are concentrated within our 
downstream value chain, and material risks affecting both 
our downstream value chain and our own operations. 
We consider our relationship with our consumers from 
the perspective of two material topics, Consumer Health 
and Responsible Communications, with disclosure of 
the applicable material impacts, risks and opportunities, 
strategy, policies, actions and targets set out on a topic-by-
topic basis in this section.
As part of our double materiality assessment, we defined 
the following short, medium and long-term time horizons:
•	 Short term: within one year;
•	 Medium term: from the end of the short-term 
reporting period up to five years; and
•	 Long term: more than five years.
Consumers and End-Users (S4)
Material Impacts, Risks and 	
213 
Opportunities
Consumer Health	
1.	 Material Impacts, Risks and 	
213
	
Opportunities
2.	 Strategy	
214
3.	 Policies	
214
4.	 Engagement Process	
215
5.	 Actions	
216
6.	 Targets and Metrics	
219
Responsible Communications	
1.	 Material Impacts 	
220
2.	 Strategy	
220
3.	 Policies	
220
4.	 Engagement Process	
221
5.	 Actions	
221
6.	 Targets	
222
Description
Time  
Horizon
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Access to Positive and Balanced Nutrition 
Access to sustainable and healthy nutrition through 
Kerry’s portfolio of products that contribute positive and 
balanced nutrition to consumer products.
Opportunity
Market Share Expansion 
Opportunity to expand market position and gain new 
customers through sustainable nutrition innovation.
 
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Food Safety and Quality  
Harm to consumer health resulting from failure to 
achieve our stringent food safety management standards 
and high product quality.
 
 
Risk
Changing Consumer Preferences 
Market risk due to consumer preferences changing 
faster than Kerry’s business assumptions, resulting in lost 
revenue as Kerry lags behind the market shift.
Consumer Health
1. Material Impacts, Risks and Opportunities
The following consumer health-related material IROs were identified as part of our double materiality assessment:
Sustainability Statement Consumers and End-Users (S4)
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
214
215
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Consumers and End-Users (S4)
2. Strategy
ESRS 2 SBM-3 – Material impacts, risks and opportunities 
and their interaction with strategy and business model
Our Beyond the Horizon strategy sets out our goal to 
reach over two billion people with sustainable nutrition 
solutions by the end of 2030. Led by our purpose 
of Inspiring Food, Nourishing Life, we recognise the 
significant role we can play in shaping the health of 
consumer diets, to help deliver balanced nutrition in 
a way that protects both people and the planet. Our 
sustainable nutrition spectrum sets out the steps we 
take to realise our ambition. The material impacts, risks 
and opportunity related to consumer health apply to 
consumers of products that contain a Kerry ingredient.  
Global nutrition and health concerns predominantly 
revolve around obesity and non-communicable diseases, 
largely attributed to excessive consumption of fat, salt, 
and sugar in modern diets. Nutritional profiling of Kerry’s 
Taste & Nutrition portfolio shows that more than 80% 
of the portfolio is positive and balanced with regards to 
the levels of sugar, salt and fat that they contribute to 
customers’ final products.
Providing access to sustainable and healthy nutrition 
through Kerry’s portfolio of products that contribute 
positive and balanced nutrition provides actual positive 
impacts to consumers. We do however recognise a 
potential material negative impact from any incidents 
that arise if we fail to achieve our stringent food safety 
and high product quality standards. Kerry manages the 
regulatory risk associated with non-compliance with food 
safety regulations through a Food Safety and Quality 
Policy and associated actions, and we are committed 
to complying with new regulations governments may 
apply restricting specific food types to reduce diet-related 
communicable diseases.
Consumer preference is also a key element of our 
marketing and consumer insights strategy, as we seek to 
mitigate the risk of falling behind market shifts and take 
advantage of opportunities to develop new products in 
response to evolving consumer needs.
3. Policies 
S4-1 – Policies related to consumers and end-users
Our Consumer Health Policy 
Kerry’s Consumer Health Policy outlines its commitment 
to shaping the health of consumer diets and delivering 
balanced nutrition in a way that protects both people 
and the planet. This policy is central to Kerry’s purpose 
of Inspiring Food, Nourishing Life. The policy establishes 
Kerry’s commitment to contribute towards the health 
of consumers through our products and work with 
customers to co-create and innovate for more sustainable 
and nutritious consumer products. It outlines our 
key activities to address material impacts, risks and 
opportunities related to consumer health, covering 
consumers and end-users. 
The policy applies to Kerry Group plc and all its 
subsidiaries, associated companies, joint venture 
partners, and all employees worldwide, and includes 
all locations where Kerry conducts business. It may be 
augmented or adjusted by other local jurisdictional 
laws, policies, and processes. In such cases, the stricter 
guideline applies. The Chief Science and Technology 
Officer and the Chief Commercial Officer, who are 
members of the Executive Leadership Team, are jointly 
accountable for this policy’s implementation and review. 
The policy is committed to respecting internationally 
recognised guidelines and third-party standards. These 
include the UK Department of Health & Food Safety 
Authority 2016, a UK traffic light nutrient profiling 
system, the World Health Organisation, the Food and 
Agriculture Organization, the Consumer Goods Forum, 
FoodDrinkEurope, and the International Organization of 
the Flavour Industry.
Key stakeholders impacted by this policy include Kerry 
employees, suppliers, customers, and consumers. This 
policy is available on our intranet and website. The impact 
listed in this policy has been identified through internal 
and external stakeholder engagement as part of our 
double materiality assessment. 
Description
Time  
Horizon
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Risk
Regulatory Risk 
Regulatory risk due to possible non-compliance with food 
ingredients and labelling regulations resulting in fines 
and legal consequences.
Risk
Compliance Risk 
Regulatory and compliance risk due to increase in regulatory 
burden resulting from governments implementing 
restrictions on specific food products to reduce diet-related 
non-communicable diseases in the general public.
 
1Own Ops = Own Operations
Our Food Safety and Quality Policy
Kerry’s Food Safety and Quality (FSQ) Policy outlines 
its commitment to ensuring that its products meet the 
highest standards of safety, integrity, and consumer 
satisfaction. This policy is central to ensuring we provide 
good nutrition and food security for consumers and 
end-users. The policy outlines Kerry’s commitments and 
the key activities it undertakes to address its material 
FSQ impact. It sets guiding principles and ambitions 
regarding managing Kerry’s FSQ, providing a holistic 
enterprise perspective including its supply chain end to 
end. The policy is monitored through the implementation 
of the Kerry Global Quality and Food Safety (Q&FS) 
Food Protection Systems Standard and a Global Hazard 
Analysis Critical Control Point (HACCP) Standard.
The policy applies to all Kerry management, facilities, and 
functions, including but not limited to manufacturing 
sites, Research, Development and Application (RD&A) 
facilities, pilot plants, raw material supply, shared 
services (purchasing, quality, supply chain, regulatory), 
warehouses, distribution centres and joint ventures. All 
Kerry facilities and functions are required to comply with 
this policy. The policy may be augmented or adjusted by 
other local jurisdictional laws, policies, and processes. 
In such cases, the stricter guideline applies. The Global 
Quality Health Safety and Environmental (QHSE) Officer is 
ultimately accountable for this policy’s implementation.
The policy sets out Kerry's commitment to respecting 
select internationally recognised guidelines and 
third-party standards. These include the Global Food 
Safety Initiative (GFSI) Benchmarked Standards, 
specifically BRCGS, FSSC 22000, SQF, and ISO/TS 
22002-1 Prerequisite Programmes on Food Safety. 
Key stakeholders impacted by this policy include Kerry 
staff, suppliers, and customers. The impact listed in 
this policy has been identified through internal and 
external stakeholder engagement as part of Kerry’s 
double materiality assessment. This policy is published 
on Kerry’s website, where it is accessible to all potentially 
affected stakeholders. Kerry leverages the ‘Eye for Food 
Safety and Quality’ document, a one-page commitment 
statement available in local languages in Kerry locations, 
to communicate and achieve the objectives of this policy.
4. Engagement Process 
Interests and Views of Consumers and End-
Users
ESRS 2 SBM-2 – Interests and views of stakeholders
Kerry gathers perspectives and views from consumers 
and end-users of our products through ongoing 
engagement to better understand their needs and 
perspectives and respond more effectively to any 
potential impacts or risks that are identified. The rights 
of our consumers continue to be a core component of 
our strategy and business model, and our commitment is 
seen through our continued contributions to food safety 
and the health of our consumers.
Additionally, a selection of Kerry’s customers participated 
in Kerry’s double materiality assessment process, providing 
valuable perspectives and views on sustainability matters 
material to Kerry from an impact perspective through 
surveys and interviews. For more details on Kerry’s 
stakeholder engagement approach, please refer to the 
Stakeholder Engagement section on pages 138-139.
Processes for Engaging with our Consumers 
and End-Users
S4-2 – Processes for engaging with consumers and end-
users about impacts
While Kerry primarily operates as a Business-to-Business 
(B2B) organisation, understanding the end consumer is 
vital to our success. By fostering ongoing engagement 
with customers and consumers from pre-innovation 
to product manufacture and beyond, we operate a 
customer-centric business model, positioning ourselves 
as a trusted partner in creating a world of sustainable 
nutrition. Through insights gathered by our commercial 
teams, participation in market forums, and initiatives 
led by the Kerry Health and Nutrition Institute® (KHNI), 
we drive growth, deliver value, and provide distinctive 
perspectives that result in innovation for a dynamic 
and evolving consumer. To showcase our innovation 
capabilities, we engage customers and industry partners 
through campaigns, conferences, tradeshows, webinars, 
and strategic partnerships. These efforts are designed 
to inspire customers and industry partners to develop 
healthier products. We use platforms such as KHNI and 
customer innovation workshops, to apply our knowledge 
and expertise early in the development cycle, during the 
ideation of new concepts and innovations.
The KHNI delivers impactful sustainable nutrition 
insights to customers, academics, employees, and 
consumers. Supported by a network of scientists, external 
collaborators, and the Scientific Advisory Council, KHNI 
shares its ‘Science for Healthier Food’ insights with 
subscribers. These insights inform decision-making by 
providing a comprehensive understanding of the views of 
our customers and consumers.
At Kerry, we work closely with our customers to manage 
actual and potential impacts on consumers and end-users. 
Our cross-functional teams work collaboratively with 
customers to co-develop innovative solutions, enabling us 
to make a meaningful contribution to the UN Sustainable 
Development Goals, particularly Goal 3: Good Health 
and Well-being. Through our technology portfolio and 
Kerry Nutri Guide tool, we create products optimised for 
consumer health in alignment with regional nutrition 
profiling guidelines. 
We actively promote sustainable nutrition by educating 
and raising awareness among our customers. Our 
offerings include science-based capabilities, sustainability 
services, product and application impact calculators, expert 
commercial teams, and customer engagement platforms 
such as our website and Customer Portal. This approach 
fosters shared responsibility and supports a holistic 
understanding of the benefits of sustainable nutrition.
Responsibility for Kerry’s engagement processes with 
consumers and end-users rests with the Chief Science and 
Technology Officer and the Chief Commercial Officer.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
216
217
Sustainability Statement Consumers and End-Users (S4)
Sustainability Statement
Grievance Mechanisms
S4-3 – Processes to remediate negative impacts and channels 
for consumers and end-users to raise concerns
Kerry is committed to providing effective remedies where 
we have caused or contributed to material negative 
impacts on consumers. We provide several channels for 
consumers to raise concerns directly with us, including:
Our Customer Account Managers: Our customers can 
contact their account manager, through regular business 
dealings, to raise any queries or concerns they may have. 
These queries and concerns will be investigated and dealt 
with promptly.
Kerry’s Customer Care Line: Kerry’s Customer Care 
team serves as the primary point of contact for customer 
complaints and concerns, including quality and consumer-
related issues. The Customer Care team will investigate 
and respond to these complaints and concerns in line 
with our processes. 
Our Speak Up Channel: Kerry’s Speak Up channel offers 
customers and consumers a safe and confidential way to 
raise concerns or report issues, with anonymity provided 
where legally permissible. All complaints received through 
the Speak Up channel are monitored to ensure thorough 
investigation, and appropriate actions are taken to 
address and resolve substantiated concerns. We have a 
strict policy prohibiting retaliation or reprisals against any 
employee or stakeholder who reports a concern or assists 
in an investigation in good faith.
5. Actions 
S4-4 – Taking action on material impacts on consumers and 
end-users, and approaches to managing material risks and 
pursuing material opportunities related to consumers and 
end-users, and effectiveness of those actions
Kerry has processes in place to manage consumer health-
related material impacts, risks and opportunities with 
planned and budgeted initiatives to advance our policy 
objectives and achieve our organisational targets for 
consumer health.
For the actions disclosed in this section, the specified 
location of the actions across our value chain reflects 
where the impacts, risks and opportunity arise. We 
acknowledge that Kerry will need to initiate many of these 
activities from within our own operations.
In 2024, we took the following key actions to progress the 
achievement of our consumer health policy objectives and 
target: 
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Key Action Taken in 2024
Access to 
Positive and 
Balanced 
Nutrition
In 2024, Kerry advanced its sodium reduction capabilities for snack products with the launch of the 
Sodium Reduction Simulator. This tool assesses taste challenges across various flavour profiles and 
sodium levels. When combined with Kerry’s Tastesense™ salt portfolio, this technology facilitates 
the development of snacks with significantly less sodium. To support this initiative, we launched 
educational resources, including a scientific webinar for customers and articles detailing the science 
behind sodium reduction.
Opportunity
Key Action Taken in 2024
Market Share 
Expansion
Kerry leveraged its Innovation Framework in 2024 to commercialise technologies in support of our 
consumer health commitments. Key highlights include solutions for nutritionally optimised plant-
based alternatives and clean-label meat preservation without harmful nitrites. 
Risk
Key Action Taken in 2024
Changing 
Consumer 
Preferences
Enabled by our recognised proprietary Insight toolkit, Kerry identified marketplace opportunities 
and transformed insights into actionable strategies. Our goal is to inform better business decisions 
and inspire proactive, outward-looking perspectives. Our Insight toolkit includes proprietary 
research which utilises the latest methods to uncover consumer motivations and emerging 
behaviours, exemplified by our 2024 ‘Future Lens’ work. It also includes a framework to accelerate 
speed-to-market with purpose-driven, turnkey innovation solutions.
To accelerate progress towards our consumer health objectives, we plan to implement the following forward-
looking actions: 
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Access to 
Positive and 
Balanced 
Nutrition
Continue investing in the development of impact tools, platforms and 
innovation centres that can support product nutritional optimisation  
during innovation.
Collaborate with universities, researchers, accelerators, and startups, to co-
develop new solutions and deliver breakthrough innovation.
Risk
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Changing 
Consumer 
Preferences
Continue to develop our Consumer Insight resources which include  
Consumer Trends, and Category Trends which enables a consumer-centred 
culture of innovation to achieve Kerry’s future of sustainable nutrition. Publish 
the annual edition of the KHNI 'Top 10 Health and Nutrition' trends for 2025 on 
KHNI website.
Regulatory Risk Assessment
Kerry has processes in place to ensure compliance with regulatory changes and shifting market preferences, these 
outline the procedures for reviewing regional regulation changes and communicating them to internal stakeholders. 
We also regularly review and update the Kerry Nutri Guide tool to account for any changing requirements surrounding 
various government-endorsed front-of-pack nutrition labelling systems and national legislation requirements.
Consistent with applicable local and international laws and regulations, we are committed to providing for/or 
cooperating in the equitable remediation of identified adverse impacts to our consumers and end-users that we may 
have caused, contributed to, or are directly linked to our own operations.
During 2024, we undertook the following actions to manage regulatory and compliance risks identified:
Risk
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Regulatory 
Risk
The Kerry Nutri Map tool was launched in 2024 demonstrating country-level nutritional guidelines, 
salt regulations and sugar taxes for over 55 countries globally, equipping our commercial teams 
with the latest information that impacts their customers across regions. The Kerry Nutri Guide tool 
was updated in 2024 to include the new front-of-pack nutrition labelling calculations for Canada 
and Colombia, enabling our RD&A teams to identify areas of nutritional optimisation for customers' 
products within these regions.
Compliance 
Risk
Kerry’s regulatory team monitored regulatory updates and their impact on Kerry’s commercial 
activities. In 2024, the European Union introduced new regulations in relation to specific flavours. 
Kerry has developed a hub to inform customers about these regulations and has innovation to 
provide alternative solutions. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
218
219
Sustainability Statement Consumers and End-Users (S4)
Sustainability Statement
We will continue to monitor draft and confirmed regulation to manage our readiness to meet new requirements and 
ensure our compliance. We have planned additional risk management actions to further enhance our resilience:
Risk
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Regulatory 
Risk
Kerry Nutri Map and Kerry Nutri Guide tools will be updated with forthcoming 
updates to nutritional labelling globally as it emerges. Kerry Nutri Guide with 
be updated in 2025 to reflect the new algorithm for Nutri-Score which will be 
relevant in European markets in 2026. 
Food Safety and Quality
The quality of the food we produce is a key priority and an enabler of Kerry achieving our vision of becoming our 
customers’ most valued partner, creating a world of sustainable nutrition. Our Food Safety Strategy is based on the 
underlying principle of Safety First, Quality Always, which reflects our collective and company-wide commitment to 
the safety of our people and the safety and quality of our products. Food safety and quality are embedded in Kerry’s 
culture and are a cornerstone of our shared values. Our Global Food Safety and Quality Risk Management Framework 
is a proactive risk-based approach to food safety management. It ensures that we begin with identifying potential risks, 
implementing preventative controls, and monitoring effectiveness.  
Kerry ensures food safety management through implementing the Kerry Global Q&FS Food Protection Systems 
Standard that is leveraged by all sites to develop, implement, and maintain a food safety plan. Kerry is a member of the 
Global Food Safety Initiative (GFSI), which utilises several schemes to ensure food safety is maintained throughout the 
global food supply chain. We abide by the principles laid out by ISO 22000, which includes food safety requirements 
that are standardised and to be maintained across organisations to assist in controlling hazards to food safety. In 
addition, Kerry is an active member of the global non-profit SSAFE, which works to strengthen food safety and improve 
wellbeing for humans, animals, and plants.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Key Action Taken in 2024
Food Safety 
and Quality 
We facilitated in excess of 800 external food safety and quality audits across our global 
manufacturing facilities, which includes customer and accreditation audits, in addition to those 
from our internal Group Food Safety Quality (FSQ) audit team, which are key to maintaining and 
improving our food safety and quality standards.
We continue to assess and elevate the food safety and quality maturity of our manufacturing facilities through the 
standardisation of food safety requirements and the Global FSQ Internal Audit programme. Our teams drive and work 
to further embed and improve our culture of Safety First, Quality Always across the organisation, with further actions 
planned to advance this objective:
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Food Safety 
and Quality 
Ensure our own workforce behaviour continues to put Safety First, Quality 
Always at the forefront of our daily decision-making. This will ensure that 
we are delivering on our customers’ expectations for safe, high quality and 
nutritious products.
Maintain accreditation to GFSI-recognised standards in currently certified 
manufacturing facilities and achieve accreditation for the small number 
of Kerry manufacturing facilities not currently certified against a GFSI-
recognised standard.
6. Targets and Metrics1  
S4-5 – Targets related to managing material negative 
impacts, advancing positive impacts, and managing 
material risks and opportunities
The quality of the food we produce is a key priority and 
an enabler of Kerry achieving our vision. Our Sustainable 
Nutrition Spectrum integrates nutritional, environmental, 
and social measures, enabling us to act in key impact 
areas and strategically evolve our portfolio to support our 
customers in reaching their sustainable nutrition goals. 
Our targets are guided by ongoing engagement with 
our consumers to understand and address their evolving 
nutritional needs.
Nutritional Reach Target
Our 2030 target is to reach over two billion people with 
sustainable nutrition solutions that contribute to and 
maintain good health for consumers and end-users. 
Nutritional Reach Metric Performance
In 2024, we expanded our reach with positive 
and balanced nutrition solutions to 1.36 billion 
people (2023β: 1.25 billion), by expanding into new 
markets and developing regions, through customer 
partnerships and the availability of new technologies 
within our portfolio. We also continue to maintain a 
Taste & Nutrition portfolio of more than 80% (2023β: 
more than 80%) positive and balanced nutrition.  
We apply a nutritional profile scoring to our products. 
The nutritional profile is then categorised into positive, 
balanced and poor nutrition. The revenue associated 
with each product is then categorised in the same way 
and the total of positive and balanced is then compared 
to the overall Taste & Nutrition revenue. Our progress 
towards our target is in line with expectations and is 
monitored by our Portfolio Council.
Our Nutritional Reach metric calculates the number 
of consumers reached with positive and balanced 
nutrition solutions. 
The calculation methodology includes:
Step 1 - Nutritional Profiling: 
•	 Each of Kerry’s ingredient solutions are nutritionally 
analysed using objective nutritional databases that 
calculate the specific nutrient levels based on the raw 
materials used and their contribution in the product 
formulation; 
•	 These nutrient levels are compared to the UK traffic 
light food and beverage thresholds for salt, sugar, fat, 
saturated fat, and trans fat; and
•	 Each ingredient is categorised into; ‘positive’, ‘balanced’ 
or ‘poor’ nutrition in application.
Step 2 - Quantifying Nutritional Reach:
•	 Allocating the revenue associated with those products 
that have positive and balanced nutrition solutions 
within each end use market in each country;
•	 Leveraging third-party data and expertise to estimate 
the number of people who consume a product with  
positive or balanced Kerry technology; and 
•	 Eliminating double counting through the use of statistical 
methods. For more information, see Kerry’s nutrition 
profiling methodology whitepaper at kerry.com.
Product Recalls Target
The safety and quality of our food is a key priority. Our 
target is for zero product recalls annually.
Kerry has a responsibility to ensure food safety and 
integrity is treated with the utmost importance.
As a global organisation, we apply consistent food 
safety and quality standards through agreed global 
processes and structures. As part of this approach, 
Kerry has a clear policy outlining its commitment to 
produce safe and legal products, while complying with 
all applicable regulatory requirements. 
Product Recalls Metric Performance
Product recalls measure the number of product recall 
events relating to products that may cause adverse 
health consequences to consumers and/or end-users, 
aligned to the Food & Drug Administration definitions 
for recall classification. 
In 2024, there was one product recall notification (2023β: 
zero). This recall arose due to potential microbiological 
contamination. A supplier to Kerry recalled a number of 
raw materials that had been supplied to, and used by, 
Kerry manufacturing sites. Due to our well-established 
processes there were no reported illnesses associated 
with the recalled Kerry product. 
Global Food Safety Initiative Accreditation
Kerry is an active member of the GFSI, an 
industry initiative that reduces food safety risk 
by delivering equivalence between effective food 
safety management systems. Kerry recognises the 
importance of accreditation of our manufacturing sites 
to GFSI-recognised standards and requires that they 
obtain certification against these standards, which 
include Brand Reputation through Compliance Global 
Standards (BRCGS), Food Safety System Certification 
22000 (FSSC 22000), or Safe Quality Food (SQF) 
schemes. We support and guide our non-certified sites 
in the journey toward accreditation ensuring that the 
safety and quality of our products is always assured. 
In 2024, 97% of Kerry food manufacturing sites held 
accreditation against GFSI-recognised standards. 
This metric represents the number of Kerry food and 
beverage manufacturing sites holding valid accreditation 
against one or more of the GFSI-recognised standards 
on 31 of December of the reporting year, expressed 
as a percentage of the total number of Kerry food and 
beverage manufacturing sites. 
1 Comparative information denoted by β (beta) is not covered by the Independent Practitioners' Limited Assurance Report.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
220
221
Sustainability Statement Consumers and End-Users (S4)
Sustainability Statement
Responsible Communications 
1. Material Impacts 
The following Responsible Communications related material impacts were identified as part of our double 
materiality assessment:
Description
Time  
Horizon
Location in  
Value Chain
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Upstream
Own Ops1
Downstream
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Substantiated Information 
Provide accurate and substantiated information, and 
increased transparency on nutritional labels and claims, 
thereby enabling product users to make more informed 
consumption decisions.
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Stakeholder Trust 
Reduced stakeholder trust through inaccurate or 
misleading communication surrounding progress on 
sustainability.
2. Strategy
ESRS 2 SBM-3 – Material impacts, risks and opportunities and 
their interaction with strategy and business model
Kerry in its engagements communicates responsibly, for 
ethical reasons and to ensure we maintain the trust of 
customers, end-users (the public) and all stakeholders. 
Our approach to verifying that what we communicate 
externally is accurate and substantiated enables 
interested parties to rely on information we provide. 
Our strategy for communicating responsibly and 
effectively with customers and consumers can produce 
an actual positive impact, by providing information on a 
product’s nutritional composition, which can lead to more 
informed consumer choices. 
Enabling sustainable nutrition for our customers and 
their consumers underpins our broader strategy and 
our business model supports us in delivering on impact. 
Communicating effectively and accurately is crucial 
to increasing awareness of sustainability challenges 
and solutions available to address these. For example, 
understanding the nutritional profile of products and 
what can influence this is important to allow customers 
to innovate and create healthier products. Our Kerry 
Nutri Guide tool can help them to understand key impact 
areas, and as we partner with them on innovation and 
reformulation, being clear on the potential impact of our 
technologies is essential for their product development 
and onward messaging to consumers. By ensuring 
accurate and transparent communication, we can enable 
more informed consumer choice and support a shift to 
healthier diets.
In a similar way communication with our wider 
stakeholders allows us to transparently share information 
on our sustainability progress.  
We recognise our role in preventing a potential negative 
impact, and the resulting loss of trust that may arise, 
due to misleading or inaccurate communication on 
sustainability progress.
3. Policies
S4-1 – Policies related to consumers and end-users
Responsible Communications Policy
Our Responsible Communications Policy aims to ensure 
that communications from the channels outlined within 
the scope of the policy are truthful, accurate, and 
substantiated, thereby protecting stakeholders from 
inaccurate or misleading information.
It outlines our key activities to address material impacts 
related to responsible communications, including the 
preparation of communications in line with established 
standards, an approval and sign-off process, and 
an information management protocol to maintain 
communication records and facilitate verification. Kerry 
is dedicated to adhering to industry standards and best 
practices to safeguard the wellbeing of consumers and 
promote healthy choices. The policy also outlines the 
actions required of employees and business partners 
to ensure responsible communication principles are 
adhered to. The Chief Corporate Affairs Officer, who is a 
member of the Executive Leadership Team, is accountable 
for the implementation and review of this policy. 
The Responsible Communications Policy references 
several third-party standards that have informed its 
approach, including the International Chamber of 
Commerce Code, the International Food & Beverage 
1Own Ops = Own Operations
Alliance 2021 Global Policy on Marketing Communications 
to Children, and the Advertising Standards Authority for 
Ireland Code of Standards advertising and marketing 
communications in Ireland. This policy is available on 
our intranet and website. The Corporate Affairs team are 
responsible for investigating any potential breach of this 
policy and for working with business function leaders to 
ensure that appropriate mitigation and remediation steps 
are taken. These may include reporting breaches of laws 
to the relevant authorities as required by applicable laws.
4. Engagement Process 
Interests & Views of Consumers and End-Users
ESRS 2 SBM-2 – Interests and views of stakeholders
For Kerry, our customers and the consumers of finished 
products are a key group of affected stakeholders, and we 
are committed to incorporating their interests, views, and 
rights into our strategy and business model. Additionally, 
consumer representatives participated in Kerry’s double 
materiality assessment process, providing valuable 
perspectives and views on sustainability matters material 
to Kerry from an impact perspective through surveys 
and interviews. For more details on Kerry’s stakeholder 
engagement approach, please refer to the Stakeholder 
Engagement section on pages 138-139.
Processes for Engaging with Consumers and 
End-Users
S4-2 – Processes for engaging with consumers and end-
users about impacts
Stakeholders receive our communications in several 
formats, including via social media, our website (Kerry.
com), press releases, and marketing materials, including 
marketing-related product claims. Additionally, through 
data and science-based tools, Kerry Group communicates 
information to consumers about food products, helping 
them to make informed choices. The Kerry Nutri Guide 
supports front-of-pack labels through nutritional 
verification; our Kerry Food Waste Estimator helps 
manufacturers and end-users understand the impact of 
waste; and our Kerry Carbon Guide ensures our customers 
can better understand their carbon footprint. Facilitating 
the availability of trusted information via these tools helps 
users to make more informed purchasing decisions. 
Responsibility for Kerry’s engagement processes for 
responsible communications with consumers and end-
users rests with the Chief Corporate Affairs Officer.
Our processes are designed to receive feedback from 
those with whom we communicate, so that we can 
understand how those communications are being 
received. We can assess the effectiveness of our 
engagement, based in part on the nature of queries we 
receive on our materials. We engage with our customers 
directly on an ongoing basis and provide publicly 
accessible contact information in our materials and on 
our website, to facilitate contact from the public and other 
stakeholders.
For further detail on our two-way stakeholder 
engagement, please see the Stakeholder Engagement 
section on pages 138-139. For a comprehensive overview 
of the results of our engagement with consumers and 
end-users regarding sustainability matters, as well 
as our assessment of the associated impacts, risks, 
and opportunities, please see the double materiality 
assessment on pages 140-141.
Grievance Mechanisms
S4-3 – Processes to remediate negative impacts and 
channels for consumers and end-users to raise concerns
We engage with our customers directly on an ongoing 
basis and provide publicly accessible contact information 
in our materials and on our website, to facilitate contact 
from the public and other stakeholders. 
At Kerry we take any allegations of breaches of our 
responsible communication principles seriously and have 
grievance mechanisms in place for reporting concerns. 
Consumers, individuals conducting business with Kerry 
and other indirect stakeholders are encouraged to use 
the Speak Up platform to report concerns confidentially, 
safely, and anonymously (via Speak Up where permitted 
by local laws). All complaints received through the 
Speak Up channel are monitored to ensure thorough 
investigation, Kerry is committed to providing effective 
remedies where we have caused or contributed to 
material negative impacts on consumers and end-users. 
We have a strict policy prohibiting retaliation or reprisals 
against any employee or stakeholder who reports a 
concern or assists in an investigation in good faith.
5. Actions 
S4-4 – Taking action on material impacts on consumers and 
end-users, and approaches to managing material risks and 
pursuing material opportunities related to consumers and 
end-users, and effectiveness of those actions
At Kerry we acknowledge the impact that our 
communications can have on informing the actions of 
our stakeholders, and the choices they make. As such, 
we recognise the importance of ensuring that those 
communications are undertaken in a responsible manner. 
Kerry has processes in place to manage responsible 
communication-related material impacts, with planned 
and budgeted for initiatives to advance our policy 
objectives.
The initiatives outlined below demonstrate how Kerry 
prevents and mitigates against negative impact, as well as 
delivering positive impact to consumers and end-users.
For the actions disclosed in this section, the specified 
location of the actions across our value chain reflects 
where the impacts arise. We acknowledge that Kerry will 
need to initiate many of these activities from within our 
own operations. 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
222
223
Sustainability Statement
During 2024, we undertook action to manage our responsible communications impact:
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Substantiated 
Information
Kerry engaged with customers to promote nutritional awareness and provide accurate and 
transparent information that enables consumers to make informed and healthier choices.
In addition, we took action to maintain stakeholder trust:
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Key Actions Taken in 2024
Stakeholder 
Trust
To ensure that Kerry communications are accurate and substantiated, so that they can be a trusted 
source of information for our stakeholders, we monitor updates on evolving regulations related to 
communications and claims, to stay informed about the changing requirements. 
In 2024, Kerry launched a series of educational campaigns through the Kerry Health and Nutrition Institute® 
(KHNI) to inform stakeholders about the benefits of sustainable nutrition and healthier food choices.
Upholding our commitment to communicating responsibly requires continuous focus, and we have future actions 
planned to support that:
Actual 
Positive 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Substantiated 
Information
To inform healthier, more sustainable consumer choices, we will continue 
to promote awareness of nutrition and sustainability considerations by 
providing accurate and transparent information on relevant topics, via own 
communications channels.
Actions are planned to continue to build on stakeholder trust in the future:
Potential 
Negative 
Impact
Future Actions Planned
Time  
Horizon
Short​
Medium​
Long​
Stakeholder 
Trust
Recognising the importance of trusted information on topics of nutrition and 
sustainability, we will continue to ensure that statements and claims made in official 
communications follow citation and referencing standards and policies, with data 
references being maintained for verification and substantiation purposes.
Continue to review industry best practice on responsible communications 
to ensure that the information delivered via our channels meets the highest 
applicable standards for trusted sources.
We track and assess the effectiveness of these actions and initiatives through regular monitoring and review. Our formal 
approval process for communications materials ensures consistency and compliance with communication policies.
6. Targets
S4-5 – Targets related to managing material negative impacts, advancing positive impacts, and managing material risks and 
opportunities
We maintain our adherence to relevant regulatory guidelines, industry standards and best practices in this area, and 
investigate any suspected breaches of these practices where identified. We have not set an outcome-oriented target for 
responsible communications at this time, given the qualitative nature of related commitments.
Sustainability Statement Appendix
1. ESRS 2 Appendix B
The table below illustrates the datapoints in ESRS 2 and topical ESRS that derive from other EU legislation.
Disclosure Requirement and 
related datapoint
SFDR Reference
Pillar 3 Reference
Benchmark Regulation 
Reference
EU Climate 
Law 
Reference
Material/Not 
Material
Page 
Number
ESRS 2 GOV-1 Board’s gender 
diversity paragraph 21 (d)
Indicator number 13 of 
Table #1 of Annex 1
 
Commission Delegated 
Regulation (EU) 2020/1816 
(27), Annex II
 
Material
134
ESRS 2 GOV-1 
Percentage of board members who 
are independent paragraph 21 (e)
 
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Material
134 
ESRS 2 GOV-4 
Statement on due diligence 
paragraph 30
Indicator number 10 
Table #3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
135
ESRS 2 SBM-1 
Involvement in activities related to 
fossil fuel activities paragraph 40 (d) i
Indicators number 4 
Table #1 of Annex 1
Article 449a Regulation (EU) No 
575/2013; Commission Implementing 
Regulation (EU) 2022/2453 (28) 
Table 1: Qualitative information 
on Environmental risk and Table 2: 
Qualitative information on Social risk
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Not Material
 -
ESRS 2 SBM-1 
Involvement in activities related to 
chemical production paragraph 40 
(d) ii
Indicator number 9 Table 
#2 of Annex 1
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Not Material
 -
ESRS 2 SBM-1 
Involvement in activities related to 
controversial weapons paragraph 40 
(d) iii
Indicator number 14 
Table #1 of Annex 1
 
Delegated Regulation 
(EU) 2020/1818 (29), 
Article 12(1) Delegated 
Regulation (EU) 2020/1816, 
Annex II
 
Not Material
-
ESRS 2 SBM-1 
Involvement in activities related to 
cultivation and production of tobacco 
paragraph 40 (d) iv
 
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Article 12(1) 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Not Material
-
ESRS E1-1 
Transition plan to reach climate 
neutrality by 2050 paragraph 14
 
 
 
Regulation 
(EU) 
2021/1119, 
Article 2(1)
Material
147-150
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
224
Sustainability Statement
225
Sustainability Statement Appendix
Disclosure Requirement and 
related datapoint
SFDR Reference
Pillar 3 Reference
Benchmark Regulation 
Reference
EU Climate 
Law 
Reference
Material/Not 
Material
Page 
Number
ESRS E1-1 
Undertakings excluded from Paris-
aligned Benchmarks paragraph 16 (g)
 
Article 449a Regulation (EU) No 
575/2013; Commission Implementing 
Regulation (EU) 2022/2453 Template 
1: Banking book-Climate Change 
transition risk: Credit quality of 
exposures by sector, emissions and 
residual maturity
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Article12.1 (d) 
to (g), and Article 12.2
 
Material
150
ESRS E1-4 
GHG emission reduction targets 
paragraph 34
Indicator number 4 Table 
#2 of Annex 1
Article 449a Regulation (EU) No 
575/2013; Commission Implementing 
Regulation (EU) 2022/2453 Template 
3: Banking book – Climate change 
transition risk: alignment metrics
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Article 6
 
Material
158-159
ESRS E1-5 
Energy consumption from fossil 
sources disaggregated by sources 
(only high climate impact sectors) 
paragraph 38
Indicator number 5 Table 
#1 and Indicator n. 5 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
160
ESRS E1-5 
Energy consumption and mix 
paragraph 37
Indicator number 5 Table 
#1 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
160
ESRS E1-5 
Energy intensity associated with 
activities in high climate impact 
sectors paragraphs 40 to 43
Indicator number 6 Table 
#1 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
160
ESRS E1-6 
Gross Scope 1, 2, 3 and Total GHG 
emissions paragraph 44
Indicators number 1 and 
2 Table #1 of Annex 1
Article 449a; Regulation (EU) No 
575/2013; Commission Implementing 
Regulation (EU) 2022/2453 Template 
1: Banking book – Climate change 
transition risk: Credit quality of 
exposures by sector, emissions and 
residual maturity
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Article 5(1), 6 
and 8(1)
 
Material
163
ESRS E1-6 
Gross GHG emissions intensity 
paragraphs 53 to 55
Indicators number 3 
Table #1 of Annex 1
Article 449a Regulation (EU) No 
575/2013; Commission Implementing 
Regulation (EU) 2022/2453 Template 
3: Banking book – Climate change 
transition risk: alignment metrics
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Article 8(1)
 
Material
164
Disclosure Requirement and 
related datapoint
SFDR Reference
Pillar 3 Reference
Benchmark Regulation 
Reference
EU Climate 
Law 
Reference
Material/Not 
Material
Page 
Number
ESRS E1-7 
GHG removals and carbon credits 
paragraph 56
 
 
 
Regulation 
(EU) 
2021/1119, 
Article 2(1)
Material
164
ESRS E1-9 
Exposure of the benchmark portfolio 
to climate-related physical risks 
paragraph 66
 
 
Delegated Regulation 
(EU) 2020/1818, Annex II 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Material - see 
Appendix 3
233
ESRS E1-9 
Disaggregation of monetary amounts 
by acute and chronic physical risk 
paragraph 66 (a)
 
Article 449a Regulation (EU) No 
575/2013; Commission Implementing 
Regulation (EU) 2022/2453 paragraphs 
46 and 47; Template 5: Banking book - 
Climate change physical risk: Exposures 
subject to physical risk.
 
 
Material - see 
Appendix 3
233
ESRS E1-9 
Location of significant assets at 
material physical risk paragraph 66 
(c).
 
 
 
Material - see 
Appendix 3
233
ESRS E1-9 Breakdown of the carrying 
value of its real estate assets by 
energy-efficiency classes paragraph 
67 (c).
 
Article 449a Regulation (EU) No 
575/2013; Commission Implementing 
Regulation (EU) 2022/2453 paragraph 
34;Template 2:Banking book - 
Climate change transition risk: Loans 
collateralised by immovable property - 
Energy efficiency of the collateral
 
 
Material - see 
Appendix 3
233
ESRS E1-9 
Degree of exposure of the portfolio 
to climate-related opportunities 
paragraph 69
 
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Annex II
 
Material - see 
Appendix 3
233
ESRS E2-4 
Amount of each pollutant listed in 
Annex II of the E-PRTR Regulation 
(European Pollutant Release and 
Transfer Register) emitted to air, 
water and soil, paragraph 28
Indicator number 8 
Table #1 of Annex 1 
Indicator number 2 
Table #2 of Annex 1 
Indicator number 1 Table 
#2 of Annex 1 Indicator 
number 3 Table #2 of 
Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
226
227
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Appendix
Disclosure Requirement and 
related datapoint
SFDR Reference
Pillar 3 Reference
Benchmark Regulation 
Reference
EU Climate 
Law 
Reference
Material/Not 
Material
Page 
Number
ESRS E3-1 
Water and marine resources 
paragraph 9
Indicator number 7 Table 
#2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
165-166
ESRS E3-1 
Dedicated policy paragraph 13
Indicator number 8 Table 
2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
165-166
ESRS E3-1 
Sustainable oceans and seas 
paragraph 14
Indicator number 12 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS E3-4 
Total water recycled and reused 
paragraph 28 (c)
Indicator number 6.2 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS E3-4 
Total water consumption in m 3 
per net revenue on own operations 
paragraph 29
Indicator number 6.1 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS 2- SBM 3 - E4 paragraph 16 (a) i
Indicator number 7 Table 
#1 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS 2- SBM 3 - E4 paragraph 16 (b)
Indicator number 10 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS 2- SBM 3 - E4 paragraph 16 (c)
Indicator number 14 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS E4-2 
Sustainable land/agriculture practices 
or policies paragraph 24 (b)
Indicator number 11 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
170-171
ESRS E4-2 
Sustainable oceans/seas practices or 
policies paragraph 24 (c)
Indicator number 12 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS E4-2 
Policies to address deforestation 
paragraph 24 (d)
Indicator number 15 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
170-171
ESRS E5-5 
Non-recycled waste paragraph 37 (d)
Indicator number 13 
Table #2 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS E5-5 
Hazardous waste and radioactive 
waste paragraph 39
Indicator number 9 Table 
#1 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
Disclosure Requirement and 
related datapoint
SFDR Reference
Pillar 3 Reference
Benchmark Regulation 
Reference
EU Climate 
Law 
Reference
Material/Not 
Material
Page 
Number
ESRS 2- SBM3 - S1 
Risk of incidents of forced labour 
paragraph 14 (f)
Indicator number 13 
Table #3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS 2- SBM3 - S1 
Risk of incidents of child labour 
paragraph 14 (g)
Indicator number 12 
Table #3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS S1-1 
Human rights policy commitments 
paragraph 20
Indicator number 9 Table 
#3 and Indicator number 
11 Table #1 of Annex I
 
 
 
Material
190
ESRS S1-1 
Due diligence policies on issues 
addressed by the fundamental 
International Labor Organisation 
Conventions 1 to 8, paragraph 21
 
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Material
190
ESRS S1-1 
processes and measures for 
preventing trafficking in human 
beings paragraph 22
Indicator number 11 
Table #3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Material
186
ESRS S1-1 
workplace accident prevention policy 
or management system paragraph 
23
Indicator number 1 Table 
#3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Material
 189
ESRS S1-3 
grievance/complaints handling 
mechanisms paragraph 32 (c)
Indicator number 5 Table 
#3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Material
192
ESRS S1-14 
Number of fatalities and number 
and rate of work-related accidents 
paragraph 88 (b) and (c)
Indicator number 2 Table 
#3 of Annex I
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Material
204
ESRS S1-14 
Number of days lost to injuries, 
accidents, fatalities or illness 
paragraph 88 (e)
Indicator number 3 Table 
#3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Material
204
ESRS S1-16 
Unadjusted gender pay gap 
paragraph 97 (a)
Indicator number 12 
Table #1 of Annex I
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Material
202
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
228
229
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Appendix
Disclosure Requirement and 
related datapoint
SFDR Reference
Pillar 3 Reference
Benchmark Regulation 
Reference
EU Climate 
Law 
Reference
Material/Not 
Material
Page 
Number
ESRS S1-16 
Excessive CEO pay ratio paragraph 
97 (b)
Indicator number 8 Table 
#3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Material
 202
ESRS S1-17 
Incidents of discrimination paragraph 
103 (a)
Indicator number 7 Table 
#3 of Annex I
 
 
 
Material
 205
ESRS S1-17 Non-respect of UNGPs 
on Business and Human Rights and 
OECD Guidelines paragraph 104 (a)
Indicator number 10 
Table #1 and Indicator n. 
14 Table #3 of Annex I
 
Delegated Regulation 
(EU) 2020/1816, Annex II 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818 Art 12 (1)
 
Material
 205
ESRS 2- SBM3 – S2 
Significant risk of child labour or 
forced labour in the value chain 
paragraph 11 (b)
Indicators number 12 
and n. 13 Table #3 of 
Annex I
 
 
 
Material
207
ESRS S2-1 
Human rights policy commitments 
paragraph 17
Indicator number 9 Table 
#3 and Indicator n. 11 
Table #1 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
 208
ESRS S2-1  
Policies related to value chain 
workers paragraph 18
Indicator number 11 and 
n. 4 Table #3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
208
ESRS S2-1 
Non-respect of UNGPs on Business 
and Human Rights principles and 
OECD guidelines paragraph 19
Indicator number 10 
Table #1 of Annex 1
 
Delegated Regulation 
(EU) 2020/1816, Annex II 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Art 12 (1)
 
Material
208
ESRS S2-1 
Due diligence policies on issues 
addressed by the fundamental 
International Labor Organisation 
Conventions 1 to 8, paragraph 19
 
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II
 
Material
208
ESRS S2-4 
Human rights issues and incidents 
connected to its upstream and 
downstream value chain paragraph 
36
Indicator number 14 
Table #3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
210
Disclosure Requirement and 
related datapoint
SFDR Reference
Pillar 3 Reference
Benchmark Regulation 
Reference
EU Climate 
Law 
Reference
Material/Not 
Material
Page 
Number
ESRS S3-1 
Human rights policy commitments 
paragraph 16
Indicator number 9 
Table #3 of Annex 1 and 
Indicator number 11 
Table #1 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
 -
ESRS S3-1 
Non-respect of UNGPs on Business 
and Human Rights, ILO principles or 
OECD guidelines paragraph 17
Indicator number 10 
Table #1 Annex 1
 
Delegated Regulation 
(EU) 2020/1816, Annex II 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Art 12 (1)
 
Not Material
-
ESRS S3-4 
Human rights issues and incidents 
paragraph 36
Indicator number 14 
Table #3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
- 
ESRS S4-1 Policies related to 
consumers and end-users paragraph 
16
Indicator number 9 Table 
#3 and Indicator number 
11 Table #1 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Material
 214 and 220
ESRS S4-1 
Non-respect of UNGPs on Business 
and Human Rights and OECD 
guidelines paragraph 17
Indicator number 10 
Table #1 of Annex 1
 
Delegated Regulation 
(EU) 2020/1816, Annex II 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1818, Art 12 (1)
 
Not Material
-
ESRS S4-4 
Human rights issues and incidents 
paragraph 35
Indicator number 14 
Table #3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS G1-1 
United Nations Convention against 
Corruption paragraph 10 (b)
Indicator number 15 
Table #3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS G1-1 
Protection of whistle- blowers 
paragraph 10 (d)
Indicator number 6 Table 
#3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
ESRS G1-4 
Fines for violation of anti-corruption 
and anti-bribery laws paragraph 24 
(a)
Indicator number 17 
Table #3 of Annex 1
 
Delegated Regulation (EU) 
2020/1816, Annex II)
 
Not Material
-
ESRS G1-4 
Standards of anti- corruption and 
anti- bribery paragraph 24 (b)
Indicator number 16 
Table #3 of Annex 1
 
 
 
Not Material
-
 
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
230
231
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Appendix
2. Index of compliance with disclosure requirements
ESRS 2 IRO-2 – Disclosure Requirements in ESRS covered by the undertaking’s sustainability statement
The following table covers general disclosure requirements and disclosure requirements for the topics that were 
deemed to be material following the double materiality assessment.
ESRS
Material DR
Description
Page 
Number
ESRS 2 – General Disclosures
ESRS 2
BP-1
General basis for preparation of sustainability statement
131
BP-2
Disclosures in relation to specific circumstances
131
GOV-1
The role of the administrative, management and supervisory bodies
133
GOV-2
Information provided to and sustainability matters addressed by the 
undertaking’s administrative, management and supervisory bodies
134
GOV-3
Integration of sustainability-related performance in incentive schemes
135
GOV-4
Statement on due diligence
135
GOV-5
Risk management and internal controls over sustainability reporting
136
SBM-1
Strategy, business model and value chain
137
SBM-2
Interests and views of stakeholders
138
SBM-3
Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interaction with 
strategy and business model
137 and 142
IRO-1
Description of the processes to identify and assess material impacts, 
risks and opportunities
140
IRO-2
Disclosure Requirements in ESRS covered by the undertaking’s 
sustainability statement
230
E1 – Climate Change
ESRS E1
ESRS 2 GOV-3 
– E1
Integration of sustainability-related performance in incentive schemes
135
E1-1
Transition plan for climate change mitigation
147
ESRS 2 SBM-3 
– E1
Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interaction with 
strategy and business model
156
ESRS 2 IRO-1 
– E1
Description of the processes to identify and assess material climate-
related impacts, risks and opportunities
146 and 151
E1-2
Policies related to climate change mitigation and adaptation
157
E1-3
Actions and resources in relation to climate change policies
147
E1-4
Targets related to climate change mitigation and adaptation
158
E1-5
Energy consumption and mix
159
E1-6
Gross Scopes 1, 2, 3 and Total GHG emissions
160-164
E1-7
GHG removals and GHG mitigation projects financed through  
carbon credits
164
E1-8
Internal carbon pricing
164
ESRS
Material DR
Description
Page 
Number
E3 – Water and Marine Resources
ESRS E3
ESRS 2  
IRO-1 – E3
Description of the processes to identify and assess material water and 
marine resources-related impacts, risks and opportunities
165
E3-1
Policies related to water and marine resources
165
E3-2
Actions and resources related to water and marine resources
166
E3-3
Targets related to water and marine resources
168
E4 – Biodiversity and Ecosystems
ESRS E4
E4-1
Transition plan and consideration of biodiversity and ecosystems in 
strategy and business model
170
ESRS 2  
SBM-3 – E4
Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interaction with 
strategy and business model
170
ESRS 2  
IRO-1– E4
Description of processes to identify and assess material biodiversity 
and ecosystem-related impacts, risks and opportunities
169
E4-2
Policies related to biodiversity and ecosystems
170
E4-3
Actions and resources related to biodiversity and ecosystems
171
E4-4
Targets related to biodiversity and ecosystems
173
E4-5
Impact metrics related to biodiversity and ecosystems change
173
E5 - Resource Use and Circular Economy
ESRS E5
ESRS 2  
IRO-1 – E5
Description of the processes to identify and assess material resource 
use and circular economy-related impacts, risks and opportunities
175
E5-1
Policies related to resource use and circular
176
E5-2
Actions and resources related to resource use and circular economy
176
E5-3
Targets related to resource use and circular economy
177
S1 – Own Workforce
ESRS S1
ESRS 2  
SBM-2 – S1
Interests and views of stakeholders
191
ESRS 2  
SBM-3 – S1
Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interaction with 
strategy and business model
188
S1-1
Policies related to own workforce
189
S1-2
Processes for engaging with own workforce and workers’ 
representatives about impacts
191
S1-3
Processes to remediate negative impacts and channels for own 
workforce to raise concerns
192
S1-4
Taking action on material impacts on own workforce, and approaches 
to managing material risks and pursuing material opportunities 
related to own workforce, and effectiveness of those actions
192
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
232
233
Sustainability Statement
Sustainability Statement Appendix
ESRS
Material DR
Description
Page 
Number
S1 – Own Workforce
ESRS S1
S1-5
Targets related to managing material negative impacts, advancing 
positive impacts, and managing material risks and opportunities
196
S1-6
Characteristics of the undertaking’s employees
197
S1-7
Characteristics of non-employees in the undertaking’s own workforce
200
S1-8
Collective bargaining coverage and social dialogue
200
S1-9
Diversity metrics
199
S1-10
Adequate wages
201
S1-11
Social protection
201
S1-13
Training and skills development metrics
202
S1-14
Health and safety metrics
203
S1-16
Remuneration metrics (pay gap and total remuneration)
202
S1-17
Incidents, complaints and severe human rights impacts
205
S2 – Workers in the Value Chain
ESRS S2
ESRS 2  
SBM-2 – S2
Interests and views of stakeholders
208
ESRS 2  
SBM-3 – S2
Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interaction with 
strategy and business model
207
S2-1
Policies related to value chain workers
208
S2-2
Processes for engaging with value chain workers about impacts
209
S2-3
Processes to remediate negative impacts and channels for value chain 
workers to raise concerns
209
S2-4
Taking action on material impacts on value chain workers, and 
approaches to managing material risks and pursuing material 
opportunities related to value chain workers, and effectiveness of 
those actions
210
S2-5
Targets related to managing material negative impacts, advancing 
positive impacts, and managing material risks and opportunities	
212
S4 – Consumers and End-Users
ESRS S4
ESRS 2 SBM-2 
– S4
Interests and views of stakeholders
215 and 221
ESRS 2 SBM-3 
– S4
Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interaction with 
strategy and business model
214 and 220
S4-1
Policies related to consumers and end-users
214 and 220
S4-2
Processes for engaging with consumers and end-users about impacts
215 and 221
S4-3
Processes to remediate negative impacts and channels for consumers 
and end-users to raise concerns
216 and 221
S4 – Consumers and End-Users
ESRS Disclosure Requirement
Full name of Disclosure Requirement
ESRS 2 SBM-1 40 b and c
Strategy, business model and value chain
ESRS 2 SBM-3 48 e
Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interaction with strategy  
and business model
E1-9
Anticipated financial effects from material physical and transition risks and 
potential climate-related opportunities
E3-5
Anticipated financial effects from water and marine resources-related risks  
and opportunities
E4-6
Anticipated financial effects from biodiversity and ecosystem-related risks  
and opportunities
E5-6
Anticipated financial effects from resource use and circular economy-related risks 
and opportunities
S1-12
Persons with disabilities
S1-15
Work-life balance
ESRS
Material DR
Description
Page 
Number
ESRS S4
S4-4
Taking action on material impacts on consumers and end-users, 
and approaches to managing material risks and pursuing material 
opportunities related to consumers and end-users, and effectiveness 
of those actions
216 and 221
S4-5
Targets related to managing material negative impacts, advancing 
positive impacts, and managing material risks and opportunities
219 and 222
3. Disclosures for which phase-in reliefs have been availed of within this Sustainability Statement
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements
234
FINANCIAL  
STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
Report on the audit of the  
financial statements
Opinion
In our opinion, Kerry Group plc’s Consolidated 
financial statements and Company financial 
statements (the “financial statements”):
–	 give a true and fair view of the Group’s and the 
Company’s assets, liabilities and financial position 
as at 31 December 2024 and of the Group’s profit 
and the Group’s and the Company’s cash flows for 
the year then ended;
–	 have been properly prepared in accordance with 
International Financial Reporting Standards 
(“IFRSs”) as adopted by the European Union and, 
as regards the Company’s financial statements, as 
applied in accordance with the provisions of the 
Companies Act 2014; and
–	 have been properly prepared in accordance with 
the requirements of the Companies Act 2014 and, 
as regards the Consolidated financial statements, 
Article 4 of the IAS Regulation.
We have audited the financial statements, included 
within the Annual Report 2024 (“Annual Report”), 
which comprise: 
 
–	 the Consolidated and Company Balance Sheets as 
at 31 December 2024;
–	 the Consolidated Income Statement and 
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive 
Income for the year then ended;
–	 the Consolidated and Company Statements of 
Cash Flows for the year then ended;
–	 the Consolidated and Company Statements of 
Changes in Equity for the year then ended; and
–	 the notes to the financial statements, which 
include a description of the accounting policies.
Certain required disclosures have been presented 
elsewhere in the Annual Report, rather than in the 
notes to the financial statements. These are cross-
referenced from the financial statements and are 
identified as audited.
Our opinion is consistent with our reporting to the 
Audit Committee.
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT
Independent auditors’ report to  
the members of Kerry Group plc
Separate opinion in relation to IFRS 
Accounting Standards as issued by the 
International Accounting Standards Board
As explained in note 1 to the financial statements, 
the Group, in addition to applying IFRSs as adopted 
by the European Union, has also applied IFRS 
Accounting Standards as issued by the International 
Accounting Standards Board (IASB).
In our opinion, the Consolidated financial 
statements comply with IFRS Accounting Standards 
as issued by the IASB.
 
Basis for opinion
We conducted our audit in accordance with 
International Standards on Auditing (Ireland) (“ISAs 
(Ireland)”) and applicable law. Our responsibilities 
under ISAs (Ireland) are further described in the 
Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of the financial 
statements section of our report. We believe that the 
audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and 
appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.
Independence
We remained independent of the Group in 
accordance with the ethical requirements that are 
relevant to our audit of the financial statements in 
Ireland, which includes IAASA’s Ethical Standard as 
applicable to listed public interest entities, and we 
have fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in 
accordance with these requirements.
To the best of our knowledge and belief, we declare 
that non-audit services prohibited by IAASA’s  
Ethical Standard were not provided to the Group  
or the Company.
Other than those disclosed in note 3 to the financial 
statements, we have provided no other services to 
the Group or the Company in the period from  
1 January 2024 to 31 December 2024.
 
 
235
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
Our audit approach
Overview
	
Overall materiality
	
–	 €41.7 million (2023: €40 million) - Consolidated financial statements.
	
–	 Based on approximately 5% of profit before taxation and non-trading items 
from continuing operations.
	
–	 €31.5 million (2023: €14.4 million) - Company financial statements.
	
–	 Based on approximately 1% of net assets.
	
Performance materiality
	
–	 €31.2 million (2023: €30 million) - Consolidated financial statements.
	
–	 €23.6 million (2023: €10.8 million) - Company financial statements.
	
Audit scope
	
–	 We conducted audit work in 33 reporting components. We selected these 
components due to their size or characteristics and to ensure appropriate audit 
coverage. An audit of the complete financial information of 19 components 
was performed. Specific audit procedures on certain balances and transactions 
were also performed at a further 14 components. We have audited centrally the 
external debt and derivatives which are managed by the central Treasury function 
and the defined benefit post-retirement schemes within Ireland and the UK. We 
also performed audit work at each of the Group’s principal shared service centres.
	
–	 The reporting components where an audit of the complete financial information 
was performed accounted for in excess of 75% of Consolidated revenue from 
continuing operations and in excess of 75% of Consolidated profit before taxation 
and non-trading items from continuing operations.
	
Key audit matters
	
–	 Goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets impairment assessment (Group).
	
–	 Income taxes (Group).
	
–	 Disposal of Kerry Dairy Ireland (Group and Company).
	
–	 Recoverability of Investments in Subsidiaries (Company). 
The scope of our audit
As part of designing our audit, we determined materiality and assessed the risks of material misstatement 
in the financial statements. In particular, we looked at where the directors made subjective judgements, for 
example in respect of significant accounting estimates that involved making assumptions and considering 
future events that are inherently uncertain. As in all of our audits we also addressed the risk of management 
override of internal controls, including evaluating whether there was evidence of bias by the directors that 
represented a risk of material misstatement due to fraud. 
Key audit matters
Key audit matters are those matters that, in the auditors’ professional judgement, were of most significance in the 
audit of the financial statements of the current period and include the most significant assessed risks of material 
misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) identified by the auditors, including those which had the greatest effect 
on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the engagement 
team. These matters, and any comments we make on the results of our procedures thereon, were addressed in 
the context of our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not 
provide a separate opinion on these matters. This is not a complete list of all risks identified by our audit. 
Key audit matter
How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets 
impairment assessment (Group) 
(continued)
Goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets are 
subject to impairment testing on an annual basis or 
more frequently if there are indicators of impairment. 
Management carried out an impairment test as at 
31 December 2024 and concluded there was no 
impairment.
We determined this to be a key audit matter given the 
scale of the assets and because the determination 
of whether an impairment charge for goodwill or 
indefinite life intangible assets was necessary involves 
significant judgement in estimating the future 
results of the business, which includes the cash flows 
(including revenue growth rates and EBITDA margin 
percentages) and long term growth rate assumptions, 
and determining the appropriate discount rate to use.
We assessed the appropriateness of the Group’s 
long term growth rate assumptions used to calculate 
terminal values at year five, by comparing them to 
independent sources (for example OECD statistics) of 
projected growth rates for each region.
We used our in-house valuation experts in assessing 
management’s calculation of the discount rates. 
Our experts developed a range of discount rates 
(adjusted to reflect risks associated with each group 
of CGUs) using observable inputs from independent 
external sources.
We also considered management’s sensitivity analysis 
which included the potential impact of the current 
macro-economic environment and climate related 
events and performed our own sensitivity analysis 
on the impact of changes in key assumptions on the 
impairment assessment, for example the cash flows 
(including revenue growth rates and EBITDA margin 
percentages), discount rates and the long term rates 
of growth assumed by management.  
Based on our procedures we determined that 
management’s conclusion that there was no  
goodwill or indefinite life intangible assets 
impairment was reasonable.
We assessed the appropriateness of the related 
disclosures within the financial statements and 
consider the disclosures, including the assessed 
impact of climate change on the impairment 
assessment to be reasonable.
Income taxes (Group)
Refer to note 1 ‘Statement of accounting policies’ - 
“Income taxes” and “Critical accounting estimates 
and judgements”, note 7 ‘Income taxes’ and note 18 
‘Deferred tax assets and liabilities’. 
The global nature of the Group means that it operates 
across many jurisdictions and is subject to periodic 
challenges by local tax authorities on a range of tax 
matters during the normal course of business. Tax 
legislation is open to different interpretations and 
the tax treatments of many items are uncertain. Tax 
audits can require several years to conclude, and 
transfer pricing judgements by tax authorities may 
impact the Group’s tax liabilities. 
Management judgement and estimation is required 
in the measurement of uncertain tax positions in the 
context of the recognition of current and deferred tax 
assets/liabilities.
We determined this to be a key audit matter due 
to its inherent complexity and the estimation and 
judgement involved in the measurement of uncertain 
tax positions in the context of the recognition of 
current and deferred tax assets/liabilities.	
We obtained an understanding of the Group tax 
strategy through discussions with management and 
the Group’s in-house tax specialists.
The team, assisted by PwC International and Irish 
taxation specialists, challenged judgements used 
and estimates made by management to measure 
uncertain tax positions in the context of the 
recognition of current and deferred tax assets/ 
liabilities. This included obtaining explanations 
regarding the tax treatment applied to material 
transactions and evidence to corroborate 
management’s explanations. Such evidence, where 
appropriate, included management’s communications 
with local tax authorities and copies of the tax advice 
obtained by management from its external tax 
advisors including transfer pricing studies.
We also considered any tax developments during the 
financial year, including outcomes of concluded tax 
authority audits.
Based on the evidence obtained, while noting the 
inherent uncertainty with such tax matters, we 
determined the measurement of uncertain tax 
positions in the context of the recognition of  
current and deferred tax assets/liabilities as at  
31 December 2024 to be within an acceptable  
range of reasonable estimates.
Key audit matter
How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets 
impairment assessment (Group)
Refer to note 1 ‘Statement of accounting policies’ 
- “Intangible assets”, “Impairment of non-financial 
assets”, “Critical accounting estimates and 
judgements” and note 13 ‘Intangible assets’.
The Group has goodwill and indefinite life 
intangible assets of €4,950.7 million at 31 
December 2024 representing approximately 40% 
of the Group’s total assets at year end.
Our audit team, assisted by our in-house valuation 
experts, considered the Group’s impairment models 
and evaluated the methodology followed and key 
assumptions used. We tested the mathematical accuracy 
of the underlying calculations in the models.
We assessed management’s future cash flow forecasts, 
and the process by which they were drawn up, including 
comparing them to the latest board approved budgets. 
In evaluating these forecasts we considered the Group’s 
historic performance and its past record of achieving 
strategic objectives, and management’s assessment 
of the likely impact the current macro-economic 
environment and climate related risks may have on 
financial performance.
	
236
237
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
Key audit matter
How our audit addressed the key audit matter
Disposal of Kerry Dairy Ireland  
(Group and Company)
Refer to note 1 ‘Statement of accounting policies’ - 
“Discontinued operations”, note 5 ‘Non-trading items’, 
note 8 ‘Discontinued operation’, note 24 ‘Analysis 
of financial instruments by category’ and note 25 ‘ 
Financial instruments’. 
On 12 November 2024, the Group announced that it 
has entered into an agreement with Kerry Co-Operative 
Creameries Limited (the ‘Co-Op’) in relation to the sale 
of the Group’s shareholding in Kerry Dairy Holdings 
(Ireland) Limited (“Kerry Dairy Ireland”), to be completed 
in two phases. 
On 31 December 2024, the Group completed phase 
one of the sale which resulted in the disposal of 70% 
of its shareholding in Kerry Dairy Ireland. The profit 
on disposal (before tax) recorded in the Consolidated 
financial statements amounted to €24.2 million and 
has been classified within ‘Non-trading items’.  Included 
within ‘Other non-current financial instruments’ in the 
Consolidated and Company financial statements is 
other financial assets of €148.5 million relating to the 
retained 30% shareholding. 
The disposal is accounted for and disclosed in 
accordance with the requirements of IFRS 5 -  
‘Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued 
Operations’. The retained investment has been 
accounted for in accordance with IFRS 9 -  
‘Financial Instruments’. 
We determined the accounting for the disposal to 
be a key audit matter due to the significance of the 
transaction and the impact that the disposal has on 
the presentation of the financial statements.
We read and understood the terms of the  
disposal and related agreements.
We assessed management’s determination  
that the business met the definition of a 
discontinued operation (for disposals) in accordance 
with IFRS 5 - ‘Non-current Assets Held for Sale and 
Discontinued Operations’. 
We tested the calculation of the profit recognised on 
disposal and the classification of that profit within 
‘Non-trading items’ in the consolidated financial 
statements.
We evaluated the accounting for the €148.5 
million other financial asset for the retained 30% 
shareholding as a financial instrument measured 
at fair value through profit and loss in accordance 
with IFRS 9 - Financial Instruments. We focused on 
the Group’s conclusion that no significant influence 
exists, considering the decision-making rights 
arising from the 30% shareholding and the effect 
of the immediately exercisable call option held by 
the Co-Op. We also evaluated whether the Group’s 
entitlement to a dividend of €7.5 million per annum 
was fixed. 
We assessed the appropriateness of the  
presentation of and accounting for the disposal 
within the financial statements and determined  
them to be reasonable.
Recoverability of Investments in Subsidiaries 
(Company)
Refer to note 1 ‘Statement of accounting policies’ 
- “Investments in subsidiaries” and note 16 
‘Investments in subsidiaries’.
The Company has investments in subsidiaries of 
€1,049.8 million at 31 December 2024. The carrying 
value of the investments in subsidiaries needs to 
be considered for impairment where any indicators 
arise that suggest that the carrying value of these 
investments would not be recoverable. 
We determined this to be a key audit matter due to 
the significance of these investments in subsidiaries.
We considered management’s assessment as to 
whether there were any indicators of impairment 
at year end taking into account the market 
capitalisation of the Company and the procedures 
performed on the future cash flow forecasts 
prepared for the purposes of the impairment 
assessment as described in the “Goodwill and 
indefinite life intangible assets impairment 
assessment” key audit matter above. 
Based on our procedures we determined that 
management’s conclusion that there are no 
impairment indicators was reasonable.
We determined that an audit of the complete 
financial information (a “full scope” audit) should 
be performed at 19 components due to their size 
or risk characteristics and to ensure appropriate 
coverage. Specific audit procedures on certain 
balances and transactions were also performed at a 
further 14 components. The reporting components 
where an audit of the complete financial 
information was performed accounted for in excess 
of 75% of Consolidated revenues from continuing 
operations and in excess of 75% of Consolidated 
profit before taxation and non-trading items from 
continuing operations.
The Group team performed the audit of certain 
group and central functions. These procedures 
included, amongst others, procedures over IT 
systems, external debt and derivatives, defined 
benefit post-retirement schemes within Ireland 
and the UK, the consolidation process and key 
audit matters including uncertain tax positions, 
impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite 
life intangible assets and the accounting for the 
disposal of Kerry Dairy Ireland. Component auditors 
within PwC ROI and from other PwC network firms, 
operating under our instruction, performed the 
audit on all other in scope components and the 
required supporting audit work at each of the 
Group’s principal shared service centres.
The Group team was responsible for the scope 
and direction of the audit. Where the work was 
performed by component auditors, we determined 
the level of involvement the Group team needed 
to have to be able to conclude whether sufficient 
appropriate audit evidence had been obtained as a 
basis for our opinion on the consolidated financial 
statements as a whole. 
In the current year, the Group team continued a 
programme of site visits which are designed so 
that senior team members regularly visit the full 
scope audit locations on a rotational basis. During 
2024, the Group team visited component locations 
in Ireland, the United States, United Kingdom 
and Malaysia. In addition to site visits, senior 
members of the Group engagement team used 
video conferencing to facilitate our oversight of the 
component auditor work and had video meetings 
and discussions with certain management and 
component audit teams in locations that we did not 
visit in the current year. 
The meetings, both physical and virtual, with our 
component teams confirmed their audit approach. 
The meetings also involved discussing and 
understanding the significant audit risk areas and 
obtaining updates on local laws and regulations 
and other relevant matters. In addition to the 
meetings noted above, the Group team interacted 
regularly with the component teams during 
all stages of the audit. We received a detailed 
memorandum of examination on work performed 
and relevant findings in addition to an audit report 
that supplemented our understanding of the 
individual components. 
The Group engagement team also reviewed certain 
audit working papers in component audit files. 
Conference calls were held with all full scope audit 
teams to discuss their audit findings. 
This, together with audit procedures performed by 
the Group team gave us the evidence we needed for 
our opinion on the consolidated financial statements 
as a whole. 
Materiality
The scope of our audit was influenced by our 
application of materiality. We set certain quantitative 
thresholds for materiality. These, together with 
qualitative considerations, helped us to determine the 
scope of our audit and the nature, timing and extent 
of our audit procedures on the individual financial 
statement line items and disclosures and in evaluating 
the effect of misstatements, both individually and in 
aggregate on the financial statements as a whole. 
Based on our professional judgement, we 
determined materiality for the financial statements 
as a whole as follows:
Consolidated  
financial  
statements
Company 
financial 
statements
Overall 
materiality
€41.7 million  
(2023: €40 million).
€31.5 million 
(2023: €14.4 
million).
How we 
determined  
it
Approximately 5% of 
profit before taxation 
and non-trading 
items from continuing 
operations. 
Approximately 
1% of net 
assets.
Rationale for 
benchmark 
applied
We applied this 
benchmark because 
in our view this is 
a metric against 
which the recurring 
performance of the 
Group is commonly 
measured by its 
stakeholders and 
it results in using a 
materiality level that 
excludes the impact 
of non-recurring 
items which are 
not reflective of the 
Group’s ongoing 
trading activity.
The entity 
is a holding 
Company 
whose main 
activity is the 
management 
of investments 
in subsidiaries.
How we tailored the audit scope
We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we performed enough work to be able to give an opinion on 
the financial statements as a whole, taking into account the structure of the Group, the accounting processes 
and controls, including those performed at the Group’s shared service centres and the industry in which the 
Group operates. 
The Group is structured along two operating segments: Taste & Nutrition and Dairy Ireland. The majority of 
the Group’s components are supported by one of either of the Group’s principal shared service centres in 
Malaysia and Mexico. 
238
239
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
We use performance materiality to reduce to 
an appropriately low level the probability that 
the aggregate of uncorrected and undetected 
misstatements exceeds overall materiality. 
Specifically, we use performance materiality in 
determining the scope of our audit and the nature 
and extent of our testing of account balances, 
classes of transactions and disclosures, for example 
in determining sample sizes. Our performance 
materiality was 75% of overall materiality, amounting 
to €31.2 million (Group audit) and €23.6 million 
(Company audit).
In determining the performance materiality, we 
considered a number of factors - the history of 
misstatements, risk assessment and aggregation 
risk and the effectiveness of controls - and concluded 
that an amount at the upper end of our normal 
range was appropriate.
We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would 
report to them misstatements identified during our 
audit above €2.0 million (Group audit) (2023: €1.9 
million) and €1.58 million (Company audit) (2023: 
€720,000) as well as misstatements below that 
amount that, in our view, warranted reporting for 
qualitative reasons.
 
Conclusions relating to going concern
Our evaluation of the directors’ assessment of the 
Group and Company’s ability to continue to adopt 
the going concern basis of accounting included:
–	 evaluating the Directors’ going concern 
assessment (being the period of 12 months from 
the date on which the financial statements are 
authorised for issue) and challenging the key 
assumptions. In evaluating these forecasts, we 
considered the Group’s historic performance and 
its past record of achieving strategic objectives. 
Additionally we have considered management’s 
assessment of the likely impact which the current 
macroeconomic environment and climate related 
risks may have on financial performance and 
liquidity for a period of 12 months from the date 
on which the financial statements are authorised 
for issue;
–	 testing the mathematical integrity of the forecasts 
and the models and reconciling these to board 
approved budgets;
–	 considering whether the assumptions underlying 
the base case were consistent with related 
assumptions used in other areas of the entity’s 
business activities, for example in testing for non-
financial asset impairment;
–	 performing our own independent sensitivity 
analysis to assess further appropriate downside 
scenarios; and 
–	 considering the Group’s available liquidity, 
financing and maturity profile to assess liquidity 
through the going concern assessment period.
Corporate Governance Statement
The Listing Rules and ISAs (Ireland) require us to 
review the directors’ statements in relation to going 
concern, longer-term viability and that part of the 
Corporate Governance Statement relating to the 
Company’s compliance with the provisions of the UK 
Corporate Governance Code and the Irish Corporate 
Governance Annex (the “Code”) specified for our 
review. Our additional responsibilities with respect 
to the Corporate Governance Statement as other 
information are described in the Reporting on other 
information section of this report.
Based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, 
we have concluded that each of the following 
elements of the Corporate Governance Statement is 
materially consistent with the financial statements 
and our knowledge obtained during the audit and 
we have nothing material to add or draw attention 
to in relation to:
–	 The directors’ confirmation that they have carried 
out a robust assessment of the emerging and 
principal risks;
–	 The disclosures in the Annual Report that describe 
those principal risks, what procedures are in place 
to identify emerging risks and an explanation of 
how these are being managed or mitigated;
–	 The directors’ statement in the financial 
statements about whether they considered it 
appropriate to adopt the going concern basis 
of accounting in preparing them, and their 
identification of any material uncertainties to the 
Group’s and Company’s ability to continue to do 
so over a period of at least twelve months from 
the date of approval of the financial statements;
–	 The directors’ explanation as to their assessment 
of the Group’s and Company’s prospects, the 
period this assessment covers and why the period 
is appropriate; and
–	 The directors’ statement as to whether they have 
a reasonable expectation that the Company will 
be able to continue in operation and meet its 
liabilities as they fall due over the period of its 
assessment, including any related disclosures 
drawing attention to any necessary qualifications 
or assumptions.
Our review of the directors’ statement regarding the 
longer-term viability of the Group was substantially 
less in scope than an audit and only consisted of 
making inquiries and considering the directors’ 
process supporting their statement; checking that 
the statement is in alignment with the relevant 
provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code; 
and considering whether the statement is consistent 
with the financial statements and our knowledge and 
understanding of the Group and Company and their 
environment obtained in the course of the audit.
Based on the work we have performed, we 
have not identified any material uncertainties 
relating to events or conditions that, individually 
or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the 
Group’s or the Company’s ability to continue as 
a going concern for a period of at least twelve 
months from the date on which the financial 
statements are authorised for issue.
In auditing the financial statements, we have 
concluded that the directors’ use of the going 
concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the 
financial statements is appropriate.
However, because not all future events or conditions 
can be predicted, this conclusion is not a guarantee 
as to the Group’s or the Company’s ability to 
continue as a going concern.
In relation to the Company’s reporting on how they 
have applied the UK Corporate Governance Code, 
we have nothing material to add or draw attention 
to in relation to the directors’ statement in the 
financial statements about whether the directors 
considered it appropriate to adopt the going 
concern basis of accounting.
We are required to report if the directors’ statement 
relating to going concern in accordance with the 
Listing Rules for Euronext Dublin is materially 
inconsistent with our knowledge obtained in the 
audit. We have nothing to report in respect of this 
responsibility.
Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of 
the directors with respect to going concern are 
described in the relevant sections of this report.
 
Reporting on other information
The other information comprises all of the 
information in the Annual Report other than the 
financial statements and our auditors’ report 
thereon. The directors are responsible for the 
other information. Our opinion on the financial 
statements does not cover the other information 
and, accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion 
or, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in 
this report, any form of assurance thereon. 
In connection with our audit of the financial 
statements, our responsibility is to read the other 
information and, in doing so, consider whether 
the other information is materially inconsistent 
with the financial statements or our knowledge 
obtained in the audit, or otherwise appears to be 
materially misstated. If we identify an apparent 
material inconsistency or material misstatement, 
we are required to perform procedures to conclude 
whether there is a material misstatement of the 
financial statements or a material misstatement 
of the other information. If, based on the work 
we have performed, we conclude that there is a 
material misstatement of this other information, we 
are required to report that fact. We have nothing to 
report based on these responsibilities.
With respect to the Directors’ Report, we also 
considered whether the disclosures required by 
the Companies Act 2014 (excluding the information 
included in the “Non Financial Statement” and the 
sustainability reporting required by that Act on which 
we are not required to report) have been included.
Based on the responsibilities described above and 
our work undertaken in the course of the audit, 
ISAs (Ireland) and the Companies Act 2014 require 
us to also report certain opinions and matters as 
described below.
–	 In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in 
the course of the audit, the information given in 
the Directors’ Report (excluding the information 
included in the “Non Financial Statement” and 
the sustainability reporting on which we are 
not required to report) for the year ended 31 
December 2024 is consistent with the financial 
statements and has been prepared in accordance 
with the applicable legal requirements.
–	 Based on our knowledge and understanding of 
the Group and Company and their environment 
obtained in the course of the audit, we did 
not identify any material misstatements in the 
Directors’ Report (excluding the information 
included in the “Non Financial Statement” and 
the sustainability reporting on which we are not 
required to report).
–	 In our opinion, based on the work undertaken 
in the course of the audit of the financial 
statements,
	
-	 the description of the main features of the 
internal control and risk management systems 
in relation to the financial reporting process 
included in the Corporate Governance Report; 
and
	
- 	 the information required by Section 1373(2)
(d) of the Companies Act 2014 included in the 
Report of the Directors;
	
is consistent with the financial statements and has 
been prepared in accordance with section 1373(2) 
of the Companies Act 2014.
–	 Based on our knowledge and understanding of 
the Company and its environment obtained in the 
course of the audit of the financial statements, 
we have not identified material misstatements 
in the description of the main features of the 
internal control and risk management systems 
in relation to the financial reporting process 
and the information required by section 1373(2)
(d) of the Companies Act 2014 included in the 
Corporate Governance Report and the Report of 
the Directors.
–	 In our opinion, based on the work undertaken 
during the course of the audit of the financial 
statements, the information required by section 
1373(2)(a),(b),(e) and (f) of the Companies Act 
2014 and regulation 6 of the European Union 
(Disclosure of Non-Financial and Diversity 
Information by certain large undertakings and 
groups) Regulations 2017 is contained in the 
Corporate Governance Statement.
240
241
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
Financial Statements / Independent Auditors’ Report
In addition, based on the work undertaken as  
part of our audit, we have concluded that each  
of the following elements of the Corporate 
Governance Statement is materially consistent 
with the financial statements and our knowledge 
obtained during the audit:
–	 The directors’ statement that they consider 
the Annual Report, taken as a whole, is fair, 
balanced and understandable, and provides 
the information necessary for the members 
to assess the Group’s and Company’s position, 
performance, business model and strategy;
–	 The section of the Annual Report that describes 
the review of effectiveness of risk management 
and internal control systems; and
–	 The section of the Annual Report describing the 
work of the Audit Committee.
We have nothing to report in respect of our 
responsibility to report when the directors’ 
statement relating to the Company’s compliance 
with the Code does not properly disclose a departure 
from a relevant provision of the Code specified 
under the Listing Rules for review by the auditors.
 
Responsibilities for the financial statements 
and the audit
Responsibilities of the directors for the 
financial statements
As explained more fully in the Directors’ 
Responsibility Statement set out on pages 66-67, 
the directors are responsible for the preparation 
of the financial statements in accordance with the 
applicable framework and for being satisfied that 
they give a true and fair view. 
The directors are also responsible for such internal 
control as they determine is necessary to enable 
the preparation of financial statements that are free 
from material misstatement, whether due to fraud 
or error.
In preparing the financial statements, the directors 
are responsible for assessing the Group’s and the 
Company’s ability to continue as a going concern, 
disclosing as applicable, matters related to going 
concern and using the going concern basis of 
accounting unless the directors either intend  
to liquidate the Group or the Company or to  
cease operations, or have no realistic alternative  
but to do so.
Other required reporting
 
Companies Act 2014 opinions on  
other matters
–	 We have obtained all the information and 
explanations which we consider necessary for the 
purposes of our audit.
–	 In our opinion the accounting records of the 
Company were sufficient to permit the Company 
financial statements to be readily and properly 
audited.
–	 The Company Balance Sheet is in agreement with 
the accounting records.
 
Other exception reporting
Directors’ remuneration and transactions
Under the Companies Act 2014 we are required to 
report to you if, in our opinion, the disclosures of 
directors’ remuneration and transactions specified 
by sections 305 to 312 of that Act have not been 
made. We have no exceptions to report arising from 
this responsibility. 
We are required by the Listing Rules to review 
the six specified elements of disclosures in the 
report to shareholders by the Board on directors’ 
remuneration. We have no exceptions to report 
arising from this responsibility.
Prior financial year Non Financial Statement
We are required to report if the Company has not 
provided the information required by Regulation 
5(2) to 5(7) of the European Union (Disclosure of 
Non-Financial and Diversity Information by certain 
large undertakings and groups) Regulations 2017 in 
respect of the prior financial year. We have nothing 
to report arising from this responsibility.
Prior financial year Remuneration Report
We are required to report if the Company has not 
provided the information required by Section 1110N 
of the Companies Act 2014 in respect of the prior 
financial year. We have nothing to report arising 
from this responsibility.
 
Appointment
We were appointed by the members on 28 April 
2016 to audit the financial statements for the 
year ended 31 December 2016 and subsequent 
financial periods. The period of total uninterrupted 
engagement is 9 years, covering the years ended 31 
December 2016 to 31 December 2024. 
Paul Barrie
for and on behalf of PricewaterhouseCoopers
Chartered Accountants and Statutory Audit Firm
Dublin
17 February 2025
Auditors’ responsibilities for the audit of the 
financial statements
Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance 
about whether the financial statements as a whole 
are free from material misstatement, whether due 
to fraud or error, and to issue an auditors’ report 
that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a 
high level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that 
an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (Ireland) 
will always detect a material misstatement when it 
exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error 
and are considered material if, individually or in the 
aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to 
influence the economic decisions of users taken on 
the basis of these financial statements.
Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of 
non-compliance with laws and regulations. We 
design procedures in line with our responsibilities, 
outlined above, to detect material misstatements in 
respect of irregularities, including fraud. The extent 
to which our procedures are capable of detecting 
irregularities, including fraud, is detailed below.
Based on our understanding of the Group and 
industry, we identified that the principal risks of 
non-compliance with laws and regulations related 
to breaches of environmental regulations, food 
safety and hygiene regulations and health and 
safety regulations, and we considered the extent 
to which non-compliance might have a material 
effect on the financial statements. We also 
considered those laws and regulations that have 
a direct impact on the preparation of the financial 
statements such as the Irish Companies Act 2014 
and tax legislation. We evaluated management’s 
incentives and opportunities for fraudulent 
manipulation of the financial statements (including 
the risk of override of controls), and determined 
that the principal risks were related to posting 
inappropriate journal entries to manipulate 
financial results and potential management bias in 
accounting estimates. Audit procedures performed 
by the engagement team included:
–	 Discussions with the Audit Committee, 
management, legal and internal audit including 
any known or suspected instances of non-
compliance with laws and regulations and fraud;
–	 Reading the meeting minutes of the Board of 
Directors, Audit, Risk Oversight, Governance and 
Nomination, Sustainability and Remuneration 
Committees;
–	 Considered the results of the audit procedures 
performed by component teams relating to 
compliance with applicable laws and regulations 
and to address assessed fraud risk;
–	 Considered the Group’s assessment of matters 
reported on the Group’s whistleblowing service 
referred to as the ‘Speak Up Programme’ and 
the results of the Ethics and Compliance Team’s 
investigation of matters raised in so far as they 
are related to the financial statements; 
–	 Inspection of internal audit reports in so far as 
they related to the financial statements; 
–	 Evaluating whether there was evidence of 
management bias that represents a risk of 
material misstatement due to fraud;
–	 Identifying and testing journal entries, including 
manual revenue entries, unusual account 
combinations and consolidation journals based 
on our risk assessment; and
–	 Designing audit procedures to incorporate 
elements of unpredictability around the nature 
and extent of audit procedures performed.
There are inherent limitations in the audit 
procedures described above. We are less likely to 
become aware of instances of non-compliance with 
laws and regulations that are not closely related to 
events and transactions reflected in the financial 
statements. Also, the risk of not detecting a material 
misstatement due to fraud is higher than the risk 
of not detecting one resulting from error, as fraud 
may involve deliberate concealment by, for example, 
forgery or intentional misrepresentations, or 
through collusion.
Our audit testing might include testing complete 
populations of certain transactions and balances, 
possibly using data auditing techniques. However, 
it typically involves selecting a limited number of 
items for testing, rather than testing complete 
populations. We will often seek to target particular 
items for testing based on their size or risk 
characteristics. In other cases, we will use audit 
sampling to enable us to draw a conclusion about 
the population from which the sample is selected.
A further description of our responsibilities for the 
audit of the financial statements is located on the 
IAASA website at:
https://www.iaasa.ie/getmedia/b2389013-1cf6-
458b-9b8f-a98202dc9c3a/Description_of_auditors_
responsibilities_for_audit.pdf
This description forms part of our auditors’ report.
Use of this report
This report, including the opinions, has been 
prepared for and only for the Company’s members 
as a body in accordance with section 391 of the 
Companies Act 2014 and for no other purpose. We 
do not, in giving these opinions, accept or assume 
responsibility for any other purpose or to any other 
person to whom this report is shown or into whose 
hands it may come save where expressly agreed by 
our prior consent in writing.
242
243
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT
for the financial year ended 31 December 2024	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Re-presented*
Notes
Before 
Non- 
Trading 
Items
2024
€’m
Non- 
Trading 
Items
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Before 
Non- 
Trading 
Items
2023
€’m
Non- 
Trading 
Items
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Continuing operations
Revenue
2
6,929.1
-
6,929.1
6,974.9
-
6,974.9
Earnings before interest, tax, depreciation  
and amortisation
2/3
1,188.0
-
1,188.0
1,111.7
-
1,111.7
Depreciation (net) and intangible asset amortisation
3
(299.4)
-
(299.4)
(277.5)
-
(277.5)
Non-trading items
5
-
(55.8)
(55.8)
-
8.1
8.1
Operating profit
3
888.6
(55.8)
832.8
834.2
8.1
842.3
Finance income
6
34.8
-
34.8
21.8
-
21.8
Finance costs
6
(88.3)
-
(88.3)
(71.8)
-
(71.8)
Share of joint ventures’ results after taxation 
15
(0.9)
-
(0.9)
(1.9)
-
(1.9)
Profit before taxation
834.2
(55.8)
778.4
782.3
8.1
790.4
Income taxes
5/7
(117.2)
12.2
(105.0)
(98.4)
8.7
(89.7)
Profit from continuing operations
717.0
(43.6)
673.4
683.9
16.8
700.7
Discontinued operations
Profit from discontinued operations
5/8
33.2
27.8
61.0
26.8
0.6
27.4
Profit after taxation
750.2
(15.8)
734.4
710.7
17.4
728.1
Attributable to:
Equity holders of the parent - continuing operations
673.4
700.9
Equity holders of the parent - discontinued operations
61.0
27.4
Non-controlling interests - continuing operations
-
(0.2)
734.4
728.1
Earnings per A ordinary share 
Cent
Cent
Basic Earnings Per Share (cent)
Continuing operations
10
389.2
395.0
Discontinued operations
10
35.3
15.4
424.5
410.4
Diluted Earnings Per Share (cent)
Continuing operations
10
388.6
394.3
Discontinued operations
10
35.2
15.4
423.8
409.7
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.	
	
	
	
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME 
for the financial year ended 31 December 2024	
	
Re-presented*
Notes
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Profit after taxation
734.4
728.1
Other comprehensive income:
Items that are or may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss:
Fair value movements on cash flow hedges
1.8
(1.6)
Cash flow hedges - reclassified to profit or loss from equity
25
(1.9)
1.3
Net change in cost of hedging
25
0.6
0.1
Deferred tax effect of fair value movements on cash flow hedges
18
(0.5)
(0.4)
Exchange difference on translation of foreign operations
- Continuing operations
206.9
(129.0)
Cumulative exchange difference on translation recycled on disposal
- Continuing operations
5
0.4
(1.5)
- Discontinued operations
8
(0.6)
-
Items that will not be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss:
Re-measurement on retirement benefits obligation
27
10.8
(33.5)
Deferred tax effect of re-measurement on retirement benefits obligation
18
(2.9)
7.1
Net income/(expense) recognised directly in total other comprehensive income 
214.6
(157.5)
Total comprehensive income
949.0
570.6
Attributable to:
Equity holders of the parent - continuing operations
888.6
543.4
Equity holders of the parent - discontinued operations
60.4
27.4
Non-controlling interests - continuing operations
-
(0.2)
949.0
570.6
	
	
	
	
	
	
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.	
244
245
244
245
Financial Statements
Financial Statements
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
as at 31 December 2024
	
Notes
31 December
2024
€’m
31 December
2023
€’m
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment
12
2,106.7
2,133.0
Intangible assets
13
5,778.1
5,749.8
Financial asset investments 
14
59.2
52.0
Investments in joint ventures
15
38.9
39.8
Other non-current financial instruments
24/25
295.7
125.0
Retirement benefits asset
27
100.7
98.0
Deferred tax assets
18
93.3
80.2
8,472.6
8,277.8
Current assets
Inventories
17
1,050.7
1,100.2
Trade and other receivables
20
1,235.5
1,279.0
Cash at bank and in hand
24
1,610.0
943.7
Other current financial instruments
24/25
113.6
13.7
Tax assets
26.6
-
Assets classified as held for sale
19
3.5
1.5
4,039.9
3,338.1
Total assets
12,512.5
11,615.9
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables
21
1,742.5
1,773.1
Borrowings and overdrafts
24/25
950.3
37.1
Other current financial instruments
24/25
32.3
7.5
Tax liabilities
179.0
173.0
Provisions
26
7.0
18.3
Deferred income
22
1.0
4.5
2,912.1
2,013.5
Non-current liabilities
Borrowings
24/25
2,482.7
2,432.6
Other non-current financial instruments
24/25
0.5
9.7
Retirement benefits obligation
27
33.4
49.7
Other non-current liabilities
23
134.2
132.4
Deferred tax liabilities
18
400.9
394.2
Provisions
26
50.6
46.4
Deferred income
22
10.8
14.6
3,113.1
3,079.6
Total liabilities
6,025.2
5,093.1
Net assets
6,487.3
6,522.8
Equity
Share capital
28
20.8
21.9
Share premium
1,879.2
398.7
Other reserves 
205.6
(44.6)
Retained earnings
4,380.2
6,145.3
Equity attributable to equity holders of the parent
6,485.8
6,521.3
Non-controlling interests
1.5
1.5
Total equity
6,487.3
6,522.8
	
	
	
	
The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 17 February 2025 and signed on its behalf by:		
	
	
Tom Moran, Chairman	
	
Edmond Scanlon, Chief Executive Officer	
COMPANY BALANCE SHEET 
as at 31 December 2024
Notes
31 December
2024
€’m
31 December
2023
€’m
Non-current assets
Investments in subsidiaries
16
1,049.8
1,058.5
Other non-current financial instruments 
24/25
148.5
-
1,198.3
1,058.5
Current assets
Cash at bank and in hand
24
-
-
Trade and other receivables
20
2,039.5
394.2
2,039.5
394.2
Total assets
3,237.8
1,452.7
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables
21
79.1
5.1
79.1
5.1
Non-current liabilities
Deferred income
22
-
-
-
-
Total liabilities
79.1
5.1
Net assets
3,158.7
1,447.6
Issued capital and reserves
Share capital
28
20.8
21.9
Share premium
1,879.2
398.7
Other reserves
197.1
154.1
Retained earnings
1,061.6
872.9
Shareholders’ equity
3,158.7
1,447.6
	
	
	
	
The Company earned a profit after taxation of €2,695.6m for the financial year ended 31 December 2024 (2023: €650.4m) as 
disclosed in note 9.
The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 17 February 2025 and signed on its behalf by:		
	
	
Tom Moran, Chairman	
	
Edmond Scanlon, Chief Executive Officer	
	
	
246
247
Financial Statements
Financial Statements
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
for the financial year ended 31 December 2024	
	
Attributable to equity holders of the parent
Notes
Share 
Capital
€’m
Share 
Premium
€’m
Other
Reserves
€’m
Retained 
Earnings
€’m
Total
€’m
Non-
controlling 
interests
€’m
Total 
equity
€’m
Group:
At 1 January 2023
22.1
398.7
64.3
5,736.8
6,221.9
1.7
6,223.6
Profit after taxation
-
-
-
 728.3 
728.3
(0.2)
728.1
Other comprehensive expense
-
-
(130.7)
(26.8)
(157.5)
-
(157.5)
Total comprehensive  
(expense)/income
-
-
(130.7)
701.5
570.8
(0.2)
570.6
Shares issued during the  
financial year
28
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Shares (purchased)/cancelled 
during the financial year
28
(0.2)
-
0.2
(101.7)
(101.7)
-
(101.7)
Dividends paid
11
-
-
-
(191.3)
(191.3)
-
(191.3)
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
21.6
-
21.6
-
21.6
At 31 December 2023
21.9
398.7
(44.6)
6,145.3
6,521.3
1.5
6,522.8
Profit after taxation
-
-
-
734.4
734.4
-
734.4
Other comprehensive income
-
-
207.2
7.4
214.6
-
214.6
Total comprehensive income
-
 - 
207.2
741.8
949.0
-
949.0
Shares issued during the  
financial year
28
2.1
1,480.5
-
-
1,482.6
-
1,482.6
Shares (purchased)/cancelled 
during the financial year
28
(3.2)
-
3.2
(2,301.7) (2,301.7)
-
(2,301.7)
Dividends paid
11
-
-
-
(205.2)
(205.2)
-
(205.2)
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
39.8
-
39.8
-
39.8
At 31 December 2024
20.8
1,879.2
205.6
4,380.2
6,485.8
1.5
6,487.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Other Reserves comprise the following:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Note
Capital 
Redemption 
Reserve
€’m
Other 
Undenominated 
Capital
€’m
Share-
Based 
Payment 
Reserve
€’m
Translation 
Reserve
€’m
Hedging 
Reserve
€’m
Cost of 
Hedging 
Reserve
€’m
Total
€’m
At 1 January 2023
1.7
0.3
130.3
(71.0)
4.5
(1.5)
64.3
Other comprehensive (expense)/
income
-
-
-
(130.5)
(0.3)
0.1
(130.7)
Shares cancelled during the 
financial year
0.2
-
-
-
-
-
0.2
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
21.6
-
-
-
21.6
At 31 December 2023
1.9
0.3
151.9
(201.5)
4.2
(1.4)
(44.6)
Other comprehensive  
income/(expense)
-
-
-
206.7
(0.1)
0.6
207.2
Shares cancelled during the 
financial year 
3.2
-
-
-
-
-
3.2
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
39.8
-
-
-
39.8
At 31 December 2024
5.1
0.3
191.7
5.2
4.1
(0.8)
205.6
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The nature and purpose of each reserve within shareholders’ equity is described in note 36.	
COMPANY STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
for the financial year ended 31 December 2024	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Share 
Capital
€’m
Share 
Premium
€’m
Other 
Reserves
€’m
Retained 
Earnings
€’m
Total
€’m
Company:
At 1 January 2023
22.1
398.7
132.3
515.5
1,068.6
Profit after taxation
9
-
-
-
650.4
650.4
Other comprehensive income
-
-
-
-
-
Total comprehensive income
-
-
-
650.4
650.4
Shares issued during the financial year
28
-
-
-
-
-
Shares (purchased)/cancelled during the 
financial year
28
(0.2)
-
0.2
(101.7)
(101.7)
Dividends paid
11
-
-
-
(191.3)
(191.3)
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
21.6
-
21.6
At 31 December 2023
21.9
398.7
154.1
872.9
1,447.6
Profit after taxation
9
-
-
-
2,695.6
2,695.6
Other comprehensive income
-
-
-
-
-
Total comprehensive income
 - 
-
-
2,695.6
2,695.6
Shares issued during the financial year
28
2.1
1,480.5
-
-
1,482.6
Shares (purchased)/cancelled during the 
financial year
28
(3.2)
-
3.2
(2,301.7)
(2,301.7)
Dividends paid
11
-
-
-
(205.2)
(205.2)
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
39.8
-
39.8
At 31 December 2024
20.8
1,879.2
197.1
1,061.6
3,158.7
	
Other Reserves comprise the following:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Note
Capital 
Redemption 
Reserve 
€’m
Other 
Undenominated 
Capital 
€’m
Share-Based 
Payment 
Reserve 
€’m
Total 
€’m
At 1 January 2023
1.7
0.3
130.3
132.3
Other comprehensive income 
-
-
-
-
Shares cancelled during the financial year
0.2
-
-
0.2
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
21.6
21.6
At 31 December 2023
1.9
0.3
151.9
154.1
Other comprehensive income 
-
-
-
-
Shares cancelled during the financial year
3.2
-
-
3.2
Share-based payment expense
29
-
-
39.8
39.8
At 31 December 2024
5.1
0.3
191.7
197.1
The nature and purpose of each reserve within shareholders’ equity is described in note 36.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
248
249
Financial Statements
Financial Statements
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS 
for the financial year ended 31 December 2024	
Notes
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before taxation
841.8
822.6
Adjustments for:
Depreciation (net)
234.8
219.6
Intangible asset amortisation
87.8
79.5
Share of joint ventures’ results after taxation 
15
0.9
1.9
Non-trading items income statement charge/(income)
5
31.6
(8.8)
Finance costs (net)
6/8
53.9
50.3
Change in working capital
30
(43.4)
185.5
Pension contributions paid less pension expense
(12.1)
(13.5)
Payments on non-trading items
(50.7)
(99.8)
Exchange translation adjustment
(3.8)
(14.2)
Cash generated from operations
1,140.8
1,223.1
Income taxes paid
(108.2)
(119.5)
Finance income received
23.8
13.9
Finance costs paid
(67.7)
(79.7)
Net cash from operating activities
988.7
1,037.8
Investing activities
Purchase of assets
30
(305.8)
(281.9)
(Outflow)/inflow from the sale of assets (net of disposal expenses)
5/8
(5.6)
11.6
Capital grants received
2.3
3.3
Purchase of businesses (net of cash acquired)
31
(166.4)
(131.1)
Payments relating to previous acquisitions
(1.6)
(9.7)
Purchase of investments
14
(1.8)
(3.0)
Disposal of businesses (net of disposal expenses)
5/8
(27.7)
316.4
Net cash used in investing activities
(506.6)
(94.4)
Financing activities
Dividends paid
11
(205.2)
(191.3)
Purchase of own shares
(556.5)
(101.7)
Payment of lease liabilities
30
(40.8)
(36.4)
Issue of share capital
28
-
-
Repayment of borrowings
30
(2.5)
(695.9)
Cash inflow from interest rate swaps on repayment of borrowings 
30
3.3
34.4
Proceeds from borrowings 
30
994.0
4.1
Net cash movement due to financing activities
192.3
(986.8)
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
674.4
(43.4)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the financial year
909.0
969.8
Exchange translation adjustment on cash and cash equivalents
24.2
(17.4)
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the financial year
30
1,607.6
909.0
Reconciliation of Net Cash Flow to Movement in Net Debt
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
674.4
(43.4)
Cash flow from debt financing
(994.8)
657.4
Changes in net debt resulting from cash flows 
(320.4)
614.0
Fair value movement on interest rate swaps (net of adjustment to borrowings)
30
3.4
1.0
Exchange translation adjustment on net debt
30
13.3
(2.3)
Movement in net debt in the financial year
(303.7)
612.7
Net debt at beginning of the financial year - pre lease liabilities
(1,535.5)
(2,148.2)
Net debt at end of the financial year - pre lease liabilities
24
(1,839.2)
(1,535.5)
Lease liabilities
12/30
(86.6)
(68.6)
Net debt at end of the financial year
24/30
(1,925.8)
(1,604.1)
	
	
	
COMPANY STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
for the financial year ended 31 December 2024	
Notes
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before taxation
2,692.5
645.9
Adjustments for:
Depreciation (net)
-
0.1
Non-trading items income statement income
(179.0)
-
Finance costs 
1.5 
-
Finance income
(5.6)
(4.2)
Change in working capital
30
(1,625.2)
(138.0)
Cash generated from operations
884.2
503.8
Finance income received
5.6
4.2
Net cash from operating activities
889.8
508.0
Investing activities
Investments in subsidiary undertakings
16
(123.9)
(215.0)
Disposal of businesses (net of disposal expenses)
(4.2)
-
Net cash used in investing activities
(128.1)
(215.0)
Financing activities
Dividends paid
11
(205.2)
(191.3)
Issue of share capital
28
-
-
Purchase of own shares 
(556.5)
(101.7)
Net cash movement due to financing activities
(761.7)
(293.0)
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents
-
-
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the financial year
-
-
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the financial year
30
-
-
250
251
Financial Statements
Financial Statements
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Basis of consolidation	
Subsidiaries	
The consolidated financial statements incorporate the 
financial statements of the Company and the entities 
controlled by the Company (its subsidiaries), all of 
which prepare financial statements up to 31 December. 
Accounting policies of subsidiaries are consistent with 
the policies adopted by the Group. Control is achieved 
where the Company has the power over the investee, 
has exposure or has rights to variable returns from its 
involvement with the investee and has the ability to use 
its power to affect its returns.	
The results of subsidiaries acquired or disposed of 
during the financial year are included in the Consolidated 
Income Statement from the date the Company gained 
control until the date the Company ceased to control the 
subsidiary. All inter-group transactions and balances are 
eliminated on consolidation. 
Non-controlling interests
Non-controlling interests represent the portion of the 
equity of a subsidiary not attributable either directly or 
indirectly to the Group and are presented separately in 
the Consolidated Income Statement and within equity 
in the Consolidated Balance Sheet, distinguished from 
the Group’s shareholders’ equity. Where not all of the 
equity of a subsidiary is acquired, the non-controlling 
interests are recognised at the non-controlling 
interest’s share of the acquiree’s net identifiable assets.
Joint ventures	
Joint ventures are all entities over which the Group has 
joint control, whereby the Group has rights to the net 
assets of the arrangement, rather than rights to its 
assets and obligations for its liabilities. Investments 
in joint ventures are accounted for using the equity 
method of accounting and are initially recognised at 
cost. On acquisition of the investment in joint venture, 
any excess of the cost of the investment over the 
Group’s share of the net fair value of the identifiable 
assets and liabilities of the investee is recognised as 
goodwill, which is included within the carrying value of 
the investment. 
The Group’s share of its joint ventures post-acquisition 
profits or losses is recognised in ‘Share of joint 
ventures’ results after taxation’ in the Consolidated 
Income Statement, and its share of post-acquisition 
movements in reserves is recognised in reserves until 
the date on which joint control ceases. The cumulative 
post-acquisition movements are adjusted against 
the carrying amount of the investment, less any 
impairment in value. Where indicators of impairment 
arise, the carrying amount of the joint venture is tested 
for impairment by comparing its recoverable amount 
with its carrying amount.
Unrealised gains arising from transactions with joint 
ventures are eliminated to the extent of the Group’s 
interest in the entity. Unrealised losses are eliminated 
to the extent that they do not provide evidence of 
impairment. The accounting policies of joint ventures 
are amended where necessary to ensure consistency of 
accounting treatment at Group level.
Revenue
Revenue represents the value of the consideration 
received or receivable, for both segments from third 
party customers. Revenue is recorded at invoice value, 
net of discounts, allowances, volume and promotional 
rebates and excludes VAT. Revenue is recognised when 
control of the products has transferred, which is usually 
upon shipment, or in line with terms agreed with 
individual customers. Revenue is recorded when there 
is no unfulfilled obligation on the part of the Group. An 
estimate is made on the basis of historical sales returns 
and is recorded to allocate these returns to the same 
period as the original revenue is recorded. Rebates 
and discounts are provided for based on agreements 
or contracts with customers, agreed promotional 
arrangements and accumulated experience using 
the expected value method. Any unutilised accrual is 
released after assessment that the likelihood of such 
a claim being made is highly improbable. Under IFRS 
15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ revenue 
is primarily recognised at a point in time. Revenue 
recorded over time during the year was not material to 
the Group. 
The Group disaggregates revenue by End Use Market 
(EUM) and primary geographic market. An EUM is 
defined as the market in which the end consumer or 
customer of Kerry’s product operates. The economic 
factors within the EUMs of Food, Beverage and Pharma 
& other which affect the nature, amount, timing and 
uncertainty of revenue and cash flows are similar. 	
Segmental analysis
Operating segments are reported in a manner 
consistent with the internal management structure 
of the Group and the internal financial information 
provided to the Group’s Chief Operating Decision 
Maker (the Executive Directors) who is responsible 
for making strategic decisions, allocating resources, 
monitoring and assessing the performance of each 
segment. EBITDA as reported internally by segment is 
the key measure utilised in assessing the performance 
of operating segments within the Group. Other 
Corporate activities, such as the cost of corporate 
stewardship, are reported along with the elimination 
of inter-group activities under the heading ‘Group 
Eliminations and Unallocated’. Non-trading items, net 
finance costs and income taxes are managed on a 
centralised basis and therefore, these items are not 
allocated between operating segments and are not 
reported per segment in note 2. Given that borrowings, 
deferred tax balances and certain intangible assets 
are managed on a centralised basis, these items are 
not allocated between operating segments for the 
purposes of the information presented in note 2. 	
For the period ended 31 December 2024 and 
comparative periods, the Group has determined it 
has two operating segments: Taste & Nutrition and 
Dairy Ireland. The Taste & Nutrition segment is a world 
leading provider of taste and nutrition solutions for the 
food, beverage and pharmaceutical markets. Utilising 
a broad range of ingredient solutions to innovate with 
our customers to create great tasting products, with 
improved nutrition and functionality, while ensuring a 
better impact for the planet. Kerry is driven to be our 
customers’ most valued partner, creating a world of 
sustainable nutrition through solving our customers’ 
most complex challenges with differentiated solutions. 
NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS	
for the financial year ended 31 December 2024	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies	
General information
	
Kerry Group plc is a public limited company 
incorporated in the Republic of Ireland. The registered 
number is 111471 and registered office address is 
Prince’s Street, Tralee, Co. Kerry, V92 EH11, Ireland. The 
principal activities of the Company and its subsidiaries 
are described in the Business Reviews and note 37 
‘Group entities’. 
Basis of preparation 	
The consolidated financial statements of Kerry 
Group plc have been prepared in accordance with 
International Financial Reporting Standards as issued 
by the IASB (‘IFRS Accounting Standards’), International 
Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (‘IFRIC’) 
interpretations and those parts of the Companies 
Act, 2014 applicable to companies reporting under 
IFRS Accounting Standards. The financial statements 
comprise the Consolidated Income Statement, the 
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income, 
the Consolidated Balance Sheet, the Company Balance 
Sheet, the Consolidated Statement of Changes in 
Equity, the Company Statement of Changes in Equity, 
the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows, the 
Company Statement of Cash Flows and the notes to the 
financial statements. The financial statements include 
the information in the remuneration report described 
as being an integral part of the financial statements. 
Both the Parent Company and Group financial 
statements have also been prepared in accordance 
with International Financial Reporting Standards 
(‘IFRS’) adopted by the European Union (‘EU’) which 
comprise standards and interpretations approved by 
the International Accounting Standards Board (‘IASB’). 
The Group financial statements comply with Article 4 of 
the EU IAS Regulation. IFRS adopted by the EU differs 
in certain respects from IFRS Accounting Standards 
issued by the IASB. References to IFRS hereafter refer 
to IFRS adopted by the EU. 
The Parent Company’s financial statements are 
prepared using accounting policies consistent with 
the accounting policies applied to the consolidated 
financial statements by the Group.
The consolidated financial statements have been 
prepared under the historical cost convention, as 
modified by the revaluation of certain financial 
assets and liabilities (including derivative financial 
instruments) and financial asset investments which 
are held at fair value. Assets and liabilities classified as 
held for sale are stated at the lower of carrying value 
or fair value less costs to sell. The investments in joint 
ventures are accounted for using the equity method.	
The consolidated financial statements contained herein 
are presented in euro, which is the functional currency 
of the Parent Company, Kerry Group plc. The functional 
currencies of the Group’s main subsidiaries are euro, 
US dollar and sterling.	
In the 2024 consolidated financial statements, the 
2023 Balance Sheet was re-presented due to IFRS 3 
measurement period adjustments (note 31). As a result 
of this, balances were re-presented in the following 
notes, note 2 ‘Analysis of results’, note 13 ‘Intangible 
assets’, note 18 ‘Deferred tax assets and liabilities’, 
note 23 ‘Other non-current liabilities’, note 24 ‘Analysis 
of financial instruments by category’, and note 25 
‘Financial instruments’. 
Following the disposal of 70% of Kerry Dairy Holdings 
(Ireland) Limited (‘Kerry Dairy Ireland’) and related 
assets, and in accordance with the requirements 
of IFRS 5 ‘Non-current assets held for sale and 
discontinued operations’, the results of Kerry Dairy 
Ireland to 31 December 2024, the date of disposal, 
have been presented within profit from discontinued 
operations in the consolidated income statement 
with the prior year comparatives re-presented 
accordingly.	
Certain income statement headings and other financial 
measures included in the consolidated financial 
statements are not defined by IFRS such as earnings 
before interest, tax, depreciation and amortisation 
(‘EBITDA’), non-trading items and net debt. The Group 
makes this distinction to enhance the understanding  
of the financial performance of the business as  
outlined in the Supplementary Information section  
on pages 322-326.
The consolidated and company financial statements 
have been prepared on the going concern basis of 
accounting. The Directors have considered the Group’s 
business activities and how it generates value, together 
with the main trends and factors likely to affect future 
development, business performance and position of 
the Group including liquidity and access to financing 
as outlined in note 25 and the potential impacts of 
climate, geopolitical, technological and macroeconomic 
environment related risks on profitability. The 
going concern of the Group was also assessed by 
considering the potential impact of climate-related 
risks on profitability and liquidity, macroeconomic 
and geopolitical developments, customer inventory 
management and changing interest rates during the 
period. There are no material uncertainties that cast 
significant doubt on the Group’s ability to continue as a 
going concern over a period of at least 12 months from 
the date of approval of these financial statements. 	
The Directors report that they have satisfied 
themselves that the Group is a going concern, having 
adequate resources to continue in operational 
existence for the foreseeable future. In forming this 
view, the Directors have reviewed the Group’s forecast 
for a period not less than 12 months, the medium term 
plan, and its cashflow implications have been taken 
into account, including proposed capital expenditure, 
and compared these with the Group’s committed 
borrowing facilities and projected gearing ratios.	
	
	
252
253
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Discontinued operations 
A discontinued operation is a component of the 
Group’s business, the operations and cash flows of 
which can be clearly distinguished from the rest of the 
Group and which:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
-	
represents a separate major line of business or 
geographic area of operations;
-	
is part of a single co-ordinated plan to dispose of 
a separate major line of business or geographic 
area of operations; or	
-	
is a subsidiary acquired exclusively with a view  
to resale.
Classification as a discontinued operation occurs at the 
earlier of disposal or when the operation meets criteria 
to be classified as held for sale. When an operation is 
classified as a discontinued operation, the comparative 
income statement and statement of comprehensive 
income are presented as if the operation had been 
discontinued from the start of the comparative 
period. In determining the amount to be presented as 
discontinued operations, all intercompany items are 
eliminated on consolidation. These items are eliminated 
against continuing operations when an arrangement 
will continue and are eliminated against discontinued 
operations where an arrangement will not continue. 
Discontinued operations are excluded from the results 
of continuing operations and are presented as a single 
amount as profit or loss from discontinued operations 
in the income statement. Net cash flows attributable 
to the operating, investing and financing activities of 
discontinued operations are separately disclosed in the 
notes to the financial statements.
Intangible assets	
Goodwill
Goodwill arises on business combinations and 
represents the excess of the cost of acquisition over 
the Group’s interest in the fair value of the identifiable 
assets and liabilities acquired. 	
Goodwill arising on acquisitions before the date of 
transition to IFRS has been retained at the previous 
Irish/UK GAAP amounts subject to impairment testing. 
Goodwill written off to reserves under Irish/UK GAAP 
prior to 1998 has not been reinstated and is not 
included in determining any subsequent profit or loss 
on disposal.	
At the date control is achieved, goodwill is allocated for 
the purpose of impairment testing to groups of cash 
generating units (CGUs) provided they represent the 
lowest level at which management monitor goodwill for 
impairment purposes. Goodwill is not amortised but is 
reviewed for indications of impairment at least annually 
and is carried at cost less accumulated impairment 
losses, where identified. Impairment is recognised 
immediately in the Consolidated Income Statement 
and is not subsequently reversed. On disposal of a 
subsidiary, the attributable amount of goodwill (not 
previously written off to reserves) is included in the 
determination of the profit or loss on disposal.
Brand related intangibles
Brand related intangibles acquired as part of a 
business combination are valued at their fair value 
at the date control is achieved. Intangible assets 
determined to have an indefinite useful economic life 
are not amortised and are tested for impairment at 
least annually. Indefinite life intangible assets are those 
for which there is no foreseeable limit to their expected 
useful economic life. In arriving at the conclusion that 
these brand related intangibles have an indefinite 
useful economic life, management considers the 
nature and type of the intangible asset, the absence of 
any legal or other limits on the assets’ use, the fact the 
business and products have a track record of stability, 
the high barriers to market entry and the Group’s 
commitment to continue to invest for the long-term 
to extend the period over which the intangible asset 
is expected to continue to provide economic benefits. 
The classification of intangible assets as indefinite 
is reviewed annually. The future expectation of 
potential market disruption due to changing consumer 
preferences or changes in supply chain of raw 
materials linked to sustainability and climate change 
were assessed as part of this review and were deemed 
to have no material impact.
Finite life brand related intangible assets are amortised 
over the period of their expected useful economic 
lives, which predominantly range from 2 to 20 years, by 
charging equal annual instalments to the Consolidated 
Income Statement. The useful economic life used to 
amortise finite intangible assets relates to the future 
performance of the assets acquired and management’s 
estimate of the period over which economic benefit 
will be derived from the asset. Historically, changes 
in useful economic lives have not resulted in material 
changes to the Group’s amortisation charge.
Computer software
Computer software separately acquired, including 
computer software which is not an integral part of 
an item of computer hardware, is stated at cost less 
any accumulated amortisation and any accumulated 
impairment losses. Cost comprises purchase price and 
other directly attributable costs. 	
Costs relating to the development of computer 
software for internal use are capitalised once the 
following recognition criteria outlined are met:
-	
an asset can be separately identified;	
-	
it is probable that the asset created will generate 
future economic benefits;
-	
the development cost of the asset can be 
measured reliably;
-	
it is probable that the expected future economic 
benefits that are attributable to the asset will flow 
to the entity;	
-	
the cost of the asset can be measured reliably; 
and	
-	
the Group controls the asset.
Computer software is amortised over its expected 
useful economic life, which ranges from 3 to 7 years, by 
charging equal annual instalments to the Consolidated 
Income Statement. Amortisation commences when the 
assets are ready for use.
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Segmental analysis (continued) 
The Taste & Nutrition segment supplies industries 
across Europe, Americas and APMEA (Asia Pacific, 
Middle East and Africa). The Dairy Ireland segment is 
a leading Irish provider of value-add dairy ingredients 
and consumer products. The dairy ingredients product 
portfolio includes functional proteins while our dairy 
consumer brands can be found predominantly in 
chilled cabinets in retailers across Ireland and the UK. 
Property, plant and equipment	
Property, plant and equipment, other than freehold 
land, are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation 
and any accumulated impairment losses. Cost 
comprises purchase price and other directly 
attributable costs. Freehold land is stated at cost and 
is not depreciated. Depreciation on the remaining 
property, plant and equipment is calculated by 
charging equal annual instalments to the Consolidated 
Income Statement at the following annual rates:	
-	
Buildings		
	
	
2% - 5%	
-	
Plant, machinery and equipment	
7% - 25%
-	
Motor vehicles	
	
	
20%
The charge in respect of periodic depreciation is 
calculated after establishing an estimate of the asset’s 
useful economic life and the expected residual value 
at the end of its useful economic life. Increasing/
(decreasing) an asset’s expected useful economic life 
or its residual value would result in a (decreased)/
increased depreciation charge to the Consolidated 
Income Statement as well as an increase/(decrease) in 
the carrying value of the asset.
The useful economic lives of Group assets are 
determined by management at the time the assets are 
acquired and reviewed annually for appropriateness. 
These useful economic lives are based on historical 
experience with similar assets as well as anticipation of 
future events, which may impact their useful economic 
life, such as changes in technology or the location 
of the asset and its climate-related risk. Historically, 
changes in useful economic lives or residual values 
have not resulted in material changes to the Group’s 
depreciation charge.
Assets in the course of construction for production or 
administrative purposes are carried at cost less any 
recognised impairment loss. Cost includes professional 
fees and other directly attributable costs. Depreciation 
of these assets commences when the assets are ready 
for their intended use, on the same basis as other 
property assets.
Leasing
At the commencement date of the lease, the Group 
recognises a right-of-use asset and a lease liability on 
the balance sheet. The right-of-use asset is measured 
at cost, which consists of the initial measurement of 
the lease liability, any initial direct costs incurred by 
the Group in setting up/entering into the lease, an 
estimate of any costs to dismantle and remove the 
asset at the end of the lease and any payments made 
in advance of the lease commencement date (net of 
any incentive received). 	
The Group depreciates right-of-use assets on a 
straight-line basis from the lease commencement  
date to the earlier of the end of the useful economic 
life or the end of the lease term. The carrying 
amounts of right-of-use assets are reviewed at each 
balance sheet date to determine whether there is 
any indication of impairment. An impairment loss 
is recognised when the carrying value of an asset 
exceeds its recoverable amount.
The Group measures the lease liability at the 
present value of the lease payments unpaid at that 
date, discounted using the applicable incremental 
borrowing rate. Lease payments included in the 
measurement of the lease liability comprises of fixed 
or variable payments (based on an index or rate), 
amounts expected to be payable under a residual 
value guarantee and payments arising from options 
reasonably certain to be exercised.
Subsequent to the initial measurement, the liability 
will be reduced for payments made and increased 
for the interest applied and is remeasured to reflect 
any reassessment or contract modifications. When 
the lease liability is remeasured, the corresponding 
adjustment is reflected in the right-of-use asset or in 
the Consolidated Income Statement if the right-of-use 
asset is already reduced to nil.	
The Group has elected to record short-term leases of 
less than 12 months and leases of low-value assets 
as defined in IFRS 16 as an operating expense in the 
Consolidated Income Statement on a straight-line basis 
over the lease term.	
The Group has also elected not to separate non-lease 
components from lease components, and instead 
account for each lease component and any associated 
non-lease components as a single lease component, 
further increasing the lease liability.
254
255
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Income taxes	 (continued) 
Current income tax assets and current income tax 
liabilities are offset where there is a legally enforceable 
right to offset the recognised amounts and the Group 
intends to settle on a net basis. Deferred income tax 
assets and deferred income tax liabilities are offset 
where there is a legally enforceable right to offset 
the recognised amounts, the deferred tax assets and 
deferred tax liabilities relate to taxes levied by the same 
taxation authority and the Group intends to settle on a 
net basis.	
Retirement benefits obligation	
Payments to defined contribution schemes are 
recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement as 
they fall due and any contributions outstanding at the 
financial year end are included as an accrual in the 
Consolidated Balance Sheet. 	
Actuarial valuations for accounting purposes are 
carried out at each balance sheet date in relation to 
defined benefit schemes, using the projected unit 
credit method, to determine the schemes’ liabilities and 
the related cost of providing benefits. Scheme assets 
are accounted for at fair value using bid prices.
Current service cost is recognised as it arises within 
staff costs in the Consolidated Income Statement. Net 
interest which is calculated by applying the discount 
rate to the net balance of the defined benefit obligation 
and the fair value of plan assets is recognised in 
interest costs in the Consolidated Income Statement. 
Gains or losses on the curtailment or settlement of a 
scheme are recognised in the Consolidated Income 
Statement when the curtailment or settlement occurs. 
Re-measurement of retirement benefits obligation, 
comprising actuarial gains and losses and the return 
on scheme assets (excluding amounts included in 
net interest cost) are recognised in full in the period 
in which they occur in the Consolidated Statement of 
Comprehensive Income.
The defined benefit liability recognised in the 
Consolidated Balance Sheet represents the present 
value of the defined benefit obligation less the fair value 
of any scheme assets. Defined benefit assets are also 
recognised in the Consolidated Balance Sheet but are 
limited to the present value of available refunds from, 
and reductions in future contributions to, the scheme.
Provisions	
Provisions can be distinguished from other types of 
liability by considering the events that give rise to the 
obligation and the degree of uncertainty as to the 
amount or timing of the liability. These are recognised 
in the Consolidated Balance Sheet when:	
-	
the Group has a present obligation (legal or 
constructive) as a result of a past event;	
-	
it is probable that the Group will be required to 
settle the obligation; and
-	
a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of 
the obligation.	
The amount recognised as a provision is the best 
estimate of the amount required to settle the present 
obligation at the balance sheet date, after taking 
account of the risks and uncertainties surrounding the 
obligation.	
The outcome depends on future events which are by 
their nature uncertain. In assessing the likely outcome, 
management bases its assessment on historical 
experience and other factors that are believed to 
be reasonable in the circumstances. Provisions are 
disclosed in note 26 to the consolidated financial 
statements.	
Non-trading items	
Certain items, by virtue of their nature and/or amount, 
are disclosed separately in order for the user to obtain 
a proper understanding of the financial information. 
These items relate to events or circumstances that are 
not related to normal trading activities and are labelled 
collectively as ‘non-trading items’.	
Non-trading items predominantly include gains or losses 
on the disposal of businesses, disposal of assets (non-
current assets and assets classified as held for sale), 
costs in preparation of disposal of assets, impairment 
of goodwill and intangible assets, costs relating to 
material restructuring or material transformation plans 
and material transaction, integration and restructuring 
costs associated with acquisitions. Non-trading items 
are disclosed in note 5 to the consolidated financial 
statements and are presented separately in the 
Consolidated Income Statement.
	
	
	
	
	
	
Inventories	
Inventories are valued at the lower of cost and net 
realisable value. Cost includes raw materials, direct 
labour and all other expenditure incurred in the normal 
course of business in bringing the products to their 
present location and condition. Cost is calculated 
at the weighted average cost incurred in acquiring 
inventories. Net realisable value is the estimated 
selling price of inventory on hand less all further costs 
to completion and all costs expected to be incurred 
in distribution and selling. Write-downs of inventories 
are primarily recognised under ‘Raw materials and 
consumables’ in the Consolidated Income Statement.
Dividends
Dividends are accounted for when they are  
approved, through the retained earnings reserve. 
Dividends proposed do not meet the definition of a 
liability until such time as they have been approved. 
Dividends are disclosed in note 11 to the consolidated 
financial statements.	
Share-based payments	
Long-Term and Short-Term Incentive Plan:	
	
The Group has granted share-based payments to 
Executive Directors and senior executives under a long-
term incentive plan and to Executive Directors under a 
short-term incentive plan.
The equity-settled share-based awards granted under 
these plans are measured at the fair value of the equity 
instrument at the date of grant. The cost of the award 
is charged to the Consolidated Income Statement 
over the vesting period of the awards based on the 
probable number of awards that will eventually vest, 
with a corresponding credit to shareholders’ equity.	
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Research and development expenditure
Expenditure on research activities is recognised as an 
expense in the financial year it is incurred.	
Development expenditure is assessed and capitalised 
as an internally generated intangible asset only if it 
meets all of the following criteria:		
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
-	
it is technically feasible to complete the asset for 
use or sale;	
-	
it is intended to complete the asset for use or 
sale;	
-	
the Group has the ability to use or sell the 
intangible asset;
-	
it is probable that the asset created will generate 
future economic benefits;
-	
adequate resources are available to complete the 
asset for sale or use; and
-	
the development cost of the asset can be 
measured reliably.	
Capitalised development costs are amortised over 
their expected economic lives. Where no internally 
generated intangible asset can be recognised, product 
development expenditure is recognised as an expense 
in the financial year it is incurred. Accordingly, the 
Group has not capitalised product development 
expenditure to date.	
Impairment of non-financial assets
Goodwill and other intangible assets that have an 
indefinite useful economic life are not subject to 
amortisation. They are tested annually for impairment 
or when indications exist that the asset may be 
impaired. For the purpose of assessing impairment, 
these assets are allocated to groups of cash generating 
units (CGUs) using a reasonable and consistent basis. 
An impairment loss is recognised immediately in the 
Consolidated Income Statement for the amount by 
which the asset’s carrying value exceeds its recoverable 
amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of an 
asset’s fair value less costs to sell or its value in use. 
Value in use is determined as the discounted future 
cash flows of the CGU. The key assumptions during 
the financial year for the value in use calculations are 
discount rates, cash flows (including revenue growth 
rates and EBITDA margin percentages) and long-term 
growth rates.	
When an impairment loss (other than on goodwill) 
subsequently reverses, the carrying amount of the asset 
is increased to the revised estimate of its recoverable 
amount, not exceeding its carrying amount that would 
have been determined had no impairment loss been 
recognised for the asset in prior years. Assets that are 
subject to amortisation are reviewed for impairment 
whenever events or changes in circumstances 
indicate the carrying amount may not be recoverable. 
Impairment is reviewed by assessing the asset’s value in 
use when compared to its carrying value.
The carrying amounts of property, plant and equipment 
are reviewed at each balance sheet date to determine 
whether there is any indication of impairment. An 
impairment loss is recognised when the carrying value 
of an asset exceeds its recoverable amount.	
Income taxes	
Income taxes include both current and deferred 
taxes. Income taxes are charged or credited to the 
Consolidated Income Statement except when they 
relate to items charged or credited directly in other 
comprehensive income or shareholders’ equity. In this 
instance the income taxes are also charged or credited 
to other comprehensive income or shareholders’ equity.
The current tax charge is calculated as the amount 
payable based on taxable profit and the tax rates 
applying to those profits in the financial year together 
with adjustments relating to prior years. Deferred  
taxes are calculated using the tax rates that are 
expected to apply in the period when the liability is 
settled or the asset is realised, based on tax rates that 
have been enacted or substantively enacted at the 
balance sheet date.
The Group is subject to uncertainties, including tax 
audits, in any of the jurisdictions in which it operates. 
The Group accounts for uncertain tax positions 
in line with IFRIC 23 ‘Uncertainty over Income Tax 
Treatments’. The Group considers each uncertain tax 
treatment separately or together with one or more 
uncertain tax treatments based on which approach 
better predicts the resolution of the uncertainty. If the 
Group concludes that it is not probable that a taxation 
authority will accept an uncertain tax treatment 
the Group reflects the effect of the uncertainty in 
determining the related taxable profit, tax bases, 
unused tax losses, unused tax credits or tax rate. 
The Group reflects the effect of uncertainty for each 
uncertain tax treatment using an expected value 
approach or a most likely approach depending on 
which method the Group expects to better predict the 
resolution of the uncertainty. The unit of account for 
recognition purposes is the income tax/deferred tax 
assets or liabilities and the Group does not provide 
separately for uncertain tax positions. When the  
final tax outcome for these items is different from 
amounts recorded, such differences will impact the 
income tax and deferred tax in the period in which 
such a determination is made, as well as the Group’s 
cash position.
Deferred taxes are calculated based on the temporary 
differences arising between the tax base of the asset 
or liability and its carrying value in the Consolidated 
Balance Sheet. Deferred taxes are recognised on all 
temporary differences in existence at the balance sheet 
date except for:
-	
temporary differences which arise from the initial 
recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction 
other than a business combination that at the 
time of the transaction does not affect accounting 
or taxable profit or loss, or on the initial 
recognition of goodwill for which a tax deduction 
is not available; and	
-	
temporary differences which arise on investments 
in subsidiaries where the timing of the reversal 
is controlled by the Group and it is probable that 
the temporary difference will not reverse in the 
foreseeable future.
The recognition of a deferred tax asset is based upon 
whether it is probable that sufficient and suitable 
taxable profits will be available in the future, against 
which the reversal of temporary differences can be 
deducted. Deferred tax assets are reviewed at each 
reporting date.
256
257
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Financial instruments (continued) 	
All financial assets are recognised and derecognised 
on a trade date basis, where the purchase or sale of a 
financial asset is under a contract whose terms require 
delivery of the financial asset within the timeframe of 
the market concerned.	 	
Financial assets and liabilities are offset and presented 
on a net basis in the Consolidated Balance Sheet, only 
if the Group holds an enforceable legal right of set off 
for such amounts and there is an intention to settle 
on a net basis or to realise an asset and settle the 
liability simultaneously. In all other instances they are 
presented gross in the Consolidated Balance Sheet.	
The Group classifies its financial assets in the following 
measurement categories:
-	
those to be measured subsequently at fair value 
(either through other comprehensive income 
(‘OCI’) or through profit or loss); and
-	
those to be measured at amortised cost.	
The classification depends on the Group’s business 
model for managing the financial assets and the 
contractual terms of the cash flows. For assets 
measured at fair value, gains and losses will either 
be recorded in profit or loss or OCI. For investments 
in equity instruments that are not held for trading, 
this will depend on whether the Group has made an 
irrevocable election at the time of initial recognition to 
account for the equity investment at fair value through 
other comprehensive income (‘FVOCI’).
Debt instruments:
Subsequent measurement of debt instruments depend 
on the Group’s business model for managing the asset 
and the cash flow characteristics of the asset. There are 
three measurement categories into which the Group 
classifies its debt instruments:	
-	
Amortised cost: Assets that are held for collection 
of contractual cash flows, where those cash 
flows represent solely payments of principal 
and interest, are measured at amortised cost. 
Any gain or loss arising on derecognition is 
recognised directly in the Consolidated Income 
Statement. Impairment losses are presented in 
the Consolidated Income Statement.
-	
FVOCI: Assets that are held for collection of 
contractual cash flows and for selling the financial 
assets, where the assets’ cash flows represent 
solely payments of principal and interest, are 
measured at FVOCI. The Group has no debt 
instruments measured at FVOCI.
-	
FVPL: Assets that do not meet the criteria for 
amortised cost or FVOCI are measured at fair 
value through profit or loss (‘FVPL’). In addition, 
assets that are irrevocably designated as FVPL at 
origination to eliminate or significantly reduce 
an accounting mismatch are also measured at 
FVPL. A gain or loss on a debt investment that is 
subsequently measured at FVPL is recognised in 
the Consolidated Income Statement.	
Equity instruments:
The Group subsequently measures all equity 
investments at fair value. Where the Group’s 
management has elected to present fair value gains 
and losses on equity investments in OCI, there is no 
subsequent reclassification of fair value gains and 
losses to the Consolidated Income Statement following 
the derecognition of the investment. Dividends from 
such investments continue to be recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement when the Group’s 
right to receive payments is established.	
Changes in the fair value of financial assets measured 
at FVPL (Rabbi Trust assets) are recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement. Impairment 
losses (and reversal of impairment losses) on equity 
investments measured at FVOCI are not reported 
separately from other changes in fair value.
Trade and other receivables:	
Trade receivables are amounts due from customers 
for goods sold or services performed in the ordinary 
course of business. Trade receivables are recognised 
initially at the amount of consideration that is 
unconditional unless they contain significant financing 
components. The amount of consideration that is 
unconditional approximates to fair value. The Group 
holds the trade receivables with the objective to collect 
the contractual cash flows and therefore measures 
them subsequently at amortised cost using the 
effective interest method.
Cash and cash equivalents: 	
Cash and cash equivalents carried at amortised cost 
consists of cash at bank and in hand, bank overdrafts 
held by the Group and short-term bank deposits with 
a maturity of three months or less from the date of 
placement. Cash at bank and in hand and short-term 
bank deposits are shown under current assets on 
the Consolidated Balance Sheet under the heading 
‘Cash at bank and in hand’. Bank overdrafts are shown 
within ‘Borrowings and overdrafts’ in current liabilities 
on the Consolidated Balance Sheet but are included 
as a component of cash and cash equivalents for the 
purpose of the Statement of Cash Flows. The carrying 
amount of these assets and liabilities approximates to 
their fair value.
Financial liabilities measured at amortised cost
Other non-derivative financial liabilities consist 
primarily of trade and other payables and borrowings. 
Trade and other payables are stated at amortised 
cost, which approximates to their fair value given the 
short-term nature of these liabilities. Trade and other 
payables are non-interest bearing.	
Debt instruments are initially recorded at fair value, net 
of transaction costs. Subsequently they are reported at 
amortised cost, except for hedged debt. To the extent 
that debt instruments are hedged under qualifying 
fair value hedges, the carrying value of the debt 
instrument is adjusted for changes in the fair value 
of the hedged risk, with changes arising recognised 
in the Consolidated Income Statement. The fair value 
of the hedged item is primarily determined using the 
discounted cash flow basis.
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Share-based payments	 (continued)
Long-Term and Short-Term Incentive Plan: (continued)	
For the purposes of the long-term incentive plan, the 
fair value of the award is measured using the Monte 
Carlo Pricing Model. For the short-term incentive plan, 
the fair value of the expense equates directly to the cash 
value of the portion of the short-term incentive plan that 
will be settled by way of shares/share options.	
At the balance sheet date, the estimate of the level 
of vesting for all share-based payments is reviewed 
and any adjustment necessary is recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement and in the Statement of 
Changes in Equity. Share-based payments are disclosed 
in note 29 to the consolidated financial statements.	
All Employee Share Plan:
The Group grants share-based payments to 
participating employees under its All Employee Share 
Plan (AESP). The equity-settled share-based awards 
granted under the plan are measured at the fair value 
of the equity instrument at the date of grant. The cost 
of the award is charged to the Consolidated Income 
Statement over the vesting period of the awards based 
on the probable number of awards that will eventually 
vest, with a corresponding credit to shareholders’ 
equity. The fair value of the award is measured using 
the Monte Carlo option pricing model.
At the balance sheet date, the estimate of the level of 
vesting for this plan is reviewed and any adjustment 
necessary is recognised in the Consolidated Income 
Statement and in the Statement of Changes in Equity. 
Share-based payments are disclosed in note 29 to the 
consolidated financial statements.
Foreign currency
Foreign currency transactions are translated into 
functional currency at the rate of exchange ruling 
at the date of the transaction. Exchange differences 
arising from either the retranslation of the resulting 
monetary assets or liabilities at the exchange rate 
at the balance sheet date or from the settlement of 
the balance at a different rate are recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement when they occur. 
On consolidation, the income statements of foreign 
currency subsidiaries are translated monthly into euro 
at the average exchange rate. If this average is not a 
reasonable approximation of the cumulative effect 
of the rates prevailing on the transaction dates, a 
weighted average rate is used. The balance sheets of 
such subsidiaries are translated at the rate of exchange 
at the balance sheet date. Resulting exchange 
differences arising on the translation of foreign 
currency subsidiaries are taken directly to a separate 
component of shareholders’ equity. 
Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the 
acquisition of foreign subsidiaries are treated as 
assets and liabilities of the foreign subsidiaries and are 
translated at the closing rate.	
On disposal of a foreign currency subsidiary, the 
cumulative translation difference for that foreign 
subsidiary is recycled to the Consolidated Income 
Statement as part of the profit or loss on disposal. 
Business combinations	
The acquisition method of accounting is used 
for the acquisition of businesses. The cost of the 
acquisition is measured at the aggregate fair value 
of the consideration given. The acquiree’s identifiable 
assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities that 
meet the conditions for recognition under IFRS 3 
‘Business Combinations’ are recognised at their fair 
value at the date the Group assumes control of the 
acquiree. Acquisition related costs are recognised in 
the Consolidated Income Statement as incurred. If 
the business combination is achieved in stages, the 
acquisition date fair value of the Group’s previously 
held investment in the acquiree is remeasured to fair 
value at the acquisition date through profit or loss.	
Certain assets and liabilities are not recognised at their 
fair value at the date control was achieved as they 
are accounted for using other applicable IFRSs. These 
include deferred tax assets/liabilities and also any 
assets related to employee benefit arrangements. 	
If the initial accounting for a business combination is 
incomplete by the end of the reporting period in which 
the combination occurs, the Group reports provisional 
amounts for the items for which the valuation of the fair 
value of assets and liabilities acquired is still in progress. 
Those provisional amounts are adjusted during the 
measurement period of one year from the date control 
is achieved when additional information is obtained 
about facts and circumstances which would have 
affected the amounts recognised as of that date.	
Where applicable, the consideration for the acquisition 
includes any asset or liability resulting from a 
contingent consideration arrangement measured at 
fair value at the date control is achieved. Subsequent 
changes in such fair values are adjusted against the 
cost of acquisition where they qualify as measurement 
period adjustments. All other subsequent changes in 
the fair value of contingent consideration classified as 
an asset or liability are accounted for in accordance 
with relevant IFRSs.	
Any fair value adjustments in relation to acquisitions 
completed prior to 1 January 2010 have been accounted 
for under IFRS 3 ‘Business Combinations (2004)’.
Investments in subsidiaries
Investments in subsidiaries held by the Parent 
Company are carried at cost less accumulated 
impairment losses.	
Investments in joint ventures
Investments in joint ventures held by the Group  
are accounted for using the equity method, after 
initially being recognised at cost in the Consolidated 
Balance Sheet.	
Financial instruments 	
Financial assets and financial liabilities are recognised 
on the Consolidated Balance Sheet when the Group 
becomes party to the contractual provisions of the 
instrument.	
Financial assets and liabilities are initially measured 
at fair value plus transaction costs, except for those 
classified as fair value through profit or loss, which are 
initially measured at fair value.	
	
258
259
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Financial instruments (continued) 
Trading derivatives
Certain derivatives which comply with the Group’s 
financial risk management policies are not accounted 
for using hedge accounting. This arises where the 
derivatives; (a) provide a hedge against foreign 
currency borrowings without having to apply hedge 
accounting; or (b) where management have decided 
not to apply hedge accounting. In these cases the 
instrument is reported independently at fair value with 
any changes recognised in the Consolidated Income 
Statement. In all other instances, cash flow or fair value 
hedge accounting is applied.
Supplier finance arrangements	
The Group facilitates a supplier financing arrangement 
that allows suppliers to discount their receivable 
position ahead of the due date from the Group. These 
are not seen as financing arrangements by the Group. 
Under the arrangement, a bank agrees to pay amounts 
to a participating supplier in respect of invoices owed 
by the Group and receives settlement from the Group 
at a later date. 
The Group has not derecognised the original liabilities 
to which supplier finance arrangements apply because 
neither a legal release was obtained nor was the 
original liability substantially modified on entering into 
the arrangement. From the Group’s perspective, the 
arrangement does not significantly extend payment 
terms beyond the normal terms agreed with other 
suppliers that are not participating. The Group does 
not incur any additional interest to the bank on the 
amounts due to the suppliers. The Group therefore 
discloses the amounts factored by suppliers within 
trade payables because the nature and function of 
the financial liability remain the same as those of 
other trade payables but discloses disaggregated 
amounts in the notes. All payables under supplier 
finance arrangements are classified as current as at 
31 December 2024. The payments to the bank are 
included within operating cash flows because they 
continue to be part of the normal operating cycle of the 
Group and their principal nature remains operating, as 
payments for the purchase of goods and services.	
Critical accounting estimates and judgements
The preparation of the Group consolidated financial 
statements requires management to make certain 
estimations, assumptions and judgements that affect 
the reported profits, assets and liabilities.	
Estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed 
on an ongoing basis. Changes in accounting estimates 
may be necessary if there are changes in the 
circumstances on which the estimate was based or as 
a result of new information or more experience. Such 
changes are recognised in the period in which the 
estimate is revised.
In particular, information about significant areas 
of estimation and judgement that have the most 
significant effect on the amounts recognised in the 
consolidated financial statements are described 
below and in the respective notes to the consolidated 
financial statements.	
Impairment of goodwill and intangible assets (Estimation)
Determining whether goodwill and intangible assets 
are impaired or whether a reversal of an impairment 
of intangible assets (other than on goodwill) should 
be recorded requires comparison of the value in 
use for the relevant groups of cash generating units 
(CGUs) to the net assets attributable to those CGUs. 
The value in use calculation is based on an estimate 
of future cash flows expected to arise from the CGUs 
and these are discounted to net present value using 
an appropriate discount rate. The tests are dependent 
on management’s estimates, in particular in relation to 
the forecasting of future cash flows, the discount rates 
applied to those cash flows, the expected long-term 
growth rate of the applicable businesses and terminal 
values. Such estimates are subject to change as a result 
of changing economic conditions. As forecasting future 
cash flows are dependent upon the Group successfully 
leveraging its base of intangible assets over the 
long-term, estimates are required in relation to future 
cash flows which will support the asset value. These 
estimates may depend upon the outcome of future 
events and may need to be revised as circumstances 
change. The impact of climate change has also been 
considered, specifically on the timing and the extent 
of costs and cash outflows and is based on a critical 
evaluation of the facts currently available to the Group 
taking into account factors such as, existing technology, 
currently enacted laws and regulations and knowledge 
and expertise within the Group. Changes to legislation 
and government policy relating to climate change as 
well as potential market disruption due to changing 
consumer preferences or changes in supply chain of raw 
materials have been considered in the assessment of 
the impact of climate change. The measurement of the 
impact of climate change is based on reasonable and 
supportable assumptions that represent management’s 
current best estimate of the range of conditions that 
will exist in the foreseeable future. The potential impact 
of climate-related events, aligned with those included 
in the Group’s physical climate risk assessment, was 
also considered as part of the sensitivity analysis 
and had no impact on our conclusions. Details of 
the assumptions used and key sources of estimation 
involved are outlined in note 13 to these consolidated 
financial statements. The Group continues to monitor its 
assessment of the economic environment particularly 
due to macroeconomic and geopolitical developments, 
industry inflation and customer inventory management. 
The long-term outlook for our businesses currently 
remains positive, supports our CGU valuations and no 
impairment was identified as a result of the impairment 
testing review carried out. There is significant headroom 
in the recoverable amount of the related CGUs as 
compared to their carrying value and any impairment is 
not considered likely to occur in the next financial year.	
Business combinations (Estimation)
When acquiring a business, the Group is required 
to bring acquired assets and liabilities on to the 
Consolidated Balance Sheet at their fair value, the 
determination of which requires a significant degree of 
estimation.	
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Financial instruments (continued)
Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss (FVPL)
Financial liabilities at FVPL arise when the financial 
liabilities are either derivative liabilities held for trading 
or they are designated upon initial recognition as FVPL.
The Group classifies as held for trading certain 
derivatives that are not designated and effective as 
a hedging instrument. The Group does not have any 
other financial liabilities classified as held for trading.
Impairment of financial assets	
The Group assesses on a forward looking basis 
the expected credit losses associated with its debt 
instruments carried at amortised cost and FVOCI. The 
impairment methodology applied depends on whether 
there has been a significant increase in credit risk. 	
For trade receivables, the Group applies the simplified 
approach permitted by IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’, 
which requires expected lifetime losses to be 
recognised from initial recognition of the receivables. 
Further detail is provided in note 20. 
Derecognition of financial liabilities
The Group derecognises financial liabilities only  
when the Group’s obligations are discharged, cancelled 
or expired.
Derivative financial instruments and hedge accounting
Derivatives are carried at fair value. The Group’s 
activities expose it to risks of changes in foreign 
currency exchange rates and interest rates in relation 
to international trading and long-term debt. The Group 
uses foreign exchange forward contracts, interest rate 
swaps and forward rate agreements to hedge these 
exposures. The Group does not use derivative financial 
instruments for speculative purposes. When cross 
currency interest rate swaps are used to hedge interest 
rates and foreign exchange rates, the change in the 
foreign currency basis spreads element of the contract, 
that relates to the hedged item, is recognised within 
other reserves under the cost of hedging reserve.	
At inception of the hedge relationship, the Group 
documents the economic relationship between 
hedging instruments and hedged items including 
whether changes in the cash flows of the hedging 
instruments are expected to offset changes in the cash 
flows of hedged items. The Group documents its risk 
management objective and strategy for undertaking its 
hedge transactions.	
Fair value of financial instrument derivatives
The fair value of derivative instruments is calculated 
using quoted prices. Where such prices are not 
available a discounted cash flow analysis is used based 
on the applicable yield curve adjusted for counterparty 
risk for the duration and currency of the instrument, 
which are observable:	
	
	
	
	
-	
foreign exchange forward contracts are measured 
using quoted forward exchange rates to match 
the maturities of these contracts; and	
-	
interest rate swaps are measured at the present 
value of future cash flows estimated and 
discounted based on the applicable yield curves 
adjusted for counterparty credit risk.
Cash flow hedges
Where derivatives, including forward foreign exchange 
contracts and floating to fixed interest rate swaps 
or cross currency swaps are used, they are primarily 
treated as cash flow hedges. The gain or loss relating 
to the effective portion of the interest rate swaps and 
cross currency interest rate swaps is recognised in 
OCI and is reclassified to profit or loss in the period 
when the hedged item is recognised through profit 
or loss. All effective amounts are directly offset 
against movements in the underlying hedged item. 
Any ineffective portion of the hedge is recognised 
in the Consolidated Income Statement. The gain 
or loss relating to the effective portion of forward 
foreign exchange contracts is recognised in OCI 
and is reclassified to profit or loss in the period the 
hedged item is recognised through profit or loss. Any 
ineffective portion of the hedge is recognised in the 
Consolidated Income Statement. When the hedged 
firm commitment or forecasted transaction occurs and 
results in the recognition of an asset or liability, the 
amounts previously recognised in the hedge reserve, 
within OCI are reclassified through profit or loss in 
the periods when the hedged item is impacting the 
Consolidated Income Statement.	
When a hedging instrument expires, or is sold or 
terminated, or when a hedge no longer meets the 
criteria for hedge accounting, any cumulative deferred 
gain or loss and deferred cost of hedging in equity 
at that time remains in equity until the forecast 
transaction occurs, resulting in the recognition of 
a non-financial asset, such as inventory. When the 
forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, 
the cumulative gain or loss and deferred cost of 
hedging that were reported in equity are immediately 
reclassified to profit or loss.
Cash flow hedge accounting is applied to foreign 
exchange forward contracts which are expected to 
offset the changes in fair value of expected future 
cash flows. In order to achieve and maintain cash flow 
hedge accounting, it is necessary for management 
to determine, at inception and on an ongoing basis, 
whether a forecast transaction is highly probable.	
Fair value hedges
Where fixed to floating interest rate swaps are used, 
they are treated as fair value hedges when the 
qualifying conditions are met. Changes in the fair value 
of derivatives that are designated as fair value hedges 
are recognised directly in the Consolidated Income 
Statement, together with any changes in the fair value 
of the hedged asset or liability that are attributable to 
the hedged risk.
Hedge accounting is derecognised when the hedging 
relationship ceases to exist. The fair value adjustment 
to the carrying amount of the hedged item arising 
from the hedged risk is amortised over the remaining 
maturity of the hedged item through the Consolidated 
Income Statement from that date. 
260
261
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
2.	 Analysis of results 	
For the period ended 31 December 2024 and comparative periods, the Group has determined it has two operating 
segments: Taste & Nutrition and Dairy Ireland. The Taste & Nutrition segment is a world leading provider of taste and 
nutrition solutions for the food, beverage and pharmaceutical markets. Utilising a broad range of ingredient solutions to 
innovate with our customers to create great tasting products, with improved nutrition and functionality, while ensuring 
a better impact for the planet. Kerry is driven to be our customers’ most valued partner, creating a world of sustainable 
nutrition through solving our customers’ most complex challenges with differentiated solutions. The Taste & Nutrition 
segment supplies industries across Europe, Americas and APMEA (Asia Pacific, Middle East and Africa). The Dairy Ireland 
segment is a leading Irish provider of value-add dairy ingredients and consumer products. The dairy ingredients product 
portfolio includes functional proteins while our dairy consumer brands can be found predominantly in chilled cabinets in 
retailers across Ireland and the UK. 
Following the sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland (which forms the Dairy Ireland segment) as described in Note 8, effective 2025 the 
Group’s reportable segments will change from two to the following three segments: Europe, Americas and APMEA. This 
realignment reflects the way resources will be allocated and performance will be assessed by the Chief Operating Decision 
Maker from 2025 following the sale of the Dairy Ireland segment. In the Group’s financial reporting for 2025, comparative 
information for 2024 will be restated to reflect the changes in reportable segments. Segmental information presented in 
these financial statements is based on the segment structure for the financial year ended 31 December 2024, being Taste & 
Nutrition and Dairy Ireland. The change in segment reporting post year end does not have a financial impact on the Group’s 
Consolidated Financial Statements for the financial year ended 31 December 2024. 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
Taste &
Nutrition
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy 
Ireland
2024
€’m
Group
Eliminations
and
Unallocated*
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
Taste &
Nutrition
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy
Ireland
2023
€’m
Group
Eliminations
and
Unallocated*
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
External revenue
6,879.0
1,101.6
- 7,980.6
6,936.7
1,083.6
- 8,020.3
Inter-segment 
revenue
50.1
213.5
(263.6)
-
38.2
199.8
(238.0)
-
Revenue
6,929.1
1,315.1
(263.6) 7,980.6
6,974.9
1,283.4
(238.0) 8,020.3
EBITDA**
1,256.1
62.8
(68.1) 1,250.8
1,185.9
53.4
(74.2) 1,165.1
Depreciation (net)
(211.5)
(23.0)
(0.3) (234.8)
(197.7)
(21.4)
(0.5) (219.6)
Intangible asset 
amortisation
(51.4)
(0.2)
(36.2)
(87.8)
(39.0)
(0.2)
(40.3)
(79.5)
Non-trading items
-
24.2
(55.8)
(31.6)
-
0.7
8.1
8.8
Operating profit
993.2
63.8
(160.4)
896.6
949.2
32.5
(106.9)
874.8
Finance income
34.8
21.8
Finance costs
(88.7)
(72.1)
Share of joint ventures’ 
results after taxation 
(0.9)
(1.9)
Profit before taxation
841.8
822.6
Income taxes
(107.4)
(94.5)
Profit after taxation
734.4
728.1
Attributable to:
Equity holders of the 
parent - continuing 
operations
673.4
700.9
Equity holders of the 
parent - discontinued 
operations
61.0
27.4
Non-controlling 
interests - continuing 
operations
-
(0.2)
734.4
728.1
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Inter-segment revenue eliminations form part of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information. All other Group 
Eliminations and Unallocated amounts form part of continuing operations.
** EBITDA represents profit before finance income and costs, income taxes, depreciation (net of capital grant amortisation),  
intangible asset amortisation, non-trading items and share of joint ventures’ results after taxation.
1. 	 Statement of accounting policies (continued)
Critical accounting estimates and judgements (continued) 
Business combinations (Estimation) (continued)
Acquisitions may also result in intangible benefits being brought into the Group, some of which qualify for recognition 
as intangible assets while other such benefits do not meet the recognition requirements of IFRS and therefore form 
part of goodwill. Estimation is required in the assessment and valuation of these intangible assets. For intangible assets 
acquired, the Group bases valuations on expected future cash flows taking into consideration the impact of climate-
related risk and macroeconomic conditions where applicable. This method employs a discounted cash flow analysis 
using the present value of the estimated after-tax cash flows expected to be generated from the purchased intangible 
asset using risk adjusted discount rates, revenue forecasts and estimated customer attrition as appropriate. The period 
of expected cash flows is based on the expected useful economic life of the intangible asset acquired.
Depending on the nature of the assets and liabilities acquired, determined provisional fair values may possibly be 
adjusted within the measurement period as allowed by IFRS 3 ‘Business Combinations’.	
The useful economic lives of intangible assets are determined by management at the time the assets are acquired 
and reviewed annually for appropriateness, including assessment as finite or indefinite. These useful economic lives 
are based on historical experience with similar assets as well as anticipation of future events, such as changes in 
technology, the location of the asset and its climate-related risk. 
Intangible assets are disclosed in note 13 and business combinations in note 31 to the consolidated financial statements.	
Income tax charge and income/deferred tax assets and liabilities (Estimation and Judgement)	
Significant judgement and a high degree of estimation is required in determining the income tax charge as the Group 
operates in many jurisdictions and the tax treatment of many items is uncertain with tax legislation being open to 
different interpretation. Furthermore, the Group can also be subject to uncertainties, including tax audits in any of the 
jurisdictions in which it operates, which by their nature are often complex and can require several years to conclude. 
The Group considers these uncertain tax positions in the recognition of its income tax/deferred tax assets or liabilities. 
In line with its accounting policy, the Group bases its assessment on the probability of a tax authority accepting its 
general treatment having regard to all information available on the tax matter and when it is not probable reflects the 
uncertainty in income tax/deferred tax assets or liabilities. When applying its accounting policy at the year end the 
Group generally considered each uncertain tax treatment separately and reflected the effect of the uncertainty in the 
income tax/deferred tax assets or liabilities using an expected value approach as this better predicts the resolution 
of the uncertainty. Such estimates are determined based on management judgement, interpretation of the relevant 
tax laws, correspondence with the relevant tax authorities and external tax advisors and past practices of the tax 
authorities. Where the final outcome of these tax matters is different from the amounts that were recorded, such 
differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax charge in the period in which such determination is made.	
Income taxes and deferred tax assets and liabilities are disclosed in notes 7 and 18 to the consolidated financial 
statements, respectively.	
	
New standards and interpretations
Certain new and revised accounting standards and new International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee 
(‘IFRIC’) interpretations have been issued. The Group intends to adopt the relevant new and revised standards 
when they become effective and endorsed by the EU. The Group’s assessment of the impact of these standards and 
interpretations is set out below.	
The following Standards and Interpretations are effective for the Group in 2024 but do not have a 
material effect on the results or financial position of the Group:
Effective Date
- IAS 1 (Amendments)
Presentation of Financial Statements
1 January 2024
- IFRS 16 (Amendments)
Leases
1 January 2024
- IAS 7 & IFRS 7 (Amendments)
Supplier Finance Arrangements 
1 January 2024
The following Standards and Interpretations are not yet effective for the Group and are not  
expected to have a material effect on the results or financial position of the Group:	
Effective Date
- IAS 21 (Amendments)
The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates
1 January 2025
- IFRS 7 & IFRS 9 (Amendments)
Classification and Measurement of Financial Instruments	
1 January 2026
- IFRS 18	
Presentation and Disclosure in Financial Statements
1 January 2027
- IFRS 19	
Subsidiaries without Public Accountability: Disclosures	
1 January 2027
262
263
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
2.	 Analysis of results (continued) 	
Information about geographical areas (continued) 
The revenue and non-current assets (as defined in IFRS 8 ‘Operating Segments’) attributable to the country of domicile and 
all foreign countries of operation, for which revenue exceeds 10% of total external Group revenue, are set out below.
Kerry Group plc is domiciled in the Republic of Ireland and the revenues from external customers in the Republic of 
Ireland were €493.5m (2023: €540.0m). The non-current assets at 31 December 2024 located in the Republic of Ireland 
are €2,245.0m (2023: €1,285.7m).	
Revenues from external customers include €896.1m (2023: €939.9m) in the UK and €2,940.3m (2023: €2,972.1m) in the 
USA. The non-current assets in the UK are €243.5m (2023: €352.1m) and in the USA are €3,264.0m (2023: €3,112.1m). 
For clarity the UK is included within Europe in the tables above.	
Taste & Nutrition external revenues consists of €2,242.8m (2023: €2,186.4m) in emerging markets and €4,636.2m (2023: 
€4,750.3m) in developed markets. Third party revenues in Taste & Nutrition in the foodservice channel was €2,209.0m 
(2023: €2,138.0m) and €4,670.0m (2023: €4,798.7m) in the non-foodservice channels.
There are no material dependencies or concentrations on individual customers which would warrant disclosure under IFRS 
8 ‘Operating Segments’. The accounting policies of the operating segments are the same as the Group’s accounting policies 
as outlined in the Statement of Accounting Policies. Under IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ revenue is 
primarily recognised at a point in time. Revenue recorded over time during the year was not material to the Group. 
3.	 Operating profit 
(i) Analysis of costs by nature	
	
Notes
Continuing
Operations
2024
€’m
Re-presented*
Continuing
Operations
2023
€’m
External revenue
6,879.0
6,936.7
Inter-segment revenue
50.1
38.2
Continuing revenue
6,929.1
6,974.9
Less operating costs:
Raw materials and consumables
3,361.1
3,446.7
Other general overheads
1,047.5
1,024.6
Staff costs
4
1,316.5
1,261.7
Loss allowances on trade receivables
20
1.6
0.9
Foreign exchange losses/(gains)
6.7
(11.6)
Change in inventories of finished goods
7.7
140.9
Earnings before interest, tax, depreciation and amortisation
1,188.0
1,111.7
Depreciation (net):
- property, plant and equipment
12 (i)
172.8
165.0
- right-of-use assets
12 (ii)
39.8
34.1
- capital grants amortisation
22
(0.8)
(0.9)
Intangible asset amortisation
13
87.6
79.3
Non-trading items
5
55.8
(8.1)
Operating profit
832.8
842.3
And is stated after charging:
Research and development costs
304.4
294.0
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.
2.	 Analysis of results (continued) 
	
Segment assets and liabilities	
Continuing 
Operations
Taste &
Nutrition
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy 
Ireland
2024
€’m
Group
Eliminations
and
Unallocated
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
Taste &
Nutrition
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy
Ireland
2023
€’m
Group
Eliminations
and
Unallocated
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Assets
7,733.2
-
4,779.3 12,512.5
8,088.9
683.4
2,843.6 11,615.9
Liabilities
(1,739.6)
-
(4,285.6) (6,025.2)
(1,657.6)
(247.7)
(3,187.8) (5,093.1)
Net assets
5,993.6
-
493.7
6,487.3
6,431.3
435.7
(344.2)
6,522.8
Other segmental information
Property, plant 
and equipment 
additions
303.0
26.5
0.8
330.3
271.0
37.6
0.9
309.5
Intangible asset 
additions
3.7
-
23.8
27.5
1.6
-
14.3
15.9
Share of joint 
ventures’ results 
after taxation 
0.9
-
-
0.9
1.9
-
-
1.9
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Revenue analysis	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Disaggregation of revenue from external customers is analysed by End Use Market (EUM), which is the primary market 
in which Kerry’s products are consumed and primary geographic market. An EUM is defined as the market in which the 
end consumer or customer of Kerry’s product operates. The economic factors within the EUMs of Food, Beverage and 
Pharma & other and within the primary geographic markets which affect the nature, amount, timing and uncertainty of 
revenue and cash flows are similar. 	
Analysis by EUM	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
Taste & Nutrition
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy Ireland
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
Taste & Nutrition
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations 
Dairy Ireland
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Food
4,533.0
1,090.3
5,623.3
4,637.3
1,051.9
5,689.2
Beverage
1,850.0
11.3
1,861.3
1,798.6
31.7
1,830.3
Pharma & other
496.0
-
496.0
500.8
-
500.8
External revenue
6,879.0
1,101.6
7,980.6
6,936.7
1,083.6
8,020.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Analysis by primary geographic market	
Disaggregation of revenue from external customers is analysed by geographical split:	
	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
Taste & Nutrition
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy Ireland
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations 
Taste & Nutrition
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy Ireland
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Republic of Ireland
87.6
405.9
493.5
134.7
405.3
540.0
Rest of Europe
1,367.2
626.3
1,993.5
1,382.5
600.3
1,982.8
Americas
3,763.5
31.0
3,794.5
3,772.5
32.5
3,805.0
APMEA
1,660.7
38.4
1,699.1
1,647.0
45.5
1,692.5
External revenue
6,879.0
1,101.6
7,980.6
6,936.7
1,083.6
8,020.3
Information about geographical areas
Europe
2024
€’m
Americas
2024
€’m
APMEA
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Europe
2023
€’m
Americas
2023
€’m
APMEA
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Assets by location
5,675.6
5,196.4
1,640.5
12,512.5
5,177.2
4,941.4
1,497.3
11,615.9
Property, plant and 
equipment additions
80.7
165.5
84.1
330.3
92.1
161.9
55.5
309.5
Intangible asset additions
23.8
3.4
0.3
27.5
14.3
1.6
-
15.9
264
265
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
5.	 Non-trading items 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Re-presented*
Notes
Continuing 
operations
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
operations
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
 Continuing 
operations
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
operations
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Global Business Services expansion
(ii)
-
-
-
(4.1)
-
(4.1)
Acquisition integration costs
(iii)
(4.8)
-
(4.8)
(16.5)
-
(16.5)
Accelerate Operational Excellence
(iv)
(43.3)
-
(43.3)
(53.5)
-
(53.5)
(48.1)
-
(48.1)
(74.1)
-
(74.1)
(Loss)/profit on disposal of  
businesses and assets
(i)/8
(7.7)
24.2
16.5
82.2
0.7
82.9
Non-trading items (before tax)
(55.8)
24.2
(31.6)
8.1
0.7
8.8
Tax on above
7/8
12.2
3.6
15.8
8.7
(0.1)
8.6
Non-trading items (net of related tax)
(43.6)
27.8
(15.8)
16.8
0.6
17.4
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.
(i) Loss on disposal of businesses and assets - continuing operations	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Total
2024
€’m
Property, plant and equipment - disposed
12
(4.2)
Property, plant and equipment - impaired
12
(0.2)
Goodwill
13
(0.6)
Brand related intangible assets
13
(2.0)
Inventories
(0.9)
Assets classified as held for sale - disposed
19
(0.7)
Assets classified as held for sale - impaired
12
(1.2)
Deferred tax liability
0.5
(9.3)
Cash received
4.6
Disposal related costs 
(3.4)
Cumulative exchange difference on translation recycled on disposal
0.4
Loss on disposal of businesses and assets
(7.7)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Net cash outflow on disposal: 
Total
2024
€’m
Consideration 
4.6
Less: disposal related costs paid*
(22.3)
(17.7)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Includes payments that were fully provided for in prior years primarily relating to costs associated with the divestment of the  
Sweet Ingredients Portfolio in 2023.
The above table represents continuing operations. See note 8 for further information on discontinued operations.
3.	 Operating profit (continued)
(ii) Auditors’ remuneration	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
PwC
Ireland
2024
€’m
PwC
Other
2024
€’m
PwC
Worldwide
2024
€’m
PwC
Ireland
2023
€’m
PwC
Other
2023
€’m
PwC
Worldwide
2023
€’m
Statutory disclosure:
Group audit
1.4
2.4
3.8
1.4
2.4
3.8
Other assurance services
0.6
-
0.6
-
-
-
Total assurance services
2.0
2.4
4.4
1.4
2.4
3.8
Tax advisory services
-
-
-
-
-
-
Other non-audit services
-
-
-
-
0.1
0.1
Total non-audit services
-
-
-
-
0.1
0.1
Total auditors’ remuneration
2.0
2.4
4.4
1.4
2.5
3.9
Assurance services
100%
97%
Non-audit services
0%
3%
Total
100%
100%
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Group audit consists of fees payable for the consolidated and statutory audits of the Group and its subsidiaries. Included 
in Group audit are total fees of €5,207 (2023: €5,056) which are due to the Group’s auditor in respect of the Parent 
Company. Included in other assurance services is €0.5m (2023: €nil) for CSRD limited assurance report. Reimbursement of 
auditors’ expenses amounted to €0.2m (2023: €0.1m). 	
4.	 Total staff numbers and costs 
The average number of people employed by the Group was:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Re-presented*
Continuing 
Operations
Taste & 
Nutrition
2024
Number
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy 
Ireland
2024
Number
Total
2024
Number
 Continuing 
Operations
Taste & 
Nutrition
2023
Number
 Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy 
Ireland 
2023
Number
Total
2023
Number
Europe
3,856
1,501
5,357
4,017
1,582
5,599
Americas
9,843
-
9,843
9,948
-
9,948
APMEA
6,447
-
6,447
6,245
-
6,245
20,146
1,501
21,647
20,210
1,582
21,792
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.
The aggregate payroll costs of employees (including Executive Directors) was:	
	
	
	
	
Re-presented*
Continuing 
Operations
Taste & 
Nutrition
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy 
Ireland
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
Taste & 
Nutrition
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
Dairy 
Ireland
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Europe
299.2
108.3
407.5
290.3
105.8
396.1
Americas
 753.6 
-
 753.6 
725.5
-
725.5
APMEA
263.7
-
263.7
245.9
-
245.9
 1,316.5 
 108.3 
 1,424.8 
1,261.7
105.8
1,367.5
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.	
Social welfare costs of €173.6m (2023: €168.2m) and share-based payment expense of €39.8m (2023: €21.6m) are 
included in payroll costs. Pension costs included in the payroll costs are disclosed in note 27. 
266
267
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
7.	 Income taxes 	
	
	
	
Notes
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Recognition in the Consolidated Income Statement (before credit on non-trading items)
Current tax expense in the financial year
129.3
126.5
Adjustments in respect of prior years
(0.7)
1.9
128.6
128.4
Deferred tax in the financial year
(5.4)
(25.3)
Income tax expense (before credit on non-trading items)
123.2
103.1
Income tax expense (before credit on non-trading items) on continuing operations
117.2
98.4
Income tax expense (before credit on non-trading items) on discontinued operations
6.0
4.7
Income tax expense (before credit on non-trading items)
123.2
103.1
(Credit)/charge on non-trading items:
Current tax 
(20.3)
(0.8)
Deferred tax 
4.5
(7.8)
5
(15.8)
(8.6)
Credit on non-trading items on continuing operations
(12.2)
(8.7)
(Credit)/charge on non-trading items on discontinued operations
(3.6)
0.1
Income tax expense (before credit on non-trading items)
(15.8)
(8.6)
Recognition in the Consolidated Income Statement (after credit on non-trading items)
Current tax expense in the financial year
109.0
125.7
Adjustments in respect of prior years
(0.7)
1.9
108.3
127.6
Deferred tax in the financial year
18
(0.9)
(33.1)
Income tax expense (after credit on non-trading items)
107.4
94.5
Income tax expense on continuing operations
105.0
89.7
Income tax expense on discontinued operations
2.4
4.8
Income tax expense (after credit on non-trading items)
107.4
94.5
	
	
	
	
	
The tax on the Group’s profit before taxation differs from the amount that would arise applying the standard 
corporation tax rate in Ireland as follows:	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Profit before taxation 
841.8
822.6
Taxed at Irish Standard Rate of Tax (12.5%)
105.2
102.8
Adjustments to current tax and deferred tax in respect of prior years
0.1
1.4
Net effect of differing tax rates
14.5
3.6
Changes in standard rates of taxes
-
(2.8)
Income not subject to tax
(8.9)
(4.8)
Recognition of unprovided deferred tax assets
(5.1)
(5.6)
Other adjusting items
1.6
(0.1)
Income tax expense
107.4
94.5
	
	
	
	
	
An increase in the Group’s applicable tax rate of 1% would reduce profit after tax by €8.4m (2023: €8.2m).	
	
Factors that may affect the Group’s future tax charge include the effects of restructuring, acquisitions and disposals, 
changes in tax legislation and rates and the use of brought forward losses.
The Government of Ireland, the jurisdiction in which Kerry Group plc is incorporated, transposed the Global Minimum 
Tax Pillar Two rules into domestic legislation as part of the Finance (No. 2) Act 2023 (the ‘Finance Act’). The Irish 
legislation closely follows the EU Minimum Tax Directive and OECD Guidance released to date. The Pillar Two legislation 
took effect from 1 January 2024 and applies a 15% effective tax rate on the Group’s profits. The Pillar Two legislation 
sets out a detailed and highly complex set of rules on how to calculate the 15% effective tax rate. As a result of these 
complexities, the accounting effective tax rate is not always indicative of the effective tax rate as calculated under the 
Pillar Two legislation. In addition, the Pillar Two legislation includes transitional safe harbour provisions, which aim to 
ease the administrative burden for in-scope groups during the initial periods of the application of the legislation.
5.	 Non-trading items (continued) 
(i) Loss on disposal of businesses and assets - continuing operations (continued)	
	
	
	
	
In 2024, the Group disposed of a non-core business and assets in Europe, APMEA and North America for a combined 
consideration of €4.6m resulting in a loss of €7.7m including an impairment of €1.4m in the Americas. A tax credit of 
€2.0m arose on the disposals.
In 2023, the Group completed the sale of the trade and assets of its Sweet Ingredients Portfolio and also disposed of 
small operations in South Africa and South Korea. In addition, the Group disposed of property, plant and equipment 
primarily in North America and Europe. The combined final consideration for the divested business’ and assets was 
€495.7m resulting in a gain of €111.7m for the year ended 31 December 2023, with the related tax charge of €3.8m. The 
profit on disposal of property, plant and equipment was offset by an impairment charge of €15.3m in North America 
and a €13.5m charge with respect to related disposal costs resulting in a net gain of €82.2m.	
(ii) Global Business Services expansion
In 2020, the Group commenced a programme to evolve, migrate and expand its Global Business Services model to 
better enable the business and support further growth. This phase of the programme completed at the end of 2023 and 
the Group incurred no costs in the year ended 31 December 2024 (2023: €4.1m). The costs in the prior year reflected 
relocation of resources, advisory fees, redundancies and the streamlining of operations. The associated tax credit was 
€nil (2023: €0.5m).
(iii) Acquisition integration costs
These costs of €4.8m (2023: €16.5m) reflect the relocation of resources, the restructuring of operations in order to 
integrate the acquired businesses into the existing Kerry operating model and external costs associated with deal 
preparation, integration planning and due diligence. A tax credit of €0.9m (2023: €2.8m) arose due to tax deductions 
available on acquisition related costs.
(iv) Accelerate Operational Excellence
These costs of €43.3m (2023: €53.5m) predominantly reflect cost of streamlining operations, project management costs 
and consultancy fees incurred in the year relating to our Accelerate Operational Excellence transformation programme, 
which was predominately completed at the end of 2024. This material transformation project deploying next generation 
manufacturing processes, including advanced process controls, was combined with building capabilities within the 
Group to enhance continuous improvement in manufacturing processes which delivered step change manufacturing 
excellence across the organisation. This project also focused on supply chain excellence, optimising the Group’s 
warehousing and distribution network. A tax credit of €9.3m (2023: €9.1m) arose due to tax deductions available on 
accelerated operational excellence costs.
6.	 Finance income and costs	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Continuing
Operations
2024
€’m
Re-presented*
Continuing
Operations
2023
€’m
Finance income:
Interest income on deposits
24.5
14.5
Interest income on vendor loan note 
25
10.3
7.3
Finance income
34.8
21.8
Finance costs:
Interest payable and finance charges
(85.9)
(72.8)
Interest on lease liabilities
12 (iii.i)
(3.8)
(2.3)
Interest rate derivative
-
0.2
(89.7)
(74.9)
Net interest income on retirement benefits obligation
27
1.4
3.1
Finance costs
(88.3)
(71.8)
Net finance costs
(53.5)
(50.0)
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.	
268
269
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
8.	 Discontinued operations (continued)	
(i) Analysis of costs by nature	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Notes
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Revenue
1,315.1
1,283.4
Inter-segment revenue
(263.6)
(238.0)
Discontinued revenue
2
1,051.5
1,045.4
Less operating costs:
Raw materials and consumables
747.0
701.9
Other general overheads
142.0
148.6
Staff costs
108.3
105.8
Loss allowances on trade receivables
-
-
Foreign exchange (gains)/losses
(1.2)
0.4
Change in inventories of finished goods
(7.4)
35.3
Earnings before interest, tax, depreciation and amortisation
62.8
53.4
Depreciation (net):
- property, plant and equipment
12 (i)
23.1
21.6
- right-of-use assets
12 (ii)
0.8
0.8
- capital grants amortisation
22
(0.9)
(1.0)
Intangible asset amortisation
13
0.2
0.2
Non-trading items
5
(24.2)
(0.7)
Operating profit
63.8
32.5
Finance costs
(0.4)
(0.3)
Profit before taxation
63.4
32.2
Income taxes
(2.4)
(4.8)
Profit from discontinued operations
61.0
27.4
Operating profit is stated after charging:
Research and development costs
5.4
7.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(ii) Other comprehensive income movement from discontinued operations	
	
	
	
	
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Profit from discontinued operations
61.0
27.4
Cumulative exchange difference on translation recycled on disposal
(0.6)
-
Total comprehensive income
60.4
27.4
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii) Cash flows (used in)/from discontinued operations	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Net cash from operating activities
27.6
38.0
Net cash used in investing activities
(27.7)
(35.3)
Net cash used in financing activities
(0.8)
(0.7)
Net cash flows for the period
(0.9)
2.0
7.	 Income taxes (continued) 	
	
	
	
In respect of the year ended 31 December 2024, Kerry Group plc is availing of the transitional safe harbour rules in 
respect of a significant number of the jurisdictions in which it operates. There is an immaterial current tax charge in 
respect of Pillar Two income taxes which has been included in the income tax expense. The Group applies the exception 
to recognising and disclosing information about deferred tax assets and liabilities related to Pillar Two income taxes, as 
provided in the amendments to IAS 12 issued in May 2023.
The Group will continue to monitor changes in law and guidance as they apply to the Group. 
 
8.	 Discontinued operations
On 12 November 2024, the Group announced that it had entered into an agreement with Kerry Co-Operative Creameries 
Limited (the ‘Co-Op’) in relation to the sale of the Group’s shareholding in Kerry Dairy Holdings (Ireland) Limited (‘Kerry 
Dairy Ireland’) for a total expected consideration of €500 million. Consideration is subject to adjustments for customary 
completion accounts adjustments in respect of cash, debt and working capital and a potential valuation adjustment 
should Kerry Dairy Ireland not achieve adjusted EBITDA targets for fiscal year end 2025. Preliminary completion 
adjustments have been processed through the Phase 1 vendor loan receivable. To the extent any further adjustments 
should arise, the Group does not expect these to be material.
The sale comprises two stages: 	
1.	
Phase 1, wherein the Co-Op acquired a 70% shareholding in Kerry Dairy Ireland, with the Group retaining a 30% 
shareholding. Phase 1 consideration comprises redemption of a portion of the Co-Op’s shareholding in Kerry; cash 
receivable; and a vendor loan receivable. The Group will be entitled to a fixed dividend of €7.5 million per annum 
during the period of the joint ownership. 
Prior to this transaction, the Co-Op held approximately 11% of the issued share capital of Kerry Group plc. The following 
steps (the ‘share exchange’) form part of Phase 1: 
-	
Share for Share exchange: A share for share exchange whereby the Group acquired approximately 85% of the shares 
in the Co-Op that were held by its members, in exchange for issuing an amount of Kerry Group plc shares directly to the 
members of the Co-Op, equal in value to approximately 85% of the Kerry Group plc shares previously held by the Co-Op; 
-	
Redemptions: (a) The redemption by the Group of the Co-Op’s entire shareholding in Kerry Group plc (19,045,396 
shares), in exchange for a promissory note of equivalent value, and (b) the redemption by the Co-Op of the Co-Op 
shares held by the Group (as acquired in the share for share exchange above) in exchange for a promissory note of 
equivalent value; 
-	
Promissory note set off: The amounts outstanding under each promissory note are offset against each other,  
which results in a promissory note balance in favour of the Co-Op equal to approximately 15% of the market value 
of the Co-Op’s original 11% shareholding in Kerry Group plc and which was used by the Co-Op to fund part of the 
Phase 1 consideration. 
Pursuant to this share exchange, the Group’s issued share capital reduced by 2,858,372 shares; the Co-Op ceased to be a 
shareholder of Kerry Group plc and members of the Co-Op instead hold shares in Kerry Group plc directly. The portion of the 
consideration attributable to the share redemption was €261.9m based on a volume-weighted average share price of €91.63.
2.	
Phase 2, wherein the Group and the Co-Op have agreed to a put-call arrangement that will transfer the remaining 
30% shareholding in Kerry Dairy Ireland to the Co-Op. At any time on or prior to 31 July 2035, the Co-Op will have 
the right to purchase the remaining 30% shareholding in Kerry Dairy Ireland in exchange for cash in an amount of 
€150 million (the ‘Call Option’). In the event that the Co-Op does not exercise the Call Option before 31 July 2030, 
the Group will have the right at any time after 31 July 2030 and on or prior to 31 July 2035, to require the Co-Op to 
purchase the entire 30% shareholding in Kerry Dairy Ireland for a consideration of €150 million (the ‘Put Option’). 
The Phase 2 consideration of €150m is subject to certain adjustment mechanisms as outlined above. To the extent 
any such adjustments should arise, the Group does not expect these to be material.
The agreement for the sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland was approved by Co-Op members and by the Group’s shareholders on 
16 December 2024 and 19 December 2024, respectively. Pursuant to respective shareholder approval, Phase 1 of the sale 
of Kerry Dairy Ireland (which forms the Dairy Ireland segment), completed on 31 December 2024. Accordingly, the Group 
ceased to control Kerry Dairy Ireland on 31 December 2024. The Group analysed the quantitative and qualitative factors 
relevant to the Kerry Dairy Ireland business and determined that the criteria for discontinued operations presentation were 
met as at 31 December 2024. The operating results of the Kerry Dairy Ireland business were therefore reported separately 
as discontinued operations, net of income tax expense, in the Consolidated Income Statement and Consolidated Statement 
of Comprehensive Income for the financial years ended 31 December 2024 and 2023, respectively. 
Accounting for the Group’s 30% shareholding in Kerry Dairy Ireland requires judgement relating to accounting treatment 
for this investment and the put and call options that are part of the transaction. The terms and conditions of the call 
option are relevant in determining the accounting treatment for the 30% shareholding, as the Group needs to determine 
whether the 30% shareholding represents a joint arrangement or an associate over which the Group has significant 
influence. There is judgement in determining whether the call option held by the Co-Op is substantive. The Co-Op’s call 
option is immediately exercisable and in management’s judgement this gives the Co-Op control of Kerry Dairy Ireland. 
The existence and effect of the immediately exercisable call option held by the Co-Op means the Group’s current 
interest in Kerry Dairy Ireland is limited to the €150m call option price. As a result, the Group does not have access to 
the economic benefits associated with a present ownership interest in Kerry Dairy Ireland and therefore does not have 
significant influence. The 30% shareholding therefore represents a financial asset and this asset is accounted for at fair 
value through profit and loss. Refer to notes 24 and 25 for further detail.
270
271
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
10.	Earnings per A ordinary share	
	
	
	
	
	
Re-presented*
Continuing
Operations
2024
Discontinued
Operations
2024
Total
2024
 Continuing
Operations
2023
Discontinued
Operations
2023
Total
2023
Basic earnings per share
Profit after taxation attributable to equity 
holders of the parent (€’m)
673.4
61.0
734.4
700.9
27.4
728.3
Basic earnings per share (cent)
389.2
35.3
424.5
395.0
15.4
410.4
Re-presented*
Continuing
Operations
2024
Discontinued
Operations
2024
Total
2024
 Continuing
Operations
2023
Discontinued
Operations
2023
Total
2023
Diluted earnings per share
Profit after taxation attributable to equity 
holders of the parent (€’m)
673.4
61.0
734.4
700.9
27.4
728.3
Diluted earnings per share (cent)
388.6
35.2
423.8
394.3
15.4
409.7
Number of Shares
Note
2024 
m’s
2023 
m’s
Basic weighted average number of shares
173.0
177.4
Impact of share options outstanding
0.3
0.3
Diluted weighted average number of shares
173.3
177.7
Actual number of shares in issue  
as at 31 December
28
166.4
175.8
11.	Dividends	 	
	
	
	
	
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Group and Company:
Amounts recognised as distributions to equity shareholders in the financial year
Final 2023 dividend of 80.80 cent per A ordinary share paid 10 May 2024 
(Final 2022 dividend of 73.40 cent per A ordinary share paid 12 May 2023)
140.4
130.0
Interim 2024 dividend of 38.10 cent per A ordinary share paid 8 November 2024 
(Interim 2023 dividend of 34.60 cent per A ordinary share paid 10 November 2023)
64.8
61.3
205.2
191.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Since the financial year end the Board has proposed a final 2024 dividend of 89.0 cent per A ordinary share which 
amounts to €148.1m based on ordinary shares in issue at 31 December 2024. The payment date for the final dividend 
will be 9 May 2025 to shareholders registered on the record date as at 11 April 2025. The consolidated financial 
statements do not reflect this dividend.	
	
	
	
	
	
12.	Property, plant and equipment
Notes
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Group:
Property, plant and equipment
(i)
2,026.6
2,070.3
Right-of-use assets
(ii)
80.1
62.7
2,106.7
2,133.0
8.	 Discontinued operations (continued)	
	
	
	
	
	
(iv) Effect of disposal on financial position of the Group	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The composition of assets and liabilities disposed of are set out in the table below:	
	
	
	
Notes
Total
2024
€’m
Property, plant and equipment (net of grants) - disposed
12/22
(205.3)
Goodwill
13
(132.2)
Brand related intangible assets
13
(24.4)
Computer software
13
(0.3)
Cash disposed
(10.3)
Inventories
(110.0)
Trade and other receivables
(224.8)
Deferred tax liabilities
15.1
Trade and other payables
191.5
Net amounts due to Kerry entities
34
12.3
(488.4)
Consideration
Share redemption consideration
261.9
Consideration receivable - to be satisfied in cash*
56.0
Working capital - receivable on closing*
47.5
Phase 1 vendor loan receivable**
20.6
Retained investment in Kerry Dairy Ireland
150.0
536.0
Disposal related costs 
(24.0)
512.0
Cumulative exchange difference on translation recycled on disposal
0.6
Profit on disposal of businesses and assets (before tax)
24.2
Tax on above
3.6
Profit on disposal of businesses and assets (net of related tax)
27.8
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* These amounts of a combined €103.5m were due from the Co-Op at 31 December 2024 and were received by the Group  
on 8 January 2025.
** Phase 1 vendor loan receivable balance following draft completion account adjustments.
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Net cash outflow on disposal: 
Total 
2024 
€’m
Consideration received
-
Less: cash disposed
(10.3)
Less: disposal related costs paid
(5.3)
(15.6)
9.	 Profit attributable to Kerry Group plc	
	
	
	
	
	
In accordance with section 304(2) of the Companies Act, 2014, the Company is availing of the exemption from 
presenting its individual income statement to the Annual General Meeting and from filing it with the Registrar of 
Companies. The Company’s profit after taxation for the financial year is €2,695.6m (2023: €650.4m). The profit primarily 
arose due to the receipt of dividends from subsidiaries of the Company.	
272
273
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
12.	Property, plant and equipment (continued) 
(ii) Right-of-use assets analysis	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Land and
Buildings
€’m
Plant,
Machinery
and
Equipment
€’m
Motor
Vehicles
€’m
Total
€’m
Group:
Cost
At 1 January 2023
104.7
21.7
13.7
140.1
Businesses acquired
2.6
-
-
2.6
Additions
19.4
13.0
4.0
36.4
Terminations
(18.5)
(1.8)
(3.0)
(23.3)
Transfer to held for sale
(0.6)
(0.1)
(0.1)
(0.8)
Exchange translation adjustment
(2.8)
(0.4)
(0.2)
(3.4)
At 31 December 2023
104.8
32.4
14.4
151.6
Businesses acquired
31
-
-
0.1
0.1
Additions
48.9
11.1
4.2
64.2
Disposal of discontinued operations
8
(4.0)
(3.1)
(0.1)
(7.2)
Terminations
(13.9)
(4.8)
(1.6)
(20.3)
Exchange translation adjustment
1.3
0.5
(0.1)
1.7
At 31 December 2024
137.1
36.1
16.9
190.1
Accumulated depreciation
At 1 January 2023
54.9
13.5
9.6
78.0
Charge during the financial year
25.1
7.0
2.8
34.9
Terminations
(16.8)
(1.6)
(2.9)
(21.3)
Transfer to held for sale
(0.4)
-
-
(0.4)
Exchange translation adjustment
(2.0)
(0.2)
(0.1)
(2.3)
At 31 December 2023
60.8
18.7
9.4
88.9
Charge during the financial year
3/8
29.7
8.0
2.9
40.6
Disposal of discontinued operations
8
(1.7)
(1.7)
(0.1)
(3.5)
Terminations
(11.6)
(4.7)
(1.5)
(17.8)
Exchange translation adjustment
1.5
0.4
(0.1)
1.8
At 31 December 2024
78.7
20.7
10.6
110.0
Carrying value
At 31 December 2023
44.0
13.7
5.0
62.7
At 31 December 2024
58.4
15.4
6.3
80.1
The right-of-use assets consist of:		
	
	
	
	
	
	
-	
land and buildings for warehouse space, offices and manufacturing facilities. The lease terms vary and range from 
1 to 89 years for buildings and range from 1 to 86 years for land;
-	
machinery, equipment, tools, furniture and other equipment when combined are insignificant to the total leased 
assets portfolio and have an average remaining lease term of 2 years; and
-	
motor vehicles for management and sales functions and trucks for distribution in specific businesses. The lease 
terms for motor vehicles range from 1 to 5 years with an average remaining term of 2 years.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
12.	Property, plant and equipment (continued) 
(i) Property, plant and equipment analysis	
	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Land and
Buildings
€’m
Plant,
Machinery
 and 
Equipment
€’m
Construction
in Progress
€’m
Motor
Vehicles
€’m
Total
€’m
Group:
Cost
At 1 January 2023
1,351.3
2,152.6
209.3
14.4
3,727.6
Businesses acquired
0.5
2.0
4.6
-
7.1
Additions
23.8
37.7
209.0
2.6
273.1
Purchase adjustments 
(3.6)
-
-
-
(3.6)
Transfer from construction in progress
55.0
153.6
(208.6)
-
-
Businesses disposed
(1.0)
(2.2)
-
-
(3.2)
Disposals
(32.0)
(155.7)
(0.8)
(2.1)
(190.6)
Transfer from/(to) held for sale
1.1
(6.6)
0.1
-
(5.4)
Exchange translation adjustment
(46.6)
(34.3)
(5.0)
(0.2)
(86.1)
At 31 December 2023
1,348.5
2,147.1
208.6
14.7
3,718.9
Businesses acquired
31
20.2
22.8
-
-
43.0
Additions
13.3
25.2
226.9
0.7
266.1
Transfer from construction in progress
42.1
158.8
(200.9)
-
-
Disposal of discontinued operations
8
(169.9)
(425.0)
(8.7)
(6.2)
(609.8)
Disposals
5
(11.3)
(64.3)
-
(2.7)
(78.3)
Transfer to held for sale
19
(3.5)
(1.2)
-
-
(4.7)
Exchange translation adjustment
43.0
65.7
6.1
(0.6)
114.2
At 31 December 2024
1,282.4
1,929.1
232.0
5.9
3,449.4
Accumulated depreciation and impairment
At 1 January 2023
430.0
1,248.6
-
11.8
1,690.4
Charge during the financial year
42.3
143.1
-
1.2
186.6
Businesses disposed
-
(1.5)
-
-
(1.5)
Disposals
(24.3)
(153.2)
-
(1.8)
(179.3)
Transfer from/(to) held for sale
0.5
(3.3)
-
-
(2.8)
Exchange translation adjustment
(10.4)
(34.1)
-
(0.3)
(44.8)
At 31 December 2023
438.1
1,199.6
-
10.9
1,648.6
Charge during the financial year
3/8
43.7
151.0
-
1.2
195.9
Disposal of discontinued operations
8
(69.6)
(325.2)
-
(5.7)
(400.5)
Disposals
5
(10.4)
(61.6)
-
(2.1)
(74.1)
Transfer to held for sale
19
(1.3)
(0.7)
-
-
(2.0)
Impairments
-
1.4
-
-
1.4
Exchange translation adjustment
13.6
39.9
-
-
53.5
At 31 December 2024
414.1
1,004.4
-
4.3
1,422.8
Carrying value
At 31 December 2023
910.4
947.5
208.6
3.8
2,070.3
At 31 December 2024
868.3
924.7
232.0
1.6
2,026.6
274
275
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
13.	Intangible assets	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Goodwill
€’m
Brand
Related
 Intangibles
€’m
Computer
Software
€’m
Total
€’m
Cost 
At 1 January 2023
3,225.1
2,726.0
409.8
6,360.9
Businesses acquired
118.9
23.1
-
142.0
Additions
-
-
15.9
15.9
Purchase adjustment
8.2
3.2
-
11.4
Businesses disposed
(0.7)
(0.5)
-
(1.2)
Disposals
-
(7.2)
(7.5)
(14.7)
Transfer (to)/from held for sale
(10.3)
20.2
(2.7)
7.2
Exchange translation adjustment
(42.2)
(30.3)
0.4
(72.1)
At 31 December 2023
3,299.0
2,734.5
415.9
6,449.4
Businesses acquired
31
29.2
86.8
-
116.0
Additions
-
-
27.5
27.5
Disposal of discontinued operations
8
(132.2)
(45.0)
(1.5)
(178.7)
Businesses disposed
5
(0.6)
(2.6)
-
(3.2)
Disposals
 
-
-
(6.4)
(6.4)
Exchange translation adjustment
64.1
72.0
5.9
142.0
At 31 December 2024
3,259.5
2,845.7
441.4
6,546.6
Accumulated amortisation and impairment
At 1 January 2023
14.4
337.6
288.9
640.9
Charge during the financial year
-
52.3
27.2
79.5
Businesses disposed
-
-
-
-
Disposals
-
(7.2)
(7.5)
(14.7)
Transfer (to)/from held for sale
(11.0)
19.4
(2.6)
5.8
Exchange translation adjustment
(2.9)
(8.4)
(0.6)
(11.9)
At 31 December 2023
0.5
393.7
305.4
699.6
Charge during the financial year
3
-
58.6
29.2
87.8
Disposal of discontinued operations
8
-
(20.6)
(1.2)
(21.8)
Businesses disposed
5
-
(0.6)
-
(0.6)
Disposals
 
-
-
(6.4)
(6.4)
Exchange translation adjustment
-
6.5
3.4
9.9
At 31 December 2024
0.5
437.6
330.4
768.5
Carrying value
At 31 December 2023
3,298.5
2,340.8
110.5
5,749.8
At 31 December 2024
3,259.0
2,408.1
111.0
5,778.1
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Allocation of the purchase price in a business combination affects the results of the Group as finite life intangible assets 
are amortised, whereas indefinite life intangible assets, including goodwill, are not amortised. This could result in 
differing amortisation charges based on the allocation to finite life and indefinite life intangible assets.
Included in brand related intangibles are intangibles of €1,691.7m (2023: €1,629.9m) which have indefinite lives.
Approximately €10.7m (2023: €4.4m) of computer software additions during the year were internally generated, 
included in this are payroll costs of €5.3m (2023: €3.9m). The Group has not capitalised product development 
expenditure in 2024 (2023: €nil).	
The Group has no separate individual intangible asset that is material, as all intangibles acquired are integrated and 
developed within the existing business.	
12.	Property, plant and equipment (continued) 
(iii) Lease disclosures
(iii.i) Amounts recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement:	
	
	
	
	
	
Note
Continuing
Operations
2024
€’m
Re-presented*
Continuing
Operations
2023
€’m
Depreciation charged during the financial year
39.8
34.1
Expenses relating to short-term leases
3.8
3.4
Expenses relating to leases of low-value assets, excluding  
short-term leases of low-value assets
0.2
0.2
Interest on lease liabilities charged during the financial year
6
3.8
2.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii.ii) Amounts recognised in the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows:	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Total cash outflow for leases during the year*
47.7
41.5
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Includes interest expense and principal repayments of lease liabilities and short-term and low-value lease expenses.
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii.iii) Lease liabilities	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
At beginning of the financial year
68.6
69.2
Additions
64.2
39.0
Terminations
(2.6)
(1.9)
Remeasurements
-
-
Payments
(40.8)
(36.4)
Disposal of discontinued operations
 
(4.1)
-
Exchange translation adjustment
1.3
(1.3)
At end of the financial year
86.6
68.6
Analysed as: 
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Current liabilities
31.1
26.2
Non-current liabilities
55.5
42.4
At end of the financial year
86.6
68.6
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii.iv) At the balance sheet date the Group had commitments under non-cancellable leases which fall due as follows:	
Discounted
2024
€’m
Undiscounted
2024
€’m
Discounted
2023
€’m
Undiscounted
2023
€’m
Within 1 year
31.1
36.9
26.2
31.0
Between 1 and 2 years
23.0
25.9
16.9
18.5
Between 2 and 5 years
26.4
29.7
18.2
24.1
After 5 years
6.1
10.0
7.3
10.7
86.6
102.5
68.6
84.3
276
277
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
13.	Intangible assets (continued) 
Impairment testing (continued)	 	
	
Sensitivity analysis	
	
	
	
	
Sensitivity analysis has been performed across the three CGUs. If the discount rate was 1% higher than management’s 
estimates, there would have been no requirement for the Group to recognise any impairment charge in 2024 or 2023. 
Further, a 5% increase in the discount rate would not have resulted in an impairment charge in 2024 or 2023 as there 
is headroom in the discounted cash flows. If the estimated growth rate was 1% lower than management’s estimates, 
there would have been no requirement for the Group to recognise any impairment charge in 2024 or 2023. If the 
estimated cash flows were 5% lower than management’s estimates, again there would have been no requirement for 
the Group to recognise any impairment charge in 2024 or 2023. Management believes that no reasonable change, in 
normal circumstances, in any of the above key assumptions would cause the carrying value of any CGU to exceed its 
recoverable amount. The potential impact of climate-related events, aligned with those included in the Group’s physical 
climate risk assessment, and the estimated capital expenditure required to achieve the Group’s sustainability objectives 
in reducing carbon emissions and achieving the ambition to become net zero before 2050 were also considered as part 
of the sensitivity analysis and had no impact on our conclusions.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
14.	 Financial asset investments
FVOCI
 Investments
€’m
Other 
Investments
€’m
Total
€’m
At 1 January 2023
15.1
43.8
58.9
Additions
3.0
2.9
5.9
Disposals
(5.7)
(6.7)
(12.4)
Fair value movements 
-
1.4
1.4
Exchange translation adjustment
(0.3)
(1.5)
(1.8)
At 31 December 2023
12.1
39.9
52.0
Additions
1.8
5.2
7.0
Disposals 
(0.2)
(9.3)
(9.5)
Fair value movements 
-
6.6
6.6
Exchange translation adjustment
0.7
2.4
3.1
At 31 December 2024
14.4
44.8
59.2
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Investments held at fair value through other comprehensive income
During 2024, the Group increased its investments by €1.8m (2023: €3.0m), which was offset by a disposal of €0.2m 
(2023: €5.7m). These investments have no fixed maturity or coupon rate. A fair value assessment was performed at 31 
December 2024 and at 31 December 2023 which did not result in a change to the carrying value of these assets.
Other investments
The Group maintains Rabbi Trusts in the USA. The assets of these trusts primarily consist of equities, bonds and cash 
which are restricted for use. These assets are fair valued through profit or loss at each financial year end using quoted 
market prices. The corresponding liabilities are recognised within other non-current liabilities (note 23).
13.	Intangible assets (continued) 
Impairment testing	
	
	
	
Goodwill and indefinite life intangibles are subject to impairment testing on an annual basis, or more frequently if there 
are indicators of impairment. These assets are allocated to groups of cash generating units (CGUs). The recoverable 
amount of each of the three CGUs (2023: four CGUs) is determined on value in use calculations. Intangible assets 
acquired in a business combination are allocated to CGUs that are expected to benefit from the business acquisition, 
rather than where the assets are owned.
Cash flow forecasts employed for the value in use calculations are for a five year period approved by management and 
a terminal value which is applied to the year five cash flows. The terminal value reflects the discounted value of the cash 
flows beyond year five which is based on the weighted average long-term growth rates for each CGU. 
No impairment was recognised in 2024 or 2023 as a result of the impairment testing which identified significant 
headroom in the recoverable amount of the related CGUs as compared to their carrying value. 
A summary of the allocation of the carrying value of goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets by CGU, is as follows:
Goodwill
2024
€’m
Goodwill
2023
€’m
Indefinite Life 
Intangibles
2024
€’m
Indefinite Life 
Intangibles
2023
€’m
Taste & Nutrition 
Europe
669.9
644.0
188.5
166.4
Americas
2,241.2
2,181.5
1,455.6
1,398.3
APMEA
347.9
346.0
47.6
41.1
Dairy Ireland
Europe
-
127.0
-
24.1
3,259.0
3,298.5
1,691.7
1,629.9
	
	
	
	
	
Key assumptions
Forecasts are generally derived from a combination of internal and external factors based on historical experience and 
take account of expected growth in the relevant region. The key assumptions for calculating value in use calculations 
are those relating to the discount rate, growth rate and cash flows (including revenue growth rates and EBITDA margin 
percentages). The table below outlines the weighted average discount rates and weighted average long-term growth 
rates used in the terminal value for each CGU:
Discount 
Rates
2024
Discount 
Rates
2023
Growth 
Rates
2024
Growth 
Rates
2023
Taste & Nutrition
Europe
7.7%
8.8%
1.4%
1.3%
Americas
8.2%
8.8%
1.2%
1.1%
APMEA
9.4%
9.8%
3.2%
3.7%
Dairy Ireland
Europe
N/A
8.5%
N/A
2.0%
 
Management estimate discount rates using pre-tax rates consistent with the Group’s weighted average cost of capital 
and the risks specific to the CGUs. A higher discount rate is applied to higher risk markets, while a lower rate is applied 
to more stable markets.	
Long-term growth rates are based on external market data, are broadly in line with long-term industry growth rates 
and are conservative in nature. Generally, lower growth rates are used in mature markets while higher growth rates are 
used in emerging markets.
The assumptions used by management in estimating cash flows for each CGU include future profitability and capital 
expenditure requirements. The cash flows included in the value in use calculations are generally determined based 
on historical performance, management’s past experience, management’s expectation of future trends affecting the 
industry and other developments and initiatives in the business including the Group’s strategic plans. Management 
also considered the impact of the economic environment particularly industry inflation, changing interest rates and 
customer inventory management on the Group which has been reflected in the cash flow forecasts employed in 
the value in use calculations. Capital expenditure requirements to maintain the CGUs performance and profitability 
are based on the Group’s strategic plans, excluding future development activity, and broadly assume that historic 
investment patterns will be maintained.	
278
279
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
18.	Deferred tax assets and liabilities	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The following is an analysis of the movement in the major categories of deferred tax liabilities/(assets) recognised by 
the Group:
Note
Property, 
Plant and 
Equipment
€’m
Intangible 
Assets
€’m
Tax Credits 
and NOLs
€’m
Retirement 
Benefits 
Obligation
€’m
Short-Term 
Temporary 
Differences 
and Other 
Differences
€’m
Total 
€’m
At 1 January 2023
103.0
397.8
(29.3)
3.5
(94.6)
380.4
Consolidated Income 
Statement movement
7
2.8
(10.9)
(11.2)
3.1
(16.9)
(33.1)
Recognised in OCI during the 
financial year 
-
-
-
(7.1)
0.4
(6.7)
Related to businesses 
acquired/(disposed)
-
(22.1)
-
-
0.5
(21.6)
Exchange translation 
adjustment
(2.6)
(6.0)
0.5
0.2
2.9
(5.0)
At 31 December 2023
103.2
358.8
(40.0)
(0.3)
(107.7)
314.0
Consolidated Income 
Statement movement
7
(2.5)
(4.3)
0.1
1.9
3.9
(0.9)
Recognised in OCI during the 
financial year
-
-
-
2.9
0.5
3.4
Related to businesses 
acquired/(disposed)
(6.5)
(9.7)
-
-
0.6
(15.6)
Exchange translation 
adjustment
4.6
7.1
0.3
(0.6)
(4.7)
6.7
At 31 December 2024
98.8
351.9
(39.6)
3.9
(107.4)
307.6
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The short-term temporary differences and other temporary differences recognised in other comprehensive income 
comprise fair value movements on cash flow hedges of €0.5m (2023: €0.4m). In the above table, NOLs refers to Net 
Operating Losses.
The following is an analysis of the deferred tax balances (after offset) for balance sheet purposes:	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Deferred tax assets
(93.3)
(80.2)
Deferred tax liabilities
400.9
394.2
307.6
314.0
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The total deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses for which deferred tax assets have not been 
recognised is €10.3m (2023: €12.0m). The Group does not have any unrecognised losses which have an expiry date.
Deferred tax has not been recognised in respect of withholding taxes and other taxes that would be payable on 
the unremitted earnings of foreign subsidiaries, as the Group is in a position to control the timing of reversal of the 
temporary differences and it is probable that the temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future. The 
deferred tax liabilities which have not been recognised in respect of these temporary differences are not material as the 
Group can rely on the availability of participation exemptions and tax credits in the context of the Group’s investments 
in subsidiaries.
An increase of 1% in the tax rates at which deferred tax is calculated would increase the net deferred tax balance of the 
Group by €14.0m (2023: €14.7m).	
15.	Investments in joint ventures	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
At 1 January
39.8
41.7
Share of results after taxation during the financial year
(0.9)
(1.9)
At 31 December
38.9
39.8
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group’s investments in joint ventures represents the shareholding in Proparent B.V. (see note 37). The amounts 
included in these Group consolidated financial statements in respect of the post acquisition profits or losses of this 
joint venture are taken from their latest financial statements prepared up to their financial year end together with 
management accounts for the intervening period to the Group’s year end. 	
	
	
	
	
	
16.	Investments in subsidiaries	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Company:
At 1 January
1,058.5
843.5
Additions
191.4
215.0
Disposals
(200.1)
-
At 31 December
1,049.8
1,058.5
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
In 2024, the movement in investments in subsidiaries related to preparing Kerry Dairy Ireland and its subsidiaries for 
disposal and the subsequent disposal of the Company’s investment in Kerry Dairy Ireland.
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
17.	Inventories	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Raw materials and consumables
533.9
509.4
Finished goods and goods for resale
437.4
514.4
Expense inventories
79.4
76.4
At 31 December
1,050.7
1,100.2
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
These inventory balances are valued at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Write-downs of inventories  
recognised as an expense approximates to 1.3% (2023: 1.8%*) of raw materials and consumables in the Consolidated 
Income Statement.
* As re-presented to reflect the impact of discontinued operations. See note 8 for further information.	
280
281
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
20.	Trade and other receivables (continued) 
Trade and other receivables are stated at amortised cost less loss allowances. The fair value of these receivables 
approximates their carrying value as these are short-term in nature; hence, the maximum exposure to credit risk at the 
reporting date is the carrying value of each class of receivable.	
The Group applies the IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ simplified approach to measuring expected credit losses which uses 
a lifetime expected loss allowance for all trade receivables. To measure the expected credit losses, trade receivables 
have been grouped based on shared credit risk characteristics and the days past due. The expected loss rates are 
based on the payment profiles of sales and the corresponding historical credit loss experience. The historical loss rates 
are adjusted to reflect current and forward looking information on macroeconomic factors, including the GDP of the 
countries in which the Group sells its goods and services, that affect the ability of customers to settle receivables. 
There is no material provision for impairment in the Company’s intercompany receivables balance of €2,039.5m  
(2023: €394.2m) as all amounts are expected to be recovered in full in the short term. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Before accepting any new customer, the Group uses a credit scoring system to assess the potential customer’s credit 
quality and defines credit limits by customer. These credit limits are reviewed regularly throughout the financial year. 
The Group does not typically require collateral in respect of trade receivables.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
There is no significant concentration of credit risk or transaction currency risk with respect to trade receivables, as the 
Group has a large number of internationally dispersed customers. Further disclosures on currency risk are provided in 
note 25 to the financial statements.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group considers the following as constituting an event of default for internal credit risk management purposes 
as historical experience indicates that financial assets that meet either of the following criteria are generally not 
recoverable:
- 	
when there is a breach of financial covenants by the debtor; 
- 	
information developed internally or obtained from external sources indicates that the debtor is unlikely to pay its 
creditors, including the Group, in full.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group writes off a trade receivable when there is information indicating that the debtor is in severe financial 
difficulty and there is no realistic prospect of recovery, for example when a debtor has been placed under liquidation or 
has entered into bankruptcy proceedings. 	
21.	Trade and other payables	
	
	
	
Group
2024
€’m
Group
2023
€’m
Company
2024
€’m
Company
2023
€’m
Trade payables*
1,443.7
1,535.4
7.5
4.5
Other payables and accruals
238.4
190.6
71.1
-
Lease liabilities
31.1
26.2
-
-
Deferred payments on acquisition of businesses
7.6
2.1
0.5
0.6
PAYE
14.1
11.6
-
-
Social security costs
7.6
7.2
-
-
1,742.5
1,773.1
79.1
5.1
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Included in trade payables of €1,443.7m is a balance of €9.6m relating to Kerry Dairy Ireland - see note 34 for further details.
Trade and other payables are stated at amortised cost, which approximates to fair value given the short-term nature of 
these liabilities. The above balances are all due within 1 year.	 	
	
	
	
19.	Assets and liabilities classified as held for sale	 	
	
	
	
	
2024 
€’m
2023
€’m
Assets classified as held for sale
Property, plant and equipment
3.5
1.5
Total assets classified as held for sale
3.5
1.5
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Non-current assets are transferred to assets and liabilities classified as held for sale when it is expected that their 
carrying amounts will be recovered principally through disposal and a sale is considered highly probable. They are held 
at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell.
During the year, the Group held certain property, plant and equipment classified as held for sale in the Europe and 
Americas Taste & Nutrition segment. These assets have been impaired by €1.2m representing their fair value less costs 
to sell (note 5).	
	
20.	Trade and other receivables	
	
	
	
	
Group
2024
€’m
Group
2023
€’m
Company
2024
€’m
Company
2023
€’m
Trade receivables*
1,187.4
1,228.8
-
-
Loss allowances 
(34.5)
(40.3)
-
-
Trade receivables due within 1 year
1,152.9
1,188.5
-
-
Other receivables and prepayments
31.8
47.5
-
-
Amounts due from subsidiaries
-
-
2,039.5
394.2
VAT receivable
47.0
41.3
-
-
Receivables due after 1 year
3.8
1.7
-
-
1,235.5
1,279.0
2,039.5
394.2
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Included in trade receivables of €1,187.4m is a balance of €21.9m relating to Kerry Dairy Ireland - see note 34 for further details.
All receivable balances are due within 1 year except for €3.8m (2023: €1.7m) outlined above. All receivable balances are 
within terms with the exception of certain trade receivables which are past due and are detailed below. 
The following table shows an analysis of trade receivables split between past due and within terms accounts, where past 
due is deemed to be when an account exceeds the agreed terms of trade:	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Within terms
1,012.9
1,050.6
Past due not more than 1 month
84.4
89.9
Past due more than 1 month but less than 2 months
25.7
27.1
Past due more than 2 months but less than 3 months
17.4
12.3
Past due more than 3 months
12.5
8.6
Trade receivables (net)
1,152.9
1,188.5
	
	
	
	
	
	
The following table summarises the movement in loss allowances:	
	
	
	
	
Note
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
At beginning of the financial year
40.3
46.3
Increase in loss allowance charged to the Consolidated Income Statement
3
1.6
0.9
Written off during the financial year
(5.2)
(6.2)
Disposal of discontinued operations
(2.6)
-
Exchange translation adjustment
0.4
(0.7)
At end of the financial year
34.5
40.3
282
283
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
24.	Analysis of financial instruments by category	 	
	
	
	
	
The following table outlines the financial assets and liabilities held by the Group at the balance sheet date:	
	
Notes
Financial 
Assets/ 
(Liabilities) 
at Amortised 
Cost
2024
€’m
Assets/ 
(Liabilities) 
 at Fair Value 
 through Profit 
or Loss
2024
€’m
Derivatives 
Designated 
as Hedging 
Instruments
2024
€’m
Assets/ 
(Liabilities) at 
FVOCI
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Group:
Financial asset investments
14
-
44.8
-
14.4
59.2
Derivative financial instruments
25 (iii)
-
-
12.3
-
12.3
Vendor loan note 
25 (v)
124.6
-
-
-
124.6
Other financial assets
25 (v)
123.9
148.5
-
-
272.4
Trade and other receivables 
20
1,235.5
-
-
-
1,235.5
Cash at bank and in hand
25 (v)
1,610.0
-
-
-
1,610.0
Total financial assets
3,094.0
193.3
12.3
14.4
3,314.0
Borrowings and overdrafts
25 (iv.i)
(3,436.3)
3.3
-
-
(3,433.0)
Derivative financial instruments
25 (iii)
-
-
(32.8)
-
(32.8)
Trade and other payables
21/23
(1,853.8)
(22.9)
-
-
(1,876.7)
Total financial liabilities
(5,290.1)
(19.6)
(32.8)
-
(5,342.5)
Total net financial (liabilities)/assets
(2,196.1)
173.7
(20.5)
14.4
(2,028.5)
Included in the previous table are the following components of net debt:
Analysis of net debt by category
Bank overdrafts
(2.4)
-
-
-
(2.4)
Bank loans
2.0
-
-
-
2.0
Senior Notes
(3,435.9)
3.3
-
-
(3,432.6)
Borrowings and overdrafts
(3,436.3)
3.3
-
-
(3,433.0)
Interest rate swaps
-
-
(16.2)
-
(16.2)
Cash at bank and in hand
25 (v)
1,610.0
-
-
-
1,610.0
Net debt - pre lease liabilities
(1826.3)
3.3
(16.2)
-
(1,839.2)
Lease liabilities
21/23
(86.6)
-
-
-
(86.6)
Net debt
(1,912.9)
3.3
(16.2)
-
(1,925.8)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
All Group borrowings and overdrafts and interest rate swaps are guaranteed by Kerry Group plc. No assets of the Group 
have been pledged to secure these items.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
As at 31 December 2024, the Group’s debt portfolio included:
- 	
€750m of Senior Notes issued in 2015 and €200m issued in April 2020 as a tap onto the original issuance (2025 
Senior Notes). €175m of the issuance in 2015 were swapped, using cross currency swaps, to US dollar;
- 	
€750m of Senior Notes issued in 2019 (2029 Senior Notes); 
- 	
€750m of sustainability-linked bond notes issued in 2021 (2031 SLB Senior Notes); and 
- 	
€1,000m of Senior Notes issued in 2024 under a €3,000m EMTN programme - €500m 2033 Senior Notes and 
€500m 2036 Senior Notes.
The adjustment to Senior Notes classified under fair value through profit or loss of €3.3m of an asset (2023: €6.6m) 
represents the part adjustment to the carrying value of debt from applying fair value hedge accounting for interest 
rate risk. This amount is primarily offset by the fair value adjustment on the corresponding hedge items being the 
underlying cross currency interest rate swaps.	
22.	Deferred income	 	
	
	
	
Notes
Group
2024
€’m
Group
2023
€’m
Company
2024
€’m
Company
2023
€’m
Grants and other 
At beginning of the financial year
19.1
19.4
-
0.1
Grants received during the financial year
2.3
3.3
-
-
Amortised during the financial year
3/8
(1.7)
(1.9)
-
(0.1)
Utilised during the financial year 
(0.4)
(1.6)
-
-
Disposal of discontinued operations
(7.7)
-
-
-
Exchange translation adjustment
0.2
(0.1)
-
-
At end of the financial year
11.8
19.1
-
-
Analysed as:
Current liabilities 
1.0
4.5
-
-
Non-current liabilities
10.8
14.6
-
-
11.8
19.1
-
-
	
	
	
	
	
	
There are no material unfulfilled conditions or other contingencies attaching to any government grants and other 
deferred income received. 	
23.	Other non-current liabilities	
	
	
	
	
Group
2024
€’m
Group
2023
€’m
Company
2024
€’m
Company
2023
€’m
Other payables and accruals
63.4
66.5
-
-
Lease liabilities
55.5
42.4
-
-
Deferred payments on acquisition of businesses
15.3
23.5
-
-
134.2
132.4
-
-
	
	
	
	
	
	
All of the above balances are payable within 2 to 5 years except for €6.1m (2023: €7.3m) which is not due to be paid until 
after 5 years.	 	
284
285
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments	
	
	
Capital management	
The financing structure of the Group is managed in order to optimise shareholder value while allowing the Group 
to take advantage of opportunities that arise to grow the business. The Group targets acquisition and investment 
opportunities that are value enhancing and the Group’s policy is to fund these transactions from cash flow or 
borrowings while maintaining its strong investment grade credit rating. 
The capital structure of the Group consists of debt related financial liabilities, cash and cash equivalents, deferred 
payments on acquisitions of businesses and equity attributable to equity holders of the parent, comprising issued 
capital, reserves and retained earnings. These items are disclosed in the Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity, 
as represented in the table below: 	
	
	
Notes
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Equity attributable to equity holders of the parent
6,485.8
 6,521.3 
Net debt - pre lease liabilities
24
 1,839.2 
 1,535.5 
Lease liabilities
21/23
86.6
 68.6 
Deferred payments on acquisition of businesses
21/23
 22.9 
25.6
8,434.5
8,151.0
The Group has no borrowings that carry financial covenants.	
Net debt is subject to seasonal fluctuations that can be up to 25% above year end debt levels, before allowance for 
acquisition activity undertaken during the financial year.
Capital is managed by setting net debt to earnings before finance income and costs, income taxes, depreciation 
(net), intangible asset amortisation and non-trading items (EBITDA) targets while allowing flexibility to accommodate 
significant acquisition opportunities. Any expected variation from these targets should be reversible in a period of time 
that retains our strong investment grade credit rating, otherwise consideration would be given to issuing additional 
equity in the Group.	
	
	
2024
Times
2023
Times
Net debt:EBITDA
1.6
1.5
EBITDA:Net interest
21.7
21.8
	
	
	
	
The Net debt:EBITDA and EBITDA:Net interest ratios disclosed are calculated using an adjusted EBITDA, adjusted finance 
costs (net of finance income) and an adjusted net debt value to adjust for the impact of acquisitions net of disposals and 
deferred payments in relation to acquisitions. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
24.	Analysis of financial instruments by category (continued) 	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Financial 
Assets/ 
(Liabilities) 
at Amortised 
Cost
2023
€’m
Assets/ 
(Liabilities) 
 at Fair Value 
 through 
Profit or Loss
2023
€’m
Derivatives 
Designated as 
Hedging 
Instruments
2023
€’m
Assets/ 
(Liabilities) at 
FVOCI
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Group:
Financial asset investments
14
-
39.9
-
12.1
52.0
Derivative financial instruments
25 (iii)
-
-
14.4
-
14.4
Vendor loan note 
25 (v)
124.3
-
-
-
124.3
Other financial assets
25 (v)
-
-
-
-
-
Trade and other receivables 
20
1,279.0
-
-
-
1,279.0
Cash at bank and in hand
25 (v)
943.7
-
-
-
943.7
Total financial assets
2,347.0
39.9
14.4
12.1
2,413.4
Borrowings and overdrafts
25 (iv.i)
(2,476.3)
6.6
-
-
(2,469.7)
Derivative financial instruments
25 (iii)
-
-
(17.2)
-
(17.2)
Trade and other payables
21/23
(1,879.9)
(25.6)
-
-
(1,905.5)
Total financial liabilities
(4,356.2)
(19.0)
(17.2)
-
(4,392.4)
Total net financial (liabilities)/assets
(2,009.2)
20.9
(2.8)
12.1
(1,979.0)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Included in the previous table are the following components of net debt:
Analysis of net debt by category
Bank overdrafts
(34.7)
-
-
-
(34.7)
Bank loans
0.2
-
-
-
0.2
Senior Notes
(2,441.8)
6.6
-
-
(2,435.2)
Borrowings and overdrafts
(2,476.3)
6.6
-
-
(2,469.7)
Interest rate swaps
-
-
(9.5)
-
(9.5)
Cash at bank and in hand
25 (v)
943.7
-
-
-
943.7
Net debt - pre lease liabilities
(1,532.6)
6.6
(9.5)
-
(1,535.5)
Lease liabilities
21/23
(68.6)
-
-
-
(68.6)
Net debt
(1,601.2)
6.6
(9.5)
-
(1,604.1)
The following table outlines the financial assets and liabilities held by the Company at the balance sheet date:	 	
Notes
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Company:
Financial assets at amortised cost (unless stated)
Cash at bank and in hand
-
-
Other financial asset1
25 (v)
148.5
-
Trade and other receivables
20
2,039.5
394.2
Total financial assets 
2,188.0
394.2
Financial liabilities at amortised cost
Borrowings and overdrafts
-
-
Trade and other payables
21
(79.1)
(5.1)
Total financial liabilities - all current
(79.1)
(5.1)
Total net financial assets
2,108.9
389.1
1 At fair value through profit or loss.
286
287
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(ii) Interest rate risk management
The Group is exposed to interest rate risk as the Group holds borrowings on both a fixed and floating basis. This 
exposure to interest rate risk is managed by optimising the mix of fixed and floating rate borrowings and by using 
interest rate swaps, cross currency swaps and forward rate agreements to hedge these exposures, in accordance with 
Group policy as approved by the Board of Directors. The Group reviews the mix of fixed and floating rate borrowings on 
an ongoing basis and adjusts where necessary to comply with Group policy. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(ii.i) Interest rate profile of financial liabilities excluding related derivatives fair value	 	
	
The Group’s exposure to interest rates are detailed in the table below including the impact of cross currency swaps (CCS) 
on the currency profile of net debt (including cash at bank and lease liabilities):	
Total 
Pre CCS
€’m
Impact 
of CCS
€’m
Total 
after CCS
€’m
Floating 
Rate 
Net Debt
€’m
Fixed 
Rate Debt
€’m
Euro
(2,473.1)
175.0
(2,298.1)
976.9
(3,275.0)
Sterling
104.1
-
104.1
104.1
-
US Dollar 
292.8
(175.0)
117.8
117.8
-
Others
163.3
-
163.3
163.3
-
At 31 December 2024
(1,912.9)
-
(1,912.9)
1,362.1
(3,275.0)
Euro
(2,214.0)
175.0
(2,039.0)
236.0
(2,275.0)
Sterling
93.0
-
93.0
93.0
-
US Dollar 
314.3
(175.0)
139.3
139.3
-
Others
205.5
-
205.5
205.5
-
At 31 December 2023
(1,601.2)
-
(1,601.2)
673.8
(2,275.0)
The Group holds €950m of 2025 Senior Notes of which €750m were issued in 2015 and €200m were issued in 2020. 
€175m of the 2025 Senior Notes from 2015 were swapped, using cross currency swaps, from euro fixed to US dollar 
floating and are accounted for as fair value hedges of the related debt. The fair value of the related derivative includes 
a liability of €12.1m (2023: €1.4m liability) for movement in exchange rates since the date of execution which is directly 
offset by a gain of €12.1m (2023: €1.4m gain) on the application of hedge accounting on the cross currency swaps.
The floating rate financial liabilities are at rates which fluctuate mainly based upon SOFR, SONIA and EURIBOR and 
comprise of bank borrowings and other financial liabilities bearing interest rates fixed in advance for periods ranging 
from 1 to 6 months. At the financial year end approximately 7% (2023: 10%) of gross debt was held at floating rates. 
The floating rate net debt as set out above, includes cash at bank, which attracts interest at market rates. If the interest 
rates applicable were to rise by 1% holding all other items constant, the profit of the Group before taxation and non-
trading items in the Consolidated Income Statement could increase by 1.3% (2023: 0.8%).	
Further details on the interest rate swap contracts are included within derivative financial instruments (section iii).
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives	
	
	
The Group has a clearly defined Financial Risk Management Programme, which is approved by the Board of Directors 
and is subject to regular monitoring by the Group Finance Committee and Group Internal Audit. The Group operates a 
centralised treasury function, which manages the principal financial risks of the Group and Company.
The principal objectives of the Group’s Financial Risk Management Programme are:
- 	
to manage the Group’s exposure to foreign exchange rate risk;
- 	
to manage the Group’s exposure to interest rate risk;
- 	
to ensure that the Group has sufficient credit facilities available to fund the Group and manage liquidity risk; and
- 	
to ensure that counterparty credit risk is monitored and managed.
Residual exposures not managed commercially are hedged using approved financial instruments. The use of financial 
derivatives is governed by the Group’s policies and procedures. The Group does not engage in speculative trading.
The principal objectives of the Group’s Financial Risk Management Programme are further discussed across the 
following categories:	
	
	
(i) 	
Foreign exchange rate risk management	
	
	
(ii)	
Interest rate risk management 	
	
	
(iii) 	 Derivative financial instruments 
	
-   forward foreign exchange contracts 
	
-   interest rate swap contracts 
	
-   forward commodity contracts	
	
	
(iv) 	 Liquidity risk management - key banking facilities available to the Group and the maturity profile of the Group’s debt.
(v) 	 Credit risk management - details in relation to the management of credit risk within the Group.	 	
	
(vi) 	 Fair value of financial instruments - disclosures in relation to the fair value of financial instruments.
(vii) 	 Offsetting financial instruments - disclosures in relation to the potential offsetting values in financial instruments.	
(i) Foreign exchange rate risk management	
The Group is exposed to transactional foreign currency risk on trading activities conducted by subsidiaries in currencies 
other than their functional currency. Group policy is to manage foreign currency exposures commercially and through 
netting of exposures wherever possible. Any residual exposures arising on foreign exchange transactions are hedged 
in accordance with Group policy using approved financial instruments, which consist primarily of spot and forward 
exchange contracts and currency swaps.
As at 31 December, the Group had an exposure to a US dollar liability of €16.2m (2023: €27.9m asset) and a sterling 
asset of €1.5m (2023: €28.5m liability). Based on these net positions, as at 31 December 2024, a weakening of 5% of the 
US dollar and sterling against all other key operational currencies, and holding all other items constant, would have 
impacted the profit after taxation of the Group for the financial year by an increase of €0.6m (2023: €nil).
The Group’s gain or loss on the retranslation of the net assets of foreign currency subsidiaries is taken directly to the 
translation reserve. As at 31 December 2024, a 5% strengthening of the euro against the US dollar and sterling, holding 
all other items constant, would have resulted in an additional translation reserve loss of €108.6m (2023: €99.4m) and 
€23.3m (2023: €25.5m), respectively.
The Group’s activities expose it to risks of changes in foreign currency exchange rates in relation to international 
trading, primarily sales in US dollar and sterling out of the Eurozone and sales and purchases in US dollar in APMEA. 
The Group uses forward foreign exchange contracts to hedge these exposures. All such exposures are highly probable. 
Derivative financial instruments are held in the Consolidated Balance Sheet at their fair value.
Further details on the forward foreign exchange contracts are included within derivative financial instruments (section iii).	
288
289
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii) Derivative financial instruments (continued) 
The following table details the impact of the portfolio of derivative financial instruments on the Consolidated Balance 
Sheet as at 31 December: 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Interest 
Rate 
Swaps 
- Cash 
Flow 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Interest 
Rate Swaps 
- Fair Value 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Forward 
Foreign 
Exchange 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Forward 
Commodity 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Interest 
Rate 
Swaps 
- Cash 
Flow 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Interest 
Rate Swaps 
- Fair Value 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Forward 
Foreign 
Exchange 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Forward 
Commodity 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Derivative financial 
instruments
-
(16.2)
(6.2)
1.9
(0.1)
(9.4)
6.7
-
Fixed rate 
borrowings:
Interest rate 
movements
-
3.3
-
-
-
6.6
-
-
Receivables:
Foreign exchange 
rate fluctuations
-
12.1
-
-
-
1.4
-
-
Other assets:
Cash at bank and  
in hand
3.3
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Retained earnings 
and other reserves:
Cash flow hedging 
reserve
(3.3)
-
1.1
(1.9)
0.1
-
(4.3)
-
Amount reclassified 
from OCI to profit 
or loss
-
-
5.1
-
-
-
(2.4)
-
Hedge 
ineffectiveness
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Cost of hedging 
reserve
-
0.8
-
-
-
1.4
-
-
-
16.2
6.2
(1.9)
0.1
9.4
(6.7)
-
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii) Derivative financial instruments
The following table details the portfolio of derivative financial instruments at the balance sheet date:		
	
Hedging 
Relationship
2024
€’m
Asset
2024
€’m
Liability
2024
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Asset
2023
€’m
Liability
2023
€’m
Total
Forward foreign 
exchange contracts:
Non-current
Cash flow hedges
0.3
(0.5)
(0.2)
0.7
(0.2)
0.5
Current
Cash flow hedges
10.1
(16.1)
(6.0)
13.7
(7.5)
6.2
10.4
(16.6)
(6.2)
14.4
(7.7)
6.7
Forward commodity 
contracts:
Non-current
1.9
-
1.9
-
-
-
Current
-
-
-
-
-
-
1.9
-
1.9
-
-
-
Interest rate swaps:
Non-current
Cash flow hedges
-
-
-
-
(0.1)
(0.1)
Current	
Cash flow hedges
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(0.1)
(0.1)
Non-current
Fair value hedges
-
-
-
-
(9.4)
(9.4)
Current
Fair value hedges
-
(16.2)
(16.2)
-
-
-
 
-
(16.2)
(16.2)
-
(9.4)
(9.4)
-
(16.2)
(16.2)
-
(9.5)
(9.5)
Total derivative 
financial instruments:
Non-current
2.2
(0.5)
1.7
0.7
(9.7)
(9.0)
Current
10.1
(32.3)
(22.2)
13.7
(7.5)
6.2
12.3
(32.8)
(20.5)
14.4
(17.2)
(2.8)
290
291
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii) Derivative financial instruments (continued) 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii.i) Forward foreign exchange contracts	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The following table details the foreign exchange contracts classified as cash flow hedges at 31 December:	
	
Fair Value (Liability)/Asset
Notional Principal
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Forward foreign exchange contracts 
less than 1 year
(6.0)
6.2
1,242.1
1,408.8
1 - 2 years
(0.2)
0.5
44.1
52.9
Forward foreign exchange contracts - cash flow hedges
(6.2)
6.7
1,286.2
1,461.7
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group adopted the hedge accounting requirements of IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’. The Group enters into hedge 
relationships when there is an economic relationship between the underlying highly probable forecasted transactions 
(hedged item) and the forward foreign exchange contracts (hedged instruments). As the critical terms match for the 
prospective assessment of effectiveness, a qualitative assessment is performed. The Group has established a 1:1 
hedge ratio as the underlying risks in the forward foreign currency exchange contract are identical to the hedged risk 
components. Hedge effectiveness is determined at the origination of the hedging relationship. In instances where 
changes occur to the hedged item which result in the critical terms no longer matching, the Group uses the hypothetical 
derivative method to assess effectiveness. 	
There were no transactions during 2024 or 2023 which were designated as hedges that did not occur, nor are there 
hedges on forecast transactions that are no longer expected to occur.	
The fair value included in the hedging reserve will primarily be released to the Consolidated Income Statement within 6 
months (2023: 9 months) of the balance sheet date. All forward contracts relate to sales revenue and purchases made 
in their respective currencies and forward foreign exchange contracts that provide a hedge against foreign currency 
receivables from ‘within Group’ lending. 	
The Group does not hold any forward foreign exchange contracts classified as fair value hedges.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii.ii) Interest rate swap contracts 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group’s activities expose it to risks of changes in interest rates in relation to long-term debt. The Group uses 
interest rate swaps, cross currency swaps and forward rate agreements to hedge these exposures. Derivative financial 
instruments are held in the Consolidated Balance Sheet at their fair values. 
The Group adopts an ‘exit price’ approach to valuing interest rate derivatives to allow for credit risk. 
The Group adopted the hedge accounting requirements of IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’. The Group enters into hedge 
relationships when there is an economic relationship between the identified notional amount of the underlying debt 
instrument (hedged item) and the interest rate swap contract (hedged instrument). 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Interest rate swap	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
As the critical terms match for the prospective assessment of effectiveness, a qualitative assessment is performed. The 
Group has established a 1:1 hedge ratio as the underlying risks in the interest rate swap contracts are identical to the 
hedged risk components. Hedge effectiveness is determined at the origination of the hedging relationship. In instances 
where changes occur to the hedged item which result in the critical terms no longer matching, the Group uses the 
hypothetical derivative method to assess effectiveness. Hedge ineffectiveness may occur due to the credit/debit value 
adjustment on the interest rate swaps which is not matched by the loan.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Cross currency interest rate swap	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group uses the hypothetical derivative method to assess effectiveness for such swaps as while the critical terms match, 
both qualitative and quantitative assessments are required to be performed as there remains characteristics in cross 
currency interest rate swap contracts that are not present in the hedged item, being basis risks. The Group has established 
a 1:1 hedge ratio as the underlying risks in the cross currency interest rate swap contracts are identical to the hedged risk 
components. Hedge effectiveness is determined at the origination of the hedging relationship and at each reporting date.	
The full fair value of a hedging derivative is classified as a non-current asset or liability if the remaining maturity of the 
hedged item is more than twelve months and as a current asset or liability if the maturity of the hedged item is less 
than twelve months. 	
Under cash flow hedge interest rate swap contracts, including cross currency interest rate swaps, the Group agrees 
to exchange the difference between the fixed and floating rate interest amounts calculated on the agreed notional 
principal amounts. 
Under fair value hedge interest rate swap contracts including cross currency interest rate swaps, the Group agrees to 
exchange the difference between the floating and fixed interest amounts calculated on the agreed notional  
principal amounts.
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii) Derivative financial instruments (continued) 
The following table details the impact of the portfolio of derivative financial instruments on the Consolidated Statement 
of Comprehensive Income and in the Consolidated Income Statement during the financial year:	
	
Interest 
Rate 
Swaps 
- Cash 
Flow 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Interest 
Rate Swaps 
- Fair Value 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Forward 
Foreign 
Exchange 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Forward 
Commodity 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2024
€’m
Interest 
Rate 
Swaps 
- Cash 
Flow 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Interest 
Rate Swaps 
- Fair Value 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Forward 
Foreign 
Exchange 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Forward 
Commodity 
Contracts 
- Cash Flow 
Hedges
2023
€’m
Movements recognised in the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
Amount recognised 
in cash flow 
hedging reserve
3.5
-
(3.6)
1.9
5.0
-
(3.8)
-
Amount recognised 
in cost of hedging 
reserve
-
0.6
-
-
0.1
-
-
-
Amount reclassified 
from hedge reserve 
to profit or loss re: 
foreign exchange 
rate fluctuations
-
-
(1.8)
-
(4.3)
-
2.0
-
Amount reclassified 
from OCI to profit 
or loss re: interest 
rate fluctuations
(0.1)
-
-
-
0.7
-
-
-
Ineffectiveness 
recognised in profit 
or loss
-
-
-
-
0.1
-
-
-
3.4
0.6
(5.4)
1.9
1.6
-
(1.8)
-
Movements recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement
Derivative financial instruments
Amount reclassified 
from OCI to profit 
or loss
0.1
-
1.8
-
0.7
-
(2.0)
-
Ineffectiveness 
recognised in profit 
or loss
-
-
-
-
0.1
(0.1)
-
-
Foreign exchange 
rate fluctuations
-
(10.8)
-
-
(4.3)
6.1
-
-
Interest rate 
movements
-
3.9
-
-
-
5.9
-
-
Fixed rate borrowings
Foreign exchange 
rate fluctuations
-
-
-
-
4.3
-
-
-
Interest rate 
movements
-
(3.9)
-
-
-
(5.9)
-
-
Receivables
Foreign exchange 
rate fluctuations
-
10.8
-
-
-
(6.1)
-
-
0.1
-
1.8
-
0.8
(0.1)
(2.0)
-
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The full fair value of a hedging derivative is classified as a non-current asset or liability if the remaining maturity of the 
hedged item is more than twelve months and as a current asset or liability if the maturity of the hedged item is less 
than twelve months.
292
293
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii) Derivative financial instruments (continued) 
(iii.iii) Forward commodity contracts (continued)
Credit risk assessment	
The Group assess the credit risk associated with the counterparty to the vPPAs. The fair value is adjusted to reflect the 
two-way risk of loss for both the Group and the counterparty using a CVA/DVA approach. There was a minimal impact 
for credit risk assessment as at 31 December 2024.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iv) Liquidity risk management	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Liquidity risk considers the risk that the Group could encounter difficulties in meeting obligations associated with 
financial liabilities that are settled by delivering cash or another financial asset. There is no significant concentration of 
liquidity risk.	
The Group entered 2024 with significant available liquidity. During 2024, the Group exercised the first of the two 
1-year extension options on the €1,500m revolving credit facility. In August 2024, the Group established a €3bn EMTN 
programme for future Euro public bond issuances. In September 2024, the Group issued €1bn of new public bonds 
under this programme. 
Group funding and liquidity is managed by ensuring that sufficient facilities are available from diverse funding sources 
with an appropriate spread of debt maturities. The Group uses cash flow forecasts to constantly monitor the funding 
requirements of the Group.
Group businesses are funded from cash generated from operations, borrowings from banks and Senior Notes from 
capital markets. It is Group policy to ensure that:
- 	
sufficient facilities are available to cover its gross forecast debt by at least 1.25 times; and	
- 	
at least 75% of total facilities available are committed. 
Both targets were met at 31 December 2024 and 2023.
All Group credit facilities are arranged and managed by Group Treasury and approved by the Board of Directors. Where 
possible, facilities have common terms and conditions.
At 31 December 2024, the Group had undrawn committed bank facilities of €1,500m (2023: €1,500m), and a portfolio of 
undrawn standby facilities amounting to €344m (2023: €335m). The undrawn committed facilities comprise primarily of 
a revolving credit facility maturing between 4- 5 years (2023: between 4 - 5 years).	
(iv.i) Contractual maturity profile of non-derivative financial instruments
The following table details the Group’s remaining contractual maturity of its non-derivative financial instruments, 
including lease liabilities and deferred payments on acquisitions of businesses, excluding the remaining trade and 
other payables (note 21) and other non-current liabilities (note 23). This information has been drawn up based on the 
undiscounted cash flows of financial liabilities to the earliest date on which the Group can be required to repay. The 
analysis includes both interest commitments and principal cash flows. To the extent that interest rates are floating, the 
rate used is derived from interest rate yield curves at the end of the reporting date and as such, are subject to change 
based on market movements.	
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii) Derivative financial instruments (continued) 
(iii.ii) Interest rate swap contracts (continued)
Cross currency interest rate swap (continued)	
The following table details the notional principal amounts and remaining terms of:
a)	
cash flow hedges, where the Group receives a floating or a fixed interest rate and pays fixed interest rate  
on swaps; and
b) 	
fair value hedges, where the Group receives a fixed interest rate and pays a floating interest rate on swaps: 
 
Average Contracted 
Fixed Interest Rate
Fair Value Asset/(Liability)
Notional Principal
2024
%
2023
%
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
a) Cash flow hedges
> 5 years1
-
2.43
-
(0.1)
-
375.0
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
b) Fair value hedges
less than 1 year
2.38
-
(16.2)
-
175.0
-
1 - 2 years
-
2.38
-
(9.4)
-
175.0
Total interest rate swaps
(16.2)
(9.5)
175.0
550.0
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The cash flow hedges interest rate swaps settle on a 6 monthly basis, the difference between the floating rate or fixed 
rate due to be received and the fixed rate to be paid are settled on a net basis. 	
The fair value hedges interest rate swaps settle on a 6 monthly or annual basis. The floating interest rate paid by the 
Group is based on 6 month market interest rates for the underlying swap currency. All hedges are highly effective on a 
prospective and retrospective basis. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
1 During 2024 the Group cancelled out of the €375.0m forward starting interest rate swap entered into during 2023. In 2023, the 
forward starting interest rate swap was accounted for as a cash flow hedge of a future debt issuance. The swap provided protection 
to the Group against interest rate movements in 2024 and was cancelled when the Group issued the future debt issuance, the 2036 
Euro Senior Notes. When cancelled, the Group received a cash inflow of €3.3m. As the hedged item exists, the €3.3m is recognised in 
the cashflow hedge reserve and will be released as a credit to interest expense over the first 10 years of the 2036 Euro Senior Notes.
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iii.iii) Forward commodity contracts 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Fair Value Asset/(Liability)
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Forward Commodity contracts
1-2 years
1.9
-
> 5 years
-
-
Forward Commodity Contracts - cash flow hedges
1.9
-
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The entity has entered into two Virtual Power Purchase Agreements (vPPAs) in the United Kingdom both of which 
include an embedded derivative. A vPPA is a contract for differences where the entity agrees to pay or receive the 
difference between the market price of electricity and a fixed price. The embedded derivative is classified as a cashflow 
hedge. The hedged risk is the exposure to variability in future cash flows caused by the fluctuation of the wholesale 
electricity price component of forecast electricity purchases. The fair value of the embedded derivative is determined 
using a valuation technique that incorporates significant unobservable inputs (Level 3).	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Level 3 Fair value disclosures	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Valuation Techniques and Inputs: The fair value of the embedded derivative is determined using a discounted cash flow 
model. Key inputs include forecasted electricity prices, discount rates, and the expected production of the renewable 
energy asset. Observable inputs are possible for a period of the valuation, beyond which the unobservable inputs are 
constructed using a forward curve of the UK baseload electricity using proxy curves and other adjustments to other 
observable and unobservable market data inputs.
Reconciliation of Fair Value Measurements: As this is the first period of reporting, all amounts in 2024 were for Transfers 
into Level 3 for €1.9m and is included in OCI. There were no transfers between fair value levels during the period.
Sensitivity Analysis: The Group performs a sensitivity analysis for the significant unobservable inputs used in the fair 
value measurement. A +/- 5% movement in the capture rates input to determine the fair value of the vPPA contracts 
would have resulted in movements +/- of the fair value by €1.8m	
294
295
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iv) Liquidity risk management (continued)	
(iv.ii) Contractual maturity profile of derivative financial instruments	
	
	
	
The following table details the Group’s remaining contractual maturity of its derivative financial instruments. The table 
has been drawn up based on the undiscounted net cash inflows and outflows on derivative instruments that settle on a 
net basis. To the extent that the amounts payable or receivable are not fixed, the rate used is derived from interest rate 
yield curves at the end of the reporting date and as such are subject to change based on market movements.	
On demand & 
up to 1 year 
€’m
Up to 
2 years 
€’m
2 - 5 
years 
€’m
> 5 years 
€’m
Total 
€’m
Interest rate swaps inflow
2.9
-
-
-
2.9
Interest rate swaps outflow
(20.3)
-
-
-
(20.3)
Net interest rate swaps inflow/(outflow)
(17.4)
-
-
-
(17.4)
Forward foreign exchange contracts outflow
(6.0)
(0.2)
-
-
(6.2)
Forward commodity contracts inflow
-
1.9
-
-
1.9
At 31 December 2024
(23.4)
1.7
-
-
(21.7)
Interest rate swaps inflow
4.2
2.9
-
4.0
11.1
Interest rate swaps outflow
(11.8)
(8.6)
(3.0)
(0.1)
(23.5)
Net interest rate swaps (outflow)/inflow
(7.6)
(5.7)
(3.0)
3.9
(12.4)
Forward foreign exchange contracts inflow
6.2
0.5
-
-
6.7
At 31 December 2023
(1.4)
(5.2)
(3.0)
3.9
(5.7)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Included in the interest rate swaps inflow and outflow is the foreign currency differential on final maturity of the cross 
currency interest rate swaps as follows:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
At 31 December 2024
(12.1)
-
-
-
(12.1)
At 31 December 2023
 - 
(1.4)
-
-
(1.4)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iv.iii) Summary of borrowing arrangements	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(a) Bank loans	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Bank loans comprise committed term loan facilities, committed revolving credit facilities, bilateral term loans and other 
uncommitted facilities:	
- 	
demand facilities;
- 	
committed revolving credit facilities of €1,500m to June 2029; and
- 	
bilateral term loans with maturities ranging up to 1 year.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(b) Public bonds	
	
	
	
	
	
	
All issued by Kerry Group Financial Services Unlimited Company and Guaranteed by Kerry Group plc.		
	
2025 Euro 
Senior Notes
2029 Euro 
Senior Notes
2031 Euro 
Senior Notes
2033 Euro 
Senior Notes
2036 Euro 
Senior Notes 
Issue date(s)
10 Sept. 2015 / 
20 April 2020
20 Sept. 2019
01 Dec. 2021
05 Sept. 2024
05 Sept. 2024
Maturity Date
10 Sept. 2025
20 Sept. 2029
01 Dec. 2031
05 Mar. 2033
05 Sept. 2036
Amount
€ 950m1
€ 750m
€ 750m2
€ 500m
€ 500m
Coupon Rate
2.375%
0.625%
0.875%
3.375%
3.750%
Documentation
Standalone
Standalone
Standalone
EMTN Programme3
EMTN Programme3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
All Senior Notes issued by the Group are rated by S&P (BBB+) and Moody’s (Baa1).		
	
	
	
	
	
1 €750m issued in 2015 and €200m tap issuance in 2020.
2 Euro sustainability-linked bond notes with targets to 1) Reduce absolute Scope 1 & 2 carbon emissions by 55% by 2030 against the 
2017 baseline; 2) Reduce Food Waste by 50% by 2030 against the 2017 baseline. Should either of these targets not be met by 2030 
there is a +0.5% increase in the final interest coupon. If both targets are not met there is a 1% increase in the final interest coupon. 
The step up in the interest coupon (if any) is payable to investors on the last interest payment date in December 2031.
3 €3bn EMTN programme entered into in August 2024.	
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iv) Liquidity risk management (continued)	
(iv.i) Contractual maturity profile of non-derivative financial instruments (continued)	 	
	
	
Note
On 
demand & 
up to 1 
year
€’m
Up to 
2 years
€’m
2 - 5 
years
€’m
> 5 years
€’m
Total
€’m
31 December 2024
Bank overdrafts
(2.4)
-
-
-
(2.4)
Bank loans
-
-
-
-
-
Senior Notes
(950.0)
-
(750.0)
(1,750.0)
(3,450.0)
Borrowings and overdrafts - contractual repayments
(952.4)
-
(750.0)
(1,750.0)
(3,452.4)
Lease liabilities (undiscounted)
12 (iii.iv)
(36.9)
(25.9)
(29.7)
(10.0)
(102.5)
Deferred payments on acquisition of businesses
(7.6)
(15.3)
-
-
(22.9)
(996.9)
(41.2)
(779.7)
(1,760.0)
(3,577.8)
Interest commitments on borrowings and overdrafts
(62.5)
(46.9)
(139.3)
(191.5)
(440.2)
At 31 December 2024
(1,059.4)
(88.1)
(919.0)
(1,951.5)
(4,018.0)
Reconciliation to net debt position:
Borrowings and overdrafts - contractual repayments
(952.4)
-
(750.0)
(1,750.0)
(3,452.4)
Bank Loans - amortised cost adjustments
-
-
2.0
-
2.0
Senior Notes - amortised cost adjustments
(1.2)
-
4.8
10.5
14.1
Senior Notes - fair value adjustment
3.3
-
-
-
3.3
Borrowings and overdrafts
(950.3)
-
(743.2)
(1,739.5)
(3,433.0)
Interest rate swaps
(16.2)
-
-
-
(16.2)
Cash at bank and in hand
1,610.0
-
-
-
1,610.0
Net debt - pre lease liabilities
643.5
-
(743.2)
(1,739.5)
(1,839.2)
Lease liabilities (discounted)
12 (iii.iv)
(31.1)
(23.0)
(26.4)
(6.1)
(86.6)
Net debt as at 31 December 2024
612.4
(23.0)
(769.6)
(1,745.6)
(1,925.8)
31 December 2023
Bank overdrafts
(34.7)
-
-
-
(34.7)
Bank loans
(2.4)
-
-
-
(2.4)
Senior Notes
-
(950.0)
-
(1,500.0)
(2,450.0)
Borrowings and overdrafts - contractual repayments
(37.1)
(950.0)
-
(1,500.0)
(2,487.1)
Lease liabilities (undiscounted)
12 (iii.iv)
(31.0)
(18.5)
(24.1)
(10.7)
(84.3)
Deferred payments on acquisition of businesses
(2.1)
(7.1)
(16.4)
-
(25.6)
(70.2)
(975.6)
(40.5)
(1,510.7)
(2,597.0)
Interest commitments on borrowings and overdrafts
(33.8)
(26.8)
(33.8)
(22.5)
(116.9)
At 31 December 2023
(104.0)
(1,002.4)
(74.3)
(1,533.2)
(2,713.9)
Reconciliation to net debt position:
Borrowings and overdrafts - contractual repayments
(37.1)
(950.0)
-
(1,500.0)
(2,487.1)
Bank Loans - amortised cost adjustments
-
-
2.6
-
2.6
Senior Notes - amortised cost adjustments
-
(2.9)
-
11.1
8.2
Senior Notes - fair value adjustment
-
6.6
-
-
6.6
Borrowings and overdrafts
(37.1)
(946.3)
2.6
(1,488.9)
(2,469.7)
Interest rate swaps
-
(9.4)
-
(0.1)
(9.5)
Cash at bank and in hand
943.7
-
-
-
943.7
Net debt - pre lease liabilities
906.6
(955.7)
2.6
(1,489.0)
(1,535.5)
Lease liabilities (discounted)
12 (iii.iv)
(26.2)
(16.9)
(18.2)
(7.3)
(68.6)
Net debt as at 31 December 2023
880.4
(972.6)
(15.6)
(1,496.3)
(1,604.1)
296
297
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(v) Credit risk management (continued)	
(d) The Group’s other financial assets of €272.4m (2023: €nil) arises from the completion of Phase 1 of the sale of Kerry 
Dairy Ireland and comprises:  
 
- 	
€103.5m (2023: €nil) in current, which was cash settled on the 08 January 2025; and  
- 	
€168.9m (2023: €nil) in non-current , which includes:
- 	
€20.4m (2023: €nil), being the €20.6m Phase 1 vendor loan receivable adjusted for an expected credit loss 
assessment of €0.2m (2023: €nil); and
-	
€148.5m (2023: €nil), being the carrying amount of the retained investment in Kerry Dairy Ireland of €150m, 
net of a downwards adjustment through profit or loss for associated credit risk of €1.5m (2023: €nil).
Credit risk is assessed as low, and has been considered in the measurement of the outstanding balances as  
described above.
As the Group objective for the Phase 1 vendor loan receivable of €20.4m (2023:€nil) is to collect the contractual 
cashflows when due it is recognised at amortised cost using the effective interest method subsequent to initial 
recognition, adjusted for any expected credit loss assessment. 
Due to its nature and associated terms, the retained investment in Kerry Dairy Ireland of €148.5m (2023: €nil) is 
measured at fair value through profit or loss. The fair value of the retained investment is determined using a discounted 
cash flow model, which includes significant unobservable inputs, and is therefore included in Level 3 of the fair value 
hierarchy. Significant unobservable inputs include discount rates, which are based on the Group’s internal models, and 
assumptions about market conditions, including credit risk assessments. There were no transfers between fair value 
levels during the period.
The Company’s other financial asset comprises the €148.5m (2023: €nil) retained investment in Kerry Dairy Ireland as 
described above. Further details are set out in Note 8 - Discontinued Operations.
The Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk consists of gross trade receivables (note 20), cash/deposits (note 24) 
and other financial assets (note 24), which are primarily vendor loan notes, retained investment in Kerry Dairy Ireland, 
interest rate swaps and foreign exchange contracts.
(vi) Fair value of financial instruments	
(a) Fair value of financial instruments carried at fair value		
	
	
	
	
	
Financial instruments recognised at fair value are analysed between those based on:
- 	
quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1);
- 	
those involving inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the assets or liabilities, 
either directly (as prices) or indirectly (derived from prices) (Level 2); and	
- 	
those involving inputs for the assets or liabilities that are not based on observable market data (unobservable 
inputs) (Level 3).	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
2023
Fair Value 
Hierarchy
Assets
€’m
Liabilities
€’m
Assets
€’m
Liabilities
€’m
Interest rate swaps:
Non-current
Level 2
-
-
-
(9.5)
Current
Level 2
-
(16.2)
-
-
Forward foreign exchange 
contracts:
Non-current
Level 2
0.3
(0.5)
0.7
(0.2)
Current
Level 2
10.1
(16.1)
13.7
(7.5)
Forward commodity contracts: Non-current
Level 3
1.9
-
-
-
Current
Level 3
-
-
-
-
Financial asset investments: 
Fair value through profit or loss
Level 1
44.8
-
39.9
-
Fair value through other 
comprehensive income
Level 3
14.4
-
12.1
-
Other financial asset
Fair value through profit or loss
Level 3
148.5
-
-
-
Deferred payments on 
acquisition of businesses
Non-current
Level 3
-
(15.3)
-
(23.5)
Current
Level 3
-
(7.6)
-
(2.1)
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(iv) Liquidity risk management (continued)	
(iv.iii) Summary of borrowing arrangements (continued)	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(c) Lease liabilities	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group’s lease liabilities are set out in note 12 (iii).(iii).
(d) Supplier finance arrangement
The Group facilitates a supplier financing arrangement that allows suppliers to discount their receivable position 
ahead of the due date from the Group. A small portion of total financial liabilities are included in the supplier financing 
arrangement and therefore does not result in concentration of liquidity risk of the Group.	
	
	
	
Group 2024
Group 2023
Carrying amount of liabilities
Presented within trade and other payables:
€’m
169.4
218.6
– of which suppliers have received payment from finance provider
€’m
113.3
180.6
Range of payment due dates
Liabilities that are part of the arrangement
Days
90-180
90-180
Trade payables that are not part of an arrangement
Days
60-180
60-180
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(v) Credit risk management	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Group
2024
€’m
Group
2023
€’m
Company
2024
€’m
Company
2023
€’m
Cash at bank and in hand
 (a) 
 1,610.0 
 943.7 
 - 
 - 
Trade & other receivables
 (b) 
1,235.5
 1,279.0 
2,039.5
 394.2 
Vendor loan notes
 (c) 
 124.6 
 124.3 
 - 
 - 
Other financial assets
- Current assets
 (d) 
 103.5 
 - 
 - 
 - 
- Non-current assets
 (d) 
 168.9 
 - 
 148.5 
 - 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(a) Cash deposits and other financial assets give rise to credit risk on the amounts due from counterparties. 
 
The Group controls and monitors the distribution of this exposure by ensuring that all financial instruments are held with 
reputable and financially secure institutions and that exposure to credit risk is distributed across a number of institutions. 
At 31 December 2024 and 2023, all cash, short-term deposits and other liquid investments had a maturity of less than 3 
months. Cash at bank and in hand of €1,610.0m (2023: €943.7m) includes an amount of €943.9m (2023: €243.8m) held on 
short-term deposit of which €227.0m (2023: €50.8m) was held under a Sustainable Deposits programme. 
Credit risk exposure to financial institutions is actively managed across the portfolio of institutions by setting appropriate 
credit exposure limits based on a value at risk calculation that takes the EBITDA of the Group and calculates approved 
tolerance levels based on credit default swap rates for the financial institutions. These levels are applied in controlling 
the level of material surplus funds that are placed with counterparties and for controlling the institutions with which the 
Group enters into derivative contracts. Credit default swaps are updated and reviewed on an ongoing basis.
The Group’s exposure to its counterparties is continuously monitored and the aggregate value of transactions entered 
into is spread amongst approved counterparties.
(b) Trade receivables consist of a large number of customers, spread across diverse geographical areas. Ongoing 
credit evaluation is performed on the financial condition of accounts receivable at operating unit level at least on a 
monthly basis.
(c) The Group holds an interest-bearing vendor loan note which was entered into as part of the consideration for the 
sale of the trade and assets of the Sweet Ingredients Portfolio from the Taste & Nutrition segment during 2023. The 
carrying amount of the debt receivable is €124.6m (2023: €124.3m), this represents the amount due from third parties, 
initially recognised at fair value of €125.0m and interest capitalised on a bi-annual basis. As the Group objective for 
the vendor loan note is to collect the contractual cash flows when due, the Group measures at amortised cost using 
the effective interest method subsequent to initial recognition adjusted for any expected credit loss assessment. The 
borrower shall repay the interest-bearing vendor loan note in full (together with all accrued but unpaid interest thereon) 
on the 3 year tenor termination date. The termination date may be extended using extension options.
298
299
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(vii) Offsetting financial instruments	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group enters into derivative transactions under International Swaps and Derivatives Association (ISDA) master 
netting agreements. The ISDA agreements do not meet the criteria for offsetting in the Consolidated Balance Sheet. 
This is because the Group does not have any current legally enforceable right to offset recognised amounts, because 
the right to offset is enforceable only on the occurrence of future events such as a default on the bank loans or other 
credit events. No collateral is paid or received.
The following table sets out the carrying amounts of recognised financial instruments that are subject to the  
above agreements.
The table also sets out where the Group has offset bank overdrafts against cash at bank and in hand based on a legal 
right of offset as set out in the banking agreements.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Gross 
amounts
€’m
Effects of offsetting in the Consolidated Balance Sheet 
Gross amounts
offset in the
Consolidated
Balance Sheet
€’m
Amounts
of financial
instruments
presented in the
Consolidated
Balance Sheet
€’m
Related
financial 
instruments
that are not
offset
€’m
Net amount
€’m
At 31 December 2024
Financial assets
Cash at bank and in hand
1,610.0
-
1,610.0
-
1,610.0
Derivative financial instruments
12.3
-
12.3
(7.4)
4.9
1,622.3
-
1,622.3
(7.4)
1,614.9
Financial liabilities
Bank overdrafts
(2.4)
-
(2.4)
-
(2.4)
Derivative financial instruments
(32.8)
-
(32.8)
7.4
(25.4)
(35.2)
-
(35.2)
7.4
(27.8)
At 31 December 2023
Financial assets
Cash at bank and in hand
943.7
-
943.7
-
943.7
Derivative financial instruments
14.4
-
14.4
(4.6)
9.8
958.1
-
958.1
(4.6)
953.5
Financial liabilities
Bank overdrafts
(34.7)
-
(34.7)
-
(34.7)
Derivative financial instruments
(17.2)
-
(17.2)
4.6
(12.6)
(51.9)
-
(51.9)
4.6
(47.3)
25.	Financial instruments (continued) 
Financial risk management objectives (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
(vi) Fair value of financial instruments (continued)	
(a) Fair value of financial instruments carried at fair value (continued)	
	
	
	
The reconciliation of Level 3 for forward commodity contracts is included under (iii.iii) forward commodity contracts of 
this note 25.	
The reconciliation of Level 3 for other financial asset is included under (v) credit risk management of this note 25.
The reconciliation of Level 3 financial asset investments is provided in note 14. 
Deferred contingent consideration is included in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, details of the movement in the year 
are included in note 31. The fair value is determined considering the expected payment, discounted to present value 
using a risk adjusted discount rate. The expected payment is determined separately in respect of each individual earn-
out agreement taking into consideration the expected level of profitability of each acquisition. 	
	
	
(b) Fair value of financial instruments carried at amortised cost
Except as detailed in the following table, it is considered that the carrying amounts of financial assets and financial 
liabilities recognised at amortised cost in the financial statements approximate their fair values.	
	
	
Fair Value
Hierarchy
Carrying
Amount
2024
€’m
Fair
Value
2024
€’m
Carrying
Amount
2023
€’m
Fair
Value
2023
€’m
Financial liabilities: Senior Notes - Public
Level 2
(3,435.9)
(3,242.3)
(2,441.8)
(2,204.5)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(c) Valuation principles	
The fair value of financial assets and liabilities are determined as follows:
- 	
assets and liabilities with standard terms and conditions which are traded on active liquid markets are determined 
with reference to quoted market prices. This includes equity investments;
- 	
other financial assets and liabilities (excluding derivatives) are determined in accordance with generally accepted 
pricing models based on discounted cash flow analysis using prices from observable current market transactions 
and dealer quotes for similar instruments. This includes interest rate swaps and forward foreign exchange 
contracts which are determined by discounting the estimated future cash flows; 	
- 	
the fair values of financial instruments that are not based on observable market data (unobservable inputs) 
requires entity specific valuation techniques; and	
- 	
derivative financial instruments are calculated using quoted prices. Where such prices are not available, a 
discounted cash flow analysis is performed using the applicable yield curve for the duration of the instruments. 
Forward foreign exchange contracts are measured using quoted forward exchange rates and yield curves derived 
from quoted interest rates adjusted for counterparty credit risk, which is calculated based on credit default swaps 
of the respective counterparties. Interest rate swaps are measured at the present value of future cash flows 
estimated and discounted based on the applicable yield curves derived from quoted interest rates adjusted for 
counterparty credit risk, which is calculated based on credit default swaps of the respective counterparties.	
300
301
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
27.	Retirement benefits obligation (continued)	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Defined benefit schemes (continued)	
The values used in the Group’s consolidated financial statements are based on the most recent actuarial valuations 
which have been updated by the schemes’ independent and professionally qualified actuaries to incorporate the 
requirements of IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits’ in order to assess the liabilities of the various schemes as at 31 December 
2024 using the projected unit credit method. All assets in the schemes have been measured at their fair value at the 
balance sheet date. Full actuarial valuations, which are not available for public inspection, are carried out every three 
years in Ireland (most recent 1 January 2024) and the UK (most recent 31 December 2023); and annually in the USA 
(most recent 1 January 2024). 	
The defined benefit schemes expose the Group to risks such as interest rate risk, investment risk, inflation risk and 
mortality risk.	
Interest rate risk
The present value of the defined benefit obligation is sensitive to the discount rate which is derived from the interest 
yield on high quality corporate bonds at the balance sheet date. Fluctuations in interest rates can significantly impact 
the present value of the defined benefit obligation which can lead to volatility in the Group’s consolidated financial 
statements. Interest rates also impact the funding requirements of the schemes. However, a portion of the schemes’ 
assets are invested in Liability Driven Investment (LDI) strategies which are designed to offset the impact of changes in 
interest rates on the scheme’s liabilities, hence mitigating some of the interest rate risk.
Investment risk
The net surplus/(deficit) recognised in the Consolidated Balance Sheet represents the present value of the defined 
benefit obligation less the fair value of the schemes’ assets. When assets generate a rate of return less than the 
discount rate this results in an increase/(decrease) in the net surplus/(deficit). The schemes have a diversified portfolio 
of investments which include equities, bonds and other asset classes. The investment allocation for each scheme is 
reviewed periodically by the scheme’s external investment consultants who advise on the most appropriate asset 
allocation taking account of asset valuations, funding requirements, liability duration and the achievement of an 
appropriate return on assets.	
Inflation risk	
A significant proportion of the defined benefit obligation is linked to inflation, therefore an increase in inflation rates will 
increase the defined benefit obligation. However, a portion of the schemes’ assets are invested in LDI strategies which 
are designed to offset the impact of changes in inflation rates on the scheme’s liabilities, hence mitigating some of the 
inflation rate risk. Some benefits are also subject to inflation caps.	
Mortality risk	
The present value of the defined benefit obligation is calculated by reference to the best estimate of the mortality  
of schemes’ participants. An increase in the life expectancy of the schemes’ participants will increase the defined  
benefit obligation.	
(i) Recognition in the Consolidated Income Statement and Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income	
The following amounts have been recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement and the Consolidated Statement of 
Comprehensive Income in relation to defined contribution and defined benefit post-retirement schemes:	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Service cost:
- Costs relating to defined contribution schemes
69.7
62.9
- Current service cost relating to defined benefit schemes
4.7
1.4
- Past service and settlements
(1.4)
(2.0)
Net interest income
(1.4)
(3.1)
Recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement
71.6
59.2
Re-measurements of the net defined benefit liability:
- Return on scheme assets (excluding amounts included in net interest cost)
90.6
(11.3)
- Experience (gains)/losses on schemes’ liabilities
(8.0)
11.9
- Actuarial gains arising from changes in demographic assumptions
(4.5)
(14.5)
- Actuarial (gains)/losses arising from changes in financial assumptions
(88.9)
47.4
Recognised in the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
(10.8)
33.5
Total
60.8
92.7
The total service cost is included in total staff numbers and costs (note 4) and the net interest (income)/cost is included 
in finance income and costs (note 6). 	
26.	Provisions		
	
	
Insurance
€’m
Non-Trading Items
€’m
Environmental
€’m
Total
€’m
Group:
At 1 January 2023
46.7
6.5
12.6
65.8
Provided during the financial year
17.1
2.2
2.4
21.7
Utilised during the financial year
(15.8)
-
-
(15.8)
Released during the financial year
(6.7)
-
-
(6.7)
Transferred to payables and accruals
-
(0.9)
-
(0.9)
Exchange translation adjustment
1.0
-
(0.4)
0.6
At 31 December 2023
42.3
7.8
14.6
64.7
Provided during the financial year
14.5
-
-
14.5
Utilised during the financial year
(3.3)
(7.3)
-
(10.6)
Released during the financial year
(13.3)
-
-
(13.3)
Transferred to payables and accruals
-
(0.5)
-
(0.5)
Exchange translation adjustment
2.1
-
0.7
2.8
At 31 December 2024
42.3
-
15.3
57.6
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Analysed as:
Current liabilities
7.0
18.3
Non-current liabilities
50.6
46.4
57.6
64.7
	
	
	
	
	
Insurance
The Group operates a level of self-insurance. Under these arrangements, the Group retains certain exposures up to 
pre-determined self-insurance levels. The amount of self-insurance is reviewed on a regular basis to ensure it remains 
appropriate. The provision for these exposures represents amounts provided for based on advice from insurance 
consultants, industry information, actuarial valuation and historical data in respect of claims that are classified as 
incurred but not reported and outstanding loss reserves. The methodology of estimating the provision is periodically 
reviewed to ensure that the assumptions made continue to be appropriate. The utilisation of the provision is dependent 
on the timing of settlement of the outstanding claims. Historically, the average time for settlement of outstanding 
claims ranges from 2 to 3 years from claim date.
Non-trading items
Non-trading items relate to restructuring and acquisition integration provisions expensed in 2023 and 2022.
Environmental	
This includes provisions for site remediation, restoration and environmental works stemming from established best 
practice for recently acquired acquisitions. The timing of utilisation of these provisions is uncertain.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
 27.	Retirement benefits obligation	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group operates post-retirement benefit schemes in a number of its businesses throughout the world. These 
schemes are structured to accord with local conditions and practices in each country they operate in and can include 
both defined contribution and defined benefit schemes. The assets of the schemes are held, where relevant, in separate 
trustee administered funds.	
Defined contribution schemes
The Group has a number of defined contribution pension schemes in operation. Payments to defined contribution 
schemes are recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement as they fall due.	
	
	
	
Defined benefit schemes	
Defined benefit post-retirement schemes exist primarily in Republic of Ireland, the UK and the USA (included in Rest of 
World). These defined benefit schemes comprise final salary pension schemes, career average salary pension schemes 
and post-retirement medical plans. All material defined benefit pension schemes are closed to future accrual. The 
post-retirement medical plans operated by the Group relate primarily to a number of USA employees and are closed to 
new entrants. Defined benefit schemes in Ireland, the UK, and the USA are administered by Boards of Trustees. These 
Boards are responsible for the management and governance of the schemes including compliance with all relevant laws 
and regulations.	
302
303
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
27.	Retirement benefits obligation (continued)
(iii) Financial and demographic assumptions (continued)	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The most significant demographic assumption is mortality. The mortality assumptions used are based on advice from 
the pension schemes’ actuaries and reflect each scheme’s population. The life expectancy of a member retiring at 31 
December at age 65, now and in 20 years’ time, some of which have been shown in range format to reflect the differing 
assumptions in each scheme, is as follows:	
2024
2023
Ireland
Years
UK
Years
Rest of 
World
Years
Ireland
Years
UK
Years
Rest of 
 World
Years
Male - retiring now
23
21
21 - 22
 23 
 21 
 21 - 22 
Female - retiring now
24
24
23
 24 
 23 
 23 
Male - retiring in 20 years’ time
24
23
22 - 23
 24 
 22 
 22 - 23 
Female - retiring in 20 years’ time
26
26
24 - 25
 26 
 26 
 24 - 25 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
There are inherent uncertainties surrounding the financial and demographic assumptions adopted by the Group. 
The assumptions may differ from the actual data as a result of changes in economic and market conditions as well as 
the actual experience within each scheme. The present value of post-retirement benefit schemes’ liabilities is heavily 
dependent on the discount rate. As the discount rate is based on a market driven measure, which is the interest yield on 
high quality corporate bonds at the balance sheet date, the present value of post-retirement benefit schemes’ liabilities 
can fluctuate significantly from valuation to valuation. The expected rate of inflation impacts the schemes’ liabilities 
in that inflation is the basis for the calculation of the assumed future salary and revaluation increases in each scheme 
where applicable. In relation to demographic assumptions, differing expectations regarding current and future changes 
in mortality rates can have a significant impact on the schemes’ liabilities.
The table below gives an approximate indication of the impact of a change in the principal financial actuarial 
assumptions (discount rate, inflation rate & pension increases and salary increases) and the principal demographic 
actuarial assumption (mortality) on the schemes’ liabilities. The present value of the defined benefit obligation has been 
calculated using the projected unit credit method. The impact on the defined benefit obligation at 31 December 2024 
is calculated on the basis that only one assumption is changed with all other assumptions remaining unchanged. The 
assessment of the sensitivity analysis below could therefore be limited as a change in one assumption may not occur in 
isolation as assumptions may be correlated. There have been no changes from the previous year in the methods and 
assumptions used in preparing the sensitivity analysis.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Impact on schemes’ liabilities of changes in assumptions
2024
2023
Change in Assumption
Ireland 
%
UK 
%
Rest of 
World 
%
Ireland 
%
UK 
%
Rest of 
 World 
%
Discount rate
Decrease of 0.50%
7.9%
7.1%
3.7%
8.2%
8.1%
4.0%
Increase of 0.50%
(7.0%)
(6.4%)
(3.4%)
(7.3%)
(7.2%)
(3.8%)
Inflation Rate and Pension Increases
Increase of 0.50%
6.2%
2.6%
-
6.5%
3.3%
-
Decrease of 0.50%
(5.6%)
(2.8%)
-
(5.9%)
(3.4%)
-
Salary Increase
Increase of 0.50%
-
-
0.2%
-
-
0.2%
Decrease of 0.50%
-
-
(0.2%)
-
-
(0.2%)
Mortality
Increase in life expectancy of 1 Year
3.5%
4.0%
1.9%
4.1%
4.0%
2.0%
Decrease in life expectancy of 1 Year
(3.5%)
(4.0%)
(1.9%)
(4.1%)
(4.0%)
(2.0%)
27.	Retirement benefits obligation (continued)
(ii) Recognition in the Consolidated Balance Sheet	
The net defined benefit post-retirement schemes’ surplus/(deficit) at 31 December, which has been recognised in the 
Consolidated Balance Sheet, was as follows:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Schemes
in Surplus
2024
€’m
Schemes
in Deficit
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Schemes
in Surplus
2023
€’m
Schemes
in Deficit
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Present value of defined benefit obligation
(304.9)
(644.1)
(949.0)
(314.2)
(703.1)
(1,017.3)
Fair value of scheme assets
405.6
610.7
1,016.3
412.2
653.4
1,065.6
Net recognised surplus/(deficit) before deferred tax
100.7
(33.4)
67.3
98.0
(49.7)
48.3
Net related deferred tax (liability)/asset
(12.6)
8.2
(4.4)
(12.3)
12.2
(0.1)
Net recognised surplus/(deficit) after deferred tax
88.1
(25.2)
62.9
85.7
(37.5)
48.2
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Net recognised surplus/(deficit) by region:	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Ireland
2024
€’m
UK
2024
€’m
Rest of
World
2024
€’m
Total
2024
€’m
Ireland
2023
€’m
UK
2023
€’m
Rest of
World
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Present value of defined 
benefit obligation
(304.9)
(555.9)
(88.2)
(949.0)
(314.2)
(617.1)
(86.0)
(1,017.3)
Fair value of scheme assets
405.6
545.4
65.3
1,016.3
412.2
589.1
64.3
1,065.6
Net recognised surplus/
(deficit) before deferred tax
100.7
(10.5)
(22.9)
67.3
98.0
(28.0)
(21.7)
48.3
Net related deferred tax 
(liability)/asset
(12.6)
2.6
5.6
(4.4)
(12.3)
6.9
5.3
(0.1)
Net recognised surplus/
(deficit) after deferred tax
88.1
(7.9)
(17.3)
62.9
85.7
(21.1)
(16.4)
48.2
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The surplus at 31 December 2024 relates to the Irish scheme (31 December 2023: Irish scheme) and has been 
recognised in accordance with IFRIC 14 ‘The Limit on a Defined Benefit Asset, Minimum Funding Requirements and their 
Interaction’ as it has been determined that the Group has an unconditional right to a refund of the surplus.	
In June 2023, the UK High Court (Virgin Media Limited V NTL Pension Trustees II Limited) ruled that certain historical 
amendments for contracted-out defined benefit schemes were invalid if they were not accompanied by the relevant 
actuarial confirmation. The judgement was appealed and in July 2024 the UK Court of Appeal upheld the decision of the 
High Court. The Group is currently evaluating the impact of this ruling. However, as the evaluation is still ongoing, it is 
appropriate that no changes have been made to the Group Consolidated Financial Statements at this time.
(iii) Financial and demographic assumptions	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The principal financial assumptions used by the Group’s actuaries in order to calculate the defined benefit obligation 
at 31 December, some of which have been shown in range format to reflect the differing assumptions in each scheme, 
were as follows:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
2023
Ireland
%
UK
%
Rest of 
World
%
Ireland
%
UK
%
Rest of 
World
%
Rate used to discount schemes’ liabilities
3.60
5.60
4.75 - 6.00
3.60
4.60
4.70 - 6.00
Inflation assumption
2.10
3.10
2.50
2.20
3.00
2.50
Rate of increase in salaries
N/A*
N/A*
3.50
N/A*
N/A*
4.50
Rate of increase for pensions in payment  
and deferred pensions
2.10
2.00 - 2.95
-
2.20
2.35 - 2.95
-
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Not applicable as the Irish and UK defined benefit schemes are closed to future accrual.	
304
305
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
27.	Retirement benefits obligation (continued)
(iv) Reconciliations for defined benefit schemes (continued)	
The fair values of each of the categories of the pension schemes’ assets at 31 December were as follows:	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Liability Driven Investment
514.3
604.5
Other Bonds and Debt Securities:
- Investment Grade Credit
163.7
181.7
- Asset Backed Securities
176.7
92.3
- Other bonds
-
54.8
Equities:
- Global Equities
145.2
96.0
- Emerging Market Equities
-
11.4
Diversified Growth Funds
-
13.9
Cash and other
16.4
11.0
Total fair value of pension schemes’ assets
1,016.3
1,065.6
The majority of equity securities and bonds have quoted prices in active markets. The schemes’ assets are invested 
with professional investment managers. Investments in the Group’s own financial instruments, if any, are solely at the 
discretion of the investment managers concerned. The actual amount of the Group’s own financial instruments held by 
the pension schemes during 2024 and 2023 were not material. No property held by the pension schemes was occupied 
by the Group nor were any other pension schemes’ assets used by the Group during 2024 or 2023.	
The Irish, UK and USA schemes have invested in Liability Driven Investment (LDI) strategies. The primary goal of this asset 
class is to mitigate the impact of interest rate and inflation volatility and enable better matching of investment returns 
with the cash outflows required to pay benefits. The LDI solutions invest in various leveraged/unleveraged bonds and 
derivatives and the value of the LDI assets at 31 December 2024 across the schemes was €514.3m (2023: €604.5m) which 
is based on the latest market bid price for the underlying investments, which are traded daily on liquid markets.
(v) Funding for defined benefit schemes
The Group operates a number of defined benefit schemes in a number of countries and each scheme is required to 
be operated in line with local legislation, conditions, practices and the regulatory framework in place for the specific 
country. As a result, there are a number of different funding arrangements in place that accord with the specific local 
legislative, regulatory and actuarial requirements.
Funding for each scheme is carried out by cash contributions from the Group’s subsidiaries. These funding 
arrangements have been advised by the pension schemes’ actuaries and agreed between the Group and the relevant 
Trustees. Actuarial valuations, which are not available for public inspection, are carried out every three years in Ireland 
and the UK; and every year in the USA. During the financial year ending 31 December 2025, the Group expects to make 
contributions of approximately €12.0m to its defined benefit schemes.	
28.	Share capital	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Group and Company:
Authorised
280,000,000 A ordinary shares of 12.50 cent each
35.0
35.0
Allotted, called-up and fully paid (A ordinary shares of 12.50 cent each)
At beginning of the financial year 
21.9
22.1
Shares issued during the financial year
2.1
-
Shares cancelled during the financial year
(3.2)
(0.2)
At end of the financial year
20.8
21.9
	
	
	
	
	
	
The Company has one class of ordinary share which carries no right to fixed income. The total number of shares in issue 
at 31 December 2024 was 166,440,652 (2023: 175,792,661).
27.	Retirement benefits obligation (continued)
(iv) Reconciliations for defined benefit schemes	
	
	
	
	
The movements in the defined benefit schemes’ obligation during the financial year were:	 	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Present value of the defined benefit obligation at beginning of the financial year
(1,017.3)
(964.3)
Current service cost
(4.7)
(1.4)
Past service and settlements
1.4
2.0
Contributions by employees
-
-
Interest expense
(44.2)
(44.5)
Benefits paid
48.8
45.2
Re-measurements:
- experience gains/(losses) on schemes’ liabilities
8.0
(11.9)
- actuarial gains arising from changes in demographic assumptions
4.5
14.5
- actuarial gains/(losses) arising from changes in financial assumptions
88.9
(47.4)
Exchange translation adjustment
(34.4)
(9.5)
Present value of the defined benefit obligation at end of the financial year
(949.0)
(1,017.3)
Present value of the defined benefit obligation at end of the financial year that relates to:
Wholly unfunded schemes
(17.4)
(14.0)
Wholly or partly funded schemes
(931.6)
(1,003.3)
(949.0)
(1,017.3)
The weighted average duration of the defined benefit obligation at 31 December 2024 is approximately 15 years  
(2023: approximately 15 years).
The movements in the schemes’ assets during the financial year were:	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Fair value of scheme assets at beginning of the financial year
1,065.6
1,029.7
Interest income
45.6
47.6
Contributions by employer
12.5
12.0
Contributions by employees
-
-
Benefits paid
(48.8)
(45.2)
Re-measurements:
- return on scheme assets (excluding amounts included in net interest cost)
(90.6)
11.3
Exchange translation adjustment
32.0
10.2
Fair value of scheme assets at end of the financial year
1,016.3
1,065.6
306
307
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
29.	Share-based payments (continued)	 	
	
	
	
(i) Long-Term Incentive Plan (continued) 	 	
	
	
	
	
For the 2022, 2023 and 2024 awards, the performance conditions are weighted 40% for Adjusted EPS growth calculated 
on a constant currency basis, 25% for TSR, 15% for ROACE and the remaining 20% of the shares/share options will vest 
according to the Group’s Sustainability metrics versus predetermined targets. An invitation may lapse if a participant 
ceases to be employed within the Group before the vesting date.	
Under the LTIP, the Group introduced career shares awards, under which an invitation to participate was made to a 
limited number of senior executives. The proportion of each invitation which vests will depend on personal objectives 
during a three year period (‘the performance period’) and the senior executives remaining within the Group for a four 
year period (‘the retention period’). The invitations made in 2019 - 2021 will potentially vest in 2025 - 2027 respectively. 
An invitation may lapse if a participant ceases to be employed within the Group before the vesting date.
A summary of the status of the LTIP as at 31 December and the changes during the financial year are presented below:	
Number of 
Conditional 
Awards 
2024
Number of 
Conditional 
Awards 
2023
Outstanding at beginning of the financial year
1,600,533
1,420,418
Forfeited
(119,539)
(88,076)
Shares vested 
(76,723)
(59,462)
Share options vested
(188,811)
(112,933)
Relinquished
(155,329)
(210,134)
New conditional awards 
791,831
650,720
Outstanding at end of the financial year
1,851,962
1,600,533
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Number of Conditional Awards 2024
Number of Conditional Awards 2023
Shares
Share 
Options 
Total
Shares
Share 
Options 
Total
Outstanding at beginning of 
the financial year
444,904
1,155,629
1,600,533
417,964
1,002,454
1,420,418
Forfeited
(56,944)
(62,595)
(119,539)
(40,046)
(48,030)
(88,076)
Vested
(76,723)
(188,811)
(265,534)
(59,462)
(112,933)
(172,395)
Relinquished
(42,499)
(112,830)
(155,329)
(58,848)
(151,286)
(210,134)
New conditional awards
234,059
557,772
791,831
185,296
465,424
650,720
Outstanding at end of the 
financial year
502,797
1,349,165
1,851,962
444,904
1,155,629
1,600,533
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Number of 
Share 
Options
2024
Number of 
Share 
Options
2023
Share options arising under the LTIP
Outstanding at beginning of the financial year
260,397
240,118
Options released at vesting date 
161,968
69,805
Options released from deferral
54,130
62,432
Exercised 
(170,909)
(111,958)
Outstanding and exercisable at end of the financial year
305,586
260,397
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Share options under the LTIP scheme have an exercise price of 12.50 cent. The remaining weighted average life for 
share options outstanding is 2.8 years (2023: 3.8 years). The weighted average share price at the date of exercise was 
€83.79 (2023: €86.80). 26,843 share options (2023: 43,128 share options) which vested in the financial year are deferred 
and therefore are not exercisable at year end. 	
28.	Share capital (continued)	
	
	
	
	
Shares issued 	
During 2024 a total of 264,089 (2023: 179,441) A ordinary shares, each with a nominal value of 12.50 cent, were issued 
at nominal value per share under the Long-Term and Short-Term Incentive Plans. 	
Share exchange pursuant to Kerry Dairy Ireland Sale 	
Arising from the implementation of the share exchange as part of Phase 1 of the sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland, the 
Company, on 31 December 2024, redeemed and cancelled Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited’s entire shareholding 
of 19,045,396 A Ordinary Shares and the Company issued a total of 16,187,024 A Ordinary Shares directly to the 
members of Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited and to satisfy fractional share entitlements. As a result, the 
Company’s issued share capital reduced by 2,858,372 shares. See Note 8 for further information regarding the sale of 
Kerry Dairy Ireland.  
Share Buyback Programme
At the 2024 Annual General Meeting, shareholders passed a resolution authorising the Company to purchase up to 10% 
of its own issued share capital. 	
In May 2024 and November 2024, the Board approved new Share Buyback Programmes of up to €300 million each. 
The Share Buyback Programmes are underpinned by the Group’s strong balance sheet and cash flow and is aligned to 
Kerry’s Capital Allocation Framework. 
The May 2024 Share Buyback Programme commenced on 7 May 2024 and was completed by 12 November 2024. The 
total number of shares acquired as part of the May 2024 Share Buyback Programme was 3,632,456 at a cost of €300.3m 
including transaction costs of €0.3m. 
The November 2024 Share Buyback Programme commenced on 13 November 2024. In the period from 13 November 
2024 to 31 December 2024 the Company purchased 644,079 shares at a total cost of €57.6m. At 31 December 2024, 
there was no financial liability recorded in relation to the Share Buyback Programme. Since the period end, and up to  
31 January 2025, the Company repurchased 458,271 shares at a cost of €43.3m.
The previous Share Buyback Programme announced in October 2023, commenced on 1 November 2023 and was 
completed by 30 April 2024. The total number of shares acquired during 2023 was 1,373,261 at a cost of €101.7m. 
During the period 1 January 2024 to 30 April 2024, an additional 2,481,191 shares were acquired at a cost of €198.6m, 
resulting in a total number of shares acquired as part of this programme of 3,854,452 at a total cost of €300.3m 
including transaction costs of €0.3m. 	
All shares acquired as part of the above Share Buyback Programmes were A ordinary shares with a nominal value of 
12.50 cent. The shares acquired were cancelled immediately following their repurchase.	
The buyback programme is conducted in accordance with the relevant provisions of the Market Abuse Regulation 
596/2014/EU (‘MAR’ and including MAR as in force in the UK and as amended by the Market Abuse (Amendment) (EU 
Exit) Regulations 2019) and the Commission Delegated Regulation (EU) 2016/1052 (including as in force in the UK and as 
amended by the FCA’s Technical Standards (Market Abuse Regulation) (EU Exit) Instrument 2019) as well as the rules of 
the Central Bank of Ireland.	
29.	Share-based payments	
	
	
	
	
The Group operates three equity-settled share-based payment plans. The first plan is the Group’s Long-Term Incentive 
Plan, the second is the element of the Group’s Short-Term Incentive Plan that is settled in shares/share options after 
a 2 year deferral period and the third is the Group’s All Employee Share Plan. Details on each of the Group’s plans are 
outlined below and are the same as those recognised in the Company financial statements. 
The Group recognised an expense of €39.8m (2023: €21.6m) related to equity-settled share-based payment transactions 
in the Consolidated Income Statement during the financial year. The expectation of meeting performance criteria was 
taken into account when calculating this expense.	
(i) Long-Term Incentive Plan
The Group operates an equity-settled Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) under which an invitation to participate was made 
to Executive Directors and senior executives. The proportion of each invitation which vests will depend on the Adjusted 
Earnings Per Share (EPS) performance, Total Shareholder Return (TSR), Return on Average Capital Employed (ROACE) 
and Sustainability metrics of the Group during a three year period (‘the performance period’). The invitations made in 
2022, 2023 and 2024 will potentially vest in 2025, 2026 and 2027 respectively. 
308
309
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
30.	Cash flow components	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(i) Cash flow analysis	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Notes
Group
2024
€’m
Group
2023
€’m
Company
2024
€’m
Company
2023
€’m
Change in working capital
(Increase)/decrease in inventories
(26.6)
220.9
-
-
(Increase)/decrease in trade and other receivables
(165.1)
136.2
(1,684.2)
(163.2)
Increase/(decrease) in trade and other payables
116.9
(176.0)
19.2
3.6
Decrease in non-current liabilities
(8.4)
(17.2)
-
-
Share-based payment expense 
29
39.8
21.6
39.8
21.6
(43.4)
185.5
(1,625.2)
(138.0)
Purchase of assets
Purchase of property, plant and equipment
(278.3)
(266.0)
-
-
Purchase of intangible assets
13
(27.5)
(15.9)
-
-
(305.8)
(281.9)
-
-
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash at bank and in hand
24
1,610.0
943.7
-
-
Bank overdrafts
24
(2.4)
(34.7)
-
-
1,607.6
909.0
-
-
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(ii) Net debt reconciliation	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Note
Cash at 
bank and 
in hand
€’m
Overdrafts 
due within 
1 year*
€’m
Interest 
Rate 
Swaps 
€’m
Borrowings 
due within 
1 year*
€’m
Borrowings 
due after 
1 year*
€’m
Net Debt 
 - pre lease 
liabilities
€’m
Lease 
liabilities*
€’m
Net 
Debt
€’m
At 1 January 2023
970.0
(0.2)
15.5
(700.9)
(2,432.6)
(2,148.2)
(69.2) (2,217.4)
Cash flows
(8.9)
(34.5)
(34.4)
687.3
4.5
614.0
36.4
650.4
Foreign exchange 
adjustments
(17.4)
-
2.5
12.9
(0.3)
(2.3)
1.3
(1.0)
Other non-cash 
movements
-
-
6.9
(1.7)
(4.2)
1.0
(37.1)
(36.1)
At 31 December 2023
24
943.7
(34.7)
(9.5)
(2.4)
(2,432.6)
(1,535.5)
(68.6) (1,604.1)
Cash flows
642.1
32.3
(3.3)
2.5
(994.0)
(320.4)
40.8
(279.6)
Foreign exchange 
adjustments
24.2
-
(10.8)
(0.1)
-
13.3
(1.2)
12.1
Other non-cash 
movements
-
-
7.4
(947.9)
943.9
3.4
(57.6)
(54.2)
At 31 December 2024
24
1,610.0
(2.4)
(16.2)
(947.9)
(2,482.7)
(1,839.2)
(86.6) (1,925.8)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Liabilities from financing activities. 	
29.	Share-based payments (continued)	 	
	
	
	
(i) Long-Term Incentive Plan (continued) 
At the invitation grant date, the fair value per conditional award and the assumptions used in the calculations are  
as follows:	
	
	
	
	
	
LTIP Scheme
2024
Conditional
Award at
Grant Date
2023
Conditional
Award at
Grant Date
2022
Conditional
Award at
Grant Date
2021
Conditional
Award at
Grant Date
Conditional Award Invitation date
March 2024
March 2023
March 2022
March 2021
Year of potential vesting
2027
2026
2025
2024
Share price at grant date
€80.94
€91.26
€95.46
€107.80
Exercise price*
€0.125
€0.125
€0.125
€0.125
Expected volatility
21.9%
22.9%
28.6%
25.5%
Expected life
3 years
3 years
3 years
3 years
Risk free rate
2.6%
3.1%
(0.3%)
(0.7%)
Expected dividend yield
1.4%
1.0%
0.8%
0.8%
Expected forfeiture rate
5.0%
5.0%
5.0%
5.0%
Weighted average fair value at grant date
€65.20
€73.50
€77.68
€89.78
Valuation model
Monte Carlo 
Pricing
Monte Carlo 
Pricing
Monte Carlo 
Pricing
Monte Carlo 
Pricing
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Exercise price refers to exercise price for both shares and share options.
Expected volatility was determined by calculating the historical volatility of the Group’s share price over the previous 
three years. Market based vesting conditions, such as the TSR condition, have been taken into account in establishing 
the fair value of equity instruments granted. The TSR performance over the period is measured against the TSR 
performance of a peer group of listed companies. Non‐market based performance conditions were not taken into 
account in establishing the fair value of equity instruments granted, however the number of equity instruments 
included in the measurement of the transaction is adjusted so that the amount recognised is based on the number of 
equity instruments that eventually vest.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(ii) Short-Term Incentive Plan	
	
	
	
	
	
In 2013 the Group’s Short-Term Incentive Plan (STIP) for Executive Directors was amended to incorporate a share-based 
payment element with 33% of the total bonus to be settled in shares/share options. The shares/share options awarded 
as part of this scheme will be issued 2 years after the vesting date once a deferral period has elapsed. There are no 
further performance conditions relating to the shares/share options during the deferral period.
There are 14,808 share options (2023: 5,601 share options) outstanding and exercisable in relation to the STIP.	
A share-based payment expense is recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement for the scheme to reflect the cash 
value of the bonus to be paid by way of shares/share options. The issuance of shares/share options under the STIP 
which related to the 2023 and 2024 financial years will be released from deferral in 2025 and 2026 respectively.
(iii) All Employee Share Plan	
	
	
	
	
	
The Group implemented a new all employee share plan (AESP) in September 2023. Phase one of the plan was available 
to employees in the following countries: Ireland, UK, Spain, Australia, India, Indonesia, Thailand and Singapore. Phase 
two of the plan was implemented in September 2024 and was extended to the following countries: Brazil, Canada, 
China, Costa Rica, Denmark, France, Germany, Italy, Malaysia, Mexico, Netherlands, New Zealand, Oman, Poland, United 
Arab Emirates and the United States. The plan is structured as an equity-settled scheme. Under the plan, participating 
employees are granted one share for every three shares purchased. The additional share is issued to the participating 
employee after a two-year period.
The expense of €244,032 (2023: €5,623) related to the AESP has been recognised in the Consolidated Income Statement. 
The fair value of the shares granted under the AESP as at December 31 2024 was €nil (2023: €nil). The weighted average 
fair value of the shares granted was €nil (2023: €nil). 
310
311
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
31.	Business combinations (continued)		
	
	
	
	
	
	
The acquisition method has been used to account for businesses acquired in the Group’s financial statements. Given 
that the valuation of the fair value of assets and liabilities recently acquired is still in progress, some of the values 
are determined provisionally, primarily values relating to property, plant and equipment and liabilities (as not all 
information is available at this point in time). The valuation of the fair value of assets and liabilities will be completed 
within the measurement period. For the acquisitions completed in 2023, there have been material revisions of the 
provisional fair value adjustments since the initial values were established as outlined in the table below. The Group 
performs quantitative and qualitative assessments of each acquisition in order to determine whether it is material for 
the purposes of separate disclosure under IFRS 3 ‘Business Combinations’. None of the acquisitions completed during 
the period were considered material to warrant separate disclosure.
The goodwill is attributable to the expected profitability, revenue growth, future market development and assembled 
workforce of the acquired businesses and the synergies expected to arise within the Group after the acquisition. €24.5m 
of the goodwill recognised is expected to be deductible for income tax purposes.
Transaction expenses related to these acquisitions of €2.9m were charged in the Group’s Consolidated Income 
Statement during the financial year. The fair value of the financial assets acquired includes trade and other receivables 
with a fair value of €3.7m and a gross contractual value of €3.8m. 
The revenue and profit after taxation attributable to equity holders of the parent to the Group contributed from date of 
acquisition for all business combinations effected during the financial year is as follows:	
	
	
	
Total
2024
€’m
Revenue
40.7
Profit after taxation attributable to equity holders of the parent
5.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The revenue and profit after taxation attributable to equity holders of the parent to the Group determined in 
accordance with IFRS as though the acquisition date for all business combinations effected during the financial year had 
been the beginning of that financial year would be as follows:	 	
	
	
	
	
 Continuing Operations
2024
acquisitions
€’m
Kerry Group 
excluding
2024
acquisitions
€’m
Consolidated
Group
including
acquisitions
€’m
Revenue
 59.4 
 6,888.4 
 6,947.8 
Profit after taxation attributable to equity holders of the parent
 7.5 
668.1
675.6
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2023 Acquisitions
During 2023, the Group completed a total of two acquisitions both of which are 100% owned by the Group. The initial 
assessment of fair values to identifiable net assets acquired was performed on a provisional basis. As part of the 
finalisation of the expected contingent consideration and the fair value exercise in respect of the 2023 acquisitions, the 
Group considered the valuations applied to intangible and tangible assets acquired. The outcome of this exercise resulted 
in a reduction of goodwill arising on acquisition by €58.0m and a reduction in contingent consideration of €75.1m. The 
amendments to these fair values were made to the comparative figures during the subsequent reporting window within 
the measurement period imposed by IFRS 3 ‘Business Combinations’. The provisional fair value of these assets recorded, 
together with the adjustments made to those carrying values to arrive at the final fair values were as follows:
Provisional fair
values of 2023
acquisitions
2023
€’m
Measurement
period
adjustments
2023
€’m
Total
2023
€’m
Property, plant and equipment
9.7
-
9.7
Goodwill arising on acquisition
176.9
(58.0)
118.9
Other brand-related intangibles
41.6
(18.5)
23.1
Non-current assets
228.2
(76.5)
151.7
Current assets
14.2
-
14.2
Non-current liabilities
(13.5)
1.4
(12.1)
Current liabilities
(18.8)
-
(18.8)
Total identifiable assets
210.1
(75.1)
135.0
Total consideration
210.1
(75.1)
135.0
31.	Business combinations	
	
	
	
	
	
The following acquisitions were completed by the Group during 2024:	
	
	
	
	
	
Acquisition
Type
Completion 
date
Percentage  
acquired
Segment
Principal activity Strategic rationale
Part of the 
global lactase 
enzymes 
business of 
Novonesis 
(formerly 
Chr. Hansen 
Holdings 
A/S (‘Chr. 
Hansen’) and 
Novozymes A/S 
(‘Novozymes’)).
Asset 
& 
Equity
April 2024
Certain trade and 
assets of Chr. 
Hansen’s global 
lactase enzyme 
business on a 
carve-out basis and 
100% of the share 
capital of Nuocheng 
Trillion Food (Tianjin) 
Co., Ltd., a Chinese 
subsidiary of 
Novozymes.
Taste & 
Nutrition
The Lactase 
Enzymes 
Business which 
includes NOLA® 
Products, further 
enhances Kerry’s 
biotechnology 
solutions 
capability.
This acquisition adds 
enzyme technology which 
helps create lactose-free 
and sugar reduced dairy 
products, while preserving 
their authentic clean 
taste. Global demand for 
lactase is being driven by 
increased awareness of 
lactose intolerance, while 
many consumers are also 
choosing lactose-free for 
lifestyle and health reasons.
LactoSens® 
testing 
technology.
Asset
September 
2024
The LactoSens® 
testing technology 
assets and related 
business from 
DirectSens GmbH.
Taste & 
Nutrition
Lactose testing 
technology.
To enhance Kerry’s position 
and capability in providing 
the complete solution as 
regards lactose-free dairy 
products.
The table below provides details of the identifiable net assets, including adjustments to provisional fair values,  
in respect of the acquisitions completed during the year ended 31 December 2024:	
	
	
	
Total
2024
€’m
Recognised amounts of identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed:
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment
43.1
Brand related intangibles
86.8
Current assets
Cash at bank and in hand
0.8
Inventories
5.9
Trade and other receivables
3.8
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables
(2.3)
Non-current liabilities
Other non-current liabilities
(0.1)
Total identifiable assets
138.0
Goodwill
29.2
Total consideration
167.2
 
Satisfied by:
Cash
167.2
Net cash outflow on acquisition:
Total
2024
€’m
Cash
167.2
Less: cash and cash equivalents acquired
(0.8)
166.4
312
313
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
34.	Related party transactions (continued)	
(iii) Trading with joint ventures	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Details of transactions and balances outstanding with joint ventures are as follows:	
	
	
	
Rendering of services
Sale of goods
Amounts receivable 
at 31 December
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Joint ventures
-
0.1
0.4
0.2
4.8
4.2
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
These trading transactions are undertaken and settled at normal trading terms.	
(iv) Trading with other related parties
As detailed in the Directors’ Report, Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited was considered to be a related party of the 
Group during 2024 as a result of its significant shareholding in the Parent Company. During 2024, dividends of €23.3m 
(2023: €21.6m) were paid to Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited based on its shareholding. A subsidiary of Kerry 
Group plc traded product to the value of €0.1m (2023: €0.1m) on behalf of Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited.
On 31 December 2024, Phase 1 of the sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland to Kerry Co-Operative Creameries Limited completed. 
At 31 December 2024, Kerry Group plc had a net trading receivable balance of €12.3m which consisted of a receivable 
balance of €21.9m and a payable balance of €9.6m with Kerry Dairy Ireland. Receivables from Kerry Co-Operative 
Creameries Limited as part of the Phase 1 sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland are disclosed in note 8. In note 21 an amount due 
to related parties of €50.0m is included within ‘Other payables and accruals’ in both the group and company financial 
statements. See notes 8, 21, 25 (v)(d) and 28 for further information.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(v) Transactions with key management personnel	
The Board of Directors are deemed to be key management personnel of Kerry Group plc as they are responsible for 
planning, directing and controlling the activities of the Group.
In addition to their salaries and short-term benefits, the Group also contributes to post-retirement defined benefit, 
defined contribution and saving plans on behalf of the Executive Directors (note 27). The Directors also participate in the 
Group’s Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) (note 29). 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Remuneration cost of key management personnel is as follows:	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Short-term benefits (salaries, fees and other short-term benefits)
11.1
8.6
Post-retirement benefits
0.3
0.3
LTIP accounting charge
5.1
2.9
Other long-term benefits
-
-
Termination benefits
-
-
Total
16.5
11.8
Retirement benefit charges of €0.1m (2023: €0.1m) arise under a defined benefit scheme relating to 1 Director  
(2023: 1 Director) and charges of €0.2m (2023: €0.2m) arise under a defined contribution scheme relating to 2 Directors 
(2023: 2 Directors). The LTIP accounting charge above is determined in accordance with the Group’s accounting policy 
for share-based payments. 	
Post-retirement benefits in the above table and the statutory and listing rules disclosure in respect of pension 
contributions in the Executive Directors’ remuneration table in the remuneration report are determined on a current 
service cost basis.
The aggregate amount of gains accruing to Executive Directors on the exercise of share options is €nil (2023: €1.8m). 
Dividends totalling €0.2m (2023: €0.1m) were also received by key management personnel during the financial year, 
based on their personal interests in the shares of the company.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
32.	Contingent liabilities	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Company:
(i) Guarantees in respect of borrowings of subsidiaries
 3,436.3 
2,476.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(ii) For the purposes of Section 357 of the Companies Act, 2014, the Company has undertaken by Board resolution to 
indemnify the creditors of its subsidiaries incorporated in the Republic of Ireland, as set out in note 37, in respect of 
all amounts shown as liabilities or commitments in the statutory financial statements as referred to in Section 357 (1) 
(b) of the Companies Act, 2014 for the financial year ending on 31 December 2024 or any amended financial period 
incorporating the said financial year. All other provisions of Section 357 have been complied with in this regard. The 
Company has given similar indemnities in relation to its subsidiaries in Germany (section 264 paragraph 3 of the 
Commercial Code), Luxembourg (Article 70 of the Luxembourg law of 19 December 2002 as amended) and Netherlands 
(Article 2:403 of the Dutch Civil Code), as set out in note 37. In addition, the Company has also availed of the exemption 
from filing subsidiary financial statements in Luxembourg, Germany, Netherlands and Ireland.
The Company does not expect any material loss to arise from these guarantees and considers their fair value to  
be negligible.
33.	Other financial commitments
Commitments for the acquisition of property, plant, equipment and computer software at 31 December for which no 
provision has been made in the accounts are as follows:	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Group:
Commitments in respect of contracts placed
93.4
50.8
Expenditure authorised by the Directors but not contracted for at the financial year end
150.2
150.9
243.6
201.7
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
34.	Related party transactions 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
(i) Trading with Directors
In the ordinary course of business as a farmer during 2024, one Director has traded on standard commercial terms 
with the Group’s Dairy Ireland reporting segment. Aggregate purchases from, and sales to, this Director during the year 
amounted to €0.1m (2023: €0.1m) and €nil (2023: €nil) respectively. The trading balance outstanding to the Group at the 
financial year end was €nil. All transactions with this Director were on standard commercial terms. No expense has been 
recognised in the financial year for bad or doubtful debts in respect of amounts owed by this Director.
(ii) Trading between Parent Company and subsidiaries
Transactions in the financial year between the Parent Company and its subsidiaries included:	
	
	
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Dividends received by the Parent Company
 2,550.0 
668.3
Cost recharges from subsidiaries of the Parent Company
 31.0 
27.4
Trade and other receivables to the Parent Company
2,039.5
394.2
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
314
315
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
37.	Group entities	
	
	
	
Principal subsidiaries and joint venture undertakings	
Country
Company Name
Nature of Business
Registered Office
Ireland
Carteret Investments Unlimited Company
Investment
1
Cuarto Limited
Taste & Nutrition
1
Dawn Dairies Limited
Services
1
Golden Vale Limited
Investment
1
Kerry Agri Business Holdings Limited
Investment
1
Kerry Dairy Consumer Foods Limited
Services
1
Kerry Food Ingredients (Cork) Limited
Taste & Nutrition
1
Kerry Group Business Services Limited
Services
1
Kerry Group Finance International Limited
Services
1
Kerry Group Financial Services Unlimited Company
Services
1
Kerry Group Services International Limited
Services
1
Kerry Group Services Limited
Services
1
Kerry Health and Nutrition Institute Limited
Taste & Nutrition
1
Kerry Holdings International (Ireland) Limited
Investment
1
Kerry Holdings (Ireland) Limited
Investment
1
Kerry Ingredients & Flavours Limited
Taste & Nutrition
1
Kerry Dairy Holdings (Ireland) Limited (30% shareholding) Investment
1
Kerry Taste & Nutrition (Ireland) Limited
Taste & Nutrition
1
Lifesource Foods Research Limited
Investment
1
Linovale Limited
Investment
1
Princemark Holdings Designated Activity Company
Services
1
Tacna Investments Limited
Investment
1
Zenbury International Limited
Services
1
UK
Dairy Produce Packers Limited
Services
2
Golden Vale (NI) Limited
Investment 
2
Kerry Foods Limited
Services
3
Kerry Holdings (U.K.) Limited
Investment
3
Kerry Ingredients (UK) Limited
Taste & Nutrition
3
Kerry Ingredients Holdings (U.K.) Limited
Investment
3
Kerry Management Services (UK) Limited
Services
3
Belgium
Kerry Ingredients Belgium N.V.
Taste & Nutrition
4
Netherlands
Kerry (NL) B.V.
Taste & Nutrition
5
Kerry Group B.V.
Investment
5
Proparent B.V. (75% shareholding)
Taste & Nutrition
6
Niacet B.V.
Taste & Nutrition
7
Czech Republic Kerry Ingredients & Flavours S.R.O.
Taste & Nutrition
8
France
Kerry Ingredients Holdings France SAS
Investment
9
Kerry Savoury Ingredients France SAS
Taste & Nutrition
9
Kerry Flavours France SAS
Taste & Nutrition
10
35.	Events after the balance sheet date	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Since the financial year end, the Group has:	
- 	
proposed a final dividend of 89.0 cent per A ordinary share (note 11); 
- 	
subsequent to year end, the Company repurchased 458,271 shares at a cost of €43.3m up to 31 January 2025.  
The Company’s intention is to continue to repurchase shares up to the announced amount of €300.0m and will  
end no later than 30 June 2025 (note 28); and	
	
- 	
Following the sale of Kerry Dairy Ireland (which formed the Dairy Ireland segment) as described in note 8, 
effective 2025 the Group’s reportable segments will change from two to the following three segments: Europe, 
Americas and APMEA. See note 2 for further information. In the Group’s financial reporting for 2025, comparative 
information for 2024 will be restated to reflect the changes in reportable segments. Segmental information 
presented in these financial statements is based on the segment structure for the financial year ended 31 
December 2024, being Taste & Nutrition and Dairy Ireland. The change in segment reporting post year end  
does not have a financial impact on the Group’s Consolidated Financial Statements for the financial year ended  
31 December 2024. 	
There have been no other significant events, outside the ordinary course of business, affecting the Group since  
31 December 2024.
36.	Reserves	 	
Fair value through other comprehensive income reserve (FVOCI)
The fair value through other comprehensive income reserve represents the unrealised gains and losses on the financial 
assets held at fair value through other comprehensive income by the Group.
Capital redemption reserve
Capital redemption reserve represents the nominal cost of the cancelled shares in 2007, 2023 and 2024.
Other undenominated capital
Other undenominated capital represents the amount transferred to reserves as a result of renominalising the share 
capital of the Parent Company due to the euro conversion in 2002.
Share-based payment reserve
The share-based payment reserve relates to invitations made to employees to participate in the Group’s Long-Term 
Incentive Plan and the All Employee Share Plan for participating employees. Further information in relation to share-
based payment is set out in note 29.
Translation reserve
Exchange differences relating to the translation of the balance sheets of the Group’s foreign currency operations from 
their functional currencies to the Group’s presentation currency (euro) are recognised directly in other comprehensive 
income and accumulated in the translation reserve.	
Hedging reserve
The hedging reserve represents the effective portion of gains and losses on hedging instruments from the application 
of cash flow hedge accounting for which the underlying hedged transaction is not impacting profit or loss. The 
cumulative deferred gain or loss on the hedging instrument is reclassified to profit or loss only when the hedged 
transaction affects the profit or loss.
Cost of hedging reserve
The cost of hedging reserve arises from where the Group has entered into cross currency interest rate swaps. Such 
cross currency interest rate swaps have basis risk as there are characteristics in the cross currency interest rate swap 
contracts that are not present in the hedged item, being currency basis spreads.
Retained earnings	
Retained earnings refers to the portion of net income, which is retained by the Group rather than distributed to 
shareholders as dividends.	
Non-controlling interests
Non-controlling interests represent the portion of the equity of a subsidiary not attributable either directly or indirectly 
to the Group.	
316
317
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
37.	Group entities (continued)	
	
	
	
Principal subsidiaries and joint venture undertakings (continued)	
Country
Company Name
Nature of Business
Registered Office
El Salvador
Baltimore Spice de El Salvador, S.A. de C.V.
Taste & Nutrition
46
Aromaticos de Centro America, S.A. de C.V.
Taste & Nutrition
46
Thailand
Kerry Ingredients (Thailand) Limited
Taste & Nutrition
47
Philippines
Kerry Food Ingredients (Philippines), Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
48
Kerry Manufacturing (Philippines), Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
49
Singapore
Kerry Ingredients (S) PTE Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
50
Malaysia
Kerry Ingredients (M) Sdn. Bhd.
Taste & Nutrition
51
Kerry Group Business Services (ASPAC) Sdn. Bhd.
Taste & Nutrition
51
Almer Malaysia Sdn. Bhd.
Taste & Nutrition
51
Japan
Kerry Japan Kabushiki Kaisha
Taste & Nutrition
52
China
Kerry Food Ingredients (Hangzhou) Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
53
Kerry Foods (Nantong) Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
54
TianNing Flavor & Fragrance (JiangSu) Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
55
Zhejiang Hangmai Food Technologies Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
56
Sias Food Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
57
Shandong Tianbo Food Ingredients Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
58
Shanghai Greatang Orchard Food Co., Ltd.
Taste & Nutrition
59
Kerry Food (Shandong) Co., Limited
Taste & Nutrition
60
Kerry Food (Shanghai) Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
61
Nuocheng Trillion Food (Tianjin) Co., Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
62
Egypt
Kerry Egypt LLC
Taste & Nutrition
63
Indonesia
PT. Kerry Ingredients Indonesia
Taste & Nutrition
64
PT. Kerry Trading Indonesia
Taste & Nutrition
65
India
Kerry Ingredients India Private Limited
Taste & Nutrition
66
Australia
Kerry Ingredients Australia Pty. Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
67
New Zealand
Kerry Ingredients (NZ) Limited
Taste & Nutrition
68
Kenya
Kerry Kenya Limited
Taste & Nutrition
69
Kerry Taste & Nutrition Kenya Limited
Taste & Nutrition
69
Cameroon
Afribon Cameroun SARL
Taste & Nutrition
70
Nigeria
Kerry Ingredients Nigeria Limited
Taste & Nutrition
71
Rwanda
Kerry Taste & Nutrition Rwanda Limited
Taste & Nutrition
72
Tanzania
Kerry Taste & Nutrition Tanzania Ltd
Taste & Nutrition
73
Uganda
Kerry Taste & Nutrition Uganda - SMC Limited 
Taste & Nutrition
74
South Africa
Kerry Ingredients South Africa (Proprietary) Limited
Taste & Nutrition
75
South Korea
Kerry Ingredients Korea LLC
Taste & Nutrition
76
Saudi Arabia
AATCO Food Industries LLC
Taste & Nutrition
77
Oman
Kerry Oman S.P.C.
Taste & Nutrition
78
Vietnam
Kerry Taste & Nutrition (Vietnam) Company Limited
Taste & Nutrition
79
UAE
Kerry MENAT DMCC
Taste & Nutrition
80
 
Notes	
	
	
	
(a)	
All group entities are wholly owned subsidiaries unless otherwise stated.	
	
	
(b)	
Country represents country of incorporation and operation. Ireland refers to the Republic of Ireland.	
(c)	
With the exception of the USA, Canadian and Mexican subsidiaries, where the holding is in the form of common 
stock, all holdings are in the form of ordinary shares.		
	
(d)	
Pursuant to Section 314-316 of the Companies Act 2014, a full list of subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated 
undertakings will be annexed to the Company’s Annual Return to be filed in the Companies Registration Office  
in Ireland.
37.	Group entities (continued)	
	
	
	
Principal subsidiaries and joint venture undertakings (continued)	
Country
Company Name
Nature of Business
Registered Office
Germany
Kerry Food GmbH
Taste & Nutrition
11
Kerry Ingredients GmbH
Taste & Nutrition
11
Red Arrow Handels GmbH
Taste & Nutrition
12
Kerry Biotech GP GmbH
Taste & Nutrition
13
c-LEcta GmbH (93% shareholding)
Taste & Nutrition
14
Denmark
Cremo Ingredients A/S
Taste & Nutrition
15
Italy
Kerry Ingredients & Flavours Italia S.p.A.
Taste & Nutrition
16
Poland
Kerry Polska Sp. z o.o.
Taste & Nutrition
17
Hungary
Kerry Hungaria Kft
Taste & Nutrition
18
Luxembourg
Kerry Luxembourg S.a.r.l.
Services
19
Zenbury International Limited S.a.r.l.
Services
19
Romania
Kerry Romania S.R.L.
Taste & Nutrition
20
Spain
Kerry Iberia Taste & Nutrition, S.L.U.
Taste & Nutrition
21
Harinas y Sémolas del Noroeste, S.A.U.
Taste & Nutrition
22
Pevesa Biotech, S.A.U.
Taste & Nutrition
23
Biosearch, S.A.U.
Taste & Nutrition
24
Slovakia
Dera SK, S.R.O.
Taste & Nutrition
25
Sweden
Tarber AB
Taste & Nutrition
26
Ukraine
Kerry Ukraine LLC
Taste & Nutrition
27
USA
Kerry Holding Co.
Investment
28
Kerry Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
28
Ganeden Biotech, Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
28
Fleischmann’s Vinegar Company, Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
28
Insight Beverages, Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
29
Kerry Stock & Broth Company Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
30
Niacet Corporation
Taste & Nutrition
31
Natreon, Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
32
Canada
Kerry (Canada) Inc.
Taste & Nutrition
33
Mexico
Kerry Ingredients (de Mexico), S.A. de C.V.
Taste & Nutrition
34
Enmex, S.A. de C.V.
Taste & Nutrition
35
Brazil
Kerry do Brasil Ltda
Taste & Nutrition
36
Kerry da Amazonia Ingredientes e Aromas Ltda
Taste & Nutrition
37
Costa Rica
Baltimore Spice Central America, S.A.
Taste & Nutrition
38
Chile
Kerry Chile Ingredientes, Sabores Y Aromas Ltda
Taste & Nutrition
39
Colombia
Kerry Ingredients & Flavours Colombia S.A.S.
Taste & Nutrition
40
Real S.A.S.
Taste & Nutrition
41
Proexcar S.A.S.
Taste & Nutrition
42
Panama
Kerry Panama S.A.
Taste & Nutrition
43
Guatemala
Baltimore Spice Guatemala, S.A.
Taste & Nutrition
44
Kerry Guatemala, S.A.
Taste & Nutrition
44
Aromaticos de Centroamerica, S.A.
Taste & Nutrition
45
318
319
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
Financial Statements / Notes to the Financial Statements 
37.	Group entities (continued)
Registered Office (continued)
44
Kilómetro 26.5 Carretera al Pacifico, Paso a Desnivel, Entrada a Amatitlán, Amatitlán, Guatemala.
45
23 Avenida 34-61, Zona 12, Colonia Santa Elisa, Guatemala, Guatemala.
46
2 Calle Oriente Avenida Melvin Jones, Local 14, Centro Comercial Argoz, Santa Tecla, La Libertad, El Salvador.
47
No. 618, Moo 4, Bangpoo Industrial Estate, Tambol Prakesa, Amphur Muang Samutprakarn, Samutprakarn 
Province, Thailand.
48
Room 406, Cebu Business & Investments Consultants, 4/F Tulips Centre, AS Fortuna Street, Mandaue City, Cebu, 
6014, Philippines.
49
8/F The W Fifth Avenue Building, 5th Avenue, Bonifacio Global City, Fort Bonifacio, Taguig City, 1634, Philippines.
50
8A Biomedical Grove, #02-05/12, Immunos, 138648, Singapore.
51
Tricor Corporate Services Sdn Bhd (779773-H), Suite 1301, 13th Floor, City Plaza, Jalan Tebrau, 80300 Johor Bahru, 
Johor, Malaysia.
52
Kamiyacho Sankei Building, 2F, 1-7-2, Azabudai 1-chome, Minato-ku, Tokyo 106-0041, Japan.
53
Renhe Industry Zone, Jiulong Village, Hangzhou, China.
54
North Side of Xiangjiang Road, Rudong County, Nantong City, China.
55
Dujiashan, Huayang County, Jurong, Jiangsu Province, 212425, China.
56
26 Tai Ping Qiao Industry Park, Xin’an, Deqing County, Zhejiang Province, China.
57
North side of XinYe Road, West side of LiDaXian, DaChang Industrial District, LangFang City, HeBei Province, China.
58
No.6 Haichuan Road, Jiezhuang Street, Hi-tech Zone, Jining, Shandong Province, China.
59
No. 101 Qianxin Road, Jinshanwei Town, Jinshuan District, Shanghai, China.
60
Southeast corner of intersection of Quanxing Road and Jingong Road, Economic Development Zone, Sishui County, 
Jining City, Shandong, 272000, China.
61
Floor 2,3,4, Building B, No 1397 Yishan Road, Xuhui District, Shanghai, China.
62
No.35 Taihua Road, Tianjin Economic and Technological Development Area, China.
63
5th Floor, Namaa Bulding, Rameses Extension Street, 6th District, Nasr City, Cairo, Egypt.
64
JL. Industri Utama Blok SS-6 Kws.Ind Jababeka II, Cikarang Utara, Desa/Kelurahan Mekarmukti, Kec. Cikarang 
Utara, Kab. Bekasi, Provinsi Jawa Barat, 17834, Indonesia.
65
Jalan Industri Utama Blok SS-6 Kawasan Industri Jababeka 2, Desa/Kelurahan Mekarmukti, Kec. Cikarang Utara, 
Kab. Bekasi, Provinsi Jawa Barat, 17834, Indonesia.
66
8th Floor, Pritech Park Annex, Marathahalli-Sarjapur Outer Ring Road, Bellandur, Bangalore, Karnataka, 560103, 
India.
67
Suite 202, 7-9 Irvine Place Bella Vista NSW 2153, Australia.
68
11-13 Bell Avenue, Otahuhu, Auckland, New Zealand.
69
EcoGreen Business Centre, Ngecha Chunga Mali Road, Off A104 Nairobi -Nakuru Highway, Kenya.
70
Akwa, Douala, PO Box 5449, Cameroon.
71
1st Floor Plot 8, Dr Nurdeen Olowopop Ikeja Central Business District, Agidingbi, Ikeja, Lagos Estate, Nigeria.
72
Niboye, Kicukiro, Umujyi wa Kigali, Rwanda.
73
Plot Number 24, Sawe Street, Mikocheni Industrial Road, P.O. Box 62043, Dar-es-Salaam, United Republic of 
Tanzania.
74
Plot No.3 Kakoma Road, Barkati House, Ntinda Industrial Area, Kampala, Uganda.
75
Block 3 Nguni Park, 4-6 Lucas Drive, Hillcrest, Durban, KwaZulu Natal, 3610, South Africa.
76
9th Fl., Sheenbang Bldg, 2575 Nambusunhwan-ro, Seocho-Gu, Seoul, 06735, Republic of Korea.
77
PO Box Number: 5802, PC 21432, 2nd Industrial City, Jeddah, Kingdom of Saudi Arabia.
78
P.O. Box 130, Postal Code 322, Sohar, Sultanate of Oman, Oman.
79
Me Linh Point Tower, 2 Ngo Duc Ke Street, Ben Nghe Ward, District 1, Ho Chi Minh City, Vietnam.
80
Unit No: AG-GF-01, AG Tower, Plot No: JLT-PH1-I1A, Jumeirah Lakes Towers, Dubai, United Arab Emirates.
37.	Group entities (continued)	
	
	
	
	
Registered Office	
	
	
	
	
1
Prince’s Street, Tralee, Co Kerry, V92 EH11, Ireland.
2
Millburn Road, Coleraine, Londonderry, BT52 1QZ, United Kingdom.
3
Kerry, Bradley Road, Royal Portbury Dock, Bristol, BS20 7NZ, United Kingdom.
4
Boulevard Industriel 9, 1070, Brussels, Belgium.
5
Maarssenbroeksedijk 2a, 3542 DN, Utrecht, Netherlands.
6
Cuneraweg 9c, 4051 CE, Ochten, Netherlands.
7
Papesteeg 91, 4006 WC Tiel, Netherlands.
8
Pujmanové 1753/10a, Nusle, 140 00, Praha 4, Czech Republic.
9
43 Rue Pasteur, 62575, Blendecques, France.
10
Zone Industrielle du Plan, BP 82067, 06131 Grasse cedex, France.
11
Hauptstrasse 22, 63924, Kleinheubach, Germany.
12
Hanna-Kunath-Strasse 25, 28199, Bremen, Germany.
13
c/o Kerry Food GmbH, Hauptstrasse 22, 63924, Kleinheubach, Germany.
14
Perlickstrasse 5, 04103, Leipzig, Germany.
15
Toftegårdsvej 3, DK-5620, Glamsbjerg, Denmark.
16
Via Capitani di Mozzo, 12/16, 24030, Mozzo, Bergamo, Italy.
17
Ul. Energetyczna 13, 56-400, Olesnica, Poland.
18
Dévai utca 26-28, Budapest, H-1134, Hungary.
19
17 Rue Antoine Jans, Luxembourg, L-1820, Luxembourg.
20
5th Floor, Room A-7.3, 313 - 315 Barbu Vacarescu Street, District 2, Bucharest, 020272, Romania.
21
Calle Coto de Doñana, 15, 28320 Pinto, Madrid, Spain.
22
Polígono Industrial de las Gándaras de Budiño, O Porriño, Pontevedra, Spain.
23
Avenida Industria S/N Pol. Ind. Poliviso, 41520 El Viso Del Alcor, Sevilla, Spain.
24
Camino del Purchil, 66, 18004, Granada, Spain.
25
Hodžovo námestie 1A, Bratislava, 811 06, Slovakia.
26
Box 1420 - Frejgatan 13, 114 79 Stockholm, Sweden.
27
Khmelnytska Street, 20/21, Kiev, 03115, Ukraine.
28
3400 Millington Road, Beloit WI 53511, United States.
29
635 Oakwood Drive, Lake Zurich IL 60047, United States.
30
1711 North Liberty Street, Harrisonburg VA 22802, United States.
31
275 Northpointe Parkway, Suite 105, Amherst NY 14228, United States.
32
2-D Janine Place, New Brunswick NJ 08901, United States.
33
Osler, Hoskin & Harcourt, LLP, 100 King Street West, 1 First Canadian Place, Suite 6200, PO Box 50, Toronto  
ON M5X IB8, Canada.
34
Carretera Panamericana Irapuato-Salamanca, Km 11.2, Apartado Postal 789, Irapuato, Guanajuato, 36660, Mexico.
35
Rio Lerma 228, Fraccionamiento Industrial San Nicolas, Tlalnepantla de Baz, Estado de Mexico, CP 54030, Mexico.
36
Avenida Mercedes Benz 460, Distrito Industrial, Campinas, Sao Paolo, 13054-750, Brazil.
37
Rua Hidra 188, Santo Agostinho, Manaus, 69036-520, Brazil.
38
Liceo de Pavas 200m West, 100 mts North, PO Box 1035 - 1200, San Jose, 10109, Costa Rica.
39
C.M. El Trovador No 4280, Of 1205, Las Condes, Suc. Cerro Portezuelo 9901, Quilicura, Santiago, Chile.
40
Carrera 7 No 71-52, Torre A Piso 5, Bogota, Colombia.
41
Carrera 3 # 6a – 100 oficina 703., Ed. Torre Protección, Cartagena, Bolivar, Colombia.
42
Carrera 50G #10B - Sur 14, Bodega 6, Medellin, Antioquia, Colombia.
43
Parque Industrial Costa del Este, Calle 3ra Lote 88. Corregimiento Parque Lefevre, 0819-01869, Panama.
320
321
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
CONTENTS
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024

SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
Financial Statements / Financial Definitions
Financial Statements / Financial Definitions
Supplementary Information 
FINANCIAL DEFINITIONS
(not covered by independent auditors’ report)
Kerry uses a number of financial and non-financial key performance indicators (KPIs) to measure performance across 
its business. These KPIs help inform decision making, assist effective goal setting and track progress in achieving the 
Group’s strategic objectives. Kerry believes that long-term sustainable success will be achieved by generating value for all 
stakeholders, while developing and monitoring strategy, managing the risks that face the organisation and embedding 
the Group’s purpose and values. Non-financial key performance indicators are outlined in pages 26-27, while the principal 
financial definitions used by the Group, together with reconciliations where the non-IFRS measures are not readily 
identifiable from the financial statements, are as follows:	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
1.	 Revenue	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Volume performance	 	
	
	
	
	
	
This represents the sales performance year-on-year, excluding pass-through pricing on input costs, currency impacts, 
acquisitions, disposals and rationalisation volumes.	
Volume performance is an important metric as it is seen as the key driver of organic top-line business improvement. 
Pricing therefore impacts revenue performance positively or negatively depending on whether input costs move up or 
down. A full reconciliation to reported revenue performance is detailed in the revenue reconciliation below.
Revenue Reconciliation	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
Volume 
performance
Price
Transaction 
currency Acquisitions
 Disposals
Translation 
currency
Reported 
revenue 
performance
Taste & Nutrition
3.4%
(2.1%)
0.2%
0.8%
(1.8%)
(1.2%)
(0.7%)
Dairy Ireland -  
discontinued operations
1.6%
2.2%
0.3%
 - 
(2.3%)*
0.7%
2.5%
Group
3.3%
(1.9%)
0.2%
0.7%
(1.9%)
(0.9%)
(0.5%)
2023
Taste & Nutrition
1.1%
1.1%
-
1.2%
(6.0%)
(3.4%)
(6.0%)
Dairy Ireland - 
discontinued operations
(6.5%)
(9.3%)
(0.1%)
 - 
-
(0.7%)
(16.6%)
Group
(0.9%)
(0.7%)
-
1.0%
(5.1%)
(2.9%)
(8.6%)
* Reduction in revenue reflects changes in contractual arrangements implemented in the current year, where Dairy Ireland has  
become an agent, in accordance with IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’. The related revenue in 2024 amounted  
to €2.7m (2023: €32.5m).	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
2.	 EBITDA	
	
	
	
	
	
	
EBITDA represents profit after taxation before finance income and costs, income taxes, depreciation (net of capital 
grant amortisation), intangible asset amortisation, non-trading items and share of joint ventures’ results after taxation. 
EBITDA is reflective of underlying trading performance and allows comparison of the trading performance of the 
Group’s businesses, either year-on-year or with other businesses.	
	
	
	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2024
€’m
 
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2023
€’m
 
Total
2023
€’m
Profit after taxation
673.4
61.0
734.4
700.7
27.4
 728.1 
Share of joint ventures’ 
results after taxation 
0.9
-
0.9
1.9
-
 1.9 
Finance income
(34.8)
-
(34.8)
(21.8)
-
(21.8)
Finance costs
88.3
0.4
88.7
71.8
0.3
 72.1 
Income taxes
105.0
2.4
107.4
89.7
4.8
 94.5 
Non-trading items
55.8
(24.2)
31.6
(8.1)
(0.7)
(8.8)
Intangible asset amortisation
87.6
0.2
87.8
79.3
0.2
 79.5 
Depreciation (net)
211.8
23.0
234.8
198.2
21.4
 219.6 
EBITDA
 1,188.0 
 62.8 
1,250.8
 1,111.7 
 53.4 
 1,165.1 
3. 	 EBITDA Margin	
	
	
	
	
	
	
EBITDA margin represents EBITDA expressed as a percentage of revenue.	
	
	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2024
€’m
 
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2023
€’m
 
Total
2023
€’m
EBITDA
 1,188.0 
 62.8 
 1,250.8 
 1,111.7 
 53.4 
 1,165.1 
Revenue
 6,929.1 
 1,051.5 
 7,980.6 
 6,974.9 
 1,045.4 
 8,020.3 
EBITDA margin
17.1%
6.0%
15.7%
15.9%
5.1%
14.5%
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
4. 	 Operating Profit 	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Operating profit is profit before income taxes, finance income, finance costs and share of joint ventures’ results after 
taxation.	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2024
€’m
 
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2023
€’m
 
Total
2023
€’m
Profit before taxation
778.4
 63.4 
841.8
 790.4 
 32.2 
 822.6 
Finance income 
(34.8)
-
(34.8)
(21.8)
-
(21.8)
Finance costs
 88.3 
 0.4 
 88.7 
 71.8 
 0.3 
 72.1 
Share of joint ventures’ 
results after taxation
 0.9 
 - 
 0.9 
 1.9 
 - 
 1.9 
Operating profit
832.8
 63.8 
896.6
 842.3 
 32.5 
 874.8 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
5. 	 Group Income Statement	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
2024
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2024
€’m
 
Total
2024
€’m
Continuing 
Operations
2023
€’m
Discontinued 
Operations
2023
€’m
 
Total
2023
€’m
External revenue
6,879.0
1,101.6
7,980.6
6,936.7
1,083.6
8,020.3
Inter-segment revenue
50.1
(50.1)
-
38.2
(38.2)
-
Revenue
6,929.1
1,051.5
7,980.6
6,974.9
1,045.4
8,020.3
EBITDA
1,188.0
62.8
1,250.8
1,111.7
53.4
1,165.1
Depreciation (net)
(211.8)
(23.0)
(234.8)
(198.2)
(21.4)
(219.6)
Intangible asset amortisation
(87.6)
(0.2)
(87.8)
(79.3)
(0.2)
(79.5)
Non-trading items
(55.8)
24.2
(31.6)
8.1
0.7
8.8
Operating profit
832.8
63.8
896.6
842.3
32.5
874.8
Finance income
34.8
-
34.8
21.8
-
21.8
Finance costs
(88.3)
(0.4)
(88.7)
(71.8)
(0.3)
(72.1)
Share of joint ventures’ 
results after taxation 
(0.9)
-
(0.9)
(1.9)
-
(1.9)
Profit before taxation
778.4
63.4
841.8
790.4
32.2
822.6
Income taxes
(105.0)
(2.4)
(107.4)
(89.7)
(4.8)
(94.5)
Profit after taxation
673.4
61.0
734.4
700.7
27.4
728.1
322
323
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS

SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
Financial Statements / Financial Definitions
Financial Statements / Financial Definitions
6. 	 Adjusted Earnings Per Share and Performance in Adjusted Earnings Per Share  
on a Constant Currency Basis 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
The performance in adjusted earnings per share on a constant currency basis is provided as it is considered more 
reflective of the Group’s underlying trading performance. Adjusted earnings is profit after taxation attributable to equity 
holders of the parent before brand related intangible asset amortisation and non-trading items (net of related tax). 
These items are excluded in order to assist in the understanding of underlying earnings. A full reconciliation of adjusted 
earnings per share to basic earnings is provided below. Constant currency eliminates the translational effect that arises 
from changes in foreign currency year-on-year. The performance in adjusted earnings per share on a constant currency 
basis is calculated by comparing current year adjusted earnings per share to the prior year adjusted earnings per share 
retranslated at current year average exchange rates. 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Continuing and Discontinued operations
2024
EPS
cent
Performance
%
2023
EPS
cent
Performance
%
Basic earnings per share 
424.5
3.4%
410.4
20.0%
Brand related intangible asset amortisation
33.9
-
29.5
-
Non-trading items (net of related tax) 
9.1
-
(9.8)
-
Adjusted earnings per share
467.5
8.7%
430.1
(2.4%)
Impact of retranslating prior year adjusted earnings per 
share at current year average rates*
1.0%
3.6%
Growth in adjusted earnings per share on a constant 
currency basis
9.7%
1.2%
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Impact of 2024 translation was (4.4)/430.1 cent = 1.0% (2023: 3.6%). 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Continuing 
Operations
2024
EPS
cent
Discontinued 
Operations
2024
EPS
cent
Total
2024
EPS
cent
Continuing 
Operations
2023
EPS
cent
Discontinued 
Operations
2023
EPS
cent
Total
2023
EPS
cent
Basic earnings per share 
389.2
35.3
424.5
395.0
15.4
410.4
Brand related intangible asset 
amortisation
33.8
0.1
33.9
29.5
-
29.5
Non-trading items (net of related tax) 
25.2
(16.1)
9.1
(9.6)
(0.2)
(9.8)
Adjusted earnings per share
448.2
19.3
467.5
414.9
15.2
430.1
Adjusted EPS Growth (%)
8.0%
27.0%
8.7%
Impact of exchange rate translation*
1.1%
(1.3%)
1.0%
Growth in adjusted earnings per share 
on a constant currency basis
9.1%
25.7%
9.7%
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
* Impact of 2024 translation for continuing operations was (4.6)/414.9 cent = 1.1% 
* Impact of 2024 translation for discontinued operations was 0.2/15.2 cent = (1.3%) 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
7. 	 Free Cash Flow	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Free cash flow is EBITDA plus movement in average working capital, capital expenditure net (purchase of assets, 
payment of lease liabilities, (outflow)/inflow from the sale of assets (net of disposal expenses) and capital grants 
received), pensions contributions paid less pension expense, finance costs paid (net) and income taxes paid.
Free cash flow is seen as an important indicator of the strength and quality of the business and of the availability to 
the Group of funds for reinvestment or for return to shareholders. Movement in average working capital is used when 
calculating free cash flow as management believes this provides a more accurate measure of the increase or decrease 
in working capital needed to support the business over the course of the year rather than at two distinct points in time 
and more accurately reflects fluctuations caused by seasonality and other timing factors. Average working capital is the 
sum of each month’s working capital over 12 months adjusted for the impact of acquisitions and disposals. Below is a 
reconciliation of free cash flow to the nearest IFRS measure, which is ‘Net cash from operating activities’.	
	
Continuing and Discontinued operations
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Net cash from operating activities
988.7
1,037.8
Difference between movement in monthly average working capital and movement  
in the financial year end working capital
72.3
(147.1)
Payments on non-trading items
 50.7 
99.8
Purchase of assets 
(305.8)
(281.9)
Payment of lease liabilities
(40.8)
(36.4)
(Outflow)/inflow from the sale of property, plant and equipment
(5.6)
11.6
Capital grants received
2.3
 3.3 
Exchange translation adjustment
3.8
14.2
Free cash flow
765.6
701.3
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
8. 	 Cash Conversion	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Cash conversion is defined as free cash flow, expressed as a percentage of adjusted earnings after taxation.  
Cash conversion is an important metric as it measures how much of the Group’s adjusted earnings is converted into cash.
Continuing and Discontinued operations
2024
€’m
2023
€’m
Free cash flow
765.6
701.3
Profit after taxation attributable to equity holders of the parent
734.4
728.3
Brand related intangible asset amortisation
58.6
52.3
Non-trading items (net of related tax)
15.8
(17.4)
Adjusted earnings after taxation
808.8
763.2
Cash Conversion
95%
92%
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
9. 	 Liquidity Analysis		
	
	
	
	
	
The Net debt:EBITDA and EBITDA:Net interest ratios disclosed are calculated using an adjusted EBITDA, adjusted finance 
costs (net of finance income) and an adjusted net debt value to adjust for the impact of acquisitions net of disposals and 
deferred payments in relation to acquisitions. 	
	
	
	
	
	
2024
Times
2023
Times
Net debt:EBITDA
1.6
 1.5 
EBITDA:Net interest
21.7
 21.8 
	
	
	
	
	
	
324
325
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS

SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION
Financial Statements / Financial Definitions
10.	Average Capital Employed - continuing operations
Average capital employed is calculated by taking an average of the shareholders’ equity less vendor loan note relating 
to the Sweet Ingredients Portfolio divestment and net debt over the last three reported balance sheets.	
	
2024
€’m
H1 2024
€’m
2023
€’m
H1 2023
€’m
2022
€’m
Equity attributable to equity holders of the parent
6,485.8
 6,512.8 
 6,521.3 
 6,356.5 
 6,221.9 
Vendor loan note
(124.6)
(128.0)
(124.3)
(125.0)
Net debt 
1,925.8
 1,843.9 
 1,604.1 
 1,846.5 
 2,217.4 
Total capital employed
8,287.0
 8,228.7 
 8,001.1 
 8,078.0 
 8,439.3 
Average capital employed
8,172.3
 8,172.8 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
11.	Return on Average Capital Employed (ROACE) 	 	
	
	
	
	
	
This measure is defined as profit after taxation attributable to equity holders of the parent before non-trading 
items (net of related tax), brand related intangible asset amortisation and finance income and costs expressed as a 
percentage of average capital employed. ROACE is a key measure of the return the Group achieves on its investment in 
capital expenditure projects, acquisitions and other strategic investments.	
	
	
	
	
Continuing and Discontinued operations
2024 
€’m
2023 
€’m
Profit after taxation attributable to equity holders of the parent
 734.4 
 728.3 
Non-trading items (net of related tax)
15.8
(17.4)
Brand related intangible asset amortisation
58.6
 52.3 
Net finance costs
 53.9 
 50.3 
Adjusted profit
 862.7 
 813.5 
Average capital employed
8,172.3
 8,172.8 
Return on average capital employed
10.6%
10.0%
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
12.	Total Shareholder Return 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Total shareholder return represents the change in the capital value of Kerry Group plc shares plus dividends in the 
financial year. 		
	
	
	
	
	
2024
2023
Share price (1 January)
€78.66
€84.24
Interim dividend (cent)
38.1
 34.6 
Dividend paid (cent)
80.8
 73.4 
Share price (31 December)
€93.25
€78.66
Total shareholder return
20.1%
(5.3%)
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
13. Market Capitalisation	
	
	
	
	
	
	
Market capitalisation is calculated as the share price times the number of shares in issue.	
	
	
	
2024
2023
Share price (31 December)
€93.25
€78.66
Shares in issue (‘000)
166,440.7
 175,792.7 
Market capitalisation (€’m)
15,520.6
 13,827.9 
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
14. Enterprise Value	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Enterprise value is calculated as per external market sources. It is market capitalisation plus reported borrowings less 
total cash and cash equivalents.	 	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
	
15. Net Debt	 	
	
	
	
	
	
Net debt comprises borrowings and overdrafts, interest rate derivative financial instruments, lease liabilities and cash at 
bank and in hand. See full reconciliation of net debt in note 24 to the financial statements on pages 285-286.
326
CBP023485
Kerry Group
Prince’s Street, Tralee, 
Co. Kerry, V92 EH11, Ireland.
T: +353 66 718 2000
www.kerry.com
DIRECTORS’ REPORT
STRATEGIC REPORT
Kerry Group Annual Report 2024
SUSTAINABILITY STATEMENT
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS